1 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2 . This is the primary source of the Exim Manual. It is an xfpt document that is
3 . converted into DocBook XML for subsequent conversion into printing and online
4 . formats. The markup used herein is "standard" xfpt markup, with some extras.
5 . The markup is summarized in a file called Markup.txt.
7 . WARNING: When you use the .new macro, make sure it appears *before* any
8 . adjacent index items; otherwise you get an empty "paragraph" which causes
9 . unwanted vertical space.
10 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
15 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
16 . This outputs the standard DocBook boilerplate.
17 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22 . These lines are processing instructions for the Simple DocBook Processor that
23 . Philip Hazel has developed as a less cumbersome way of making PostScript and
24 . PDFs than using xmlto and fop. They will be ignored by all other XML
26 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
30 foot_right_recto="&chaptertitle; (&chapternumber;)"
31 foot_right_verso="&chaptertitle; (&chapternumber;)"
32 toc_chapter_blanks="yes,yes"
33 table_warn_overflow="overprint"
37 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38 . This generate the outermost <book> element that wraps then entire document.
39 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
43 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
44 . These definitions set some parameters and save some typing. Remember that
45 . the <bookinfo> element must also be updated for each new edition.
46 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
48 .set previousversion "4.80"
51 .set ACL "access control lists (ACLs)"
52 .set I " "
55 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
56 . Additional xfpt markup used by this document, over and above the default
57 . provided in the xfpt library.
58 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
60 . --- Override the &$ flag to automatically insert a $ with the variable name
62 .flag &$ $& "<varname>$" "</varname>"
64 . --- Short flags for daggers in option headings. They will always be inside
65 . --- an italic string, but we want the daggers to be roman.
67 .flag &!! "</emphasis>†<emphasis>"
68 .flag &!? "</emphasis>‡<emphasis>"
70 . --- A macro for an Exim option definition heading, generating a one-line
71 . --- table with four columns. For cases when the option name is given with
72 . --- a space, so that it can be split, a fifth argument is used for the
82 .itable all 0 0 4 8* left 6* center 6* center 6* right
83 .row "&%$1%&" "Use: &'$2'&" "Type: &'$3'&" "Default: &'$4'&"
87 . --- A macro for the common 2-column tables. The width of the first column
88 . --- is suitable for the many tables at the start of the main options chapter;
89 . --- the small number of other 2-column tables override it.
91 .macro table2 196pt 254pt
92 .itable none 0 0 2 $1 left $2 left
95 . --- A macro that generates .row, but puts &I; at the start of the first
96 . --- argument, thus indenting it. Assume a minimum of two arguments, and
97 . --- allow up to four arguments, which is as many as we'll ever need.
101 .row "&I;$1" "$2" "$3" "$4"
105 .row "&I;$1" "$2" "$3"
113 . --- Macros for option, variable, and concept index entries. For a "range"
114 . --- style of entry, use .scindex for the start and .ecindex for the end. The
115 . --- first argument of .scindex and the only argument of .ecindex must be the
116 . --- ID that ties them together.
119 &<indexterm role="concept">&
120 &<primary>&$1&</primary>&
122 &<secondary>&$2&</secondary>&
128 &<indexterm role="concept" id="$1" class="startofrange">&
129 &<primary>&$2&</primary>&
131 &<secondary>&$3&</secondary>&
137 &<indexterm role="concept" startref="$1" class="endofrange"/>&
141 &<indexterm role="option">&
142 &<primary>&$1&</primary>&
144 &<secondary>&$2&</secondary>&
150 &<indexterm role="variable">&
151 &<primary>&$1&</primary>&
153 &<secondary>&$2&</secondary>&
159 .echo "** Don't use .index; use .cindex or .oindex or .vindex"
161 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
164 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
165 . The <bookinfo> element is removed from the XML before processing for Ascii
167 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
171 <title>Specification of the Exim Mail Transfer Agent</title>
172 <titleabbrev>The Exim MTA</titleabbrev>
173 <date>17 May 2012</date>
174 <author><firstname>Exim</firstname><surname>Maintainers</surname></author>
175 <authorinitials>EM</authorinitials>
176 <revhistory><revision>
177 <revnumber>4.80</revnumber>
178 <date>17 May 2012</date>
179 <authorinitials>EM</authorinitials>
180 </revision></revhistory>
181 <copyright><year>2012</year><holder>University of Cambridge</holder></copyright>
186 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
187 . This chunk of literal XML implements index entries of the form "x, see y" and
188 . "x, see also y". However, the DocBook DTD doesn't allow <indexterm> entries
189 . at the top level, so we have to put the .chapter directive first.
190 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
192 .chapter "Introduction" "CHID1"
195 <indexterm role="variable">
196 <primary>$1, $2, etc.</primary>
197 <see><emphasis>numerical variables</emphasis></see>
199 <indexterm role="concept">
200 <primary>address</primary>
201 <secondary>rewriting</secondary>
202 <see><emphasis>rewriting</emphasis></see>
204 <indexterm role="concept">
205 <primary>Bounce Address Tag Validation</primary>
206 <see><emphasis>BATV</emphasis></see>
208 <indexterm role="concept">
209 <primary>Client SMTP Authorization</primary>
210 <see><emphasis>CSA</emphasis></see>
212 <indexterm role="concept">
213 <primary>CR character</primary>
214 <see><emphasis>carriage return</emphasis></see>
216 <indexterm role="concept">
217 <primary>CRL</primary>
218 <see><emphasis>certificate revocation list</emphasis></see>
220 <indexterm role="concept">
221 <primary>delivery</primary>
222 <secondary>failure report</secondary>
223 <see><emphasis>bounce message</emphasis></see>
225 <indexterm role="concept">
226 <primary>dialup</primary>
227 <see><emphasis>intermittently connected hosts</emphasis></see>
229 <indexterm role="concept">
230 <primary>exiscan</primary>
231 <see><emphasis>content scanning</emphasis></see>
233 <indexterm role="concept">
234 <primary>failover</primary>
235 <see><emphasis>fallback</emphasis></see>
237 <indexterm role="concept">
238 <primary>fallover</primary>
239 <see><emphasis>fallback</emphasis></see>
241 <indexterm role="concept">
242 <primary>filter</primary>
243 <secondary>Sieve</secondary>
244 <see><emphasis>Sieve filter</emphasis></see>
246 <indexterm role="concept">
247 <primary>ident</primary>
248 <see><emphasis>RFC 1413</emphasis></see>
250 <indexterm role="concept">
251 <primary>LF character</primary>
252 <see><emphasis>linefeed</emphasis></see>
254 <indexterm role="concept">
255 <primary>maximum</primary>
256 <seealso><emphasis>limit</emphasis></seealso>
258 <indexterm role="concept">
259 <primary>monitor</primary>
260 <see><emphasis>Exim monitor</emphasis></see>
262 <indexterm role="concept">
263 <primary>no_<emphasis>xxx</emphasis></primary>
264 <see>entry for xxx</see>
266 <indexterm role="concept">
267 <primary>NUL</primary>
268 <see><emphasis>binary zero</emphasis></see>
270 <indexterm role="concept">
271 <primary>passwd file</primary>
272 <see><emphasis>/etc/passwd</emphasis></see>
274 <indexterm role="concept">
275 <primary>process id</primary>
276 <see><emphasis>pid</emphasis></see>
278 <indexterm role="concept">
279 <primary>RBL</primary>
280 <see><emphasis>DNS list</emphasis></see>
282 <indexterm role="concept">
283 <primary>redirection</primary>
284 <see><emphasis>address redirection</emphasis></see>
286 <indexterm role="concept">
287 <primary>return path</primary>
288 <seealso><emphasis>envelope sender</emphasis></seealso>
290 <indexterm role="concept">
291 <primary>scanning</primary>
292 <see><emphasis>content scanning</emphasis></see>
294 <indexterm role="concept">
295 <primary>SSL</primary>
296 <see><emphasis>TLS</emphasis></see>
298 <indexterm role="concept">
299 <primary>string</primary>
300 <secondary>expansion</secondary>
301 <see><emphasis>expansion</emphasis></see>
303 <indexterm role="concept">
304 <primary>top bit</primary>
305 <see><emphasis>8-bit characters</emphasis></see>
307 <indexterm role="concept">
308 <primary>variables</primary>
309 <see><emphasis>expansion, variables</emphasis></see>
311 <indexterm role="concept">
312 <primary>zero, binary</primary>
313 <see><emphasis>binary zero</emphasis></see>
319 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
320 . This is the real start of the first chapter. See the comment above as to why
321 . we can't have the .chapter line here.
322 . chapter "Introduction"
323 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
325 Exim is a mail transfer agent (MTA) for hosts that are running Unix or
326 Unix-like operating systems. It was designed on the assumption that it would be
327 run on hosts that are permanently connected to the Internet. However, it can be
328 used on intermittently connected hosts with suitable configuration adjustments.
330 Configuration files currently exist for the following operating systems: AIX,
331 BSD/OS (aka BSDI), Darwin (Mac OS X), DGUX, Dragonfly, FreeBSD, GNU/Hurd,
332 GNU/Linux, HI-OSF (Hitachi), HI-UX, HP-UX, IRIX, MIPS RISCOS, NetBSD, OpenBSD,
333 OpenUNIX, QNX, SCO, SCO SVR4.2 (aka UNIX-SV), Solaris (aka SunOS5), SunOS4,
334 Tru64-Unix (formerly Digital UNIX, formerly DEC-OSF1), Ultrix, and Unixware.
335 Some of these operating systems are no longer current and cannot easily be
336 tested, so the configuration files may no longer work in practice.
338 There are also configuration files for compiling Exim in the Cygwin environment
339 that can be installed on systems running Windows. However, this document does
340 not contain any information about running Exim in the Cygwin environment.
342 The terms and conditions for the use and distribution of Exim are contained in
343 the file &_NOTICE_&. Exim is distributed under the terms of the GNU General
344 Public Licence, a copy of which may be found in the file &_LICENCE_&.
346 The use, supply or promotion of Exim for the purpose of sending bulk,
347 unsolicited electronic mail is incompatible with the basic aims of the program,
348 which revolve around the free provision of a service that enhances the quality
349 of personal communications. The author of Exim regards indiscriminate
350 mass-mailing as an antisocial, irresponsible abuse of the Internet.
352 Exim owes a great deal to Smail 3 and its author, Ron Karr. Without the
353 experience of running and working on the Smail 3 code, I could never have
354 contemplated starting to write a new MTA. Many of the ideas and user interfaces
355 were originally taken from Smail 3, though the actual code of Exim is entirely
356 new, and has developed far beyond the initial concept.
358 Many people, both in Cambridge and around the world, have contributed to the
359 development and the testing of Exim, and to porting it to various operating
360 systems. I am grateful to them all. The distribution now contains a file called
361 &_ACKNOWLEDGMENTS_&, in which I have started recording the names of
365 .section "Exim documentation" "SECID1"
366 . Keep this example change bar when updating the documentation!
369 .cindex "documentation"
370 This edition of the Exim specification applies to version &version; of Exim.
371 Substantive changes from the &previousversion; edition are marked in some
372 renditions of the document; this paragraph is so marked if the rendition is
373 capable of showing a change indicator.
376 This document is very much a reference manual; it is not a tutorial. The reader
377 is expected to have some familiarity with the SMTP mail transfer protocol and
378 with general Unix system administration. Although there are some discussions
379 and examples in places, the information is mostly organized in a way that makes
380 it easy to look up, rather than in a natural order for sequential reading.
381 Furthermore, the manual aims to cover every aspect of Exim in detail, including
382 a number of rarely-used, special-purpose features that are unlikely to be of
385 .cindex "books about Exim"
386 An &"easier"& discussion of Exim which provides more in-depth explanatory,
387 introductory, and tutorial material can be found in a book entitled &'The Exim
388 SMTP Mail Server'& (second edition, 2007), published by UIT Cambridge
389 (&url(http://www.uit.co.uk/exim-book/)).
391 This book also contains a chapter that gives a general introduction to SMTP and
392 Internet mail. Inevitably, however, the book is unlikely to be fully up-to-date
393 with the latest release of Exim. (Note that the earlier book about Exim,
394 published by O'Reilly, covers Exim 3, and many things have changed in Exim 4.)
396 .cindex "Debian" "information sources"
397 If you are using a Debian distribution of Exim, you will find information about
398 Debian-specific features in the file
399 &_/usr/share/doc/exim4-base/README.Debian_&.
400 The command &(man update-exim.conf)& is another source of Debian-specific
403 .cindex "&_doc/NewStuff_&"
404 .cindex "&_doc/ChangeLog_&"
406 As the program develops, there may be features in newer versions that have not
407 yet made it into this document, which is updated only when the most significant
408 digit of the fractional part of the version number changes. Specifications of
409 new features that are not yet in this manual are placed in the file
410 &_doc/NewStuff_& in the Exim distribution.
412 Some features may be classified as &"experimental"&. These may change
413 incompatibly while they are developing, or even be withdrawn. For this reason,
414 they are not documented in this manual. Information about experimental features
415 can be found in the file &_doc/experimental.txt_&.
417 All changes to the program (whether new features, bug fixes, or other kinds of
418 change) are noted briefly in the file called &_doc/ChangeLog_&.
420 .cindex "&_doc/spec.txt_&"
421 This specification itself is available as an ASCII file in &_doc/spec.txt_& so
422 that it can easily be searched with a text editor. Other files in the &_doc_&
426 .row &_OptionLists.txt_& "list of all options in alphabetical order"
427 .row &_dbm.discuss.txt_& "discussion about DBM libraries"
428 .row &_exim.8_& "a man page of Exim's command line options"
429 .row &_experimental.txt_& "documentation of experimental features"
430 .row &_filter.txt_& "specification of the filter language"
431 .row &_Exim3.upgrade_& "upgrade notes from release 2 to release 3"
432 .row &_Exim4.upgrade_& "upgrade notes from release 3 to release 4"
435 The main specification and the specification of the filtering language are also
436 available in other formats (HTML, PostScript, PDF, and Texinfo). Section
437 &<<SECTavail>>& below tells you how to get hold of these.
441 .section "FTP and web sites" "SECID2"
444 The primary site for Exim source distributions is currently the University of
445 Cambridge's FTP site, whose contents are described in &'Where to find the Exim
446 distribution'& below. In addition, there is a web site and an FTP site at
447 &%exim.org%&. These are now also hosted at the University of Cambridge. The
448 &%exim.org%& site was previously hosted for a number of years by Energis
449 Squared, formerly Planet Online Ltd, whose support I gratefully acknowledge.
453 As well as Exim distribution tar files, the Exim web site contains a number of
454 differently formatted versions of the documentation. A recent addition to the
455 online information is the Exim wiki (&url(http://wiki.exim.org)),
456 which contains what used to be a separate FAQ, as well as various other
457 examples, tips, and know-how that have been contributed by Exim users.
460 An Exim Bugzilla exists at &url(http://bugs.exim.org). You can use
461 this to report bugs, and also to add items to the wish list. Please search
462 first to check that you are not duplicating a previous entry.
466 .section "Mailing lists" "SECID3"
467 .cindex "mailing lists" "for Exim users"
468 The following Exim mailing lists exist:
471 .row &'exim-announce@exim.org'& "Moderated, low volume announcements list"
472 .row &'exim-users@exim.org'& "General discussion list"
473 .row &'exim-dev@exim.org'& "Discussion of bugs, enhancements, etc."
474 .row &'exim-cvs@exim.org'& "Automated commit messages from the VCS"
477 You can subscribe to these lists, change your existing subscriptions, and view
478 or search the archives via the mailing lists link on the Exim home page.
479 .cindex "Debian" "mailing list for"
480 If you are using a Debian distribution of Exim, you may wish to subscribe to
481 the Debian-specific mailing list &'pkg-exim4-users@lists.alioth.debian.org'&
484 &url(http://lists.alioth.debian.org/mailman/listinfo/pkg-exim4-users)
486 Please ask Debian-specific questions on this list and not on the general Exim
489 .section "Exim training" "SECID4"
490 .cindex "training courses"
491 Training courses in Cambridge (UK) used to be run annually by the author of
492 Exim, before he retired. At the time of writing, there are no plans to run
493 further Exim courses in Cambridge. However, if that changes, relevant
494 information will be posted at &url(http://www-tus.csx.cam.ac.uk/courses/exim/).
496 .section "Bug reports" "SECID5"
497 .cindex "bug reports"
498 .cindex "reporting bugs"
499 Reports of obvious bugs can be emailed to &'bugs@exim.org'& or reported
500 via the Bugzilla (&url(http://bugs.exim.org)). However, if you are unsure
501 whether some behaviour is a bug or not, the best thing to do is to post a
502 message to the &'exim-dev'& mailing list and have it discussed.
506 .section "Where to find the Exim distribution" "SECTavail"
508 .cindex "distribution" "ftp site"
509 The master ftp site for the Exim distribution is
511 &*ftp://ftp.csx.cam.ac.uk/pub/software/email/exim*&
515 &*ftp://ftp.exim.org/pub/exim*&
517 The file references that follow are relative to the &_exim_& directories at
518 these sites. There are now quite a number of independent mirror sites around
519 the world. Those that I know about are listed in the file called &_Mirrors_&.
521 Within the &_exim_& directory there are subdirectories called &_exim3_& (for
522 previous Exim 3 distributions), &_exim4_& (for the latest Exim 4
523 distributions), and &_Testing_& for testing versions. In the &_exim4_&
524 subdirectory, the current release can always be found in files called
527 &_exim-n.nn.tar.bz2_&
529 where &'n.nn'& is the highest such version number in the directory. The two
530 files contain identical data; the only difference is the type of compression.
531 The &_.bz2_& file is usually a lot smaller than the &_.gz_& file.
533 .cindex "distribution" "signing details"
534 .cindex "distribution" "public key"
535 .cindex "public key for signed distribution"
536 The distributions are currently signed with Nigel Metheringham's GPG key. The
537 corresponding public key is available from a number of keyservers, and there is
538 also a copy in the file &_nigel-pubkey.asc_&. The signatures for the tar bundles are
541 &_exim-n.nn.tar.gz.asc_&
542 &_exim-n.nn.tar.bz2.asc_&
544 For each released version, the log of changes is made separately available in a
545 separate file in the directory &_ChangeLogs_& so that it is possible to
546 find out what has changed without having to download the entire distribution.
548 .cindex "documentation" "available formats"
549 The main distribution contains ASCII versions of this specification and other
550 documentation; other formats of the documents are available in separate files
551 inside the &_exim4_& directory of the FTP site:
553 &_exim-html-n.nn.tar.gz_&
554 &_exim-pdf-n.nn.tar.gz_&
555 &_exim-postscript-n.nn.tar.gz_&
556 &_exim-texinfo-n.nn.tar.gz_&
558 These tar files contain only the &_doc_& directory, not the complete
559 distribution, and are also available in &_.bz2_& as well as &_.gz_& forms.
562 .section "Limitations" "SECID6"
564 .cindex "limitations of Exim"
565 .cindex "bang paths" "not handled by Exim"
566 Exim is designed for use as an Internet MTA, and therefore handles addresses in
567 RFC 2822 domain format only. It cannot handle UUCP &"bang paths"&, though
568 simple two-component bang paths can be converted by a straightforward rewriting
569 configuration. This restriction does not prevent Exim from being interfaced to
570 UUCP as a transport mechanism, provided that domain addresses are used.
572 .cindex "domainless addresses"
573 .cindex "address" "without domain"
574 Exim insists that every address it handles has a domain attached. For incoming
575 local messages, domainless addresses are automatically qualified with a
576 configured domain value. Configuration options specify from which remote
577 systems unqualified addresses are acceptable. These are then qualified on
580 .cindex "transport" "external"
581 .cindex "external transports"
582 The only external transport mechanisms that are currently implemented are SMTP
583 and LMTP over a TCP/IP network (including support for IPv6). However, a pipe
584 transport is available, and there are facilities for writing messages to files
585 and pipes, optionally in &'batched SMTP'& format; these facilities can be used
586 to send messages to other transport mechanisms such as UUCP, provided they can
587 handle domain-style addresses. Batched SMTP input is also catered for.
589 Exim is not designed for storing mail for dial-in hosts. When the volumes of
590 such mail are large, it is better to get the messages &"delivered"& into files
591 (that is, off Exim's queue) and subsequently passed on to the dial-in hosts by
594 Although Exim does have basic facilities for scanning incoming messages, these
595 are not comprehensive enough to do full virus or spam scanning. Such operations
596 are best carried out using additional specialized software packages. If you
597 compile Exim with the content-scanning extension, straightforward interfaces to
598 a number of common scanners are provided.
602 .section "Run time configuration" "SECID7"
603 Exim's run time configuration is held in a single text file that is divided
604 into a number of sections. The entries in this file consist of keywords and
605 values, in the style of Smail 3 configuration files. A default configuration
606 file which is suitable for simple online installations is provided in the
607 distribution, and is described in chapter &<<CHAPdefconfil>>& below.
610 .section "Calling interface" "SECID8"
611 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "command line interface"
612 Like many MTAs, Exim has adopted the Sendmail command line interface so that it
613 can be a straight replacement for &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& or
614 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& when sending mail, but you do not need to know anything
615 about Sendmail in order to run Exim. For actions other than sending messages,
616 Sendmail-compatible options also exist, but those that produce output (for
617 example, &%-bp%&, which lists the messages on the queue) do so in Exim's own
618 format. There are also some additional options that are compatible with Smail
619 3, and some further options that are new to Exim. Chapter &<<CHAPcommandline>>&
620 documents all Exim's command line options. This information is automatically
621 made into the man page that forms part of the Exim distribution.
623 Control of messages on the queue can be done via certain privileged command
624 line options. There is also an optional monitor program called &'eximon'&,
625 which displays current information in an X window, and which contains a menu
626 interface to Exim's command line administration options.
630 .section "Terminology" "SECID9"
631 .cindex "terminology definitions"
632 .cindex "body of message" "definition of"
633 The &'body'& of a message is the actual data that the sender wants to transmit.
634 It is the last part of a message, and is separated from the &'header'& (see
635 below) by a blank line.
637 .cindex "bounce message" "definition of"
638 When a message cannot be delivered, it is normally returned to the sender in a
639 delivery failure message or a &"non-delivery report"& (NDR). The term
640 &'bounce'& is commonly used for this action, and the error reports are often
641 called &'bounce messages'&. This is a convenient shorthand for &"delivery
642 failure error report"&. Such messages have an empty sender address in the
643 message's &'envelope'& (see below) to ensure that they cannot themselves give
644 rise to further bounce messages.
646 The term &'default'& appears frequently in this manual. It is used to qualify a
647 value which is used in the absence of any setting in the configuration. It may
648 also qualify an action which is taken unless a configuration setting specifies
651 The term &'defer'& is used when the delivery of a message to a specific
652 destination cannot immediately take place for some reason (a remote host may be
653 down, or a user's local mailbox may be full). Such deliveries are &'deferred'&
656 The word &'domain'& is sometimes used to mean all but the first component of a
657 host's name. It is &'not'& used in that sense here, where it normally refers to
658 the part of an email address following the @ sign.
660 .cindex "envelope, definition of"
661 .cindex "sender" "definition of"
662 A message in transit has an associated &'envelope'&, as well as a header and a
663 body. The envelope contains a sender address (to which bounce messages should
664 be delivered), and any number of recipient addresses. References to the
665 sender or the recipients of a message usually mean the addresses in the
666 envelope. An MTA uses these addresses for delivery, and for returning bounce
667 messages, not the addresses that appear in the header lines.
669 .cindex "message" "header, definition of"
670 .cindex "header section" "definition of"
671 The &'header'& of a message is the first part of a message's text, consisting
672 of a number of lines, each of which has a name such as &'From:'&, &'To:'&,
673 &'Subject:'&, etc. Long header lines can be split over several text lines by
674 indenting the continuations. The header is separated from the body by a blank
677 .cindex "local part" "definition of"
678 .cindex "domain" "definition of"
679 The term &'local part'&, which is taken from RFC 2822, is used to refer to that
680 part of an email address that precedes the @ sign. The part that follows the
681 @ sign is called the &'domain'& or &'mail domain'&.
683 .cindex "local delivery" "definition of"
684 .cindex "remote delivery, definition of"
685 The terms &'local delivery'& and &'remote delivery'& are used to distinguish
686 delivery to a file or a pipe on the local host from delivery by SMTP over
687 TCP/IP to another host. As far as Exim is concerned, all hosts other than the
688 host it is running on are &'remote'&.
690 .cindex "return path" "definition of"
691 &'Return path'& is another name that is used for the sender address in a
694 .cindex "queue" "definition of"
695 The term &'queue'& is used to refer to the set of messages awaiting delivery,
696 because this term is in widespread use in the context of MTAs. However, in
697 Exim's case the reality is more like a pool than a queue, because there is
698 normally no ordering of waiting messages.
700 .cindex "queue runner" "definition of"
701 The term &'queue runner'& is used to describe a process that scans the queue
702 and attempts to deliver those messages whose retry times have come. This term
703 is used by other MTAs, and also relates to the command &%runq%&, but in Exim
704 the waiting messages are normally processed in an unpredictable order.
706 .cindex "spool directory" "definition of"
707 The term &'spool directory'& is used for a directory in which Exim keeps the
708 messages on its queue &-- that is, those that it is in the process of
709 delivering. This should not be confused with the directory in which local
710 mailboxes are stored, which is called a &"spool directory"& by some people. In
711 the Exim documentation, &"spool"& is always used in the first sense.
718 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
719 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
721 .chapter "Incorporated code" "CHID2"
722 .cindex "incorporated code"
723 .cindex "regular expressions" "library"
725 A number of pieces of external code are included in the Exim distribution.
728 Regular expressions are supported in the main Exim program and in the
729 Exim monitor using the freely-distributable PCRE library, copyright
730 © University of Cambridge. The source to PCRE is no longer shipped with
731 Exim, so you will need to use the version of PCRE shipped with your system,
732 or obtain and install the full version of the library from
733 &url(ftp://ftp.csx.cam.ac.uk/pub/software/programming/pcre).
735 .cindex "cdb" "acknowledgment"
736 Support for the cdb (Constant DataBase) lookup method is provided by code
737 contributed by Nigel Metheringham of (at the time he contributed it) Planet
738 Online Ltd. The implementation is completely contained within the code of Exim.
739 It does not link against an external cdb library. The code contains the
740 following statements:
743 Copyright © 1998 Nigel Metheringham, Planet Online Ltd
745 This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it under
746 the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by the Free Software
747 Foundation; either version 2 of the License, or (at your option) any later
749 This code implements Dan Bernstein's Constant DataBase (cdb) spec. Information,
750 the spec and sample code for cdb can be obtained from
751 &url(http://www.pobox.com/~djb/cdb.html). This implementation borrows
752 some code from Dan Bernstein's implementation (which has no license
753 restrictions applied to it).
756 .cindex "SPA authentication"
757 .cindex "Samba project"
758 .cindex "Microsoft Secure Password Authentication"
759 Client support for Microsoft's &'Secure Password Authentication'& is provided
760 by code contributed by Marc Prud'hommeaux. Server support was contributed by
761 Tom Kistner. This includes code taken from the Samba project, which is released
765 .cindex "&'pwcheck'& daemon"
766 .cindex "&'pwauthd'& daemon"
767 Support for calling the Cyrus &'pwcheck'& and &'saslauthd'& daemons is provided
768 by code taken from the Cyrus-SASL library and adapted by Alexander S.
769 Sabourenkov. The permission notice appears below, in accordance with the
770 conditions expressed therein.
773 Copyright © 2001 Carnegie Mellon University. All rights reserved.
775 Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
776 modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
780 Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
781 notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
783 Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
784 notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in
785 the documentation and/or other materials provided with the
788 The name &"Carnegie Mellon University"& must not be used to
789 endorse or promote products derived from this software without
790 prior written permission. For permission or any other legal
791 details, please contact
793 Office of Technology Transfer
794 Carnegie Mellon University
796 Pittsburgh, PA 15213-3890
797 (412) 268-4387, fax: (412) 268-7395
798 tech-transfer@andrew.cmu.edu
801 Redistributions of any form whatsoever must retain the following
804 &"This product includes software developed by Computing Services
805 at Carnegie Mellon University (&url(http://www.cmu.edu/computing/)."&
807 CARNEGIE MELLON UNIVERSITY DISCLAIMS ALL WARRANTIES WITH REGARD TO
808 THIS SOFTWARE, INCLUDING ALL IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY
809 AND FITNESS, IN NO EVENT SHALL CARNEGIE MELLON UNIVERSITY BE LIABLE
810 FOR ANY SPECIAL, INDIRECT OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES OR ANY DAMAGES
811 WHATSOEVER RESULTING FROM LOSS OF USE, DATA OR PROFITS, WHETHER IN
812 AN ACTION OF CONTRACT, NEGLIGENCE OR OTHER TORTIOUS ACTION, ARISING
813 OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION WITH THE USE OR PERFORMANCE OF THIS SOFTWARE.
818 .cindex "Exim monitor" "acknowledgment"
821 The Exim Monitor program, which is an X-Window application, includes
822 modified versions of the Athena StripChart and TextPop widgets.
823 This code is copyright by DEC and MIT, and their permission notice appears
824 below, in accordance with the conditions expressed therein.
827 Copyright 1987, 1988 by Digital Equipment Corporation, Maynard, Massachusetts,
828 and the Massachusetts Institute of Technology, Cambridge, Massachusetts.
832 Permission to use, copy, modify, and distribute this software and its
833 documentation for any purpose and without fee is hereby granted,
834 provided that the above copyright notice appear in all copies and that
835 both that copyright notice and this permission notice appear in
836 supporting documentation, and that the names of Digital or MIT not be
837 used in advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the
838 software without specific, written prior permission.
840 DIGITAL DISCLAIMS ALL WARRANTIES WITH REGARD TO THIS SOFTWARE, INCLUDING
841 ALL IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS, IN NO EVENT SHALL
842 DIGITAL BE LIABLE FOR ANY SPECIAL, INDIRECT OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES OR
843 ANY DAMAGES WHATSOEVER RESULTING FROM LOSS OF USE, DATA OR PROFITS,
844 WHETHER IN AN ACTION OF CONTRACT, NEGLIGENCE OR OTHER TORTIOUS ACTION,
845 ARISING OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION WITH THE USE OR PERFORMANCE OF THIS
850 Many people have contributed code fragments, some large, some small, that were
851 not covered by any specific licence requirements. It is assumed that the
852 contributors are happy to see their code incorporated into Exim under the GPL.
859 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
860 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
862 .chapter "How Exim receives and delivers mail" "CHID11" &&&
863 "Receiving and delivering mail"
866 .section "Overall philosophy" "SECID10"
867 .cindex "design philosophy"
868 Exim is designed to work efficiently on systems that are permanently connected
869 to the Internet and are handling a general mix of mail. In such circumstances,
870 most messages can be delivered immediately. Consequently, Exim does not
871 maintain independent queues of messages for specific domains or hosts, though
872 it does try to send several messages in a single SMTP connection after a host
873 has been down, and it also maintains per-host retry information.
876 .section "Policy control" "SECID11"
877 .cindex "policy control" "overview"
878 Policy controls are now an important feature of MTAs that are connected to the
879 Internet. Perhaps their most important job is to stop MTAs being abused as
880 &"open relays"& by misguided individuals who send out vast amounts of
881 unsolicited junk, and want to disguise its source. Exim provides flexible
882 facilities for specifying policy controls on incoming mail:
885 .cindex "&ACL;" "introduction"
886 Exim 4 (unlike previous versions of Exim) implements policy controls on
887 incoming mail by means of &'Access Control Lists'& (ACLs). Each list is a
888 series of statements that may either grant or deny access. ACLs can be used at
889 several places in the SMTP dialogue while receiving a message from a remote
890 host. However, the most common places are after each RCPT command, and at the
891 very end of the message. The sysadmin can specify conditions for accepting or
892 rejecting individual recipients or the entire message, respectively, at these
893 two points (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&). Denial of access results in an SMTP
896 An ACL is also available for locally generated, non-SMTP messages. In this
897 case, the only available actions are to accept or deny the entire message.
899 When Exim is compiled with the content-scanning extension, facilities are
900 provided in the ACL mechanism for passing the message to external virus and/or
901 spam scanning software. The result of such a scan is passed back to the ACL,
902 which can then use it to decide what to do with the message.
904 When a message has been received, either from a remote host or from the local
905 host, but before the final acknowledgment has been sent, a locally supplied C
906 function called &[local_scan()]& can be run to inspect the message and decide
907 whether to accept it or not (see chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&). If the message
908 is accepted, the list of recipients can be modified by the function.
910 Using the &[local_scan()]& mechanism is another way of calling external scanner
911 software. The &%SA-Exim%& add-on package works this way. It does not require
912 Exim to be compiled with the content-scanning extension.
914 After a message has been accepted, a further checking mechanism is available in
915 the form of the &'system filter'& (see chapter &<<CHAPsystemfilter>>&). This
916 runs at the start of every delivery process.
921 .section "User filters" "SECID12"
922 .cindex "filter" "introduction"
923 .cindex "Sieve filter"
924 In a conventional Exim configuration, users are able to run private filters by
925 setting up appropriate &_.forward_& files in their home directories. See
926 chapter &<<CHAPredirect>>& (about the &(redirect)& router) for the
927 configuration needed to support this, and the separate document entitled
928 &'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'& for user details. Two different kinds
929 of filtering are available:
932 Sieve filters are written in the standard filtering language that is defined
935 Exim filters are written in a syntax that is unique to Exim, but which is more
936 powerful than Sieve, which it pre-dates.
939 User filters are run as part of the routing process, described below.
943 .section "Message identification" "SECTmessiden"
944 .cindex "message ids" "details of format"
945 .cindex "format" "of message id"
946 .cindex "id of message"
951 Every message handled by Exim is given a &'message id'& which is sixteen
952 characters long. It is divided into three parts, separated by hyphens, for
953 example &`16VDhn-0001bo-D3`&. Each part is a sequence of letters and digits,
954 normally encoding numbers in base 62. However, in the Darwin operating
955 system (Mac OS X) and when Exim is compiled to run under Cygwin, base 36
956 (avoiding the use of lower case letters) is used instead, because the message
957 id is used to construct file names, and the names of files in those systems are
958 not always case-sensitive.
960 .cindex "pid (process id)" "re-use of"
961 The detail of the contents of the message id have changed as Exim has evolved.
962 Earlier versions relied on the operating system not re-using a process id (pid)
963 within one second. On modern operating systems, this assumption can no longer
964 be made, so the algorithm had to be changed. To retain backward compatibility,
965 the format of the message id was retained, which is why the following rules are
969 The first six characters of the message id are the time at which the message
970 started to be received, to a granularity of one second. That is, this field
971 contains the number of seconds since the start of the epoch (the normal Unix
972 way of representing the date and time of day).
974 After the first hyphen, the next six characters are the id of the process that
975 received the message.
977 There are two different possibilities for the final two characters:
979 .oindex "&%localhost_number%&"
980 If &%localhost_number%& is not set, this value is the fractional part of the
981 time of reception, normally in units of 1/2000 of a second, but for systems
982 that must use base 36 instead of base 62 (because of case-insensitive file
983 systems), the units are 1/1000 of a second.
985 If &%localhost_number%& is set, it is multiplied by 200 (100) and added to
986 the fractional part of the time, which in this case is in units of 1/200
991 After a message has been received, Exim waits for the clock to tick at the
992 appropriate resolution before proceeding, so that if another message is
993 received by the same process, or by another process with the same (re-used)
994 pid, it is guaranteed that the time will be different. In most cases, the clock
995 will already have ticked while the message was being received.
998 .section "Receiving mail" "SECID13"
999 .cindex "receiving mail"
1000 .cindex "message" "reception"
1001 The only way Exim can receive mail from another host is using SMTP over
1002 TCP/IP, in which case the sender and recipient addresses are transferred using
1003 SMTP commands. However, from a locally running process (such as a user's MUA),
1004 there are several possibilities:
1007 If the process runs Exim with the &%-bm%& option, the message is read
1008 non-interactively (usually via a pipe), with the recipients taken from the
1009 command line, or from the body of the message if &%-t%& is also used.
1011 If the process runs Exim with the &%-bS%& option, the message is also read
1012 non-interactively, but in this case the recipients are listed at the start of
1013 the message in a series of SMTP RCPT commands, terminated by a DATA
1014 command. This is so-called &"batch SMTP"& format,
1015 but it isn't really SMTP. The SMTP commands are just another way of passing
1016 envelope addresses in a non-interactive submission.
1018 If the process runs Exim with the &%-bs%& option, the message is read
1019 interactively, using the SMTP protocol. A two-way pipe is normally used for
1020 passing data between the local process and the Exim process.
1021 This is &"real"& SMTP and is handled in the same way as SMTP over TCP/IP. For
1022 example, the ACLs for SMTP commands are used for this form of submission.
1024 A local process may also make a TCP/IP call to the host's loopback address
1025 (127.0.0.1) or any other of its IP addresses. When receiving messages, Exim
1026 does not treat the loopback address specially. It treats all such connections
1027 in the same way as connections from other hosts.
1031 .cindex "message sender, constructed by Exim"
1032 .cindex "sender" "constructed by Exim"
1033 In the three cases that do not involve TCP/IP, the sender address is
1034 constructed from the login name of the user that called Exim and a default
1035 qualification domain (which can be set by the &%qualify_domain%& configuration
1036 option). For local or batch SMTP, a sender address that is passed using the
1037 SMTP MAIL command is ignored. However, the system administrator may allow
1038 certain users (&"trusted users"&) to specify a different sender address
1039 unconditionally, or all users to specify certain forms of different sender
1040 address. The &%-f%& option or the SMTP MAIL command is used to specify these
1041 different addresses. See section &<<SECTtrustedadmin>>& for details of trusted
1042 users, and the &%untrusted_set_sender%& option for a way of allowing untrusted
1043 users to change sender addresses.
1045 Messages received by either of the non-interactive mechanisms are subject to
1046 checking by the non-SMTP ACL, if one is defined. Messages received using SMTP
1047 (either over TCP/IP, or interacting with a local process) can be checked by a
1048 number of ACLs that operate at different times during the SMTP session. Either
1049 individual recipients, or the entire message, can be rejected if local policy
1050 requirements are not met. The &[local_scan()]& function (see chapter
1051 &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&) is run for all incoming messages.
1053 Exim can be configured not to start a delivery process when a message is
1054 received; this can be unconditional, or depend on the number of incoming SMTP
1055 connections or the system load. In these situations, new messages wait on the
1056 queue until a queue runner process picks them up. However, in standard
1057 configurations under normal conditions, delivery is started as soon as a
1058 message is received.
1064 .section "Handling an incoming message" "SECID14"
1065 .cindex "spool directory" "files that hold a message"
1066 .cindex "file" "how a message is held"
1067 When Exim accepts a message, it writes two files in its spool directory. The
1068 first contains the envelope information, the current status of the message, and
1069 the header lines, and the second contains the body of the message. The names of
1070 the two spool files consist of the message id, followed by &`-H`& for the
1071 file containing the envelope and header, and &`-D`& for the data file.
1073 .cindex "spool directory" "&_input_& sub-directory"
1074 By default all these message files are held in a single directory called
1075 &_input_& inside the general Exim spool directory. Some operating systems do
1076 not perform very well if the number of files in a directory gets large; to
1077 improve performance in such cases, the &%split_spool_directory%& option can be
1078 used. This causes Exim to split up the input files into 62 sub-directories
1079 whose names are single letters or digits. When this is done, the queue is
1080 processed one sub-directory at a time instead of all at once, which can improve
1081 overall performance even when there are not enough files in each directory to
1082 affect file system performance.
1084 The envelope information consists of the address of the message's sender and
1085 the addresses of the recipients. This information is entirely separate from
1086 any addresses contained in the header lines. The status of the message includes
1087 a list of recipients who have already received the message. The format of the
1088 first spool file is described in chapter &<<CHAPspool>>&.
1090 .cindex "rewriting" "addresses"
1091 Address rewriting that is specified in the rewrite section of the configuration
1092 (see chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&) is done once and for all on incoming addresses,
1093 both in the header lines and the envelope, at the time the message is accepted.
1094 If during the course of delivery additional addresses are generated (for
1095 example, via aliasing), these new addresses are rewritten as soon as they are
1096 generated. At the time a message is actually delivered (transported) further
1097 rewriting can take place; because this is a transport option, it can be
1098 different for different forms of delivery. It is also possible to specify the
1099 addition or removal of certain header lines at the time the message is
1100 delivered (see chapters &<<CHAProutergeneric>>& and
1101 &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&).
1105 .section "Life of a message" "SECID15"
1106 .cindex "message" "life of"
1107 .cindex "message" "frozen"
1108 A message remains in the spool directory until it is completely delivered to
1109 its recipients or to an error address, or until it is deleted by an
1110 administrator or by the user who originally created it. In cases when delivery
1111 cannot proceed &-- for example, when a message can neither be delivered to its
1112 recipients nor returned to its sender, the message is marked &"frozen"& on the
1113 spool, and no more deliveries are attempted.
1115 .cindex "frozen messages" "thawing"
1116 .cindex "message" "thawing frozen"
1117 An administrator can &"thaw"& such messages when the problem has been
1118 corrected, and can also freeze individual messages by hand if necessary. In
1119 addition, an administrator can force a delivery error, causing a bounce message
1122 .oindex "&%timeout_frozen_after%&"
1123 .oindex "&%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&"
1124 There are options called &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%& and
1125 &%timeout_frozen_after%&, which discard frozen messages after a certain time.
1126 The first applies only to frozen bounces, the second to any frozen messages.
1128 .cindex "message" "log file for"
1129 .cindex "log" "file for each message"
1130 While Exim is working on a message, it writes information about each delivery
1131 attempt to its main log file. This includes successful, unsuccessful, and
1132 delayed deliveries for each recipient (see chapter &<<CHAPlog>>&). The log
1133 lines are also written to a separate &'message log'& file for each message.
1134 These logs are solely for the benefit of the administrator, and are normally
1135 deleted along with the spool files when processing of a message is complete.
1136 The use of individual message logs can be disabled by setting
1137 &%no_message_logs%&; this might give an improvement in performance on very busy
1140 .cindex "journal file"
1141 .cindex "file" "journal"
1142 All the information Exim itself needs to set up a delivery is kept in the first
1143 spool file, along with the header lines. When a successful delivery occurs, the
1144 address is immediately written at the end of a journal file, whose name is the
1145 message id followed by &`-J`&. At the end of a delivery run, if there are some
1146 addresses left to be tried again later, the first spool file (the &`-H`& file)
1147 is updated to indicate which these are, and the journal file is then deleted.
1148 Updating the spool file is done by writing a new file and renaming it, to
1149 minimize the possibility of data loss.
1151 Should the system or the program crash after a successful delivery but before
1152 the spool file has been updated, the journal is left lying around. The next
1153 time Exim attempts to deliver the message, it reads the journal file and
1154 updates the spool file before proceeding. This minimizes the chances of double
1155 deliveries caused by crashes.
1159 .section "Processing an address for delivery" "SECTprocaddress"
1160 .cindex "drivers" "definition of"
1161 .cindex "router" "definition of"
1162 .cindex "transport" "definition of"
1163 The main delivery processing elements of Exim are called &'routers'& and
1164 &'transports'&, and collectively these are known as &'drivers'&. Code for a
1165 number of them is provided in the source distribution, and compile-time options
1166 specify which ones are included in the binary. Run time options specify which
1167 ones are actually used for delivering messages.
1169 .cindex "drivers" "instance definition"
1170 Each driver that is specified in the run time configuration is an &'instance'&
1171 of that particular driver type. Multiple instances are allowed; for example,
1172 you can set up several different &(smtp)& transports, each with different
1173 option values that might specify different ports or different timeouts. Each
1174 instance has its own identifying name. In what follows we will normally use the
1175 instance name when discussing one particular instance (that is, one specific
1176 configuration of the driver), and the generic driver name when discussing
1177 the driver's features in general.
1179 A &'router'& is a driver that operates on an address, either determining how
1180 its delivery should happen, by assigning it to a specific transport, or
1181 converting the address into one or more new addresses (for example, via an
1182 alias file). A router may also explicitly choose to fail an address, causing it
1185 A &'transport'& is a driver that transmits a copy of the message from Exim's
1186 spool to some destination. There are two kinds of transport: for a &'local'&
1187 transport, the destination is a file or a pipe on the local host, whereas for a
1188 &'remote'& transport the destination is some other host. A message is passed
1189 to a specific transport as a result of successful routing. If a message has
1190 several recipients, it may be passed to a number of different transports.
1192 .cindex "preconditions" "definition of"
1193 An address is processed by passing it to each configured router instance in
1194 turn, subject to certain preconditions, until a router accepts the address or
1195 specifies that it should be bounced. We will describe this process in more
1196 detail shortly. First, as a simple example, we consider how each recipient
1197 address in a message is processed in a small configuration of three routers.
1199 To make this a more concrete example, it is described in terms of some actual
1200 routers, but remember, this is only an example. You can configure Exim's
1201 routers in many different ways, and there may be any number of routers in a
1204 The first router that is specified in a configuration is often one that handles
1205 addresses in domains that are not recognized specially by the local host. These
1206 are typically addresses for arbitrary domains on the Internet. A precondition
1207 is set up which looks for the special domains known to the host (for example,
1208 its own domain name), and the router is run for addresses that do &'not'&
1209 match. Typically, this is a router that looks up domains in the DNS in order to
1210 find the hosts to which this address routes. If it succeeds, the address is
1211 assigned to a suitable SMTP transport; if it does not succeed, the router is
1212 configured to fail the address.
1214 The second router is reached only when the domain is recognized as one that
1215 &"belongs"& to the local host. This router does redirection &-- also known as
1216 aliasing and forwarding. When it generates one or more new addresses from the
1217 original, each of them is routed independently from the start. Otherwise, the
1218 router may cause an address to fail, or it may simply decline to handle the
1219 address, in which case the address is passed to the next router.
1221 The final router in many configurations is one that checks to see if the
1222 address belongs to a local mailbox. The precondition may involve a check to
1223 see if the local part is the name of a login account, or it may look up the
1224 local part in a file or a database. If its preconditions are not met, or if
1225 the router declines, we have reached the end of the routers. When this happens,
1226 the address is bounced.
1230 .section "Processing an address for verification" "SECID16"
1231 .cindex "router" "for verification"
1232 .cindex "verifying address" "overview"
1233 As well as being used to decide how to deliver to an address, Exim's routers
1234 are also used for &'address verification'&. Verification can be requested as
1235 one of the checks to be performed in an ACL for incoming messages, on both
1236 sender and recipient addresses, and it can be tested using the &%-bv%& and
1237 &%-bvs%& command line options.
1239 When an address is being verified, the routers are run in &"verify mode"&. This
1240 does not affect the way the routers work, but it is a state that can be
1241 detected. By this means, a router can be skipped or made to behave differently
1242 when verifying. A common example is a configuration in which the first router
1243 sends all messages to a message-scanning program, unless they have been
1244 previously scanned. Thus, the first router accepts all addresses without any
1245 checking, making it useless for verifying. Normally, the &%no_verify%& option
1246 would be set for such a router, causing it to be skipped in verify mode.
1251 .section "Running an individual router" "SECTrunindrou"
1252 .cindex "router" "running details"
1253 .cindex "preconditions" "checking"
1254 .cindex "router" "result of running"
1255 As explained in the example above, a number of preconditions are checked before
1256 running a router. If any are not met, the router is skipped, and the address is
1257 passed to the next router. When all the preconditions on a router &'are'& met,
1258 the router is run. What happens next depends on the outcome, which is one of
1262 &'accept'&: The router accepts the address, and either assigns it to a
1263 transport, or generates one or more &"child"& addresses. Processing the
1264 original address ceases,
1265 .oindex "&%unseen%&"
1266 unless the &%unseen%& option is set on the router. This option
1267 can be used to set up multiple deliveries with different routing (for example,
1268 for keeping archive copies of messages). When &%unseen%& is set, the address is
1269 passed to the next router. Normally, however, an &'accept'& return marks the
1272 Any child addresses generated by the router are processed independently,
1273 starting with the first router by default. It is possible to change this by
1274 setting the &%redirect_router%& option to specify which router to start at for
1275 child addresses. Unlike &%pass_router%& (see below) the router specified by
1276 &%redirect_router%& may be anywhere in the router configuration.
1278 &'pass'&: The router recognizes the address, but cannot handle it itself. It
1279 requests that the address be passed to another router. By default the address
1280 is passed to the next router, but this can be changed by setting the
1281 &%pass_router%& option. However, (unlike &%redirect_router%&) the named router
1282 must be below the current router (to avoid loops).
1284 &'decline'&: The router declines to accept the address because it does not
1285 recognize it at all. By default, the address is passed to the next router, but
1286 this can be prevented by setting the &%no_more%& option. When &%no_more%& is
1287 set, all the remaining routers are skipped. In effect, &%no_more%& converts
1288 &'decline'& into &'fail'&.
1290 &'fail'&: The router determines that the address should fail, and queues it for
1291 the generation of a bounce message. There is no further processing of the
1292 original address unless &%unseen%& is set on the router.
1294 &'defer'&: The router cannot handle the address at the present time. (A
1295 database may be offline, or a DNS lookup may have timed out.) No further
1296 processing of the address happens in this delivery attempt. It is tried again
1297 next time the message is considered for delivery.
1299 &'error'&: There is some error in the router (for example, a syntax error in
1300 its configuration). The action is as for defer.
1303 If an address reaches the end of the routers without having been accepted by
1304 any of them, it is bounced as unrouteable. The default error message in this
1305 situation is &"unrouteable address"&, but you can set your own message by
1306 making use of the &%cannot_route_message%& option. This can be set for any
1307 router; the value from the last router that &"saw"& the address is used.
1309 Sometimes while routing you want to fail a delivery when some conditions are
1310 met but others are not, instead of passing the address on for further routing.
1311 You can do this by having a second router that explicitly fails the delivery
1312 when the relevant conditions are met. The &(redirect)& router has a &"fail"&
1313 facility for this purpose.
1316 .section "Duplicate addresses" "SECID17"
1317 .cindex "case of local parts"
1318 .cindex "address duplicate, discarding"
1319 .cindex "duplicate addresses"
1320 Once routing is complete, Exim scans the addresses that are assigned to local
1321 and remote transports, and discards any duplicates that it finds. During this
1322 check, local parts are treated as case-sensitive. This happens only when
1323 actually delivering a message; when testing routers with &%-bt%&, all the
1324 routed addresses are shown.
1328 .section "Router preconditions" "SECTrouprecon"
1329 .cindex "router" "preconditions, order of processing"
1330 .cindex "preconditions" "order of processing"
1331 The preconditions that are tested for each router are listed below, in the
1332 order in which they are tested. The individual configuration options are
1333 described in more detail in chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&.
1336 The &%local_part_prefix%& and &%local_part_suffix%& options can specify that
1337 the local parts handled by the router may or must have certain prefixes and/or
1338 suffixes. If a mandatory affix (prefix or suffix) is not present, the router is
1339 skipped. These conditions are tested first. When an affix is present, it is
1340 removed from the local part before further processing, including the evaluation
1341 of any other conditions.
1343 Routers can be designated for use only when not verifying an address, that is,
1344 only when routing it for delivery (or testing its delivery routing). If the
1345 &%verify%& option is set false, the router is skipped when Exim is verifying an
1347 Setting the &%verify%& option actually sets two options, &%verify_sender%& and
1348 &%verify_recipient%&, which independently control the use of the router for
1349 sender and recipient verification. You can set these options directly if
1350 you want a router to be used for only one type of verification.
1352 If the &%address_test%& option is set false, the router is skipped when Exim is
1353 run with the &%-bt%& option to test an address routing. This can be helpful
1354 when the first router sends all new messages to a scanner of some sort; it
1355 makes it possible to use &%-bt%& to test subsequent delivery routing without
1356 having to simulate the effect of the scanner.
1358 Routers can be designated for use only when verifying an address, as
1359 opposed to routing it for delivery. The &%verify_only%& option controls this.
1361 Individual routers can be explicitly skipped when running the routers to
1362 check an address given in the SMTP EXPN command (see the &%expn%& option).
1364 If the &%domains%& option is set, the domain of the address must be in the set
1365 of domains that it defines.
1367 .vindex "&$local_part_prefix$&"
1368 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
1369 .vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
1370 If the &%local_parts%& option is set, the local part of the address must be in
1371 the set of local parts that it defines. If &%local_part_prefix%& or
1372 &%local_part_suffix%& is in use, the prefix or suffix is removed from the local
1373 part before this check. If you want to do precondition tests on local parts
1374 that include affixes, you can do so by using a &%condition%& option (see below)
1375 that uses the variables &$local_part$&, &$local_part_prefix$&, and
1376 &$local_part_suffix$& as necessary.
1378 .vindex "&$local_user_uid$&"
1379 .vindex "&$local_user_gid$&"
1381 If the &%check_local_user%& option is set, the local part must be the name of
1382 an account on the local host. If this check succeeds, the uid and gid of the
1383 local user are placed in &$local_user_uid$& and &$local_user_gid$& and the
1384 user's home directory is placed in &$home$&; these values can be used in the
1385 remaining preconditions.
1387 If the &%router_home_directory%& option is set, it is expanded at this point,
1388 because it overrides the value of &$home$&. If this expansion were left till
1389 later, the value of &$home$& as set by &%check_local_user%& would be used in
1390 subsequent tests. Having two different values of &$home$& in the same router
1391 could lead to confusion.
1393 If the &%senders%& option is set, the envelope sender address must be in the
1394 set of addresses that it defines.
1396 If the &%require_files%& option is set, the existence or non-existence of
1397 specified files is tested.
1399 .cindex "customizing" "precondition"
1400 If the &%condition%& option is set, it is evaluated and tested. This option
1401 uses an expanded string to allow you to set up your own custom preconditions.
1402 Expanded strings are described in chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&.
1406 Note that &%require_files%& comes near the end of the list, so you cannot use
1407 it to check for the existence of a file in which to lookup up a domain, local
1408 part, or sender. However, as these options are all expanded, you can use the
1409 &%exists%& expansion condition to make such tests within each condition. The
1410 &%require_files%& option is intended for checking files that the router may be
1411 going to use internally, or which are needed by a specific transport (for
1412 example, &_.procmailrc_&).
1416 .section "Delivery in detail" "SECID18"
1417 .cindex "delivery" "in detail"
1418 When a message is to be delivered, the sequence of events is as follows:
1421 If a system-wide filter file is specified, the message is passed to it. The
1422 filter may add recipients to the message, replace the recipients, discard the
1423 message, cause a new message to be generated, or cause the message delivery to
1424 fail. The format of the system filter file is the same as for Exim user filter
1425 files, described in the separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail
1427 .cindex "Sieve filter" "not available for system filter"
1428 (&*Note*&: Sieve cannot be used for system filter files.)
1430 Some additional features are available in system filters &-- see chapter
1431 &<<CHAPsystemfilter>>& for details. Note that a message is passed to the system
1432 filter only once per delivery attempt, however many recipients it has. However,
1433 if there are several delivery attempts because one or more addresses could not
1434 be immediately delivered, the system filter is run each time. The filter
1435 condition &%first_delivery%& can be used to detect the first run of the system
1438 Each recipient address is offered to each configured router in turn, subject to
1439 its preconditions, until one is able to handle it. If no router can handle the
1440 address, that is, if they all decline, the address is failed. Because routers
1441 can be targeted at particular domains, several locally handled domains can be
1442 processed entirely independently of each other.
1444 .cindex "routing" "loops in"
1445 .cindex "loop" "while routing"
1446 A router that accepts an address may assign it to a local or a remote
1447 transport. However, the transport is not run at this time. Instead, the address
1448 is placed on a list for the particular transport, which will be run later.
1449 Alternatively, the router may generate one or more new addresses (typically
1450 from alias, forward, or filter files). New addresses are fed back into this
1451 process from the top, but in order to avoid loops, a router ignores any address
1452 which has an identically-named ancestor that was processed by itself.
1454 When all the routing has been done, addresses that have been successfully
1455 handled are passed to their assigned transports. When local transports are
1456 doing real local deliveries, they handle only one address at a time, but if a
1457 local transport is being used as a pseudo-remote transport (for example, to
1458 collect batched SMTP messages for transmission by some other means) multiple
1459 addresses can be handled. Remote transports can always handle more than one
1460 address at a time, but can be configured not to do so, or to restrict multiple
1461 addresses to the same domain.
1463 Each local delivery to a file or a pipe runs in a separate process under a
1464 non-privileged uid, and these deliveries are run one at a time. Remote
1465 deliveries also run in separate processes, normally under a uid that is private
1466 to Exim (&"the Exim user"&), but in this case, several remote deliveries can be
1467 run in parallel. The maximum number of simultaneous remote deliveries for any
1468 one message is set by the &%remote_max_parallel%& option.
1469 The order in which deliveries are done is not defined, except that all local
1470 deliveries happen before any remote deliveries.
1472 .cindex "queue runner"
1473 When it encounters a local delivery during a queue run, Exim checks its retry
1474 database to see if there has been a previous temporary delivery failure for the
1475 address before running the local transport. If there was a previous failure,
1476 Exim does not attempt a new delivery until the retry time for the address is
1477 reached. However, this happens only for delivery attempts that are part of a
1478 queue run. Local deliveries are always attempted when delivery immediately
1479 follows message reception, even if retry times are set for them. This makes for
1480 better behaviour if one particular message is causing problems (for example,
1481 causing quota overflow, or provoking an error in a filter file).
1483 .cindex "delivery" "retry in remote transports"
1484 Remote transports do their own retry handling, since an address may be
1485 deliverable to one of a number of hosts, each of which may have a different
1486 retry time. If there have been previous temporary failures and no host has
1487 reached its retry time, no delivery is attempted, whether in a queue run or
1488 not. See chapter &<<CHAPretry>>& for details of retry strategies.
1490 If there were any permanent errors, a bounce message is returned to an
1491 appropriate address (the sender in the common case), with details of the error
1492 for each failing address. Exim can be configured to send copies of bounce
1493 messages to other addresses.
1495 .cindex "delivery" "deferral"
1496 If one or more addresses suffered a temporary failure, the message is left on
1497 the queue, to be tried again later. Delivery of these addresses is said to be
1500 When all the recipient addresses have either been delivered or bounced,
1501 handling of the message is complete. The spool files and message log are
1502 deleted, though the message log can optionally be preserved if required.
1508 .section "Retry mechanism" "SECID19"
1509 .cindex "delivery" "retry mechanism"
1510 .cindex "retry" "description of mechanism"
1511 .cindex "queue runner"
1512 Exim's mechanism for retrying messages that fail to get delivered at the first
1513 attempt is the queue runner process. You must either run an Exim daemon that
1514 uses the &%-q%& option with a time interval to start queue runners at regular
1515 intervals, or use some other means (such as &'cron'&) to start them. If you do
1516 not arrange for queue runners to be run, messages that fail temporarily at the
1517 first attempt will remain on your queue for ever. A queue runner process works
1518 its way through the queue, one message at a time, trying each delivery that has
1519 passed its retry time.
1520 You can run several queue runners at once.
1522 Exim uses a set of configured rules to determine when next to retry the failing
1523 address (see chapter &<<CHAPretry>>&). These rules also specify when Exim
1524 should give up trying to deliver to the address, at which point it generates a
1525 bounce message. If no retry rules are set for a particular host, address, and
1526 error combination, no retries are attempted, and temporary errors are treated
1531 .section "Temporary delivery failure" "SECID20"
1532 .cindex "delivery" "temporary failure"
1533 There are many reasons why a message may not be immediately deliverable to a
1534 particular address. Failure to connect to a remote machine (because it, or the
1535 connection to it, is down) is one of the most common. Temporary failures may be
1536 detected during routing as well as during the transport stage of delivery.
1537 Local deliveries may be delayed if NFS files are unavailable, or if a mailbox
1538 is on a file system where the user is over quota. Exim can be configured to
1539 impose its own quotas on local mailboxes; where system quotas are set they will
1542 If a host is unreachable for a period of time, a number of messages may be
1543 waiting for it by the time it recovers, and sending them in a single SMTP
1544 connection is clearly beneficial. Whenever a delivery to a remote host is
1546 .cindex "hints database"
1547 Exim makes a note in its hints database, and whenever a successful
1548 SMTP delivery has happened, it looks to see if any other messages are waiting
1549 for the same host. If any are found, they are sent over the same SMTP
1550 connection, subject to a configuration limit as to the maximum number in any
1555 .section "Permanent delivery failure" "SECID21"
1556 .cindex "delivery" "permanent failure"
1557 .cindex "bounce message" "when generated"
1558 When a message cannot be delivered to some or all of its intended recipients, a
1559 bounce message is generated. Temporary delivery failures turn into permanent
1560 errors when their timeout expires. All the addresses that fail in a given
1561 delivery attempt are listed in a single message. If the original message has
1562 many recipients, it is possible for some addresses to fail in one delivery
1563 attempt and others to fail subsequently, giving rise to more than one bounce
1564 message. The wording of bounce messages can be customized by the administrator.
1565 See chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>& for details.
1567 .cindex "&'X-Failed-Recipients:'& header line"
1568 Bounce messages contain an &'X-Failed-Recipients:'& header line that lists the
1569 failed addresses, for the benefit of programs that try to analyse such messages
1572 .cindex "bounce message" "recipient of"
1573 A bounce message is normally sent to the sender of the original message, as
1574 obtained from the message's envelope. For incoming SMTP messages, this is the
1575 address given in the MAIL command. However, when an address is expanded via a
1576 forward or alias file, an alternative address can be specified for delivery
1577 failures of the generated addresses. For a mailing list expansion (see section
1578 &<<SECTmailinglists>>&) it is common to direct bounce messages to the manager
1583 .section "Failures to deliver bounce messages" "SECID22"
1584 .cindex "bounce message" "failure to deliver"
1585 If a bounce message (either locally generated or received from a remote host)
1586 itself suffers a permanent delivery failure, the message is left on the queue,
1587 but it is frozen, awaiting the attention of an administrator. There are options
1588 that can be used to make Exim discard such failed messages, or to keep them
1589 for only a short time (see &%timeout_frozen_after%& and
1590 &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&).
1596 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
1597 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
1599 .chapter "Building and installing Exim" "CHID3"
1600 .scindex IIDbuex "building Exim"
1602 .section "Unpacking" "SECID23"
1603 Exim is distributed as a gzipped or bzipped tar file which, when unpacked,
1604 creates a directory with the name of the current release (for example,
1605 &_exim-&version;_&) into which the following files are placed:
1608 .irow &_ACKNOWLEDGMENTS_& "contains some acknowledgments"
1609 .irow &_CHANGES_& "contains a reference to where changes are &&&
1611 .irow &_LICENCE_& "the GNU General Public Licence"
1612 .irow &_Makefile_& "top-level make file"
1613 .irow &_NOTICE_& "conditions for the use of Exim"
1614 .irow &_README_& "list of files, directories and simple build &&&
1618 Other files whose names begin with &_README_& may also be present. The
1619 following subdirectories are created:
1622 .irow &_Local_& "an empty directory for local configuration files"
1623 .irow &_OS_& "OS-specific files"
1624 .irow &_doc_& "documentation files"
1625 .irow &_exim_monitor_& "source files for the Exim monitor"
1626 .irow &_scripts_& "scripts used in the build process"
1627 .irow &_src_& "remaining source files"
1628 .irow &_util_& "independent utilities"
1631 The main utility programs are contained in the &_src_& directory, and are built
1632 with the Exim binary. The &_util_& directory contains a few optional scripts
1633 that may be useful to some sites.
1636 .section "Multiple machine architectures and operating systems" "SECID24"
1637 .cindex "building Exim" "multiple OS/architectures"
1638 The building process for Exim is arranged to make it easy to build binaries for
1639 a number of different architectures and operating systems from the same set of
1640 source files. Compilation does not take place in the &_src_& directory.
1641 Instead, a &'build directory'& is created for each architecture and operating
1643 .cindex "symbolic link" "to build directory"
1644 Symbolic links to the sources are installed in this directory, which is where
1645 the actual building takes place. In most cases, Exim can discover the machine
1646 architecture and operating system for itself, but the defaults can be
1647 overridden if necessary.
1650 .section "PCRE library" "SECTpcre"
1651 .cindex "PCRE library"
1652 Exim no longer has an embedded PCRE library as the vast majority of
1653 modern systems include PCRE as a system library, although you may need
1654 to install the PCRE or PCRE development package for your operating
1655 system. If your system has a normal PCRE installation the Exim build
1656 process will need no further configuration. If the library or the
1657 headers are in an unusual location you will need to either set the PCRE_LIBS
1658 and INCLUDE directives appropriately,
1659 or set PCRE_CONFIG=yes to use the installed &(pcre-config)& command.
1660 If your operating system has no
1661 PCRE support then you will need to obtain and build the current PCRE
1662 from &url(ftp://ftp.csx.cam.ac.uk/pub/software/programming/pcre/).
1663 More information on PCRE is available at &url(http://www.pcre.org/).
1665 .section "DBM libraries" "SECTdb"
1666 .cindex "DBM libraries" "discussion of"
1667 .cindex "hints database" "DBM files used for"
1668 Even if you do not use any DBM files in your configuration, Exim still needs a
1669 DBM library in order to operate, because it uses indexed files for its hints
1670 databases. Unfortunately, there are a number of DBM libraries in existence, and
1671 different operating systems often have different ones installed.
1673 .cindex "Solaris" "DBM library for"
1674 .cindex "IRIX, DBM library for"
1675 .cindex "BSD, DBM library for"
1676 .cindex "Linux, DBM library for"
1677 If you are using Solaris, IRIX, one of the modern BSD systems, or a modern
1678 Linux distribution, the DBM configuration should happen automatically, and you
1679 may be able to ignore this section. Otherwise, you may have to learn more than
1680 you would like about DBM libraries from what follows.
1682 .cindex "&'ndbm'& DBM library"
1683 Licensed versions of Unix normally contain a library of DBM functions operating
1684 via the &'ndbm'& interface, and this is what Exim expects by default. Free
1685 versions of Unix seem to vary in what they contain as standard. In particular,
1686 some early versions of Linux have no default DBM library, and different
1687 distributors have chosen to bundle different libraries with their packaged
1688 versions. However, the more recent releases seem to have standardized on the
1689 Berkeley DB library.
1691 Different DBM libraries have different conventions for naming the files they
1692 use. When a program opens a file called &_dbmfile_&, there are several
1696 A traditional &'ndbm'& implementation, such as that supplied as part of
1697 Solaris, operates on two files called &_dbmfile.dir_& and &_dbmfile.pag_&.
1699 .cindex "&'gdbm'& DBM library"
1700 The GNU library, &'gdbm'&, operates on a single file. If used via its &'ndbm'&
1701 compatibility interface it makes two different hard links to it with names
1702 &_dbmfile.dir_& and &_dbmfile.pag_&, but if used via its native interface, the
1703 file name is used unmodified.
1705 .cindex "Berkeley DB library"
1706 The Berkeley DB package, if called via its &'ndbm'& compatibility interface,
1707 operates on a single file called &_dbmfile.db_&, but otherwise looks to the
1708 programmer exactly the same as the traditional &'ndbm'& implementation.
1710 If the Berkeley package is used in its native mode, it operates on a single
1711 file called &_dbmfile_&; the programmer's interface is somewhat different to
1712 the traditional &'ndbm'& interface.
1714 To complicate things further, there are several very different versions of the
1715 Berkeley DB package. Version 1.85 was stable for a very long time, releases
1716 2.&'x'& and 3.&'x'& were current for a while, but the latest versions are now
1717 numbered 4.&'x'&. Maintenance of some of the earlier releases has ceased. All
1718 versions of Berkeley DB can be obtained from
1719 &url(http://www.sleepycat.com/).
1721 .cindex "&'tdb'& DBM library"
1722 Yet another DBM library, called &'tdb'&, is available from
1723 &url(http://download.sourceforge.net/tdb). It has its own interface, and also
1724 operates on a single file.
1728 .cindex "DBM libraries" "configuration for building"
1729 Exim and its utilities can be compiled to use any of these interfaces. In order
1730 to use any version of the Berkeley DB package in native mode, you must set
1731 USE_DB in an appropriate configuration file (typically
1732 &_Local/Makefile_&). For example:
1736 Similarly, for gdbm you set USE_GDBM, and for tdb you set USE_TDB. An
1737 error is diagnosed if you set more than one of these.
1739 At the lowest level, the build-time configuration sets none of these options,
1740 thereby assuming an interface of type (1). However, some operating system
1741 configuration files (for example, those for the BSD operating systems and
1742 Linux) assume type (4) by setting USE_DB as their default, and the
1743 configuration files for Cygwin set USE_GDBM. Anything you set in
1744 &_Local/Makefile_&, however, overrides these system defaults.
1746 As well as setting USE_DB, USE_GDBM, or USE_TDB, it may also be
1747 necessary to set DBMLIB, to cause inclusion of the appropriate library, as
1748 in one of these lines:
1753 Settings like that will work if the DBM library is installed in the standard
1754 place. Sometimes it is not, and the library's header file may also not be in
1755 the default path. You may need to set INCLUDE to specify where the header
1756 file is, and to specify the path to the library more fully in DBMLIB, as in
1759 INCLUDE=-I/usr/local/include/db-4.1
1760 DBMLIB=/usr/local/lib/db-4.1/libdb.a
1762 There is further detailed discussion about the various DBM libraries in the
1763 file &_doc/dbm.discuss.txt_& in the Exim distribution.
1767 .section "Pre-building configuration" "SECID25"
1768 .cindex "building Exim" "pre-building configuration"
1769 .cindex "configuration for building Exim"
1770 .cindex "&_Local/Makefile_&"
1771 .cindex "&_src/EDITME_&"
1772 Before building Exim, a local configuration file that specifies options
1773 independent of any operating system has to be created with the name
1774 &_Local/Makefile_&. A template for this file is supplied as the file
1775 &_src/EDITME_&, and it contains full descriptions of all the option settings
1776 therein. These descriptions are therefore not repeated here. If you are
1777 building Exim for the first time, the simplest thing to do is to copy
1778 &_src/EDITME_& to &_Local/Makefile_&, then read it and edit it appropriately.
1780 There are three settings that you must supply, because Exim will not build
1781 without them. They are the location of the run time configuration file
1782 (CONFIGURE_FILE), the directory in which Exim binaries will be installed
1783 (BIN_DIRECTORY), and the identity of the Exim user (EXIM_USER and
1784 maybe EXIM_GROUP as well). The value of CONFIGURE_FILE can in fact be
1785 a colon-separated list of file names; Exim uses the first of them that exists.
1787 There are a few other parameters that can be specified either at build time or
1788 at run time, to enable the same binary to be used on a number of different
1789 machines. However, if the locations of Exim's spool directory and log file
1790 directory (if not within the spool directory) are fixed, it is recommended that
1791 you specify them in &_Local/Makefile_& instead of at run time, so that errors
1792 detected early in Exim's execution (such as a malformed configuration file) can
1795 .cindex "content scanning" "specifying at build time"
1796 Exim's interfaces for calling virus and spam scanning software directly from
1797 access control lists are not compiled by default. If you want to include these
1798 facilities, you need to set
1800 WITH_CONTENT_SCAN=yes
1802 in your &_Local/Makefile_&. For details of the facilities themselves, see
1803 chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
1806 .cindex "&_Local/eximon.conf_&"
1807 .cindex "&_exim_monitor/EDITME_&"
1808 If you are going to build the Exim monitor, a similar configuration process is
1809 required. The file &_exim_monitor/EDITME_& must be edited appropriately for
1810 your installation and saved under the name &_Local/eximon.conf_&. If you are
1811 happy with the default settings described in &_exim_monitor/EDITME_&,
1812 &_Local/eximon.conf_& can be empty, but it must exist.
1814 This is all the configuration that is needed in straightforward cases for known
1815 operating systems. However, the building process is set up so that it is easy
1816 to override options that are set by default or by operating-system-specific
1817 configuration files, for example to change the name of the C compiler, which
1818 defaults to &%gcc%&. See section &<<SECToverride>>& below for details of how to
1823 .section "Support for iconv()" "SECID26"
1824 .cindex "&[iconv()]& support"
1826 The contents of header lines in messages may be encoded according to the rules
1827 described RFC 2047. This makes it possible to transmit characters that are not
1828 in the ASCII character set, and to label them as being in a particular
1829 character set. When Exim is inspecting header lines by means of the &%$h_%&
1830 mechanism, it decodes them, and translates them into a specified character set
1831 (default ISO-8859-1). The translation is possible only if the operating system
1832 supports the &[iconv()]& function.
1834 However, some of the operating systems that supply &[iconv()]& do not support
1835 very many conversions. The GNU &%libiconv%& library (available from
1836 &url(http://www.gnu.org/software/libiconv/)) can be installed on such
1837 systems to remedy this deficiency, as well as on systems that do not supply
1838 &[iconv()]& at all. After installing &%libiconv%&, you should add
1842 to your &_Local/Makefile_& and rebuild Exim.
1846 .section "Including TLS/SSL encryption support" "SECTinctlsssl"
1847 .cindex "TLS" "including support for TLS"
1848 .cindex "encryption" "including support for"
1849 .cindex "SUPPORT_TLS"
1850 .cindex "OpenSSL" "building Exim with"
1851 .cindex "GnuTLS" "building Exim with"
1852 Exim can be built to support encrypted SMTP connections, using the STARTTLS
1853 command as per RFC 2487. It can also support legacy clients that expect to
1854 start a TLS session immediately on connection to a non-standard port (see the
1855 &%tls_on_connect_ports%& runtime option and the &%-tls-on-connect%& command
1858 If you want to build Exim with TLS support, you must first install either the
1859 OpenSSL or GnuTLS library. There is no cryptographic code in Exim itself for
1862 If OpenSSL is installed, you should set
1865 TLS_LIBS=-lssl -lcrypto
1867 in &_Local/Makefile_&. You may also need to specify the locations of the
1868 OpenSSL library and include files. For example:
1871 TLS_LIBS=-L/usr/local/openssl/lib -lssl -lcrypto
1872 TLS_INCLUDE=-I/usr/local/openssl/include/
1874 .cindex "pkg-config" "OpenSSL"
1875 If you have &'pkg-config'& available, then instead you can just use:
1878 USE_OPENSSL_PC=openssl
1880 .cindex "USE_GNUTLS"
1881 If GnuTLS is installed, you should set
1885 TLS_LIBS=-lgnutls -ltasn1 -lgcrypt
1887 in &_Local/Makefile_&, and again you may need to specify the locations of the
1888 library and include files. For example:
1892 TLS_LIBS=-L/usr/gnu/lib -lgnutls -ltasn1 -lgcrypt
1893 TLS_INCLUDE=-I/usr/gnu/include
1895 .cindex "pkg-config" "GnuTLS"
1896 If you have &'pkg-config'& available, then instead you can just use:
1900 USE_GNUTLS_PC=gnutls
1903 You do not need to set TLS_INCLUDE if the relevant directory is already
1904 specified in INCLUDE. Details of how to configure Exim to make use of TLS are
1905 given in chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&.
1910 .section "Use of tcpwrappers" "SECID27"
1912 .cindex "tcpwrappers, building Exim to support"
1913 .cindex "USE_TCP_WRAPPERS"
1914 .cindex "TCP_WRAPPERS_DAEMON_NAME"
1915 .cindex "tcp_wrappers_daemon_name"
1916 Exim can be linked with the &'tcpwrappers'& library in order to check incoming
1917 SMTP calls using the &'tcpwrappers'& control files. This may be a convenient
1918 alternative to Exim's own checking facilities for installations that are
1919 already making use of &'tcpwrappers'& for other purposes. To do this, you
1920 should set USE_TCP_WRAPPERS in &_Local/Makefile_&, arrange for the file
1921 &_tcpd.h_& to be available at compile time, and also ensure that the library
1922 &_libwrap.a_& is available at link time, typically by including &%-lwrap%& in
1923 EXTRALIBS_EXIM. For example, if &'tcpwrappers'& is installed in &_/usr/local_&,
1926 USE_TCP_WRAPPERS=yes
1927 CFLAGS=-O -I/usr/local/include
1928 EXTRALIBS_EXIM=-L/usr/local/lib -lwrap
1930 in &_Local/Makefile_&. The daemon name to use in the &'tcpwrappers'& control
1931 files is &"exim"&. For example, the line
1933 exim : LOCAL 192.168.1. .friendly.domain.example
1935 in your &_/etc/hosts.allow_& file allows connections from the local host, from
1936 the subnet 192.168.1.0/24, and from all hosts in &'friendly.domain.example'&.
1937 All other connections are denied. The daemon name used by &'tcpwrappers'&
1938 can be changed at build time by setting TCP_WRAPPERS_DAEMON_NAME in
1939 in &_Local/Makefile_&, or by setting tcp_wrappers_daemon_name in the
1940 configure file. Consult the &'tcpwrappers'& documentation for
1944 .section "Including support for IPv6" "SECID28"
1945 .cindex "IPv6" "including support for"
1946 Exim contains code for use on systems that have IPv6 support. Setting
1947 &`HAVE_IPV6=YES`& in &_Local/Makefile_& causes the IPv6 code to be included;
1948 it may also be necessary to set IPV6_INCLUDE and IPV6_LIBS on systems
1949 where the IPv6 support is not fully integrated into the normal include and
1952 Two different types of DNS record for handling IPv6 addresses have been
1953 defined. AAAA records (analogous to A records for IPv4) are in use, and are
1954 currently seen as the mainstream. Another record type called A6 was proposed
1955 as better than AAAA because it had more flexibility. However, it was felt to be
1956 over-complex, and its status was reduced to &"experimental"&. It is not known
1957 if anyone is actually using A6 records. Exim has support for A6 records, but
1958 this is included only if you set &`SUPPORT_A6=YES`& in &_Local/Makefile_&. The
1959 support has not been tested for some time.
1963 .section "Dynamically loaded lookup module support" "SECTdynamicmodules"
1964 .cindex "lookup modules"
1965 .cindex "dynamic modules"
1966 .cindex ".so building"
1967 On some platforms, Exim supports not compiling all lookup types directly into
1968 the main binary, instead putting some into external modules which can be loaded
1970 This permits packagers to build Exim with support for lookups with extensive
1971 library dependencies without requiring all users to install all of those
1973 Most, but not all, lookup types can be built this way.
1975 Set &`LOOKUP_MODULE_DIR`& to the directory into which the modules will be
1976 installed; Exim will only load modules from that directory, as a security
1977 measure. You will need to set &`CFLAGS_DYNAMIC`& if not already defined
1978 for your OS; see &_OS/Makefile-Linux_& for an example.
1979 Some other requirements for adjusting &`EXTRALIBS`& may also be necessary,
1980 see &_src/EDITME_& for details.
1982 Then, for each module to be loaded dynamically, define the relevant
1983 &`LOOKUP_`&<&'lookup_type'&> flags to have the value "2" instead of "yes".
1984 For example, this will build in lsearch but load sqlite and mysql support
1993 .section "The building process" "SECID29"
1994 .cindex "build directory"
1995 Once &_Local/Makefile_& (and &_Local/eximon.conf_&, if required) have been
1996 created, run &'make'& at the top level. It determines the architecture and
1997 operating system types, and creates a build directory if one does not exist.
1998 For example, on a Sun system running Solaris 8, the directory
1999 &_build-SunOS5-5.8-sparc_& is created.
2000 .cindex "symbolic link" "to source files"
2001 Symbolic links to relevant source files are installed in the build directory.
2003 &*Warning*&: The &%-j%& (parallel) flag must not be used with &'make'&; the
2004 building process fails if it is set.
2006 If this is the first time &'make'& has been run, it calls a script that builds
2007 a make file inside the build directory, using the configuration files from the
2008 &_Local_& directory. The new make file is then passed to another instance of
2009 &'make'&. This does the real work, building a number of utility scripts, and
2010 then compiling and linking the binaries for the Exim monitor (if configured), a
2011 number of utility programs, and finally Exim itself. The command &`make
2012 makefile`& can be used to force a rebuild of the make file in the build
2013 directory, should this ever be necessary.
2015 If you have problems building Exim, check for any comments there may be in the
2016 &_README_& file concerning your operating system, and also take a look at the
2017 FAQ, where some common problems are covered.
2021 .section 'Output from &"make"&' "SECID283"
2022 The output produced by the &'make'& process for compile lines is often very
2023 unreadable, because these lines can be very long. For this reason, the normal
2024 output is suppressed by default, and instead output similar to that which
2025 appears when compiling the 2.6 Linux kernel is generated: just a short line for
2026 each module that is being compiled or linked. However, it is still possible to
2027 get the full output, by calling &'make'& like this:
2031 The value of FULLECHO defaults to &"@"&, the flag character that suppresses
2032 command reflection in &'make'&. When you ask for the full output, it is
2033 given in addition to the short output.
2037 .section "Overriding build-time options for Exim" "SECToverride"
2038 .cindex "build-time options, overriding"
2039 The main make file that is created at the beginning of the building process
2040 consists of the concatenation of a number of files which set configuration
2041 values, followed by a fixed set of &'make'& instructions. If a value is set
2042 more than once, the last setting overrides any previous ones. This provides a
2043 convenient way of overriding defaults. The files that are concatenated are, in
2046 &_OS/Makefile-Default_&
2047 &_OS/Makefile-_&<&'ostype'&>
2049 &_Local/Makefile-_&<&'ostype'&>
2050 &_Local/Makefile-_&<&'archtype'&>
2051 &_Local/Makefile-_&<&'ostype'&>-<&'archtype'&>
2052 &_OS/Makefile-Base_&
2054 .cindex "&_Local/Makefile_&"
2055 .cindex "building Exim" "operating system type"
2056 .cindex "building Exim" "architecture type"
2057 where <&'ostype'&> is the operating system type and <&'archtype'&> is the
2058 architecture type. &_Local/Makefile_& is required to exist, and the building
2059 process fails if it is absent. The other three &_Local_& files are optional,
2060 and are often not needed.
2062 The values used for <&'ostype'&> and <&'archtype'&> are obtained from scripts
2063 called &_scripts/os-type_& and &_scripts/arch-type_& respectively. If either of
2064 the environment variables EXIM_OSTYPE or EXIM_ARCHTYPE is set, their
2065 values are used, thereby providing a means of forcing particular settings.
2066 Otherwise, the scripts try to get values from the &%uname%& command. If this
2067 fails, the shell variables OSTYPE and ARCHTYPE are inspected. A number
2068 of &'ad hoc'& transformations are then applied, to produce the standard names
2069 that Exim expects. You can run these scripts directly from the shell in order
2070 to find out what values are being used on your system.
2073 &_OS/Makefile-Default_& contains comments about the variables that are set
2074 therein. Some (but not all) are mentioned below. If there is something that
2075 needs changing, review the contents of this file and the contents of the make
2076 file for your operating system (&_OS/Makefile-<ostype>_&) to see what the
2080 .cindex "building Exim" "overriding default settings"
2081 If you need to change any of the values that are set in &_OS/Makefile-Default_&
2082 or in &_OS/Makefile-<ostype>_&, or to add any new definitions, you do not
2083 need to change the original files. Instead, you should make the changes by
2084 putting the new values in an appropriate &_Local_& file. For example,
2085 .cindex "Tru64-Unix build-time settings"
2086 when building Exim in many releases of the Tru64-Unix (formerly Digital UNIX,
2087 formerly DEC-OSF1) operating system, it is necessary to specify that the C
2088 compiler is called &'cc'& rather than &'gcc'&. Also, the compiler must be
2089 called with the option &%-std1%&, to make it recognize some of the features of
2090 Standard C that Exim uses. (Most other compilers recognize Standard C by
2091 default.) To do this, you should create a file called &_Local/Makefile-OSF1_&
2092 containing the lines
2097 If you are compiling for just one operating system, it may be easier to put
2098 these lines directly into &_Local/Makefile_&.
2100 Keeping all your local configuration settings separate from the distributed
2101 files makes it easy to transfer them to new versions of Exim simply by copying
2102 the contents of the &_Local_& directory.
2105 .cindex "NIS lookup type" "including support for"
2106 .cindex "NIS+ lookup type" "including support for"
2107 .cindex "LDAP" "including support for"
2108 .cindex "lookup" "inclusion in binary"
2109 Exim contains support for doing LDAP, NIS, NIS+, and other kinds of file
2110 lookup, but not all systems have these components installed, so the default is
2111 not to include the relevant code in the binary. All the different kinds of file
2112 and database lookup that Exim supports are implemented as separate code modules
2113 which are included only if the relevant compile-time options are set. In the
2114 case of LDAP, NIS, and NIS+, the settings for &_Local/Makefile_& are:
2120 and similar settings apply to the other lookup types. They are all listed in
2121 &_src/EDITME_&. In many cases the relevant include files and interface
2122 libraries need to be installed before compiling Exim.
2123 .cindex "cdb" "including support for"
2124 However, there are some optional lookup types (such as cdb) for which
2125 the code is entirely contained within Exim, and no external include
2126 files or libraries are required. When a lookup type is not included in the
2127 binary, attempts to configure Exim to use it cause run time configuration
2130 .cindex "pkg-config" "lookups"
2131 .cindex "pkg-config" "authenticators"
2132 Many systems now use a tool called &'pkg-config'& to encapsulate information
2133 about how to compile against a library; Exim has some initial support for
2134 being able to use pkg-config for lookups and authenticators. For any given
2135 makefile variable which starts &`LOOKUP_`& or &`AUTH_`&, you can add a new
2136 variable with the &`_PC`& suffix in the name and assign as the value the
2137 name of the package to be queried. The results of querying via the
2138 &'pkg-config'& command will be added to the appropriate Makefile variables
2139 with &`+=`& directives, so your version of &'make'& will need to support that
2140 syntax. For instance:
2143 LOOKUP_SQLITE_PC=sqlite3
2145 AUTH_GSASL_PC=libgsasl
2146 AUTH_HEIMDAL_GSSAPI=yes
2147 AUTH_HEIMDAL_GSSAPI_PC=heimdal-gssapi
2150 .cindex "Perl" "including support for"
2151 Exim can be linked with an embedded Perl interpreter, allowing Perl
2152 subroutines to be called during string expansion. To enable this facility,
2156 must be defined in &_Local/Makefile_&. Details of this facility are given in
2157 chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&.
2159 .cindex "X11 libraries, location of"
2160 The location of the X11 libraries is something that varies a lot between
2161 operating systems, and there may be different versions of X11 to cope
2162 with. Exim itself makes no use of X11, but if you are compiling the Exim
2163 monitor, the X11 libraries must be available.
2164 The following three variables are set in &_OS/Makefile-Default_&:
2167 XINCLUDE=-I$(X11)/include
2168 XLFLAGS=-L$(X11)/lib
2170 These are overridden in some of the operating-system configuration files. For
2171 example, in &_OS/Makefile-SunOS5_& there is
2174 XINCLUDE=-I$(X11)/include
2175 XLFLAGS=-L$(X11)/lib -R$(X11)/lib
2177 If you need to override the default setting for your operating system, place a
2178 definition of all three of these variables into your
2179 &_Local/Makefile-<ostype>_& file.
2182 If you need to add any extra libraries to the link steps, these can be put in a
2183 variable called EXTRALIBS, which appears in all the link commands, but by
2184 default is not defined. In contrast, EXTRALIBS_EXIM is used only on the
2185 command for linking the main Exim binary, and not for any associated utilities.
2187 .cindex "DBM libraries" "configuration for building"
2188 There is also DBMLIB, which appears in the link commands for binaries that
2189 use DBM functions (see also section &<<SECTdb>>&). Finally, there is
2190 EXTRALIBS_EXIMON, which appears only in the link step for the Exim monitor
2191 binary, and which can be used, for example, to include additional X11
2194 .cindex "configuration file" "editing"
2195 The make file copes with rebuilding Exim correctly if any of the configuration
2196 files are edited. However, if an optional configuration file is deleted, it is
2197 necessary to touch the associated non-optional file (that is,
2198 &_Local/Makefile_& or &_Local/eximon.conf_&) before rebuilding.
2201 .section "OS-specific header files" "SECID30"
2203 .cindex "building Exim" "OS-specific C header files"
2204 The &_OS_& directory contains a number of files with names of the form
2205 &_os.h-<ostype>_&. These are system-specific C header files that should not
2206 normally need to be changed. There is a list of macro settings that are
2207 recognized in the file &_OS/os.configuring_&, which should be consulted if you
2208 are porting Exim to a new operating system.
2212 .section "Overriding build-time options for the monitor" "SECID31"
2213 .cindex "building Eximon"
2214 A similar process is used for overriding things when building the Exim monitor,
2215 where the files that are involved are
2217 &_OS/eximon.conf-Default_&
2218 &_OS/eximon.conf-_&<&'ostype'&>
2219 &_Local/eximon.conf_&
2220 &_Local/eximon.conf-_&<&'ostype'&>
2221 &_Local/eximon.conf-_&<&'archtype'&>
2222 &_Local/eximon.conf-_&<&'ostype'&>-<&'archtype'&>
2224 .cindex "&_Local/eximon.conf_&"
2225 As with Exim itself, the final three files need not exist, and in this case the
2226 &_OS/eximon.conf-<ostype>_& file is also optional. The default values in
2227 &_OS/eximon.conf-Default_& can be overridden dynamically by setting environment
2228 variables of the same name, preceded by EXIMON_. For example, setting
2229 EXIMON_LOG_DEPTH in the environment overrides the value of
2230 LOG_DEPTH at run time.
2234 .section "Installing Exim binaries and scripts" "SECID32"
2235 .cindex "installing Exim"
2236 .cindex "BIN_DIRECTORY"
2237 The command &`make install`& runs the &(exim_install)& script with no
2238 arguments. The script copies binaries and utility scripts into the directory
2239 whose name is specified by the BIN_DIRECTORY setting in &_Local/Makefile_&.
2240 .cindex "setuid" "installing Exim with"
2241 The install script copies files only if they are newer than the files they are
2242 going to replace. The Exim binary is required to be owned by root and have the
2243 &'setuid'& bit set, for normal configurations. Therefore, you must run &`make
2244 install`& as root so that it can set up the Exim binary in this way. However, in
2245 some special situations (for example, if a host is doing no local deliveries)
2246 it may be possible to run Exim without making the binary setuid root (see
2247 chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>& for details).
2249 .cindex "CONFIGURE_FILE"
2250 Exim's run time configuration file is named by the CONFIGURE_FILE setting
2251 in &_Local/Makefile_&. If this names a single file, and the file does not
2252 exist, the default configuration file &_src/configure.default_& is copied there
2253 by the installation script. If a run time configuration file already exists, it
2254 is left alone. If CONFIGURE_FILE is a colon-separated list, naming several
2255 alternative files, no default is installed.
2257 .cindex "system aliases file"
2258 .cindex "&_/etc/aliases_&"
2259 One change is made to the default configuration file when it is installed: the
2260 default configuration contains a router that references a system aliases file.
2261 The path to this file is set to the value specified by
2262 SYSTEM_ALIASES_FILE in &_Local/Makefile_& (&_/etc/aliases_& by default).
2263 If the system aliases file does not exist, the installation script creates it,
2264 and outputs a comment to the user.
2266 The created file contains no aliases, but it does contain comments about the
2267 aliases a site should normally have. Mail aliases have traditionally been
2268 kept in &_/etc/aliases_&. However, some operating systems are now using
2269 &_/etc/mail/aliases_&. You should check if yours is one of these, and change
2270 Exim's configuration if necessary.
2272 The default configuration uses the local host's name as the only local domain,
2273 and is set up to do local deliveries into the shared directory &_/var/mail_&,
2274 running as the local user. System aliases and &_.forward_& files in users' home
2275 directories are supported, but no NIS or NIS+ support is configured. Domains
2276 other than the name of the local host are routed using the DNS, with delivery
2279 It is possible to install Exim for special purposes (such as building a binary
2280 distribution) in a private part of the file system. You can do this by a
2283 make DESTDIR=/some/directory/ install
2285 This has the effect of pre-pending the specified directory to all the file
2286 paths, except the name of the system aliases file that appears in the default
2287 configuration. (If a default alias file is created, its name &'is'& modified.)
2288 For backwards compatibility, ROOT is used if DESTDIR is not set,
2289 but this usage is deprecated.
2291 .cindex "installing Exim" "what is not installed"
2292 Running &'make install'& does not copy the Exim 4 conversion script
2293 &'convert4r4'&. You will probably run this only once if you are
2294 upgrading from Exim 3. None of the documentation files in the &_doc_&
2295 directory are copied, except for the info files when you have set
2296 INFO_DIRECTORY, as described in section &<<SECTinsinfdoc>>& below.
2298 For the utility programs, old versions are renamed by adding the suffix &_.O_&
2299 to their names. The Exim binary itself, however, is handled differently. It is
2300 installed under a name that includes the version number and the compile number,
2301 for example &_exim-&version;-1_&. The script then arranges for a symbolic link
2302 called &_exim_& to point to the binary. If you are updating a previous version
2303 of Exim, the script takes care to ensure that the name &_exim_& is never absent
2304 from the directory (as seen by other processes).
2306 .cindex "installing Exim" "testing the script"
2307 If you want to see what the &'make install'& will do before running it for
2308 real, you can pass the &%-n%& option to the installation script by this
2311 make INSTALL_ARG=-n install
2313 The contents of the variable INSTALL_ARG are passed to the installation
2314 script. You do not need to be root to run this test. Alternatively, you can run
2315 the installation script directly, but this must be from within the build
2316 directory. For example, from the top-level Exim directory you could use this
2319 (cd build-SunOS5-5.5.1-sparc; ../scripts/exim_install -n)
2321 .cindex "installing Exim" "install script options"
2322 There are two other options that can be supplied to the installation script.
2325 &%-no_chown%& bypasses the call to change the owner of the installed binary
2326 to root, and the call to make it a setuid binary.
2328 &%-no_symlink%& bypasses the setting up of the symbolic link &_exim_& to the
2332 INSTALL_ARG can be used to pass these options to the script. For example:
2334 make INSTALL_ARG=-no_symlink install
2336 The installation script can also be given arguments specifying which files are
2337 to be copied. For example, to install just the Exim binary, and nothing else,
2338 without creating the symbolic link, you could use:
2340 make INSTALL_ARG='-no_symlink exim' install
2345 .section "Installing info documentation" "SECTinsinfdoc"
2346 .cindex "installing Exim" "&'info'& documentation"
2347 Not all systems use the GNU &'info'& system for documentation, and for this
2348 reason, the Texinfo source of Exim's documentation is not included in the main
2349 distribution. Instead it is available separately from the ftp site (see section
2352 If you have defined INFO_DIRECTORY in &_Local/Makefile_& and the Texinfo
2353 source of the documentation is found in the source tree, running &`make
2354 install`& automatically builds the info files and installs them.
2358 .section "Setting up the spool directory" "SECID33"
2359 .cindex "spool directory" "creating"
2360 When it starts up, Exim tries to create its spool directory if it does not
2361 exist. The Exim uid and gid are used for the owner and group of the spool
2362 directory. Sub-directories are automatically created in the spool directory as
2368 .section "Testing" "SECID34"
2369 .cindex "testing" "installation"
2370 Having installed Exim, you can check that the run time configuration file is
2371 syntactically valid by running the following command, which assumes that the
2372 Exim binary directory is within your PATH environment variable:
2376 If there are any errors in the configuration file, Exim outputs error messages.
2377 Otherwise it outputs the version number and build date,
2378 the DBM library that is being used, and information about which drivers and
2379 other optional code modules are included in the binary.
2380 Some simple routing tests can be done by using the address testing option. For
2383 &`exim -bt`& <&'local username'&>
2385 should verify that it recognizes a local mailbox, and
2387 &`exim -bt`& <&'remote address'&>
2389 a remote one. Then try getting it to deliver mail, both locally and remotely.
2390 This can be done by passing messages directly to Exim, without going through a
2391 user agent. For example:
2393 exim -v postmaster@your.domain.example
2394 From: user@your.domain.example
2395 To: postmaster@your.domain.example
2396 Subject: Testing Exim
2398 This is a test message.
2401 The &%-v%& option causes Exim to output some verification of what it is doing.
2402 In this case you should see copies of three log lines, one for the message's
2403 arrival, one for its delivery, and one containing &"Completed"&.
2405 .cindex "delivery" "problems with"
2406 If you encounter problems, look at Exim's log files (&'mainlog'& and
2407 &'paniclog'&) to see if there is any relevant information there. Another source
2408 of information is running Exim with debugging turned on, by specifying the
2409 &%-d%& option. If a message is stuck on Exim's spool, you can force a delivery
2410 with debugging turned on by a command of the form
2412 &`exim -d -M`& <&'exim-message-id'&>
2414 You must be root or an &"admin user"& in order to do this. The &%-d%& option
2415 produces rather a lot of output, but you can cut this down to specific areas.
2416 For example, if you use &%-d-all+route%& only the debugging information
2417 relevant to routing is included. (See the &%-d%& option in chapter
2418 &<<CHAPcommandline>>& for more details.)
2420 .cindex '&"sticky"& bit'
2421 .cindex "lock files"
2422 One specific problem that has shown up on some sites is the inability to do
2423 local deliveries into a shared mailbox directory, because it does not have the
2424 &"sticky bit"& set on it. By default, Exim tries to create a lock file before
2425 writing to a mailbox file, and if it cannot create the lock file, the delivery
2426 is deferred. You can get round this either by setting the &"sticky bit"& on the
2427 directory, or by setting a specific group for local deliveries and allowing
2428 that group to create files in the directory (see the comments above the
2429 &(local_delivery)& transport in the default configuration file). Another
2430 approach is to configure Exim not to use lock files, but just to rely on
2431 &[fcntl()]& locking instead. However, you should do this only if all user
2432 agents also use &[fcntl()]& locking. For further discussion of locking issues,
2433 see chapter &<<CHAPappendfile>>&.
2435 One thing that cannot be tested on a system that is already running an MTA is
2436 the receipt of incoming SMTP mail on the standard SMTP port. However, the
2437 &%-oX%& option can be used to run an Exim daemon that listens on some other
2438 port, or &'inetd'& can be used to do this. The &%-bh%& option and the
2439 &'exim_checkaccess'& utility can be used to check out policy controls on
2442 Testing a new version on a system that is already running Exim can most easily
2443 be done by building a binary with a different CONFIGURE_FILE setting. From
2444 within the run time configuration, all other file and directory names
2445 that Exim uses can be altered, in order to keep it entirely clear of the
2449 .section "Replacing another MTA with Exim" "SECID35"
2450 .cindex "replacing another MTA"
2451 Building and installing Exim for the first time does not of itself put it in
2452 general use. The name by which the system's MTA is called by mail user agents
2453 is either &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&, or &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& (depending on the
2454 operating system), and it is necessary to make this name point to the &'exim'&
2455 binary in order to get the user agents to pass messages to Exim. This is
2456 normally done by renaming any existing file and making &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&
2457 or &_/usr/lib/sendmail_&
2458 .cindex "symbolic link" "to &'exim'& binary"
2459 a symbolic link to the &'exim'& binary. It is a good idea to remove any setuid
2460 privilege and executable status from the old MTA. It is then necessary to stop
2461 and restart the mailer daemon, if one is running.
2463 .cindex "FreeBSD, MTA indirection"
2464 .cindex "&_/etc/mail/mailer.conf_&"
2465 Some operating systems have introduced alternative ways of switching MTAs. For
2466 example, if you are running FreeBSD, you need to edit the file
2467 &_/etc/mail/mailer.conf_& instead of setting up a symbolic link as just
2468 described. A typical example of the contents of this file for running Exim is
2471 sendmail /usr/exim/bin/exim
2472 send-mail /usr/exim/bin/exim
2473 mailq /usr/exim/bin/exim -bp
2474 newaliases /usr/bin/true
2476 Once you have set up the symbolic link, or edited &_/etc/mail/mailer.conf_&,
2477 your Exim installation is &"live"&. Check it by sending a message from your
2478 favourite user agent.
2480 You should consider what to tell your users about the change of MTA. Exim may
2481 have different capabilities to what was previously running, and there are
2482 various operational differences such as the text of messages produced by
2483 command line options and in bounce messages. If you allow your users to make
2484 use of Exim's filtering capabilities, you should make the document entitled
2485 &'Exim's interface to mail filtering'& available to them.
2489 .section "Upgrading Exim" "SECID36"
2490 .cindex "upgrading Exim"
2491 If you are already running Exim on your host, building and installing a new
2492 version automatically makes it available to MUAs, or any other programs that
2493 call the MTA directly. However, if you are running an Exim daemon, you do need
2494 to send it a HUP signal, to make it re-execute itself, and thereby pick up the
2495 new binary. You do not need to stop processing mail in order to install a new
2496 version of Exim. The install script does not modify an existing runtime
2502 .section "Stopping the Exim daemon on Solaris" "SECID37"
2503 .cindex "Solaris" "stopping Exim on"
2504 The standard command for stopping the mailer daemon on Solaris is
2506 /etc/init.d/sendmail stop
2508 If &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& has been turned into a symbolic link, this script
2509 fails to stop Exim because it uses the command &'ps -e'& and greps the output
2510 for the text &"sendmail"&; this is not present because the actual program name
2511 (that is, &"exim"&) is given by the &'ps'& command with these options. A
2512 solution is to replace the line that finds the process id with something like
2514 pid=`cat /var/spool/exim/exim-daemon.pid`
2516 to obtain the daemon's pid directly from the file that Exim saves it in.
2518 Note, however, that stopping the daemon does not &"stop Exim"&. Messages can
2519 still be received from local processes, and if automatic delivery is configured
2520 (the normal case), deliveries will still occur.
2525 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2526 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2528 .chapter "The Exim command line" "CHAPcommandline"
2529 .scindex IIDclo1 "command line" "options"
2530 .scindex IIDclo2 "options" "command line"
2531 Exim's command line takes the standard Unix form of a sequence of options,
2532 each starting with a hyphen character, followed by a number of arguments. The
2533 options are compatible with the main options of Sendmail, and there are also
2534 some additional options, some of which are compatible with Smail 3. Certain
2535 combinations of options do not make sense, and provoke an error if used.
2536 The form of the arguments depends on which options are set.
2539 .section "Setting options by program name" "SECID38"
2541 If Exim is called under the name &'mailq'&, it behaves as if the option &%-bp%&
2542 were present before any other options.
2543 The &%-bp%& option requests a listing of the contents of the mail queue on the
2545 This feature is for compatibility with some systems that contain a command of
2546 that name in one of the standard libraries, symbolically linked to
2547 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& or &_/usr/lib/sendmail_&.
2550 If Exim is called under the name &'rsmtp'& it behaves as if the option &%-bS%&
2551 were present before any other options, for compatibility with Smail. The
2552 &%-bS%& option is used for reading in a number of messages in batched SMTP
2556 If Exim is called under the name &'rmail'& it behaves as if the &%-i%& and
2557 &%-oee%& options were present before any other options, for compatibility with
2558 Smail. The name &'rmail'& is used as an interface by some UUCP systems.
2561 .cindex "queue runner"
2562 If Exim is called under the name &'runq'& it behaves as if the option &%-q%&
2563 were present before any other options, for compatibility with Smail. The &%-q%&
2564 option causes a single queue runner process to be started.
2566 .cindex "&'newaliases'&"
2567 .cindex "alias file" "building"
2568 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "calling Exim as &'newaliases'&"
2569 If Exim is called under the name &'newaliases'& it behaves as if the option
2570 &%-bi%& were present before any other options, for compatibility with Sendmail.
2571 This option is used for rebuilding Sendmail's alias file. Exim does not have
2572 the concept of a single alias file, but can be configured to run a given
2573 command if called with the &%-bi%& option.
2576 .section "Trusted and admin users" "SECTtrustedadmin"
2577 Some Exim options are available only to &'trusted users'& and others are
2578 available only to &'admin users'&. In the description below, the phrases &"Exim
2579 user"& and &"Exim group"& mean the user and group defined by EXIM_USER and
2580 EXIM_GROUP in &_Local/Makefile_& or set by the &%exim_user%& and
2581 &%exim_group%& options. These do not necessarily have to use the name &"exim"&.
2584 .cindex "trusted users" "definition of"
2585 .cindex "user" "trusted definition of"
2586 The trusted users are root, the Exim user, any user listed in the
2587 &%trusted_users%& configuration option, and any user whose current group or any
2588 supplementary group is one of those listed in the &%trusted_groups%&
2589 configuration option. Note that the Exim group is not automatically trusted.
2591 .cindex '&"From"& line'
2592 .cindex "envelope sender"
2593 Trusted users are always permitted to use the &%-f%& option or a leading
2594 &"From&~"& line to specify the envelope sender of a message that is passed to
2595 Exim through the local interface (see the &%-bm%& and &%-f%& options below).
2596 See the &%untrusted_set_sender%& option for a way of permitting non-trusted
2597 users to set envelope senders.
2599 .cindex "&'From:'& header line"
2600 .cindex "&'Sender:'& header line"
2601 For a trusted user, there is never any check on the contents of the &'From:'&
2602 header line, and a &'Sender:'& line is never added. Furthermore, any existing
2603 &'Sender:'& line in incoming local (non-TCP/IP) messages is not removed.
2605 Trusted users may also specify a host name, host address, interface address,
2606 protocol name, ident value, and authentication data when submitting a message
2607 locally. Thus, they are able to insert messages into Exim's queue locally that
2608 have the characteristics of messages received from a remote host. Untrusted
2609 users may in some circumstances use &%-f%&, but can never set the other values
2610 that are available to trusted users.
2612 .cindex "user" "admin definition of"
2613 .cindex "admin user" "definition of"
2614 The admin users are root, the Exim user, and any user that is a member of the
2615 Exim group or of any group listed in the &%admin_groups%& configuration option.
2616 The current group does not have to be one of these groups.
2618 Admin users are permitted to list the queue, and to carry out certain
2619 operations on messages, for example, to force delivery failures. It is also
2620 necessary to be an admin user in order to see the full information provided by
2621 the Exim monitor, and full debugging output.
2623 By default, the use of the &%-M%&, &%-q%&, &%-R%&, and &%-S%& options to cause
2624 Exim to attempt delivery of messages on its queue is restricted to admin users.
2625 However, this restriction can be relaxed by setting the &%prod_requires_admin%&
2626 option false (that is, specifying &%no_prod_requires_admin%&).
2628 Similarly, the use of the &%-bp%& option to list all the messages in the queue
2629 is restricted to admin users unless &%queue_list_requires_admin%& is set
2634 &*Warning*&: If you configure your system so that admin users are able to
2635 edit Exim's configuration file, you are giving those users an easy way of
2636 getting root. There is further discussion of this issue at the start of chapter
2642 .section "Command line options" "SECID39"
2643 Exim's command line options are described in alphabetical order below. If none
2644 of the options that specifies a specific action (such as starting the daemon or
2645 a queue runner, or testing an address, or receiving a message in a specific
2646 format, or listing the queue) are present, and there is at least one argument
2647 on the command line, &%-bm%& (accept a local message on the standard input,
2648 with the arguments specifying the recipients) is assumed. Otherwise, Exim
2649 outputs a brief message about itself and exits.
2651 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2652 . Insert a stylized XML comment here, to identify the start of the command line
2653 . options. This is for the benefit of the Perl script that automatically
2654 . creates a man page for the options.
2655 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2658 <!-- === Start of command line options === -->
2665 .cindex "options" "command line; terminating"
2666 This is a pseudo-option whose only purpose is to terminate the options and
2667 therefore to cause subsequent command line items to be treated as arguments
2668 rather than options, even if they begin with hyphens.
2671 .oindex "&%--help%&"
2672 This option causes Exim to output a few sentences stating what it is.
2673 The same output is generated if the Exim binary is called with no options and
2676 .vitem &%--version%&
2677 .oindex "&%--version%&"
2678 This option is an alias for &%-bV%& and causes version information to be
2686 These options are used by Sendmail for selecting configuration files and are
2690 .vitem &%-B%&<&'type'&>
2692 .cindex "8-bit characters"
2693 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "8-bit characters"
2694 This is a Sendmail option for selecting 7 or 8 bit processing. Exim is 8-bit
2695 clean; it ignores this option.
2700 .cindex "SMTP" "listener"
2701 .cindex "queue runner"
2702 This option runs Exim as a daemon, awaiting incoming SMTP connections. Usually
2703 the &%-bd%& option is combined with the &%-q%&<&'time'&> option, to specify
2704 that the daemon should also initiate periodic queue runs.
2706 The &%-bd%& option can be used only by an admin user. If either of the &%-d%&
2707 (debugging) or &%-v%& (verifying) options are set, the daemon does not
2708 disconnect from the controlling terminal. When running this way, it can be
2709 stopped by pressing ctrl-C.
2711 By default, Exim listens for incoming connections to the standard SMTP port on
2712 all the host's running interfaces. However, it is possible to listen on other
2713 ports, on multiple ports, and only on specific interfaces. Chapter
2714 &<<CHAPinterfaces>>& contains a description of the options that control this.
2716 When a listening daemon
2717 .cindex "daemon" "process id (pid)"
2718 .cindex "pid (process id)" "of daemon"
2719 is started without the use of &%-oX%& (that is, without overriding the normal
2720 configuration), it writes its process id to a file called &_exim-daemon.pid_&
2721 in Exim's spool directory. This location can be overridden by setting
2722 PID_FILE_PATH in &_Local/Makefile_&. The file is written while Exim is still
2725 When &%-oX%& is used on the command line to start a listening daemon, the
2726 process id is not written to the normal pid file path. However, &%-oP%& can be
2727 used to specify a path on the command line if a pid file is required.
2731 .cindex "daemon" "restarting"
2732 can be used to cause the daemon to re-execute itself. This should be done
2733 whenever Exim's configuration file, or any file that is incorporated into it by
2734 means of the &%.include%& facility, is changed, and also whenever a new version
2735 of Exim is installed. It is not necessary to do this when other files that are
2736 referenced from the configuration (for example, alias files) are changed,
2737 because these are reread each time they are used.
2741 This option has the same effect as &%-bd%& except that it never disconnects
2742 from the controlling terminal, even when no debugging is specified.
2746 .cindex "testing" "string expansion"
2747 .cindex "expansion" "testing"
2748 Run Exim in expansion testing mode. Exim discards its root privilege, to
2749 prevent ordinary users from using this mode to read otherwise inaccessible
2750 files. If no arguments are given, Exim runs interactively, prompting for lines
2751 of data. Otherwise, it processes each argument in turn.
2753 If Exim was built with USE_READLINE=yes in &_Local/Makefile_&, it tries
2754 to load the &%libreadline%& library dynamically whenever the &%-be%& option is
2755 used without command line arguments. If successful, it uses the &[readline()]&
2756 function, which provides extensive line-editing facilities, for reading the
2757 test data. A line history is supported.
2759 Long expansion expressions can be split over several lines by using backslash
2760 continuations. As in Exim's run time configuration, white space at the start of
2761 continuation lines is ignored. Each argument or data line is passed through the
2762 string expansion mechanism, and the result is output. Variable values from the
2763 configuration file (for example, &$qualify_domain$&) are available, but no
2764 message-specific values (such as &$sender_domain$&) are set, because no message
2765 is being processed (but see &%-bem%& and &%-Mset%&).
2767 &*Note*&: If you use this mechanism to test lookups, and you change the data
2768 files or databases you are using, you must exit and restart Exim before trying
2769 the same lookup again. Otherwise, because each Exim process caches the results
2770 of lookups, you will just get the same result as before.
2772 .vitem &%-bem%&&~<&'filename'&>
2774 .cindex "testing" "string expansion"
2775 .cindex "expansion" "testing"
2776 This option operates like &%-be%& except that it must be followed by the name
2777 of a file. For example:
2779 exim -bem /tmp/testmessage
2781 The file is read as a message (as if receiving a locally-submitted non-SMTP
2782 message) before any of the test expansions are done. Thus, message-specific
2783 variables such as &$message_size$& and &$header_from:$& are available. However,
2784 no &'Received:'& header is added to the message. If the &%-t%& option is set,
2785 recipients are read from the headers in the normal way, and are shown in the
2786 &$recipients$& variable. Note that recipients cannot be given on the command
2787 line, because further arguments are taken as strings to expand (just like
2790 .vitem &%-bF%&&~<&'filename'&>
2792 .cindex "system filter" "testing"
2793 .cindex "testing" "system filter"
2794 This option is the same as &%-bf%& except that it assumes that the filter being
2795 tested is a system filter. The additional commands that are available only in
2796 system filters are recognized.
2798 .vitem &%-bf%&&~<&'filename'&>
2800 .cindex "filter" "testing"
2801 .cindex "testing" "filter file"
2802 .cindex "forward file" "testing"
2803 .cindex "testing" "forward file"
2804 .cindex "Sieve filter" "testing"
2805 This option runs Exim in user filter testing mode; the file is the filter file
2806 to be tested, and a test message must be supplied on the standard input. If
2807 there are no message-dependent tests in the filter, an empty file can be
2810 If you want to test a system filter file, use &%-bF%& instead of &%-bf%&. You
2811 can use both &%-bF%& and &%-bf%& on the same command, in order to test a system
2812 filter and a user filter in the same run. For example:
2814 exim -bF /system/filter -bf /user/filter </test/message
2816 This is helpful when the system filter adds header lines or sets filter
2817 variables that are used by the user filter.
2819 If the test filter file does not begin with one of the special lines
2824 it is taken to be a normal &_.forward_& file, and is tested for validity under
2825 that interpretation. See sections &<<SECTitenonfilred>>& to
2826 &<<SECTspecitredli>>& for a description of the possible contents of non-filter
2829 The result of an Exim command that uses &%-bf%&, provided no errors are
2830 detected, is a list of the actions that Exim would try to take if presented
2831 with the message for real. More details of filter testing are given in the
2832 separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'&.
2834 When testing a filter file,
2835 .cindex "&""From""& line"
2836 .cindex "envelope sender"
2837 .oindex "&%-f%&" "for filter testing"
2838 the envelope sender can be set by the &%-f%& option,
2839 or by a &"From&~"& line at the start of the test message. Various parameters
2840 that would normally be taken from the envelope recipient address of the message
2841 can be set by means of additional command line options (see the next four
2844 .vitem &%-bfd%&&~<&'domain'&>
2846 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
2847 This sets the domain of the recipient address when a filter file is being
2848 tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is the value of
2851 .vitem &%-bfl%&&~<&'local&~part'&>
2853 This sets the local part of the recipient address when a filter file is being
2854 tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is the username of the
2855 process that calls Exim. A local part should be specified with any prefix or
2856 suffix stripped, because that is how it appears to the filter when a message is
2857 actually being delivered.
2859 .vitem &%-bfp%&&~<&'prefix'&>
2861 This sets the prefix of the local part of the recipient address when a filter
2862 file is being tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is an empty
2865 .vitem &%-bfs%&&~<&'suffix'&>
2867 This sets the suffix of the local part of the recipient address when a filter
2868 file is being tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is an empty
2871 .vitem &%-bh%&&~<&'IP&~address'&>
2873 .cindex "testing" "incoming SMTP"
2874 .cindex "SMTP" "testing incoming"
2875 .cindex "testing" "relay control"
2876 .cindex "relaying" "testing configuration"
2877 .cindex "policy control" "testing"
2878 .cindex "debugging" "&%-bh%& option"
2879 This option runs a fake SMTP session as if from the given IP address, using the
2880 standard input and output. The IP address may include a port number at the end,
2881 after a full stop. For example:
2883 exim -bh 10.9.8.7.1234
2884 exim -bh fe80::a00:20ff:fe86:a061.5678
2886 When an IPv6 address is given, it is converted into canonical form. In the case
2887 of the second example above, the value of &$sender_host_address$& after
2888 conversion to the canonical form is
2889 &`fe80:0000:0000:0a00:20ff:fe86:a061.5678`&.
2891 Comments as to what is going on are written to the standard error file. These
2892 include lines beginning with &"LOG"& for anything that would have been logged.
2893 This facility is provided for testing configuration options for incoming
2894 messages, to make sure they implement the required policy. For example, you can
2895 test your relay controls using &%-bh%&.
2899 You can test features of the configuration that rely on ident (RFC 1413)
2900 information by using the &%-oMt%& option. However, Exim cannot actually perform
2901 an ident callout when testing using &%-bh%& because there is no incoming SMTP
2904 &*Warning 2*&: Address verification callouts (see section &<<SECTcallver>>&)
2905 are also skipped when testing using &%-bh%&. If you want these callouts to
2906 occur, use &%-bhc%& instead.
2908 Messages supplied during the testing session are discarded, and nothing is
2909 written to any of the real log files. There may be pauses when DNS (and other)
2910 lookups are taking place, and of course these may time out. The &%-oMi%& option
2911 can be used to specify a specific IP interface and port if this is important,
2912 and &%-oMaa%& and &%-oMai%& can be used to set parameters as if the SMTP
2913 session were authenticated.
2915 The &'exim_checkaccess'& utility is a &"packaged"& version of &%-bh%& whose
2916 output just states whether a given recipient address from a given host is
2917 acceptable or not. See section &<<SECTcheckaccess>>&.
2919 Features such as authentication and encryption, where the client input is not
2920 plain text, cannot easily be tested with &%-bh%&. Instead, you should use a
2921 specialized SMTP test program such as
2922 &url(http://jetmore.org/john/code/#swaks,swaks).
2924 .vitem &%-bhc%&&~<&'IP&~address'&>
2926 This option operates in the same way as &%-bh%&, except that address
2927 verification callouts are performed if required. This includes consulting and
2928 updating the callout cache database.
2932 .cindex "alias file" "building"
2933 .cindex "building alias file"
2934 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-bi%& option"
2935 Sendmail interprets the &%-bi%& option as a request to rebuild its alias file.
2936 Exim does not have the concept of a single alias file, and so it cannot mimic
2937 this behaviour. However, calls to &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& with the &%-bi%& option
2938 tend to appear in various scripts such as NIS make files, so the option must be
2941 If &%-bi%& is encountered, the command specified by the &%bi_command%&
2942 configuration option is run, under the uid and gid of the caller of Exim. If
2943 the &%-oA%& option is used, its value is passed to the command as an argument.
2944 The command set by &%bi_command%& may not contain arguments. The command can
2945 use the &'exim_dbmbuild'& utility, or some other means, to rebuild alias files
2946 if this is required. If the &%bi_command%& option is not set, calling Exim with
2950 . // Keep :help first, then the rest in alphabetical order
2952 .oindex "&%-bI:help%&"
2953 .cindex "querying exim information"
2954 We shall provide various options starting &`-bI:`& for querying Exim for
2955 information. The output of many of these will be intended for machine
2956 consumption. This one is not. The &%-bI:help%& option asks Exim for a
2957 synopsis of supported options beginning &`-bI:`&. Use of any of these
2958 options shall cause Exim to exit after producing the requested output.
2961 .oindex "&%-bI:dscp%&"
2962 .cindex "DSCP" "values"
2963 This option causes Exim to emit an alphabetically sorted list of all
2964 recognised DSCP names.
2966 .vitem &%-bI:sieve%&
2967 .oindex "&%-bI:sieve%&"
2968 .cindex "Sieve filter" "capabilities"
2969 This option causes Exim to emit an alphabetically sorted list of all supported
2970 Sieve protocol extensions on stdout, one per line. This is anticipated to be
2971 useful for ManageSieve (RFC 5804) implementations, in providing that protocol's
2972 &`SIEVE`& capability response line. As the precise list may depend upon
2973 compile-time build options, which this option will adapt to, this is the only
2974 way to guarantee a correct response.
2979 .cindex "local message reception"
2980 This option runs an Exim receiving process that accepts an incoming,
2981 locally-generated message on the current input. The recipients are given as the
2982 command arguments (except when &%-t%& is also present &-- see below). Each
2983 argument can be a comma-separated list of RFC 2822 addresses. This is the
2984 default option for selecting the overall action of an Exim call; it is assumed
2985 if no other conflicting option is present.
2987 If any addresses in the message are unqualified (have no domain), they are
2988 qualified by the values of the &%qualify_domain%& or &%qualify_recipient%&
2989 options, as appropriate. The &%-bnq%& option (see below) provides a way of
2990 suppressing this for special cases.
2992 Policy checks on the contents of local messages can be enforced by means of
2993 the non-SMTP ACL. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for details.
2995 .cindex "return code" "for &%-bm%&"
2996 The return code is zero if the message is successfully accepted. Otherwise, the
2997 action is controlled by the &%-oe%&&'x'& option setting &-- see below.
3000 .cindex "message" "format"
3001 .cindex "format" "message"
3002 .cindex "&""From""& line"
3003 .cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
3004 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&""From""& line"
3005 of the message must be as defined in RFC 2822, except that, for
3006 compatibility with Sendmail and Smail, a line in one of the forms
3008 From sender Fri Jan 5 12:55 GMT 1997
3009 From sender Fri, 5 Jan 97 12:55:01
3011 (with the weekday optional, and possibly with additional text after the date)
3012 is permitted to appear at the start of the message. There appears to be no
3013 authoritative specification of the format of this line. Exim recognizes it by
3014 matching against the regular expression defined by the &%uucp_from_pattern%&
3015 option, which can be changed if necessary.
3017 .oindex "&%-f%&" "overriding &""From""& line"
3018 The specified sender is treated as if it were given as the argument to the
3019 &%-f%& option, but if a &%-f%& option is also present, its argument is used in
3020 preference to the address taken from the message. The caller of Exim must be a
3021 trusted user for the sender of a message to be set in this way.
3023 .vitem &%-bmalware%&&~<&'filename'&>
3024 .oindex "&%-bmalware%&"
3025 .cindex "testing", "malware"
3026 .cindex "malware scan test"
3027 This debugging option causes Exim to scan the given file,
3028 using the malware scanning framework. The option of &%av_scanner%& influences
3029 this option, so if &%av_scanner%&'s value is dependent upon an expansion then
3030 the expansion should have defaults which apply to this invocation. ACLs are
3031 not invoked, so if &%av_scanner%& references an ACL variable then that variable
3032 will never be populated and &%-bmalware%& will fail.
3034 Exim will have changed working directory before resolving the filename, so
3035 using fully qualified pathnames is advisable. Exim will be running as the Exim
3036 user when it tries to open the file, rather than as the invoking user.
3037 This option requires admin privileges.
3039 The &%-bmalware%& option will not be extended to be more generally useful,
3040 there are better tools for file-scanning. This option exists to help
3041 administrators verify their Exim and AV scanner configuration.
3045 .cindex "address qualification, suppressing"
3046 By default, Exim automatically qualifies unqualified addresses (those
3047 without domains) that appear in messages that are submitted locally (that
3048 is, not over TCP/IP). This qualification applies both to addresses in
3049 envelopes, and addresses in header lines. Sender addresses are qualified using
3050 &%qualify_domain%&, and recipient addresses using &%qualify_recipient%& (which
3051 defaults to the value of &%qualify_domain%&).
3053 Sometimes, qualification is not wanted. For example, if &%-bS%& (batch SMTP) is
3054 being used to re-submit messages that originally came from remote hosts after
3055 content scanning, you probably do not want to qualify unqualified addresses in
3056 header lines. (Such lines will be present only if you have not enabled a header
3057 syntax check in the appropriate ACL.)
3059 The &%-bnq%& option suppresses all qualification of unqualified addresses in
3060 messages that originate on the local host. When this is used, unqualified
3061 addresses in the envelope provoke errors (causing message rejection) and
3062 unqualified addresses in header lines are left alone.
3067 .cindex "configuration options" "extracting"
3068 .cindex "options" "configuration &-- extracting"
3069 If this option is given with no arguments, it causes the values of all Exim's
3070 main configuration options to be written to the standard output. The values
3071 of one or more specific options can be requested by giving their names as
3072 arguments, for example:
3074 exim -bP qualify_domain hold_domains
3076 .cindex "hiding configuration option values"
3077 .cindex "configuration options" "hiding value of"
3078 .cindex "options" "hiding value of"
3079 However, any option setting that is preceded by the word &"hide"& in the
3080 configuration file is not shown in full, except to an admin user. For other
3081 users, the output is as in this example:
3083 mysql_servers = <value not displayable>
3085 If &%configure_file%& is given as an argument, the name of the run time
3086 configuration file is output.
3087 If a list of configuration files was supplied, the value that is output here
3088 is the name of the file that was actually used.
3091 .cindex "options" "hiding name of"
3092 If the &%-n%& flag is given, then for most modes of &%-bP%& operation the
3093 name will not be output.
3096 .cindex "daemon" "process id (pid)"
3097 .cindex "pid (process id)" "of daemon"
3098 If &%log_file_path%& or &%pid_file_path%& are given, the names of the
3099 directories where log files and daemon pid files are written are output,
3100 respectively. If these values are unset, log files are written in a
3101 sub-directory of the spool directory called &%log%&, and the pid file is
3102 written directly into the spool directory.
3104 If &%-bP%& is followed by a name preceded by &`+`&, for example,
3106 exim -bP +local_domains
3108 it searches for a matching named list of any type (domain, host, address, or
3109 local part) and outputs what it finds.
3111 .cindex "options" "router &-- extracting"
3112 .cindex "options" "transport &-- extracting"
3113 .cindex "options" "authenticator &-- extracting"
3114 If one of the words &%router%&, &%transport%&, or &%authenticator%& is given,
3115 followed by the name of an appropriate driver instance, the option settings for
3116 that driver are output. For example:
3118 exim -bP transport local_delivery
3120 The generic driver options are output first, followed by the driver's private
3121 options. A list of the names of drivers of a particular type can be obtained by
3122 using one of the words &%router_list%&, &%transport_list%&, or
3123 &%authenticator_list%&, and a complete list of all drivers with their option
3124 settings can be obtained by using &%routers%&, &%transports%&, or
3127 .cindex "options" "macro &-- extracting"
3128 If invoked by an admin user, then &%macro%&, &%macro_list%& and &%macros%&
3129 are available, similarly to the drivers. Because macros are sometimes used
3130 for storing passwords, this option is restricted.
3131 The output format is one item per line.
3135 .cindex "queue" "listing messages on"
3136 .cindex "listing" "messages on the queue"
3137 This option requests a listing of the contents of the mail queue on the
3138 standard output. If the &%-bp%& option is followed by a list of message ids,
3139 just those messages are listed. By default, this option can be used only by an
3140 admin user. However, the &%queue_list_requires_admin%& option can be set false
3141 to allow any user to see the queue.
3143 Each message on the queue is displayed as in the following example:
3145 25m 2.9K 0t5C6f-0000c8-00 <alice@wonderland.fict.example>
3146 red.king@looking-glass.fict.example
3149 .cindex "message" "size in queue listing"
3150 .cindex "size" "of message"
3151 The first line contains the length of time the message has been on the queue
3152 (in this case 25 minutes), the size of the message (2.9K), the unique local
3153 identifier for the message, and the message sender, as contained in the
3154 envelope. For bounce messages, the sender address is empty, and appears as
3155 &"<>"&. If the message was submitted locally by an untrusted user who overrode
3156 the default sender address, the user's login name is shown in parentheses
3157 before the sender address.
3159 .cindex "frozen messages" "in queue listing"
3160 If the message is frozen (attempts to deliver it are suspended) then the text
3161 &"*** frozen ***"& is displayed at the end of this line.
3163 The recipients of the message (taken from the envelope, not the headers) are
3164 displayed on subsequent lines. Those addresses to which the message has already
3165 been delivered are marked with the letter D. If an original address gets
3166 expanded into several addresses via an alias or forward file, the original is
3167 displayed with a D only when deliveries for all of its child addresses are
3173 This option operates like &%-bp%&, but in addition it shows delivered addresses
3174 that were generated from the original top level address(es) in each message by
3175 alias or forwarding operations. These addresses are flagged with &"+D"& instead
3181 .cindex "queue" "count of messages on"
3182 This option counts the number of messages on the queue, and writes the total
3183 to the standard output. It is restricted to admin users, unless
3184 &%queue_list_requires_admin%& is set false.
3189 This option operates like &%-bp%&, but the output is not sorted into
3190 chronological order of message arrival. This can speed it up when there are
3191 lots of messages on the queue, and is particularly useful if the output is
3192 going to be post-processed in a way that doesn't need the sorting.
3196 This option is a combination of &%-bpr%& and &%-bpa%&.
3200 This option is a combination of &%-bpr%& and &%-bpu%&.
3205 This option operates like &%-bp%& but shows only undelivered top-level
3206 addresses for each message displayed. Addresses generated by aliasing or
3207 forwarding are not shown, unless the message was deferred after processing by a
3208 router with the &%one_time%& option set.
3213 .cindex "testing" "retry configuration"
3214 .cindex "retry" "configuration testing"
3215 This option is for testing retry rules, and it must be followed by up to three
3216 arguments. It causes Exim to look for a retry rule that matches the values
3217 and to write it to the standard output. For example:
3219 exim -brt bach.comp.mus.example
3220 Retry rule: *.comp.mus.example F,2h,15m; F,4d,30m;
3222 See chapter &<<CHAPretry>>& for a description of Exim's retry rules. The first
3223 argument, which is required, can be a complete address in the form
3224 &'local_part@domain'&, or it can be just a domain name. If the second argument
3225 contains a dot, it is interpreted as an optional second domain name; if no
3226 retry rule is found for the first argument, the second is tried. This ties in
3227 with Exim's behaviour when looking for retry rules for remote hosts &-- if no
3228 rule is found that matches the host, one that matches the mail domain is
3229 sought. Finally, an argument that is the name of a specific delivery error, as
3230 used in setting up retry rules, can be given. For example:
3232 exim -brt haydn.comp.mus.example quota_3d
3233 Retry rule: *@haydn.comp.mus.example quota_3d F,1h,15m
3238 .cindex "testing" "rewriting"
3239 .cindex "rewriting" "testing"
3240 This option is for testing address rewriting rules, and it must be followed by
3241 a single argument, consisting of either a local part without a domain, or a
3242 complete address with a fully qualified domain. Exim outputs how this address
3243 would be rewritten for each possible place it might appear. See chapter
3244 &<<CHAPrewrite>>& for further details.
3248 .cindex "SMTP" "batched incoming"
3249 .cindex "batched SMTP input"
3250 This option is used for batched SMTP input, which is an alternative interface
3251 for non-interactive local message submission. A number of messages can be
3252 submitted in a single run. However, despite its name, this is not really SMTP
3253 input. Exim reads each message's envelope from SMTP commands on the standard
3254 input, but generates no responses. If the caller is trusted, or
3255 &%untrusted_set_sender%& is set, the senders in the SMTP MAIL commands are
3256 believed; otherwise the sender is always the caller of Exim.
3258 The message itself is read from the standard input, in SMTP format (leading
3259 dots doubled), terminated by a line containing just a single dot. An error is
3260 provoked if the terminating dot is missing. A further message may then follow.
3262 As for other local message submissions, the contents of incoming batch SMTP
3263 messages can be checked using the non-SMTP ACL (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&).
3264 Unqualified addresses are automatically qualified using &%qualify_domain%& and
3265 &%qualify_recipient%&, as appropriate, unless the &%-bnq%& option is used.
3267 Some other SMTP commands are recognized in the input. HELO and EHLO act
3268 as RSET; VRFY, EXPN, ETRN, and HELP act as NOOP;
3269 QUIT quits, ignoring the rest of the standard input.
3271 .cindex "return code" "for &%-bS%&"
3272 If any error is encountered, reports are written to the standard output and
3273 error streams, and Exim gives up immediately. The return code is 0 if no error
3274 was detected; it is 1 if one or more messages were accepted before the error
3275 was detected; otherwise it is 2.
3277 More details of input using batched SMTP are given in section
3278 &<<SECTincomingbatchedSMTP>>&.
3282 .cindex "SMTP" "local input"
3283 .cindex "local SMTP input"
3284 This option causes Exim to accept one or more messages by reading SMTP commands
3285 on the standard input, and producing SMTP replies on the standard output. SMTP
3286 policy controls, as defined in ACLs (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&) are applied.
3287 Some user agents use this interface as a way of passing locally-generated
3288 messages to the MTA.
3291 .cindex "sender" "source of"
3292 this usage, if the caller of Exim is trusted, or &%untrusted_set_sender%& is
3293 set, the senders of messages are taken from the SMTP MAIL commands.
3294 Otherwise the content of these commands is ignored and the sender is set up as
3295 the calling user. Unqualified addresses are automatically qualified using
3296 &%qualify_domain%& and &%qualify_recipient%&, as appropriate, unless the
3297 &%-bnq%& option is used.
3301 &%-bs%& option is also used to run Exim from &'inetd'&, as an alternative to
3302 using a listening daemon. Exim can distinguish the two cases by checking
3303 whether the standard input is a TCP/IP socket. When Exim is called from
3304 &'inetd'&, the source of the mail is assumed to be remote, and the comments
3305 above concerning senders and qualification do not apply. In this situation,
3306 Exim behaves in exactly the same way as it does when receiving a message via
3307 the listening daemon.
3311 .cindex "testing" "addresses"
3312 .cindex "address" "testing"
3313 This option runs Exim in address testing mode, in which each argument is taken
3314 as a recipient address to be tested for deliverability. The results are
3315 written to the standard output. If a test fails, and the caller is not an admin
3316 user, no details of the failure are output, because these might contain
3317 sensitive information such as usernames and passwords for database lookups.
3319 If no arguments are given, Exim runs in an interactive manner, prompting with a
3320 right angle bracket for addresses to be tested.
3322 Unlike the &%-be%& test option, you cannot arrange for Exim to use the
3323 &[readline()]& function, because it is running as &'root'& and there are
3326 Each address is handled as if it were the recipient address of a message
3327 (compare the &%-bv%& option). It is passed to the routers and the result is
3328 written to the standard output. However, any router that has
3329 &%no_address_test%& set is bypassed. This can make &%-bt%& easier to use for
3330 genuine routing tests if your first router passes everything to a scanner
3333 .cindex "return code" "for &%-bt%&"
3334 The return code is 2 if any address failed outright; it is 1 if no address
3335 failed outright but at least one could not be resolved for some reason. Return
3336 code 0 is given only when all addresses succeed.
3338 .cindex "duplicate addresses"
3339 &*Note*&: When actually delivering a message, Exim removes duplicate recipient
3340 addresses after routing is complete, so that only one delivery takes place.
3341 This does not happen when testing with &%-bt%&; the full results of routing are
3344 &*Warning*&: &%-bt%& can only do relatively simple testing. If any of the
3345 routers in the configuration makes any tests on the sender address of a
3347 .oindex "&%-f%&" "for address testing"
3348 you can use the &%-f%& option to set an appropriate sender when running
3349 &%-bt%& tests. Without it, the sender is assumed to be the calling user at the
3350 default qualifying domain. However, if you have set up (for example) routers
3351 whose behaviour depends on the contents of an incoming message, you cannot test
3352 those conditions using &%-bt%&. The &%-N%& option provides a possible way of
3357 .cindex "version number of Exim"
3358 This option causes Exim to write the current version number, compilation
3359 number, and compilation date of the &'exim'& binary to the standard output.
3360 It also lists the DBM library that is being used, the optional modules (such as
3361 specific lookup types), the drivers that are included in the binary, and the
3362 name of the run time configuration file that is in use.
3364 As part of its operation, &%-bV%& causes Exim to read and syntax check its
3365 configuration file. However, this is a static check only. It cannot check
3366 values that are to be expanded. For example, although a misspelt ACL verb is
3367 detected, an error in the verb's arguments is not. You cannot rely on &%-bV%&
3368 alone to discover (for example) all the typos in the configuration; some
3369 realistic testing is needed. The &%-bh%& and &%-N%& options provide more
3370 dynamic testing facilities.
3374 .cindex "verifying address" "using &%-bv%&"
3375 .cindex "address" "verification"
3376 This option runs Exim in address verification mode, in which each argument is
3377 taken as a recipient address to be verified by the routers. (This does
3378 not involve any verification callouts). During normal operation, verification
3379 happens mostly as a consequence processing a &%verify%& condition in an ACL
3380 (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&). If you want to test an entire ACL, possibly
3381 including callouts, see the &%-bh%& and &%-bhc%& options.
3383 If verification fails, and the caller is not an admin user, no details of the
3384 failure are output, because these might contain sensitive information such as
3385 usernames and passwords for database lookups.
3387 If no arguments are given, Exim runs in an interactive manner, prompting with a
3388 right angle bracket for addresses to be verified.
3390 Unlike the &%-be%& test option, you cannot arrange for Exim to use the
3391 &[readline()]& function, because it is running as &'exim'& and there are
3394 Verification differs from address testing (the &%-bt%& option) in that routers
3395 that have &%no_verify%& set are skipped, and if the address is accepted by a
3396 router that has &%fail_verify%& set, verification fails. The address is
3397 verified as a recipient if &%-bv%& is used; to test verification for a sender
3398 address, &%-bvs%& should be used.
3400 If the &%-v%& option is not set, the output consists of a single line for each
3401 address, stating whether it was verified or not, and giving a reason in the
3402 latter case. Without &%-v%&, generating more than one address by redirection
3403 causes verification to end successfully, without considering the generated
3404 addresses. However, if just one address is generated, processing continues,
3405 and the generated address must verify successfully for the overall verification
3408 When &%-v%& is set, more details are given of how the address has been handled,
3409 and in the case of address redirection, all the generated addresses are also
3410 considered. Verification may succeed for some and fail for others.
3413 .cindex "return code" "for &%-bv%&"
3414 return code is 2 if any address failed outright; it is 1 if no address
3415 failed outright but at least one could not be resolved for some reason. Return
3416 code 0 is given only when all addresses succeed.
3418 If any of the routers in the configuration makes any tests on the sender
3419 address of a message, you should use the &%-f%& option to set an appropriate
3420 sender when running &%-bv%& tests. Without it, the sender is assumed to be the
3421 calling user at the default qualifying domain.
3425 This option acts like &%-bv%&, but verifies the address as a sender rather
3426 than a recipient address. This affects any rewriting and qualification that
3433 .cindex "inetd" "wait mode"
3434 This option runs Exim as a daemon, awaiting incoming SMTP connections,
3435 similarly to the &%-bd%& option. All port specifications on the command-line
3436 and in the configuration file are ignored. Queue-running may not be specified.
3438 In this mode, Exim expects to be passed a socket as fd 0 (stdin) which is
3439 listening for connections. This permits the system to start up and have
3440 inetd (or equivalent) listen on the SMTP ports, starting an Exim daemon for
3441 each port only when the first connection is received.
3443 If the option is given as &%-bw%&<&'time'&> then the time is a timeout, after
3444 which the daemon will exit, which should cause inetd to listen once more.
3446 .vitem &%-C%&&~<&'filelist'&>
3448 .cindex "configuration file" "alternate"
3449 .cindex "CONFIGURE_FILE"
3450 .cindex "alternate configuration file"
3451 This option causes Exim to find the run time configuration file from the given
3452 list instead of from the list specified by the CONFIGURE_FILE
3453 compile-time setting. Usually, the list will consist of just a single file
3454 name, but it can be a colon-separated list of names. In this case, the first
3455 file that exists is used. Failure to open an existing file stops Exim from
3456 proceeding any further along the list, and an error is generated.
3458 When this option is used by a caller other than root, and the list is different
3459 from the compiled-in list, Exim gives up its root privilege immediately, and
3460 runs with the real and effective uid and gid set to those of the caller.
3461 However, if a TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST file is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, that
3462 file contains a list of full pathnames, one per line, for configuration files
3463 which are trusted. Root privilege is retained for any configuration file so
3464 listed, as long as the caller is the Exim user (or the user specified in the
3465 CONFIGURE_OWNER option, if any), and as long as the configuration file is
3466 not writeable by inappropriate users or groups.
3468 Leaving TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST unset precludes the possibility of testing a
3469 configuration using &%-C%& right through message reception and delivery,
3470 even if the caller is root. The reception works, but by that time, Exim is
3471 running as the Exim user, so when it re-executes to regain privilege for the
3472 delivery, the use of &%-C%& causes privilege to be lost. However, root can
3473 test reception and delivery using two separate commands (one to put a message
3474 on the queue, using &%-odq%&, and another to do the delivery, using &%-M%&).
3476 If ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX is defined &_in Local/Makefile_&, it specifies a
3477 prefix string with which any file named in a &%-C%& command line option
3478 must start. In addition, the file name must not contain the sequence &`/../`&.
3479 However, if the value of the &%-C%& option is identical to the value of
3480 CONFIGURE_FILE in &_Local/Makefile_&, Exim ignores &%-C%& and proceeds as
3481 usual. There is no default setting for ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX; when it is
3482 unset, any file name can be used with &%-C%&.
3484 ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX can be used to confine alternative configuration files
3485 to a directory to which only root has access. This prevents someone who has
3486 broken into the Exim account from running a privileged Exim with an arbitrary
3489 The &%-C%& facility is useful for ensuring that configuration files are
3490 syntactically correct, but cannot be used for test deliveries, unless the
3491 caller is privileged, or unless it is an exotic configuration that does not
3492 require privilege. No check is made on the owner or group of the files
3493 specified by this option.
3496 .vitem &%-D%&<&'macro'&>=<&'value'&>
3498 .cindex "macro" "setting on command line"
3499 This option can be used to override macro definitions in the configuration file
3500 (see section &<<SECTmacrodefs>>&). However, like &%-C%&, if it is used by an
3501 unprivileged caller, it causes Exim to give up its root privilege.
3502 If DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, the use of &%-D%& is
3503 completely disabled, and its use causes an immediate error exit.
3505 If WHITELIST_D_MACROS is defined in &_Local/Makefile_& then it should be a
3506 colon-separated list of macros which are considered safe and, if &%-D%& only
3507 supplies macros from this list, and the values are acceptable, then Exim will
3508 not give up root privilege if the caller is root, the Exim run-time user, or
3509 the CONFIGURE_OWNER, if set. This is a transition mechanism and is expected
3510 to be removed in the future. Acceptable values for the macros satisfy the
3511 regexp: &`^[A-Za-z0-9_/.-]*$`&
3513 The entire option (including equals sign if present) must all be within one
3514 command line item. &%-D%& can be used to set the value of a macro to the empty
3515 string, in which case the equals sign is optional. These two commands are
3521 To include spaces in a macro definition item, quotes must be used. If you use
3522 quotes, spaces are permitted around the macro name and the equals sign. For
3525 exim '-D ABC = something' ...
3527 &%-D%& may be repeated up to 10 times on a command line.
3530 .vitem &%-d%&<&'debug&~options'&>
3532 .cindex "debugging" "list of selectors"
3533 .cindex "debugging" "&%-d%& option"
3534 This option causes debugging information to be written to the standard
3535 error stream. It is restricted to admin users because debugging output may show
3536 database queries that contain password information. Also, the details of users'
3537 filter files should be protected. If a non-admin user uses &%-d%&, Exim
3538 writes an error message to the standard error stream and exits with a non-zero
3541 When &%-d%& is used, &%-v%& is assumed. If &%-d%& is given on its own, a lot of
3542 standard debugging data is output. This can be reduced, or increased to include
3543 some more rarely needed information, by directly following &%-d%& with a string
3544 made up of names preceded by plus or minus characters. These add or remove sets
3545 of debugging data, respectively. For example, &%-d+filter%& adds filter
3546 debugging, whereas &%-d-all+filter%& selects only filter debugging. Note that
3547 no spaces are allowed in the debug setting. The available debugging categories
3550 &`acl `& ACL interpretation
3551 &`auth `& authenticators
3552 &`deliver `& general delivery logic
3553 &`dns `& DNS lookups (see also resolver)
3554 &`dnsbl `& DNS black list (aka RBL) code
3555 &`exec `& arguments for &[execv()]& calls
3556 &`expand `& detailed debugging for string expansions
3557 &`filter `& filter handling
3558 &`hints_lookup `& hints data lookups
3559 &`host_lookup `& all types of name-to-IP address handling
3560 &`ident `& ident lookup
3561 &`interface `& lists of local interfaces
3562 &`lists `& matching things in lists
3563 &`load `& system load checks
3564 &`local_scan `& can be used by &[local_scan()]& (see chapter &&&
3565 &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&)
3566 &`lookup `& general lookup code and all lookups
3567 &`memory `& memory handling
3568 &`pid `& add pid to debug output lines
3569 &`process_info `& setting info for the process log
3570 &`queue_run `& queue runs
3571 &`receive `& general message reception logic
3572 &`resolver `& turn on the DNS resolver's debugging output
3573 &`retry `& retry handling
3574 &`rewrite `& address rewriting
3575 &`route `& address routing
3576 &`timestamp `& add timestamp to debug output lines
3578 &`transport `& transports
3579 &`uid `& changes of uid/gid and looking up uid/gid
3580 &`verify `& address verification logic
3581 &`all `& almost all of the above (see below), and also &%-v%&
3583 The &`all`& option excludes &`memory`& when used as &`+all`&, but includes it
3584 for &`-all`&. The reason for this is that &`+all`& is something that people
3585 tend to use when generating debug output for Exim maintainers. If &`+memory`&
3586 is included, an awful lot of output that is very rarely of interest is
3587 generated, so it now has to be explicitly requested. However, &`-all`& does
3588 turn everything off.
3590 .cindex "resolver, debugging output"
3591 .cindex "DNS resolver, debugging output"
3592 The &`resolver`& option produces output only if the DNS resolver was compiled
3593 with DEBUG enabled. This is not the case in some operating systems. Also,
3594 unfortunately, debugging output from the DNS resolver is written to stdout
3597 The default (&%-d%& with no argument) omits &`expand`&, &`filter`&,
3598 &`interface`&, &`load`&, &`memory`&, &`pid`&, &`resolver`&, and &`timestamp`&.
3599 However, the &`pid`& selector is forced when debugging is turned on for a
3600 daemon, which then passes it on to any re-executed Exims. Exim also
3601 automatically adds the pid to debug lines when several remote deliveries are
3604 The &`timestamp`& selector causes the current time to be inserted at the start
3605 of all debug output lines. This can be useful when trying to track down delays
3608 If the &%debug_print%& option is set in any driver, it produces output whenever
3609 any debugging is selected, or if &%-v%& is used.
3611 .vitem &%-dd%&<&'debug&~options'&>
3613 This option behaves exactly like &%-d%& except when used on a command that
3614 starts a daemon process. In that case, debugging is turned off for the
3615 subprocesses that the daemon creates. Thus, it is useful for monitoring the
3616 behaviour of the daemon without creating as much output as full debugging does.
3619 .oindex "&%-dropcr%&"
3620 This is an obsolete option that is now a no-op. It used to affect the way Exim
3621 handled CR and LF characters in incoming messages. What happens now is
3622 described in section &<<SECTlineendings>>&.
3626 .cindex "bounce message" "generating"
3627 This option specifies that an incoming message is a locally-generated delivery
3628 failure report. It is used internally by Exim when handling delivery failures
3629 and is not intended for external use. Its only effect is to stop Exim
3630 generating certain messages to the postmaster, as otherwise message cascades
3631 could occur in some situations. As part of the same option, a message id may
3632 follow the characters &%-E%&. If it does, the log entry for the receipt of the
3633 new message contains the id, following &"R="&, as a cross-reference.
3636 .oindex "&%-e%&&'x'&"
3637 There are a number of Sendmail options starting with &%-oe%& which seem to be
3638 called by various programs without the leading &%o%& in the option. For
3639 example, the &%vacation%& program uses &%-eq%&. Exim treats all options of the
3640 form &%-e%&&'x'& as synonymous with the corresponding &%-oe%&&'x'& options.
3642 .vitem &%-F%&&~<&'string'&>
3644 .cindex "sender" "name"
3645 .cindex "name" "of sender"
3646 This option sets the sender's full name for use when a locally-generated
3647 message is being accepted. In the absence of this option, the user's &'gecos'&
3648 entry from the password data is used. As users are generally permitted to alter
3649 their &'gecos'& entries, no security considerations are involved. White space
3650 between &%-F%& and the <&'string'&> is optional.
3652 .vitem &%-f%&&~<&'address'&>
3654 .cindex "sender" "address"
3655 .cindex "address" "sender"
3656 .cindex "trusted users"
3657 .cindex "envelope sender"
3658 .cindex "user" "trusted"
3659 This option sets the address of the envelope sender of a locally-generated
3660 message (also known as the return path). The option can normally be used only
3661 by a trusted user, but &%untrusted_set_sender%& can be set to allow untrusted
3664 Processes running as root or the Exim user are always trusted. Other
3665 trusted users are defined by the &%trusted_users%& or &%trusted_groups%&
3666 options. In the absence of &%-f%&, or if the caller is not trusted, the sender
3667 of a local message is set to the caller's login name at the default qualify
3670 There is one exception to the restriction on the use of &%-f%&: an empty sender
3671 can be specified by any user, trusted or not, to create a message that can
3672 never provoke a bounce. An empty sender can be specified either as an empty
3673 string, or as a pair of angle brackets with nothing between them, as in these
3674 examples of shell commands:
3676 exim -f '<>' user@domain
3677 exim -f "" user@domain
3679 In addition, the use of &%-f%& is not restricted when testing a filter file
3680 with &%-bf%& or when testing or verifying addresses using the &%-bt%& or
3683 Allowing untrusted users to change the sender address does not of itself make
3684 it possible to send anonymous mail. Exim still checks that the &'From:'& header
3685 refers to the local user, and if it does not, it adds a &'Sender:'& header,
3686 though this can be overridden by setting &%no_local_from_check%&.
3689 .cindex "&""From""& line"
3690 space between &%-f%& and the <&'address'&> is optional (that is, they can be
3691 given as two arguments or one combined argument). The sender of a
3692 locally-generated message can also be set (when permitted) by an initial
3693 &"From&~"& line in the message &-- see the description of &%-bm%& above &-- but
3694 if &%-f%& is also present, it overrides &"From&~"&.
3698 .cindex "submission fixups, suppressing (command-line)"
3700 This option is equivalent to an ACL applying:
3702 control = suppress_local_fixups
3704 for every message received. Note that Sendmail will complain about such
3705 bad formatting, where Exim silently just does not fix it up. This may change
3708 As this affects audit information, the caller must be a trusted user to use
3712 .vitem &%-h%&&~<&'number'&>
3714 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-h%& option ignored"
3715 This option is accepted for compatibility with Sendmail, but has no effect. (In
3716 Sendmail it overrides the &"hop count"& obtained by counting &'Received:'&
3721 .cindex "Solaris" "&'mail'& command"
3722 .cindex "dot" "in incoming non-SMTP message"
3723 This option, which has the same effect as &%-oi%&, specifies that a dot on a
3724 line by itself should not terminate an incoming, non-SMTP message. I can find
3725 no documentation for this option in Solaris 2.4 Sendmail, but the &'mailx'&
3726 command in Solaris 2.4 uses it. See also &%-ti%&.
3729 .vitem &%-L%&&~<&'tag'&>
3731 .cindex "syslog" "process name; set with flag"
3732 This option is equivalent to setting &%syslog_processname%& in the config
3733 file and setting &%log_file_path%& to &`syslog`&.
3734 Its use is restricted to administrators. The configuration file has to be
3735 read and parsed, to determine access rights, before this is set and takes
3736 effect, so early configuration file errors will not honour this flag.
3738 The tag should not be longer than 32 characters.
3741 .vitem &%-M%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3743 .cindex "forcing delivery"
3744 .cindex "delivery" "forcing attempt"
3745 .cindex "frozen messages" "forcing delivery"
3746 This option requests Exim to run a delivery attempt on each message in turn. If
3747 any of the messages are frozen, they are automatically thawed before the
3748 delivery attempt. The settings of &%queue_domains%&, &%queue_smtp_domains%&,
3749 and &%hold_domains%& are ignored.
3752 .cindex "hints database" "overriding retry hints"
3753 hints for any of the addresses are overridden &-- Exim tries to deliver even if
3754 the normal retry time has not yet been reached. This option requires the caller
3755 to be an admin user. However, there is an option called &%prod_requires_admin%&
3756 which can be set false to relax this restriction (and also the same requirement
3757 for the &%-q%&, &%-R%&, and &%-S%& options).
3759 The deliveries happen synchronously, that is, the original Exim process does
3760 not terminate until all the delivery attempts have finished. No output is
3761 produced unless there is a serious error. If you want to see what is happening,
3762 use the &%-v%& option as well, or inspect Exim's main log.
3764 .vitem &%-Mar%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'address'&>&~<&'address'&>&~...
3766 .cindex "message" "adding recipients"
3767 .cindex "recipient" "adding"
3768 This option requests Exim to add the addresses to the list of recipients of the
3769 message (&"ar"& for &"add recipients"&). The first argument must be a message
3770 id, and the remaining ones must be email addresses. However, if the message is
3771 active (in the middle of a delivery attempt), it is not altered. This option
3772 can be used only by an admin user.
3774 .vitem "&%-MC%&&~<&'transport'&>&~<&'hostname'&>&~<&'sequence&~number'&>&&&
3775 &~<&'message&~id'&>"
3777 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
3778 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
3779 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
3780 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3781 by Exim to invoke another instance of itself to deliver a waiting message using
3782 an existing SMTP connection, which is passed as the standard input. Details are
3783 given in chapter &<<CHAPSMTP>>&. This must be the final option, and the caller
3784 must be root or the Exim user in order to use it.
3788 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3789 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option. It signifies that the
3790 connection to the remote host has been authenticated.
3794 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3795 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option. It signifies that the server to
3796 which Exim is connected supports pipelining.
3798 .vitem &%-MCQ%&&~<&'process&~id'&>&~<&'pipe&~fd'&>
3800 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3801 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option when the original delivery was
3802 started by a queue runner. It passes on the process id of the queue runner,
3803 together with the file descriptor number of an open pipe. Closure of the pipe
3804 signals the final completion of the sequence of processes that are passing
3805 messages through the same SMTP connection.
3809 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3810 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option, and passes on the fact that the
3811 SMTP SIZE option should be used on messages delivered down the existing
3816 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3817 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option, and passes on the fact that the
3818 host to which Exim is connected supports TLS encryption.
3820 .vitem &%-Mc%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3822 .cindex "hints database" "not overridden by &%-Mc%&"
3823 .cindex "delivery" "manually started &-- not forced"
3824 This option requests Exim to run a delivery attempt on each message in turn,
3825 but unlike the &%-M%& option, it does check for retry hints, and respects any
3826 that are found. This option is not very useful to external callers. It is
3827 provided mainly for internal use by Exim when it needs to re-invoke itself in
3828 order to regain root privilege for a delivery (see chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>&).
3829 However, &%-Mc%& can be useful when testing, in order to run a delivery that
3830 respects retry times and other options such as &%hold_domains%& that are
3831 overridden when &%-M%& is used. Such a delivery does not count as a queue run.
3832 If you want to run a specific delivery as if in a queue run, you should use
3833 &%-q%& with a message id argument. A distinction between queue run deliveries
3834 and other deliveries is made in one or two places.
3836 .vitem &%-Mes%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'address'&>
3838 .cindex "message" "changing sender"
3839 .cindex "sender" "changing"
3840 This option requests Exim to change the sender address in the message to the
3841 given address, which must be a fully qualified address or &"<>"& (&"es"& for
3842 &"edit sender"&). There must be exactly two arguments. The first argument must
3843 be a message id, and the second one an email address. However, if the message
3844 is active (in the middle of a delivery attempt), its status is not altered.
3845 This option can be used only by an admin user.
3847 .vitem &%-Mf%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3849 .cindex "freezing messages"
3850 .cindex "message" "manually freezing"
3851 This option requests Exim to mark each listed message as &"frozen"&. This
3852 prevents any delivery attempts taking place until the message is &"thawed"&,
3853 either manually or as a result of the &%auto_thaw%& configuration option.
3854 However, if any of the messages are active (in the middle of a delivery
3855 attempt), their status is not altered. This option can be used only by an admin
3858 .vitem &%-Mg%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3860 .cindex "giving up on messages"
3861 .cindex "message" "abandoning delivery attempts"
3862 .cindex "delivery" "abandoning further attempts"
3863 This option requests Exim to give up trying to deliver the listed messages,
3864 including any that are frozen. However, if any of the messages are active,
3865 their status is not altered. For non-bounce messages, a delivery error message
3866 is sent to the sender, containing the text &"cancelled by administrator"&.
3867 Bounce messages are just discarded. This option can be used only by an admin
3870 .vitem &%-Mmad%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3872 .cindex "delivery" "cancelling all"
3873 This option requests Exim to mark all the recipient addresses in the messages
3874 as already delivered (&"mad"& for &"mark all delivered"&). However, if any
3875 message is active (in the middle of a delivery attempt), its status is not
3876 altered. This option can be used only by an admin user.
3878 .vitem &%-Mmd%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'address'&>&~<&'address'&>&~...
3880 .cindex "delivery" "cancelling by address"
3881 .cindex "recipient" "removing"
3882 .cindex "removing recipients"
3883 This option requests Exim to mark the given addresses as already delivered
3884 (&"md"& for &"mark delivered"&). The first argument must be a message id, and
3885 the remaining ones must be email addresses. These are matched to recipient
3886 addresses in the message in a case-sensitive manner. If the message is active
3887 (in the middle of a delivery attempt), its status is not altered. This option
3888 can be used only by an admin user.
3890 .vitem &%-Mrm%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3892 .cindex "removing messages"
3893 .cindex "abandoning mail"
3894 .cindex "message" "manually discarding"
3895 This option requests Exim to remove the given messages from the queue. No
3896 bounce messages are sent; each message is simply forgotten. However, if any of
3897 the messages are active, their status is not altered. This option can be used
3898 only by an admin user or by the user who originally caused the message to be
3899 placed on the queue.
3901 .vitem &%-Mset%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
3903 .cindex "testing" "string expansion"
3904 .cindex "expansion" "testing"
3905 This option is useful only in conjunction with &%-be%& (that is, when testing
3906 string expansions). Exim loads the given message from its spool before doing
3907 the test expansions, thus setting message-specific variables such as
3908 &$message_size$& and the header variables. The &$recipients$& variable is made
3909 available. This feature is provided to make it easier to test expansions that
3910 make use of these variables. However, this option can be used only by an admin
3911 user. See also &%-bem%&.
3913 .vitem &%-Mt%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3915 .cindex "thawing messages"
3916 .cindex "unfreezing messages"
3917 .cindex "frozen messages" "thawing"
3918 .cindex "message" "thawing frozen"
3919 This option requests Exim to &"thaw"& any of the listed messages that are
3920 &"frozen"&, so that delivery attempts can resume. However, if any of the
3921 messages are active, their status is not altered. This option can be used only
3924 .vitem &%-Mvb%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
3926 .cindex "listing" "message body"
3927 .cindex "message" "listing body of"
3928 This option causes the contents of the message body (-D) spool file to be
3929 written to the standard output. This option can be used only by an admin user.
3931 .vitem &%-Mvc%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
3933 .cindex "message" "listing in RFC 2822 format"
3934 .cindex "listing" "message in RFC 2822 format"
3935 This option causes a copy of the complete message (header lines plus body) to
3936 be written to the standard output in RFC 2822 format. This option can be used
3937 only by an admin user.
3939 .vitem &%-Mvh%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
3941 .cindex "listing" "message headers"
3942 .cindex "header lines" "listing"
3943 .cindex "message" "listing header lines"
3944 This option causes the contents of the message headers (-H) spool file to be
3945 written to the standard output. This option can be used only by an admin user.
3947 .vitem &%-Mvl%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
3949 .cindex "listing" "message log"
3950 .cindex "message" "listing message log"
3951 This option causes the contents of the message log spool file to be written to
3952 the standard output. This option can be used only by an admin user.
3956 This is apparently a synonym for &%-om%& that is accepted by Sendmail, so Exim
3957 treats it that way too.
3961 .cindex "debugging" "&%-N%& option"
3962 .cindex "debugging" "suppressing delivery"
3963 This is a debugging option that inhibits delivery of a message at the transport
3964 level. It implies &%-v%&. Exim goes through many of the motions of delivery &--
3965 it just doesn't actually transport the message, but instead behaves as if it
3966 had successfully done so. However, it does not make any updates to the retry
3967 database, and the log entries for deliveries are flagged with &"*>"& rather
3970 Because &%-N%& discards any message to which it applies, only root or the Exim
3971 user are allowed to use it with &%-bd%&, &%-q%&, &%-R%& or &%-M%&. In other
3972 words, an ordinary user can use it only when supplying an incoming message to
3973 which it will apply. Although transportation never fails when &%-N%& is set, an
3974 address may be deferred because of a configuration problem on a transport, or a
3975 routing problem. Once &%-N%& has been used for a delivery attempt, it sticks to
3976 the message, and applies to any subsequent delivery attempts that may happen
3981 This option is interpreted by Sendmail to mean &"no aliasing"&.
3982 For normal modes of operation, it is ignored by Exim.
3983 When combined with &%-bP%& it suppresses the name of an option from being output.
3985 .vitem &%-O%&&~<&'data'&>
3987 This option is interpreted by Sendmail to mean &`set option`&. It is ignored by
3990 .vitem &%-oA%&&~<&'file&~name'&>
3992 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-oA%& option"
3993 This option is used by Sendmail in conjunction with &%-bi%& to specify an
3994 alternative alias file name. Exim handles &%-bi%& differently; see the
3997 .vitem &%-oB%&&~<&'n'&>
3999 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
4000 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
4001 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
4002 This is a debugging option which limits the maximum number of messages that can
4003 be delivered down one SMTP connection, overriding the value set in any &(smtp)&
4004 transport. If <&'n'&> is omitted, the limit is set to 1.
4008 .cindex "background delivery"
4009 .cindex "delivery" "in the background"
4010 This option applies to all modes in which Exim accepts incoming messages,
4011 including the listening daemon. It requests &"background"& delivery of such
4012 messages, which means that the accepting process automatically starts a
4013 delivery process for each message received, but does not wait for the delivery
4014 processes to finish.
4016 When all the messages have been received, the reception process exits,
4017 leaving the delivery processes to finish in their own time. The standard output
4018 and error streams are closed at the start of each delivery process.
4019 This is the default action if none of the &%-od%& options are present.
4021 If one of the queueing options in the configuration file
4022 (&%queue_only%& or &%queue_only_file%&, for example) is in effect, &%-odb%&
4023 overrides it if &%queue_only_override%& is set true, which is the default
4024 setting. If &%queue_only_override%& is set false, &%-odb%& has no effect.
4028 .cindex "foreground delivery"
4029 .cindex "delivery" "in the foreground"
4030 This option requests &"foreground"& (synchronous) delivery when Exim has
4031 accepted a locally-generated message. (For the daemon it is exactly the same as
4032 &%-odb%&.) A delivery process is automatically started to deliver the message,
4033 and Exim waits for it to complete before proceeding.
4035 The original Exim reception process does not finish until the delivery
4036 process for the final message has ended. The standard error stream is left open
4039 However, like &%-odb%&, this option has no effect if &%queue_only_override%& is
4040 false and one of the queueing options in the configuration file is in effect.
4042 If there is a temporary delivery error during foreground delivery, the
4043 message is left on the queue for later delivery, and the original reception
4044 process exits. See chapter &<<CHAPnonqueueing>>& for a way of setting up a
4045 restricted configuration that never queues messages.
4050 This option is synonymous with &%-odf%&. It is provided for compatibility with
4055 .cindex "non-immediate delivery"
4056 .cindex "delivery" "suppressing immediate"
4057 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
4058 This option applies to all modes in which Exim accepts incoming messages,
4059 including the listening daemon. It specifies that the accepting process should
4060 not automatically start a delivery process for each message received. Messages
4061 are placed on the queue, and remain there until a subsequent queue runner
4062 process encounters them. There are several configuration options (such as
4063 &%queue_only%&) that can be used to queue incoming messages under certain
4064 conditions. This option overrides all of them and also &%-odqs%&. It always
4069 .cindex "SMTP" "delaying delivery"
4070 This option is a hybrid between &%-odb%&/&%-odi%& and &%-odq%&.
4071 However, like &%-odb%& and &%-odi%&, this option has no effect if
4072 &%queue_only_override%& is false and one of the queueing options in the
4073 configuration file is in effect.
4075 When &%-odqs%& does operate, a delivery process is started for each incoming
4076 message, in the background by default, but in the foreground if &%-odi%& is
4077 also present. The recipient addresses are routed, and local deliveries are done
4078 in the normal way. However, if any SMTP deliveries are required, they are not
4079 done at this time, so the message remains on the queue until a subsequent queue
4080 runner process encounters it. Because routing was done, Exim knows which
4081 messages are waiting for which hosts, and so a number of messages for the same
4082 host can be sent in a single SMTP connection. The &%queue_smtp_domains%&
4083 configuration option has the same effect for specific domains. See also the
4088 .cindex "error" "reporting"
4089 If an error is detected while a non-SMTP message is being received (for
4090 example, a malformed address), the error is reported to the sender in a mail
4093 .cindex "return code" "for &%-oee%&"
4095 this error message is successfully sent, the Exim receiving process
4096 exits with a return code of zero. If not, the return code is 2 if the problem
4097 is that the original message has no recipients, or 1 any other error. This is
4098 the default &%-oe%&&'x'& option if Exim is called as &'rmail'&.
4102 .cindex "error" "reporting"
4103 .cindex "return code" "for &%-oem%&"
4104 This is the same as &%-oee%&, except that Exim always exits with a non-zero
4105 return code, whether or not the error message was successfully sent.
4106 This is the default &%-oe%&&'x'& option, unless Exim is called as &'rmail'&.
4110 .cindex "error" "reporting"
4111 If an error is detected while a non-SMTP message is being received, the
4112 error is reported by writing a message to the standard error file (stderr).
4113 .cindex "return code" "for &%-oep%&"
4114 The return code is 1 for all errors.
4118 .cindex "error" "reporting"
4119 This option is supported for compatibility with Sendmail, but has the same
4124 .cindex "error" "reporting"
4125 This option is supported for compatibility with Sendmail, but has the same
4130 .cindex "dot" "in incoming non-SMTP message"
4131 This option, which has the same effect as &%-i%&, specifies that a dot on a
4132 line by itself should not terminate an incoming, non-SMTP message. Otherwise, a
4133 single dot does terminate, though Exim does no special processing for other
4134 lines that start with a dot. This option is set by default if Exim is called as
4135 &'rmail'&. See also &%-ti%&.
4138 .oindex "&%-oitrue%&"
4139 This option is treated as synonymous with &%-oi%&.
4141 .vitem &%-oMa%&&~<&'host&~address'&>
4143 .cindex "sender" "host address, specifying for local message"
4144 A number of options starting with &%-oM%& can be used to set values associated
4145 with remote hosts on locally-submitted messages (that is, messages not received
4146 over TCP/IP). These options can be used by any caller in conjunction with the
4147 &%-bh%&, &%-be%&, &%-bf%&, &%-bF%&, &%-bt%&, or &%-bv%& testing options. In
4148 other circumstances, they are ignored unless the caller is trusted.
4150 The &%-oMa%& option sets the sender host address. This may include a port
4151 number at the end, after a full stop (period). For example:
4153 exim -bs -oMa 10.9.8.7.1234
4155 An alternative syntax is to enclose the IP address in square brackets,
4156 followed by a colon and the port number:
4158 exim -bs -oMa [10.9.8.7]:1234
4160 The IP address is placed in the &$sender_host_address$& variable, and the
4161 port, if present, in &$sender_host_port$&. If both &%-oMa%& and &%-bh%&
4162 are present on the command line, the sender host IP address is taken from
4163 whichever one is last.
4165 .vitem &%-oMaa%&&~<&'name'&>
4167 .cindex "authentication" "name, specifying for local message"
4168 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMaa%&
4169 option sets the value of &$sender_host_authenticated$& (the authenticator
4170 name). See chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for a discussion of SMTP authentication.
4171 This option can be used with &%-bh%& and &%-bs%& to set up an
4172 authenticated SMTP session without actually using the SMTP AUTH command.
4174 .vitem &%-oMai%&&~<&'string'&>
4176 .cindex "authentication" "id, specifying for local message"
4177 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMai%&
4178 option sets the value of &$authenticated_id$& (the id that was authenticated).
4179 This overrides the default value (the caller's login id, except with &%-bh%&,
4180 where there is no default) for messages from local sources. See chapter
4181 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for a discussion of authenticated ids.
4183 .vitem &%-oMas%&&~<&'address'&>
4185 .cindex "authentication" "sender, specifying for local message"
4186 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMas%&
4187 option sets the authenticated sender value in &$authenticated_sender$&. It
4188 overrides the sender address that is created from the caller's login id for
4189 messages from local sources, except when &%-bh%& is used, when there is no
4190 default. For both &%-bh%& and &%-bs%&, an authenticated sender that is
4191 specified on a MAIL command overrides this value. See chapter
4192 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for a discussion of authenticated senders.
4194 .vitem &%-oMi%&&~<&'interface&~address'&>
4196 .cindex "interface" "address, specifying for local message"
4197 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMi%&
4198 option sets the IP interface address value. A port number may be included,
4199 using the same syntax as for &%-oMa%&. The interface address is placed in
4200 &$received_ip_address$& and the port number, if present, in &$received_port$&.
4202 .vitem &%-oMr%&&~<&'protocol&~name'&>
4204 .cindex "protocol, specifying for local message"
4205 .vindex "&$received_protocol$&"
4206 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMr%&
4207 option sets the received protocol value that is stored in
4208 &$received_protocol$&. However, it does not apply (and is ignored) when &%-bh%&
4209 or &%-bs%& is used. For &%-bh%&, the protocol is forced to one of the standard
4210 SMTP protocol names (see the description of &$received_protocol$& in section
4211 &<<SECTexpvar>>&). For &%-bs%&, the protocol is always &"local-"& followed by
4212 one of those same names. For &%-bS%& (batched SMTP) however, the protocol can
4215 .vitem &%-oMs%&&~<&'host&~name'&>
4217 .cindex "sender" "host name, specifying for local message"
4218 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMs%&
4219 option sets the sender host name in &$sender_host_name$&. When this option is
4220 present, Exim does not attempt to look up a host name from an IP address; it
4221 uses the name it is given.
4223 .vitem &%-oMt%&&~<&'ident&~string'&>
4225 .cindex "sender" "ident string, specifying for local message"
4226 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMt%&
4227 option sets the sender ident value in &$sender_ident$&. The default setting for
4228 local callers is the login id of the calling process, except when &%-bh%& is
4229 used, when there is no default.
4233 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-om%& option ignored"
4234 In Sendmail, this option means &"me too"&, indicating that the sender of a
4235 message should receive a copy of the message if the sender appears in an alias
4236 expansion. Exim always does this, so the option does nothing.
4240 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-oo%& option ignored"
4241 This option is ignored. In Sendmail it specifies &"old style headers"&,
4242 whatever that means.
4244 .vitem &%-oP%&&~<&'path'&>
4246 .cindex "pid (process id)" "of daemon"
4247 .cindex "daemon" "process id (pid)"
4248 This option is useful only in conjunction with &%-bd%& or &%-q%& with a time
4249 value. The option specifies the file to which the process id of the daemon is
4250 written. When &%-oX%& is used with &%-bd%&, or when &%-q%& with a time is used
4251 without &%-bd%&, this is the only way of causing Exim to write a pid file,
4252 because in those cases, the normal pid file is not used.
4254 .vitem &%-or%&&~<&'time'&>
4256 .cindex "timeout" "for non-SMTP input"
4257 This option sets a timeout value for incoming non-SMTP messages. If it is not
4258 set, Exim will wait forever for the standard input. The value can also be set
4259 by the &%receive_timeout%& option. The format used for specifying times is
4260 described in section &<<SECTtimeformat>>&.
4262 .vitem &%-os%&&~<&'time'&>
4264 .cindex "timeout" "for SMTP input"
4265 .cindex "SMTP" "input timeout"
4266 This option sets a timeout value for incoming SMTP messages. The timeout
4267 applies to each SMTP command and block of data. The value can also be set by
4268 the &%smtp_receive_timeout%& option; it defaults to 5 minutes. The format used
4269 for specifying times is described in section &<<SECTtimeformat>>&.
4273 This option has exactly the same effect as &%-v%&.
4275 .vitem &%-oX%&&~<&'number&~or&~string'&>
4277 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening ports"
4278 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening interfaces"
4279 .cindex "port" "receiving TCP/IP"
4280 This option is relevant only when the &%-bd%& (start listening daemon) option
4281 is also given. It controls which ports and interfaces the daemon uses. Details
4282 of the syntax, and how it interacts with configuration file options, are given
4283 in chapter &<<CHAPinterfaces>>&. When &%-oX%& is used to start a daemon, no pid
4284 file is written unless &%-oP%& is also present to specify a pid file name.
4288 .cindex "Perl" "starting the interpreter"
4289 This option applies when an embedded Perl interpreter is linked with Exim (see
4290 chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&). It overrides the setting of the &%perl_at_start%&
4291 option, forcing the starting of the interpreter to be delayed until it is
4296 .cindex "Perl" "starting the interpreter"
4297 This option applies when an embedded Perl interpreter is linked with Exim (see
4298 chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&). It overrides the setting of the &%perl_at_start%&
4299 option, forcing the starting of the interpreter to occur as soon as Exim is
4302 .vitem &%-p%&<&'rval'&>:<&'sval'&>
4304 For compatibility with Sendmail, this option is equivalent to
4306 &`-oMr`& <&'rval'&> &`-oMs`& <&'sval'&>
4308 It sets the incoming protocol and host name (for trusted callers). The
4309 host name and its colon can be omitted when only the protocol is to be set.
4310 Note the Exim already has two private options, &%-pd%& and &%-ps%&, that refer
4311 to embedded Perl. It is therefore impossible to set a protocol value of &`p`&
4312 or &`s`& using this option (but that does not seem a real limitation).
4316 .cindex "queue runner" "starting manually"
4317 This option is normally restricted to admin users. However, there is a
4318 configuration option called &%prod_requires_admin%& which can be set false to
4319 relax this restriction (and also the same requirement for the &%-M%&, &%-R%&,
4320 and &%-S%& options).
4322 .cindex "queue runner" "description of operation"
4323 The &%-q%& option starts one queue runner process. This scans the queue of
4324 waiting messages, and runs a delivery process for each one in turn. It waits
4325 for each delivery process to finish before starting the next one. A delivery
4326 process may not actually do any deliveries if the retry times for the addresses
4327 have not been reached. Use &%-qf%& (see below) if you want to override this.
4330 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
4331 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
4332 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
4333 the delivery process spawns other processes to deliver other messages down
4334 passed SMTP connections, the queue runner waits for these to finish before
4337 When all the queued messages have been considered, the original queue runner
4338 process terminates. In other words, a single pass is made over the waiting
4339 mail, one message at a time. Use &%-q%& with a time (see below) if you want
4340 this to be repeated periodically.
4342 Exim processes the waiting messages in an unpredictable order. It isn't very
4343 random, but it is likely to be different each time, which is all that matters.
4344 If one particular message screws up a remote MTA, other messages to the same
4345 MTA have a chance of getting through if they get tried first.
4347 It is possible to cause the messages to be processed in lexical message id
4348 order, which is essentially the order in which they arrived, by setting the
4349 &%queue_run_in_order%& option, but this is not recommended for normal use.
4351 .vitem &%-q%&<&'qflags'&>
4352 The &%-q%& option may be followed by one or more flag letters that change its
4353 behaviour. They are all optional, but if more than one is present, they must
4354 appear in the correct order. Each flag is described in a separate item below.
4358 .cindex "queue" "double scanning"
4359 .cindex "queue" "routing"
4360 .cindex "routing" "whole queue before delivery"
4361 An option starting with &%-qq%& requests a two-stage queue run. In the first
4362 stage, the queue is scanned as if the &%queue_smtp_domains%& option matched
4363 every domain. Addresses are routed, local deliveries happen, but no remote
4366 .cindex "hints database" "remembering routing"
4367 The hints database that remembers which messages are waiting for specific hosts
4368 is updated, as if delivery to those hosts had been deferred. After this is
4369 complete, a second, normal queue scan happens, with routing and delivery taking
4370 place as normal. Messages that are routed to the same host should mostly be
4371 delivered down a single SMTP
4372 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
4373 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
4374 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
4375 connection because of the hints that were set up during the first queue scan.
4376 This option may be useful for hosts that are connected to the Internet
4379 .vitem &%-q[q]i...%&
4381 .cindex "queue" "initial delivery"
4382 If the &'i'& flag is present, the queue runner runs delivery processes only for
4383 those messages that haven't previously been tried. (&'i'& stands for &"initial
4384 delivery"&.) This can be helpful if you are putting messages on the queue using
4385 &%-odq%& and want a queue runner just to process the new messages.
4387 .vitem &%-q[q][i]f...%&
4389 .cindex "queue" "forcing delivery"
4390 .cindex "delivery" "forcing in queue run"
4391 If one &'f'& flag is present, a delivery attempt is forced for each non-frozen
4392 message, whereas without &'f'& only those non-frozen addresses that have passed
4393 their retry times are tried.
4395 .vitem &%-q[q][i]ff...%&
4397 .cindex "frozen messages" "forcing delivery"
4398 If &'ff'& is present, a delivery attempt is forced for every message, whether
4401 .vitem &%-q[q][i][f[f]]l%&
4403 .cindex "queue" "local deliveries only"
4404 The &'l'& (the letter &"ell"&) flag specifies that only local deliveries are to
4405 be done. If a message requires any remote deliveries, it remains on the queue
4408 .vitem &%-q%&<&'qflags'&>&~<&'start&~id'&>&~<&'end&~id'&>
4409 .cindex "queue" "delivering specific messages"
4410 When scanning the queue, Exim can be made to skip over messages whose ids are
4411 lexically less than a given value by following the &%-q%& option with a
4412 starting message id. For example:
4414 exim -q 0t5C6f-0000c8-00
4416 Messages that arrived earlier than &`0t5C6f-0000c8-00`& are not inspected. If a
4417 second message id is given, messages whose ids are lexically greater than it
4418 are also skipped. If the same id is given twice, for example,
4420 exim -q 0t5C6f-0000c8-00 0t5C6f-0000c8-00
4422 just one delivery process is started, for that message. This differs from
4423 &%-M%& in that retry data is respected, and it also differs from &%-Mc%& in
4424 that it counts as a delivery from a queue run. Note that the selection
4425 mechanism does not affect the order in which the messages are scanned. There
4426 are also other ways of selecting specific sets of messages for delivery in a
4427 queue run &-- see &%-R%& and &%-S%&.
4429 .vitem &%-q%&<&'qflags'&><&'time'&>
4430 .cindex "queue runner" "starting periodically"
4431 .cindex "periodic queue running"
4432 When a time value is present, the &%-q%& option causes Exim to run as a daemon,
4433 starting a queue runner process at intervals specified by the given time value
4434 (whose format is described in section &<<SECTtimeformat>>&). This form of the
4435 &%-q%& option is commonly combined with the &%-bd%& option, in which case a
4436 single daemon process handles both functions. A common way of starting up a
4437 combined daemon at system boot time is to use a command such as
4439 /usr/exim/bin/exim -bd -q30m
4441 Such a daemon listens for incoming SMTP calls, and also starts a queue runner
4442 process every 30 minutes.
4444 When a daemon is started by &%-q%& with a time value, but without &%-bd%&, no
4445 pid file is written unless one is explicitly requested by the &%-oP%& option.
4447 .vitem &%-qR%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4449 This option is synonymous with &%-R%&. It is provided for Sendmail
4452 .vitem &%-qS%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4454 This option is synonymous with &%-S%&.
4456 .vitem &%-R%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4458 .cindex "queue runner" "for specific recipients"
4459 .cindex "delivery" "to given domain"
4460 .cindex "domain" "delivery to"
4461 The <&'rsflags'&> may be empty, in which case the white space before the string
4462 is optional, unless the string is &'f'&, &'ff'&, &'r'&, &'rf'&, or &'rff'&,
4463 which are the possible values for <&'rsflags'&>. White space is required if
4464 <&'rsflags'&> is not empty.
4466 This option is similar to &%-q%& with no time value, that is, it causes Exim to
4467 perform a single queue run, except that, when scanning the messages on the
4468 queue, Exim processes only those that have at least one undelivered recipient
4469 address containing the given string, which is checked in a case-independent
4470 way. If the <&'rsflags'&> start with &'r'&, <&'string'&> is interpreted as a
4471 regular expression; otherwise it is a literal string.
4473 If you want to do periodic queue runs for messages with specific recipients,
4474 you can combine &%-R%& with &%-q%& and a time value. For example:
4476 exim -q25m -R @special.domain.example
4478 This example does a queue run for messages with recipients in the given domain
4479 every 25 minutes. Any additional flags that are specified with &%-q%& are
4480 applied to each queue run.
4482 Once a message is selected for delivery by this mechanism, all its addresses
4483 are processed. For the first selected message, Exim overrides any retry
4484 information and forces a delivery attempt for each undelivered address. This
4485 means that if delivery of any address in the first message is successful, any
4486 existing retry information is deleted, and so delivery attempts for that
4487 address in subsequently selected messages (which are processed without forcing)
4488 will run. However, if delivery of any address does not succeed, the retry
4489 information is updated, and in subsequently selected messages, the failing
4490 address will be skipped.
4492 .cindex "frozen messages" "forcing delivery"
4493 If the <&'rsflags'&> contain &'f'& or &'ff'&, the delivery forcing applies to
4494 all selected messages, not just the first; frozen messages are included when
4497 The &%-R%& option makes it straightforward to initiate delivery of all messages
4498 to a given domain after a host has been down for some time. When the SMTP
4499 command ETRN is accepted by its ACL (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&), its default
4500 effect is to run Exim with the &%-R%& option, but it can be configured to run
4501 an arbitrary command instead.
4505 This is a documented (for Sendmail) obsolete alternative name for &%-f%&.
4507 .vitem &%-S%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4509 .cindex "delivery" "from given sender"
4510 .cindex "queue runner" "for specific senders"
4511 This option acts like &%-R%& except that it checks the string against each
4512 message's sender instead of against the recipients. If &%-R%& is also set, both
4513 conditions must be met for a message to be selected. If either of the options
4514 has &'f'& or &'ff'& in its flags, the associated action is taken.
4516 .vitem &%-Tqt%&&~<&'times'&>
4518 This an option that is exclusively for use by the Exim testing suite. It is not
4519 recognized when Exim is run normally. It allows for the setting up of explicit
4520 &"queue times"& so that various warning/retry features can be tested.
4524 .cindex "recipient" "extracting from header lines"
4525 .cindex "&'Bcc:'& header line"
4526 .cindex "&'Cc:'& header line"
4527 .cindex "&'To:'& header line"
4528 When Exim is receiving a locally-generated, non-SMTP message on its standard
4529 input, the &%-t%& option causes the recipients of the message to be obtained
4530 from the &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&, and &'Bcc:'& header lines in the message instead of
4531 from the command arguments. The addresses are extracted before any rewriting
4532 takes place and the &'Bcc:'& header line, if present, is then removed.
4534 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-t%& option"
4535 If the command has any arguments, they specify addresses to which the message
4536 is &'not'& to be delivered. That is, the argument addresses are removed from
4537 the recipients list obtained from the headers. This is compatible with Smail 3
4538 and in accordance with the documented behaviour of several versions of
4539 Sendmail, as described in man pages on a number of operating systems (e.g.
4540 Solaris 8, IRIX 6.5, HP-UX 11). However, some versions of Sendmail &'add'&
4541 argument addresses to those obtained from the headers, and the O'Reilly
4542 Sendmail book documents it that way. Exim can be made to add argument addresses
4543 instead of subtracting them by setting the option
4544 &%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%& false.
4546 .cindex "&%Resent-%& header lines" "with &%-t%&"
4547 If there are any &%Resent-%& header lines in the message, Exim extracts
4548 recipients from all &'Resent-To:'&, &'Resent-Cc:'&, and &'Resent-Bcc:'& header
4549 lines instead of from &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&, and &'Bcc:'&. This is for compatibility
4550 with Sendmail and other MTAs. (Prior to release 4.20, Exim gave an error if
4551 &%-t%& was used in conjunction with &%Resent-%& header lines.)
4553 RFC 2822 talks about different sets of &%Resent-%& header lines (for when a
4554 message is resent several times). The RFC also specifies that they should be
4555 added at the front of the message, and separated by &'Received:'& lines. It is
4556 not at all clear how &%-t%& should operate in the present of multiple sets,
4557 nor indeed exactly what constitutes a &"set"&.
4558 In practice, it seems that MUAs do not follow the RFC. The &%Resent-%& lines
4559 are often added at the end of the header, and if a message is resent more than
4560 once, it is common for the original set of &%Resent-%& headers to be renamed as
4561 &%X-Resent-%& when a new set is added. This removes any possible ambiguity.
4565 This option is exactly equivalent to &%-t%& &%-i%&. It is provided for
4566 compatibility with Sendmail.
4568 .vitem &%-tls-on-connect%&
4569 .oindex "&%-tls-on-connect%&"
4570 .cindex "TLS" "use without STARTTLS"
4571 .cindex "TLS" "automatic start"
4572 This option is available when Exim is compiled with TLS support. It forces all
4573 incoming SMTP connections to behave as if the incoming port is listed in the
4574 &%tls_on_connect_ports%& option. See section &<<SECTsupobssmt>>& and chapter
4575 &<<CHAPTLS>>& for further details.
4580 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-U%& option ignored"
4581 Sendmail uses this option for &"initial message submission"&, and its
4582 documentation states that in future releases, it may complain about
4583 syntactically invalid messages rather than fixing them when this flag is not
4584 set. Exim ignores this option.
4588 This option causes Exim to write information to the standard error stream,
4589 describing what it is doing. In particular, it shows the log lines for
4590 receiving and delivering a message, and if an SMTP connection is made, the SMTP
4591 dialogue is shown. Some of the log lines shown may not actually be written to
4592 the log if the setting of &%log_selector%& discards them. Any relevant
4593 selectors are shown with each log line. If none are shown, the logging is
4598 AIX uses &%-x%& for a private purpose (&"mail from a local mail program has
4599 National Language Support extended characters in the body of the mail item"&).
4600 It sets &%-x%& when calling the MTA from its &%mail%& command. Exim ignores
4604 .vitem &%-X%&&~<&'logfile'&>
4606 This option is interpreted by Sendmail to cause debug information to be sent
4607 to the named file. It is ignored by Exim.
4615 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4616 . Insert a stylized DocBook comment here, to identify the end of the command
4617 . line options. This is for the benefit of the Perl script that automatically
4618 . creates a man page for the options.
4619 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4622 <!-- === End of command line options === -->
4629 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4630 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4633 .chapter "The Exim run time configuration file" "CHAPconf" &&&
4634 "The runtime configuration file"
4636 .cindex "run time configuration"
4637 .cindex "configuration file" "general description"
4638 .cindex "CONFIGURE_FILE"
4639 .cindex "configuration file" "errors in"
4640 .cindex "error" "in configuration file"
4641 .cindex "return code" "for bad configuration"
4642 Exim uses a single run time configuration file that is read whenever an Exim
4643 binary is executed. Note that in normal operation, this happens frequently,
4644 because Exim is designed to operate in a distributed manner, without central
4647 If a syntax error is detected while reading the configuration file, Exim
4648 writes a message on the standard error, and exits with a non-zero return code.
4649 The message is also written to the panic log. &*Note*&: Only simple syntax
4650 errors can be detected at this time. The values of any expanded options are
4651 not checked until the expansion happens, even when the expansion does not
4652 actually alter the string.
4654 The name of the configuration file is compiled into the binary for security
4655 reasons, and is specified by the CONFIGURE_FILE compilation option. In
4656 most configurations, this specifies a single file. However, it is permitted to
4657 give a colon-separated list of file names, in which case Exim uses the first
4658 existing file in the list.
4661 .cindex "EXIM_GROUP"
4662 .cindex "CONFIGURE_OWNER"
4663 .cindex "CONFIGURE_GROUP"
4664 .cindex "configuration file" "ownership"
4665 .cindex "ownership" "configuration file"
4666 The run time configuration file must be owned by root or by the user that is
4667 specified at compile time by the CONFIGURE_OWNER option (if set). The
4668 configuration file must not be world-writeable, or group-writeable unless its
4669 group is the root group or the one specified at compile time by the
4670 CONFIGURE_GROUP option.
4672 &*Warning*&: In a conventional configuration, where the Exim binary is setuid
4673 to root, anybody who is able to edit the run time configuration file has an
4674 easy way to run commands as root. If you specify a user or group in the
4675 CONFIGURE_OWNER or CONFIGURE_GROUP options, then that user and/or any users
4676 who are members of that group will trivially be able to obtain root privileges.
4678 Up to Exim version 4.72, the run time configuration file was also permitted to
4679 be writeable by the Exim user and/or group. That has been changed in Exim 4.73
4680 since it offered a simple privilege escalation for any attacker who managed to
4681 compromise the Exim user account.
4683 A default configuration file, which will work correctly in simple situations,
4684 is provided in the file &_src/configure.default_&. If CONFIGURE_FILE
4685 defines just one file name, the installation process copies the default
4686 configuration to a new file of that name if it did not previously exist. If
4687 CONFIGURE_FILE is a list, no default is automatically installed. Chapter
4688 &<<CHAPdefconfil>>& is a &"walk-through"& discussion of the default
4693 .section "Using a different configuration file" "SECID40"
4694 .cindex "configuration file" "alternate"
4695 A one-off alternate configuration can be specified by the &%-C%& command line
4696 option, which may specify a single file or a list of files. However, when
4697 &%-C%& is used, Exim gives up its root privilege, unless called by root (or
4698 unless the argument for &%-C%& is identical to the built-in value from
4699 CONFIGURE_FILE), or is listed in the TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST file and the caller
4700 is the Exim user or the user specified in the CONFIGURE_OWNER setting. &%-C%&
4701 is useful mainly for checking the syntax of configuration files before
4702 installing them. No owner or group checks are done on a configuration file
4703 specified by &%-C%&, if root privilege has been dropped.
4705 Even the Exim user is not trusted to specify an arbitrary configuration file
4706 with the &%-C%& option to be used with root privileges, unless that file is
4707 listed in the TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST file. This locks out the possibility of
4708 testing a configuration using &%-C%& right through message reception and
4709 delivery, even if the caller is root. The reception works, but by that time,
4710 Exim is running as the Exim user, so when it re-execs to regain privilege for
4711 the delivery, the use of &%-C%& causes privilege to be lost. However, root
4712 can test reception and delivery using two separate commands (one to put a
4713 message on the queue, using &%-odq%&, and another to do the delivery, using
4716 If ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX is defined &_in Local/Makefile_&, it specifies a
4717 prefix string with which any file named in a &%-C%& command line option must
4718 start. In addition, the file name must not contain the sequence &"&`/../`&"&.
4719 There is no default setting for ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX; when it is unset, any file
4720 name can be used with &%-C%&.
4722 One-off changes to a configuration can be specified by the &%-D%& command line
4723 option, which defines and overrides values for macros used inside the
4724 configuration file. However, like &%-C%&, the use of this option by a
4725 non-privileged user causes Exim to discard its root privilege.
4726 If DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, the use of &%-D%& is
4727 completely disabled, and its use causes an immediate error exit.
4729 The WHITELIST_D_MACROS option in &_Local/Makefile_& permits the binary builder
4730 to declare certain macro names trusted, such that root privilege will not
4731 necessarily be discarded.
4732 WHITELIST_D_MACROS defines a colon-separated list of macros which are
4733 considered safe and, if &%-D%& only supplies macros from this list, and the
4734 values are acceptable, then Exim will not give up root privilege if the caller
4735 is root, the Exim run-time user, or the CONFIGURE_OWNER, if set. This is a
4736 transition mechanism and is expected to be removed in the future. Acceptable
4737 values for the macros satisfy the regexp: &`^[A-Za-z0-9_/.-]*$`&
4739 Some sites may wish to use the same Exim binary on different machines that
4740 share a file system, but to use different configuration files on each machine.
4741 If CONFIGURE_FILE_USE_NODE is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, Exim first
4742 looks for a file whose name is the configuration file name followed by a dot
4743 and the machine's node name, as obtained from the &[uname()]& function. If this
4744 file does not exist, the standard name is tried. This processing occurs for
4745 each file name in the list given by CONFIGURE_FILE or &%-C%&.
4747 In some esoteric situations different versions of Exim may be run under
4748 different effective uids and the CONFIGURE_FILE_USE_EUID is defined to
4749 help with this. See the comments in &_src/EDITME_& for details.
4753 .section "Configuration file format" "SECTconffilfor"
4754 .cindex "configuration file" "format of"
4755 .cindex "format" "configuration file"
4756 Exim's configuration file is divided into a number of different parts. General
4757 option settings must always appear at the start of the file. The other parts
4758 are all optional, and may appear in any order. Each part other than the first
4759 is introduced by the word &"begin"& followed by the name of the part. The
4763 &'ACL'&: Access control lists for controlling incoming SMTP mail (see chapter
4766 .cindex "AUTH" "configuration"
4767 &'authenticators'&: Configuration settings for the authenticator drivers. These
4768 are concerned with the SMTP AUTH command (see chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&).
4770 &'routers'&: Configuration settings for the router drivers. Routers process
4771 addresses and determine how the message is to be delivered (see chapters
4772 &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&&--&<<CHAPredirect>>&).
4774 &'transports'&: Configuration settings for the transport drivers. Transports
4775 define mechanisms for copying messages to destinations (see chapters
4776 &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&&--&<<CHAPsmtptrans>>&).
4778 &'retry'&: Retry rules, for use when a message cannot be delivered immediately.
4779 If there is no retry section, or if it is empty (that is, no retry rules are
4780 defined), Exim will not retry deliveries. In this situation, temporary errors
4781 are treated the same as permanent errors. Retry rules are discussed in chapter
4784 &'rewrite'&: Global address rewriting rules, for use when a message arrives and
4785 when new addresses are generated during delivery. Rewriting is discussed in
4786 chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&.
4788 &'local_scan'&: Private options for the &[local_scan()]& function. If you
4789 want to use this feature, you must set
4791 LOCAL_SCAN_HAS_OPTIONS=yes
4793 in &_Local/Makefile_& before building Exim. Details of the &[local_scan()]&
4794 facility are given in chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&.
4797 .cindex "configuration file" "leading white space in"
4798 .cindex "configuration file" "trailing white space in"
4799 .cindex "white space" "in configuration file"
4800 Leading and trailing white space in configuration lines is always ignored.
4802 Blank lines in the file, and lines starting with a # character (ignoring
4803 leading white space) are treated as comments and are ignored. &*Note*&: A
4804 # character other than at the beginning of a line is not treated specially,
4805 and does not introduce a comment.
4807 Any non-comment line can be continued by ending it with a backslash. Note that
4808 the general rule for white space means that trailing white space after the
4809 backslash and leading white space at the start of continuation
4810 lines is ignored. Comment lines beginning with # (but not empty lines) may
4811 appear in the middle of a sequence of continuation lines.
4813 A convenient way to create a configuration file is to start from the
4814 default, which is supplied in &_src/configure.default_&, and add, delete, or
4815 change settings as required.
4817 The ACLs, retry rules, and rewriting rules have their own syntax which is
4818 described in chapters &<<CHAPACL>>&, &<<CHAPretry>>&, and &<<CHAPrewrite>>&,
4819 respectively. The other parts of the configuration file have some syntactic
4820 items in common, and these are described below, from section &<<SECTcos>>&
4821 onwards. Before that, the inclusion, macro, and conditional facilities are
4826 .section "File inclusions in the configuration file" "SECID41"
4827 .cindex "inclusions in configuration file"
4828 .cindex "configuration file" "including other files"
4829 .cindex "&`.include`& in configuration file"
4830 .cindex "&`.include_if_exists`& in configuration file"
4831 You can include other files inside Exim's run time configuration file by
4834 &`.include`& <&'file name'&>
4835 &`.include_if_exists`& <&'file name'&>
4837 on a line by itself. Double quotes round the file name are optional. If you use
4838 the first form, a configuration error occurs if the file does not exist; the
4839 second form does nothing for non-existent files. In all cases, an absolute file
4842 Includes may be nested to any depth, but remember that Exim reads its
4843 configuration file often, so it is a good idea to keep them to a minimum.
4844 If you change the contents of an included file, you must HUP the daemon,
4845 because an included file is read only when the configuration itself is read.
4847 The processing of inclusions happens early, at a physical line level, so, like
4848 comment lines, an inclusion can be used in the middle of an option setting,
4851 hosts_lookup = a.b.c \
4854 Include processing happens after macro processing (see below). Its effect is to
4855 process the lines of the included file as if they occurred inline where the
4860 .section "Macros in the configuration file" "SECTmacrodefs"
4861 .cindex "macro" "description of"
4862 .cindex "configuration file" "macros"
4863 If a line in the main part of the configuration (that is, before the first
4864 &"begin"& line) begins with an upper case letter, it is taken as a macro
4865 definition, and must be of the form
4867 <&'name'&> = <&'rest of line'&>
4869 The name must consist of letters, digits, and underscores, and need not all be
4870 in upper case, though that is recommended. The rest of the line, including any
4871 continuations, is the replacement text, and has leading and trailing white
4872 space removed. Quotes are not removed. The replacement text can never end with
4873 a backslash character, but this doesn't seem to be a serious limitation.
4875 Macros may also be defined between router, transport, authenticator, or ACL
4876 definitions. They may not, however, be defined within an individual driver or
4877 ACL, or in the &%local_scan%&, retry, or rewrite sections of the configuration.
4879 .section "Macro substitution" "SECID42"
4880 Once a macro is defined, all subsequent lines in the file (and any included
4881 files) are scanned for the macro name; if there are several macros, the line is
4882 scanned for each in turn, in the order in which the macros are defined. The
4883 replacement text is not re-scanned for the current macro, though it is scanned
4884 for subsequently defined macros. For this reason, a macro name may not contain
4885 the name of a previously defined macro as a substring. You could, for example,
4888 &`ABCD_XYZ = `&<&'something'&>
4889 &`ABCD = `&<&'something else'&>
4891 but putting the definitions in the opposite order would provoke a configuration
4892 error. Macro expansion is applied to individual physical lines from the file,
4893 before checking for line continuation or file inclusion (see above). If a line
4894 consists solely of a macro name, and the expansion of the macro is empty, the
4895 line is ignored. A macro at the start of a line may turn the line into a
4896 comment line or a &`.include`& line.
4899 .section "Redefining macros" "SECID43"
4900 Once defined, the value of a macro can be redefined later in the configuration
4901 (or in an included file). Redefinition is specified by using &'=='& instead of
4906 MAC == updated value
4908 Redefinition does not alter the order in which the macros are applied to the
4909 subsequent lines of the configuration file. It is still the same order in which
4910 the macros were originally defined. All that changes is the macro's value.
4911 Redefinition makes it possible to accumulate values. For example:
4915 MAC == MAC and something added
4917 This can be helpful in situations where the configuration file is built
4918 from a number of other files.
4920 .section "Overriding macro values" "SECID44"
4921 The values set for macros in the configuration file can be overridden by the
4922 &%-D%& command line option, but Exim gives up its root privilege when &%-D%& is
4923 used, unless called by root or the Exim user. A definition on the command line
4924 using the &%-D%& option causes all definitions and redefinitions within the
4929 .section "Example of macro usage" "SECID45"
4930 As an example of macro usage, consider a configuration where aliases are looked
4931 up in a MySQL database. It helps to keep the file less cluttered if long
4932 strings such as SQL statements are defined separately as macros, for example:
4934 ALIAS_QUERY = select mailbox from user where \
4935 login='${quote_mysql:$local_part}';
4937 This can then be used in a &(redirect)& router setting like this:
4939 data = ${lookup mysql{ALIAS_QUERY}}
4941 In earlier versions of Exim macros were sometimes used for domain, host, or
4942 address lists. In Exim 4 these are handled better by named lists &-- see
4943 section &<<SECTnamedlists>>&.
4946 .section "Conditional skips in the configuration file" "SECID46"
4947 .cindex "configuration file" "conditional skips"
4948 .cindex "&`.ifdef`&"
4949 You can use the directives &`.ifdef`&, &`.ifndef`&, &`.elifdef`&,
4950 &`.elifndef`&, &`.else`&, and &`.endif`& to dynamically include or exclude
4951 portions of the configuration file. The processing happens whenever the file is
4952 read (that is, when an Exim binary starts to run).
4954 The implementation is very simple. Instances of the first four directives must
4955 be followed by text that includes the names of one or macros. The condition
4956 that is tested is whether or not any macro substitution has taken place in the
4960 message_size_limit = 50M
4962 message_size_limit = 100M
4965 sets a message size limit of 50M if the macro &`AAA`& is defined, and 100M
4966 otherwise. If there is more than one macro named on the line, the condition
4967 is true if any of them are defined. That is, it is an &"or"& condition. To
4968 obtain an &"and"& condition, you need to use nested &`.ifdef`&s.
4970 Although you can use a macro expansion to generate one of these directives,
4971 it is not very useful, because the condition &"there was a macro substitution
4972 in this line"& will always be true.
4974 Text following &`.else`& and &`.endif`& is ignored, and can be used as comment
4975 to clarify complicated nestings.
4979 .section "Common option syntax" "SECTcos"
4980 .cindex "common option syntax"
4981 .cindex "syntax of common options"
4982 .cindex "configuration file" "common option syntax"
4983 For the main set of options, driver options, and &[local_scan()]& options,
4984 each setting is on a line by itself, and starts with a name consisting of
4985 lower-case letters and underscores. Many options require a data value, and in
4986 these cases the name must be followed by an equals sign (with optional white
4987 space) and then the value. For example:
4989 qualify_domain = mydomain.example.com
4991 .cindex "hiding configuration option values"
4992 .cindex "configuration options" "hiding value of"
4993 .cindex "options" "hiding value of"
4994 Some option settings may contain sensitive data, for example, passwords for
4995 accessing databases. To stop non-admin users from using the &%-bP%& command
4996 line option to read these values, you can precede the option settings with the
4997 word &"hide"&. For example:
4999 hide mysql_servers = localhost/users/admin/secret-password
5001 For non-admin users, such options are displayed like this:
5003 mysql_servers = <value not displayable>
5005 If &"hide"& is used on a driver option, it hides the value of that option on
5006 all instances of the same driver.
5008 The following sections describe the syntax used for the different data types
5009 that are found in option settings.
5012 .section "Boolean options" "SECID47"
5013 .cindex "format" "boolean"
5014 .cindex "boolean configuration values"
5015 .oindex "&%no_%&&'xxx'&"
5016 .oindex "&%not_%&&'xxx'&"
5017 Options whose type is given as boolean are on/off switches. There are two
5018 different ways of specifying such options: with and without a data value. If
5019 the option name is specified on its own without data, the switch is turned on;
5020 if it is preceded by &"no_"& or &"not_"& the switch is turned off. However,
5021 boolean options may be followed by an equals sign and one of the words
5022 &"true"&, &"false"&, &"yes"&, or &"no"&, as an alternative syntax. For example,
5023 the following two settings have exactly the same effect:
5028 The following two lines also have the same (opposite) effect:
5033 You can use whichever syntax you prefer.
5038 .section "Integer values" "SECID48"
5039 .cindex "integer configuration values"
5040 .cindex "format" "integer"
5041 If an option's type is given as &"integer"&, the value can be given in decimal,
5042 hexadecimal, or octal. If it starts with a digit greater than zero, a decimal
5043 number is assumed. Otherwise, it is treated as an octal number unless it starts
5044 with the characters &"0x"&, in which case the remainder is interpreted as a
5047 If an integer value is followed by the letter K, it is multiplied by 1024; if
5048 it is followed by the letter M, it is multiplied by 1024x1024. When the values
5049 of integer option settings are output, values which are an exact multiple of
5050 1024 or 1024x1024 are sometimes, but not always, printed using the letters K
5051 and M. The printing style is independent of the actual input format that was
5055 .section "Octal integer values" "SECID49"
5056 .cindex "integer format"
5057 .cindex "format" "octal integer"
5058 If an option's type is given as &"octal integer"&, its value is always
5059 interpreted as an octal number, whether or not it starts with the digit zero.
5060 Such options are always output in octal.
5063 .section "Fixed point numbers" "SECID50"
5064 .cindex "fixed point configuration values"
5065 .cindex "format" "fixed point"
5066 If an option's type is given as &"fixed-point"&, its value must be a decimal
5067 integer, optionally followed by a decimal point and up to three further digits.
5071 .section "Time intervals" "SECTtimeformat"
5072 .cindex "time interval" "specifying in configuration"
5073 .cindex "format" "time interval"
5074 A time interval is specified as a sequence of numbers, each followed by one of
5075 the following letters, with no intervening white space:
5085 For example, &"3h50m"& specifies 3 hours and 50 minutes. The values of time
5086 intervals are output in the same format. Exim does not restrict the values; it
5087 is perfectly acceptable, for example, to specify &"90m"& instead of &"1h30m"&.
5091 .section "String values" "SECTstrings"
5092 .cindex "string" "format of configuration values"
5093 .cindex "format" "string"
5094 If an option's type is specified as &"string"&, the value can be specified with
5095 or without double-quotes. If it does not start with a double-quote, the value
5096 consists of the remainder of the line plus any continuation lines, starting at
5097 the first character after any leading white space, with trailing white space
5098 removed, and with no interpretation of the characters in the string. Because
5099 Exim removes comment lines (those beginning with #) at an early stage, they can
5100 appear in the middle of a multi-line string. The following two settings are
5101 therefore equivalent:
5103 trusted_users = uucp:mail
5104 trusted_users = uucp:\
5105 # This comment line is ignored
5108 .cindex "string" "quoted"
5109 .cindex "escape characters in quoted strings"
5110 If a string does start with a double-quote, it must end with a closing
5111 double-quote, and any backslash characters other than those used for line
5112 continuation are interpreted as escape characters, as follows:
5115 .irow &`\\`& "single backslash"
5116 .irow &`\n`& "newline"
5117 .irow &`\r`& "carriage return"
5119 .irow "&`\`&<&'octal digits'&>" "up to 3 octal digits specify one character"
5120 .irow "&`\x`&<&'hex digits'&>" "up to 2 hexadecimal digits specify one &&&
5124 If a backslash is followed by some other character, including a double-quote
5125 character, that character replaces the pair.
5127 Quoting is necessary only if you want to make use of the backslash escapes to
5128 insert special characters, or if you need to specify a value with leading or
5129 trailing spaces. These cases are rare, so quoting is almost never needed in
5130 current versions of Exim. In versions of Exim before 3.14, quoting was required
5131 in order to continue lines, so you may come across older configuration files
5132 and examples that apparently quote unnecessarily.
5135 .section "Expanded strings" "SECID51"
5136 .cindex "expansion" "definition of"
5137 Some strings in the configuration file are subjected to &'string expansion'&,
5138 by which means various parts of the string may be changed according to the
5139 circumstances (see chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&). The input syntax for such strings
5140 is as just described; in particular, the handling of backslashes in quoted
5141 strings is done as part of the input process, before expansion takes place.
5142 However, backslash is also an escape character for the expander, so any
5143 backslashes that are required for that reason must be doubled if they are
5144 within a quoted configuration string.
5147 .section "User and group names" "SECID52"
5148 .cindex "user name" "format of"
5149 .cindex "format" "user name"
5150 .cindex "groups" "name format"
5151 .cindex "format" "group name"
5152 User and group names are specified as strings, using the syntax described
5153 above, but the strings are interpreted specially. A user or group name must
5154 either consist entirely of digits, or be a name that can be looked up using the
5155 &[getpwnam()]& or &[getgrnam()]& function, as appropriate.
5158 .section "List construction" "SECTlistconstruct"
5159 .cindex "list" "syntax of in configuration"
5160 .cindex "format" "list item in configuration"
5161 .cindex "string" "list, definition of"
5162 The data for some configuration options is a list of items, with colon as the
5163 default separator. Many of these options are shown with type &"string list"& in
5164 the descriptions later in this document. Others are listed as &"domain list"&,
5165 &"host list"&, &"address list"&, or &"local part list"&. Syntactically, they
5166 are all the same; however, those other than &"string list"& are subject to
5167 particular kinds of interpretation, as described in chapter
5168 &<<CHAPdomhosaddlists>>&.
5170 In all these cases, the entire list is treated as a single string as far as the
5171 input syntax is concerned. The &%trusted_users%& setting in section
5172 &<<SECTstrings>>& above is an example. If a colon is actually needed in an item
5173 in a list, it must be entered as two colons. Leading and trailing white space
5174 on each item in a list is ignored. This makes it possible to include items that
5175 start with a colon, and in particular, certain forms of IPv6 address. For
5178 local_interfaces = 127.0.0.1 : ::::1
5180 contains two IP addresses, the IPv4 address 127.0.0.1 and the IPv6 address ::1.
5182 &*Note*&: Although leading and trailing white space is ignored in individual
5183 list items, it is not ignored when parsing the list. The space after the first
5184 colon in the example above is necessary. If it were not there, the list would
5185 be interpreted as the two items 127.0.0.1:: and 1.
5187 .section "Changing list separators" "SECID53"
5188 .cindex "list separator" "changing"
5189 .cindex "IPv6" "addresses in lists"
5190 Doubling colons in IPv6 addresses is an unwelcome chore, so a mechanism was
5191 introduced to allow the separator character to be changed. If a list begins
5192 with a left angle bracket, followed by any punctuation character, that
5193 character is used instead of colon as the list separator. For example, the list
5194 above can be rewritten to use a semicolon separator like this:
5196 local_interfaces = <; 127.0.0.1 ; ::1
5198 This facility applies to all lists, with the exception of the list in
5199 &%log_file_path%&. It is recommended that the use of non-colon separators be
5200 confined to circumstances where they really are needed.
5202 .cindex "list separator" "newline as"
5203 .cindex "newline" "as list separator"
5204 It is also possible to use newline and other control characters (those with
5205 code values less than 32, plus DEL) as separators in lists. Such separators
5206 must be provided literally at the time the list is processed. For options that
5207 are string-expanded, you can write the separator using a normal escape
5208 sequence. This will be processed by the expander before the string is
5209 interpreted as a list. For example, if a newline-separated list of domains is
5210 generated by a lookup, you can process it directly by a line such as this:
5212 domains = <\n ${lookup mysql{.....}}
5214 This avoids having to change the list separator in such data. You are unlikely
5215 to want to use a control character as a separator in an option that is not
5216 expanded, because the value is literal text. However, it can be done by giving
5217 the value in quotes. For example:
5219 local_interfaces = "<\n 127.0.0.1 \n ::1"
5221 Unlike printing character separators, which can be included in list items by
5222 doubling, it is not possible to include a control character as data when it is
5223 set as the separator. Two such characters in succession are interpreted as
5224 enclosing an empty list item.
5228 .section "Empty items in lists" "SECTempitelis"
5229 .cindex "list" "empty item in"
5230 An empty item at the end of a list is always ignored. In other words, trailing
5231 separator characters are ignored. Thus, the list in
5233 senders = user@domain :
5235 contains only a single item. If you want to include an empty string as one item
5236 in a list, it must not be the last item. For example, this list contains three
5237 items, the second of which is empty:
5239 senders = user1@domain : : user2@domain
5241 &*Note*&: There must be white space between the two colons, as otherwise they
5242 are interpreted as representing a single colon data character (and the list
5243 would then contain just one item). If you want to specify a list that contains
5244 just one, empty item, you can do it as in this example:
5248 In this case, the first item is empty, and the second is discarded because it
5249 is at the end of the list.
5254 .section "Format of driver configurations" "SECTfordricon"
5255 .cindex "drivers" "configuration format"
5256 There are separate parts in the configuration for defining routers, transports,
5257 and authenticators. In each part, you are defining a number of driver
5258 instances, each with its own set of options. Each driver instance is defined by
5259 a sequence of lines like this:
5261 <&'instance name'&>:
5266 In the following example, the instance name is &(localuser)&, and it is
5267 followed by three options settings:
5272 transport = local_delivery
5274 For each driver instance, you specify which Exim code module it uses &-- by the
5275 setting of the &%driver%& option &-- and (optionally) some configuration
5276 settings. For example, in the case of transports, if you want a transport to
5277 deliver with SMTP you would use the &(smtp)& driver; if you want to deliver to
5278 a local file you would use the &(appendfile)& driver. Each of the drivers is
5279 described in detail in its own separate chapter later in this manual.
5281 You can have several routers, transports, or authenticators that are based on
5282 the same underlying driver (each must have a different instance name).
5284 The order in which routers are defined is important, because addresses are
5285 passed to individual routers one by one, in order. The order in which
5286 transports are defined does not matter at all. The order in which
5287 authenticators are defined is used only when Exim, as a client, is searching
5288 them to find one that matches an authentication mechanism offered by the
5291 .cindex "generic options"
5292 .cindex "options" "generic &-- definition of"
5293 Within a driver instance definition, there are two kinds of option: &'generic'&
5294 and &'private'&. The generic options are those that apply to all drivers of the
5295 same type (that is, all routers, all transports or all authenticators). The
5296 &%driver%& option is a generic option that must appear in every definition.
5297 .cindex "private options"
5298 The private options are special for each driver, and none need appear, because
5299 they all have default values.
5301 The options may appear in any order, except that the &%driver%& option must
5302 precede any private options, since these depend on the particular driver. For
5303 this reason, it is recommended that &%driver%& always be the first option.
5305 Driver instance names, which are used for reference in log entries and
5306 elsewhere, can be any sequence of letters, digits, and underscores (starting
5307 with a letter) and must be unique among drivers of the same type. A router and
5308 a transport (for example) can each have the same name, but no two router
5309 instances can have the same name. The name of a driver instance should not be
5310 confused with the name of the underlying driver module. For example, the
5311 configuration lines:
5316 create an instance of the &(smtp)& transport driver whose name is
5317 &(remote_smtp)&. The same driver code can be used more than once, with
5318 different instance names and different option settings each time. A second
5319 instance of the &(smtp)& transport, with different options, might be defined
5325 command_timeout = 10s
5327 The names &(remote_smtp)& and &(special_smtp)& would be used to reference
5328 these transport instances from routers, and these names would appear in log
5331 Comment lines may be present in the middle of driver specifications. The full
5332 list of option settings for any particular driver instance, including all the
5333 defaulted values, can be extracted by making use of the &%-bP%& command line
5341 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
5342 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
5344 .chapter "The default configuration file" "CHAPdefconfil"
5345 .scindex IIDconfiwal "configuration file" "default &""walk through""&"
5346 .cindex "default" "configuration file &""walk through""&"
5347 The default configuration file supplied with Exim as &_src/configure.default_&
5348 is sufficient for a host with simple mail requirements. As an introduction to
5349 the way Exim is configured, this chapter &"walks through"& the default
5350 configuration, giving brief explanations of the settings. Detailed descriptions
5351 of the options are given in subsequent chapters. The default configuration file
5352 itself contains extensive comments about ways you might want to modify the
5353 initial settings. However, note that there are many options that are not
5354 mentioned at all in the default configuration.
5358 .section "Main configuration settings" "SECTdefconfmain"
5359 The main (global) configuration option settings must always come first in the
5360 file. The first thing you'll see in the file, after some initial comments, is
5363 # primary_hostname =
5365 This is a commented-out setting of the &%primary_hostname%& option. Exim needs
5366 to know the official, fully qualified name of your host, and this is where you
5367 can specify it. However, in most cases you do not need to set this option. When
5368 it is unset, Exim uses the &[uname()]& system function to obtain the host name.
5370 The first three non-comment configuration lines are as follows:
5372 domainlist local_domains = @
5373 domainlist relay_to_domains =
5374 hostlist relay_from_hosts = 127.0.0.1
5376 These are not, in fact, option settings. They are definitions of two named
5377 domain lists and one named host list. Exim allows you to give names to lists of
5378 domains, hosts, and email addresses, in order to make it easier to manage the
5379 configuration file (see section &<<SECTnamedlists>>&).
5381 The first line defines a domain list called &'local_domains'&; this is used
5382 later in the configuration to identify domains that are to be delivered
5385 .cindex "@ in a domain list"
5386 There is just one item in this list, the string &"@"&. This is a special form
5387 of entry which means &"the name of the local host"&. Thus, if the local host is
5388 called &'a.host.example'&, mail to &'any.user@a.host.example'& is expected to
5389 be delivered locally. Because the local host's name is referenced indirectly,
5390 the same configuration file can be used on different hosts.
5392 The second line defines a domain list called &'relay_to_domains'&, but the
5393 list itself is empty. Later in the configuration we will come to the part that
5394 controls mail relaying through the local host; it allows relaying to any
5395 domains in this list. By default, therefore, no relaying on the basis of a mail
5396 domain is permitted.
5398 The third line defines a host list called &'relay_from_hosts'&. This list is
5399 used later in the configuration to permit relaying from any host or IP address
5400 that matches the list. The default contains just the IP address of the IPv4
5401 loopback interface, which means that processes on the local host are able to
5402 submit mail for relaying by sending it over TCP/IP to that interface. No other
5403 hosts are permitted to submit messages for relaying.
5405 Just to be sure there's no misunderstanding: at this point in the configuration
5406 we aren't actually setting up any controls. We are just defining some domains
5407 and hosts that will be used in the controls that are specified later.
5409 The next two configuration lines are genuine option settings:
5411 acl_smtp_rcpt = acl_check_rcpt
5412 acl_smtp_data = acl_check_data
5414 These options specify &'Access Control Lists'& (ACLs) that are to be used
5415 during an incoming SMTP session for every recipient of a message (every RCPT
5416 command), and after the contents of the message have been received,
5417 respectively. The names of the lists are &'acl_check_rcpt'& and
5418 &'acl_check_data'&, and we will come to their definitions below, in the ACL
5419 section of the configuration. The RCPT ACL controls which recipients are
5420 accepted for an incoming message &-- if a configuration does not provide an ACL
5421 to check recipients, no SMTP mail can be accepted. The DATA ACL allows the
5422 contents of a message to be checked.
5424 Two commented-out option settings are next:
5426 # av_scanner = clamd:/tmp/clamd
5427 # spamd_address = 127.0.0.1 783
5429 These are example settings that can be used when Exim is compiled with the
5430 content-scanning extension. The first specifies the interface to the virus
5431 scanner, and the second specifies the interface to SpamAssassin. Further
5432 details are given in chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
5434 Three more commented-out option settings follow:
5436 # tls_advertise_hosts = *
5437 # tls_certificate = /etc/ssl/exim.crt
5438 # tls_privatekey = /etc/ssl/exim.pem
5440 These are example settings that can be used when Exim is compiled with
5441 support for TLS (aka SSL) as described in section &<<SECTinctlsssl>>&. The
5442 first one specifies the list of clients that are allowed to use TLS when
5443 connecting to this server; in this case the wildcard means all clients. The
5444 other options specify where Exim should find its TLS certificate and private
5445 key, which together prove the server's identity to any clients that connect.
5446 More details are given in chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&.
5448 Another two commented-out option settings follow:
5450 # daemon_smtp_ports = 25 : 465 : 587
5451 # tls_on_connect_ports = 465
5453 .cindex "port" "465 and 587"
5454 .cindex "port" "for message submission"
5455 .cindex "message" "submission, ports for"
5456 .cindex "ssmtp protocol"
5457 .cindex "smtps protocol"
5458 .cindex "SMTP" "ssmtp protocol"
5459 .cindex "SMTP" "smtps protocol"
5460 These options provide better support for roaming users who wish to use this
5461 server for message submission. They are not much use unless you have turned on
5462 TLS (as described in the previous paragraph) and authentication (about which
5463 more in section &<<SECTdefconfauth>>&). The usual SMTP port 25 is often blocked
5464 on end-user networks, so RFC 4409 specifies that message submission should use
5465 port 587 instead. However some software (notably Microsoft Outlook) cannot be
5466 configured to use port 587 correctly, so these settings also enable the
5467 non-standard &"smtps"& (aka &"ssmtp"&) port 465 (see section
5468 &<<SECTsupobssmt>>&).
5470 Two more commented-out options settings follow:
5473 # qualify_recipient =
5475 The first of these specifies a domain that Exim uses when it constructs a
5476 complete email address from a local login name. This is often needed when Exim
5477 receives a message from a local process. If you do not set &%qualify_domain%&,
5478 the value of &%primary_hostname%& is used. If you set both of these options,
5479 you can have different qualification domains for sender and recipient
5480 addresses. If you set only the first one, its value is used in both cases.
5482 .cindex "domain literal" "recognizing format"
5483 The following line must be uncommented if you want Exim to recognize
5484 addresses of the form &'user@[10.11.12.13]'& that is, with a &"domain literal"&
5485 (an IP address within square brackets) instead of a named domain.
5487 # allow_domain_literals
5489 The RFCs still require this form, but many people think that in the modern
5490 Internet it makes little sense to permit mail to be sent to specific hosts by
5491 quoting their IP addresses. This ancient format has been used by people who
5492 try to abuse hosts by using them for unwanted relaying. However, some
5493 people believe there are circumstances (for example, messages addressed to
5494 &'postmaster'&) where domain literals are still useful.
5496 The next configuration line is a kind of trigger guard:
5500 It specifies that no delivery must ever be run as the root user. The normal
5501 convention is to set up &'root'& as an alias for the system administrator. This
5502 setting is a guard against slips in the configuration.
5503 The list of users specified by &%never_users%& is not, however, the complete
5504 list; the build-time configuration in &_Local/Makefile_& has an option called
5505 FIXED_NEVER_USERS specifying a list that cannot be overridden. The
5506 contents of &%never_users%& are added to this list. By default
5507 FIXED_NEVER_USERS also specifies root.
5509 When a remote host connects to Exim in order to send mail, the only information
5510 Exim has about the host's identity is its IP address. The next configuration
5515 specifies that Exim should do a reverse DNS lookup on all incoming connections,
5516 in order to get a host name. This improves the quality of the logging
5517 information, but if you feel it is too expensive, you can remove it entirely,
5518 or restrict the lookup to hosts on &"nearby"& networks.
5519 Note that it is not always possible to find a host name from an IP address,
5520 because not all DNS reverse zones are maintained, and sometimes DNS servers are
5523 The next two lines are concerned with &'ident'& callbacks, as defined by RFC
5524 1413 (hence their names):
5527 rfc1413_query_timeout = 5s
5529 These settings cause Exim to make ident callbacks for all incoming SMTP calls.
5530 You can limit the hosts to which these calls are made, or change the timeout
5531 that is used. If you set the timeout to zero, all ident calls are disabled.
5532 Although they are cheap and can provide useful information for tracing problem
5533 messages, some hosts and firewalls have problems with ident calls. This can
5534 result in a timeout instead of an immediate refused connection, leading to
5535 delays on starting up an incoming SMTP session.
5537 When Exim receives messages over SMTP connections, it expects all addresses to
5538 be fully qualified with a domain, as required by the SMTP definition. However,
5539 if you are running a server to which simple clients submit messages, you may
5540 find that they send unqualified addresses. The two commented-out options:
5542 # sender_unqualified_hosts =
5543 # recipient_unqualified_hosts =
5545 show how you can specify hosts that are permitted to send unqualified sender
5546 and recipient addresses, respectively.
5548 The &%percent_hack_domains%& option is also commented out:
5550 # percent_hack_domains =
5552 It provides a list of domains for which the &"percent hack"& is to operate.
5553 This is an almost obsolete form of explicit email routing. If you do not know
5554 anything about it, you can safely ignore this topic.
5556 The last two settings in the main part of the default configuration are
5557 concerned with messages that have been &"frozen"& on Exim's queue. When a
5558 message is frozen, Exim no longer continues to try to deliver it. Freezing
5559 occurs when a bounce message encounters a permanent failure because the sender
5560 address of the original message that caused the bounce is invalid, so the
5561 bounce cannot be delivered. This is probably the most common case, but there
5562 are also other conditions that cause freezing, and frozen messages are not
5563 always bounce messages.
5565 ignore_bounce_errors_after = 2d
5566 timeout_frozen_after = 7d
5568 The first of these options specifies that failing bounce messages are to be
5569 discarded after 2 days on the queue. The second specifies that any frozen
5570 message (whether a bounce message or not) is to be timed out (and discarded)
5571 after a week. In this configuration, the first setting ensures that no failing
5572 bounce message ever lasts a week.
5576 .section "ACL configuration" "SECID54"
5577 .cindex "default" "ACLs"
5578 .cindex "&ACL;" "default configuration"
5579 In the default configuration, the ACL section follows the main configuration.
5580 It starts with the line
5584 and it contains the definitions of two ACLs, called &'acl_check_rcpt'& and
5585 &'acl_check_data'&, that were referenced in the settings of &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&
5586 and &%acl_smtp_data%& above.
5588 .cindex "RCPT" "ACL for"
5589 The first ACL is used for every RCPT command in an incoming SMTP message. Each
5590 RCPT command specifies one of the message's recipients. The ACL statements
5591 are considered in order, until the recipient address is either accepted or
5592 rejected. The RCPT command is then accepted or rejected, according to the
5593 result of the ACL processing.
5597 This line, consisting of a name terminated by a colon, marks the start of the
5602 This ACL statement accepts the recipient if the sending host matches the list.
5603 But what does that strange list mean? It doesn't actually contain any host
5604 names or IP addresses. The presence of the colon puts an empty item in the
5605 list; Exim matches this only if the incoming message did not come from a remote
5606 host, because in that case, the remote hostname is empty. The colon is
5607 important. Without it, the list itself is empty, and can never match anything.
5609 What this statement is doing is to accept unconditionally all recipients in
5610 messages that are submitted by SMTP from local processes using the standard
5611 input and output (that is, not using TCP/IP). A number of MUAs operate in this
5614 deny message = Restricted characters in address
5615 domains = +local_domains
5616 local_parts = ^[.] : ^.*[@%!/|]
5618 deny message = Restricted characters in address
5619 domains = !+local_domains
5620 local_parts = ^[./|] : ^.*[@%!] : ^.*/\\.\\./
5622 These statements are concerned with local parts that contain any of the
5623 characters &"@"&, &"%"&, &"!"&, &"/"&, &"|"&, or dots in unusual places.
5624 Although these characters are entirely legal in local parts (in the case of
5625 &"@"& and leading dots, only if correctly quoted), they do not commonly occur
5626 in Internet mail addresses.
5628 The first three have in the past been associated with explicitly routed
5629 addresses (percent is still sometimes used &-- see the &%percent_hack_domains%&
5630 option). Addresses containing these characters are regularly tried by spammers
5631 in an attempt to bypass relaying restrictions, and also by open relay testing
5632 programs. Unless you really need them it is safest to reject these characters
5633 at this early stage. This configuration is heavy-handed in rejecting these
5634 characters for all messages it accepts from remote hosts. This is a deliberate
5635 policy of being as safe as possible.
5637 The first rule above is stricter, and is applied to messages that are addressed
5638 to one of the local domains handled by this host. This is implemented by the
5639 first condition, which restricts it to domains that are listed in the
5640 &'local_domains'& domain list. The &"+"& character is used to indicate a
5641 reference to a named list. In this configuration, there is just one domain in
5642 &'local_domains'&, but in general there may be many.
5644 The second condition on the first statement uses two regular expressions to
5645 block local parts that begin with a dot or contain &"@"&, &"%"&, &"!"&, &"/"&,
5646 or &"|"&. If you have local accounts that include these characters, you will
5647 have to modify this rule.
5649 Empty components (two dots in a row) are not valid in RFC 2822, but Exim
5650 allows them because they have been encountered in practice. (Consider the
5651 common convention of local parts constructed as
5652 &"&'first-initial.second-initial.family-name'&"& when applied to someone like
5653 the author of Exim, who has no second initial.) However, a local part starting
5654 with a dot or containing &"/../"& can cause trouble if it is used as part of a
5655 file name (for example, for a mailing list). This is also true for local parts
5656 that contain slashes. A pipe symbol can also be troublesome if the local part
5657 is incorporated unthinkingly into a shell command line.
5659 The second rule above applies to all other domains, and is less strict. This
5660 allows your own users to send outgoing messages to sites that use slashes
5661 and vertical bars in their local parts. It blocks local parts that begin
5662 with a dot, slash, or vertical bar, but allows these characters within the
5663 local part. However, the sequence &"/../"& is barred. The use of &"@"&, &"%"&,
5664 and &"!"& is blocked, as before. The motivation here is to prevent your users
5665 (or your users' viruses) from mounting certain kinds of attack on remote sites.
5667 accept local_parts = postmaster
5668 domains = +local_domains
5670 This statement, which has two conditions, accepts an incoming address if the
5671 local part is &'postmaster'& and the domain is one of those listed in the
5672 &'local_domains'& domain list. The &"+"& character is used to indicate a
5673 reference to a named list. In this configuration, there is just one domain in
5674 &'local_domains'&, but in general there may be many.
5676 The presence of this statement means that mail to postmaster is never blocked
5677 by any of the subsequent tests. This can be helpful while sorting out problems
5678 in cases where the subsequent tests are incorrectly denying access.
5680 require verify = sender
5682 This statement requires the sender address to be verified before any subsequent
5683 ACL statement can be used. If verification fails, the incoming recipient
5684 address is refused. Verification consists of trying to route the address, to
5685 see if a bounce message could be delivered to it. In the case of remote
5686 addresses, basic verification checks only the domain, but &'callouts'& can be
5687 used for more verification if required. Section &<<SECTaddressverification>>&
5688 discusses the details of address verification.
5690 accept hosts = +relay_from_hosts
5691 control = submission
5693 This statement accepts the address if the message is coming from one of the
5694 hosts that are defined as being allowed to relay through this host. Recipient
5695 verification is omitted here, because in many cases the clients are dumb MUAs
5696 that do not cope well with SMTP error responses. For the same reason, the
5697 second line specifies &"submission mode"& for messages that are accepted. This
5698 is described in detail in section &<<SECTsubmodnon>>&; it causes Exim to fix
5699 messages that are deficient in some way, for example, because they lack a
5700 &'Date:'& header line. If you are actually relaying out from MTAs, you should
5701 probably add recipient verification here, and disable submission mode.
5703 accept authenticated = *
5704 control = submission
5706 This statement accepts the address if the client host has authenticated itself.
5707 Submission mode is again specified, on the grounds that such messages are most
5708 likely to come from MUAs. The default configuration does not define any
5709 authenticators, though it does include some nearly complete commented-out
5710 examples described in &<<SECTdefconfauth>>&. This means that no client can in
5711 fact authenticate until you complete the authenticator definitions.
5713 require message = relay not permitted
5714 domains = +local_domains : +relay_domains
5716 This statement rejects the address if its domain is neither a local domain nor
5717 one of the domains for which this host is a relay.
5719 require verify = recipient
5721 This statement requires the recipient address to be verified; if verification
5722 fails, the address is rejected.
5724 # deny message = rejected because $sender_host_address \
5725 # is in a black list at $dnslist_domain\n\
5727 # dnslists = black.list.example
5729 # warn dnslists = black.list.example
5730 # add_header = X-Warning: $sender_host_address is in \
5731 # a black list at $dnslist_domain
5732 # log_message = found in $dnslist_domain
5734 These commented-out lines are examples of how you could configure Exim to check
5735 sending hosts against a DNS black list. The first statement rejects messages
5736 from blacklisted hosts, whereas the second just inserts a warning header
5739 # require verify = csa
5741 This commented-out line is an example of how you could turn on client SMTP
5742 authorization (CSA) checking. Such checks do DNS lookups for special SRV
5747 The final statement in the first ACL unconditionally accepts any recipient
5748 address that has successfully passed all the previous tests.
5752 This line marks the start of the second ACL, and names it. Most of the contents
5753 of this ACL are commented out:
5756 # message = This message contains a virus \
5759 These lines are examples of how to arrange for messages to be scanned for
5760 viruses when Exim has been compiled with the content-scanning extension, and a
5761 suitable virus scanner is installed. If the message is found to contain a
5762 virus, it is rejected with the given custom error message.
5764 # warn spam = nobody
5765 # message = X-Spam_score: $spam_score\n\
5766 # X-Spam_score_int: $spam_score_int\n\
5767 # X-Spam_bar: $spam_bar\n\
5768 # X-Spam_report: $spam_report
5770 These lines are an example of how to arrange for messages to be scanned by
5771 SpamAssassin when Exim has been compiled with the content-scanning extension,
5772 and SpamAssassin has been installed. The SpamAssassin check is run with
5773 &`nobody`& as its user parameter, and the results are added to the message as a
5774 series of extra header line. In this case, the message is not rejected,
5775 whatever the spam score.
5779 This final line in the DATA ACL accepts the message unconditionally.
5782 .section "Router configuration" "SECID55"
5783 .cindex "default" "routers"
5784 .cindex "routers" "default"
5785 The router configuration comes next in the default configuration, introduced
5790 Routers are the modules in Exim that make decisions about where to send
5791 messages. An address is passed to each router in turn, until it is either
5792 accepted, or failed. This means that the order in which you define the routers
5793 matters. Each router is fully described in its own chapter later in this
5794 manual. Here we give only brief overviews.
5797 # driver = ipliteral
5798 # domains = !+local_domains
5799 # transport = remote_smtp
5801 .cindex "domain literal" "default router"
5802 This router is commented out because the majority of sites do not want to
5803 support domain literal addresses (those of the form &'user@[10.9.8.7]'&). If
5804 you uncomment this router, you also need to uncomment the setting of
5805 &%allow_domain_literals%& in the main part of the configuration.
5809 domains = ! +local_domains
5810 transport = remote_smtp
5811 ignore_target_hosts = 0.0.0.0 : 127.0.0.0/8
5814 The first uncommented router handles addresses that do not involve any local
5815 domains. This is specified by the line
5817 domains = ! +local_domains
5819 The &%domains%& option lists the domains to which this router applies, but the
5820 exclamation mark is a negation sign, so the router is used only for domains
5821 that are not in the domain list called &'local_domains'& (which was defined at
5822 the start of the configuration). The plus sign before &'local_domains'&
5823 indicates that it is referring to a named list. Addresses in other domains are
5824 passed on to the following routers.
5826 The name of the router driver is &(dnslookup)&,
5827 and is specified by the &%driver%& option. Do not be confused by the fact that
5828 the name of this router instance is the same as the name of the driver. The
5829 instance name is arbitrary, but the name set in the &%driver%& option must be
5830 one of the driver modules that is in the Exim binary.
5832 The &(dnslookup)& router routes addresses by looking up their domains in the
5833 DNS in order to obtain a list of hosts to which the address is routed. If the
5834 router succeeds, the address is queued for the &(remote_smtp)& transport, as
5835 specified by the &%transport%& option. If the router does not find the domain
5836 in the DNS, no further routers are tried because of the &%no_more%& setting, so
5837 the address fails and is bounced.
5839 The &%ignore_target_hosts%& option specifies a list of IP addresses that are to
5840 be entirely ignored. This option is present because a number of cases have been
5841 encountered where MX records in the DNS point to host names
5842 whose IP addresses are 0.0.0.0 or are in the 127 subnet (typically 127.0.0.1).
5843 Completely ignoring these IP addresses causes Exim to fail to route the
5844 email address, so it bounces. Otherwise, Exim would log a routing problem, and
5845 continue to try to deliver the message periodically until the address timed
5852 data = ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/etc/aliases}}
5854 file_transport = address_file
5855 pipe_transport = address_pipe
5857 Control reaches this and subsequent routers only for addresses in the local
5858 domains. This router checks to see whether the local part is defined as an
5859 alias in the &_/etc/aliases_& file, and if so, redirects it according to the
5860 data that it looks up from that file. If no data is found for the local part,
5861 the value of the &%data%& option is empty, causing the address to be passed to
5864 &_/etc/aliases_& is a conventional name for the system aliases file that is
5865 often used. That is why it is referenced by from the default configuration
5866 file. However, you can change this by setting SYSTEM_ALIASES_FILE in
5867 &_Local/Makefile_& before building Exim.
5872 # local_part_suffix = +* : -*
5873 # local_part_suffix_optional
5874 file = $home/.forward
5879 file_transport = address_file
5880 pipe_transport = address_pipe
5881 reply_transport = address_reply
5883 This is the most complicated router in the default configuration. It is another
5884 redirection router, but this time it is looking for forwarding data set up by
5885 individual users. The &%check_local_user%& setting specifies a check that the
5886 local part of the address is the login name of a local user. If it is not, the
5887 router is skipped. The two commented options that follow &%check_local_user%&,
5890 # local_part_suffix = +* : -*
5891 # local_part_suffix_optional
5893 .vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
5894 show how you can specify the recognition of local part suffixes. If the first
5895 is uncommented, a suffix beginning with either a plus or a minus sign, followed
5896 by any sequence of characters, is removed from the local part and placed in the
5897 variable &$local_part_suffix$&. The second suffix option specifies that the
5898 presence of a suffix in the local part is optional. When a suffix is present,
5899 the check for a local login uses the local part with the suffix removed.
5901 When a local user account is found, the file called &_.forward_& in the user's
5902 home directory is consulted. If it does not exist, or is empty, the router
5903 declines. Otherwise, the contents of &_.forward_& are interpreted as
5904 redirection data (see chapter &<<CHAPredirect>>& for more details).
5906 .cindex "Sieve filter" "enabling in default router"
5907 Traditional &_.forward_& files contain just a list of addresses, pipes, or
5908 files. Exim supports this by default. However, if &%allow_filter%& is set (it
5909 is commented out by default), the contents of the file are interpreted as a set
5910 of Exim or Sieve filtering instructions, provided the file begins with &"#Exim
5911 filter"& or &"#Sieve filter"&, respectively. User filtering is discussed in the
5912 separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'&.
5914 The &%no_verify%& and &%no_expn%& options mean that this router is skipped when
5915 verifying addresses, or when running as a consequence of an SMTP EXPN command.
5916 There are two reasons for doing this:
5919 Whether or not a local user has a &_.forward_& file is not really relevant when
5920 checking an address for validity; it makes sense not to waste resources doing
5923 More importantly, when Exim is verifying addresses or handling an EXPN
5924 command during an SMTP session, it is running as the Exim user, not as root.
5925 The group is the Exim group, and no additional groups are set up.
5926 It may therefore not be possible for Exim to read users' &_.forward_& files at
5930 The setting of &%check_ancestor%& prevents the router from generating a new
5931 address that is the same as any previous address that was redirected. (This
5932 works round a problem concerning a bad interaction between aliasing and
5933 forwarding &-- see section &<<SECTredlocmai>>&).
5935 The final three option settings specify the transports that are to be used when
5936 forwarding generates a direct delivery to a file, or to a pipe, or sets up an
5937 auto-reply, respectively. For example, if a &_.forward_& file contains
5939 a.nother@elsewhere.example, /home/spqr/archive
5941 the delivery to &_/home/spqr/archive_& is done by running the &%address_file%&
5947 # local_part_suffix = +* : -*
5948 # local_part_suffix_optional
5949 transport = local_delivery
5951 The final router sets up delivery into local mailboxes, provided that the local
5952 part is the name of a local login, by accepting the address and assigning it to
5953 the &(local_delivery)& transport. Otherwise, we have reached the end of the
5954 routers, so the address is bounced. The commented suffix settings fulfil the
5955 same purpose as they do for the &(userforward)& router.
5958 .section "Transport configuration" "SECID56"
5959 .cindex "default" "transports"
5960 .cindex "transports" "default"
5961 Transports define mechanisms for actually delivering messages. They operate
5962 only when referenced from routers, so the order in which they are defined does
5963 not matter. The transports section of the configuration starts with
5967 One remote transport and four local transports are defined.
5972 This transport is used for delivering messages over SMTP connections. All its
5973 options are defaulted. The list of remote hosts comes from the router.
5977 file = /var/mail/$local_part
5984 This &(appendfile)& transport is used for local delivery to user mailboxes in
5985 traditional BSD mailbox format. By default it runs under the uid and gid of the
5986 local user, which requires the sticky bit to be set on the &_/var/mail_&
5987 directory. Some systems use the alternative approach of running mail deliveries
5988 under a particular group instead of using the sticky bit. The commented options
5989 show how this can be done.
5991 Exim adds three headers to the message as it delivers it: &'Delivery-date:'&,
5992 &'Envelope-to:'& and &'Return-path:'&. This action is requested by the three
5993 similarly-named options above.
5999 This transport is used for handling deliveries to pipes that are generated by
6000 redirection (aliasing or users' &_.forward_& files). The &%return_output%&
6001 option specifies that any output generated by the pipe is to be returned to the
6010 This transport is used for handling deliveries to files that are generated by
6011 redirection. The name of the file is not specified in this instance of
6012 &(appendfile)&, because it comes from the &(redirect)& router.
6017 This transport is used for handling automatic replies generated by users'
6022 .section "Default retry rule" "SECID57"
6023 .cindex "retry" "default rule"
6024 .cindex "default" "retry rule"
6025 The retry section of the configuration file contains rules which affect the way
6026 Exim retries deliveries that cannot be completed at the first attempt. It is
6027 introduced by the line
6031 In the default configuration, there is just one rule, which applies to all
6034 * * F,2h,15m; G,16h,1h,1.5; F,4d,6h
6036 This causes any temporarily failing address to be retried every 15 minutes for
6037 2 hours, then at intervals starting at one hour and increasing by a factor of
6038 1.5 until 16 hours have passed, then every 6 hours up to 4 days. If an address
6039 is not delivered after 4 days of temporary failure, it is bounced.
6041 If the retry section is removed from the configuration, or is empty (that is,
6042 if no retry rules are defined), Exim will not retry deliveries. This turns
6043 temporary errors into permanent errors.
6046 .section "Rewriting configuration" "SECID58"
6047 The rewriting section of the configuration, introduced by
6051 contains rules for rewriting addresses in messages as they arrive. There are no
6052 rewriting rules in the default configuration file.
6056 .section "Authenticators configuration" "SECTdefconfauth"
6057 .cindex "AUTH" "configuration"
6058 The authenticators section of the configuration, introduced by
6060 begin authenticators
6062 defines mechanisms for the use of the SMTP AUTH command. The default
6063 configuration file contains two commented-out example authenticators
6064 which support plaintext username/password authentication using the
6065 standard PLAIN mechanism and the traditional but non-standard LOGIN
6066 mechanism, with Exim acting as the server. PLAIN and LOGIN are enough
6067 to support most MUA software.
6069 The example PLAIN authenticator looks like this:
6072 # driver = plaintext
6073 # server_set_id = $auth2
6074 # server_prompts = :
6075 # server_condition = Authentication is not yet configured
6076 # server_advertise_condition = ${if def:tls_in_cipher }
6078 And the example LOGIN authenticator looks like this:
6081 # driver = plaintext
6082 # server_set_id = $auth1
6083 # server_prompts = <| Username: | Password:
6084 # server_condition = Authentication is not yet configured
6085 # server_advertise_condition = ${if def:tls_in_cipher }
6088 The &%server_set_id%& option makes Exim remember the authenticated username
6089 in &$authenticated_id$&, which can be used later in ACLs or routers. The
6090 &%server_prompts%& option configures the &(plaintext)& authenticator so
6091 that it implements the details of the specific authentication mechanism,
6092 i.e. PLAIN or LOGIN. The &%server_advertise_condition%& setting controls
6093 when Exim offers authentication to clients; in the examples, this is only
6094 when TLS or SSL has been started, so to enable the authenticators you also
6095 need to add support for TLS as described in section &<<SECTdefconfmain>>&.
6097 The &%server_condition%& setting defines how to verify that the username and
6098 password are correct. In the examples it just produces an error message.
6099 To make the authenticators work, you can use a string expansion
6100 expression like one of the examples in chapter &<<CHAPplaintext>>&.
6102 Beware that the sequence of the parameters to PLAIN and LOGIN differ; the
6103 usercode and password are in different positions.
6104 Chapter &<<CHAPplaintext>>& covers both.
6106 .ecindex IIDconfiwal
6110 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
6111 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
6113 .chapter "Regular expressions" "CHAPregexp"
6115 .cindex "regular expressions" "library"
6117 Exim supports the use of regular expressions in many of its options. It
6118 uses the PCRE regular expression library; this provides regular expression
6119 matching that is compatible with Perl 5. The syntax and semantics of
6120 regular expressions is discussed in many Perl reference books, and also in
6121 Jeffrey Friedl's &'Mastering Regular Expressions'&, which is published by
6122 O'Reilly (see &url(http://www.oreilly.com/catalog/regex2/)).
6124 The documentation for the syntax and semantics of the regular expressions that
6125 are supported by PCRE is included in the PCRE distribution, and no further
6126 description is included here. The PCRE functions are called from Exim using
6127 the default option settings (that is, with no PCRE options set), except that
6128 the PCRE_CASELESS option is set when the matching is required to be
6131 In most cases, when a regular expression is required in an Exim configuration,
6132 it has to start with a circumflex, in order to distinguish it from plain text
6133 or an &"ends with"& wildcard. In this example of a configuration setting, the
6134 second item in the colon-separated list is a regular expression.
6136 domains = a.b.c : ^\\d{3} : *.y.z : ...
6138 The doubling of the backslash is required because of string expansion that
6139 precedes interpretation &-- see section &<<SECTlittext>>& for more discussion
6140 of this issue, and a way of avoiding the need for doubling backslashes. The
6141 regular expression that is eventually used in this example contains just one
6142 backslash. The circumflex is included in the regular expression, and has the
6143 normal effect of &"anchoring"& it to the start of the string that is being
6146 There are, however, two cases where a circumflex is not required for the
6147 recognition of a regular expression: these are the &%match%& condition in a
6148 string expansion, and the &%matches%& condition in an Exim filter file. In
6149 these cases, the relevant string is always treated as a regular expression; if
6150 it does not start with a circumflex, the expression is not anchored, and can
6151 match anywhere in the subject string.
6153 In all cases, if you want a regular expression to match at the end of a string,
6154 you must code the $ metacharacter to indicate this. For example:
6156 domains = ^\\d{3}\\.example
6158 matches the domain &'123.example'&, but it also matches &'123.example.com'&.
6161 domains = ^\\d{3}\\.example\$
6163 if you want &'example'& to be the top-level domain. The backslash before the
6164 $ is needed because string expansion also interprets dollar characters.
6168 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
6169 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
6171 .chapter "File and database lookups" "CHAPfdlookup"
6172 .scindex IIDfidalo1 "file" "lookups"
6173 .scindex IIDfidalo2 "database" "lookups"
6174 .cindex "lookup" "description of"
6175 Exim can be configured to look up data in files or databases as it processes
6176 messages. Two different kinds of syntax are used:
6179 A string that is to be expanded may contain explicit lookup requests. These
6180 cause parts of the string to be replaced by data that is obtained from the
6181 lookup. Lookups of this type are conditional expansion items. Different results
6182 can be defined for the cases of lookup success and failure. See chapter
6183 &<<CHAPexpand>>&, where string expansions are described in detail.
6185 Lists of domains, hosts, and email addresses can contain lookup requests as a
6186 way of avoiding excessively long linear lists. In this case, the data that is
6187 returned by the lookup is often (but not always) discarded; whether the lookup
6188 succeeds or fails is what really counts. These kinds of list are described in
6189 chapter &<<CHAPdomhosaddlists>>&.
6192 String expansions, lists, and lookups interact with each other in such a way
6193 that there is no order in which to describe any one of them that does not
6194 involve references to the others. Each of these three chapters makes more sense
6195 if you have read the other two first. If you are reading this for the first
6196 time, be aware that some of it will make a lot more sense after you have read
6197 chapters &<<CHAPdomhosaddlists>>& and &<<CHAPexpand>>&.
6199 .section "Examples of different lookup syntax" "SECID60"
6200 It is easy to confuse the two different kinds of lookup, especially as the
6201 lists that may contain the second kind are always expanded before being
6202 processed as lists. Therefore, they may also contain lookups of the first kind.
6203 Be careful to distinguish between the following two examples:
6205 domains = ${lookup{$sender_host_address}lsearch{/some/file}}
6206 domains = lsearch;/some/file
6208 The first uses a string expansion, the result of which must be a domain list.
6209 No strings have been specified for a successful or a failing lookup; the
6210 defaults in this case are the looked-up data and an empty string, respectively.
6211 The expansion takes place before the string is processed as a list, and the
6212 file that is searched could contain lines like this:
6214 192.168.3.4: domain1:domain2:...
6215 192.168.1.9: domain3:domain4:...
6217 When the lookup succeeds, the result of the expansion is a list of domains (and
6218 possibly other types of item that are allowed in domain lists).
6220 In the second example, the lookup is a single item in a domain list. It causes
6221 Exim to use a lookup to see if the domain that is being processed can be found
6222 in the file. The file could contains lines like this:
6227 Any data that follows the keys is not relevant when checking that the domain
6228 matches the list item.
6230 It is possible, though no doubt confusing, to use both kinds of lookup at once.
6231 Consider a file containing lines like this:
6233 192.168.5.6: lsearch;/another/file
6235 If the value of &$sender_host_address$& is 192.168.5.6, expansion of the
6236 first &%domains%& setting above generates the second setting, which therefore
6237 causes a second lookup to occur.
6239 The rest of this chapter describes the different lookup types that are
6240 available. Any of them can be used in any part of the configuration where a
6241 lookup is permitted.
6244 .section "Lookup types" "SECID61"
6245 .cindex "lookup" "types of"
6246 .cindex "single-key lookup" "definition of"
6247 Two different types of data lookup are implemented:
6250 The &'single-key'& type requires the specification of a file in which to look,
6251 and a single key to search for. The key must be a non-empty string for the
6252 lookup to succeed. The lookup type determines how the file is searched.
6254 .cindex "query-style lookup" "definition of"
6255 The &'query-style'& type accepts a generalized database query. No particular
6256 key value is assumed by Exim for query-style lookups. You can use whichever
6257 Exim variables you need to construct the database query.
6260 The code for each lookup type is in a separate source file that is included in
6261 the binary of Exim only if the corresponding compile-time option is set. The
6262 default settings in &_src/EDITME_& are:
6267 which means that only linear searching and DBM lookups are included by default.
6268 For some types of lookup (e.g. SQL databases), you need to install appropriate
6269 libraries and header files before building Exim.
6274 .section "Single-key lookup types" "SECTsinglekeylookups"
6275 .cindex "lookup" "single-key types"
6276 .cindex "single-key lookup" "list of types"
6277 The following single-key lookup types are implemented:
6280 .cindex "cdb" "description of"
6281 .cindex "lookup" "cdb"
6282 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
6283 &(cdb)&: The given file is searched as a Constant DataBase file, using the key
6284 string without a terminating binary zero. The cdb format is designed for
6285 indexed files that are read frequently and never updated, except by total
6286 re-creation. As such, it is particularly suitable for large files containing
6287 aliases or other indexed data referenced by an MTA. Information about cdb can
6288 be found in several places:
6290 &url(http://www.pobox.com/~djb/cdb.html)
6291 &url(ftp://ftp.corpit.ru/pub/tinycdb/)
6292 &url(http://packages.debian.org/stable/utils/freecdb.html)
6294 A cdb distribution is not needed in order to build Exim with cdb support,
6295 because the code for reading cdb files is included directly in Exim itself.
6296 However, no means of building or testing cdb files is provided with Exim, so
6297 you need to obtain a cdb distribution in order to do this.
6299 .cindex "DBM" "lookup type"
6300 .cindex "lookup" "dbm"
6301 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
6302 &(dbm)&: Calls to DBM library functions are used to extract data from the given
6303 DBM file by looking up the record with the given key. A terminating binary
6304 zero is included in the key that is passed to the DBM library. See section
6305 &<<SECTdb>>& for a discussion of DBM libraries.
6307 .cindex "Berkeley DB library" "file format"
6308 For all versions of Berkeley DB, Exim uses the DB_HASH style of database
6309 when building DBM files using the &%exim_dbmbuild%& utility. However, when
6310 using Berkeley DB versions 3 or 4, it opens existing databases for reading with
6311 the DB_UNKNOWN option. This enables it to handle any of the types of database
6312 that the library supports, and can be useful for accessing DBM files created by
6313 other applications. (For earlier DB versions, DB_HASH is always used.)
6315 .cindex "lookup" "dbmjz"
6316 .cindex "lookup" "dbm &-- embedded NULs"
6318 .cindex "dbmjz lookup type"
6319 &(dbmjz)&: This is the same as &(dbm)&, except that the lookup key is
6320 interpreted as an Exim list; the elements of the list are joined together with
6321 ASCII NUL characters to form the lookup key. An example usage would be to
6322 authenticate incoming SMTP calls using the passwords from Cyrus SASL's
6323 &_/etc/sasldb2_& file with the &(gsasl)& authenticator or Exim's own
6324 &(cram_md5)& authenticator.
6326 .cindex "lookup" "dbmnz"
6327 .cindex "lookup" "dbm &-- terminating zero"
6328 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
6330 .cindex "&_/etc/userdbshadow.dat_&"
6331 .cindex "dbmnz lookup type"
6332 &(dbmnz)&: This is the same as &(dbm)&, except that a terminating binary zero
6333 is not included in the key that is passed to the DBM library. You may need this
6334 if you want to look up data in files that are created by or shared with some
6335 other application that does not use terminating zeros. For example, you need to
6336 use &(dbmnz)& rather than &(dbm)& if you want to authenticate incoming SMTP
6337 calls using the passwords from Courier's &_/etc/userdbshadow.dat_& file. Exim's
6338 utility program for creating DBM files (&'exim_dbmbuild'&) includes the zeros
6339 by default, but has an option to omit them (see section &<<SECTdbmbuild>>&).
6341 .cindex "lookup" "dsearch"
6342 .cindex "dsearch lookup type"
6343 &(dsearch)&: The given file must be a directory; this is searched for an entry
6344 whose name is the key by calling the &[lstat()]& function. The key may not
6345 contain any forward slash characters. If &[lstat()]& succeeds, the result of
6346 the lookup is the name of the entry, which may be a file, directory,
6347 symbolic link, or any other kind of directory entry. An example of how this
6348 lookup can be used to support virtual domains is given in section
6349 &<<SECTvirtualdomains>>&.
6351 .cindex "lookup" "iplsearch"
6352 .cindex "iplsearch lookup type"
6353 &(iplsearch)&: The given file is a text file containing keys and data. A key is
6354 terminated by a colon or white space or the end of the line. The keys in the
6355 file must be IP addresses, or IP addresses with CIDR masks. Keys that involve
6356 IPv6 addresses must be enclosed in quotes to prevent the first internal colon
6357 being interpreted as a key terminator. For example:
6359 1.2.3.4: data for 1.2.3.4
6360 192.168.0.0/16: data for 192.168.0.0/16
6361 "abcd::cdab": data for abcd::cdab
6362 "abcd:abcd::/32" data for abcd:abcd::/32
6364 The key for an &(iplsearch)& lookup must be an IP address (without a mask). The
6365 file is searched linearly, using the CIDR masks where present, until a matching
6366 key is found. The first key that matches is used; there is no attempt to find a
6367 &"best"& match. Apart from the way the keys are matched, the processing for
6368 &(iplsearch)& is the same as for &(lsearch)&.
6370 &*Warning 1*&: Unlike most other single-key lookup types, a file of data for
6371 &(iplsearch)& can &'not'& be turned into a DBM or cdb file, because those
6372 lookup types support only literal keys.
6374 &*Warning 2*&: In a host list, you must always use &(net-iplsearch)& so that
6375 the implicit key is the host's IP address rather than its name (see section
6376 &<<SECThoslispatsikey>>&).
6378 .cindex "linear search"
6379 .cindex "lookup" "lsearch"
6380 .cindex "lsearch lookup type"
6381 .cindex "case sensitivity" "in lsearch lookup"
6382 &(lsearch)&: The given file is a text file that is searched linearly for a
6383 line beginning with the search key, terminated by a colon or white space or the
6384 end of the line. The search is case-insensitive; that is, upper and lower case
6385 letters are treated as the same. The first occurrence of the key that is found
6386 in the file is used.
6388 White space between the key and the colon is permitted. The remainder of the
6389 line, with leading and trailing white space removed, is the data. This can be
6390 continued onto subsequent lines by starting them with any amount of white
6391 space, but only a single space character is included in the data at such a
6392 junction. If the data begins with a colon, the key must be terminated by a
6397 Empty lines and lines beginning with # are ignored, even if they occur in the
6398 middle of an item. This is the traditional textual format of alias files. Note
6399 that the keys in an &(lsearch)& file are literal strings. There is no
6400 wildcarding of any kind.
6402 .cindex "lookup" "lsearch &-- colons in keys"
6403 .cindex "white space" "in lsearch key"
6404 In most &(lsearch)& files, keys are not required to contain colons or #
6405 characters, or white space. However, if you need this feature, it is available.
6406 If a key begins with a doublequote character, it is terminated only by a
6407 matching quote (or end of line), and the normal escaping rules apply to its
6408 contents (see section &<<SECTstrings>>&). An optional colon is permitted after
6409 quoted keys (exactly as for unquoted keys). There is no special handling of
6410 quotes for the data part of an &(lsearch)& line.
6413 .cindex "NIS lookup type"
6414 .cindex "lookup" "NIS"
6415 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
6416 &(nis)&: The given file is the name of a NIS map, and a NIS lookup is done with
6417 the given key, without a terminating binary zero. There is a variant called
6418 &(nis0)& which does include the terminating binary zero in the key. This is
6419 reportedly needed for Sun-style alias files. Exim does not recognize NIS
6420 aliases; the full map names must be used.
6423 .cindex "wildlsearch lookup type"
6424 .cindex "lookup" "wildlsearch"
6425 .cindex "nwildlsearch lookup type"
6426 .cindex "lookup" "nwildlsearch"
6427 &(wildlsearch)& or &(nwildlsearch)&: These search a file linearly, like
6428 &(lsearch)&, but instead of being interpreted as a literal string, each key in
6429 the file may be wildcarded. The difference between these two lookup types is
6430 that for &(wildlsearch)&, each key in the file is string-expanded before being
6431 used, whereas for &(nwildlsearch)&, no expansion takes place.
6433 .cindex "case sensitivity" "in (n)wildlsearch lookup"
6434 Like &(lsearch)&, the testing is done case-insensitively. However, keys in the
6435 file that are regular expressions can be made case-sensitive by the use of
6436 &`(-i)`& within the pattern. The following forms of wildcard are recognized:
6438 . ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
6439 . ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left.
6442 The string may begin with an asterisk to mean &"ends with"&. For example:
6444 *.a.b.c data for anything.a.b.c
6445 *fish data for anythingfish
6448 The string may begin with a circumflex to indicate a regular expression. For
6449 example, for &(wildlsearch)&:
6451 ^\N\d+\.a\.b\N data for <digits>.a.b
6453 Note the use of &`\N`& to disable expansion of the contents of the regular
6454 expression. If you are using &(nwildlsearch)&, where the keys are not
6455 string-expanded, the equivalent entry is:
6457 ^\d+\.a\.b data for <digits>.a.b
6459 The case-insensitive flag is set at the start of compiling the regular
6460 expression, but it can be turned off by using &`(-i)`& at an appropriate point.
6461 For example, to make the entire pattern case-sensitive:
6463 ^(?-i)\d+\.a\.b data for <digits>.a.b
6466 If the regular expression contains white space or colon characters, you must
6467 either quote it (see &(lsearch)& above), or represent these characters in other
6468 ways. For example, &`\s`& can be used for white space and &`\x3A`& for a
6469 colon. This may be easier than quoting, because if you quote, you have to
6470 escape all the backslashes inside the quotes.
6472 &*Note*&: It is not possible to capture substrings in a regular expression
6473 match for later use, because the results of all lookups are cached. If a lookup
6474 is repeated, the result is taken from the cache, and no actual pattern matching
6475 takes place. The values of all the numeric variables are unset after a
6476 &((n)wildlsearch)& match.
6479 Although I cannot see it being of much use, the general matching function that
6480 is used to implement &((n)wildlsearch)& means that the string may begin with a
6481 lookup name terminated by a semicolon, and followed by lookup data. For
6484 cdb;/some/file data for keys that match the file
6486 The data that is obtained from the nested lookup is discarded.
6489 Keys that do not match any of these patterns are interpreted literally. The
6490 continuation rules for the data are the same as for &(lsearch)&, and keys may
6491 be followed by optional colons.
6493 &*Warning*&: Unlike most other single-key lookup types, a file of data for
6494 &((n)wildlsearch)& can &'not'& be turned into a DBM or cdb file, because those
6495 lookup types support only literal keys.
6499 .section "Query-style lookup types" "SECID62"
6500 .cindex "lookup" "query-style types"
6501 .cindex "query-style lookup" "list of types"
6502 The supported query-style lookup types are listed below. Further details about
6503 many of them are given in later sections.
6506 .cindex "DNS" "as a lookup type"
6507 .cindex "lookup" "DNS"
6508 &(dnsdb)&: This does a DNS search for one or more records whose domain names
6509 are given in the supplied query. The resulting data is the contents of the
6510 records. See section &<<SECTdnsdb>>&.
6512 .cindex "InterBase lookup type"
6513 .cindex "lookup" "InterBase"
6514 &(ibase)&: This does a lookup in an InterBase database.
6516 .cindex "LDAP" "lookup type"
6517 .cindex "lookup" "LDAP"
6518 &(ldap)&: This does an LDAP lookup using a query in the form of a URL, and
6519 returns attributes from a single entry. There is a variant called &(ldapm)&
6520 that permits values from multiple entries to be returned. A third variant
6521 called &(ldapdn)& returns the Distinguished Name of a single entry instead of
6522 any attribute values. See section &<<SECTldap>>&.
6524 .cindex "MySQL" "lookup type"
6525 .cindex "lookup" "MySQL"
6526 &(mysql)&: The format of the query is an SQL statement that is passed to a
6527 MySQL database. See section &<<SECTsql>>&.
6529 .cindex "NIS+ lookup type"
6530 .cindex "lookup" "NIS+"
6531 &(nisplus)&: This does a NIS+ lookup using a query that can specify the name of
6532 the field to be returned. See section &<<SECTnisplus>>&.
6534 .cindex "Oracle" "lookup type"
6535 .cindex "lookup" "Oracle"
6536 &(oracle)&: The format of the query is an SQL statement that is passed to an
6537 Oracle database. See section &<<SECTsql>>&.
6539 .cindex "lookup" "passwd"
6540 .cindex "passwd lookup type"
6541 .cindex "&_/etc/passwd_&"
6542 &(passwd)& is a query-style lookup with queries that are just user names. The
6543 lookup calls &[getpwnam()]& to interrogate the system password data, and on
6544 success, the result string is the same as you would get from an &(lsearch)&
6545 lookup on a traditional &_/etc/passwd file_&, though with &`*`& for the
6546 password value. For example:
6548 *:42:42:King Rat:/home/kr:/bin/bash
6551 .cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type"
6552 .cindex "lookup" "PostgreSQL"
6553 &(pgsql)&: The format of the query is an SQL statement that is passed to a
6554 PostgreSQL database. See section &<<SECTsql>>&.
6557 .cindex "sqlite lookup type"
6558 .cindex "lookup" "sqlite"
6559 &(sqlite)&: The format of the query is a file name followed by an SQL statement
6560 that is passed to an SQLite database. See section &<<SECTsqlite>>&.
6563 &(testdb)&: This is a lookup type that is used for testing Exim. It is
6564 not likely to be useful in normal operation.
6566 .cindex "whoson lookup type"
6567 .cindex "lookup" "whoson"
6568 &(whoson)&: &'Whoson'& (&url(http://whoson.sourceforge.net)) is a protocol that
6569 allows a server to check whether a particular (dynamically allocated) IP
6570 address is currently allocated to a known (trusted) user and, optionally, to
6571 obtain the identity of the said user. For SMTP servers, &'Whoson'& was popular
6572 at one time for &"POP before SMTP"& authentication, but that approach has been
6573 superseded by SMTP authentication. In Exim, &'Whoson'& can be used to implement
6574 &"POP before SMTP"& checking using ACL statements such as
6576 require condition = \
6577 ${lookup whoson {$sender_host_address}{yes}{no}}
6579 The query consists of a single IP address. The value returned is the name of
6580 the authenticated user, which is stored in the variable &$value$&. However, in
6581 this example, the data in &$value$& is not used; the result of the lookup is
6582 one of the fixed strings &"yes"& or &"no"&.
6587 .section "Temporary errors in lookups" "SECID63"
6588 .cindex "lookup" "temporary error in"
6589 Lookup functions can return temporary error codes if the lookup cannot be
6590 completed. For example, an SQL or LDAP database might be unavailable. For this
6591 reason, it is not advisable to use a lookup that might do this for critical
6592 options such as a list of local domains.
6594 When a lookup cannot be completed in a router or transport, delivery
6595 of the message (to the relevant address) is deferred, as for any other
6596 temporary error. In other circumstances Exim may assume the lookup has failed,
6597 or may give up altogether.
6601 .section "Default values in single-key lookups" "SECTdefaultvaluelookups"
6602 .cindex "wildcard lookups"
6603 .cindex "lookup" "default values"
6604 .cindex "lookup" "wildcard"
6605 .cindex "lookup" "* added to type"
6606 .cindex "default" "in single-key lookups"
6607 In this context, a &"default value"& is a value specified by the administrator
6608 that is to be used if a lookup fails.
6610 &*Note:*& This section applies only to single-key lookups. For query-style
6611 lookups, the facilities of the query language must be used. An attempt to
6612 specify a default for a query-style lookup provokes an error.
6614 If &"*"& is added to a single-key lookup type (for example, &%lsearch*%&)
6615 and the initial lookup fails, the key &"*"& is looked up in the file to
6616 provide a default value. See also the section on partial matching below.
6618 .cindex "*@ with single-key lookup"
6619 .cindex "lookup" "*@ added to type"
6620 .cindex "alias file" "per-domain default"
6621 Alternatively, if &"*@"& is added to a single-key lookup type (for example
6622 &%dbm*@%&) then, if the initial lookup fails and the key contains an @
6623 character, a second lookup is done with everything before the last @ replaced
6624 by *. This makes it possible to provide per-domain defaults in alias files
6625 that include the domains in the keys. If the second lookup fails (or doesn't
6626 take place because there is no @ in the key), &"*"& is looked up.
6627 For example, a &(redirect)& router might contain:
6629 data = ${lookup{$local_part@$domain}lsearch*@{/etc/mix-aliases}}
6631 Suppose the address that is being processed is &'jane@eyre.example'&. Exim
6632 looks up these keys, in this order:
6638 The data is taken from whichever key it finds first. &*Note*&: In an
6639 &(lsearch)& file, this does not mean the first of these keys in the file. A
6640 complete scan is done for each key, and only if it is not found at all does
6641 Exim move on to try the next key.
6645 .section "Partial matching in single-key lookups" "SECTpartiallookup"
6646 .cindex "partial matching"
6647 .cindex "wildcard lookups"
6648 .cindex "lookup" "partial matching"
6649 .cindex "lookup" "wildcard"
6650 .cindex "asterisk" "in search type"
6651 The normal operation of a single-key lookup is to search the file for an exact
6652 match with the given key. However, in a number of situations where domains are
6653 being looked up, it is useful to be able to do partial matching. In this case,
6654 information in the file that has a key starting with &"*."& is matched by any
6655 domain that ends with the components that follow the full stop. For example, if
6656 a key in a DBM file is
6658 *.dates.fict.example
6660 then when partial matching is enabled this is matched by (amongst others)
6661 &'2001.dates.fict.example'& and &'1984.dates.fict.example'&. It is also matched
6662 by &'dates.fict.example'&, if that does not appear as a separate key in the
6665 &*Note*&: Partial matching is not available for query-style lookups. It is
6666 also not available for any lookup items in address lists (see section
6667 &<<SECTaddresslist>>&).
6669 Partial matching is implemented by doing a series of separate lookups using
6670 keys constructed by modifying the original subject key. This means that it can
6671 be used with any of the single-key lookup types, provided that
6672 partial matching keys
6673 beginning with a special prefix (default &"*."&) are included in the data file.
6674 Keys in the file that do not begin with the prefix are matched only by
6675 unmodified subject keys when partial matching is in use.
6677 Partial matching is requested by adding the string &"partial-"& to the front of
6678 the name of a single-key lookup type, for example, &%partial-dbm%&. When this
6679 is done, the subject key is first looked up unmodified; if that fails, &"*."&
6680 is added at the start of the subject key, and it is looked up again. If that
6681 fails, further lookups are tried with dot-separated components removed from the
6682 start of the subject key, one-by-one, and &"*."& added on the front of what
6685 A minimum number of two non-* components are required. This can be adjusted
6686 by including a number before the hyphen in the search type. For example,
6687 &%partial3-lsearch%& specifies a minimum of three non-* components in the
6688 modified keys. Omitting the number is equivalent to &"partial2-"&. If the
6689 subject key is &'2250.dates.fict.example'& then the following keys are looked
6690 up when the minimum number of non-* components is two:
6692 2250.dates.fict.example
6693 *.2250.dates.fict.example
6694 *.dates.fict.example
6697 As soon as one key in the sequence is successfully looked up, the lookup
6700 .cindex "lookup" "partial matching &-- changing prefix"
6701 .cindex "prefix" "for partial matching"
6702 The use of &"*."& as the partial matching prefix is a default that can be
6703 changed. The motivation for this feature is to allow Exim to operate with file
6704 formats that are used by other MTAs. A different prefix can be supplied in
6705 parentheses instead of the hyphen after &"partial"&. For example:
6707 domains = partial(.)lsearch;/some/file
6709 In this example, if the domain is &'a.b.c'&, the sequence of lookups is
6710 &`a.b.c`&, &`.a.b.c`&, and &`.b.c`& (the default minimum of 2 non-wild
6711 components is unchanged). The prefix may consist of any punctuation characters
6712 other than a closing parenthesis. It may be empty, for example:
6714 domains = partial1()cdb;/some/file
6716 For this example, if the domain is &'a.b.c'&, the sequence of lookups is
6717 &`a.b.c`&, &`b.c`&, and &`c`&.
6719 If &"partial0"& is specified, what happens at the end (when the lookup with
6720 just one non-wild component has failed, and the original key is shortened right
6721 down to the null string) depends on the prefix:
6724 If the prefix has zero length, the whole lookup fails.
6726 If the prefix has length 1, a lookup for just the prefix is done. For
6727 example, the final lookup for &"partial0(.)"& is for &`.`& alone.
6729 Otherwise, if the prefix ends in a dot, the dot is removed, and the
6730 remainder is looked up. With the default prefix, therefore, the final lookup is
6731 for &"*"& on its own.
6733 Otherwise, the whole prefix is looked up.
6737 If the search type ends in &"*"& or &"*@"& (see section
6738 &<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>& above), the search for an ultimate default that
6739 this implies happens after all partial lookups have failed. If &"partial0"& is
6740 specified, adding &"*"& to the search type has no effect with the default
6741 prefix, because the &"*"& key is already included in the sequence of partial
6742 lookups. However, there might be a use for lookup types such as
6743 &"partial0(.)lsearch*"&.
6745 The use of &"*"& in lookup partial matching differs from its use as a wildcard
6746 in domain lists and the like. Partial matching works only in terms of
6747 dot-separated components; a key such as &`*fict.example`&
6748 in a database file is useless, because the asterisk in a partial matching
6749 subject key is always followed by a dot.
6754 .section "Lookup caching" "SECID64"
6755 .cindex "lookup" "caching"
6756 .cindex "caching" "lookup data"
6757 Exim caches all lookup results in order to avoid needless repetition of
6758 lookups. However, because (apart from the daemon) Exim operates as a collection
6759 of independent, short-lived processes, this caching applies only within a
6760 single Exim process. There is no inter-process lookup caching facility.
6762 For single-key lookups, Exim keeps the relevant files open in case there is
6763 another lookup that needs them. In some types of configuration this can lead to
6764 many files being kept open for messages with many recipients. To avoid hitting
6765 the operating system limit on the number of simultaneously open files, Exim
6766 closes the least recently used file when it needs to open more files than its
6767 own internal limit, which can be changed via the &%lookup_open_max%& option.
6769 The single-key lookup files are closed and the lookup caches are flushed at
6770 strategic points during delivery &-- for example, after all routing is
6776 .section "Quoting lookup data" "SECID65"
6777 .cindex "lookup" "quoting"
6778 .cindex "quoting" "in lookups"
6779 When data from an incoming message is included in a query-style lookup, there
6780 is the possibility of special characters in the data messing up the syntax of
6781 the query. For example, a NIS+ query that contains
6785 will be broken if the local part happens to contain a closing square bracket.
6786 For NIS+, data can be enclosed in double quotes like this:
6788 [name="$local_part"]
6790 but this still leaves the problem of a double quote in the data. The rule for
6791 NIS+ is that double quotes must be doubled. Other lookup types have different
6792 rules, and to cope with the differing requirements, an expansion operator
6793 of the following form is provided:
6795 ${quote_<lookup-type>:<string>}
6797 For example, the safest way to write the NIS+ query is
6799 [name="${quote_nisplus:$local_part}"]
6801 See chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>& for full coverage of string expansions. The quote
6802 operator can be used for all lookup types, but has no effect for single-key
6803 lookups, since no quoting is ever needed in their key strings.
6808 .section "More about dnsdb" "SECTdnsdb"
6809 .cindex "dnsdb lookup"
6810 .cindex "lookup" "dnsdb"
6811 .cindex "DNS" "as a lookup type"
6812 The &(dnsdb)& lookup type uses the DNS as its database. A simple query consists
6813 of a record type and a domain name, separated by an equals sign. For example,
6814 an expansion string could contain:
6816 ${lookup dnsdb{mx=a.b.example}{$value}fail}
6818 If the lookup succeeds, the result is placed in &$value$&, which in this case
6819 is used on its own as the result. If the lookup does not succeed, the
6820 &`fail`& keyword causes a &'forced expansion failure'& &-- see section
6821 &<<SECTforexpfai>>& for an explanation of what this means.
6823 The supported DNS record types are A, CNAME, MX, NS, PTR, SPF, SRV, and TXT,
6824 and, when Exim is compiled with IPv6 support, AAAA (and A6 if that is also
6825 configured). If no type is given, TXT is assumed. When the type is PTR,
6826 the data can be an IP address, written as normal; inversion and the addition of
6827 &%in-addr.arpa%& or &%ip6.arpa%& happens automatically. For example:
6829 ${lookup dnsdb{ptr=192.168.4.5}{$value}fail}
6831 If the data for a PTR record is not a syntactically valid IP address, it is not
6832 altered and nothing is added.
6834 .cindex "MX record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
6835 .cindex "SRV record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
6836 For an MX lookup, both the preference value and the host name are returned for
6837 each record, separated by a space. For an SRV lookup, the priority, weight,
6838 port, and host name are returned for each record, separated by spaces.
6840 For any record type, if multiple records are found (or, for A6 lookups, if a
6841 single record leads to multiple addresses), the data is returned as a
6842 concatenation, with newline as the default separator. The order, of course,
6843 depends on the DNS resolver. You can specify a different separator character
6844 between multiple records by putting a right angle-bracket followed immediately
6845 by the new separator at the start of the query. For example:
6847 ${lookup dnsdb{>: a=host1.example}}
6849 It is permitted to specify a space as the separator character. Further
6850 white space is ignored.
6852 .cindex "TXT record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
6853 .cindex "SPF record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
6854 For TXT records with multiple items of data, only the first item is returned,
6855 unless a separator for them is specified using a comma after the separator
6856 character followed immediately by the TXT record item separator. To concatenate
6857 items without a separator, use a semicolon instead. For SPF records the
6858 default behaviour is to concatenate multiple items without using a separator.
6860 ${lookup dnsdb{>\n,: txt=a.b.example}}
6861 ${lookup dnsdb{>\n; txt=a.b.example}}
6862 ${lookup dnsdb{spf=example.org}}
6864 It is permitted to specify a space as the separator character. Further
6865 white space is ignored.
6867 .section "Pseudo dnsdb record types" "SECID66"
6868 .cindex "MX record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
6869 By default, both the preference value and the host name are returned for
6870 each MX record, separated by a space. If you want only host names, you can use
6871 the pseudo-type MXH:
6873 ${lookup dnsdb{mxh=a.b.example}}
6875 In this case, the preference values are omitted, and just the host names are
6878 .cindex "name server for enclosing domain"
6879 Another pseudo-type is ZNS (for &"zone NS"&). It performs a lookup for NS
6880 records on the given domain, but if none are found, it removes the first
6881 component of the domain name, and tries again. This process continues until NS
6882 records are found or there are no more components left (or there is a DNS
6883 error). In other words, it may return the name servers for a top-level domain,
6884 but it never returns the root name servers. If there are no NS records for the
6885 top-level domain, the lookup fails. Consider these examples:
6887 ${lookup dnsdb{zns=xxx.quercite.com}}
6888 ${lookup dnsdb{zns=xxx.edu}}
6890 Assuming that in each case there are no NS records for the full domain name,
6891 the first returns the name servers for &%quercite.com%&, and the second returns
6892 the name servers for &%edu%&.
6894 You should be careful about how you use this lookup because, unless the
6895 top-level domain does not exist, the lookup always returns some host names. The
6896 sort of use to which this might be put is for seeing if the name servers for a
6897 given domain are on a blacklist. You can probably assume that the name servers
6898 for the high-level domains such as &%com%& or &%co.uk%& are not going to be on
6901 .cindex "CSA" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
6902 A third pseudo-type is CSA (Client SMTP Authorization). This looks up SRV
6903 records according to the CSA rules, which are described in section
6904 &<<SECTverifyCSA>>&. Although &(dnsdb)& supports SRV lookups directly, this is
6905 not sufficient because of the extra parent domain search behaviour of CSA. The
6906 result of a successful lookup such as:
6908 ${lookup dnsdb {csa=$sender_helo_name}}
6910 has two space-separated fields: an authorization code and a target host name.
6911 The authorization code can be &"Y"& for yes, &"N"& for no, &"X"& for explicit
6912 authorization required but absent, or &"?"& for unknown.
6915 .section "Multiple dnsdb lookups" "SECID67"
6916 In the previous sections, &(dnsdb)& lookups for a single domain are described.
6917 However, you can specify a list of domains or IP addresses in a single
6918 &(dnsdb)& lookup. The list is specified in the normal Exim way, with colon as
6919 the default separator, but with the ability to change this. For example:
6921 ${lookup dnsdb{one.domain.com:two.domain.com}}
6922 ${lookup dnsdb{a=one.host.com:two.host.com}}
6923 ${lookup dnsdb{ptr = <; 1.2.3.4 ; 4.5.6.8}}
6925 In order to retain backwards compatibility, there is one special case: if
6926 the lookup type is PTR and no change of separator is specified, Exim looks
6927 to see if the rest of the string is precisely one IPv6 address. In this
6928 case, it does not treat it as a list.
6930 The data from each lookup is concatenated, with newline separators by default,
6931 in the same way that multiple DNS records for a single item are handled. A
6932 different separator can be specified, as described above.
6934 The &(dnsdb)& lookup fails only if all the DNS lookups fail. If there is a
6935 temporary DNS error for any of them, the behaviour is controlled by
6936 an optional keyword followed by a comma that may appear before the record
6937 type. The possible keywords are &"defer_strict"&, &"defer_never"&, and
6938 &"defer_lax"&. With &"strict"& behaviour, any temporary DNS error causes the
6939 whole lookup to defer. With &"never"& behaviour, a temporary DNS error is
6940 ignored, and the behaviour is as if the DNS lookup failed to find anything.
6941 With &"lax"& behaviour, all the queries are attempted, but a temporary DNS
6942 error causes the whole lookup to defer only if none of the other lookups
6943 succeed. The default is &"lax"&, so the following lookups are equivalent:
6945 ${lookup dnsdb{defer_lax,a=one.host.com:two.host.com}}
6946 ${lookup dnsdb{a=one.host.com:two.host.com}}
6948 Thus, in the default case, as long as at least one of the DNS lookups
6949 yields some data, the lookup succeeds.
6954 .section "More about LDAP" "SECTldap"
6955 .cindex "LDAP" "lookup, more about"
6956 .cindex "lookup" "LDAP"
6957 .cindex "Solaris" "LDAP"
6958 The original LDAP implementation came from the University of Michigan; this has
6959 become &"Open LDAP"&, and there are now two different releases. Another
6960 implementation comes from Netscape, and Solaris 7 and subsequent releases
6961 contain inbuilt LDAP support. Unfortunately, though these are all compatible at
6962 the lookup function level, their error handling is different. For this reason
6963 it is necessary to set a compile-time variable when building Exim with LDAP, to
6964 indicate which LDAP library is in use. One of the following should appear in
6965 your &_Local/Makefile_&:
6967 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=UMICHIGAN
6968 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=OPENLDAP1
6969 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=OPENLDAP2
6970 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=NETSCAPE
6971 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=SOLARIS
6973 If LDAP_LIB_TYPE is not set, Exim assumes &`OPENLDAP1`&, which has the
6974 same interface as the University of Michigan version.
6976 There are three LDAP lookup types in Exim. These behave slightly differently in
6977 the way they handle the results of a query:
6980 &(ldap)& requires the result to contain just one entry; if there are more, it
6983 &(ldapdn)& also requires the result to contain just one entry, but it is the
6984 Distinguished Name that is returned rather than any attribute values.
6986 &(ldapm)& permits the result to contain more than one entry; the attributes
6987 from all of them are returned.
6991 For &(ldap)& and &(ldapm)&, if a query finds only entries with no attributes,
6992 Exim behaves as if the entry did not exist, and the lookup fails. The format of
6993 the data returned by a successful lookup is described in the next section.
6994 First we explain how LDAP queries are coded.
6997 .section "Format of LDAP queries" "SECTforldaque"
6998 .cindex "LDAP" "query format"
6999 An LDAP query takes the form of a URL as defined in RFC 2255. For example, in
7000 the configuration of a &(redirect)& router one might have this setting:
7002 data = ${lookup ldap \
7003 {ldap:///cn=$local_part,o=University%20of%20Cambridge,\
7004 c=UK?mailbox?base?}}
7006 .cindex "LDAP" "with TLS"
7007 The URL may begin with &`ldap`& or &`ldaps`& if your LDAP library supports
7008 secure (encrypted) LDAP connections. The second of these ensures that an
7009 encrypted TLS connection is used.
7011 With sufficiently modern LDAP libraries, Exim supports forcing TLS over regular
7012 LDAP connections, rather than the SSL-on-connect &`ldaps`&.
7013 See the &%ldap_start_tls%& option.
7016 .section "LDAP quoting" "SECID68"
7017 .cindex "LDAP" "quoting"
7018 Two levels of quoting are required in LDAP queries, the first for LDAP itself
7019 and the second because the LDAP query is represented as a URL. Furthermore,
7020 within an LDAP query, two different kinds of quoting are required. For this
7021 reason, there are two different LDAP-specific quoting operators.
7023 The &%quote_ldap%& operator is designed for use on strings that are part of
7024 filter specifications. Conceptually, it first does the following conversions on
7032 in accordance with RFC 2254. The resulting string is then quoted according
7033 to the rules for URLs, that is, all non-alphanumeric characters except
7037 are converted to their hex values, preceded by a percent sign. For example:
7039 ${quote_ldap: a(bc)*, a<yz>; }
7043 %20a%5C28bc%5C29%5C2A%2C%20a%3Cyz%3E%3B%20
7045 Removing the URL quoting, this is (with a leading and a trailing space):
7047 a\28bc\29\2A, a<yz>;
7049 The &%quote_ldap_dn%& operator is designed for use on strings that are part of
7050 base DN specifications in queries. Conceptually, it first converts the string
7051 by inserting a backslash in front of any of the following characters:
7055 It also inserts a backslash before any leading spaces or # characters, and
7056 before any trailing spaces. (These rules are in RFC 2253.) The resulting string
7057 is then quoted according to the rules for URLs. For example:
7059 ${quote_ldap_dn: a(bc)*, a<yz>; }
7063 %5C%20a(bc)*%5C%2C%20a%5C%3Cyz%5C%3E%5C%3B%5C%20
7065 Removing the URL quoting, this is (with a trailing space):
7067 \ a(bc)*\, a\<yz\>\;\
7069 There are some further comments about quoting in the section on LDAP
7070 authentication below.
7073 .section "LDAP connections" "SECID69"
7074 .cindex "LDAP" "connections"
7075 The connection to an LDAP server may either be over TCP/IP, or, when OpenLDAP
7076 is in use, via a Unix domain socket. The example given above does not specify
7077 an LDAP server. A server that is reached by TCP/IP can be specified in a query
7080 ldap://<hostname>:<port>/...
7082 If the port (and preceding colon) are omitted, the standard LDAP port (389) is
7083 used. When no server is specified in a query, a list of default servers is
7084 taken from the &%ldap_default_servers%& configuration option. This supplies a
7085 colon-separated list of servers which are tried in turn until one successfully
7086 handles a query, or there is a serious error. Successful handling either
7087 returns the requested data, or indicates that it does not exist. Serious errors
7088 are syntactical, or multiple values when only a single value is expected.
7089 Errors which cause the next server to be tried are connection failures, bind
7090 failures, and timeouts.
7092 For each server name in the list, a port number can be given. The standard way
7093 of specifying a host and port is to use a colon separator (RFC 1738). Because
7094 &%ldap_default_servers%& is a colon-separated list, such colons have to be
7095 doubled. For example
7097 ldap_default_servers = ldap1.example.com::145:ldap2.example.com
7099 If &%ldap_default_servers%& is unset, a URL with no server name is passed
7100 to the LDAP library with no server name, and the library's default (normally
7101 the local host) is used.
7103 If you are using the OpenLDAP library, you can connect to an LDAP server using
7104 a Unix domain socket instead of a TCP/IP connection. This is specified by using
7105 &`ldapi`& instead of &`ldap`& in LDAP queries. What follows here applies only
7106 to OpenLDAP. If Exim is compiled with a different LDAP library, this feature is
7109 For this type of connection, instead of a host name for the server, a pathname
7110 for the socket is required, and the port number is not relevant. The pathname
7111 can be specified either as an item in &%ldap_default_servers%&, or inline in
7112 the query. In the former case, you can have settings such as
7114 ldap_default_servers = /tmp/ldap.sock : backup.ldap.your.domain
7116 When the pathname is given in the query, you have to escape the slashes as
7117 &`%2F`& to fit in with the LDAP URL syntax. For example:
7119 ${lookup ldap {ldapi://%2Ftmp%2Fldap.sock/o=...
7121 When Exim processes an LDAP lookup and finds that the &"hostname"& is really
7122 a pathname, it uses the Unix domain socket code, even if the query actually
7123 specifies &`ldap`& or &`ldaps`&. In particular, no encryption is used for a
7124 socket connection. This behaviour means that you can use a setting of
7125 &%ldap_default_servers%& such as in the example above with traditional &`ldap`&
7126 or &`ldaps`& queries, and it will work. First, Exim tries a connection via
7127 the Unix domain socket; if that fails, it tries a TCP/IP connection to the
7130 If an explicit &`ldapi`& type is given in a query when a host name is
7131 specified, an error is diagnosed. However, if there are more items in
7132 &%ldap_default_servers%&, they are tried. In other words:
7135 Using a pathname with &`ldap`& or &`ldaps`& forces the use of the Unix domain
7138 Using &`ldapi`& with a host name causes an error.
7142 Using &`ldapi`& with no host or path in the query, and no setting of
7143 &%ldap_default_servers%&, does whatever the library does by default.
7147 .section "LDAP authentication and control information" "SECID70"
7148 .cindex "LDAP" "authentication"
7149 The LDAP URL syntax provides no way of passing authentication and other control
7150 information to the server. To make this possible, the URL in an LDAP query may
7151 be preceded by any number of <&'name'&>=<&'value'&> settings, separated by
7152 spaces. If a value contains spaces it must be enclosed in double quotes, and
7153 when double quotes are used, backslash is interpreted in the usual way inside
7154 them. The following names are recognized:
7156 &`DEREFERENCE`& set the dereferencing parameter
7157 &`NETTIME `& set a timeout for a network operation
7158 &`USER `& set the DN, for authenticating the LDAP bind
7159 &`PASS `& set the password, likewise
7160 &`REFERRALS `& set the referrals parameter
7161 &`SIZE `& set the limit for the number of entries returned
7162 &`TIME `& set the maximum waiting time for a query
7164 The value of the DEREFERENCE parameter must be one of the words &"never"&,
7165 &"searching"&, &"finding"&, or &"always"&. The value of the REFERRALS parameter
7166 must be &"follow"& (the default) or &"nofollow"&. The latter stops the LDAP
7167 library from trying to follow referrals issued by the LDAP server.
7169 The name CONNECT is an obsolete name for NETTIME, retained for
7170 backwards compatibility. This timeout (specified as a number of seconds) is
7171 enforced from the client end for operations that can be carried out over a
7172 network. Specifically, it applies to network connections and calls to the
7173 &'ldap_result()'& function. If the value is greater than zero, it is used if
7174 LDAP_OPT_NETWORK_TIMEOUT is defined in the LDAP headers (OpenLDAP), or
7175 if LDAP_X_OPT_CONNECT_TIMEOUT is defined in the LDAP headers (Netscape
7176 SDK 4.1). A value of zero forces an explicit setting of &"no timeout"& for
7177 Netscape SDK; for OpenLDAP no action is taken.
7179 The TIME parameter (also a number of seconds) is passed to the server to
7180 set a server-side limit on the time taken to complete a search.
7183 Here is an example of an LDAP query in an Exim lookup that uses some of these
7184 values. This is a single line, folded to fit on the page:
7187 {user="cn=manager,o=University of Cambridge,c=UK" pass=secret
7188 ldap:///o=University%20of%20Cambridge,c=UK?sn?sub?(cn=foo)}
7191 The encoding of spaces as &`%20`& is a URL thing which should not be done for
7192 any of the auxiliary data. Exim configuration settings that include lookups
7193 which contain password information should be preceded by &"hide"& to prevent
7194 non-admin users from using the &%-bP%& option to see their values.
7196 The auxiliary data items may be given in any order. The default is no
7197 connection timeout (the system timeout is used), no user or password, no limit
7198 on the number of entries returned, and no time limit on queries.
7200 When a DN is quoted in the USER= setting for LDAP authentication, Exim
7201 removes any URL quoting that it may contain before passing it LDAP. Apparently
7202 some libraries do this for themselves, but some do not. Removing the URL
7203 quoting has two advantages:
7206 It makes it possible to use the same &%quote_ldap_dn%& expansion for USER=
7207 DNs as with DNs inside actual queries.
7209 It permits spaces inside USER= DNs.
7212 For example, a setting such as
7214 USER=cn=${quote_ldap_dn:$1}
7216 should work even if &$1$& contains spaces.
7218 Expanded data for the PASS= value should be quoted using the &%quote%&
7219 expansion operator, rather than the LDAP quote operators. The only reason this
7220 field needs quoting is to ensure that it conforms to the Exim syntax, which
7221 does not allow unquoted spaces. For example:
7225 The LDAP authentication mechanism can be used to check passwords as part of
7226 SMTP authentication. See the &%ldapauth%& expansion string condition in chapter
7231 .section "Format of data returned by LDAP" "SECID71"
7232 .cindex "LDAP" "returned data formats"
7233 The &(ldapdn)& lookup type returns the Distinguished Name from a single entry
7234 as a sequence of values, for example
7236 cn=manager, o=University of Cambridge, c=UK
7238 The &(ldap)& lookup type generates an error if more than one entry matches the
7239 search filter, whereas &(ldapm)& permits this case, and inserts a newline in
7240 the result between the data from different entries. It is possible for multiple
7241 values to be returned for both &(ldap)& and &(ldapm)&, but in the former case
7242 you know that whatever values are returned all came from a single entry in the
7245 In the common case where you specify a single attribute in your LDAP query, the
7246 result is not quoted, and does not contain the attribute name. If the attribute
7247 has multiple values, they are separated by commas.
7249 If you specify multiple attributes, the result contains space-separated, quoted
7250 strings, each preceded by the attribute name and an equals sign. Within the
7251 quotes, the quote character, backslash, and newline are escaped with
7252 backslashes, and commas are used to separate multiple values for the attribute.
7253 Apart from the escaping, the string within quotes takes the same form as the
7254 output when a single attribute is requested. Specifying no attributes is the
7255 same as specifying all of an entry's attributes.
7257 Here are some examples of the output format. The first line of each pair is an
7258 LDAP query, and the second is the data that is returned. The attribute called
7259 &%attr1%& has two values, whereas &%attr2%& has only one value:
7261 ldap:///o=base?attr1?sub?(uid=fred)
7264 ldap:///o=base?attr2?sub?(uid=fred)
7267 ldap:///o=base?attr1,attr2?sub?(uid=fred)
7268 attr1="value1.1, value1.2" attr2="value two"
7270 ldap:///o=base??sub?(uid=fred)
7271 objectClass="top" attr1="value1.1, value1.2" attr2="value two"
7273 The &%extract%& operator in string expansions can be used to pick out
7274 individual fields from data that consists of &'key'&=&'value'& pairs. You can
7275 make use of Exim's &%-be%& option to run expansion tests and thereby check the
7276 results of LDAP lookups.
7281 .section "More about NIS+" "SECTnisplus"
7282 .cindex "NIS+ lookup type"
7283 .cindex "lookup" "NIS+"
7284 NIS+ queries consist of a NIS+ &'indexed name'& followed by an optional colon
7285 and field name. If this is given, the result of a successful query is the
7286 contents of the named field; otherwise the result consists of a concatenation
7287 of &'field-name=field-value'& pairs, separated by spaces. Empty values and
7288 values containing spaces are quoted. For example, the query
7290 [name=mg1456],passwd.org_dir
7292 might return the string
7294 name=mg1456 passwd="" uid=999 gid=999 gcos="Martin Guerre"
7295 home=/home/mg1456 shell=/bin/bash shadow=""
7297 (split over two lines here to fit on the page), whereas
7299 [name=mg1456],passwd.org_dir:gcos
7305 with no quotes. A NIS+ lookup fails if NIS+ returns more than one table entry
7306 for the given indexed key. The effect of the &%quote_nisplus%& expansion
7307 operator is to double any quote characters within the text.
7311 .section "SQL lookups" "SECTsql"
7312 .cindex "SQL lookup types"
7313 .cindex "MySQL" "lookup type"
7314 .cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type"
7315 .cindex "lookup" "MySQL"
7316 .cindex "lookup" "PostgreSQL"
7317 .cindex "Oracle" "lookup type"
7318 .cindex "lookup" "Oracle"
7319 .cindex "InterBase lookup type"
7320 .cindex "lookup" "InterBase"
7321 Exim can support lookups in InterBase, MySQL, Oracle, PostgreSQL, and SQLite
7322 databases. Queries for these databases contain SQL statements, so an example
7325 ${lookup mysql{select mailbox from users where id='userx'}\
7328 If the result of the query contains more than one field, the data for each
7329 field in the row is returned, preceded by its name, so the result of
7331 ${lookup pgsql{select home,name from users where id='userx'}\
7336 home=/home/userx name="Mister X"
7338 Empty values and values containing spaces are double quoted, with embedded
7339 quotes escaped by a backslash. If the result of the query contains just one
7340 field, the value is passed back verbatim, without a field name, for example:
7344 If the result of the query yields more than one row, it is all concatenated,
7345 with a newline between the data for each row.
7348 .section "More about MySQL, PostgreSQL, Oracle, and InterBase" "SECID72"
7349 .cindex "MySQL" "lookup type"
7350 .cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type"
7351 .cindex "lookup" "MySQL"
7352 .cindex "lookup" "PostgreSQL"
7353 .cindex "Oracle" "lookup type"
7354 .cindex "lookup" "Oracle"
7355 .cindex "InterBase lookup type"
7356 .cindex "lookup" "InterBase"
7357 If any MySQL, PostgreSQL, Oracle, or InterBase lookups are used, the
7358 &%mysql_servers%&, &%pgsql_servers%&, &%oracle_servers%&, or &%ibase_servers%&
7359 option (as appropriate) must be set to a colon-separated list of server
7361 (For MySQL and PostgreSQL only, the global option need not be set if all
7362 queries contain their own server information &-- see section
7363 &<<SECTspeserque>>&.) Each item in the list is a slash-separated list of four
7364 items: host name, database name, user name, and password. In the case of
7365 Oracle, the host name field is used for the &"service name"&, and the database
7366 name field is not used and should be empty. For example:
7368 hide oracle_servers = oracle.plc.example//userx/abcdwxyz
7370 Because password data is sensitive, you should always precede the setting with
7371 &"hide"&, to prevent non-admin users from obtaining the setting via the &%-bP%&
7372 option. Here is an example where two MySQL servers are listed:
7374 hide mysql_servers = localhost/users/root/secret:\
7375 otherhost/users/root/othersecret
7377 For MySQL and PostgreSQL, a host may be specified as <&'name'&>:<&'port'&> but
7378 because this is a colon-separated list, the colon has to be doubled. For each
7379 query, these parameter groups are tried in order until a connection is made and
7380 a query is successfully processed. The result of a query may be that no data is
7381 found, but that is still a successful query. In other words, the list of
7382 servers provides a backup facility, not a list of different places to look.
7384 The &%quote_mysql%&, &%quote_pgsql%&, and &%quote_oracle%& expansion operators
7385 convert newline, tab, carriage return, and backspace to \n, \t, \r, and \b
7386 respectively, and the characters single-quote, double-quote, and backslash
7387 itself are escaped with backslashes. The &%quote_pgsql%& expansion operator, in
7388 addition, escapes the percent and underscore characters. This cannot be done
7389 for MySQL because these escapes are not recognized in contexts where these
7390 characters are not special.
7392 .section "Specifying the server in the query" "SECTspeserque"
7393 For MySQL and PostgreSQL lookups (but not currently for Oracle and InterBase),
7394 it is possible to specify a list of servers with an individual query. This is
7395 done by starting the query with
7397 &`servers=`&&'server1:server2:server3:...'&&`;`&
7399 Each item in the list may take one of two forms:
7401 If it contains no slashes it is assumed to be just a host name. The appropriate
7402 global option (&%mysql_servers%& or &%pgsql_servers%&) is searched for a host
7403 of the same name, and the remaining parameters (database, user, password) are
7406 If it contains any slashes, it is taken as a complete parameter set.
7408 The list of servers is used in exactly the same way as the global list.
7409 Once a connection to a server has happened and a query has been
7410 successfully executed, processing of the lookup ceases.
7412 This feature is intended for use in master/slave situations where updates
7413 are occurring and you want to update the master rather than a slave. If the
7414 master is in the list as a backup for reading, you might have a global setting
7417 mysql_servers = slave1/db/name/pw:\
7421 In an updating lookup, you could then write:
7423 ${lookup mysql{servers=master; UPDATE ...} }
7425 That query would then be sent only to the master server. If, on the other hand,
7426 the master is not to be used for reading, and so is not present in the global
7427 option, you can still update it by a query of this form:
7429 ${lookup pgsql{servers=master/db/name/pw; UPDATE ...} }
7433 .section "Special MySQL features" "SECID73"
7434 For MySQL, an empty host name or the use of &"localhost"& in &%mysql_servers%&
7435 causes a connection to the server on the local host by means of a Unix domain
7436 socket. An alternate socket can be specified in parentheses. The full syntax of
7437 each item in &%mysql_servers%& is:
7439 <&'hostname'&>::<&'port'&>(<&'socket name'&>)/<&'database'&>/&&&
7440 <&'user'&>/<&'password'&>
7442 Any of the three sub-parts of the first field can be omitted. For normal use on
7443 the local host it can be left blank or set to just &"localhost"&.
7445 No database need be supplied &-- but if it is absent here, it must be given in
7448 If a MySQL query is issued that does not request any data (an insert, update,
7449 or delete command), the result of the lookup is the number of rows affected.
7451 &*Warning*&: This can be misleading. If an update does not actually change
7452 anything (for example, setting a field to the value it already has), the result
7453 is zero because no rows are affected.
7456 .section "Special PostgreSQL features" "SECID74"
7457 PostgreSQL lookups can also use Unix domain socket connections to the database.
7458 This is usually faster and costs less CPU time than a TCP/IP connection.
7459 However it can be used only if the mail server runs on the same machine as the
7460 database server. A configuration line for PostgreSQL via Unix domain sockets
7463 hide pgsql_servers = (/tmp/.s.PGSQL.5432)/db/user/password : ...
7465 In other words, instead of supplying a host name, a path to the socket is
7466 given. The path name is enclosed in parentheses so that its slashes aren't
7467 visually confused with the delimiters for the other server parameters.
7469 If a PostgreSQL query is issued that does not request any data (an insert,
7470 update, or delete command), the result of the lookup is the number of rows
7473 .section "More about SQLite" "SECTsqlite"
7474 .cindex "lookup" "SQLite"
7475 .cindex "sqlite lookup type"
7476 SQLite is different to the other SQL lookups because a file name is required in
7477 addition to the SQL query. An SQLite database is a single file, and there is no
7478 daemon as in the other SQL databases. The interface to Exim requires the name
7479 of the file, as an absolute path, to be given at the start of the query. It is
7480 separated from the query by white space. This means that the path name cannot
7481 contain white space. Here is a lookup expansion example:
7483 ${lookup sqlite {/some/thing/sqlitedb \
7484 select name from aliases where id='userx';}}
7486 In a list, the syntax is similar. For example:
7488 domainlist relay_domains = sqlite;/some/thing/sqlitedb \
7489 select * from relays where ip='$sender_host_address';
7491 The only character affected by the &%quote_sqlite%& operator is a single
7492 quote, which it doubles.
7494 The SQLite library handles multiple simultaneous accesses to the database
7495 internally. Multiple readers are permitted, but only one process can
7496 update at once. Attempts to access the database while it is being updated
7497 are rejected after a timeout period, during which the SQLite library
7498 waits for the lock to be released. In Exim, the default timeout is set
7499 to 5 seconds, but it can be changed by means of the &%sqlite_lock_timeout%&
7505 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
7506 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
7508 .chapter "Domain, host, address, and local part lists" &&&
7509 "CHAPdomhosaddlists" &&&
7510 "Domain, host, and address lists"
7511 .scindex IIDdohoadli "lists of domains; hosts; etc."
7512 A number of Exim configuration options contain lists of domains, hosts,
7513 email addresses, or local parts. For example, the &%hold_domains%& option
7514 contains a list of domains whose delivery is currently suspended. These lists
7515 are also used as data in ACL statements (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&), and as
7516 arguments to expansion conditions such as &%match_domain%&.
7518 Each item in one of these lists is a pattern to be matched against a domain,
7519 host, email address, or local part, respectively. In the sections below, the
7520 different types of pattern for each case are described, but first we cover some
7521 general facilities that apply to all four kinds of list.
7525 .section "Expansion of lists" "SECID75"
7526 .cindex "expansion" "of lists"
7527 Each list is expanded as a single string before it is used. The result of
7528 expansion must be a list, possibly containing empty items, which is split up
7529 into separate items for matching. By default, colon is the separator character,
7530 but this can be varied if necessary. See sections &<<SECTlistconstruct>>& and
7531 &<<SECTempitelis>>& for details of the list syntax; the second of these
7532 discusses the way to specify empty list items.
7535 If the string expansion is forced to fail, Exim behaves as if the item it is
7536 testing (domain, host, address, or local part) is not in the list. Other
7537 expansion failures cause temporary errors.
7539 If an item in a list is a regular expression, backslashes, dollars and possibly
7540 other special characters in the expression must be protected against
7541 misinterpretation by the string expander. The easiest way to do this is to use
7542 the &`\N`& expansion feature to indicate that the contents of the regular
7543 expression should not be expanded. For example, in an ACL you might have:
7545 deny senders = \N^\d{8}\w@.*\.baddomain\.example$\N : \
7546 ${lookup{$domain}lsearch{/badsenders/bydomain}}
7548 The first item is a regular expression that is protected from expansion by
7549 &`\N`&, whereas the second uses the expansion to obtain a list of unwanted
7550 senders based on the receiving domain.
7555 .section "Negated items in lists" "SECID76"
7556 .cindex "list" "negation"
7557 .cindex "negation" "in lists"
7558 Items in a list may be positive or negative. Negative items are indicated by a
7559 leading exclamation mark, which may be followed by optional white space. A list
7560 defines a set of items (domains, etc). When Exim processes one of these lists,
7561 it is trying to find out whether a domain, host, address, or local part
7562 (respectively) is in the set that is defined by the list. It works like this:
7564 The list is scanned from left to right. If a positive item is matched, the
7565 subject that is being checked is in the set; if a negative item is matched, the
7566 subject is not in the set. If the end of the list is reached without the
7567 subject having matched any of the patterns, it is in the set if the last item
7568 was a negative one, but not if it was a positive one. For example, the list in
7570 domainlist relay_domains = !a.b.c : *.b.c
7572 matches any domain ending in &'.b.c'& except for &'a.b.c'&. Domains that match
7573 neither &'a.b.c'& nor &'*.b.c'& do not match, because the last item in the
7574 list is positive. However, if the setting were
7576 domainlist relay_domains = !a.b.c
7578 then all domains other than &'a.b.c'& would match because the last item in the
7579 list is negative. In other words, a list that ends with a negative item behaves
7580 as if it had an extra item &`:*`& on the end.
7582 Another way of thinking about positive and negative items in lists is to read
7583 the connector as &"or"& after a positive item and as &"and"& after a negative
7588 .section "File names in lists" "SECTfilnamlis"
7589 .cindex "list" "file name in"
7590 If an item in a domain, host, address, or local part list is an absolute file
7591 name (beginning with a slash character), each line of the file is read and
7592 processed as if it were an independent item in the list, except that further
7593 file names are not allowed,
7594 and no expansion of the data from the file takes place.
7595 Empty lines in the file are ignored, and the file may also contain comment
7599 For domain and host lists, if a # character appears anywhere in a line of the
7600 file, it and all following characters are ignored.
7602 Because local parts may legitimately contain # characters, a comment in an
7603 address list or local part list file is recognized only if # is preceded by
7604 white space or the start of the line. For example:
7606 not#comment@x.y.z # but this is a comment
7610 Putting a file name in a list has the same effect as inserting each line of the
7611 file as an item in the list (blank lines and comments excepted). However, there
7612 is one important difference: the file is read each time the list is processed,
7613 so if its contents vary over time, Exim's behaviour changes.
7615 If a file name is preceded by an exclamation mark, the sense of any match
7616 within the file is inverted. For example, if
7618 hold_domains = !/etc/nohold-domains
7620 and the file contains the lines
7625 then &'a.b.c'& is in the set of domains defined by &%hold_domains%&, whereas
7626 any domain matching &`*.b.c`& is not.
7630 .section "An lsearch file is not an out-of-line list" "SECID77"
7631 As will be described in the sections that follow, lookups can be used in lists
7632 to provide indexed methods of checking list membership. There has been some
7633 confusion about the way &(lsearch)& lookups work in lists. Because
7634 an &(lsearch)& file contains plain text and is scanned sequentially, it is
7635 sometimes thought that it is allowed to contain wild cards and other kinds of
7636 non-constant pattern. This is not the case. The keys in an &(lsearch)& file are
7637 always fixed strings, just as for any other single-key lookup type.
7639 If you want to use a file to contain wild-card patterns that form part of a
7640 list, just give the file name on its own, without a search type, as described
7641 in the previous section. You could also use the &(wildlsearch)& or
7642 &(nwildlsearch)&, but there is no advantage in doing this.
7647 .section "Named lists" "SECTnamedlists"
7648 .cindex "named lists"
7649 .cindex "list" "named"
7650 A list of domains, hosts, email addresses, or local parts can be given a name
7651 which is then used to refer to the list elsewhere in the configuration. This is
7652 particularly convenient if the same list is required in several different
7653 places. It also allows lists to be given meaningful names, which can improve
7654 the readability of the configuration. For example, it is conventional to define
7655 a domain list called &'local_domains'& for all the domains that are handled
7656 locally on a host, using a configuration line such as
7658 domainlist local_domains = localhost:my.dom.example
7660 Named lists are referenced by giving their name preceded by a plus sign, so,
7661 for example, a router that is intended to handle local domains would be
7662 configured with the line
7664 domains = +local_domains
7666 The first router in a configuration is often one that handles all domains
7667 except the local ones, using a configuration with a negated item like this:
7671 domains = ! +local_domains
7672 transport = remote_smtp
7675 The four kinds of named list are created by configuration lines starting with
7676 the words &%domainlist%&, &%hostlist%&, &%addresslist%&, or &%localpartlist%&,
7677 respectively. Then there follows the name that you are defining, followed by an
7678 equals sign and the list itself. For example:
7680 hostlist relay_hosts = 192.168.23.0/24 : my.friend.example
7681 addresslist bad_senders = cdb;/etc/badsenders
7683 A named list may refer to other named lists:
7685 domainlist dom1 = first.example : second.example
7686 domainlist dom2 = +dom1 : third.example
7687 domainlist dom3 = fourth.example : +dom2 : fifth.example
7689 &*Warning*&: If the last item in a referenced list is a negative one, the
7690 effect may not be what you intended, because the negation does not propagate
7691 out to the higher level. For example, consider:
7693 domainlist dom1 = !a.b
7694 domainlist dom2 = +dom1 : *.b
7696 The second list specifies &"either in the &%dom1%& list or &'*.b'&"&. The first
7697 list specifies just &"not &'a.b'&"&, so the domain &'x.y'& matches it. That
7698 means it matches the second list as well. The effect is not the same as
7700 domainlist dom2 = !a.b : *.b
7702 where &'x.y'& does not match. It's best to avoid negation altogether in
7703 referenced lists if you can.
7705 Named lists may have a performance advantage. When Exim is routing an
7706 address or checking an incoming message, it caches the result of tests on named
7707 lists. So, if you have a setting such as
7709 domains = +local_domains
7711 on several of your routers
7712 or in several ACL statements,
7713 the actual test is done only for the first one. However, the caching works only
7714 if there are no expansions within the list itself or any sublists that it
7715 references. In other words, caching happens only for lists that are known to be
7716 the same each time they are referenced.
7718 By default, there may be up to 16 named lists of each type. This limit can be
7719 extended by changing a compile-time variable. The use of domain and host lists
7720 is recommended for concepts such as local domains, relay domains, and relay
7721 hosts. The default configuration is set up like this.
7725 .section "Named lists compared with macros" "SECID78"
7726 .cindex "list" "named compared with macro"
7727 .cindex "macro" "compared with named list"
7728 At first sight, named lists might seem to be no different from macros in the
7729 configuration file. However, macros are just textual substitutions. If you
7732 ALIST = host1 : host2
7733 auth_advertise_hosts = !ALIST
7735 it probably won't do what you want, because that is exactly the same as
7737 auth_advertise_hosts = !host1 : host2
7739 Notice that the second host name is not negated. However, if you use a host
7742 hostlist alist = host1 : host2
7743 auth_advertise_hosts = ! +alist
7745 the negation applies to the whole list, and so that is equivalent to
7747 auth_advertise_hosts = !host1 : !host2
7751 .section "Named list caching" "SECID79"
7752 .cindex "list" "caching of named"
7753 .cindex "caching" "named lists"
7754 While processing a message, Exim caches the result of checking a named list if
7755 it is sure that the list is the same each time. In practice, this means that
7756 the cache operates only if the list contains no $ characters, which guarantees
7757 that it will not change when it is expanded. Sometimes, however, you may have
7758 an expanded list that you know will be the same each time within a given
7759 message. For example:
7761 domainlist special_domains = \
7762 ${lookup{$sender_host_address}cdb{/some/file}}
7764 This provides a list of domains that depends only on the sending host's IP
7765 address. If this domain list is referenced a number of times (for example,
7766 in several ACL lines, or in several routers) the result of the check is not
7767 cached by default, because Exim does not know that it is going to be the
7768 same list each time.
7770 By appending &`_cache`& to &`domainlist`& you can tell Exim to go ahead and
7771 cache the result anyway. For example:
7773 domainlist_cache special_domains = ${lookup{...
7775 If you do this, you should be absolutely sure that caching is going to do
7776 the right thing in all cases. When in doubt, leave it out.
7780 .section "Domain lists" "SECTdomainlist"
7781 .cindex "domain list" "patterns for"
7782 .cindex "list" "domain list"
7783 Domain lists contain patterns that are to be matched against a mail domain.
7784 The following types of item may appear in domain lists:
7787 .cindex "primary host name"
7788 .cindex "host name" "matched in domain list"
7789 .oindex "&%primary_hostname%&"
7790 .cindex "domain list" "matching primary host name"
7791 .cindex "@ in a domain list"
7792 If a pattern consists of a single @ character, it matches the local host name,
7793 as set by the &%primary_hostname%& option (or defaulted). This makes it
7794 possible to use the same configuration file on several different hosts that
7795 differ only in their names.
7797 .cindex "@[] in a domain list"
7798 .cindex "domain list" "matching local IP interfaces"
7799 .cindex "domain literal"
7800 If a pattern consists of the string &`@[]`& it matches an IP address enclosed
7801 in square brackets (as in an email address that contains a domain literal), but
7802 only if that IP address is recognized as local for email routing purposes. The
7803 &%local_interfaces%& and &%extra_local_interfaces%& options can be used to
7804 control which of a host's several IP addresses are treated as local.
7805 In today's Internet, the use of domain literals is controversial.
7808 .cindex "@mx_primary"
7809 .cindex "@mx_secondary"
7810 .cindex "domain list" "matching MX pointers to local host"
7811 If a pattern consists of the string &`@mx_any`& it matches any domain that
7812 has an MX record pointing to the local host or to any host that is listed in
7813 .oindex "&%hosts_treat_as_local%&"
7814 &%hosts_treat_as_local%&. The items &`@mx_primary`& and &`@mx_secondary`&
7815 are similar, except that the first matches only when a primary MX target is the
7816 local host, and the second only when no primary MX target is the local host,
7817 but a secondary MX target is. &"Primary"& means an MX record with the lowest
7818 preference value &-- there may of course be more than one of them.
7820 The MX lookup that takes place when matching a pattern of this type is
7821 performed with the resolver options for widening names turned off. Thus, for
7822 example, a single-component domain will &'not'& be expanded by adding the
7823 resolver's default domain. See the &%qualify_single%& and &%search_parents%&
7824 options of the &(dnslookup)& router for a discussion of domain widening.
7826 Sometimes you may want to ignore certain IP addresses when using one of these
7827 patterns. You can specify this by following the pattern with &`/ignore=`&<&'ip
7828 list'&>, where <&'ip list'&> is a list of IP addresses. These addresses are
7829 ignored when processing the pattern (compare the &%ignore_target_hosts%& option
7830 on a router). For example:
7832 domains = @mx_any/ignore=127.0.0.1
7834 This example matches any domain that has an MX record pointing to one of
7835 the local host's IP addresses other than 127.0.0.1.
7837 The list of IP addresses is in fact processed by the same code that processes
7838 host lists, so it may contain CIDR-coded network specifications and it may also
7839 contain negative items.
7841 Because the list of IP addresses is a sublist within a domain list, you have to
7842 be careful about delimiters if there is more than one address. Like any other
7843 list, the default delimiter can be changed. Thus, you might have:
7845 domains = @mx_any/ignore=<;127.0.0.1;0.0.0.0 : \
7846 an.other.domain : ...
7848 so that the sublist uses semicolons for delimiters. When IPv6 addresses are
7849 involved, it is easiest to change the delimiter for the main list as well:
7851 domains = <? @mx_any/ignore=<;127.0.0.1;::1 ? \
7852 an.other.domain ? ...
7855 .cindex "asterisk" "in domain list"
7856 .cindex "domain list" "asterisk in"
7857 .cindex "domain list" "matching &""ends with""&"
7858 If a pattern starts with an asterisk, the remaining characters of the pattern
7859 are compared with the terminating characters of the domain. The use of &"*"& in
7860 domain lists differs from its use in partial matching lookups. In a domain
7861 list, the character following the asterisk need not be a dot, whereas partial
7862 matching works only in terms of dot-separated components. For example, a domain
7863 list item such as &`*key.ex`& matches &'donkey.ex'& as well as
7867 .cindex "regular expressions" "in domain list"
7868 .cindex "domain list" "matching regular expression"
7869 If a pattern starts with a circumflex character, it is treated as a regular
7870 expression, and matched against the domain using a regular expression matching
7871 function. The circumflex is treated as part of the regular expression.
7872 Email domains are case-independent, so this regular expression match is by
7873 default case-independent, but you can make it case-dependent by starting it
7874 with &`(?-i)`&. References to descriptions of the syntax of regular expressions
7875 are given in chapter &<<CHAPregexp>>&.
7877 &*Warning*&: Because domain lists are expanded before being processed, you
7878 must escape any backslash and dollar characters in the regular expression, or
7879 use the special &`\N`& sequence (see chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&) to specify that
7880 it is not to be expanded (unless you really do want to build a regular
7881 expression by expansion, of course).
7883 .cindex "lookup" "in domain list"
7884 .cindex "domain list" "matching by lookup"
7885 If a pattern starts with the name of a single-key lookup type followed by a
7886 semicolon (for example, &"dbm;"& or &"lsearch;"&), the remainder of the pattern
7887 must be a file name in a suitable format for the lookup type. For example, for
7888 &"cdb;"& it must be an absolute path:
7890 domains = cdb;/etc/mail/local_domains.cdb
7892 The appropriate type of lookup is done on the file using the domain name as the
7893 key. In most cases, the data that is looked up is not used; Exim is interested
7894 only in whether or not the key is present in the file. However, when a lookup
7895 is used for the &%domains%& option on a router
7896 or a &%domains%& condition in an ACL statement, the data is preserved in the
7897 &$domain_data$& variable and can be referred to in other router options or
7898 other statements in the same ACL.
7901 Any of the single-key lookup type names may be preceded by
7902 &`partial`&<&'n'&>&`-`&, where the <&'n'&> is optional, for example,
7904 domains = partial-dbm;/partial/domains
7906 This causes partial matching logic to be invoked; a description of how this
7907 works is given in section &<<SECTpartiallookup>>&.
7910 .cindex "asterisk" "in lookup type"
7911 Any of the single-key lookup types may be followed by an asterisk. This causes
7912 a default lookup for a key consisting of a single asterisk to be done if the
7913 original lookup fails. This is not a useful feature when using a domain list to
7914 select particular domains (because any domain would match), but it might have
7915 value if the result of the lookup is being used via the &$domain_data$&
7918 If the pattern starts with the name of a query-style lookup type followed by a
7919 semicolon (for example, &"nisplus;"& or &"ldap;"&), the remainder of the
7920 pattern must be an appropriate query for the lookup type, as described in
7921 chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&. For example:
7923 hold_domains = mysql;select domain from holdlist \
7924 where domain = '${quote_mysql:$domain}';
7926 In most cases, the data that is looked up is not used (so for an SQL query, for
7927 example, it doesn't matter what field you select). Exim is interested only in
7928 whether or not the query succeeds. However, when a lookup is used for the
7929 &%domains%& option on a router, the data is preserved in the &$domain_data$&
7930 variable and can be referred to in other options.
7932 .cindex "domain list" "matching literal domain name"
7933 If none of the above cases apply, a caseless textual comparison is made
7934 between the pattern and the domain.
7937 Here is an example that uses several different kinds of pattern:
7939 domainlist funny_domains = \
7942 *.foundation.fict.example : \
7943 \N^[1-2]\d{3}\.fict\.example$\N : \
7944 partial-dbm;/opt/data/penguin/book : \
7945 nis;domains.byname : \
7946 nisplus;[name=$domain,status=local],domains.org_dir
7948 There are obvious processing trade-offs among the various matching modes. Using
7949 an asterisk is faster than a regular expression, and listing a few names
7950 explicitly probably is too. The use of a file or database lookup is expensive,
7951 but may be the only option if hundreds of names are required. Because the
7952 patterns are tested in order, it makes sense to put the most commonly matched
7957 .section "Host lists" "SECThostlist"
7958 .cindex "host list" "patterns in"
7959 .cindex "list" "host list"
7960 Host lists are used to control what remote hosts are allowed to do. For
7961 example, some hosts may be allowed to use the local host as a relay, and some
7962 may be permitted to use the SMTP ETRN command. Hosts can be identified in
7963 two different ways, by name or by IP address. In a host list, some types of
7964 pattern are matched to a host name, and some are matched to an IP address.
7965 You need to be particularly careful with this when single-key lookups are
7966 involved, to ensure that the right value is being used as the key.
7969 .section "Special host list patterns" "SECID80"
7970 .cindex "empty item in hosts list"
7971 .cindex "host list" "empty string in"
7972 If a host list item is the empty string, it matches only when no remote host is
7973 involved. This is the case when a message is being received from a local
7974 process using SMTP on the standard input, that is, when a TCP/IP connection is
7977 .cindex "asterisk" "in host list"
7978 The special pattern &"*"& in a host list matches any host or no host. Neither
7979 the IP address nor the name is actually inspected.
7983 .section "Host list patterns that match by IP address" "SECThoslispatip"
7984 .cindex "host list" "matching IP addresses"
7985 If an IPv4 host calls an IPv6 host and the call is accepted on an IPv6 socket,
7986 the incoming address actually appears in the IPv6 host as
7987 &`::ffff:`&<&'v4address'&>. When such an address is tested against a host
7988 list, it is converted into a traditional IPv4 address first. (Not all operating
7989 systems accept IPv4 calls on IPv6 sockets, as there have been some security
7992 The following types of pattern in a host list check the remote host by
7993 inspecting its IP address:
7996 If the pattern is a plain domain name (not a regular expression, not starting
7997 with *, not a lookup of any kind), Exim calls the operating system function
7998 to find the associated IP address(es). Exim uses the newer
7999 &[getipnodebyname()]& function when available, otherwise &[gethostbyname()]&.
8000 This typically causes a forward DNS lookup of the name. The result is compared
8001 with the IP address of the subject host.
8003 If there is a temporary problem (such as a DNS timeout) with the host name
8004 lookup, a temporary error occurs. For example, if the list is being used in an
8005 ACL condition, the ACL gives a &"defer"& response, usually leading to a
8006 temporary SMTP error code. If no IP address can be found for the host name,
8007 what happens is described in section &<<SECTbehipnot>>& below.
8010 .cindex "@ in a host list"
8011 If the pattern is &"@"&, the primary host name is substituted and used as a
8012 domain name, as just described.
8015 If the pattern is an IP address, it is matched against the IP address of the
8016 subject host. IPv4 addresses are given in the normal &"dotted-quad"& notation.
8017 IPv6 addresses can be given in colon-separated format, but the colons have to
8018 be doubled so as not to be taken as item separators when the default list
8019 separator is used. IPv6 addresses are recognized even when Exim is compiled
8020 without IPv6 support. This means that if they appear in a host list on an
8021 IPv4-only host, Exim will not treat them as host names. They are just addresses
8022 that can never match a client host.
8025 .cindex "@[] in a host list"
8026 If the pattern is &"@[]"&, it matches the IP address of any IP interface on
8027 the local host. For example, if the local host is an IPv4 host with one
8028 interface address 10.45.23.56, these two ACL statements have the same effect:
8030 accept hosts = 127.0.0.1 : 10.45.23.56
8034 .cindex "CIDR notation"
8035 If the pattern is an IP address followed by a slash and a mask length (for
8036 example 10.11.42.0/24), it is matched against the IP address of the subject
8037 host under the given mask. This allows, an entire network of hosts to be
8038 included (or excluded) by a single item. The mask uses CIDR notation; it
8039 specifies the number of address bits that must match, starting from the most
8040 significant end of the address.
8042 &*Note*&: The mask is &'not'& a count of addresses, nor is it the high number
8043 of a range of addresses. It is the number of bits in the network portion of the
8044 address. The above example specifies a 24-bit netmask, so it matches all 256
8045 addresses in the 10.11.42.0 network. An item such as
8049 matches just two addresses, 192.168.23.236 and 192.168.23.237. A mask value of
8050 32 for an IPv4 address is the same as no mask at all; just a single address
8053 Here is another example which shows an IPv4 and an IPv6 network:
8055 recipient_unqualified_hosts = 192.168.0.0/16: \
8056 3ffe::ffff::836f::::/48
8058 The doubling of list separator characters applies only when these items
8059 appear inline in a host list. It is not required when indirecting via a file.
8062 recipient_unqualified_hosts = /opt/exim/unqualnets
8064 could make use of a file containing
8069 to have exactly the same effect as the previous example. When listing IPv6
8070 addresses inline, it is usually more convenient to use the facility for
8071 changing separator characters. This list contains the same two networks:
8073 recipient_unqualified_hosts = <; 172.16.0.0/12; \
8076 The separator is changed to semicolon by the leading &"<;"& at the start of the
8082 .section "Host list patterns for single-key lookups by host address" &&&
8083 "SECThoslispatsikey"
8084 .cindex "host list" "lookup of IP address"
8085 When a host is to be identified by a single-key lookup of its complete IP
8086 address, the pattern takes this form:
8088 &`net-<`&&'single-key-search-type'&&`>;<`&&'search-data'&&`>`&
8092 hosts_lookup = net-cdb;/hosts-by-ip.db
8094 The text form of the IP address of the subject host is used as the lookup key.
8095 IPv6 addresses are converted to an unabbreviated form, using lower case
8096 letters, with dots as separators because colon is the key terminator in
8097 &(lsearch)& files. [Colons can in fact be used in keys in &(lsearch)& files by
8098 quoting the keys, but this is a facility that was added later.] The data
8099 returned by the lookup is not used.
8101 .cindex "IP address" "masking"
8102 .cindex "host list" "masked IP address"
8103 Single-key lookups can also be performed using masked IP addresses, using
8104 patterns of this form:
8106 &`net<`&&'number'&&`>-<`&&'single-key-search-type'&&`>;<`&&'search-data'&&`>`&
8110 net24-dbm;/networks.db
8112 The IP address of the subject host is masked using <&'number'&> as the mask
8113 length. A textual string is constructed from the masked value, followed by the
8114 mask, and this is used as the lookup key. For example, if the host's IP address
8115 is 192.168.34.6, the key that is looked up for the above example is
8116 &"192.168.34.0/24"&.
8118 When an IPv6 address is converted to a string, dots are normally used instead
8119 of colons, so that keys in &(lsearch)& files need not contain colons (which
8120 terminate &(lsearch)& keys). This was implemented some time before the ability
8121 to quote keys was made available in &(lsearch)& files. However, the more
8122 recently implemented &(iplsearch)& files do require colons in IPv6 keys
8123 (notated using the quoting facility) so as to distinguish them from IPv4 keys.
8124 For this reason, when the lookup type is &(iplsearch)&, IPv6 addresses are
8125 converted using colons and not dots. In all cases, full, unabbreviated IPv6
8126 addresses are always used.
8128 Ideally, it would be nice to tidy up this anomalous situation by changing to
8129 colons in all cases, given that quoting is now available for &(lsearch)&.
8130 However, this would be an incompatible change that might break some existing
8133 &*Warning*&: Specifying &%net32-%& (for an IPv4 address) or &%net128-%& (for an
8134 IPv6 address) is not the same as specifying just &%net-%& without a number. In
8135 the former case the key strings include the mask value, whereas in the latter
8136 case the IP address is used on its own.
8140 .section "Host list patterns that match by host name" "SECThoslispatnam"
8141 .cindex "host" "lookup failures"
8142 .cindex "unknown host name"
8143 .cindex "host list" "matching host name"
8144 There are several types of pattern that require Exim to know the name of the
8145 remote host. These are either wildcard patterns or lookups by name. (If a
8146 complete hostname is given without any wildcarding, it is used to find an IP
8147 address to match against, as described in the section &<<SECThoslispatip>>&
8150 If the remote host name is not already known when Exim encounters one of these
8151 patterns, it has to be found from the IP address.
8152 Although many sites on the Internet are conscientious about maintaining reverse
8153 DNS data for their hosts, there are also many that do not do this.
8154 Consequently, a name cannot always be found, and this may lead to unwanted
8155 effects. Take care when configuring host lists with wildcarded name patterns.
8156 Consider what will happen if a name cannot be found.
8158 Because of the problems of determining host names from IP addresses, matching
8159 against host names is not as common as matching against IP addresses.
8161 By default, in order to find a host name, Exim first does a reverse DNS lookup;
8162 if no name is found in the DNS, the system function (&[gethostbyaddr()]& or
8163 &[getipnodebyaddr()]& if available) is tried. The order in which these lookups
8164 are done can be changed by setting the &%host_lookup_order%& option. For
8165 security, once Exim has found one or more names, it looks up the IP addresses
8166 for these names and compares them with the IP address that it started with.
8167 Only those names whose IP addresses match are accepted. Any other names are
8168 discarded. If no names are left, Exim behaves as if the host name cannot be
8169 found. In the most common case there is only one name and one IP address.
8171 There are some options that control what happens if a host name cannot be
8172 found. These are described in section &<<SECTbehipnot>>& below.
8174 .cindex "host" "alias for"
8175 .cindex "alias for host"
8176 As a result of aliasing, hosts may have more than one name. When processing any
8177 of the following types of pattern, all the host's names are checked:
8180 .cindex "asterisk" "in host list"
8181 If a pattern starts with &"*"& the remainder of the item must match the end of
8182 the host name. For example, &`*.b.c`& matches all hosts whose names end in
8183 &'.b.c'&. This special simple form is provided because this is a very common
8184 requirement. Other kinds of wildcarding require the use of a regular
8187 .cindex "regular expressions" "in host list"
8188 .cindex "host list" "regular expression in"
8189 If the item starts with &"^"& it is taken to be a regular expression which is
8190 matched against the host name. Host names are case-independent, so this regular
8191 expression match is by default case-independent, but you can make it
8192 case-dependent by starting it with &`(?-i)`&. References to descriptions of the
8193 syntax of regular expressions are given in chapter &<<CHAPregexp>>&. For
8198 is a regular expression that matches either of the two hosts &'a.c.d'& or
8199 &'b.c.d'&. When a regular expression is used in a host list, you must take care
8200 that backslash and dollar characters are not misinterpreted as part of the
8201 string expansion. The simplest way to do this is to use &`\N`& to mark that
8202 part of the string as non-expandable. For example:
8204 sender_unqualified_hosts = \N^(a|b)\.c\.d$\N : ....
8206 &*Warning*&: If you want to match a complete host name, you must include the
8207 &`$`& terminating metacharacter in the regular expression, as in the above
8208 example. Without it, a match at the start of the host name is all that is
8215 .section "Behaviour when an IP address or name cannot be found" "SECTbehipnot"
8216 .cindex "host" "lookup failures, permanent"
8217 While processing a host list, Exim may need to look up an IP address from a
8218 name (see section &<<SECThoslispatip>>&), or it may need to look up a host name
8219 from an IP address (see section &<<SECThoslispatnam>>&). In either case, the
8220 behaviour when it fails to find the information it is seeking is the same.
8222 &*Note*&: This section applies to permanent lookup failures. It does &'not'&
8223 apply to temporary DNS errors, whose handling is described in the next section.
8225 .cindex "&`+include_unknown`&"
8226 .cindex "&`+ignore_unknown`&"
8227 By default, Exim behaves as if the host does not match the list. This may not
8228 always be what you want to happen. To change Exim's behaviour, the special
8229 items &`+include_unknown`& or &`+ignore_unknown`& may appear in the list (at
8230 top level &-- they are not recognized in an indirected file).
8233 If any item that follows &`+include_unknown`& requires information that
8234 cannot found, Exim behaves as if the host does match the list. For example,
8236 host_reject_connection = +include_unknown:*.enemy.ex
8238 rejects connections from any host whose name matches &`*.enemy.ex`&, and also
8239 any hosts whose name it cannot find.
8242 If any item that follows &`+ignore_unknown`& requires information that cannot
8243 be found, Exim ignores that item and proceeds to the rest of the list. For
8246 accept hosts = +ignore_unknown : friend.example : \
8249 accepts from any host whose name is &'friend.example'& and from 192.168.4.5,
8250 whether or not its host name can be found. Without &`+ignore_unknown`&, if no
8251 name can be found for 192.168.4.5, it is rejected.
8254 Both &`+include_unknown`& and &`+ignore_unknown`& may appear in the same
8255 list. The effect of each one lasts until the next, or until the end of the
8259 .section "Temporary DNS errors when looking up host information" &&&
8261 .cindex "host" "lookup failures, temporary"
8262 .cindex "&`+include_defer`&"
8263 .cindex "&`+ignore_defer`&"
8264 A temporary DNS lookup failure normally causes a defer action (except when
8265 &%dns_again_means_nonexist%& converts it into a permanent error). However,
8266 host lists can include &`+ignore_defer`& and &`+include_defer`&, analagous to
8267 &`+ignore_unknown`& and &`+include_unknown`&, as described in the previous
8268 section. These options should be used with care, probably only in non-critical
8269 host lists such as whitelists.
8273 .section "Host list patterns for single-key lookups by host name" &&&
8274 "SECThoslispatnamsk"
8275 .cindex "unknown host name"
8276 .cindex "host list" "matching host name"
8277 If a pattern is of the form
8279 <&'single-key-search-type'&>;<&'search-data'&>
8283 dbm;/host/accept/list
8285 a single-key lookup is performed, using the host name as its key. If the
8286 lookup succeeds, the host matches the item. The actual data that is looked up
8289 &*Reminder*&: With this kind of pattern, you must have host &'names'& as
8290 keys in the file, not IP addresses. If you want to do lookups based on IP
8291 addresses, you must precede the search type with &"net-"& (see section
8292 &<<SECThoslispatsikey>>&). There is, however, no reason why you could not use
8293 two items in the same list, one doing an address lookup and one doing a name
8294 lookup, both using the same file.
8298 .section "Host list patterns for query-style lookups" "SECID81"
8299 If a pattern is of the form
8301 <&'query-style-search-type'&>;<&'query'&>
8303 the query is obeyed, and if it succeeds, the host matches the item. The actual
8304 data that is looked up is not used. The variables &$sender_host_address$& and
8305 &$sender_host_name$& can be used in the query. For example:
8307 hosts_lookup = pgsql;\
8308 select ip from hostlist where ip='$sender_host_address'
8310 The value of &$sender_host_address$& for an IPv6 address contains colons. You
8311 can use the &%sg%& expansion item to change this if you need to. If you want to
8312 use masked IP addresses in database queries, you can use the &%mask%& expansion
8315 If the query contains a reference to &$sender_host_name$&, Exim automatically
8316 looks up the host name if has not already done so. (See section
8317 &<<SECThoslispatnam>>& for comments on finding host names.)
8319 Historical note: prior to release 4.30, Exim would always attempt to find a
8320 host name before running the query, unless the search type was preceded by
8321 &`net-`&. This is no longer the case. For backwards compatibility, &`net-`& is
8322 still recognized for query-style lookups, but its presence or absence has no
8323 effect. (Of course, for single-key lookups, &`net-`& &'is'& important.
8324 See section &<<SECThoslispatsikey>>&.)
8328 .section "Mixing wildcarded host names and addresses in host lists" &&&
8330 .cindex "host list" "mixing names and addresses in"
8331 If you have name lookups or wildcarded host names and IP addresses in the same
8332 host list, you should normally put the IP addresses first. For example, in an
8335 accept hosts = 10.9.8.7 : *.friend.example
8337 The reason for this lies in the left-to-right way that Exim processes lists.
8338 It can test IP addresses without doing any DNS lookups, but when it reaches an
8339 item that requires a host name, it fails if it cannot find a host name to
8340 compare with the pattern. If the above list is given in the opposite order, the
8341 &%accept%& statement fails for a host whose name cannot be found, even if its
8342 IP address is 10.9.8.7.
8344 If you really do want to do the name check first, and still recognize the IP
8345 address, you can rewrite the ACL like this:
8347 accept hosts = *.friend.example
8348 accept hosts = 10.9.8.7
8350 If the first &%accept%& fails, Exim goes on to try the second one. See chapter
8351 &<<CHAPACL>>& for details of ACLs.
8357 .section "Address lists" "SECTaddresslist"
8358 .cindex "list" "address list"
8359 .cindex "address list" "empty item"
8360 .cindex "address list" "patterns"
8361 Address lists contain patterns that are matched against mail addresses. There
8362 is one special case to be considered: the sender address of a bounce message is
8363 always empty. You can test for this by providing an empty item in an address
8364 list. For example, you can set up a router to process bounce messages by
8365 using this option setting:
8369 The presence of the colon creates an empty item. If you do not provide any
8370 data, the list is empty and matches nothing. The empty sender can also be
8371 detected by a regular expression that matches an empty string,
8372 and by a query-style lookup that succeeds when &$sender_address$& is empty.
8374 Non-empty items in an address list can be straightforward email addresses. For
8377 senders = jbc@askone.example : hs@anacreon.example
8379 A certain amount of wildcarding is permitted. If a pattern contains an @
8380 character, but is not a regular expression and does not begin with a
8381 semicolon-terminated lookup type (described below), the local part of the
8382 subject address is compared with the local part of the pattern, which may start
8383 with an asterisk. If the local parts match, the domain is checked in exactly
8384 the same way as for a pattern in a domain list. For example, the domain can be
8385 wildcarded, refer to a named list, or be a lookup:
8387 deny senders = *@*.spamming.site:\
8388 *@+hostile_domains:\
8389 bozo@partial-lsearch;/list/of/dodgy/sites:\
8390 *@dbm;/bad/domains.db
8392 .cindex "local part" "starting with !"
8393 .cindex "address list" "local part starting with !"
8394 If a local part that begins with an exclamation mark is required, it has to be
8395 specified using a regular expression, because otherwise the exclamation mark is
8396 treated as a sign of negation, as is standard in lists.
8398 If a non-empty pattern that is not a regular expression or a lookup does not
8399 contain an @ character, it is matched against the domain part of the subject
8400 address. The only two formats that are recognized this way are a literal
8401 domain, or a domain pattern that starts with *. In both these cases, the effect
8402 is the same as if &`*@`& preceded the pattern. For example:
8404 deny senders = enemy.domain : *.enemy.domain
8407 The following kinds of more complicated address list pattern can match any
8408 address, including the empty address that is characteristic of bounce message
8412 .cindex "regular expressions" "in address list"
8413 .cindex "address list" "regular expression in"
8414 If (after expansion) a pattern starts with &"^"&, a regular expression match is
8415 done against the complete address, with the pattern as the regular expression.
8416 You must take care that backslash and dollar characters are not misinterpreted
8417 as part of the string expansion. The simplest way to do this is to use &`\N`&
8418 to mark that part of the string as non-expandable. For example:
8420 deny senders = \N^.*this.*@example\.com$\N : \
8421 \N^\d{8}.+@spamhaus.example$\N : ...
8423 The &`\N`& sequences are removed by the expansion, so these items do indeed
8424 start with &"^"& by the time they are being interpreted as address patterns.
8427 .cindex "address list" "lookup for complete address"
8428 Complete addresses can be looked up by using a pattern that starts with a
8429 lookup type terminated by a semicolon, followed by the data for the lookup. For
8432 deny senders = cdb;/etc/blocked.senders : \
8433 mysql;select address from blocked where \
8434 address='${quote_mysql:$sender_address}'
8436 Both query-style and single-key lookup types can be used. For a single-key
8437 lookup type, Exim uses the complete address as the key. However, empty keys are
8438 not supported for single-key lookups, so a match against the empty address
8439 always fails. This restriction does not apply to query-style lookups.
8441 Partial matching for single-key lookups (section &<<SECTpartiallookup>>&)
8442 cannot be used, and is ignored if specified, with an entry being written to the
8444 .cindex "*@ with single-key lookup"
8445 However, you can configure lookup defaults, as described in section
8446 &<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>&, but this is useful only for the &"*@"& type of
8447 default. For example, with this lookup:
8449 accept senders = lsearch*@;/some/file
8451 the file could contains lines like this:
8453 user1@domain1.example
8456 and for the sender address &'nimrod@jaeger.example'&, the sequence of keys
8459 nimrod@jaeger.example
8463 &*Warning 1*&: Do not include a line keyed by &"*"& in the file, because that
8464 would mean that every address matches, thus rendering the test useless.
8466 &*Warning 2*&: Do not confuse these two kinds of item:
8468 deny recipients = dbm*@;/some/file
8469 deny recipients = *@dbm;/some/file
8471 The first does a whole address lookup, with defaulting, as just described,
8472 because it starts with a lookup type. The second matches the local part and
8473 domain independently, as described in a bullet point below.
8477 The following kinds of address list pattern can match only non-empty addresses.
8478 If the subject address is empty, a match against any of these pattern types
8483 .cindex "@@ with single-key lookup"
8484 .cindex "address list" "@@ lookup type"
8485 .cindex "address list" "split local part and domain"
8486 If a pattern starts with &"@@"& followed by a single-key lookup item
8487 (for example, &`@@lsearch;/some/file`&), the address that is being checked is
8488 split into a local part and a domain. The domain is looked up in the file. If
8489 it is not found, there is no match. If it is found, the data that is looked up
8490 from the file is treated as a colon-separated list of local part patterns, each
8491 of which is matched against the subject local part in turn.
8493 .cindex "asterisk" "in address list"
8494 The lookup may be a partial one, and/or one involving a search for a default
8495 keyed by &"*"& (see section &<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>&). The local part
8496 patterns that are looked up can be regular expressions or begin with &"*"&, or
8497 even be further lookups. They may also be independently negated. For example,
8500 deny senders = @@dbm;/etc/reject-by-domain
8502 the data from which the DBM file is built could contain lines like
8504 baddomain.com: !postmaster : *
8506 to reject all senders except &%postmaster%& from that domain.
8508 .cindex "local part" "starting with !"
8509 If a local part that actually begins with an exclamation mark is required, it
8510 has to be specified using a regular expression. In &(lsearch)& files, an entry
8511 may be split over several lines by indenting the second and subsequent lines,
8512 but the separating colon must still be included at line breaks. White space
8513 surrounding the colons is ignored. For example:
8515 aol.com: spammer1 : spammer2 : ^[0-9]+$ :
8518 As in all colon-separated lists in Exim, a colon can be included in an item by
8521 If the last item in the list starts with a right angle-bracket, the remainder
8522 of the item is taken as a new key to look up in order to obtain a continuation
8523 list of local parts. The new key can be any sequence of characters. Thus one
8524 might have entries like
8526 aol.com: spammer1 : spammer 2 : >*
8527 xyz.com: spammer3 : >*
8530 in a file that was searched with &%@@dbm*%&, to specify a match for 8-digit
8531 local parts for all domains, in addition to the specific local parts listed for
8532 each domain. Of course, using this feature costs another lookup each time a
8533 chain is followed, but the effort needed to maintain the data is reduced.
8535 .cindex "loop" "in lookups"
8536 It is possible to construct loops using this facility, and in order to catch
8537 them, the chains may be no more than fifty items long.
8540 The @@<&'lookup'&> style of item can also be used with a query-style
8541 lookup, but in this case, the chaining facility is not available. The lookup
8542 can only return a single list of local parts.
8545 &*Warning*&: There is an important difference between the address list items
8546 in these two examples:
8549 senders = *@+my_list
8551 In the first one, &`my_list`& is a named address list, whereas in the second
8552 example it is a named domain list.
8557 .section "Case of letters in address lists" "SECTcasletadd"
8558 .cindex "case of local parts"
8559 .cindex "address list" "case forcing"
8560 .cindex "case forcing in address lists"
8561 Domains in email addresses are always handled caselessly, but for local parts
8562 case may be significant on some systems (see &%caseful_local_part%& for how
8563 Exim deals with this when routing addresses). However, RFC 2505 (&'Anti-Spam
8564 Recommendations for SMTP MTAs'&) suggests that matching of addresses to
8565 blocking lists should be done in a case-independent manner. Since most address
8566 lists in Exim are used for this kind of control, Exim attempts to do this by
8569 The domain portion of an address is always lowercased before matching it to an
8570 address list. The local part is lowercased by default, and any string
8571 comparisons that take place are done caselessly. This means that the data in
8572 the address list itself, in files included as plain file names, and in any file
8573 that is looked up using the &"@@"& mechanism, can be in any case. However, the
8574 keys in files that are looked up by a search type other than &(lsearch)& (which
8575 works caselessly) must be in lower case, because these lookups are not
8578 .cindex "&`+caseful`&"
8579 To allow for the possibility of caseful address list matching, if an item in
8580 an address list is the string &"+caseful"&, the original case of the local
8581 part is restored for any comparisons that follow, and string comparisons are no
8582 longer case-independent. This does not affect the domain, which remains in
8583 lower case. However, although independent matches on the domain alone are still
8584 performed caselessly, regular expressions that match against an entire address
8585 become case-sensitive after &"+caseful"& has been seen.
8589 .section "Local part lists" "SECTlocparlis"
8590 .cindex "list" "local part list"
8591 .cindex "local part" "list"
8592 Case-sensitivity in local part lists is handled in the same way as for address
8593 lists, as just described. The &"+caseful"& item can be used if required. In a
8594 setting of the &%local_parts%& option in a router with &%caseful_local_part%&
8595 set false, the subject is lowercased and the matching is initially
8596 case-insensitive. In this case, &"+caseful"& will restore case-sensitive
8597 matching in the local part list, but not elsewhere in the router. If
8598 &%caseful_local_part%& is set true in a router, matching in the &%local_parts%&
8599 option is case-sensitive from the start.
8601 If a local part list is indirected to a file (see section &<<SECTfilnamlis>>&),
8602 comments are handled in the same way as address lists &-- they are recognized
8603 only if the # is preceded by white space or the start of the line.
8604 Otherwise, local part lists are matched in the same way as domain lists, except
8605 that the special items that refer to the local host (&`@`&, &`@[]`&,
8606 &`@mx_any`&, &`@mx_primary`&, and &`@mx_secondary`&) are not recognized.
8607 Refer to section &<<SECTdomainlist>>& for details of the other available item
8609 .ecindex IIDdohoadli
8614 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
8615 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
8617 .chapter "String expansions" "CHAPexpand"
8618 .scindex IIDstrexp "expansion" "of strings"
8619 Many strings in Exim's run time configuration are expanded before use. Some of
8620 them are expanded every time they are used; others are expanded only once.
8622 When a string is being expanded it is copied verbatim from left to right except
8623 when a dollar or backslash character is encountered. A dollar specifies the
8624 start of a portion of the string that is interpreted and replaced as described
8625 below in section &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& onwards. Backslash is used as an
8626 escape character, as described in the following section.
8628 Whether a string is expanded depends upon the context. Usually this is solely
8629 dependent upon the option for which a value is sought; in this documentation,
8630 options for which string expansion is performed are marked with † after
8631 the data type. ACL rules always expand strings. A couple of expansion
8632 conditions do not expand some of the brace-delimited branches, for security
8637 .section "Literal text in expanded strings" "SECTlittext"
8638 .cindex "expansion" "including literal text"
8639 An uninterpreted dollar can be included in an expanded string by putting a
8640 backslash in front of it. A backslash can be used to prevent any special
8641 character being treated specially in an expansion, including backslash itself.
8642 If the string appears in quotes in the configuration file, two backslashes are
8643 required because the quotes themselves cause interpretation of backslashes when
8644 the string is read in (see section &<<SECTstrings>>&).
8646 .cindex "expansion" "non-expandable substrings"
8647 A portion of the string can specified as non-expandable by placing it between
8648 two occurrences of &`\N`&. This is particularly useful for protecting regular
8649 expressions, which often contain backslashes and dollar signs. For example:
8651 deny senders = \N^\d{8}[a-z]@some\.site\.example$\N
8653 On encountering the first &`\N`&, the expander copies subsequent characters
8654 without interpretation until it reaches the next &`\N`& or the end of the
8659 .section "Character escape sequences in expanded strings" "SECID82"
8660 .cindex "expansion" "escape sequences"
8661 A backslash followed by one of the letters &"n"&, &"r"&, or &"t"& in an
8662 expanded string is recognized as an escape sequence for the character newline,
8663 carriage return, or tab, respectively. A backslash followed by up to three
8664 octal digits is recognized as an octal encoding for a single character, and a
8665 backslash followed by &"x"& and up to two hexadecimal digits is a hexadecimal
8668 These escape sequences are also recognized in quoted strings when they are read
8669 in. Their interpretation in expansions as well is useful for unquoted strings,
8670 and for other cases such as looked-up strings that are then expanded.
8673 .section "Testing string expansions" "SECID83"
8674 .cindex "expansion" "testing"
8675 .cindex "testing" "string expansion"
8677 Many expansions can be tested by calling Exim with the &%-be%& option. This
8678 takes the command arguments, or lines from the standard input if there are no
8679 arguments, runs them through the string expansion code, and writes the results
8680 to the standard output. Variables based on configuration values are set up, but
8681 since no message is being processed, variables such as &$local_part$& have no
8682 value. Nevertheless the &%-be%& option can be useful for checking out file and
8683 database lookups, and the use of expansion operators such as &%sg%&, &%substr%&
8686 Exim gives up its root privilege when it is called with the &%-be%& option, and
8687 instead runs under the uid and gid it was called with, to prevent users from
8688 using &%-be%& for reading files to which they do not have access.
8691 If you want to test expansions that include variables whose values are taken
8692 from a message, there are two other options that can be used. The &%-bem%&
8693 option is like &%-be%& except that it is followed by a file name. The file is
8694 read as a message before doing the test expansions. For example:
8696 exim -bem /tmp/test.message '$h_subject:'
8698 The &%-Mset%& option is used in conjunction with &%-be%& and is followed by an
8699 Exim message identifier. For example:
8701 exim -be -Mset 1GrA8W-0004WS-LQ '$recipients'
8703 This loads the message from Exim's spool before doing the test expansions, and
8704 is therefore restricted to admin users.
8707 .section "Forced expansion failure" "SECTforexpfai"
8708 .cindex "expansion" "forced failure"
8709 A number of expansions that are described in the following section have
8710 alternative &"true"& and &"false"& substrings, enclosed in brace characters
8711 (which are sometimes called &"curly brackets"&). Which of the two strings is
8712 used depends on some condition that is evaluated as part of the expansion. If,
8713 instead of a &"false"& substring, the word &"fail"& is used (not in braces),
8714 the entire string expansion fails in a way that can be detected by the code
8715 that requested the expansion. This is called &"forced expansion failure"&, and
8716 its consequences depend on the circumstances. In some cases it is no different
8717 from any other expansion failure, but in others a different action may be
8718 taken. Such variations are mentioned in the documentation of the option that is
8724 .section "Expansion items" "SECTexpansionitems"
8725 The following items are recognized in expanded strings. White space may be used
8726 between sub-items that are keywords or substrings enclosed in braces inside an
8727 outer set of braces, to improve readability. &*Warning*&: Within braces,
8728 white space is significant.
8731 .vitem &*$*&<&'variable&~name'&>&~or&~&*${*&<&'variable&~name'&>&*}*&
8732 .cindex "expansion" "variables"
8733 Substitute the contents of the named variable, for example:
8738 The second form can be used to separate the name from subsequent alphanumeric
8739 characters. This form (using braces) is available only for variables; it does
8740 &'not'& apply to message headers. The names of the variables are given in
8741 section &<<SECTexpvar>>& below. If the name of a non-existent variable is
8742 given, the expansion fails.
8744 .vitem &*${*&<&'op'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
8745 .cindex "expansion" "operators"
8746 The string is first itself expanded, and then the operation specified by
8747 <&'op'&> is applied to it. For example:
8751 The string starts with the first character after the colon, which may be
8752 leading white space. A list of operators is given in section &<<SECTexpop>>&
8753 below. The operator notation is used for simple expansion items that have just
8754 one argument, because it reduces the number of braces and therefore makes the
8755 string easier to understand.
8757 .vitem &*$bheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&*$bh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&
8758 This item inserts &"basic"& header lines. It is described with the &%header%&
8759 expansion item below.
8761 .vitem "&*${dlfunc{*&<&'file'&>&*}{*&<&'function'&>&*}{*&<&'arg'&>&*}&&&
8762 {*&<&'arg'&>&*}...}*&"
8764 This expansion dynamically loads and then calls a locally-written C function.
8765 This functionality is available only if Exim is compiled with
8769 set in &_Local/Makefile_&. Once loaded, Exim remembers the dynamically loaded
8770 object so that it doesn't reload the same object file in the same Exim process
8771 (but of course Exim does start new processes frequently).
8773 There may be from zero to eight arguments to the function. When compiling
8774 a local function that is to be called in this way, &_local_scan.h_& should be
8775 included. The Exim variables and functions that are defined by that API
8776 are also available for dynamically loaded functions. The function itself
8777 must have the following type:
8779 int dlfunction(uschar **yield, int argc, uschar *argv[])
8781 Where &`uschar`& is a typedef for &`unsigned char`& in &_local_scan.h_&. The
8782 function should return one of the following values:
8784 &`OK`&: Success. The string that is placed in the variable &'yield'& is put
8785 into the expanded string that is being built.
8787 &`FAIL`&: A non-forced expansion failure occurs, with the error message taken
8788 from &'yield'&, if it is set.
8790 &`FAIL_FORCED`&: A forced expansion failure occurs, with the error message
8791 taken from &'yield'& if it is set.
8793 &`ERROR`&: Same as &`FAIL`&, except that a panic log entry is written.
8795 When compiling a function that is to be used in this way with gcc,
8796 you need to add &%-shared%& to the gcc command. Also, in the Exim build-time
8797 configuration, you must add &%-export-dynamic%& to EXTRALIBS.
8799 .vitem "&*${extract{*&<&'key'&>&*}{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}&&&
8800 {*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
8801 .cindex "expansion" "extracting substrings by key"
8802 .cindex "&%extract%&" "substrings by key"
8803 The key and <&'string1'&> are first expanded separately. Leading and trailing
8804 white space is removed from the key (but not from any of the strings). The key
8805 must not consist entirely of digits. The expanded <&'string1'&> must be of the
8808 <&'key1'&> = <&'value1'&> <&'key2'&> = <&'value2'&> ...
8811 where the equals signs and spaces (but not both) are optional. If any of the
8812 values contain white space, they must be enclosed in double quotes, and any
8813 values that are enclosed in double quotes are subject to escape processing as
8814 described in section &<<SECTstrings>>&. The expanded <&'string1'&> is searched
8815 for the value that corresponds to the key. The search is case-insensitive. If
8816 the key is found, <&'string2'&> is expanded, and replaces the whole item;
8817 otherwise <&'string3'&> is used. During the expansion of <&'string2'&> the
8818 variable &$value$& contains the value that has been extracted. Afterwards, it
8819 is restored to any previous value it might have had.
8821 If {<&'string3'&>} is omitted, the item is replaced by an empty string if the
8822 key is not found. If {<&'string2'&>} is also omitted, the value that was
8823 extracted is used. Thus, for example, these two expansions are identical, and
8826 ${extract{gid}{uid=1984 gid=2001}}
8827 ${extract{gid}{uid=1984 gid=2001}{$value}}
8829 Instead of {<&'string3'&>} the word &"fail"& (not in curly brackets) can
8830 appear, for example:
8832 ${extract{Z}{A=... B=...}{$value} fail }
8834 This forces an expansion failure (see section &<<SECTforexpfai>>&);
8835 {<&'string2'&>} must be present for &"fail"& to be recognized.
8838 .vitem "&*${extract{*&<&'number'&>&*}{*&<&'separators'&>&*}&&&
8839 {*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
8840 .cindex "expansion" "extracting substrings by number"
8841 .cindex "&%extract%&" "substrings by number"
8842 The <&'number'&> argument must consist entirely of decimal digits,
8843 apart from leading and trailing white space, which is ignored.
8844 This is what distinguishes this form of &%extract%& from the previous kind. It
8845 behaves in the same way, except that, instead of extracting a named field, it
8846 extracts from <&'string1'&> the field whose number is given as the first
8847 argument. You can use &$value$& in <&'string2'&> or &`fail`& instead of
8848 <&'string3'&> as before.
8850 The fields in the string are separated by any one of the characters in the
8851 separator string. These may include space or tab characters.
8852 The first field is numbered one. If the number is negative, the fields are
8853 counted from the end of the string, with the rightmost one numbered -1. If the
8854 number given is zero, the entire string is returned. If the modulus of the
8855 number is greater than the number of fields in the string, the result is the
8856 expansion of <&'string3'&>, or the empty string if <&'string3'&> is not
8857 provided. For example:
8859 ${extract{2}{:}{x:42:99:& Mailer::/bin/bash}}
8863 ${extract{-4}{:}{x:42:99:& Mailer::/bin/bash}}
8865 yields &"99"&. Two successive separators mean that the field between them is
8866 empty (for example, the fifth field above).
8869 .vitem &*${filter{*&<&'string'&>&*}{*&<&'condition'&>&*}}*&
8870 .cindex "list" "selecting by condition"
8871 .cindex "expansion" "selecting from list by condition"
8873 After expansion, <&'string'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by
8874 default, but the separator can be changed in the usual way. For each item
8875 in this list, its value is place in &$item$&, and then the condition is
8876 evaluated. If the condition is true, &$item$& is added to the output as an
8877 item in a new list; if the condition is false, the item is discarded. The
8878 separator used for the output list is the same as the one used for the
8879 input, but a separator setting is not included in the output. For example:
8881 ${filter{a:b:c}{!eq{$item}{b}}
8883 yields &`a:c`&. At the end of the expansion, the value of &$item$& is restored
8884 to what it was before. See also the &*map*& and &*reduce*& expansion items.
8887 .vitem &*${hash{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&
8888 .cindex "hash function" "textual"
8889 .cindex "expansion" "textual hash"
8890 This is a textual hashing function, and was the first to be implemented in
8891 early versions of Exim. In current releases, there are other hashing functions
8892 (numeric, MD5, and SHA-1), which are described below.
8894 The first two strings, after expansion, must be numbers. Call them <&'m'&> and
8895 <&'n'&>. If you are using fixed values for these numbers, that is, if
8896 <&'string1'&> and <&'string2'&> do not change when they are expanded, you can
8897 use the simpler operator notation that avoids some of the braces:
8899 ${hash_<n>_<m>:<string>}
8901 The second number is optional (in both notations). If <&'n'&> is greater than
8902 or equal to the length of the string, the expansion item returns the string.
8903 Otherwise it computes a new string of length <&'n'&> by applying a hashing
8904 function to the string. The new string consists of characters taken from the
8905 first <&'m'&> characters of the string
8907 abcdefghijklmnopqrstuvwxyzABCDEFGHIJKLMNOPQWRSTUVWXYZ0123456789
8909 If <&'m'&> is not present the value 26 is used, so that only lower case
8910 letters appear. For example:
8912 &`$hash{3}{monty}} `& yields &`jmg`&
8913 &`$hash{5}{monty}} `& yields &`monty`&
8914 &`$hash{4}{62}{monty python}}`& yields &`fbWx`&
8917 .vitem "&*$header_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&&&
8918 &*$h_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&" &&&
8919 "&*$bheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&&&
8920 &*$bh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&" &&&
8921 "&*$rheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&&&
8922 &*$rh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&"
8923 .cindex "expansion" "header insertion"
8924 .vindex "&$header_$&"
8925 .vindex "&$bheader_$&"
8926 .vindex "&$rheader_$&"
8927 .cindex "header lines" "in expansion strings"
8928 .cindex "header lines" "character sets"
8929 .cindex "header lines" "decoding"
8930 Substitute the contents of the named message header line, for example
8934 The newline that terminates a header line is not included in the expansion, but
8935 internal newlines (caused by splitting the header line over several physical
8936 lines) may be present.
8938 The difference between &%rheader%&, &%bheader%&, and &%header%& is in the way
8939 the data in the header line is interpreted.
8942 .cindex "white space" "in header lines"
8943 &%rheader%& gives the original &"raw"& content of the header line, with no
8944 processing at all, and without the removal of leading and trailing white space.
8947 .cindex "base64 encoding" "in header lines"
8948 &%bheader%& removes leading and trailing white space, and then decodes base64
8949 or quoted-printable MIME &"words"& within the header text, but does no
8950 character set translation. If decoding of what looks superficially like a MIME
8951 &"word"& fails, the raw string is returned. If decoding
8952 .cindex "binary zero" "in header line"
8953 produces a binary zero character, it is replaced by a question mark &-- this is
8954 what Exim does for binary zeros that are actually received in header lines.
8957 &%header%& tries to translate the string as decoded by &%bheader%& to a
8958 standard character set. This is an attempt to produce the same string as would
8959 be displayed on a user's MUA. If translation fails, the &%bheader%& string is
8960 returned. Translation is attempted only on operating systems that support the
8961 &[iconv()]& function. This is indicated by the compile-time macro HAVE_ICONV in
8962 a system Makefile or in &_Local/Makefile_&.
8965 In a filter file, the target character set for &%header%& can be specified by a
8966 command of the following form:
8968 headers charset "UTF-8"
8970 This command affects all references to &$h_$& (or &$header_$&) expansions in
8971 subsequently obeyed filter commands. In the absence of this command, the target
8972 character set in a filter is taken from the setting of the &%headers_charset%&
8973 option in the runtime configuration. The value of this option defaults to the
8974 value of HEADERS_CHARSET in &_Local/Makefile_&. The ultimate default is
8977 Header names follow the syntax of RFC 2822, which states that they may contain
8978 any printing characters except space and colon. Consequently, curly brackets
8979 &'do not'& terminate header names, and should not be used to enclose them as
8980 if they were variables. Attempting to do so causes a syntax error.
8982 Only header lines that are common to all copies of a message are visible to
8983 this mechanism. These are the original header lines that are received with the
8984 message, and any that are added by an ACL statement or by a system
8985 filter. Header lines that are added to a particular copy of a message by a
8986 router or transport are not accessible.
8988 For incoming SMTP messages, no header lines are visible in ACLs that are obeyed
8989 before the DATA ACL, because the header structure is not set up until the
8990 message is received. Header lines that are added in a RCPT ACL (for example)
8991 are saved until the message's incoming header lines are available, at which
8992 point they are added. When a DATA ACL is running, however, header lines added
8993 by earlier ACLs are visible.
8995 Upper case and lower case letters are synonymous in header names. If the
8996 following character is white space, the terminating colon may be omitted, but
8997 this is not recommended, because you may then forget it when it is needed. When
8998 white space terminates the header name, it is included in the expanded string.
8999 If the message does not contain the given header, the expansion item is
9000 replaced by an empty string. (See the &%def%& condition in section
9001 &<<SECTexpcond>>& for a means of testing for the existence of a header.)
9003 If there is more than one header with the same name, they are all concatenated
9004 to form the substitution string, up to a maximum length of 64K. Unless
9005 &%rheader%& is being used, leading and trailing white space is removed from
9006 each header before concatenation, and a completely empty header is ignored. A
9007 newline character is then inserted between non-empty headers, but there is no
9008 newline at the very end. For the &%header%& and &%bheader%& expansion, for
9009 those headers that contain lists of addresses, a comma is also inserted at the
9010 junctions between headers. This does not happen for the &%rheader%& expansion.
9013 .vitem &*${hmac{*&<&'hashname'&>&*}{*&<&'secret'&>&*}{*&<&'string'&>&*}}*&
9014 .cindex "expansion" "hmac hashing"
9016 This function uses cryptographic hashing (either MD5 or SHA-1) to convert a
9017 shared secret and some text into a message authentication code, as specified in
9018 RFC 2104. This differs from &`${md5:secret_text...}`& or
9019 &`${sha1:secret_text...}`& in that the hmac step adds a signature to the
9020 cryptographic hash, allowing for authentication that is not possible with MD5
9021 or SHA-1 alone. The hash name must expand to either &`md5`& or &`sha1`& at
9022 present. For example:
9024 ${hmac{md5}{somesecret}{$primary_hostname $tod_log}}
9026 For the hostname &'mail.example.com'& and time 2002-10-17 11:30:59, this
9029 dd97e3ba5d1a61b5006108f8c8252953
9031 As an example of how this might be used, you might put in the main part of
9032 an Exim configuration:
9034 SPAMSCAN_SECRET=cohgheeLei2thahw
9036 In a router or a transport you could then have:
9039 X-Spam-Scanned: ${primary_hostname} ${message_exim_id} \
9040 ${hmac{md5}{SPAMSCAN_SECRET}\
9041 {${primary_hostname},${message_exim_id},$h_message-id:}}
9043 Then given a message, you can check where it was scanned by looking at the
9044 &'X-Spam-Scanned:'& header line. If you know the secret, you can check that
9045 this header line is authentic by recomputing the authentication code from the
9046 host name, message ID and the &'Message-id:'& header line. This can be done
9047 using Exim's &%-be%& option, or by other means, for example by using the
9048 &'hmac_md5_hex()'& function in Perl.
9051 .vitem &*${if&~*&<&'condition'&>&*&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&
9052 .cindex "expansion" "conditional"
9053 .cindex "&%if%&, expansion item"
9054 If <&'condition'&> is true, <&'string1'&> is expanded and replaces the whole
9055 item; otherwise <&'string2'&> is used. The available conditions are described
9056 in section &<<SECTexpcond>>& below. For example:
9058 ${if eq {$local_part}{postmaster} {yes}{no} }
9060 The second string need not be present; if it is not and the condition is not
9061 true, the item is replaced with nothing. Alternatively, the word &"fail"& may
9062 be present instead of the second string (without any curly brackets). In this
9063 case, the expansion is forced to fail if the condition is not true (see section
9064 &<<SECTforexpfai>>&).
9066 If both strings are omitted, the result is the string &`true`& if the condition
9067 is true, and the empty string if the condition is false. This makes it less
9068 cumbersome to write custom ACL and router conditions. For example, instead of
9070 condition = ${if >{$acl_m4}{3}{true}{false}}
9074 condition = ${if >{$acl_m4}{3}}
9077 .vitem &*${length{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&
9078 .cindex "expansion" "string truncation"
9079 .cindex "&%length%& expansion item"
9080 The &%length%& item is used to extract the initial portion of a string. Both
9081 strings are expanded, and the first one must yield a number, <&'n'&>, say. If
9082 you are using a fixed value for the number, that is, if <&'string1'&> does not
9083 change when expanded, you can use the simpler operator notation that avoids
9086 ${length_<n>:<string>}
9088 The result of this item is either the first <&'n'&> characters or the whole
9089 of <&'string2'&>, whichever is the shorter. Do not confuse &%length%& with
9090 &%strlen%&, which gives the length of a string.
9093 .vitem "&*${lookup{*&<&'key'&>&*}&~*&<&'search&~type'&>&*&~&&&
9094 {*&<&'file'&>&*}&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}&~{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&"
9095 This is the first of one of two different types of lookup item, which are both
9096 described in the next item.
9098 .vitem "&*${lookup&~*&<&'search&~type'&>&*&~{*&<&'query'&>&*}&~&&&
9099 {*&<&'string1'&>&*}&~{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&"
9100 .cindex "expansion" "lookup in"
9101 .cindex "file" "lookups"
9102 .cindex "lookup" "in expanded string"
9103 The two forms of lookup item specify data lookups in files and databases, as
9104 discussed in chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&. The first form is used for single-key
9105 lookups, and the second is used for query-style lookups. The <&'key'&>,
9106 <&'file'&>, and <&'query'&> strings are expanded before use.
9108 If there is any white space in a lookup item which is part of a filter command,
9109 a retry or rewrite rule, a routing rule for the &(manualroute)& router, or any
9110 other place where white space is significant, the lookup item must be enclosed
9111 in double quotes. The use of data lookups in users' filter files may be locked
9112 out by the system administrator.
9115 If the lookup succeeds, <&'string1'&> is expanded and replaces the entire item.
9116 During its expansion, the variable &$value$& contains the data returned by the
9117 lookup. Afterwards it reverts to the value it had previously (at the outer
9118 level it is empty). If the lookup fails, <&'string2'&> is expanded and replaces
9119 the entire item. If {<&'string2'&>} is omitted, the replacement is the empty
9120 string on failure. If <&'string2'&> is provided, it can itself be a nested
9121 lookup, thus providing a mechanism for looking up a default value when the
9122 original lookup fails.
9124 If a nested lookup is used as part of <&'string1'&>, &$value$& contains the
9125 data for the outer lookup while the parameters of the second lookup are
9126 expanded, and also while <&'string2'&> of the second lookup is expanded, should
9127 the second lookup fail. Instead of {<&'string2'&>} the word &"fail"& can
9128 appear, and in this case, if the lookup fails, the entire expansion is forced
9129 to fail (see section &<<SECTforexpfai>>&). If both {<&'string1'&>} and
9130 {<&'string2'&>} are omitted, the result is the looked up value in the case of a
9131 successful lookup, and nothing in the case of failure.
9133 For single-key lookups, the string &"partial"& is permitted to precede the
9134 search type in order to do partial matching, and * or *@ may follow a search
9135 type to request default lookups if the key does not match (see sections
9136 &<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>& and &<<SECTpartiallookup>>& for details).
9138 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in lookup expansion"
9139 If a partial search is used, the variables &$1$& and &$2$& contain the wild
9140 and non-wild parts of the key during the expansion of the replacement text.
9141 They return to their previous values at the end of the lookup item.
9143 This example looks up the postmaster alias in the conventional alias file:
9145 ${lookup {postmaster} lsearch {/etc/aliases} {$value}}
9147 This example uses NIS+ to look up the full name of the user corresponding to
9148 the local part of an address, forcing the expansion to fail if it is not found:
9150 ${lookup nisplus {[name=$local_part],passwd.org_dir:gcos} \
9155 .vitem &*${map{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&
9156 .cindex "expansion" "list creation"
9158 After expansion, <&'string1'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by
9159 default, but the separator can be changed in the usual way. For each item
9160 in this list, its value is place in &$item$&, and then <&'string2'&> is
9161 expanded and added to the output as an item in a new list. The separator used
9162 for the output list is the same as the one used for the input, but a separator
9163 setting is not included in the output. For example:
9165 ${map{a:b:c}{[$item]}} ${map{<- x-y-z}{($item)}}
9167 expands to &`[a]:[b]:[c] (x)-(y)-(z)`&. At the end of the expansion, the
9168 value of &$item$& is restored to what it was before. See also the &*filter*&
9169 and &*reduce*& expansion items.
9171 .vitem &*${nhash{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&
9172 .cindex "expansion" "numeric hash"
9173 .cindex "hash function" "numeric"
9174 The three strings are expanded; the first two must yield numbers. Call them
9175 <&'n'&> and <&'m'&>. If you are using fixed values for these numbers, that is,
9176 if <&'string1'&> and <&'string2'&> do not change when they are expanded, you
9177 can use the simpler operator notation that avoids some of the braces:
9179 ${nhash_<n>_<m>:<string>}
9181 The second number is optional (in both notations). If there is only one number,
9182 the result is a number in the range 0&--<&'n'&>-1. Otherwise, the string is
9183 processed by a div/mod hash function that returns two numbers, separated by a
9184 slash, in the ranges 0 to <&'n'&>-1 and 0 to <&'m'&>-1, respectively. For
9187 ${nhash{8}{64}{supercalifragilisticexpialidocious}}
9189 returns the string &"6/33"&.
9193 .vitem &*${perl{*&<&'subroutine'&>&*}{*&<&'arg'&>&*}{*&<&'arg'&>&*}...}*&
9194 .cindex "Perl" "use in expanded string"
9195 .cindex "expansion" "calling Perl from"
9196 This item is available only if Exim has been built to include an embedded Perl
9197 interpreter. The subroutine name and the arguments are first separately
9198 expanded, and then the Perl subroutine is called with those arguments. No
9199 additional arguments need be given; the maximum number permitted, including the
9200 name of the subroutine, is nine.
9202 The return value of the subroutine is inserted into the expanded string, unless
9203 the return value is &%undef%&. In that case, the expansion fails in the same
9204 way as an explicit &"fail"& on a lookup item. The return value is a scalar.
9205 Whatever you return is evaluated in a scalar context. For example, if you
9206 return the name of a Perl vector, the return value is the size of the vector,
9209 If the subroutine exits by calling Perl's &%die%& function, the expansion fails
9210 with the error message that was passed to &%die%&. More details of the embedded
9211 Perl facility are given in chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&.
9213 The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_perl%& which locks
9214 out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
9217 .vitem &*${prvs{*&<&'address'&>&*}{*&<&'secret'&>&*}{*&<&'keynumber'&>&*}}*&
9218 .cindex "&%prvs%& expansion item"
9219 The first argument is a complete email address and the second is secret
9220 keystring. The third argument, specifying a key number, is optional. If absent,
9221 it defaults to 0. The result of the expansion is a prvs-signed email address,
9222 to be typically used with the &%return_path%& option on an &(smtp)& transport
9223 as part of a bounce address tag validation (BATV) scheme. For more discussion
9224 and an example, see section &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
9226 .vitem "&*${prvscheck{*&<&'address'&>&*}{*&<&'secret'&>&*}&&&
9227 {*&<&'string'&>&*}}*&"
9228 .cindex "&%prvscheck%& expansion item"
9229 This expansion item is the complement of the &%prvs%& item. It is used for
9230 checking prvs-signed addresses. If the expansion of the first argument does not
9231 yield a syntactically valid prvs-signed address, the whole item expands to the
9232 empty string. When the first argument does expand to a syntactically valid
9233 prvs-signed address, the second argument is expanded, with the prvs-decoded
9234 version of the address and the key number extracted from the address in the
9235 variables &$prvscheck_address$& and &$prvscheck_keynum$&, respectively.
9237 These two variables can be used in the expansion of the second argument to
9238 retrieve the secret. The validity of the prvs-signed address is then checked
9239 against the secret. The result is stored in the variable &$prvscheck_result$&,
9240 which is empty for failure or &"1"& for success.
9242 The third argument is optional; if it is missing, it defaults to an empty
9243 string. This argument is now expanded. If the result is an empty string, the
9244 result of the expansion is the decoded version of the address. This is the case
9245 whether or not the signature was valid. Otherwise, the result of the expansion
9246 is the expansion of the third argument.
9248 All three variables can be used in the expansion of the third argument.
9249 However, once the expansion is complete, only &$prvscheck_result$& remains set.
9250 For more discussion and an example, see section &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
9252 .vitem &*${readfile{*&<&'file&~name'&>&*}{*&<&'eol&~string'&>&*}}*&
9253 .cindex "expansion" "inserting an entire file"
9254 .cindex "file" "inserting into expansion"
9255 .cindex "&%readfile%& expansion item"
9256 The file name and end-of-line string are first expanded separately. The file is
9257 then read, and its contents replace the entire item. All newline characters in
9258 the file are replaced by the end-of-line string if it is present. Otherwise,
9259 newlines are left in the string.
9260 String expansion is not applied to the contents of the file. If you want this,
9261 you must wrap the item in an &%expand%& operator. If the file cannot be read,
9262 the string expansion fails.
9264 The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_readfile%& which
9265 locks out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
9269 .vitem "&*${readsocket{*&<&'name'&>&*}{*&<&'request'&>&*}&&&
9270 {*&<&'timeout'&>&*}{*&<&'eol&~string'&>&*}{*&<&'fail&~string'&>&*}}*&"
9271 .cindex "expansion" "inserting from a socket"
9272 .cindex "socket, use of in expansion"
9273 .cindex "&%readsocket%& expansion item"
9274 This item inserts data from a Unix domain or Internet socket into the expanded
9275 string. The minimal way of using it uses just two arguments, as in these
9278 ${readsocket{/socket/name}{request string}}
9279 ${readsocket{inet:some.host:1234}{request string}}
9281 For a Unix domain socket, the first substring must be the path to the socket.
9282 For an Internet socket, the first substring must contain &`inet:`& followed by
9283 a host name or IP address, followed by a colon and a port, which can be a
9284 number or the name of a TCP port in &_/etc/services_&. An IP address may
9285 optionally be enclosed in square brackets. This is best for IPv6 addresses. For
9288 ${readsocket{inet:[::1]:1234}{request string}}
9290 Only a single host name may be given, but if looking it up yields more than
9291 one IP address, they are each tried in turn until a connection is made. For
9292 both kinds of socket, Exim makes a connection, writes the request string
9293 (unless it is an empty string) and reads from the socket until an end-of-file
9294 is read. A timeout of 5 seconds is applied. Additional, optional arguments
9295 extend what can be done. Firstly, you can vary the timeout. For example:
9297 ${readsocket{/socket/name}{request string}{3s}}
9299 A fourth argument allows you to change any newlines that are in the data
9300 that is read, in the same way as for &%readfile%& (see above). This example
9301 turns them into spaces:
9303 ${readsocket{inet:127.0.0.1:3294}{request string}{3s}{ }}
9305 As with all expansions, the substrings are expanded before the processing
9306 happens. Errors in these sub-expansions cause the expansion to fail. In
9307 addition, the following errors can occur:
9310 Failure to create a socket file descriptor;
9312 Failure to connect the socket;
9314 Failure to write the request string;
9316 Timeout on reading from the socket.
9319 By default, any of these errors causes the expansion to fail. However, if
9320 you supply a fifth substring, it is expanded and used when any of the above
9321 errors occurs. For example:
9323 ${readsocket{/socket/name}{request string}{3s}{\n}\
9326 You can test for the existence of a Unix domain socket by wrapping this
9327 expansion in &`${if exists`&, but there is a race condition between that test
9328 and the actual opening of the socket, so it is safer to use the fifth argument
9329 if you want to be absolutely sure of avoiding an expansion error for a
9330 non-existent Unix domain socket, or a failure to connect to an Internet socket.
9332 The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_readsocket%& which
9333 locks out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
9336 .vitem &*${reduce{*&<&'string1'&>}{<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&
9337 .cindex "expansion" "reducing a list to a scalar"
9338 .cindex "list" "reducing to a scalar"
9341 This operation reduces a list to a single, scalar string. After expansion,
9342 <&'string1'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by default, but the
9343 separator can be changed in the usual way. Then <&'string2'&> is expanded and
9344 assigned to the &$value$& variable. After this, each item in the <&'string1'&>
9345 list is assigned to &$item$& in turn, and <&'string3'&> is expanded for each of
9346 them. The result of that expansion is assigned to &$value$& before the next
9347 iteration. When the end of the list is reached, the final value of &$value$& is
9348 added to the expansion output. The &*reduce*& expansion item can be used in a
9349 number of ways. For example, to add up a list of numbers:
9351 ${reduce {<, 1,2,3}{0}{${eval:$value+$item}}}
9353 The result of that expansion would be &`6`&. The maximum of a list of numbers
9356 ${reduce {3:0:9:4:6}{0}{${if >{$item}{$value}{$item}{$value}}}}
9358 At the end of a &*reduce*& expansion, the values of &$item$& and &$value$& are
9359 restored to what they were before. See also the &*filter*& and &*map*&
9362 .vitem &*$rheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&*$rh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&
9363 This item inserts &"raw"& header lines. It is described with the &%header%&
9364 expansion item above.
9366 .vitem "&*${run{*&<&'command'&>&*&~*&<&'args'&>&*}{*&<&'string1'&>&*}&&&
9367 {*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&"
9368 .cindex "expansion" "running a command"
9369 .cindex "&%run%& expansion item"
9370 The command and its arguments are first expanded separately, and then the
9371 command is run in a separate process, but under the same uid and gid. As in
9372 other command executions from Exim, a shell is not used by default. If you want
9373 a shell, you must explicitly code it.
9375 The standard input for the command exists, but is empty. The standard output
9376 and standard error are set to the same file descriptor.
9377 .cindex "return code" "from &%run%& expansion"
9379 If the command succeeds (gives a zero return code) <&'string1'&> is expanded
9380 and replaces the entire item; during this expansion, the standard output/error
9381 from the command is in the variable &$value$&. If the command fails,
9382 <&'string2'&>, if present, is expanded and used. Once again, during the
9383 expansion, the standard output/error from the command is in the variable
9386 If <&'string2'&> is absent, the result is empty. Alternatively, <&'string2'&>
9387 can be the word &"fail"& (not in braces) to force expansion failure if the
9388 command does not succeed. If both strings are omitted, the result is contents
9389 of the standard output/error on success, and nothing on failure.
9392 The return code from the command is put in the variable &$runrc$&, and this
9393 remains set afterwards, so in a filter file you can do things like this:
9395 if "${run{x y z}{}}$runrc" is 1 then ...
9396 elif $runrc is 2 then ...
9400 If execution of the command fails (for example, the command does not exist),
9401 the return code is 127 &-- the same code that shells use for non-existent
9404 &*Warning*&: In a router or transport, you cannot assume the order in which
9405 option values are expanded, except for those preconditions whose order of
9406 testing is documented. Therefore, you cannot reliably expect to set &$runrc$&
9407 by the expansion of one option, and use it in another.
9409 The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_run%& which locks
9410 out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
9413 .vitem &*${sg{*&<&'subject'&>&*}{*&<&'regex'&>&*}{*&<&'replacement'&>&*}}*&
9414 .cindex "expansion" "string substitution"
9415 .cindex "&%sg%& expansion item"
9416 This item works like Perl's substitution operator (s) with the global (/g)
9417 option; hence its name. However, unlike the Perl equivalent, Exim does not
9418 modify the subject string; instead it returns the modified string for insertion
9419 into the overall expansion. The item takes three arguments: the subject string,
9420 a regular expression, and a substitution string. For example:
9422 ${sg{abcdefabcdef}{abc}{xyz}}
9424 yields &"xyzdefxyzdef"&. Because all three arguments are expanded before use,
9425 if any $ or \ characters are required in the regular expression or in the
9426 substitution string, they have to be escaped. For example:
9428 ${sg{abcdef}{^(...)(...)\$}{\$2\$1}}
9430 yields &"defabc"&, and
9432 ${sg{1=A 4=D 3=C}{\N(\d+)=\N}{K\$1=}}
9434 yields &"K1=A K4=D K3=C"&. Note the use of &`\N`& to protect the contents of
9435 the regular expression from string expansion.
9439 .vitem &*${substr{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&
9440 .cindex "&%substr%& expansion item"
9441 .cindex "substring extraction"
9442 .cindex "expansion" "substring extraction"
9443 The three strings are expanded; the first two must yield numbers. Call them
9444 <&'n'&> and <&'m'&>. If you are using fixed values for these numbers, that is,
9445 if <&'string1'&> and <&'string2'&> do not change when they are expanded, you
9446 can use the simpler operator notation that avoids some of the braces:
9448 ${substr_<n>_<m>:<string>}
9450 The second number is optional (in both notations).
9451 If it is absent in the simpler format, the preceding underscore must also be
9454 The &%substr%& item can be used to extract more general substrings than
9455 &%length%&. The first number, <&'n'&>, is a starting offset, and <&'m'&> is the
9456 length required. For example
9458 ${substr{3}{2}{$local_part}}
9460 If the starting offset is greater than the string length the result is the
9461 null string; if the length plus starting offset is greater than the string
9462 length, the result is the right-hand part of the string, starting from the
9463 given offset. The first character in the string has offset zero.
9465 The &%substr%& expansion item can take negative offset values to count
9466 from the right-hand end of its operand. The last character is offset -1, the
9467 second-last is offset -2, and so on. Thus, for example,
9469 ${substr{-5}{2}{1234567}}
9471 yields &"34"&. If the absolute value of a negative offset is greater than the
9472 length of the string, the substring starts at the beginning of the string, and
9473 the length is reduced by the amount of overshoot. Thus, for example,
9475 ${substr{-5}{2}{12}}
9477 yields an empty string, but
9479 ${substr{-3}{2}{12}}
9483 When the second number is omitted from &%substr%&, the remainder of the string
9484 is taken if the offset is positive. If it is negative, all characters in the
9485 string preceding the offset point are taken. For example, an offset of -1 and
9486 no length, as in these semantically identical examples:
9489 ${substr{-1}{abcde}}
9491 yields all but the last character of the string, that is, &"abcd"&.
9495 .vitem "&*${tr{*&<&'subject'&>&*}{*&<&'characters'&>&*}&&&
9496 {*&<&'replacements'&>&*}}*&"
9497 .cindex "expansion" "character translation"
9498 .cindex "&%tr%& expansion item"
9499 This item does single-character translation on its subject string. The second
9500 argument is a list of characters to be translated in the subject string. Each
9501 matching character is replaced by the corresponding character from the
9502 replacement list. For example
9504 ${tr{abcdea}{ac}{13}}
9506 yields &`1b3de1`&. If there are duplicates in the second character string, the
9507 last occurrence is used. If the third string is shorter than the second, its
9508 last character is replicated. However, if it is empty, no translation takes
9514 .section "Expansion operators" "SECTexpop"
9515 .cindex "expansion" "operators"
9516 For expansion items that perform transformations on a single argument string,
9517 the &"operator"& notation is used because it is simpler and uses fewer braces.
9518 The substring is first expanded before the operation is applied to it. The
9519 following operations can be performed:
9522 .vitem &*${address:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9523 .cindex "expansion" "RFC 2822 address handling"
9524 .cindex "&%address%& expansion item"
9525 The string is interpreted as an RFC 2822 address, as it might appear in a
9526 header line, and the effective address is extracted from it. If the string does
9527 not parse successfully, the result is empty.
9530 .vitem &*${addresses:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9531 .cindex "expansion" "RFC 2822 address handling"
9532 .cindex "&%addresses%& expansion item"
9533 The string (after expansion) is interpreted as a list of addresses in RFC
9534 2822 format, such as can be found in a &'To:'& or &'Cc:'& header line. The
9535 operative address (&'local-part@domain'&) is extracted from each item, and the
9536 result of the expansion is a colon-separated list, with appropriate
9537 doubling of colons should any happen to be present in the email addresses.
9538 Syntactically invalid RFC2822 address items are omitted from the output.
9540 It is possible to specify a character other than colon for the output
9541 separator by starting the string with > followed by the new separator
9542 character. For example:
9544 ${addresses:>& Chief <ceo@up.stairs>, sec@base.ment (dogsbody)}
9546 expands to &`ceo@up.stairs&&sec@base.ment`&. Compare the &*address*& (singular)
9547 expansion item, which extracts the working address from a single RFC2822
9548 address. See the &*filter*&, &*map*&, and &*reduce*& items for ways of
9552 .vitem &*${base62:*&<&'digits'&>&*}*&
9553 .cindex "&%base62%& expansion item"
9554 .cindex "expansion" "conversion to base 62"
9555 The string must consist entirely of decimal digits. The number is converted to
9556 base 62 and output as a string of six characters, including leading zeros. In
9557 the few operating environments where Exim uses base 36 instead of base 62 for
9558 its message identifiers (because those systems do not have case-sensitive file
9559 names), base 36 is used by this operator, despite its name. &*Note*&: Just to
9560 be absolutely clear: this is &'not'& base64 encoding.
9562 .vitem &*${base62d:*&<&'base-62&~digits'&>&*}*&
9563 .cindex "&%base62d%& expansion item"
9564 .cindex "expansion" "conversion to base 62"
9565 The string must consist entirely of base-62 digits, or, in operating
9566 environments where Exim uses base 36 instead of base 62 for its message
9567 identifiers, base-36 digits. The number is converted to decimal and output as a
9571 .vitem &*${domain:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9572 .cindex "domain" "extraction"
9573 .cindex "expansion" "domain extraction"
9574 The string is interpreted as an RFC 2822 address and the domain is extracted
9575 from it. If the string does not parse successfully, the result is empty.
9578 .vitem &*${escape:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9579 .cindex "expansion" "escaping non-printing characters"
9580 .cindex "&%escape%& expansion item"
9581 If the string contains any non-printing characters, they are converted to
9582 escape sequences starting with a backslash. Whether characters with the most
9583 significant bit set (so-called &"8-bit characters"&) count as printing or not
9584 is controlled by the &%print_topbitchars%& option.
9587 .vitem &*${eval:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&&~and&~&*${eval10:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9588 .cindex "expansion" "expression evaluation"
9589 .cindex "expansion" "arithmetic expression"
9590 .cindex "&%eval%& expansion item"
9591 These items supports simple arithmetic and bitwise logical operations in
9592 expansion strings. The string (after expansion) must be a conventional
9593 arithmetic expression, but it is limited to basic arithmetic operators, bitwise
9594 logical operators, and parentheses. All operations are carried out using
9595 integer arithmetic. The operator priorities are as follows (the same as in the
9596 C programming language):
9598 .irow &'highest:'& "not (~), negate (-)"
9599 .irow "" "multiply (*), divide (/), remainder (%)"
9600 .irow "" "plus (+), minus (-)"
9601 .irow "" "shift-left (<<), shift-right (>>)"
9604 .irow &'lowest:'& "or (|)"
9606 Binary operators with the same priority are evaluated from left to right. White
9607 space is permitted before or after operators.
9609 For &%eval%&, numbers may be decimal, octal (starting with &"0"&) or
9610 hexadecimal (starting with &"0x"&). For &%eval10%&, all numbers are taken as
9611 decimal, even if they start with a leading zero; hexadecimal numbers are not
9612 permitted. This can be useful when processing numbers extracted from dates or
9613 times, which often do have leading zeros.
9615 A number may be followed by &"K"&, &"M"& or &"G"& to multiply it by 1024, 1024*1024
9617 respectively. Negative numbers are supported. The result of the computation is
9618 a decimal representation of the answer (without &"K"&, &"M"& or &"G"&). For example:
9621 &`${eval:1+1} `& yields 2
9622 &`${eval:1+2*3} `& yields 7
9623 &`${eval:(1+2)*3} `& yields 9
9624 &`${eval:2+42%5} `& yields 4
9625 &`${eval:0xc&5} `& yields 4
9626 &`${eval:0xc|5} `& yields 13
9627 &`${eval:0xc^5} `& yields 9
9628 &`${eval:0xc>>1} `& yields 6
9629 &`${eval:0xc<<1} `& yields 24
9630 &`${eval:~255&0x1234} `& yields 4608
9631 &`${eval:-(~255&0x1234)} `& yields -4608
9634 As a more realistic example, in an ACL you might have
9636 deny message = Too many bad recipients
9639 {>{$rcpt_count}{10}} \
9642 {$recipients_count} \
9643 {${eval:$rcpt_count/2}} \
9647 The condition is true if there have been more than 10 RCPT commands and
9648 fewer than half of them have resulted in a valid recipient.
9651 .vitem &*${expand:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9652 .cindex "expansion" "re-expansion of substring"
9653 The &%expand%& operator causes a string to be expanded for a second time. For
9656 ${expand:${lookup{$domain}dbm{/some/file}{$value}}}
9658 first looks up a string in a file while expanding the operand for &%expand%&,
9659 and then re-expands what it has found.
9662 .vitem &*${from_utf8:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9664 .cindex "UTF-8" "conversion from"
9665 .cindex "expansion" "UTF-8 conversion"
9666 .cindex "&%from_utf8%& expansion item"
9667 The world is slowly moving towards Unicode, although there are no standards for
9668 email yet. However, other applications (including some databases) are starting
9669 to store data in Unicode, using UTF-8 encoding. This operator converts from a
9670 UTF-8 string to an ISO-8859-1 string. UTF-8 code values greater than 255 are
9671 converted to underscores. The input must be a valid UTF-8 string. If it is not,
9672 the result is an undefined sequence of bytes.
9674 Unicode code points with values less than 256 are compatible with ASCII and
9675 ISO-8859-1 (also known as Latin-1).
9676 For example, character 169 is the copyright symbol in both cases, though the
9677 way it is encoded is different. In UTF-8, more than one byte is needed for
9678 characters with code values greater than 127, whereas ISO-8859-1 is a
9679 single-byte encoding (but thereby limited to 256 characters). This makes
9680 translation from UTF-8 to ISO-8859-1 straightforward.
9683 .vitem &*${hash_*&<&'n'&>&*_*&<&'m'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9684 .cindex "hash function" "textual"
9685 .cindex "expansion" "textual hash"
9686 The &%hash%& operator is a simpler interface to the hashing function that can
9687 be used when the two parameters are fixed numbers (as opposed to strings that
9688 change when expanded). The effect is the same as
9690 ${hash{<n>}{<m>}{<string>}}
9692 See the description of the general &%hash%& item above for details. The
9693 abbreviation &%h%& can be used when &%hash%& is used as an operator.
9697 .vitem &*${hex2b64:*&<&'hexstring'&>&*}*&
9698 .cindex "base64 encoding" "conversion from hex"
9699 .cindex "expansion" "hex to base64"
9700 .cindex "&%hex2b64%& expansion item"
9701 This operator converts a hex string into one that is base64 encoded. This can
9702 be useful for processing the output of the MD5 and SHA-1 hashing functions.
9705 .vitem &*${lc:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9706 .cindex "case forcing in strings"
9707 .cindex "string" "case forcing"
9708 .cindex "lower casing"
9709 .cindex "expansion" "case forcing"
9710 .cindex "&%lc%& expansion item"
9711 This forces the letters in the string into lower-case, for example:
9716 .vitem &*${length_*&<&'number'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9717 .cindex "expansion" "string truncation"
9718 .cindex "&%length%& expansion item"
9719 The &%length%& operator is a simpler interface to the &%length%& function that
9720 can be used when the parameter is a fixed number (as opposed to a string that
9721 changes when expanded). The effect is the same as
9723 ${length{<number>}{<string>}}
9725 See the description of the general &%length%& item above for details. Note that
9726 &%length%& is not the same as &%strlen%&. The abbreviation &%l%& can be used
9727 when &%length%& is used as an operator.
9730 .vitem &*${listcount:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9731 .cindex "expansion" "list item count"
9732 .cindex "list" "item count"
9733 .cindex "list" "count of items"
9734 .cindex "&%listcount%& expansion item"
9735 The string is interpreted as a list and the number of items is returned.
9738 .vitem &*${listnamed:*&<&'name'&>&*}*&&~and&~&*${list_*&<&'type'&>&*name'&>&*}*&
9739 .cindex "expansion" "named list"
9740 .cindex "&%listnamed%& expansion item"
9741 The name is interpreted as a named list and the content of the list is returned,
9742 expanding any referenced lists, re-quoting as needed for colon-separation.
9743 If the optional type if given it must be one of "a", "d", "h" or "l"
9744 and selects address-, domain-, host- or localpart- lists to search among respectively.
9745 Otherwise all types are searched in an undefined order and the first
9746 matching list is returned.
9749 .vitem &*${local_part:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9750 .cindex "expansion" "local part extraction"
9751 .cindex "&%local_part%& expansion item"
9752 The string is interpreted as an RFC 2822 address and the local part is
9753 extracted from it. If the string does not parse successfully, the result is
9757 .vitem &*${mask:*&<&'IP&~address'&>&*/*&<&'bit&~count'&>&*}*&
9758 .cindex "masked IP address"
9759 .cindex "IP address" "masking"
9760 .cindex "CIDR notation"
9761 .cindex "expansion" "IP address masking"
9762 .cindex "&%mask%& expansion item"
9763 If the form of the string to be operated on is not an IP address followed by a
9764 slash and an integer (that is, a network address in CIDR notation), the
9765 expansion fails. Otherwise, this operator converts the IP address to binary,
9766 masks off the least significant bits according to the bit count, and converts
9767 the result back to text, with mask appended. For example,
9769 ${mask:10.111.131.206/28}
9771 returns the string &"10.111.131.192/28"&. Since this operation is expected to
9772 be mostly used for looking up masked addresses in files, the result for an IPv6
9773 address uses dots to separate components instead of colons, because colon
9774 terminates a key string in lsearch files. So, for example,
9776 ${mask:3ffe:ffff:836f:0a00:000a:0800:200a:c031/99}
9780 3ffe.ffff.836f.0a00.000a.0800.2000.0000/99
9782 Letters in IPv6 addresses are always output in lower case.
9785 .vitem &*${md5:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9787 .cindex "expansion" "MD5 hash"
9788 .cindex "&%md5%& expansion item"
9789 The &%md5%& operator computes the MD5 hash value of the string, and returns it
9790 as a 32-digit hexadecimal number, in which any letters are in lower case.
9793 .vitem &*${nhash_*&<&'n'&>&*_*&<&'m'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9794 .cindex "expansion" "numeric hash"
9795 .cindex "hash function" "numeric"
9796 The &%nhash%& operator is a simpler interface to the numeric hashing function
9797 that can be used when the two parameters are fixed numbers (as opposed to
9798 strings that change when expanded). The effect is the same as
9800 ${nhash{<n>}{<m>}{<string>}}
9802 See the description of the general &%nhash%& item above for details.
9805 .vitem &*${quote:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9806 .cindex "quoting" "in string expansions"
9807 .cindex "expansion" "quoting"
9808 .cindex "&%quote%& expansion item"
9809 The &%quote%& operator puts its argument into double quotes if it
9810 is an empty string or
9811 contains anything other than letters, digits, underscores, dots, and hyphens.
9812 Any occurrences of double quotes and backslashes are escaped with a backslash.
9813 Newlines and carriage returns are converted to &`\n`& and &`\r`&,
9814 respectively For example,
9822 The place where this is useful is when the argument is a substitution from a
9823 variable or a message header.
9825 .vitem &*${quote_local_part:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9826 .cindex "&%quote_local_part%& expansion item"
9827 This operator is like &%quote%&, except that it quotes the string only if
9828 required to do so by the rules of RFC 2822 for quoting local parts. For
9829 example, a plus sign would not cause quoting (but it would for &%quote%&).
9830 If you are creating a new email address from the contents of &$local_part$&
9831 (or any other unknown data), you should always use this operator.
9834 .vitem &*${quote_*&<&'lookup-type'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9835 .cindex "quoting" "lookup-specific"
9836 This operator applies lookup-specific quoting rules to the string. Each
9837 query-style lookup type has its own quoting rules which are described with
9838 the lookups in chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&. For example,
9840 ${quote_ldap:two * two}
9846 For single-key lookup types, no quoting is ever necessary and this operator
9847 yields an unchanged string.
9850 .vitem &*${randint:*&<&'n'&>&*}*&
9851 .cindex "random number"
9852 This operator returns a somewhat random number which is less than the
9853 supplied number and is at least 0. The quality of this randomness depends
9854 on how Exim was built; the values are not suitable for keying material.
9855 If Exim is linked against OpenSSL then RAND_pseudo_bytes() is used.
9856 If Exim is linked against GnuTLS then gnutls_rnd(GNUTLS_RND_NONCE) is used,
9857 for versions of GnuTLS with that function.
9858 Otherwise, the implementation may be arc4random(), random() seeded by
9859 srandomdev() or srandom(), or a custom implementation even weaker than
9863 .vitem &*${reverse_ip:*&<&'ipaddr'&>&*}*&
9864 .cindex "expansion" "IP address"
9865 This operator reverses an IP address; for IPv4 addresses, the result is in
9866 dotted-quad decimal form, while for IPv6 addreses the result is in
9867 dotted-nibble hexadecimal form. In both cases, this is the "natural" form
9868 for DNS. For example,
9870 ${reverse_ip:192.0.2.4}
9871 ${reverse_ip:2001:0db8:c42:9:1:abcd:192.0.2.3}
9876 3.0.2.0.0.0.0.c.d.c.b.a.1.0.0.0.9.0.0.0.2.4.c.0.8.b.d.0.1.0.0.2
9880 .vitem &*${rfc2047:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9881 .cindex "expansion" "RFC 2047"
9882 .cindex "RFC 2047" "expansion operator"
9883 .cindex "&%rfc2047%& expansion item"
9884 This operator encodes text according to the rules of RFC 2047. This is an
9885 encoding that is used in header lines to encode non-ASCII characters. It is
9886 assumed that the input string is in the encoding specified by the
9887 &%headers_charset%& option, which defaults to ISO-8859-1. If the string
9888 contains only characters in the range 33&--126, and no instances of the
9891 ? = ( ) < > @ , ; : \ " . [ ] _
9893 it is not modified. Otherwise, the result is the RFC 2047 encoding of the
9894 string, using as many &"encoded words"& as necessary to encode all the
9898 .vitem &*${rfc2047d:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9899 .cindex "expansion" "RFC 2047"
9900 .cindex "RFC 2047" "decoding"
9901 .cindex "&%rfc2047d%& expansion item"
9902 This operator decodes strings that are encoded as per RFC 2047. Binary zero
9903 bytes are replaced by question marks. Characters are converted into the
9904 character set defined by &%headers_charset%&. Overlong RFC 2047 &"words"& are
9905 not recognized unless &%check_rfc2047_length%& is set false.
9907 &*Note*&: If you use &%$header%&_&'xxx'&&*:*& (or &%$h%&_&'xxx'&&*:*&) to
9908 access a header line, RFC 2047 decoding is done automatically. You do not need
9909 to use this operator as well.
9913 .vitem &*${rxquote:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9914 .cindex "quoting" "in regular expressions"
9915 .cindex "regular expressions" "quoting"
9916 .cindex "&%rxquote%& expansion item"
9917 The &%rxquote%& operator inserts a backslash before any non-alphanumeric
9918 characters in its argument. This is useful when substituting the values of
9919 variables or headers inside regular expressions.
9922 .vitem &*${sha1:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9923 .cindex "SHA-1 hash"
9924 .cindex "expansion" "SHA-1 hashing"
9925 .cindex "&%sha2%& expansion item"
9926 The &%sha1%& operator computes the SHA-1 hash value of the string, and returns
9927 it as a 40-digit hexadecimal number, in which any letters are in upper case.
9930 .vitem &*${stat:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9931 .cindex "expansion" "statting a file"
9932 .cindex "file" "extracting characteristics"
9933 .cindex "&%stat%& expansion item"
9934 The string, after expansion, must be a file path. A call to the &[stat()]&
9935 function is made for this path. If &[stat()]& fails, an error occurs and the
9936 expansion fails. If it succeeds, the data from the stat replaces the item, as a
9937 series of <&'name'&>=<&'value'&> pairs, where the values are all numerical,
9938 except for the value of &"smode"&. The names are: &"mode"& (giving the mode as
9939 a 4-digit octal number), &"smode"& (giving the mode in symbolic format as a
9940 10-character string, as for the &'ls'& command), &"inode"&, &"device"&,
9941 &"links"&, &"uid"&, &"gid"&, &"size"&, &"atime"&, &"mtime"&, and &"ctime"&. You
9942 can extract individual fields using the &%extract%& expansion item.
9944 The use of the &%stat%& expansion in users' filter files can be locked out by
9945 the system administrator. &*Warning*&: The file size may be incorrect on 32-bit
9946 systems for files larger than 2GB.
9948 .vitem &*${str2b64:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9949 .cindex "expansion" "base64 encoding"
9950 .cindex "base64 encoding" "in string expansion"
9951 .cindex "&%str2b64%& expansion item"
9952 This operator converts a string into one that is base64 encoded.
9956 .vitem &*${strlen:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9957 .cindex "expansion" "string length"
9958 .cindex "string" "length in expansion"
9959 .cindex "&%strlen%& expansion item"
9960 The item is replace by the length of the expanded string, expressed as a
9961 decimal number. &*Note*&: Do not confuse &%strlen%& with &%length%&.
9964 .vitem &*${substr_*&<&'start'&>&*_*&<&'length'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9965 .cindex "&%substr%& expansion item"
9966 .cindex "substring extraction"
9967 .cindex "expansion" "substring expansion"
9968 The &%substr%& operator is a simpler interface to the &%substr%& function that
9969 can be used when the two parameters are fixed numbers (as opposed to strings
9970 that change when expanded). The effect is the same as
9972 ${substr{<start>}{<length>}{<string>}}
9974 See the description of the general &%substr%& item above for details. The
9975 abbreviation &%s%& can be used when &%substr%& is used as an operator.
9977 .vitem &*${time_eval:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9978 .cindex "&%time_eval%& expansion item"
9979 .cindex "time interval" "decoding"
9980 This item converts an Exim time interval such as &`2d4h5m`& into a number of
9983 .vitem &*${time_interval:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9984 .cindex "&%time_interval%& expansion item"
9985 .cindex "time interval" "formatting"
9986 The argument (after sub-expansion) must be a sequence of decimal digits that
9987 represents an interval of time as a number of seconds. It is converted into a
9988 number of larger units and output in Exim's normal time format, for example,
9991 .vitem &*${uc:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9992 .cindex "case forcing in strings"
9993 .cindex "string" "case forcing"
9994 .cindex "upper casing"
9995 .cindex "expansion" "case forcing"
9996 .cindex "&%uc%& expansion item"
9997 This forces the letters in the string into upper-case.
10005 .section "Expansion conditions" "SECTexpcond"
10006 .scindex IIDexpcond "expansion" "conditions"
10007 The following conditions are available for testing by the &%${if%& construct
10008 while expanding strings:
10011 .vitem &*!*&<&'condition'&>
10012 .cindex "expansion" "negating a condition"
10013 .cindex "negation" "in expansion condition"
10014 Preceding any condition with an exclamation mark negates the result of the
10017 .vitem <&'symbolic&~operator'&>&~&*{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10018 .cindex "numeric comparison"
10019 .cindex "expansion" "numeric comparison"
10020 There are a number of symbolic operators for doing numeric comparisons. They
10026 &`>= `& greater or equal
10028 &`<= `& less or equal
10032 ${if >{$message_size}{10M} ...
10034 Note that the general negation operator provides for inequality testing. The
10035 two strings must take the form of optionally signed decimal integers,
10036 optionally followed by one of the letters &"K"&, &"M"& or &"G"& (in either upper or
10037 lower case), signifying multiplication by 1024, 1024*1024 or 1024*1024*1024, respectively.
10038 As a special case, the numerical value of an empty string is taken as
10041 In all cases, a relative comparator OP is testing if <&'string1'&> OP
10042 <&'string2'&>; the above example is checking if &$message_size$& is larger than
10043 10M, not if 10M is larger than &$message_size$&.
10046 .vitem &*bool&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10047 .cindex "expansion" "boolean parsing"
10048 .cindex "&%bool%& expansion condition"
10049 This condition turns a string holding a true or false representation into
10050 a boolean state. It parses &"true"&, &"false"&, &"yes"& and &"no"&
10051 (case-insensitively); also positive integer numbers map to true if non-zero,
10053 An empty string is treated as false.
10054 Leading and trailing whitespace is ignored;
10055 thus a string consisting only of whitespace is false.
10056 All other string values will result in expansion failure.
10058 When combined with ACL variables, this expansion condition will let you
10059 make decisions in one place and act on those decisions in another place.
10062 ${if bool{$acl_m_privileged_sender} ...
10066 .vitem &*bool_lax&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10067 .cindex "expansion" "boolean parsing"
10068 .cindex "&%bool_lax%& expansion condition"
10069 Like &%bool%&, this condition turns a string into a boolean state. But
10070 where &%bool%& accepts a strict set of strings, &%bool_lax%& uses the same
10071 loose definition that the Router &%condition%& option uses. The empty string
10072 and the values &"false"&, &"no"& and &"0"& map to false, all others map to
10073 true. Leading and trailing whitespace is ignored.
10075 Note that where &"bool{00}"& is false, &"bool_lax{00}"& is true.
10077 .vitem &*crypteq&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10078 .cindex "expansion" "encrypted comparison"
10079 .cindex "encrypted strings, comparing"
10080 .cindex "&%crypteq%& expansion condition"
10081 This condition is included in the Exim binary if it is built to support any
10082 authentication mechanisms (see chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&). Otherwise, it is
10083 necessary to define SUPPORT_CRYPTEQ in &_Local/Makefile_& to get &%crypteq%&
10084 included in the binary.
10086 The &%crypteq%& condition has two arguments. The first is encrypted and
10087 compared against the second, which is already encrypted. The second string may
10088 be in the LDAP form for storing encrypted strings, which starts with the
10089 encryption type in curly brackets, followed by the data. If the second string
10090 does not begin with &"{"& it is assumed to be encrypted with &[crypt()]& or
10091 &[crypt16()]& (see below), since such strings cannot begin with &"{"&.
10092 Typically this will be a field from a password file. An example of an encrypted
10093 string in LDAP form is:
10095 {md5}CY9rzUYh03PK3k6DJie09g==
10097 If such a string appears directly in an expansion, the curly brackets have to
10098 be quoted, because they are part of the expansion syntax. For example:
10100 ${if crypteq {test}{\{md5\}CY9rzUYh03PK3k6DJie09g==}{yes}{no}}
10102 The following encryption types (whose names are matched case-independently) are
10107 .cindex "base64 encoding" "in encrypted password"
10108 &%{md5}%& computes the MD5 digest of the first string, and expresses this as
10109 printable characters to compare with the remainder of the second string. If the
10110 length of the comparison string is 24, Exim assumes that it is base64 encoded
10111 (as in the above example). If the length is 32, Exim assumes that it is a
10112 hexadecimal encoding of the MD5 digest. If the length not 24 or 32, the
10116 .cindex "SHA-1 hash"
10117 &%{sha1}%& computes the SHA-1 digest of the first string, and expresses this as
10118 printable characters to compare with the remainder of the second string. If the
10119 length of the comparison string is 28, Exim assumes that it is base64 encoded.
10120 If the length is 40, Exim assumes that it is a hexadecimal encoding of the
10121 SHA-1 digest. If the length is not 28 or 40, the comparison fails.
10124 .cindex "&[crypt()]&"
10125 &%{crypt}%& calls the &[crypt()]& function, which traditionally used to use
10126 only the first eight characters of the password. However, in modern operating
10127 systems this is no longer true, and in many cases the entire password is used,
10128 whatever its length.
10131 .cindex "&[crypt16()]&"
10132 &%{crypt16}%& calls the &[crypt16()]& function, which was originally created to
10133 use up to 16 characters of the password in some operating systems. Again, in
10134 modern operating systems, more characters may be used.
10136 Exim has its own version of &[crypt16()]&, which is just a double call to
10137 &[crypt()]&. For operating systems that have their own version, setting
10138 HAVE_CRYPT16 in &_Local/Makefile_& when building Exim causes it to use the
10139 operating system version instead of its own. This option is set by default in
10140 the OS-dependent &_Makefile_& for those operating systems that are known to
10141 support &[crypt16()]&.
10143 Some years after Exim's &[crypt16()]& was implemented, a user discovered that
10144 it was not using the same algorithm as some operating systems' versions. It
10145 turns out that as well as &[crypt16()]& there is a function called
10146 &[bigcrypt()]& in some operating systems. This may or may not use the same
10147 algorithm, and both of them may be different to Exim's built-in &[crypt16()]&.
10149 However, since there is now a move away from the traditional &[crypt()]&
10150 functions towards using SHA1 and other algorithms, tidying up this area of
10151 Exim is seen as very low priority.
10153 If you do not put a encryption type (in curly brackets) in a &%crypteq%&
10154 comparison, the default is usually either &`{crypt}`& or &`{crypt16}`&, as
10155 determined by the setting of DEFAULT_CRYPT in &_Local/Makefile_&. The default
10156 default is &`{crypt}`&. Whatever the default, you can always use either
10157 function by specifying it explicitly in curly brackets.
10159 .vitem &*def:*&<&'variable&~name'&>
10160 .cindex "expansion" "checking for empty variable"
10161 .cindex "&%def%& expansion condition"
10162 The &%def%& condition must be followed by the name of one of the expansion
10163 variables defined in section &<<SECTexpvar>>&. The condition is true if the
10164 variable does not contain the empty string. For example:
10166 ${if def:sender_ident {from $sender_ident}}
10168 Note that the variable name is given without a leading &%$%& character. If the
10169 variable does not exist, the expansion fails.
10171 .vitem "&*def:header_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~&~or&~&&&
10172 &~&*def:h_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&"
10173 .cindex "expansion" "checking header line existence"
10174 This condition is true if a message is being processed and the named header
10175 exists in the message. For example,
10177 ${if def:header_reply-to:{$h_reply-to:}{$h_from:}}
10179 &*Note*&: No &%$%& appears before &%header_%& or &%h_%& in the condition, and
10180 the header name must be terminated by a colon if white space does not follow.
10182 .vitem &*eq&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
10183 &*eqi&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10184 .cindex "string" "comparison"
10185 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
10186 .cindex "&%eq%& expansion condition"
10187 .cindex "&%eqi%& expansion condition"
10188 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the two
10189 resulting strings are identical. For &%eq%& the comparison includes the case of
10190 letters, whereas for &%eqi%& the comparison is case-independent.
10192 .vitem &*exists&~{*&<&'file&~name'&>&*}*&
10193 .cindex "expansion" "file existence test"
10194 .cindex "file" "existence test"
10195 .cindex "&%exists%&, expansion condition"
10196 The substring is first expanded and then interpreted as an absolute path. The
10197 condition is true if the named file (or directory) exists. The existence test
10198 is done by calling the &[stat()]& function. The use of the &%exists%& test in
10199 users' filter files may be locked out by the system administrator.
10201 .vitem &*first_delivery*&
10202 .cindex "delivery" "first"
10203 .cindex "first delivery"
10204 .cindex "expansion" "first delivery test"
10205 .cindex "&%first_delivery%& expansion condition"
10206 This condition, which has no data, is true during a message's first delivery
10207 attempt. It is false during any subsequent delivery attempts.
10210 .vitem "&*forall{*&<&'a list'&>&*}{*&<&'a condition'&>&*}*&" &&&
10211 "&*forany{*&<&'a list'&>&*}{*&<&'a condition'&>&*}*&"
10212 .cindex "list" "iterative conditions"
10213 .cindex "expansion" "&*forall*& condition"
10214 .cindex "expansion" "&*forany*& condition"
10216 These conditions iterate over a list. The first argument is expanded to form
10217 the list. By default, the list separator is a colon, but it can be changed by
10218 the normal method. The second argument is interpreted as a condition that is to
10219 be applied to each item in the list in turn. During the interpretation of the
10220 condition, the current list item is placed in a variable called &$item$&.
10222 For &*forany*&, interpretation stops if the condition is true for any item, and
10223 the result of the whole condition is true. If the condition is false for all
10224 items in the list, the overall condition is false.
10226 For &*forall*&, interpretation stops if the condition is false for any item,
10227 and the result of the whole condition is false. If the condition is true for
10228 all items in the list, the overall condition is true.
10230 Note that negation of &*forany*& means that the condition must be false for all
10231 items for the overall condition to succeed, and negation of &*forall*& means
10232 that the condition must be false for at least one item. In this example, the
10233 list separator is changed to a comma:
10235 ${if forany{<, $recipients}{match{$item}{^user3@}}{yes}{no}}
10237 The value of &$item$& is saved and restored while &*forany*& or &*forall*& is
10238 being processed, to enable these expansion items to be nested.
10241 .vitem &*ge&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
10242 &*gei&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10243 .cindex "string" "comparison"
10244 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
10245 .cindex "&%ge%& expansion condition"
10246 .cindex "&%gei%& expansion condition"
10247 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
10248 string is lexically greater than or equal to the second string. For &%ge%& the
10249 comparison includes the case of letters, whereas for &%gei%& the comparison is
10252 .vitem &*gt&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
10253 &*gti&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10254 .cindex "string" "comparison"
10255 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
10256 .cindex "&%gt%& expansion condition"
10257 .cindex "&%gti%& expansion condition"
10258 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
10259 string is lexically greater than the second string. For &%gt%& the comparison
10260 includes the case of letters, whereas for &%gti%& the comparison is
10263 .vitem &*inlist&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
10264 &*inlisti&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10265 .cindex "string" "comparison"
10266 .cindex "list" "iterative conditions"
10267 Both strings are expanded; the second string is treated as a list of simple
10268 strings; if the first string is a member of the second, then the condition
10271 These are simpler to use versions of the more powerful &*forany*& condition.
10272 Examples, and the &*forany*& equivalents:
10274 ${if inlist{needle}{foo:needle:bar}}
10275 ${if forany{foo:needle:bar}{eq{$item}{needle}}}
10276 ${if inlisti{Needle}{fOo:NeeDLE:bAr}}
10277 ${if forany{fOo:NeeDLE:bAr}{eqi{$item}{Needle}}}
10280 .vitem &*isip&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*& &&&
10281 &*isip4&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*& &&&
10282 &*isip6&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10283 .cindex "IP address" "testing string format"
10284 .cindex "string" "testing for IP address"
10285 .cindex "&%isip%& expansion condition"
10286 .cindex "&%isip4%& expansion condition"
10287 .cindex "&%isip6%& expansion condition"
10288 The substring is first expanded, and then tested to see if it has the form of
10289 an IP address. Both IPv4 and IPv6 addresses are valid for &%isip%&, whereas
10290 &%isip4%& and &%isip6%& test specifically for IPv4 or IPv6 addresses.
10292 For an IPv4 address, the test is for four dot-separated components, each of
10293 which consists of from one to three digits. For an IPv6 address, up to eight
10294 colon-separated components are permitted, each containing from one to four
10295 hexadecimal digits. There may be fewer than eight components if an empty
10296 component (adjacent colons) is present. Only one empty component is permitted.
10298 &*Note*&: The checks are just on the form of the address; actual numerical
10299 values are not considered. Thus, for example, 999.999.999.999 passes the IPv4
10300 check. The main use of these tests is to distinguish between IP addresses and
10301 host names, or between IPv4 and IPv6 addresses. For example, you could use
10303 ${if isip4{$sender_host_address}...
10305 to test which IP version an incoming SMTP connection is using.
10307 .vitem &*ldapauth&~{*&<&'ldap&~query'&>&*}*&
10308 .cindex "LDAP" "use for authentication"
10309 .cindex "expansion" "LDAP authentication test"
10310 .cindex "&%ldapauth%& expansion condition"
10311 This condition supports user authentication using LDAP. See section
10312 &<<SECTldap>>& for details of how to use LDAP in lookups and the syntax of
10313 queries. For this use, the query must contain a user name and password. The
10314 query itself is not used, and can be empty. The condition is true if the
10315 password is not empty, and the user name and password are accepted by the LDAP
10316 server. An empty password is rejected without calling LDAP because LDAP binds
10317 with an empty password are considered anonymous regardless of the username, and
10318 will succeed in most configurations. See chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details
10319 of SMTP authentication, and chapter &<<CHAPplaintext>>& for an example of how
10323 .vitem &*le&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
10324 &*lei&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10325 .cindex "string" "comparison"
10326 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
10327 .cindex "&%le%& expansion condition"
10328 .cindex "&%lei%& expansion condition"
10329 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
10330 string is lexically less than or equal to the second string. For &%le%& the
10331 comparison includes the case of letters, whereas for &%lei%& the comparison is
10334 .vitem &*lt&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
10335 &*lti&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10336 .cindex "string" "comparison"
10337 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
10338 .cindex "&%lt%& expansion condition"
10339 .cindex "&%lti%& expansion condition"
10340 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
10341 string is lexically less than the second string. For &%lt%& the comparison
10342 includes the case of letters, whereas for &%lti%& the comparison is
10346 .vitem &*match&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10347 .cindex "expansion" "regular expression comparison"
10348 .cindex "regular expressions" "match in expanded string"
10349 .cindex "&%match%& expansion condition"
10350 The two substrings are first expanded. The second is then treated as a regular
10351 expression and applied to the first. Because of the pre-expansion, if the
10352 regular expression contains dollar, or backslash characters, they must be
10353 escaped. Care must also be taken if the regular expression contains braces
10354 (curly brackets). A closing brace must be escaped so that it is not taken as a
10355 premature termination of <&'string2'&>. The easiest approach is to use the
10356 &`\N`& feature to disable expansion of the regular expression.
10359 ${if match {$local_part}{\N^\d{3}\N} ...
10361 If the whole expansion string is in double quotes, further escaping of
10362 backslashes is also required.
10364 The condition is true if the regular expression match succeeds.
10365 The regular expression is not required to begin with a circumflex
10366 metacharacter, but if there is no circumflex, the expression is not anchored,
10367 and it may match anywhere in the subject, not just at the start. If you want
10368 the pattern to match at the end of the subject, you must include the &`$`&
10369 metacharacter at an appropriate point.
10371 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &%if%& expansion"
10372 At the start of an &%if%& expansion the values of the numeric variable
10373 substitutions &$1$& etc. are remembered. Obeying a &%match%& condition that
10374 succeeds causes them to be reset to the substrings of that condition and they
10375 will have these values during the expansion of the success string. At the end
10376 of the &%if%& expansion, the previous values are restored. After testing a
10377 combination of conditions using &%or%&, the subsequent values of the numeric
10378 variables are those of the condition that succeeded.
10380 .vitem &*match_address&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10381 .cindex "&%match_address%& expansion condition"
10382 See &*match_local_part*&.
10384 .vitem &*match_domain&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10385 .cindex "&%match_domain%& expansion condition"
10386 See &*match_local_part*&.
10388 .vitem &*match_ip&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10389 .cindex "&%match_ip%& expansion condition"
10390 This condition matches an IP address to a list of IP address patterns. It must
10391 be followed by two argument strings. The first (after expansion) must be an IP
10392 address or an empty string. The second (not expanded) is a restricted host
10393 list that can match only an IP address, not a host name. For example:
10395 ${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{1.2.3.4:5.6.7.8}{...}{...}}
10397 The specific types of host list item that are permitted in the list are:
10400 An IP address, optionally with a CIDR mask.
10402 A single asterisk, which matches any IP address.
10404 An empty item, which matches only if the IP address is empty. This could be
10405 useful for testing for a locally submitted message or one from specific hosts
10406 in a single test such as
10407 . ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
10408 . ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left. This comment applies to
10409 . ==== the use of xmlto plus fop. There's no problem when formatting with
10410 . ==== sdop, with or without the extra indent.
10412 ${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{:4.3.2.1:...}{...}{...}}
10414 where the first item in the list is the empty string.
10416 The item @[] matches any of the local host's interface addresses.
10418 Single-key lookups are assumed to be like &"net-"& style lookups in host lists,
10419 even if &`net-`& is not specified. There is never any attempt to turn the IP
10420 address into a host name. The most common type of linear search for
10421 &*match_ip*& is likely to be &*iplsearch*&, in which the file can contain CIDR
10422 masks. For example:
10424 ${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{iplsearch;/some/file}...
10426 It is of course possible to use other kinds of lookup, and in such a case, you
10427 do need to specify the &`net-`& prefix if you want to specify a specific
10428 address mask, for example:
10430 ${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{net24-dbm;/some/file}...
10432 However, unless you are combining a &%match_ip%& condition with others, it is
10433 just as easy to use the fact that a lookup is itself a condition, and write:
10435 ${lookup{${mask:$sender_host_address/24}}dbm{/a/file}...
10439 Note that <&'string2'&> is not itself subject to string expansion, unless
10440 Exim was built with the EXPAND_LISTMATCH_RHS option.
10442 Consult section &<<SECThoslispatip>>& for further details of these patterns.
10444 .vitem &*match_local_part&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10445 .cindex "domain list" "in expansion condition"
10446 .cindex "address list" "in expansion condition"
10447 .cindex "local part" "list, in expansion condition"
10448 .cindex "&%match_local_part%& expansion condition"
10449 This condition, together with &%match_address%& and &%match_domain%&, make it
10450 possible to test domain, address, and local part lists within expansions. Each
10451 condition requires two arguments: an item and a list to match. A trivial
10454 ${if match_domain{a.b.c}{x.y.z:a.b.c:p.q.r}{yes}{no}}
10456 In each case, the second argument may contain any of the allowable items for a
10457 list of the appropriate type. Also, because the second argument (after
10458 expansion) is a standard form of list, it is possible to refer to a named list.
10459 Thus, you can use conditions like this:
10461 ${if match_domain{$domain}{+local_domains}{...
10463 .cindex "&`+caseful`&"
10464 For address lists, the matching starts off caselessly, but the &`+caseful`&
10465 item can be used, as in all address lists, to cause subsequent items to
10466 have their local parts matched casefully. Domains are always matched
10469 Note that <&'string2'&> is not itself subject to string expansion, unless
10470 Exim was built with the EXPAND_LISTMATCH_RHS option.
10472 &*Note*&: Host lists are &'not'& supported in this way. This is because
10473 hosts have two identities: a name and an IP address, and it is not clear
10474 how to specify cleanly how such a test would work. However, IP addresses can be
10475 matched using &%match_ip%&.
10477 .vitem &*pam&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*:*&<&'string2'&>&*:...}*&
10478 .cindex "PAM authentication"
10479 .cindex "AUTH" "with PAM"
10480 .cindex "Solaris" "PAM support"
10481 .cindex "expansion" "PAM authentication test"
10482 .cindex "&%pam%& expansion condition"
10483 &'Pluggable Authentication Modules'&
10484 (&url(http://www.kernel.org/pub/linux/libs/pam/)) are a facility that is
10485 available in the latest releases of Solaris and in some GNU/Linux
10486 distributions. The Exim support, which is intended for use in conjunction with
10487 the SMTP AUTH command, is available only if Exim is compiled with
10491 in &_Local/Makefile_&. You probably need to add &%-lpam%& to EXTRALIBS, and
10492 in some releases of GNU/Linux &%-ldl%& is also needed.
10494 The argument string is first expanded, and the result must be a
10495 colon-separated list of strings. Leading and trailing white space is ignored.
10496 The PAM module is initialized with the service name &"exim"& and the user name
10497 taken from the first item in the colon-separated data string (<&'string1'&>).
10498 The remaining items in the data string are passed over in response to requests
10499 from the authentication function. In the simple case there will only be one
10500 request, for a password, so the data consists of just two strings.
10502 There can be problems if any of the strings are permitted to contain colon
10503 characters. In the usual way, these have to be doubled to avoid being taken as
10504 separators. If the data is being inserted from a variable, the &%sg%& expansion
10505 item can be used to double any existing colons. For example, the configuration
10506 of a LOGIN authenticator might contain this setting:
10508 server_condition = ${if pam{$auth1:${sg{$auth2}{:}{::}}}}
10510 For a PLAIN authenticator you could use:
10512 server_condition = ${if pam{$auth2:${sg{$auth3}{:}{::}}}}
10514 In some operating systems, PAM authentication can be done only from a process
10515 running as root. Since Exim is running as the Exim user when receiving
10516 messages, this means that PAM cannot be used directly in those systems.
10517 A patched version of the &'pam_unix'& module that comes with the
10518 Linux PAM package is available from &url(http://www.e-admin.de/pam_exim/).
10519 The patched module allows one special uid/gid combination, in addition to root,
10520 to authenticate. If you build the patched module to allow the Exim user and
10521 group, PAM can then be used from an Exim authenticator.
10524 .vitem &*pwcheck&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*:*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10525 .cindex "&'pwcheck'& daemon"
10527 .cindex "expansion" "&'pwcheck'& authentication test"
10528 .cindex "&%pwcheck%& expansion condition"
10529 This condition supports user authentication using the Cyrus &'pwcheck'& daemon.
10530 This is one way of making it possible for passwords to be checked by a process
10531 that is not running as root. &*Note*&: The use of &'pwcheck'& is now
10532 deprecated. Its replacement is &'saslauthd'& (see below).
10534 The pwcheck support is not included in Exim by default. You need to specify
10535 the location of the pwcheck daemon's socket in &_Local/Makefile_& before
10536 building Exim. For example:
10538 CYRUS_PWCHECK_SOCKET=/var/pwcheck/pwcheck
10540 You do not need to install the full Cyrus software suite in order to use
10541 the pwcheck daemon. You can compile and install just the daemon alone
10542 from the Cyrus SASL library. Ensure that &'exim'& is the only user that has
10543 access to the &_/var/pwcheck_& directory.
10545 The &%pwcheck%& condition takes one argument, which must be the user name and
10546 password, separated by a colon. For example, in a LOGIN authenticator
10547 configuration, you might have this:
10549 server_condition = ${if pwcheck{$auth1:$auth2}}
10551 Again, for a PLAIN authenticator configuration, this would be:
10553 server_condition = ${if pwcheck{$auth2:$auth3}}
10555 .vitem &*queue_running*&
10556 .cindex "queue runner" "detecting when delivering from"
10557 .cindex "expansion" "queue runner test"
10558 .cindex "&%queue_running%& expansion condition"
10559 This condition, which has no data, is true during delivery attempts that are
10560 initiated by queue runner processes, and false otherwise.
10563 .vitem &*radius&~{*&<&'authentication&~string'&>&*}*&
10565 .cindex "expansion" "Radius authentication"
10566 .cindex "&%radius%& expansion condition"
10567 Radius authentication (RFC 2865) is supported in a similar way to PAM. You must
10568 set RADIUS_CONFIG_FILE in &_Local/Makefile_& to specify the location of
10569 the Radius client configuration file in order to build Exim with Radius
10572 With just that one setting, Exim expects to be linked with the &%radiusclient%&
10573 library, using the original API. If you are using release 0.4.0 or later of
10574 this library, you need to set
10576 RADIUS_LIB_TYPE=RADIUSCLIENTNEW
10578 in &_Local/Makefile_& when building Exim. You can also link Exim with the
10579 &%libradius%& library that comes with FreeBSD. To do this, set
10581 RADIUS_LIB_TYPE=RADLIB
10583 in &_Local/Makefile_&, in addition to setting RADIUS_CONFIGURE_FILE.
10584 You may also have to supply a suitable setting in EXTRALIBS so that the
10585 Radius library can be found when Exim is linked.
10587 The string specified by RADIUS_CONFIG_FILE is expanded and passed to the
10588 Radius client library, which calls the Radius server. The condition is true if
10589 the authentication is successful. For example:
10591 server_condition = ${if radius{<arguments>}}
10595 .vitem "&*saslauthd&~{{*&<&'user'&>&*}{*&<&'password'&>&*}&&&
10596 {*&<&'service'&>&*}{*&<&'realm'&>&*}}*&"
10597 .cindex "&'saslauthd'& daemon"
10599 .cindex "expansion" "&'saslauthd'& authentication test"
10600 .cindex "&%saslauthd%& expansion condition"
10601 This condition supports user authentication using the Cyrus &'saslauthd'&
10602 daemon. This replaces the older &'pwcheck'& daemon, which is now deprecated.
10603 Using this daemon is one way of making it possible for passwords to be checked
10604 by a process that is not running as root.
10606 The saslauthd support is not included in Exim by default. You need to specify
10607 the location of the saslauthd daemon's socket in &_Local/Makefile_& before
10608 building Exim. For example:
10610 CYRUS_SASLAUTHD_SOCKET=/var/state/saslauthd/mux
10612 You do not need to install the full Cyrus software suite in order to use
10613 the saslauthd daemon. You can compile and install just the daemon alone
10614 from the Cyrus SASL library.
10616 Up to four arguments can be supplied to the &%saslauthd%& condition, but only
10617 two are mandatory. For example:
10619 server_condition = ${if saslauthd{{$auth1}{$auth2}}}
10621 The service and the realm are optional (which is why the arguments are enclosed
10622 in their own set of braces). For details of the meaning of the service and
10623 realm, and how to run the daemon, consult the Cyrus documentation.
10628 .section "Combining expansion conditions" "SECID84"
10629 .cindex "expansion" "combining conditions"
10630 Several conditions can be tested at once by combining them using the &%and%&
10631 and &%or%& combination conditions. Note that &%and%& and &%or%& are complete
10632 conditions on their own, and precede their lists of sub-conditions. Each
10633 sub-condition must be enclosed in braces within the overall braces that contain
10634 the list. No repetition of &%if%& is used.
10638 .vitem &*or&~{{*&<&'cond1'&>&*}{*&<&'cond2'&>&*}...}*&
10639 .cindex "&""or""& expansion condition"
10640 .cindex "expansion" "&""or""& of conditions"
10641 The sub-conditions are evaluated from left to right. The condition is true if
10642 any one of the sub-conditions is true.
10645 ${if or {{eq{$local_part}{spqr}}{eq{$domain}{testing.com}}}...
10647 When a true sub-condition is found, the following ones are parsed but not
10648 evaluated. If there are several &"match"& sub-conditions the values of the
10649 numeric variables afterwards are taken from the first one that succeeds.
10651 .vitem &*and&~{{*&<&'cond1'&>&*}{*&<&'cond2'&>&*}...}*&
10652 .cindex "&""and""& expansion condition"
10653 .cindex "expansion" "&""and""& of conditions"
10654 The sub-conditions are evaluated from left to right. The condition is true if
10655 all of the sub-conditions are true. If there are several &"match"&
10656 sub-conditions, the values of the numeric variables afterwards are taken from
10657 the last one. When a false sub-condition is found, the following ones are
10658 parsed but not evaluated.
10660 .ecindex IIDexpcond
10665 .section "Expansion variables" "SECTexpvar"
10666 .cindex "expansion" "variables, list of"
10667 This section contains an alphabetical list of all the expansion variables. Some
10668 of them are available only when Exim is compiled with specific options such as
10669 support for TLS or the content scanning extension.
10672 .vitem "&$0$&, &$1$&, etc"
10673 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)"
10674 When a &%match%& expansion condition succeeds, these variables contain the
10675 captured substrings identified by the regular expression during subsequent
10676 processing of the success string of the containing &%if%& expansion item.
10677 However, they do not retain their values afterwards; in fact, their previous
10678 values are restored at the end of processing an &%if%& item. The numerical
10679 variables may also be set externally by some other matching process which
10680 precedes the expansion of the string. For example, the commands available in
10681 Exim filter files include an &%if%& command with its own regular expression
10682 matching condition.
10684 .vitem "&$acl_c...$&"
10685 Values can be placed in these variables by the &%set%& modifier in an ACL. They
10686 can be given any name that starts with &$acl_c$& and is at least six characters
10687 long, but the sixth character must be either a digit or an underscore. For
10688 example: &$acl_c5$&, &$acl_c_mycount$&. The values of the &$acl_c...$&
10689 variables persist throughout the lifetime of an SMTP connection. They can be
10690 used to pass information between ACLs and between different invocations of the
10691 same ACL. When a message is received, the values of these variables are saved
10692 with the message, and can be accessed by filters, routers, and transports
10693 during subsequent delivery.
10695 .vitem "&$acl_m...$&"
10696 These variables are like the &$acl_c...$& variables, except that their values
10697 are reset after a message has been received. Thus, if several messages are
10698 received in one SMTP connection, &$acl_m...$& values are not passed on from one
10699 message to the next, as &$acl_c...$& values are. The &$acl_m...$& variables are
10700 also reset by MAIL, RSET, EHLO, HELO, and after starting a TLS session. When a
10701 message is received, the values of these variables are saved with the message,
10702 and can be accessed by filters, routers, and transports during subsequent
10705 .vitem &$acl_verify_message$&
10706 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
10707 After an address verification has failed, this variable contains the failure
10708 message. It retains its value for use in subsequent modifiers. The message can
10709 be preserved by coding like this:
10711 warn !verify = sender
10712 set acl_m0 = $acl_verify_message
10714 You can use &$acl_verify_message$& during the expansion of the &%message%& or
10715 &%log_message%& modifiers, to include information about the verification
10718 .vitem &$address_data$&
10719 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
10720 This variable is set by means of the &%address_data%& option in routers. The
10721 value then remains with the address while it is processed by subsequent routers
10722 and eventually a transport. If the transport is handling multiple addresses,
10723 the value from the first address is used. See chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&
10724 for more details. &*Note*&: The contents of &$address_data$& are visible in
10727 If &$address_data$& is set when the routers are called from an ACL to verify
10728 a recipient address, the final value is still in the variable for subsequent
10729 conditions and modifiers of the ACL statement. If routing the address caused it
10730 to be redirected to just one address, the child address is also routed as part
10731 of the verification, and in this case the final value of &$address_data$& is
10732 from the child's routing.
10734 If &$address_data$& is set when the routers are called from an ACL to verify a
10735 sender address, the final value is also preserved, but this time in
10736 &$sender_address_data$&, to distinguish it from data from a recipient
10739 In both cases (recipient and sender verification), the value does not persist
10740 after the end of the current ACL statement. If you want to preserve
10741 these values for longer, you can save them in ACL variables.
10743 .vitem &$address_file$&
10744 .vindex "&$address_file$&"
10745 When, as a result of aliasing, forwarding, or filtering, a message is directed
10746 to a specific file, this variable holds the name of the file when the transport
10747 is running. At other times, the variable is empty. For example, using the
10748 default configuration, if user &%r2d2%& has a &_.forward_& file containing
10750 /home/r2d2/savemail
10752 then when the &(address_file)& transport is running, &$address_file$&
10753 contains the text string &`/home/r2d2/savemail`&.
10754 .cindex "Sieve filter" "value of &$address_file$&"
10755 For Sieve filters, the value may be &"inbox"& or a relative folder name. It is
10756 then up to the transport configuration to generate an appropriate absolute path
10757 to the relevant file.
10759 .vitem &$address_pipe$&
10760 .vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
10761 When, as a result of aliasing or forwarding, a message is directed to a pipe,
10762 this variable holds the pipe command when the transport is running.
10764 .vitem "&$auth1$& &-- &$auth3$&"
10765 .vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
10766 These variables are used in SMTP authenticators (see chapters
10767 &<<CHAPplaintext>>&&--&<<CHAPspa>>&). Elsewhere, they are empty.
10769 .vitem &$authenticated_id$&
10770 .cindex "authentication" "id"
10771 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
10772 When a server successfully authenticates a client it may be configured to
10773 preserve some of the authentication information in the variable
10774 &$authenticated_id$& (see chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&). For example, a
10775 user/password authenticator configuration might preserve the user name for use
10776 in the routers. Note that this is not the same information that is saved in
10777 &$sender_host_authenticated$&.
10778 When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP connection)
10779 the value of &$authenticated_id$& is normally the login name of the calling
10780 process. However, a trusted user can override this by means of the &%-oMai%&
10781 command line option.
10786 .vitem &$authenticated_sender$&
10787 .cindex "sender" "authenticated"
10788 .cindex "authentication" "sender"
10789 .cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
10790 .vindex "&$authenticated_sender$&"
10791 When acting as a server, Exim takes note of the AUTH= parameter on an incoming
10792 SMTP MAIL command if it believes the sender is sufficiently trusted, as
10793 described in section &<<SECTauthparamail>>&. Unless the data is the string
10794 &"<>"&, it is set as the authenticated sender of the message, and the value is
10795 available during delivery in the &$authenticated_sender$& variable. If the
10796 sender is not trusted, Exim accepts the syntax of AUTH=, but ignores the data.
10798 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
10799 When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP connection), the
10800 value of &$authenticated_sender$& is an address constructed from the login
10801 name of the calling process and &$qualify_domain$&, except that a trusted user
10802 can override this by means of the &%-oMas%& command line option.
10805 .vitem &$authentication_failed$&
10806 .cindex "authentication" "failure"
10807 .vindex "&$authentication_failed$&"
10808 This variable is set to &"1"& in an Exim server if a client issues an AUTH
10809 command that does not succeed. Otherwise it is set to &"0"&. This makes it
10810 possible to distinguish between &"did not try to authenticate"&
10811 (&$sender_host_authenticated$& is empty and &$authentication_failed$& is set to
10812 &"0"&) and &"tried to authenticate but failed"& (&$sender_host_authenticated$&
10813 is empty and &$authentication_failed$& is set to &"1"&). Failure includes any
10814 negative response to an AUTH command, including (for example) an attempt to use
10815 an undefined mechanism.
10817 .vitem &$av_failed$&
10818 .cindex "content scanning" "AV scanner failure"
10819 This variable is available when Exim is compiled with the content-scanning
10820 extension. It is set to &"0"& by default, but will be set to &"1"& if any
10821 problem occurs with the virus scanner (specified by &%av_scanner%&) during
10822 the ACL malware condition.
10824 .vitem &$body_linecount$&
10825 .cindex "message body" "line count"
10826 .cindex "body of message" "line count"
10827 .vindex "&$body_linecount$&"
10828 When a message is being received or delivered, this variable contains the
10829 number of lines in the message's body. See also &$message_linecount$&.
10831 .vitem &$body_zerocount$&
10832 .cindex "message body" "binary zero count"
10833 .cindex "body of message" "binary zero count"
10834 .cindex "binary zero" "in message body"
10835 .vindex "&$body_zerocount$&"
10836 When a message is being received or delivered, this variable contains the
10837 number of binary zero bytes (ASCII NULs) in the message's body.
10839 .vitem &$bounce_recipient$&
10840 .vindex "&$bounce_recipient$&"
10841 This is set to the recipient address of a bounce message while Exim is creating
10842 it. It is useful if a customized bounce message text file is in use (see
10843 chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>&).
10845 .vitem &$bounce_return_size_limit$&
10846 .vindex "&$bounce_return_size_limit$&"
10847 This contains the value set in the &%bounce_return_size_limit%& option, rounded
10848 up to a multiple of 1000. It is useful when a customized error message text
10849 file is in use (see chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>&).
10851 .vitem &$caller_gid$&
10852 .cindex "gid (group id)" "caller"
10853 .vindex "&$caller_gid$&"
10854 The real group id under which the process that called Exim was running. This is
10855 not the same as the group id of the originator of a message (see
10856 &$originator_gid$&). If Exim re-execs itself, this variable in the new
10857 incarnation normally contains the Exim gid.
10859 .vitem &$caller_uid$&
10860 .cindex "uid (user id)" "caller"
10861 .vindex "&$caller_uid$&"
10862 The real user id under which the process that called Exim was running. This is
10863 not the same as the user id of the originator of a message (see
10864 &$originator_uid$&). If Exim re-execs itself, this variable in the new
10865 incarnation normally contains the Exim uid.
10867 .vitem &$compile_date$&
10868 .vindex "&$compile_date$&"
10869 The date on which the Exim binary was compiled.
10871 .vitem &$compile_number$&
10872 .vindex "&$compile_number$&"
10873 The building process for Exim keeps a count of the number
10874 of times it has been compiled. This serves to distinguish different
10875 compilations of the same version of the program.
10877 .vitem &$demime_errorlevel$&
10878 .vindex "&$demime_errorlevel$&"
10879 This variable is available when Exim is compiled with
10880 the content-scanning extension and the obsolete &%demime%& condition. For
10881 details, see section &<<SECTdemimecond>>&.
10883 .vitem &$demime_reason$&
10884 .vindex "&$demime_reason$&"
10885 This variable is available when Exim is compiled with the
10886 content-scanning extension and the obsolete &%demime%& condition. For details,
10887 see section &<<SECTdemimecond>>&.
10889 .vitem &$dnslist_domain$& &&&
10890 &$dnslist_matched$& &&&
10891 &$dnslist_text$& &&&
10893 .vindex "&$dnslist_domain$&"
10894 .vindex "&$dnslist_matched$&"
10895 .vindex "&$dnslist_text$&"
10896 .vindex "&$dnslist_value$&"
10897 .cindex "black list (DNS)"
10898 When a DNS (black) list lookup succeeds, these variables are set to contain
10899 the following data from the lookup: the list's domain name, the key that was
10900 looked up, the contents of any associated TXT record, and the value from the
10901 main A record. See section &<<SECID204>>& for more details.
10904 .vindex "&$domain$&"
10905 When an address is being routed, or delivered on its own, this variable
10906 contains the domain. Uppercase letters in the domain are converted into lower
10907 case for &$domain$&.
10909 Global address rewriting happens when a message is received, so the value of
10910 &$domain$& during routing and delivery is the value after rewriting. &$domain$&
10911 is set during user filtering, but not during system filtering, because a
10912 message may have many recipients and the system filter is called just once.
10914 When more than one address is being delivered at once (for example, several
10915 RCPT commands in one SMTP delivery), &$domain$& is set only if they all
10916 have the same domain. Transports can be restricted to handling only one domain
10917 at a time if the value of &$domain$& is required at transport time &-- this is
10918 the default for local transports. For further details of the environment in
10919 which local transports are run, see chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
10921 .oindex "&%delay_warning_condition%&"
10922 At the end of a delivery, if all deferred addresses have the same domain, it is
10923 set in &$domain$& during the expansion of &%delay_warning_condition%&.
10925 The &$domain$& variable is also used in some other circumstances:
10928 When an ACL is running for a RCPT command, &$domain$& contains the domain of
10929 the recipient address. The domain of the &'sender'& address is in
10930 &$sender_address_domain$& at both MAIL time and at RCPT time. &$domain$& is not
10931 normally set during the running of the MAIL ACL. However, if the sender address
10932 is verified with a callout during the MAIL ACL, the sender domain is placed in
10933 &$domain$& during the expansions of &%hosts%&, &%interface%&, and &%port%& in
10934 the &(smtp)& transport.
10937 When a rewrite item is being processed (see chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&),
10938 &$domain$& contains the domain portion of the address that is being rewritten;
10939 it can be used in the expansion of the replacement address, for example, to
10940 rewrite domains by file lookup.
10943 With one important exception, whenever a domain list is being scanned,
10944 &$domain$& contains the subject domain. &*Exception*&: When a domain list in
10945 a &%sender_domains%& condition in an ACL is being processed, the subject domain
10946 is in &$sender_address_domain$& and not in &$domain$&. It works this way so
10947 that, in a RCPT ACL, the sender domain list can be dependent on the
10948 recipient domain (which is what is in &$domain$& at this time).
10951 .cindex "ETRN" "value of &$domain$&"
10952 .oindex "&%smtp_etrn_command%&"
10953 When the &%smtp_etrn_command%& option is being expanded, &$domain$& contains
10954 the complete argument of the ETRN command (see section &<<SECTETRN>>&).
10958 .vitem &$domain_data$&
10959 .vindex "&$domain_data$&"
10960 When the &%domains%& option on a router matches a domain by
10961 means of a lookup, the data read by the lookup is available during the running
10962 of the router as &$domain_data$&. In addition, if the driver routes the
10963 address to a transport, the value is available in that transport. If the
10964 transport is handling multiple addresses, the value from the first address is
10967 &$domain_data$& is also set when the &%domains%& condition in an ACL matches a
10968 domain by means of a lookup. The data read by the lookup is available during
10969 the rest of the ACL statement. In all other situations, this variable expands
10972 .vitem &$exim_gid$&
10973 .vindex "&$exim_gid$&"
10974 This variable contains the numerical value of the Exim group id.
10976 .vitem &$exim_path$&
10977 .vindex "&$exim_path$&"
10978 This variable contains the path to the Exim binary.
10980 .vitem &$exim_uid$&
10981 .vindex "&$exim_uid$&"
10982 This variable contains the numerical value of the Exim user id.
10984 .vitem &$found_extension$&
10985 .vindex "&$found_extension$&"
10986 This variable is available when Exim is compiled with the
10987 content-scanning extension and the obsolete &%demime%& condition. For details,
10988 see section &<<SECTdemimecond>>&.
10990 .vitem &$header_$&<&'name'&>
10991 This is not strictly an expansion variable. It is expansion syntax for
10992 inserting the message header line with the given name. Note that the name must
10993 be terminated by colon or white space, because it may contain a wide variety of
10994 characters. Note also that braces must &'not'& be used.
10998 When the &%check_local_user%& option is set for a router, the user's home
10999 directory is placed in &$home$& when the check succeeds. In particular, this
11000 means it is set during the running of users' filter files. A router may also
11001 explicitly set a home directory for use by a transport; this can be overridden
11002 by a setting on the transport itself.
11004 When running a filter test via the &%-bf%& option, &$home$& is set to the value
11005 of the environment variable HOME.
11009 If a router assigns an address to a transport (any transport), and passes a
11010 list of hosts with the address, the value of &$host$& when the transport starts
11011 to run is the name of the first host on the list. Note that this applies both
11012 to local and remote transports.
11014 .cindex "transport" "filter"
11015 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
11016 For the &(smtp)& transport, if there is more than one host, the value of
11017 &$host$& changes as the transport works its way through the list. In
11018 particular, when the &(smtp)& transport is expanding its options for encryption
11019 using TLS, or for specifying a transport filter (see chapter
11020 &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&), &$host$& contains the name of the host to which it
11023 When used in the client part of an authenticator configuration (see chapter
11024 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&), &$host$& contains the name of the server to which the
11025 client is connected.
11028 .vitem &$host_address$&
11029 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
11030 This variable is set to the remote host's IP address whenever &$host$& is set
11031 for a remote connection. It is also set to the IP address that is being checked
11032 when the &%ignore_target_hosts%& option is being processed.
11034 .vitem &$host_data$&
11035 .vindex "&$host_data$&"
11036 If a &%hosts%& condition in an ACL is satisfied by means of a lookup, the
11037 result of the lookup is made available in the &$host_data$& variable. This
11038 allows you, for example, to do things like this:
11040 deny hosts = net-lsearch;/some/file
11041 message = $host_data
11043 .vitem &$host_lookup_deferred$&
11044 .cindex "host name" "lookup, failure of"
11045 .vindex "&$host_lookup_deferred$&"
11046 This variable normally contains &"0"&, as does &$host_lookup_failed$&. When a
11047 message comes from a remote host and there is an attempt to look up the host's
11048 name from its IP address, and the attempt is not successful, one of these
11049 variables is set to &"1"&.
11052 If the lookup receives a definite negative response (for example, a DNS lookup
11053 succeeded, but no records were found), &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&.
11056 If there is any kind of problem during the lookup, such that Exim cannot
11057 tell whether or not the host name is defined (for example, a timeout for a DNS
11058 lookup), &$host_lookup_deferred$& is set to &"1"&.
11061 Looking up a host's name from its IP address consists of more than just a
11062 single reverse lookup. Exim checks that a forward lookup of at least one of the
11063 names it receives from a reverse lookup yields the original IP address. If this
11064 is not the case, Exim does not accept the looked up name(s), and
11065 &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&. Thus, being able to find a name from an
11066 IP address (for example, the existence of a PTR record in the DNS) is not
11067 sufficient on its own for the success of a host name lookup. If the reverse
11068 lookup succeeds, but there is a lookup problem such as a timeout when checking
11069 the result, the name is not accepted, and &$host_lookup_deferred$& is set to
11070 &"1"&. See also &$sender_host_name$&.
11072 .vitem &$host_lookup_failed$&
11073 .vindex "&$host_lookup_failed$&"
11074 See &$host_lookup_deferred$&.
11078 .vindex "&$inode$&"
11079 The only time this variable is set is while expanding the &%directory_file%&
11080 option in the &(appendfile)& transport. The variable contains the inode number
11081 of the temporary file which is about to be renamed. It can be used to construct
11082 a unique name for the file.
11084 .vitem &$interface_address$&
11085 .vindex "&$interface_address$&"
11086 This is an obsolete name for &$received_ip_address$&.
11088 .vitem &$interface_port$&
11089 .vindex "&$interface_port$&"
11090 This is an obsolete name for &$received_port$&.
11094 This variable is used during the expansion of &*forall*& and &*forany*&
11095 conditions (see section &<<SECTexpcond>>&), and &*filter*&, &*map*&, and
11096 &*reduce*& items (see section &<<SECTexpcond>>&). In other circumstances, it is
11100 .vindex "&$ldap_dn$&"
11101 This variable, which is available only when Exim is compiled with LDAP support,
11102 contains the DN from the last entry in the most recently successful LDAP
11105 .vitem &$load_average$&
11106 .vindex "&$load_average$&"
11107 This variable contains the system load average, multiplied by 1000 so that it
11108 is an integer. For example, if the load average is 0.21, the value of the
11109 variable is 210. The value is recomputed every time the variable is referenced.
11111 .vitem &$local_part$&
11112 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
11113 When an address is being routed, or delivered on its own, this
11114 variable contains the local part. When a number of addresses are being
11115 delivered together (for example, multiple RCPT commands in an SMTP
11116 session), &$local_part$& is not set.
11118 Global address rewriting happens when a message is received, so the value of
11119 &$local_part$& during routing and delivery is the value after rewriting.
11120 &$local_part$& is set during user filtering, but not during system filtering,
11121 because a message may have many recipients and the system filter is called just
11124 .vindex "&$local_part_prefix$&"
11125 .vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
11126 If a local part prefix or suffix has been recognized, it is not included in the
11127 value of &$local_part$& during routing and subsequent delivery. The values of
11128 any prefix or suffix are in &$local_part_prefix$& and
11129 &$local_part_suffix$&, respectively.
11131 When a message is being delivered to a file, pipe, or autoreply transport as a
11132 result of aliasing or forwarding, &$local_part$& is set to the local part of
11133 the parent address, not to the file name or command (see &$address_file$& and
11136 When an ACL is running for a RCPT command, &$local_part$& contains the
11137 local part of the recipient address.
11139 When a rewrite item is being processed (see chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&),
11140 &$local_part$& contains the local part of the address that is being rewritten;
11141 it can be used in the expansion of the replacement address, for example.
11143 In all cases, all quoting is removed from the local part. For example, for both
11146 "abc:xyz"@test.example
11147 abc\:xyz@test.example
11149 the value of &$local_part$& is
11153 If you use &$local_part$& to create another address, you should always wrap it
11154 inside a quoting operator. For example, in a &(redirect)& router you could
11157 data = ${quote_local_part:$local_part}@new.domain.example
11159 &*Note*&: The value of &$local_part$& is normally lower cased. If you want
11160 to process local parts in a case-dependent manner in a router, you can set the
11161 &%caseful_local_part%& option (see chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&).
11163 .vitem &$local_part_data$&
11164 .vindex "&$local_part_data$&"
11165 When the &%local_parts%& option on a router matches a local part by means of a
11166 lookup, the data read by the lookup is available during the running of the
11167 router as &$local_part_data$&. In addition, if the driver routes the address
11168 to a transport, the value is available in that transport. If the transport is
11169 handling multiple addresses, the value from the first address is used.
11171 &$local_part_data$& is also set when the &%local_parts%& condition in an ACL
11172 matches a local part by means of a lookup. The data read by the lookup is
11173 available during the rest of the ACL statement. In all other situations, this
11174 variable expands to nothing.
11176 .vitem &$local_part_prefix$&
11177 .vindex "&$local_part_prefix$&"
11178 When an address is being routed or delivered, and a
11179 specific prefix for the local part was recognized, it is available in this
11180 variable, having been removed from &$local_part$&.
11182 .vitem &$local_part_suffix$&
11183 .vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
11184 When an address is being routed or delivered, and a
11185 specific suffix for the local part was recognized, it is available in this
11186 variable, having been removed from &$local_part$&.
11188 .vitem &$local_scan_data$&
11189 .vindex "&$local_scan_data$&"
11190 This variable contains the text returned by the &[local_scan()]& function when
11191 a message is received. See chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>& for more details.
11193 .vitem &$local_user_gid$&
11194 .vindex "&$local_user_gid$&"
11195 See &$local_user_uid$&.
11197 .vitem &$local_user_uid$&
11198 .vindex "&$local_user_uid$&"
11199 This variable and &$local_user_gid$& are set to the uid and gid after the
11200 &%check_local_user%& router precondition succeeds. This means that their values
11201 are available for the remaining preconditions (&%senders%&, &%require_files%&,
11202 and &%condition%&), for the &%address_data%& expansion, and for any
11203 router-specific expansions. At all other times, the values in these variables
11204 are &`(uid_t)(-1)`& and &`(gid_t)(-1)`&, respectively.
11206 .vitem &$localhost_number$&
11207 .vindex "&$localhost_number$&"
11208 This contains the expanded value of the
11209 &%localhost_number%& option. The expansion happens after the main options have
11212 .vitem &$log_inodes$&
11213 .vindex "&$log_inodes$&"
11214 The number of free inodes in the disk partition where Exim's
11215 log files are being written. The value is recalculated whenever the variable is
11216 referenced. If the relevant file system does not have the concept of inodes,
11217 the value of is -1. See also the &%check_log_inodes%& option.
11219 .vitem &$log_space$&
11220 .vindex "&$log_space$&"
11221 The amount of free space (as a number of kilobytes) in the disk
11222 partition where Exim's log files are being written. The value is recalculated
11223 whenever the variable is referenced. If the operating system does not have the
11224 ability to find the amount of free space (only true for experimental systems),
11225 the space value is -1. See also the &%check_log_space%& option.
11228 .vitem &$mailstore_basename$&
11229 .vindex "&$mailstore_basename$&"
11230 This variable is set only when doing deliveries in &"mailstore"& format in the
11231 &(appendfile)& transport. During the expansion of the &%mailstore_prefix%&,
11232 &%mailstore_suffix%&, &%message_prefix%&, and &%message_suffix%& options, it
11233 contains the basename of the files that are being written, that is, the name
11234 without the &".tmp"&, &".env"&, or &".msg"& suffix. At all other times, this
11237 .vitem &$malware_name$&
11238 .vindex "&$malware_name$&"
11239 This variable is available when Exim is compiled with the
11240 content-scanning extension. It is set to the name of the virus that was found
11241 when the ACL &%malware%& condition is true (see section &<<SECTscanvirus>>&).
11243 .vitem &$max_received_linelength$&
11244 .vindex "&$max_received_linelength$&"
11245 .cindex "maximum" "line length"
11246 .cindex "line length" "maximum"
11247 This variable contains the number of bytes in the longest line that was
11248 received as part of the message, not counting the line termination
11251 .vitem &$message_age$&
11252 .cindex "message" "age of"
11253 .vindex "&$message_age$&"
11254 This variable is set at the start of a delivery attempt to contain the number
11255 of seconds since the message was received. It does not change during a single
11258 .vitem &$message_body$&
11259 .cindex "body of message" "expansion variable"
11260 .cindex "message body" "in expansion"
11261 .cindex "binary zero" "in message body"
11262 .vindex "&$message_body$&"
11263 .oindex "&%message_body_visible%&"
11264 This variable contains the initial portion of a message's body while it is
11265 being delivered, and is intended mainly for use in filter files. The maximum
11266 number of characters of the body that are put into the variable is set by the
11267 &%message_body_visible%& configuration option; the default is 500.
11269 .oindex "&%message_body_newlines%&"
11270 By default, newlines are converted into spaces in &$message_body$&, to make it
11271 easier to search for phrases that might be split over a line break. However,
11272 this can be disabled by setting &%message_body_newlines%& to be true. Binary
11273 zeros are always converted into spaces.
11275 .vitem &$message_body_end$&
11276 .cindex "body of message" "expansion variable"
11277 .cindex "message body" "in expansion"
11278 .vindex "&$message_body_end$&"
11279 This variable contains the final portion of a message's
11280 body while it is being delivered. The format and maximum size are as for
11283 .vitem &$message_body_size$&
11284 .cindex "body of message" "size"
11285 .cindex "message body" "size"
11286 .vindex "&$message_body_size$&"
11287 When a message is being delivered, this variable contains the size of the body
11288 in bytes. The count starts from the character after the blank line that
11289 separates the body from the header. Newlines are included in the count. See
11290 also &$message_size$&, &$body_linecount$&, and &$body_zerocount$&.
11292 .vitem &$message_exim_id$&
11293 .vindex "&$message_exim_id$&"
11294 When a message is being received or delivered, this variable contains the
11295 unique message id that is generated and used by Exim to identify the message.
11296 An id is not created for a message until after its header has been successfully
11297 received. &*Note*&: This is &'not'& the contents of the &'Message-ID:'& header
11298 line; it is the local id that Exim assigns to the message, for example:
11299 &`1BXTIK-0001yO-VA`&.
11301 .vitem &$message_headers$&
11302 .vindex &$message_headers$&
11303 This variable contains a concatenation of all the header lines when a message
11304 is being processed, except for lines added by routers or transports. The header
11305 lines are separated by newline characters. Their contents are decoded in the
11306 same way as a header line that is inserted by &%bheader%&.
11308 .vitem &$message_headers_raw$&
11309 .vindex &$message_headers_raw$&
11310 This variable is like &$message_headers$& except that no processing of the
11311 contents of header lines is done.
11313 .vitem &$message_id$&
11314 This is an old name for &$message_exim_id$&, which is now deprecated.
11316 .vitem &$message_linecount$&
11317 .vindex "&$message_linecount$&"
11318 This variable contains the total number of lines in the header and body of the
11319 message. Compare &$body_linecount$&, which is the count for the body only.
11320 During the DATA and content-scanning ACLs, &$message_linecount$& contains the
11321 number of lines received. Before delivery happens (that is, before filters,
11322 routers, and transports run) the count is increased to include the
11323 &'Received:'& header line that Exim standardly adds, and also any other header
11324 lines that are added by ACLs. The blank line that separates the message header
11325 from the body is not counted.
11327 As with the special case of &$message_size$&, during the expansion of the
11328 appendfile transport's maildir_tag option in maildir format, the value of
11329 &$message_linecount$& is the precise size of the number of newlines in the
11330 file that has been written (minus one for the blank line between the
11331 header and the body).
11333 Here is an example of the use of this variable in a DATA ACL:
11335 deny message = Too many lines in message header
11337 ${if <{250}{${eval:$message_linecount - $body_linecount}}}
11339 In the MAIL and RCPT ACLs, the value is zero because at that stage the
11340 message has not yet been received.
11342 .vitem &$message_size$&
11343 .cindex "size" "of message"
11344 .cindex "message" "size"
11345 .vindex "&$message_size$&"
11346 When a message is being processed, this variable contains its size in bytes. In
11347 most cases, the size includes those headers that were received with the
11348 message, but not those (such as &'Envelope-to:'&) that are added to individual
11349 deliveries as they are written. However, there is one special case: during the
11350 expansion of the &%maildir_tag%& option in the &(appendfile)& transport while
11351 doing a delivery in maildir format, the value of &$message_size$& is the
11352 precise size of the file that has been written. See also
11353 &$message_body_size$&, &$body_linecount$&, and &$body_zerocount$&.
11355 .cindex "RCPT" "value of &$message_size$&"
11356 While running a per message ACL (mail/rcpt/predata), &$message_size$&
11357 contains the size supplied on the MAIL command, or -1 if no size was given. The
11358 value may not, of course, be truthful.
11360 .vitem &$mime_$&&'xxx'&
11361 A number of variables whose names start with &$mime$& are
11362 available when Exim is compiled with the content-scanning extension. For
11363 details, see section &<<SECTscanmimepart>>&.
11365 .vitem "&$n0$& &-- &$n9$&"
11366 These variables are counters that can be incremented by means
11367 of the &%add%& command in filter files.
11369 .vitem &$original_domain$&
11370 .vindex "&$domain$&"
11371 .vindex "&$original_domain$&"
11372 When a top-level address is being processed for delivery, this contains the
11373 same value as &$domain$&. However, if a &"child"& address (for example,
11374 generated by an alias, forward, or filter file) is being processed, this
11375 variable contains the domain of the original address (lower cased). This
11376 differs from &$parent_domain$& only when there is more than one level of
11377 aliasing or forwarding. When more than one address is being delivered in a
11378 single transport run, &$original_domain$& is not set.
11380 If a new address is created by means of a &%deliver%& command in a system
11381 filter, it is set up with an artificial &"parent"& address. This has the local
11382 part &'system-filter'& and the default qualify domain.
11384 .vitem &$original_local_part$&
11385 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
11386 .vindex "&$original_local_part$&"
11387 When a top-level address is being processed for delivery, this contains the
11388 same value as &$local_part$&, unless a prefix or suffix was removed from the
11389 local part, because &$original_local_part$& always contains the full local
11390 part. When a &"child"& address (for example, generated by an alias, forward, or
11391 filter file) is being processed, this variable contains the full local part of
11392 the original address.
11394 If the router that did the redirection processed the local part
11395 case-insensitively, the value in &$original_local_part$& is in lower case.
11396 This variable differs from &$parent_local_part$& only when there is more than
11397 one level of aliasing or forwarding. When more than one address is being
11398 delivered in a single transport run, &$original_local_part$& is not set.
11400 If a new address is created by means of a &%deliver%& command in a system
11401 filter, it is set up with an artificial &"parent"& address. This has the local
11402 part &'system-filter'& and the default qualify domain.
11404 .vitem &$originator_gid$&
11405 .cindex "gid (group id)" "of originating user"
11406 .cindex "sender" "gid"
11407 .vindex "&$caller_gid$&"
11408 .vindex "&$originator_gid$&"
11409 This variable contains the value of &$caller_gid$& that was set when the
11410 message was received. For messages received via the command line, this is the
11411 gid of the sending user. For messages received by SMTP over TCP/IP, this is
11412 normally the gid of the Exim user.
11414 .vitem &$originator_uid$&
11415 .cindex "uid (user id)" "of originating user"
11416 .cindex "sender" "uid"
11417 .vindex "&$caller_uid$&"
11418 .vindex "&$originaltor_uid$&"
11419 The value of &$caller_uid$& that was set when the message was received. For
11420 messages received via the command line, this is the uid of the sending user.
11421 For messages received by SMTP over TCP/IP, this is normally the uid of the Exim
11424 .vitem &$parent_domain$&
11425 .vindex "&$parent_domain$&"
11426 This variable is similar to &$original_domain$& (see
11427 above), except that it refers to the immediately preceding parent address.
11429 .vitem &$parent_local_part$&
11430 .vindex "&$parent_local_part$&"
11431 This variable is similar to &$original_local_part$&
11432 (see above), except that it refers to the immediately preceding parent address.
11435 .cindex "pid (process id)" "of current process"
11437 This variable contains the current process id.
11439 .vitem &$pipe_addresses$&
11440 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
11441 .cindex "transport" "filter"
11442 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
11443 This is not an expansion variable, but is mentioned here because the string
11444 &`$pipe_addresses`& is handled specially in the command specification for the
11445 &(pipe)& transport (chapter &<<CHAPpipetransport>>&) and in transport filters
11446 (described under &%transport_filter%& in chapter &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&).
11447 It cannot be used in general expansion strings, and provokes an &"unknown
11448 variable"& error if encountered.
11450 .vitem &$primary_hostname$&
11451 .vindex "&$primary_hostname$&"
11452 This variable contains the value set by &%primary_hostname%& in the
11453 configuration file, or read by the &[uname()]& function. If &[uname()]& returns
11454 a single-component name, Exim calls &[gethostbyname()]& (or
11455 &[getipnodebyname()]& where available) in an attempt to acquire a fully
11456 qualified host name. See also &$smtp_active_hostname$&.
11459 .vitem &$prvscheck_address$&
11460 This variable is used in conjunction with the &%prvscheck%& expansion item,
11461 which is described in sections &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& and
11462 &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
11464 .vitem &$prvscheck_keynum$&
11465 This variable is used in conjunction with the &%prvscheck%& expansion item,
11466 which is described in sections &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& and
11467 &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
11469 .vitem &$prvscheck_result$&
11470 This variable is used in conjunction with the &%prvscheck%& expansion item,
11471 which is described in sections &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& and
11472 &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
11474 .vitem &$qualify_domain$&
11475 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
11476 The value set for the &%qualify_domain%& option in the configuration file.
11478 .vitem &$qualify_recipient$&
11479 .vindex "&$qualify_recipient$&"
11480 The value set for the &%qualify_recipient%& option in the configuration file,
11481 or if not set, the value of &$qualify_domain$&.
11483 .vitem &$rcpt_count$&
11484 .vindex "&$rcpt_count$&"
11485 When a message is being received by SMTP, this variable contains the number of
11486 RCPT commands received for the current message. If this variable is used in a
11487 RCPT ACL, its value includes the current command.
11489 .vitem &$rcpt_defer_count$&
11490 .vindex "&$rcpt_defer_count$&"
11491 .cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "count of"
11492 When a message is being received by SMTP, this variable contains the number of
11493 RCPT commands in the current message that have previously been rejected with a
11494 temporary (4&'xx'&) response.
11496 .vitem &$rcpt_fail_count$&
11497 .vindex "&$rcpt_fail_count$&"
11498 When a message is being received by SMTP, this variable contains the number of
11499 RCPT commands in the current message that have previously been rejected with a
11500 permanent (5&'xx'&) response.
11502 .vitem &$received_count$&
11503 .vindex "&$received_count$&"
11504 This variable contains the number of &'Received:'& header lines in the message,
11505 including the one added by Exim (so its value is always greater than zero). It
11506 is available in the DATA ACL, the non-SMTP ACL, and while routing and
11509 .vitem &$received_for$&
11510 .vindex "&$received_for$&"
11511 If there is only a single recipient address in an incoming message, this
11512 variable contains that address when the &'Received:'& header line is being
11513 built. The value is copied after recipient rewriting has happened, but before
11514 the &[local_scan()]& function is run.
11516 .vitem &$received_ip_address$&
11517 .vindex "&$received_ip_address$&"
11518 As soon as an Exim server starts processing an incoming TCP/IP connection, this
11519 variable is set to the address of the local IP interface, and &$received_port$&
11520 is set to the local port number. (The remote IP address and port are in
11521 &$sender_host_address$& and &$sender_host_port$&.) When testing with &%-bh%&,
11522 the port value is -1 unless it has been set using the &%-oMi%& command line
11525 As well as being useful in ACLs (including the &"connect"& ACL), these variable
11526 could be used, for example, to make the file name for a TLS certificate depend
11527 on which interface and/or port is being used for the incoming connection. The
11528 values of &$received_ip_address$& and &$received_port$& are saved with any
11529 messages that are received, thus making these variables available at delivery
11532 &*Note:*& There are no equivalent variables for outgoing connections, because
11533 the values are unknown (unless they are explicitly set by options of the
11534 &(smtp)& transport).
11536 .vitem &$received_port$&
11537 .vindex "&$received_port$&"
11538 See &$received_ip_address$&.
11540 .vitem &$received_protocol$&
11541 .vindex "&$received_protocol$&"
11542 When a message is being processed, this variable contains the name of the
11543 protocol by which it was received. Most of the names used by Exim are defined
11544 by RFCs 821, 2821, and 3848. They start with &"smtp"& (the client used HELO) or
11545 &"esmtp"& (the client used EHLO). This can be followed by &"s"& for secure
11546 (encrypted) and/or &"a"& for authenticated. Thus, for example, if the protocol
11547 is set to &"esmtpsa"&, the message was received over an encrypted SMTP
11548 connection and the client was successfully authenticated.
11550 Exim uses the protocol name &"smtps"& for the case when encryption is
11551 automatically set up on connection without the use of STARTTLS (see
11552 &%tls_on_connect_ports%&), and the client uses HELO to initiate the
11553 encrypted SMTP session. The name &"smtps"& is also used for the rare situation
11554 where the client initially uses EHLO, sets up an encrypted connection using
11555 STARTTLS, and then uses HELO afterwards.
11557 The &%-oMr%& option provides a way of specifying a custom protocol name for
11558 messages that are injected locally by trusted callers. This is commonly used to
11559 identify messages that are being re-injected after some kind of scanning.
11561 .vitem &$received_time$&
11562 .vindex "&$received_time$&"
11563 This variable contains the date and time when the current message was received,
11564 as a number of seconds since the start of the Unix epoch.
11566 .vitem &$recipient_data$&
11567 .vindex "&$recipient_data$&"
11568 This variable is set after an indexing lookup success in an ACL &%recipients%&
11569 condition. It contains the data from the lookup, and the value remains set
11570 until the next &%recipients%& test. Thus, you can do things like this:
11572 &`require recipients = cdb*@;/some/file`&
11573 &`deny `&&'some further test involving'& &`$recipient_data`&
11575 &*Warning*&: This variable is set only when a lookup is used as an indexing
11576 method in the address list, using the semicolon syntax as in the example above.
11577 The variable is not set for a lookup that is used as part of the string
11578 expansion that all such lists undergo before being interpreted.
11580 .vitem &$recipient_verify_failure$&
11581 .vindex "&$recipient_verify_failure$&"
11582 In an ACL, when a recipient verification fails, this variable contains
11583 information about the failure. It is set to one of the following words:
11586 &"qualify"&: The address was unqualified (no domain), and the message
11587 was neither local nor came from an exempted host.
11590 &"route"&: Routing failed.
11593 &"mail"&: Routing succeeded, and a callout was attempted; rejection occurred at
11594 or before the MAIL command (that is, on initial connection, HELO, or
11598 &"recipient"&: The RCPT command in a callout was rejected.
11601 &"postmaster"&: The postmaster check in a callout was rejected.
11604 The main use of this variable is expected to be to distinguish between
11605 rejections of MAIL and rejections of RCPT.
11607 .vitem &$recipients$&
11608 .vindex "&$recipients$&"
11609 This variable contains a list of envelope recipients for a message. A comma and
11610 a space separate the addresses in the replacement text. However, the variable
11611 is not generally available, to prevent exposure of Bcc recipients in
11612 unprivileged users' filter files. You can use &$recipients$& only in these
11616 In a system filter file.
11618 In the ACLs associated with the DATA command and with non-SMTP messages, that
11619 is, the ACLs defined by &%acl_smtp_predata%&, &%acl_smtp_data%&,
11620 &%acl_smtp_mime%&, &%acl_not_smtp_start%&, &%acl_not_smtp%&, and
11621 &%acl_not_smtp_mime%&.
11623 From within a &[local_scan()]& function.
11627 .vitem &$recipients_count$&
11628 .vindex "&$recipients_count$&"
11629 When a message is being processed, this variable contains the number of
11630 envelope recipients that came with the message. Duplicates are not excluded
11631 from the count. While a message is being received over SMTP, the number
11632 increases for each accepted recipient. It can be referenced in an ACL.
11635 .vitem &$regex_match_string$&
11636 .vindex "&$regex_match_string$&"
11637 This variable is set to contain the matching regular expression after a
11638 &%regex%& ACL condition has matched (see section &<<SECTscanregex>>&).
11641 .vitem &$reply_address$&
11642 .vindex "&$reply_address$&"
11643 When a message is being processed, this variable contains the contents of the
11644 &'Reply-To:'& header line if one exists and it is not empty, or otherwise the
11645 contents of the &'From:'& header line. Apart from the removal of leading
11646 white space, the value is not processed in any way. In particular, no RFC 2047
11647 decoding or character code translation takes place.
11649 .vitem &$return_path$&
11650 .vindex "&$return_path$&"
11651 When a message is being delivered, this variable contains the return path &--
11652 the sender field that will be sent as part of the envelope. It is not enclosed
11653 in <> characters. At the start of routing an address, &$return_path$& has the
11654 same value as &$sender_address$&, but if, for example, an incoming message to a
11655 mailing list has been expanded by a router which specifies a different address
11656 for bounce messages, &$return_path$& subsequently contains the new bounce
11657 address, whereas &$sender_address$& always contains the original sender address
11658 that was received with the message. In other words, &$sender_address$& contains
11659 the incoming envelope sender, and &$return_path$& contains the outgoing
11662 .vitem &$return_size_limit$&
11663 .vindex "&$return_size_limit$&"
11664 This is an obsolete name for &$bounce_return_size_limit$&.
11667 .cindex "return code" "from &%run%& expansion"
11668 .vindex "&$runrc$&"
11669 This variable contains the return code from a command that is run by the
11670 &%${run...}%& expansion item. &*Warning*&: In a router or transport, you cannot
11671 assume the order in which option values are expanded, except for those
11672 preconditions whose order of testing is documented. Therefore, you cannot
11673 reliably expect to set &$runrc$& by the expansion of one option, and use it in
11676 .vitem &$self_hostname$&
11677 .oindex "&%self%&" "value of host name"
11678 .vindex "&$self_hostname$&"
11679 When an address is routed to a supposedly remote host that turns out to be the
11680 local host, what happens is controlled by the &%self%& generic router option.
11681 One of its values causes the address to be passed to another router. When this
11682 happens, &$self_hostname$& is set to the name of the local host that the
11683 original router encountered. In other circumstances its contents are null.
11685 .vitem &$sender_address$&
11686 .vindex "&$sender_address$&"
11687 When a message is being processed, this variable contains the sender's address
11688 that was received in the message's envelope. The case of letters in the address
11689 is retained, in both the local part and the domain. For bounce messages, the
11690 value of this variable is the empty string. See also &$return_path$&.
11692 .vitem &$sender_address_data$&
11693 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
11694 .vindex "&$sender_address_data$&"
11695 If &$address_data$& is set when the routers are called from an ACL to verify a
11696 sender address, the final value is preserved in &$sender_address_data$&, to
11697 distinguish it from data from a recipient address. The value does not persist
11698 after the end of the current ACL statement. If you want to preserve it for
11699 longer, you can save it in an ACL variable.
11701 .vitem &$sender_address_domain$&
11702 .vindex "&$sender_address_domain$&"
11703 The domain portion of &$sender_address$&.
11705 .vitem &$sender_address_local_part$&
11706 .vindex "&$sender_address_local_part$&"
11707 The local part portion of &$sender_address$&.
11709 .vitem &$sender_data$&
11710 .vindex "&$sender_data$&"
11711 This variable is set after a lookup success in an ACL &%senders%& condition or
11712 in a router &%senders%& option. It contains the data from the lookup, and the
11713 value remains set until the next &%senders%& test. Thus, you can do things like
11716 &`require senders = cdb*@;/some/file`&
11717 &`deny `&&'some further test involving'& &`$sender_data`&
11719 &*Warning*&: This variable is set only when a lookup is used as an indexing
11720 method in the address list, using the semicolon syntax as in the example above.
11721 The variable is not set for a lookup that is used as part of the string
11722 expansion that all such lists undergo before being interpreted.
11724 .vitem &$sender_fullhost$&
11725 .vindex "&$sender_fullhost$&"
11726 When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the host
11727 name and IP address in a single string. It ends with the IP address in square
11728 brackets, followed by a colon and a port number if the logging of ports is
11729 enabled. The format of the rest of the string depends on whether the host
11730 issued a HELO or EHLO SMTP command, and whether the host name was verified by
11731 looking up its IP address. (Looking up the IP address can be forced by the
11732 &%host_lookup%& option, independent of verification.) A plain host name at the
11733 start of the string is a verified host name; if this is not present,
11734 verification either failed or was not requested. A host name in parentheses is
11735 the argument of a HELO or EHLO command. This is omitted if it is identical to
11736 the verified host name or to the host's IP address in square brackets.
11738 .vitem &$sender_helo_name$&
11739 .vindex "&$sender_helo_name$&"
11740 When a message is received from a remote host that has issued a HELO or EHLO
11741 command, the argument of that command is placed in this variable. It is also
11742 set if HELO or EHLO is used when a message is received using SMTP locally via
11743 the &%-bs%& or &%-bS%& options.
11745 .vitem &$sender_host_address$&
11746 .vindex "&$sender_host_address$&"
11747 When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains that
11748 host's IP address. For locally submitted messages, it is empty.
11750 .vitem &$sender_host_authenticated$&
11751 .vindex "&$sender_host_authenticated$&"
11752 This variable contains the name (not the public name) of the authenticator
11753 driver that successfully authenticated the client from which the message was
11754 received. It is empty if there was no successful authentication. See also
11755 &$authenticated_id$&.
11758 .vitem &$sender_host_dnssec$&
11759 .vindex "&$sender_host_dnssec$&"
11760 If &$sender_host_name$& has been populated (by reference, &%hosts_lookup%& or
11761 otherwise) then this boolean will have been set true if, and only if, the
11762 resolver library states that the reverse DNS was authenticated data. At all
11763 other times, this variable is false.
11765 It is likely that you will need to coerce DNSSEC support on in the resolver
11766 library, by setting:
11771 Exim does not perform DNSSEC validation itself, instead leaving that to a
11772 validating resolver (eg, unbound, or bind with suitable configuration).
11774 Exim does not (currently) check to see if the forward DNS was also secured
11775 with DNSSEC, only the reverse DNS.
11777 If you have changed &%host_lookup_order%& so that &`bydns`& is not the first
11778 mechanism in the list, then this variable will be false.
11782 .vitem &$sender_host_name$&
11783 .vindex "&$sender_host_name$&"
11784 When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the
11785 host's name as obtained by looking up its IP address. For messages received by
11786 other means, this variable is empty.
11788 .vindex "&$host_lookup_failed$&"
11789 If the host name has not previously been looked up, a reference to
11790 &$sender_host_name$& triggers a lookup (for messages from remote hosts).
11791 A looked up name is accepted only if it leads back to the original IP address
11792 via a forward lookup. If either the reverse or the forward lookup fails to find
11793 any data, or if the forward lookup does not yield the original IP address,
11794 &$sender_host_name$& remains empty, and &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&.
11796 .vindex "&$host_lookup_deferred$&"
11797 However, if either of the lookups cannot be completed (for example, there is a
11798 DNS timeout), &$host_lookup_deferred$& is set to &"1"&, and
11799 &$host_lookup_failed$& remains set to &"0"&.
11801 Once &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&, Exim does not try to look up the
11802 host name again if there is a subsequent reference to &$sender_host_name$&
11803 in the same Exim process, but it does try again if &$host_lookup_deferred$&
11806 Exim does not automatically look up every calling host's name. If you want
11807 maximum efficiency, you should arrange your configuration so that it avoids
11808 these lookups altogether. The lookup happens only if one or more of the
11809 following are true:
11812 A string containing &$sender_host_name$& is expanded.
11814 The calling host matches the list in &%host_lookup%&. In the default
11815 configuration, this option is set to *, so it must be changed if lookups are
11816 to be avoided. (In the code, the default for &%host_lookup%& is unset.)
11818 Exim needs the host name in order to test an item in a host list. The items
11819 that require this are described in sections &<<SECThoslispatnam>>& and
11820 &<<SECThoslispatnamsk>>&.
11822 The calling host matches &%helo_try_verify_hosts%& or &%helo_verify_hosts%&.
11823 In this case, the host name is required to compare with the name quoted in any
11824 EHLO or HELO commands that the client issues.
11826 The remote host issues a EHLO or HELO command that quotes one of the
11827 domains in &%helo_lookup_domains%&. The default value of this option is
11828 . ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
11829 . ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left.
11831 helo_lookup_domains = @ : @[]
11833 which causes a lookup if a remote host (incorrectly) gives the server's name or
11834 IP address in an EHLO or HELO command.
11838 .vitem &$sender_host_port$&
11839 .vindex "&$sender_host_port$&"
11840 When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the port
11841 number that was used on the remote host.
11843 .vitem &$sender_ident$&
11844 .vindex "&$sender_ident$&"
11845 When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the
11846 identification received in response to an RFC 1413 request. When a message has
11847 been received locally, this variable contains the login name of the user that
11850 .vitem &$sender_rate_$&&'xxx'&
11851 A number of variables whose names begin &$sender_rate_$& are set as part of the
11852 &%ratelimit%& ACL condition. Details are given in section
11853 &<<SECTratelimiting>>&.
11855 .vitem &$sender_rcvhost$&
11856 .cindex "DNS" "reverse lookup"
11857 .cindex "reverse DNS lookup"
11858 .vindex "&$sender_rcvhost$&"
11859 This is provided specifically for use in &'Received:'& headers. It starts with
11860 either the verified host name (as obtained from a reverse DNS lookup) or, if
11861 there is no verified host name, the IP address in square brackets. After that
11862 there may be text in parentheses. When the first item is a verified host name,
11863 the first thing in the parentheses is the IP address in square brackets,
11864 followed by a colon and a port number if port logging is enabled. When the
11865 first item is an IP address, the port is recorded as &"port=&'xxxx'&"& inside
11868 There may also be items of the form &"helo=&'xxxx'&"& if HELO or EHLO
11869 was used and its argument was not identical to the real host name or IP
11870 address, and &"ident=&'xxxx'&"& if an RFC 1413 ident string is available. If
11871 all three items are present in the parentheses, a newline and tab are inserted
11872 into the string, to improve the formatting of the &'Received:'& header.
11874 .vitem &$sender_verify_failure$&
11875 .vindex "&$sender_verify_failure$&"
11876 In an ACL, when a sender verification fails, this variable contains information
11877 about the failure. The details are the same as for
11878 &$recipient_verify_failure$&.
11880 .vitem &$sending_ip_address$&
11881 .vindex "&$sending_ip_address$&"
11882 This variable is set whenever an outgoing SMTP connection to another host has
11883 been set up. It contains the IP address of the local interface that is being
11884 used. This is useful if a host that has more than one IP address wants to take
11885 on different personalities depending on which one is being used. For incoming
11886 connections, see &$received_ip_address$&.
11888 .vitem &$sending_port$&
11889 .vindex "&$sending_port$&"
11890 This variable is set whenever an outgoing SMTP connection to another host has
11891 been set up. It contains the local port that is being used. For incoming
11892 connections, see &$received_port$&.
11894 .vitem &$smtp_active_hostname$&
11895 .vindex "&$smtp_active_hostname$&"
11896 During an incoming SMTP session, this variable contains the value of the active
11897 host name, as specified by the &%smtp_active_hostname%& option. The value of
11898 &$smtp_active_hostname$& is saved with any message that is received, so its
11899 value can be consulted during routing and delivery.
11901 .vitem &$smtp_command$&
11902 .vindex "&$smtp_command$&"
11903 During the processing of an incoming SMTP command, this variable contains the
11904 entire command. This makes it possible to distinguish between HELO and EHLO in
11905 the HELO ACL, and also to distinguish between commands such as these:
11910 For a MAIL command, extra parameters such as SIZE can be inspected. For a RCPT
11911 command, the address in &$smtp_command$& is the original address before any
11912 rewriting, whereas the values in &$local_part$& and &$domain$& are taken from
11913 the address after SMTP-time rewriting.
11915 .vitem &$smtp_command_argument$&
11916 .cindex "SMTP" "command, argument for"
11917 .vindex "&$smtp_command_argument$&"
11918 While an ACL is running to check an SMTP command, this variable contains the
11919 argument, that is, the text that follows the command name, with leading white
11920 space removed. Following the introduction of &$smtp_command$&, this variable is
11921 somewhat redundant, but is retained for backwards compatibility.
11923 .vitem &$smtp_count_at_connection_start$&
11924 .vindex "&$smtp_count_at_connection_start$&"
11925 This variable is set greater than zero only in processes spawned by the Exim
11926 daemon for handling incoming SMTP connections. The name is deliberately long,
11927 in order to emphasize what the contents are. When the daemon accepts a new
11928 connection, it increments this variable. A copy of the variable is passed to
11929 the child process that handles the connection, but its value is fixed, and
11930 never changes. It is only an approximation of how many incoming connections
11931 there actually are, because many other connections may come and go while a
11932 single connection is being processed. When a child process terminates, the
11933 daemon decrements its copy of the variable.
11935 .vitem "&$sn0$& &-- &$sn9$&"
11936 These variables are copies of the values of the &$n0$& &-- &$n9$& accumulators
11937 that were current at the end of the system filter file. This allows a system
11938 filter file to set values that can be tested in users' filter files. For
11939 example, a system filter could set a value indicating how likely it is that a
11940 message is junk mail.
11942 .vitem &$spam_$&&'xxx'&
11943 A number of variables whose names start with &$spam$& are available when Exim
11944 is compiled with the content-scanning extension. For details, see section
11945 &<<SECTscanspamass>>&.
11948 .vitem &$spool_directory$&
11949 .vindex "&$spool_directory$&"
11950 The name of Exim's spool directory.
11952 .vitem &$spool_inodes$&
11953 .vindex "&$spool_inodes$&"
11954 The number of free inodes in the disk partition where Exim's spool files are
11955 being written. The value is recalculated whenever the variable is referenced.
11956 If the relevant file system does not have the concept of inodes, the value of
11957 is -1. See also the &%check_spool_inodes%& option.
11959 .vitem &$spool_space$&
11960 .vindex "&$spool_space$&"
11961 The amount of free space (as a number of kilobytes) in the disk partition where
11962 Exim's spool files are being written. The value is recalculated whenever the
11963 variable is referenced. If the operating system does not have the ability to
11964 find the amount of free space (only true for experimental systems), the space
11965 value is -1. For example, to check in an ACL that there is at least 50
11966 megabytes free on the spool, you could write:
11968 condition = ${if > {$spool_space}{50000}}
11970 See also the &%check_spool_space%& option.
11973 .vitem &$thisaddress$&
11974 .vindex "&$thisaddress$&"
11975 This variable is set only during the processing of the &%foranyaddress%&
11976 command in a filter file. Its use is explained in the description of that
11977 command, which can be found in the separate document entitled &'Exim's
11978 interfaces to mail filtering'&.
11980 .vitem &$tls_in_bits$&
11981 .vindex "&$tls_in_bits$&"
11982 Contains an approximation of the TLS cipher's bit-strength
11983 on the inbound connection; the meaning of
11984 this depends upon the TLS implementation used.
11985 If TLS has not been negotiated, the value will be 0.
11986 The value of this is automatically fed into the Cyrus SASL authenticator
11987 when acting as a server, to specify the "external SSF" (a SASL term).
11989 The deprecated &$tls_bits$& variable refers to the inbound side
11990 except when used in the context of an outbound SMTP delivery, when it refers to
11993 .vitem &$tls_out_bits$&
11994 .vindex "&$tls_out_bits$&"
11995 Contains an approximation of the TLS cipher's bit-strength
11996 on an outbound SMTP connection; the meaning of
11997 this depends upon the TLS implementation used.
11998 If TLS has not been negotiated, the value will be 0.
12000 .vitem &$tls_in_certificate_verified$&
12001 .vindex "&$tls_in_certificate_verified$&"
12002 This variable is set to &"1"& if a TLS certificate was verified when the
12003 message was received, and &"0"& otherwise.
12005 The deprecated &$tls_certificate_verfied$& variable refers to the inbound side
12006 except when used in the context of an outbound SMTP delivery, when it refers to
12009 .vitem &$tls_out_certificate_verified$&
12010 .vindex "&$tls_out_certificate_verified$&"
12011 This variable is set to &"1"& if a TLS certificate was verified when an
12012 outbound SMTP connection was made,
12013 and &"0"& otherwise.
12015 .vitem &$tls_in_cipher$&
12016 .vindex "&$tls_in_cipher$&"
12017 .vindex "&$tls_cipher$&"
12018 When a message is received from a remote host over an encrypted SMTP
12019 connection, this variable is set to the cipher suite that was negotiated, for
12020 example DES-CBC3-SHA. In other circumstances, in particular, for message
12021 received over unencrypted connections, the variable is empty. Testing
12022 &$tls_cipher$& for emptiness is one way of distinguishing between encrypted and
12023 non-encrypted connections during ACL processing.
12025 The deprecated &$tls_cipher$& variable is the same as &$tls_in_cipher$& during message reception,
12026 but in the context of an outward SMTP delivery taking place via the &(smtp)& transport
12027 becomes the same as &$tls_out_cipher$&.
12029 .vitem &$tls_out_cipher$&
12030 .vindex "&$tls_out_cipher$&"
12032 cleared before any outgoing SMTP connection is made,
12033 and then set to the outgoing cipher suite if one is negotiated. See chapter
12034 &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS support and chapter &<<CHAPsmtptrans>>& for
12035 details of the &(smtp)& transport.
12037 .vitem &$tls_in_peerdn$&
12038 .vindex "&$tls_in_peerdn$&"
12039 .vindex "&$tls_peerdn$&"
12040 When a message is received from a remote host over an encrypted SMTP
12041 connection, and Exim is configured to request a certificate from the client,
12042 the value of the Distinguished Name of the certificate is made available in the
12043 &$tls_in_peerdn$& during subsequent processing.
12045 The deprecated &$tls_peerdn$& variable refers to the inbound side
12046 except when used in the context of an outbound SMTP delivery, when it refers to
12049 .vitem &$tls_out_peerdn$&
12050 .vindex "&$tls_out_peerdn$&"
12051 When a message is being delivered to a remote host over an encrypted SMTP
12052 connection, and Exim is configured to request a certificate from the server,
12053 the value of the Distinguished Name of the certificate is made available in the
12054 &$tls_out_peerdn$& during subsequent processing.
12056 .vitem &$tls_in_sni$&
12057 .vindex "&$tls_in_sni$&"
12058 .vindex "&$tls_sni$&"
12059 .cindex "TLS" "Server Name Indication"
12060 When a TLS session is being established, if the client sends the Server
12061 Name Indication extension, the value will be placed in this variable.
12062 If the variable appears in &%tls_certificate%& then this option and
12063 some others, described in &<<SECTtlssni>>&,
12064 will be re-expanded early in the TLS session, to permit
12065 a different certificate to be presented (and optionally a different key to be
12066 used) to the client, based upon the value of the SNI extension.
12068 The deprecated &$tls_sni$& variable refers to the inbound side
12069 except when used in the context of an outbound SMTP delivery, when it refers to
12072 .vitem &$tls_out_sni$&
12073 .vindex "&$tls_out_sni$&"
12074 .cindex "TLS" "Server Name Indication"
12076 SMTP deliveries, this variable reflects the value of the &%tls_sni%& option on
12079 .vitem &$tod_bsdinbox$&
12080 .vindex "&$tod_bsdinbox$&"
12081 The time of day and the date, in the format required for BSD-style mailbox
12082 files, for example: Thu Oct 17 17:14:09 1995.
12084 .vitem &$tod_epoch$&
12085 .vindex "&$tod_epoch$&"
12086 The time and date as a number of seconds since the start of the Unix epoch.
12088 .vitem &$tod_epoch_l$&
12089 .vindex "&$tod_epoch_l$&"
12090 The time and date as a number of microseconds since the start of the Unix epoch.
12092 .vitem &$tod_full$&
12093 .vindex "&$tod_full$&"
12094 A full version of the time and date, for example: Wed, 16 Oct 1995 09:51:40
12095 +0100. The timezone is always given as a numerical offset from UTC, with
12096 positive values used for timezones that are ahead (east) of UTC, and negative
12097 values for those that are behind (west).
12100 .vindex "&$tod_log$&"
12101 The time and date in the format used for writing Exim's log files, for example:
12102 1995-10-12 15:32:29, but without a timezone.
12104 .vitem &$tod_logfile$&
12105 .vindex "&$tod_logfile$&"
12106 This variable contains the date in the format yyyymmdd. This is the format that
12107 is used for datestamping log files when &%log_file_path%& contains the &`%D`&
12110 .vitem &$tod_zone$&
12111 .vindex "&$tod_zone$&"
12112 This variable contains the numerical value of the local timezone, for example:
12115 .vitem &$tod_zulu$&
12116 .vindex "&$tod_zulu$&"
12117 This variable contains the UTC date and time in &"Zulu"& format, as specified
12118 by ISO 8601, for example: 20030221154023Z.
12121 .vindex "&$value$&"
12122 This variable contains the result of an expansion lookup, extraction operation,
12123 or external command, as described above. It is also used during a
12124 &*reduce*& expansion.
12126 .vitem &$version_number$&
12127 .vindex "&$version_number$&"
12128 The version number of Exim.
12130 .vitem &$warn_message_delay$&
12131 .vindex "&$warn_message_delay$&"
12132 This variable is set only during the creation of a message warning about a
12133 delivery delay. Details of its use are explained in section &<<SECTcustwarn>>&.
12135 .vitem &$warn_message_recipients$&
12136 .vindex "&$warn_message_recipients$&"
12137 This variable is set only during the creation of a message warning about a
12138 delivery delay. Details of its use are explained in section &<<SECTcustwarn>>&.
12144 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
12145 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
12147 .chapter "Embedded Perl" "CHAPperl"
12148 .scindex IIDperl "Perl" "calling from Exim"
12149 Exim can be built to include an embedded Perl interpreter. When this is done,
12150 Perl subroutines can be called as part of the string expansion process. To make
12151 use of the Perl support, you need version 5.004 or later of Perl installed on
12152 your system. To include the embedded interpreter in the Exim binary, include
12157 in your &_Local/Makefile_& and then build Exim in the normal way.
12160 .section "Setting up so Perl can be used" "SECID85"
12161 .oindex "&%perl_startup%&"
12162 Access to Perl subroutines is via a global configuration option called
12163 &%perl_startup%& and an expansion string operator &%${perl ...}%&. If there is
12164 no &%perl_startup%& option in the Exim configuration file then no Perl
12165 interpreter is started and there is almost no overhead for Exim (since none of
12166 the Perl library will be paged in unless used). If there is a &%perl_startup%&
12167 option then the associated value is taken to be Perl code which is executed in
12168 a newly created Perl interpreter.
12170 The value of &%perl_startup%& is not expanded in the Exim sense, so you do not
12171 need backslashes before any characters to escape special meanings. The option
12172 should usually be something like
12174 perl_startup = do '/etc/exim.pl'
12176 where &_/etc/exim.pl_& is Perl code which defines any subroutines you want to
12177 use from Exim. Exim can be configured either to start up a Perl interpreter as
12178 soon as it is entered, or to wait until the first time it is needed. Starting
12179 the interpreter at the beginning ensures that it is done while Exim still has
12180 its setuid privilege, but can impose an unnecessary overhead if Perl is not in
12181 fact used in a particular run. Also, note that this does not mean that Exim is
12182 necessarily running as root when Perl is called at a later time. By default,
12183 the interpreter is started only when it is needed, but this can be changed in
12187 .oindex "&%perl_at_start%&"
12188 Setting &%perl_at_start%& (a boolean option) in the configuration requests
12189 a startup when Exim is entered.
12191 The command line option &%-ps%& also requests a startup when Exim is entered,
12192 overriding the setting of &%perl_at_start%&.
12195 There is also a command line option &%-pd%& (for delay) which suppresses the
12196 initial startup, even if &%perl_at_start%& is set.
12199 .section "Calling Perl subroutines" "SECID86"
12200 When the configuration file includes a &%perl_startup%& option you can make use
12201 of the string expansion item to call the Perl subroutines that are defined
12202 by the &%perl_startup%& code. The operator is used in any of the following
12206 ${perl{foo}{argument}}
12207 ${perl{foo}{argument1}{argument2} ... }
12209 which calls the subroutine &%foo%& with the given arguments. A maximum of eight
12210 arguments may be passed. Passing more than this results in an expansion failure
12211 with an error message of the form
12213 Too many arguments passed to Perl subroutine "foo" (max is 8)
12215 The return value of the Perl subroutine is evaluated in a scalar context before
12216 it is passed back to Exim to be inserted into the expanded string. If the
12217 return value is &'undef'&, the expansion is forced to fail in the same way as
12218 an explicit &"fail"& on an &%if%& or &%lookup%& item. If the subroutine aborts
12219 by obeying Perl's &%die%& function, the expansion fails with the error message
12220 that was passed to &%die%&.
12223 .section "Calling Exim functions from Perl" "SECID87"
12224 Within any Perl code called from Exim, the function &'Exim::expand_string()'&
12225 is available to call back into Exim's string expansion function. For example,
12228 my $lp = Exim::expand_string('$local_part');
12230 makes the current Exim &$local_part$& available in the Perl variable &$lp$&.
12231 Note those are single quotes and not double quotes to protect against
12232 &$local_part$& being interpolated as a Perl variable.
12234 If the string expansion is forced to fail by a &"fail"& item, the result of
12235 &'Exim::expand_string()'& is &%undef%&. If there is a syntax error in the
12236 expansion string, the Perl call from the original expansion string fails with
12237 an appropriate error message, in the same way as if &%die%& were used.
12239 .cindex "debugging" "from embedded Perl"
12240 .cindex "log" "writing from embedded Perl"
12241 Two other Exim functions are available for use from within Perl code.
12242 &'Exim::debug_write()'& writes a string to the standard error stream if Exim's
12243 debugging is enabled. If you want a newline at the end, you must supply it.
12244 &'Exim::log_write()'& writes a string to Exim's main log, adding a leading
12245 timestamp. In this case, you should not supply a terminating newline.
12248 .section "Use of standard output and error by Perl" "SECID88"
12249 .cindex "Perl" "standard output and error"
12250 You should not write to the standard error or output streams from within your
12251 Perl code, as it is not defined how these are set up. In versions of Exim
12252 before 4.50, it is possible for the standard output or error to refer to the
12253 SMTP connection during message reception via the daemon. Writing to this stream
12254 is certain to cause chaos. From Exim 4.50 onwards, the standard output and
12255 error streams are connected to &_/dev/null_& in the daemon. The chaos is
12256 avoided, but the output is lost.
12258 .cindex "Perl" "use of &%warn%&"
12259 The Perl &%warn%& statement writes to the standard error stream by default.
12260 Calls to &%warn%& may be embedded in Perl modules that you use, but over which
12261 you have no control. When Exim starts up the Perl interpreter, it arranges for
12262 output from the &%warn%& statement to be written to the Exim main log. You can
12263 change this by including appropriate Perl magic somewhere in your Perl code.
12264 For example, to discard &%warn%& output completely, you need this:
12266 $SIG{__WARN__} = sub { };
12268 Whenever a &%warn%& is obeyed, the anonymous subroutine is called. In this
12269 example, the code for the subroutine is empty, so it does nothing, but you can
12270 include any Perl code that you like. The text of the &%warn%& message is passed
12271 as the first subroutine argument.
12275 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
12276 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
12278 .chapter "Starting the daemon and the use of network interfaces" &&&
12279 "CHAPinterfaces" &&&
12280 "Starting the daemon"
12281 .cindex "daemon" "starting"
12282 .cindex "interface" "listening"
12283 .cindex "network interface"
12284 .cindex "interface" "network"
12285 .cindex "IP address" "for listening"
12286 .cindex "daemon" "listening IP addresses"
12287 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening interfaces"
12288 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening ports"
12289 A host that is connected to a TCP/IP network may have one or more physical
12290 hardware network interfaces. Each of these interfaces may be configured as one
12291 or more &"logical"& interfaces, which are the entities that a program actually
12292 works with. Each of these logical interfaces is associated with an IP address.
12293 In addition, TCP/IP software supports &"loopback"& interfaces (127.0.0.1 in
12294 IPv4 and ::1 in IPv6), which do not use any physical hardware. Exim requires
12295 knowledge about the host's interfaces for use in three different circumstances:
12298 When a listening daemon is started, Exim needs to know which interfaces
12299 and ports to listen on.
12301 When Exim is routing an address, it needs to know which IP addresses
12302 are associated with local interfaces. This is required for the correct
12303 processing of MX lists by removing the local host and others with the
12304 same or higher priority values. Also, Exim needs to detect cases
12305 when an address is routed to an IP address that in fact belongs to the
12306 local host. Unless the &%self%& router option or the &%allow_localhost%&
12307 option of the smtp transport is set (as appropriate), this is treated
12308 as an error situation.
12310 When Exim connects to a remote host, it may need to know which interface to use
12311 for the outgoing connection.
12315 Exim's default behaviour is likely to be appropriate in the vast majority
12316 of cases. If your host has only one interface, and you want all its IP
12317 addresses to be treated in the same way, and you are using only the
12318 standard SMTP port, you should not need to take any special action. The
12319 rest of this chapter does not apply to you.
12321 In a more complicated situation you may want to listen only on certain
12322 interfaces, or on different ports, and for this reason there are a number of
12323 options that can be used to influence Exim's behaviour. The rest of this
12324 chapter describes how they operate.
12326 When a message is received over TCP/IP, the interface and port that were
12327 actually used are set in &$received_ip_address$& and &$received_port$&.
12331 .section "Starting a listening daemon" "SECID89"
12332 When a listening daemon is started (by means of the &%-bd%& command line
12333 option), the interfaces and ports on which it listens are controlled by the
12337 &%daemon_smtp_ports%& contains a list of default ports. (For backward
12338 compatibility, this option can also be specified in the singular.)
12340 &%local_interfaces%& contains list of interface IP addresses on which to
12341 listen. Each item may optionally also specify a port.
12344 The default list separator in both cases is a colon, but this can be changed as
12345 described in section &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&. When IPv6 addresses are involved,
12346 it is usually best to change the separator to avoid having to double all the
12347 colons. For example:
12349 local_interfaces = <; 127.0.0.1 ; \
12352 3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061
12354 There are two different formats for specifying a port along with an IP address
12355 in &%local_interfaces%&:
12358 The port is added onto the address with a dot separator. For example, to listen
12359 on port 1234 on two different IP addresses:
12361 local_interfaces = <; 192.168.23.65.1234 ; \
12362 3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061.1234
12365 The IP address is enclosed in square brackets, and the port is added
12366 with a colon separator, for example:
12368 local_interfaces = <; [192.168.23.65]:1234 ; \
12369 [3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061]:1234
12373 When a port is not specified, the value of &%daemon_smtp_ports%& is used. The
12374 default setting contains just one port:
12376 daemon_smtp_ports = smtp
12378 If more than one port is listed, each interface that does not have its own port
12379 specified listens on all of them. Ports that are listed in
12380 &%daemon_smtp_ports%& can be identified either by name (defined in
12381 &_/etc/services_&) or by number. However, when ports are given with individual
12382 IP addresses in &%local_interfaces%&, only numbers (not names) can be used.
12386 .section "Special IP listening addresses" "SECID90"
12387 The addresses 0.0.0.0 and ::0 are treated specially. They are interpreted
12388 as &"all IPv4 interfaces"& and &"all IPv6 interfaces"&, respectively. In each
12389 case, Exim tells the TCP/IP stack to &"listen on all IPv&'x'& interfaces"&
12390 instead of setting up separate listening sockets for each interface. The
12391 default value of &%local_interfaces%& is
12393 local_interfaces = 0.0.0.0
12395 when Exim is built without IPv6 support; otherwise it is:
12397 local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
12399 Thus, by default, Exim listens on all available interfaces, on the SMTP port.
12403 .section "Overriding local_interfaces and daemon_smtp_ports" "SECID91"
12404 The &%-oX%& command line option can be used to override the values of
12405 &%daemon_smtp_ports%& and/or &%local_interfaces%& for a particular daemon
12406 instance. Another way of doing this would be to use macros and the &%-D%&
12407 option. However, &%-oX%& can be used by any admin user, whereas modification of
12408 the runtime configuration by &%-D%& is allowed only when the caller is root or
12411 The value of &%-oX%& is a list of items. The default colon separator can be
12412 changed in the usual way if required. If there are any items that do not
12413 contain dots or colons (that is, are not IP addresses), the value of
12414 &%daemon_smtp_ports%& is replaced by the list of those items. If there are any
12415 items that do contain dots or colons, the value of &%local_interfaces%& is
12416 replaced by those items. Thus, for example,
12420 overrides &%daemon_smtp_ports%&, but leaves &%local_interfaces%& unchanged,
12423 -oX 192.168.34.5.1125
12425 overrides &%local_interfaces%&, leaving &%daemon_smtp_ports%& unchanged.
12426 (However, since &%local_interfaces%& now contains no items without ports, the
12427 value of &%daemon_smtp_ports%& is no longer relevant in this example.)
12431 .section "Support for the obsolete SSMTP (or SMTPS) protocol" "SECTsupobssmt"
12432 .cindex "ssmtp protocol"
12433 .cindex "smtps protocol"
12434 .cindex "SMTP" "ssmtp protocol"
12435 .cindex "SMTP" "smtps protocol"
12436 Exim supports the obsolete SSMTP protocol (also known as SMTPS) that was used
12437 before the STARTTLS command was standardized for SMTP. Some legacy clients
12438 still use this protocol. If the &%tls_on_connect_ports%& option is set to a
12439 list of port numbers, connections to those ports must use SSMTP. The most
12440 common use of this option is expected to be
12442 tls_on_connect_ports = 465
12444 because 465 is the usual port number used by the legacy clients. There is also
12445 a command line option &%-tls-on-connect%&, which forces all ports to behave in
12446 this way when a daemon is started.
12448 &*Warning*&: Setting &%tls_on_connect_ports%& does not of itself cause the
12449 daemon to listen on those ports. You must still specify them in
12450 &%daemon_smtp_ports%&, &%local_interfaces%&, or the &%-oX%& option. (This is
12451 because &%tls_on_connect_ports%& applies to &%inetd%& connections as well as to
12452 connections via the daemon.)
12457 .section "IPv6 address scopes" "SECID92"
12458 .cindex "IPv6" "address scopes"
12459 IPv6 addresses have &"scopes"&, and a host with multiple hardware interfaces
12460 can, in principle, have the same link-local IPv6 address on different
12461 interfaces. Thus, additional information is needed, over and above the IP
12462 address, to distinguish individual interfaces. A convention of using a
12463 percent sign followed by something (often the interface name) has been
12464 adopted in some cases, leading to addresses like this:
12466 fe80::202:b3ff:fe03:45c1%eth0
12468 To accommodate this usage, a percent sign followed by an arbitrary string is
12469 allowed at the end of an IPv6 address. By default, Exim calls &[getaddrinfo()]&
12470 to convert a textual IPv6 address for actual use. This function recognizes the
12471 percent convention in operating systems that support it, and it processes the
12472 address appropriately. Unfortunately, some older libraries have problems with
12473 &[getaddrinfo()]&. If
12475 IPV6_USE_INET_PTON=yes
12477 is set in &_Local/Makefile_& (or an OS-dependent Makefile) when Exim is built,
12478 Exim uses &'inet_pton()'& to convert a textual IPv6 address for actual use,
12479 instead of &[getaddrinfo()]&. (Before version 4.14, it always used this
12480 function.) Of course, this means that the additional functionality of
12481 &[getaddrinfo()]& &-- recognizing scoped addresses &-- is lost.
12483 .section "Disabling IPv6" "SECID93"
12484 .cindex "IPv6" "disabling"
12485 Sometimes it happens that an Exim binary that was compiled with IPv6 support is
12486 run on a host whose kernel does not support IPv6. The binary will fall back to
12487 using IPv4, but it may waste resources looking up AAAA records, and trying to
12488 connect to IPv6 addresses, causing delays to mail delivery. If you set the
12489 .oindex "&%disable_ipv6%&"
12490 &%disable_ipv6%& option true, even if the Exim binary has IPv6 support, no IPv6
12491 activities take place. AAAA records are never looked up, and any IPv6 addresses
12492 that are listed in &%local_interfaces%&, data for the &(manualroute)& router,
12493 etc. are ignored. If IP literals are enabled, the &(ipliteral)& router declines
12494 to handle IPv6 literal addresses.
12496 On the other hand, when IPv6 is in use, there may be times when you want to
12497 disable it for certain hosts or domains. You can use the &%dns_ipv4_lookup%&
12498 option to globally suppress the lookup of AAAA records for specified domains,
12499 and you can use the &%ignore_target_hosts%& generic router option to ignore
12500 IPv6 addresses in an individual router.
12504 .section "Examples of starting a listening daemon" "SECID94"
12505 The default case in an IPv6 environment is
12507 daemon_smtp_ports = smtp
12508 local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
12510 This specifies listening on the smtp port on all IPv6 and IPv4 interfaces.
12511 Either one or two sockets may be used, depending on the characteristics of
12512 the TCP/IP stack. (This is complicated and messy; for more information,
12513 read the comments in the &_daemon.c_& source file.)
12515 To specify listening on ports 25 and 26 on all interfaces:
12517 daemon_smtp_ports = 25 : 26
12519 (leaving &%local_interfaces%& at the default setting) or, more explicitly:
12521 local_interfaces = <; ::0.25 ; ::0.26 \
12522 0.0.0.0.25 ; 0.0.0.0.26
12524 To listen on the default port on all IPv4 interfaces, and on port 26 on the
12525 IPv4 loopback address only:
12527 local_interfaces = 0.0.0.0 : 127.0.0.1.26
12529 To specify listening on the default port on specific interfaces only:
12531 local_interfaces = 192.168.34.67 : 192.168.34.67
12533 &*Warning*&: Such a setting excludes listening on the loopback interfaces.
12537 .section "Recognizing the local host" "SECTreclocipadd"
12538 The &%local_interfaces%& option is also used when Exim needs to determine
12539 whether or not an IP address refers to the local host. That is, the IP
12540 addresses of all the interfaces on which a daemon is listening are always
12543 For this usage, port numbers in &%local_interfaces%& are ignored. If either of
12544 the items 0.0.0.0 or ::0 are encountered, Exim gets a complete list of
12545 available interfaces from the operating system, and extracts the relevant
12546 (that is, IPv4 or IPv6) addresses to use for checking.
12548 Some systems set up large numbers of virtual interfaces in order to provide
12549 many virtual web servers. In this situation, you may want to listen for
12550 email on only a few of the available interfaces, but nevertheless treat all
12551 interfaces as local when routing. You can do this by setting
12552 &%extra_local_interfaces%& to a list of IP addresses, possibly including the
12553 &"all"& wildcard values. These addresses are recognized as local, but are not
12554 used for listening. Consider this example:
12556 local_interfaces = <; 127.0.0.1 ; ::1 ; \
12558 3ffe:2101:12:1:a00:20ff:fe86:a061
12560 extra_local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
12562 The daemon listens on the loopback interfaces and just one IPv4 and one IPv6
12563 address, but all available interface addresses are treated as local when
12566 In some environments the local host name may be in an MX list, but with an IP
12567 address that is not assigned to any local interface. In other cases it may be
12568 desirable to treat other host names as if they referred to the local host. Both
12569 these cases can be handled by setting the &%hosts_treat_as_local%& option.
12570 This contains host names rather than IP addresses. When a host is referenced
12571 during routing, either via an MX record or directly, it is treated as the local
12572 host if its name matches &%hosts_treat_as_local%&, or if any of its IP
12573 addresses match &%local_interfaces%& or &%extra_local_interfaces%&.
12577 .section "Delivering to a remote host" "SECID95"
12578 Delivery to a remote host is handled by the smtp transport. By default, it
12579 allows the system's TCP/IP functions to choose which interface to use (if
12580 there is more than one) when connecting to a remote host. However, the
12581 &%interface%& option can be set to specify which interface is used. See the
12582 description of the smtp transport in chapter &<<CHAPsmtptrans>>& for more
12588 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
12589 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
12591 .chapter "Main configuration" "CHAPmainconfig"
12592 .scindex IIDconfima "configuration file" "main section"
12593 .scindex IIDmaiconf "main configuration"
12594 The first part of the run time configuration file contains three types of item:
12597 Macro definitions: These lines start with an upper case letter. See section
12598 &<<SECTmacrodefs>>& for details of macro processing.
12600 Named list definitions: These lines start with one of the words &"domainlist"&,
12601 &"hostlist"&, &"addresslist"&, or &"localpartlist"&. Their use is described in
12602 section &<<SECTnamedlists>>&.
12604 Main configuration settings: Each setting occupies one line of the file
12605 (with possible continuations). If any setting is preceded by the word
12606 &"hide"&, the &%-bP%& command line option displays its value to admin users
12607 only. See section &<<SECTcos>>& for a description of the syntax of these option
12611 This chapter specifies all the main configuration options, along with their
12612 types and default values. For ease of finding a particular option, they appear
12613 in alphabetical order in section &<<SECTalomo>>& below. However, because there
12614 are now so many options, they are first listed briefly in functional groups, as
12615 an aid to finding the name of the option you are looking for. Some options are
12616 listed in more than one group.
12618 .section "Miscellaneous" "SECID96"
12620 .row &%bi_command%& "to run for &%-bi%& command line option"
12621 .row &%disable_ipv6%& "do no IPv6 processing"
12622 .row &%keep_malformed%& "for broken files &-- should not happen"
12623 .row &%localhost_number%& "for unique message ids in clusters"
12624 .row &%message_body_newlines%& "retain newlines in &$message_body$&"
12625 .row &%message_body_visible%& "how much to show in &$message_body$&"
12626 .row &%mua_wrapper%& "run in &""MUA wrapper""& mode"
12627 .row &%print_topbitchars%& "top-bit characters are printing"
12628 .row &%timezone%& "force time zone"
12632 .section "Exim parameters" "SECID97"
12634 .row &%exim_group%& "override compiled-in value"
12635 .row &%exim_path%& "override compiled-in value"
12636 .row &%exim_user%& "override compiled-in value"
12637 .row &%primary_hostname%& "default from &[uname()]&"
12638 .row &%split_spool_directory%& "use multiple directories"
12639 .row &%spool_directory%& "override compiled-in value"
12644 .section "Privilege controls" "SECID98"
12646 .row &%admin_groups%& "groups that are Exim admin users"
12647 .row &%deliver_drop_privilege%& "drop root for delivery processes"
12648 .row &%local_from_check%& "insert &'Sender:'& if necessary"
12649 .row &%local_from_prefix%& "for testing &'From:'& for local sender"
12650 .row &%local_from_suffix%& "for testing &'From:'& for local sender"
12651 .row &%local_sender_retain%& "keep &'Sender:'& from untrusted user"
12652 .row &%never_users%& "do not run deliveries as these"
12653 .row &%prod_requires_admin%& "forced delivery requires admin user"
12654 .row &%queue_list_requires_admin%& "queue listing requires admin user"
12655 .row &%trusted_groups%& "groups that are trusted"
12656 .row &%trusted_users%& "users that are trusted"
12661 .section "Logging" "SECID99"
12663 .row &%hosts_connection_nolog%& "exemption from connect logging"
12664 .row &%log_file_path%& "override compiled-in value"
12665 .row &%log_selector%& "set/unset optional logging"
12666 .row &%log_timezone%& "add timezone to log lines"
12667 .row &%message_logs%& "create per-message logs"
12668 .row &%preserve_message_logs%& "after message completion"
12669 .row &%process_log_path%& "for SIGUSR1 and &'exiwhat'&"
12670 .row &%syslog_duplication%& "controls duplicate log lines on syslog"
12671 .row &%syslog_facility%& "set syslog &""facility""& field"
12672 .row &%syslog_processname%& "set syslog &""ident""& field"
12673 .row &%syslog_timestamp%& "timestamp syslog lines"
12674 .row &%write_rejectlog%& "control use of message log"
12679 .section "Frozen messages" "SECID100"
12681 .row &%auto_thaw%& "sets time for retrying frozen messages"
12682 .row &%freeze_tell%& "send message when freezing"
12683 .row &%move_frozen_messages%& "to another directory"
12684 .row &%timeout_frozen_after%& "keep frozen messages only so long"
12689 .section "Data lookups" "SECID101"
12691 .row &%ibase_servers%& "InterBase servers"
12692 .row &%ldap_ca_cert_dir%& "dir of CA certs to verify LDAP server's"
12693 .row &%ldap_ca_cert_file%& "file of CA certs to verify LDAP server's"
12694 .row &%ldap_cert_file%& "client cert file for LDAP"
12695 .row &%ldap_cert_key%& "client key file for LDAP"
12696 .row &%ldap_cipher_suite%& "TLS negotiation preference control"
12697 .row &%ldap_default_servers%& "used if no server in query"
12698 .row &%ldap_require_cert%& "action to take without LDAP server cert"
12699 .row &%ldap_start_tls%& "require TLS within LDAP"
12700 .row &%ldap_version%& "set protocol version"
12701 .row &%lookup_open_max%& "lookup files held open"
12702 .row &%mysql_servers%& "default MySQL servers"
12703 .row &%oracle_servers%& "Oracle servers"
12704 .row &%pgsql_servers%& "default PostgreSQL servers"
12705 .row &%sqlite_lock_timeout%& "as it says"
12710 .section "Message ids" "SECID102"
12712 .row &%message_id_header_domain%& "used to build &'Message-ID:'& header"
12713 .row &%message_id_header_text%& "ditto"
12718 .section "Embedded Perl Startup" "SECID103"
12720 .row &%perl_at_start%& "always start the interpreter"
12721 .row &%perl_startup%& "code to obey when starting Perl"
12726 .section "Daemon" "SECID104"
12728 .row &%daemon_smtp_ports%& "default ports"
12729 .row &%daemon_startup_retries%& "number of times to retry"
12730 .row &%daemon_startup_sleep%& "time to sleep between tries"
12731 .row &%extra_local_interfaces%& "not necessarily listened on"
12732 .row &%local_interfaces%& "on which to listen, with optional ports"
12733 .row &%pid_file_path%& "override compiled-in value"
12734 .row &%queue_run_max%& "maximum simultaneous queue runners"
12739 .section "Resource control" "SECID105"
12741 .row &%check_log_inodes%& "before accepting a message"
12742 .row &%check_log_space%& "before accepting a message"
12743 .row &%check_spool_inodes%& "before accepting a message"
12744 .row &%check_spool_space%& "before accepting a message"
12745 .row &%deliver_queue_load_max%& "no queue deliveries if load high"
12746 .row &%queue_only_load%& "queue incoming if load high"
12747 .row &%queue_only_load_latch%& "don't re-evaluate load for each message"
12748 .row &%queue_run_max%& "maximum simultaneous queue runners"
12749 .row &%remote_max_parallel%& "parallel SMTP delivery per message"
12750 .row &%smtp_accept_max%& "simultaneous incoming connections"
12751 .row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%& "non-mail commands"
12752 .row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%& "hosts to which the limit applies"
12753 .row &%smtp_accept_max_per_connection%& "messages per connection"
12754 .row &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& "connections from one host"
12755 .row &%smtp_accept_queue%& "queue mail if more connections"
12756 .row &%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& "queue if more messages per &&&
12758 .row &%smtp_accept_reserve%& "only reserve hosts if more connections"
12759 .row &%smtp_check_spool_space%& "from SIZE on MAIL command"
12760 .row &%smtp_connect_backlog%& "passed to TCP/IP stack"
12761 .row &%smtp_load_reserve%& "SMTP from reserved hosts if load high"
12762 .row &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& "these are the reserve hosts"
12767 .section "Policy controls" "SECID106"
12769 .row &%acl_not_smtp%& "ACL for non-SMTP messages"
12770 .row &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& "ACL for non-SMTP MIME parts"
12771 .row &%acl_not_smtp_start%& "ACL for start of non-SMTP message"
12772 .row &%acl_smtp_auth%& "ACL for AUTH"
12773 .row &%acl_smtp_connect%& "ACL for connection"
12774 .row &%acl_smtp_data%& "ACL for DATA"
12775 .row &%acl_smtp_dkim%& "ACL for DKIM verification"
12776 .row &%acl_smtp_etrn%& "ACL for ETRN"
12777 .row &%acl_smtp_expn%& "ACL for EXPN"
12778 .row &%acl_smtp_helo%& "ACL for EHLO or HELO"
12779 .row &%acl_smtp_mail%& "ACL for MAIL"
12780 .row &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& "ACL for AUTH on MAIL command"
12781 .row &%acl_smtp_mime%& "ACL for MIME parts"
12782 .row &%acl_smtp_predata%& "ACL for start of data"
12783 .row &%acl_smtp_quit%& "ACL for QUIT"
12784 .row &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& "ACL for RCPT"
12785 .row &%acl_smtp_starttls%& "ACL for STARTTLS"
12786 .row &%acl_smtp_vrfy%& "ACL for VRFY"
12787 .row &%av_scanner%& "specify virus scanner"
12788 .row &%check_rfc2047_length%& "check length of RFC 2047 &""encoded &&&
12790 .row &%dns_csa_search_limit%& "control CSA parent search depth"
12791 .row &%dns_csa_use_reverse%& "en/disable CSA IP reverse search"
12792 .row &%header_maxsize%& "total size of message header"
12793 .row &%header_line_maxsize%& "individual header line limit"
12794 .row &%helo_accept_junk_hosts%& "allow syntactic junk from these hosts"
12795 .row &%helo_allow_chars%& "allow illegal chars in HELO names"
12796 .row &%helo_lookup_domains%& "lookup hostname for these HELO names"
12797 .row &%helo_try_verify_hosts%& "HELO soft-checked for these hosts"
12798 .row &%helo_verify_hosts%& "HELO hard-checked for these hosts"
12799 .row &%host_lookup%& "host name looked up for these hosts"
12800 .row &%host_lookup_order%& "order of DNS and local name lookups"
12801 .row &%host_reject_connection%& "reject connection from these hosts"
12802 .row &%hosts_treat_as_local%& "useful in some cluster configurations"
12803 .row &%local_scan_timeout%& "timeout for &[local_scan()]&"
12804 .row &%message_size_limit%& "for all messages"
12805 .row &%percent_hack_domains%& "recognize %-hack for these domains"
12806 .row &%spamd_address%& "set interface to SpamAssassin"
12807 .row &%strict_acl_vars%& "object to unset ACL variables"
12812 .section "Callout cache" "SECID107"
12814 .row &%callout_domain_negative_expire%& "timeout for negative domain cache &&&
12816 .row &%callout_domain_positive_expire%& "timeout for positive domain cache &&&
12818 .row &%callout_negative_expire%& "timeout for negative address cache item"
12819 .row &%callout_positive_expire%& "timeout for positive address cache item"
12820 .row &%callout_random_local_part%& "string to use for &""random""& testing"
12825 .section "TLS" "SECID108"
12827 .row &%gnutls_compat_mode%& "use GnuTLS compatibility mode"
12828 .row &%openssl_options%& "adjust OpenSSL compatibility options"
12829 .row &%tls_advertise_hosts%& "advertise TLS to these hosts"
12830 .row &%tls_certificate%& "location of server certificate"
12831 .row &%tls_crl%& "certificate revocation list"
12832 .row &%tls_dh_max_bits%& "clamp D-H bit count suggestion"
12833 .row &%tls_dhparam%& "DH parameters for server"
12834 .row &%tls_on_connect_ports%& "specify SSMTP (SMTPS) ports"
12835 .row &%tls_privatekey%& "location of server private key"
12836 .row &%tls_remember_esmtp%& "don't reset after starting TLS"
12837 .row &%tls_require_ciphers%& "specify acceptable ciphers"
12838 .row &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& "try to verify client certificate"
12839 .row &%tls_verify_certificates%& "expected client certificates"
12840 .row &%tls_verify_hosts%& "insist on client certificate verify"
12845 .section "Local user handling" "SECID109"
12847 .row &%finduser_retries%& "useful in NIS environments"
12848 .row &%gecos_name%& "used when creating &'Sender:'&"
12849 .row &%gecos_pattern%& "ditto"
12850 .row &%max_username_length%& "for systems that truncate"
12851 .row &%unknown_login%& "used when no login name found"
12852 .row &%unknown_username%& "ditto"
12853 .row &%uucp_from_pattern%& "for recognizing &""From ""& lines"
12854 .row &%uucp_from_sender%& "ditto"
12859 .section "All incoming messages (SMTP and non-SMTP)" "SECID110"
12861 .row &%header_maxsize%& "total size of message header"
12862 .row &%header_line_maxsize%& "individual header line limit"
12863 .row &%message_size_limit%& "applies to all messages"
12864 .row &%percent_hack_domains%& "recognize %-hack for these domains"
12865 .row &%received_header_text%& "expanded to make &'Received:'&"
12866 .row &%received_headers_max%& "for mail loop detection"
12867 .row &%recipients_max%& "limit per message"
12868 .row &%recipients_max_reject%& "permanently reject excess recipients"
12874 .section "Non-SMTP incoming messages" "SECID111"
12876 .row &%receive_timeout%& "for non-SMTP messages"
12883 .section "Incoming SMTP messages" "SECID112"
12884 See also the &'Policy controls'& section above.
12887 .row &%host_lookup%& "host name looked up for these hosts"
12888 .row &%host_lookup_order%& "order of DNS and local name lookups"
12889 .row &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%& "may send unqualified recipients"
12890 .row &%rfc1413_hosts%& "make ident calls to these hosts"
12891 .row &%rfc1413_query_timeout%& "zero disables ident calls"
12892 .row &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& "may send unqualified senders"
12893 .row &%smtp_accept_keepalive%& "some TCP/IP magic"
12894 .row &%smtp_accept_max%& "simultaneous incoming connections"
12895 .row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%& "non-mail commands"
12896 .row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%& "hosts to which the limit applies"
12897 .row &%smtp_accept_max_per_connection%& "messages per connection"
12898 .row &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& "connections from one host"
12899 .row &%smtp_accept_queue%& "queue mail if more connections"
12900 .row &%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& "queue if more messages per &&&
12902 .row &%smtp_accept_reserve%& "only reserve hosts if more connections"
12903 .row &%smtp_active_hostname%& "host name to use in messages"
12904 .row &%smtp_banner%& "text for welcome banner"
12905 .row &%smtp_check_spool_space%& "from SIZE on MAIL command"
12906 .row &%smtp_connect_backlog%& "passed to TCP/IP stack"
12907 .row &%smtp_enforce_sync%& "of SMTP command/responses"
12908 .row &%smtp_etrn_command%& "what to run for ETRN"
12909 .row &%smtp_etrn_serialize%& "only one at once"
12910 .row &%smtp_load_reserve%& "only reserve hosts if this load"
12911 .row &%smtp_max_unknown_commands%& "before dropping connection"
12912 .row &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%& "apply ratelimiting to these hosts"
12913 .row &%smtp_ratelimit_mail%& "ratelimit for MAIL commands"
12914 .row &%smtp_ratelimit_rcpt%& "ratelimit for RCPT commands"
12915 .row &%smtp_receive_timeout%& "per command or data line"
12916 .row &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& "these are the reserve hosts"
12917 .row &%smtp_return_error_details%& "give detail on rejections"
12922 .section "SMTP extensions" "SECID113"
12924 .row &%accept_8bitmime%& "advertise 8BITMIME"
12925 .row &%auth_advertise_hosts%& "advertise AUTH to these hosts"
12926 .row &%ignore_fromline_hosts%& "allow &""From ""& from these hosts"
12927 .row &%ignore_fromline_local%& "allow &""From ""& from local SMTP"
12928 .row &%pipelining_advertise_hosts%& "advertise pipelining to these hosts"
12929 .row &%tls_advertise_hosts%& "advertise TLS to these hosts"
12934 .section "Processing messages" "SECID114"
12936 .row &%allow_domain_literals%& "recognize domain literal syntax"
12937 .row &%allow_mx_to_ip%& "allow MX to point to IP address"
12938 .row &%allow_utf8_domains%& "in addresses"
12939 .row &%check_rfc2047_length%& "check length of RFC 2047 &""encoded &&&
12941 .row &%delivery_date_remove%& "from incoming messages"
12942 .row &%envelope_to_remove%& "from incoming messages"
12943 .row &%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%& "affects &%-t%& processing"
12944 .row &%headers_charset%& "default for translations"
12945 .row &%qualify_domain%& "default for senders"
12946 .row &%qualify_recipient%& "default for recipients"
12947 .row &%return_path_remove%& "from incoming messages"
12948 .row &%strip_excess_angle_brackets%& "in addresses"
12949 .row &%strip_trailing_dot%& "at end of addresses"
12950 .row &%untrusted_set_sender%& "untrusted can set envelope sender"
12955 .section "System filter" "SECID115"
12957 .row &%system_filter%& "locate system filter"
12958 .row &%system_filter_directory_transport%& "transport for delivery to a &&&
12960 .row &%system_filter_file_transport%& "transport for delivery to a file"
12961 .row &%system_filter_group%& "group for filter running"
12962 .row &%system_filter_pipe_transport%& "transport for delivery to a pipe"
12963 .row &%system_filter_reply_transport%& "transport for autoreply delivery"
12964 .row &%system_filter_user%& "user for filter running"
12969 .section "Routing and delivery" "SECID116"
12971 .row &%disable_ipv6%& "do no IPv6 processing"
12972 .row &%dns_again_means_nonexist%& "for broken domains"
12973 .row &%dns_check_names_pattern%& "pre-DNS syntax check"
12974 .row &%dns_ipv4_lookup%& "only v4 lookup for these domains"
12975 .row &%dns_retrans%& "parameter for resolver"
12976 .row &%dns_retry%& "parameter for resolver"
12978 .row &%dns_use_dnssec%& "parameter for resolver"
12980 .row &%dns_use_edns0%& "parameter for resolver"
12981 .row &%hold_domains%& "hold delivery for these domains"
12982 .row &%local_interfaces%& "for routing checks"
12983 .row &%queue_domains%& "no immediate delivery for these"
12984 .row &%queue_only%& "no immediate delivery at all"
12985 .row &%queue_only_file%& "no immediate delivery if file exists"
12986 .row &%queue_only_load%& "no immediate delivery if load is high"
12987 .row &%queue_only_load_latch%& "don't re-evaluate load for each message"
12988 .row &%queue_only_override%& "allow command line to override"
12989 .row &%queue_run_in_order%& "order of arrival"
12990 .row &%queue_run_max%& "of simultaneous queue runners"
12991 .row &%queue_smtp_domains%& "no immediate SMTP delivery for these"
12992 .row &%remote_max_parallel%& "parallel SMTP delivery per message"
12993 .row &%remote_sort_domains%& "order of remote deliveries"
12994 .row &%retry_data_expire%& "timeout for retry data"
12995 .row &%retry_interval_max%& "safety net for retry rules"
13000 .section "Bounce and warning messages" "SECID117"
13002 .row &%bounce_message_file%& "content of bounce"
13003 .row &%bounce_message_text%& "content of bounce"
13004 .row &%bounce_return_body%& "include body if returning message"
13005 .row &%bounce_return_message%& "include original message in bounce"
13006 .row &%bounce_return_size_limit%& "limit on returned message"
13007 .row &%bounce_sender_authentication%& "send authenticated sender with bounce"
13008 .row &%dsn_from%& "set &'From:'& contents in bounces"
13009 .row &%errors_copy%& "copy bounce messages"
13010 .row &%errors_reply_to%& "&'Reply-to:'& in bounces"
13011 .row &%delay_warning%& "time schedule"
13012 .row &%delay_warning_condition%& "condition for warning messages"
13013 .row &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%& "discard undeliverable bounces"
13014 .row &%smtp_return_error_details%& "give detail on rejections"
13015 .row &%warn_message_file%& "content of warning message"
13020 .section "Alphabetical list of main options" "SECTalomo"
13021 Those options that undergo string expansion before use are marked with
13024 .option accept_8bitmime main boolean true
13026 .cindex "8-bit characters"
13027 This option causes Exim to send 8BITMIME in its response to an SMTP
13028 EHLO command, and to accept the BODY= parameter on MAIL commands.
13029 However, though Exim is 8-bit clean, it is not a protocol converter, and it
13030 takes no steps to do anything special with messages received by this route.
13032 Historically Exim kept this option off by default, but the maintainers
13033 feel that in today's Internet, this causes more problems than it solves.
13034 It now defaults to true.
13035 A more detailed analysis of the issues is provided by Dan Bernstein:
13037 &url(http://cr.yp.to/smtp/8bitmime.html)
13040 .option acl_not_smtp main string&!! unset
13041 .cindex "&ACL;" "for non-SMTP messages"
13042 .cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
13043 This option defines the ACL that is run when a non-SMTP message has been
13044 read and is on the point of being accepted. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for
13047 .option acl_not_smtp_mime main string&!! unset
13048 This option defines the ACL that is run for individual MIME parts of non-SMTP
13049 messages. It operates in exactly the same way as &%acl_smtp_mime%& operates for
13052 .option acl_not_smtp_start main string&!! unset
13053 .cindex "&ACL;" "at start of non-SMTP message"
13054 .cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
13055 This option defines the ACL that is run before Exim starts reading a
13056 non-SMTP message. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13058 .option acl_smtp_auth main string&!! unset
13059 .cindex "&ACL;" "setting up for SMTP commands"
13060 .cindex "AUTH" "ACL for"
13061 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP AUTH command is
13062 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13064 .option acl_smtp_connect main string&!! unset
13065 .cindex "&ACL;" "on SMTP connection"
13066 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP connection is received.
13067 See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13069 .option acl_smtp_data main string&!! unset
13070 .cindex "DATA" "ACL for"
13071 This option defines the ACL that is run after an SMTP DATA command has been
13072 processed and the message itself has been received, but before the final
13073 acknowledgment is sent. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13075 .option acl_smtp_etrn main string&!! unset
13076 .cindex "ETRN" "ACL for"
13077 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP ETRN command is
13078 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13080 .option acl_smtp_expn main string&!! unset
13081 .cindex "EXPN" "ACL for"
13082 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP EXPN command is
13083 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13085 .option acl_smtp_helo main string&!! unset
13086 .cindex "EHLO" "ACL for"
13087 .cindex "HELO" "ACL for"
13088 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP EHLO or HELO
13089 command is received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13092 .option acl_smtp_mail main string&!! unset
13093 .cindex "MAIL" "ACL for"
13094 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP MAIL command is
13095 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13097 .option acl_smtp_mailauth main string&!! unset
13098 .cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
13099 This option defines the ACL that is run when there is an AUTH parameter on
13100 a MAIL command. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for details of ACLs, and chapter
13101 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details of authentication.
13103 .option acl_smtp_mime main string&!! unset
13104 .cindex "MIME content scanning" "ACL for"
13105 This option is available when Exim is built with the content-scanning
13106 extension. It defines the ACL that is run for each MIME part in a message. See
13107 section &<<SECTscanmimepart>>& for details.
13109 .option acl_smtp_predata main string&!! unset
13110 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP DATA command is
13111 received, before the message itself is received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for
13114 .option acl_smtp_quit main string&!! unset
13115 .cindex "QUIT, ACL for"
13116 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP QUIT command is
13117 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13119 .option acl_smtp_rcpt main string&!! unset
13120 .cindex "RCPT" "ACL for"
13121 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP RCPT command is
13122 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13124 .option acl_smtp_starttls main string&!! unset
13125 .cindex "STARTTLS, ACL for"
13126 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP STARTTLS command is
13127 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13129 .option acl_smtp_vrfy main string&!! unset
13130 .cindex "VRFY" "ACL for"
13131 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP VRFY command is
13132 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13134 .option admin_groups main "string list&!!" unset
13135 .cindex "admin user"
13136 This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. If the
13137 current group or any of the supplementary groups of an Exim caller is in this
13138 colon-separated list, the caller has admin privileges. If all your system
13139 programmers are in a specific group, for example, you can give them all Exim
13140 admin privileges by putting that group in &%admin_groups%&. However, this does
13141 not permit them to read Exim's spool files (whose group owner is the Exim gid).
13142 To permit this, you have to add individuals to the Exim group.
13144 .option allow_domain_literals main boolean false
13145 .cindex "domain literal"
13146 If this option is set, the RFC 2822 domain literal format is permitted in
13147 email addresses. The option is not set by default, because the domain literal
13148 format is not normally required these days, and few people know about it. It
13149 has, however, been exploited by mail abusers.
13151 Unfortunately, it seems that some DNS black list maintainers are using this
13152 format to report black listing to postmasters. If you want to accept messages
13153 addressed to your hosts by IP address, you need to set
13154 &%allow_domain_literals%& true, and also to add &`@[]`& to the list of local
13155 domains (defined in the named domain list &%local_domains%& in the default
13156 configuration). This &"magic string"& matches the domain literal form of all
13157 the local host's IP addresses.
13160 .option allow_mx_to_ip main boolean false
13161 .cindex "MX record" "pointing to IP address"
13162 It appears that more and more DNS zone administrators are breaking the rules
13163 and putting domain names that look like IP addresses on the right hand side of
13164 MX records. Exim follows the rules and rejects this, giving an error message
13165 that explains the mis-configuration. However, some other MTAs support this
13166 practice, so to avoid &"Why can't Exim do this?"& complaints,
13167 &%allow_mx_to_ip%& exists, in order to enable this heinous activity. It is not
13168 recommended, except when you have no other choice.
13170 .option allow_utf8_domains main boolean false
13171 .cindex "domain" "UTF-8 characters in"
13172 .cindex "UTF-8" "in domain name"
13173 Lots of discussion is going on about internationalized domain names. One
13174 camp is strongly in favour of just using UTF-8 characters, and it seems
13175 that at least two other MTAs permit this. This option allows Exim users to
13176 experiment if they wish.
13178 If it is set true, Exim's domain parsing function allows valid
13179 UTF-8 multicharacters to appear in domain name components, in addition to
13180 letters, digits, and hyphens. However, just setting this option is not
13181 enough; if you want to look up these domain names in the DNS, you must also
13182 adjust the value of &%dns_check_names_pattern%& to match the extended form. A
13183 suitable setting is:
13185 dns_check_names_pattern = (?i)^(?>(?(1)\.|())[a-z0-9\xc0-\xff]\
13186 (?>[-a-z0-9\x80-\xff]*[a-z0-9\x80-\xbf])?)+$
13188 Alternatively, you can just disable this feature by setting
13190 dns_check_names_pattern =
13192 That is, set the option to an empty string so that no check is done.
13195 .option auth_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
13196 .cindex "authentication" "advertising"
13197 .cindex "AUTH" "advertising"
13198 If any server authentication mechanisms are configured, Exim advertises them in
13199 response to an EHLO command only if the calling host matches this list.
13200 Otherwise, Exim does not advertise AUTH.
13201 Exim does not accept AUTH commands from clients to which it has not
13202 advertised the availability of AUTH. The advertising of individual
13203 authentication mechanisms can be controlled by the use of the
13204 &%server_advertise_condition%& generic authenticator option on the individual
13205 authenticators. See chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for further details.
13207 Certain mail clients (for example, Netscape) require the user to provide a name
13208 and password for authentication if AUTH is advertised, even though it may
13209 not be needed (the host may accept messages from hosts on its local LAN without
13210 authentication, for example). The &%auth_advertise_hosts%& option can be used
13211 to make these clients more friendly by excluding them from the set of hosts to
13212 which Exim advertises AUTH.
13214 .cindex "AUTH" "advertising when encrypted"
13215 If you want to advertise the availability of AUTH only when the connection
13216 is encrypted using TLS, you can make use of the fact that the value of this
13217 option is expanded, with a setting like this:
13219 auth_advertise_hosts = ${if eq{$tls_in_cipher}{}{}{*}}
13221 .vindex "&$tls_in_cipher$&"
13222 If &$tls_in_cipher$& is empty, the session is not encrypted, and the result of
13223 the expansion is empty, thus matching no hosts. Otherwise, the result of the
13224 expansion is *, which matches all hosts.
13227 .option auto_thaw main time 0s
13228 .cindex "thawing messages"
13229 .cindex "unfreezing messages"
13230 If this option is set to a time greater than zero, a queue runner will try a
13231 new delivery attempt on any frozen message, other than a bounce message, if
13232 this much time has passed since it was frozen. This may result in the message
13233 being re-frozen if nothing has changed since the last attempt. It is a way of
13234 saying &"keep on trying, even though there are big problems"&.
13236 &*Note*&: This is an old option, which predates &%timeout_frozen_after%& and
13237 &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&. It is retained for compatibility, but it is not
13238 thought to be very useful any more, and its use should probably be avoided.
13241 .option av_scanner main string "see below"
13242 This option is available if Exim is built with the content-scanning extension.
13243 It specifies which anti-virus scanner to use. The default value is:
13245 sophie:/var/run/sophie
13247 If the value of &%av_scanner%& starts with a dollar character, it is expanded
13248 before use. See section &<<SECTscanvirus>>& for further details.
13251 .option bi_command main string unset
13253 This option supplies the name of a command that is run when Exim is called with
13254 the &%-bi%& option (see chapter &<<CHAPcommandline>>&). The string value is
13255 just the command name, it is not a complete command line. If an argument is
13256 required, it must come from the &%-oA%& command line option.
13259 .option bounce_message_file main string unset
13260 .cindex "bounce message" "customizing"
13261 .cindex "customizing" "bounce message"
13262 This option defines a template file containing paragraphs of text to be used
13263 for constructing bounce messages. Details of the file's contents are given in
13264 chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>&. See also &%warn_message_file%&.
13267 .option bounce_message_text main string unset
13268 When this option is set, its contents are included in the default bounce
13269 message immediately after &"This message was created automatically by mail
13270 delivery software."& It is not used if &%bounce_message_file%& is set.
13272 .option bounce_return_body main boolean true
13273 .cindex "bounce message" "including body"
13274 This option controls whether the body of an incoming message is included in a
13275 bounce message when &%bounce_return_message%& is true. The default setting
13276 causes the entire message, both header and body, to be returned (subject to the
13277 value of &%bounce_return_size_limit%&). If this option is false, only the
13278 message header is included. In the case of a non-SMTP message containing an
13279 error that is detected during reception, only those header lines preceding the
13280 point at which the error was detected are returned.
13281 .cindex "bounce message" "including original"
13283 .option bounce_return_message main boolean true
13284 If this option is set false, none of the original message is included in
13285 bounce messages generated by Exim. See also &%bounce_return_size_limit%& and
13286 &%bounce_return_body%&.
13289 .option bounce_return_size_limit main integer 100K
13290 .cindex "size" "of bounce, limit"
13291 .cindex "bounce message" "size limit"
13292 .cindex "limit" "bounce message size"
13293 This option sets a limit in bytes on the size of messages that are returned to
13294 senders as part of bounce messages when &%bounce_return_message%& is true. The
13295 limit should be less than the value of the global &%message_size_limit%& and of
13296 any &%message_size_limit%& settings on transports, to allow for the bounce text
13297 that Exim generates. If this option is set to zero there is no limit.
13299 When the body of any message that is to be included in a bounce message is
13300 greater than the limit, it is truncated, and a comment pointing this out is
13301 added at the top. The actual cutoff may be greater than the value given, owing
13302 to the use of buffering for transferring the message in chunks (typically 8K in
13303 size). The idea is to save bandwidth on those undeliverable 15-megabyte
13306 .option bounce_sender_authentication main string unset
13307 .cindex "bounce message" "sender authentication"
13308 .cindex "authentication" "bounce message"
13309 .cindex "AUTH" "on bounce message"
13310 This option provides an authenticated sender address that is sent with any
13311 bounce messages generated by Exim that are sent over an authenticated SMTP
13312 connection. A typical setting might be:
13314 bounce_sender_authentication = mailer-daemon@my.domain.example
13316 which would cause bounce messages to be sent using the SMTP command:
13318 MAIL FROM:<> AUTH=mailer-daemon@my.domain.example
13320 The value of &%bounce_sender_authentication%& must always be a complete email
13323 .option callout_domain_negative_expire main time 3h
13324 .cindex "caching" "callout timeouts"
13325 .cindex "callout" "caching timeouts"
13326 This option specifies the expiry time for negative callout cache data for a
13327 domain. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
13328 section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
13331 .option callout_domain_positive_expire main time 7d
13332 This option specifies the expiry time for positive callout cache data for a
13333 domain. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
13334 section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
13337 .option callout_negative_expire main time 2h
13338 This option specifies the expiry time for negative callout cache data for an
13339 address. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
13340 section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
13343 .option callout_positive_expire main time 24h
13344 This option specifies the expiry time for positive callout cache data for an
13345 address. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
13346 section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
13349 .option callout_random_local_part main string&!! "see below"
13350 This option defines the &"random"& local part that can be used as part of
13351 callout verification. The default value is
13353 $primary_hostname-$tod_epoch-testing
13355 See section &<<CALLaddparcall>>& for details of how this value is used.
13358 .option check_log_inodes main integer 0
13359 See &%check_spool_space%& below.
13362 .option check_log_space main integer 0
13363 See &%check_spool_space%& below.
13365 .oindex "&%check_rfc2047_length%&"
13366 .cindex "RFC 2047" "disabling length check"
13367 .option check_rfc2047_length main boolean true
13368 RFC 2047 defines a way of encoding non-ASCII characters in headers using a
13369 system of &"encoded words"&. The RFC specifies a maximum length for an encoded
13370 word; strings to be encoded that exceed this length are supposed to use
13371 multiple encoded words. By default, Exim does not recognize encoded words that
13372 exceed the maximum length. However, it seems that some software, in violation
13373 of the RFC, generates overlong encoded words. If &%check_rfc2047_length%& is
13374 set false, Exim recognizes encoded words of any length.
13377 .option check_spool_inodes main integer 0
13378 See &%check_spool_space%& below.
13381 .option check_spool_space main integer 0
13382 .cindex "checking disk space"
13383 .cindex "disk space, checking"
13384 .cindex "spool directory" "checking space"
13385 The four &%check_...%& options allow for checking of disk resources before a
13386 message is accepted.
13388 .vindex "&$log_inodes$&"
13389 .vindex "&$log_space$&"
13390 .vindex "&$spool_inodes$&"
13391 .vindex "&$spool_space$&"
13392 When any of these options are set, they apply to all incoming messages. If you
13393 want to apply different checks to different kinds of message, you can do so by
13394 testing the variables &$log_inodes$&, &$log_space$&, &$spool_inodes$&, and
13395 &$spool_space$& in an ACL with appropriate additional conditions.
13398 &%check_spool_space%& and &%check_spool_inodes%& check the spool partition if
13399 either value is greater than zero, for example:
13401 check_spool_space = 10M
13402 check_spool_inodes = 100
13404 The spool partition is the one that contains the directory defined by
13405 SPOOL_DIRECTORY in &_Local/Makefile_&. It is used for holding messages in
13408 &%check_log_space%& and &%check_log_inodes%& check the partition in which log
13409 files are written if either is greater than zero. These should be set only if
13410 &%log_file_path%& and &%spool_directory%& refer to different partitions.
13412 If there is less space or fewer inodes than requested, Exim refuses to accept
13413 incoming mail. In the case of SMTP input this is done by giving a 452 temporary
13414 error response to the MAIL command. If ESMTP is in use and there was a
13415 SIZE parameter on the MAIL command, its value is added to the
13416 &%check_spool_space%& value, and the check is performed even if
13417 &%check_spool_space%& is zero, unless &%no_smtp_check_spool_space%& is set.
13419 The values for &%check_spool_space%& and &%check_log_space%& are held as a
13420 number of kilobytes. If a non-multiple of 1024 is specified, it is rounded up.
13422 For non-SMTP input and for batched SMTP input, the test is done at start-up; on
13423 failure a message is written to stderr and Exim exits with a non-zero code, as
13424 it obviously cannot send an error message of any kind.
13426 .option daemon_smtp_ports main string &`smtp`&
13427 .cindex "port" "for daemon"
13428 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening ports"
13429 This option specifies one or more default SMTP ports on which the Exim daemon
13430 listens. See chapter &<<CHAPinterfaces>>& for details of how it is used. For
13431 backward compatibility, &%daemon_smtp_port%& (singular) is a synonym.
13433 .option daemon_startup_retries main integer 9
13434 .cindex "daemon startup, retrying"
13435 This option, along with &%daemon_startup_sleep%&, controls the retrying done by
13436 the daemon at startup when it cannot immediately bind a listening socket
13437 (typically because the socket is already in use): &%daemon_startup_retries%&
13438 defines the number of retries after the first failure, and
13439 &%daemon_startup_sleep%& defines the length of time to wait between retries.
13441 .option daemon_startup_sleep main time 30s
13442 See &%daemon_startup_retries%&.
13444 .option delay_warning main "time list" 24h
13445 .cindex "warning of delay"
13446 .cindex "delay warning, specifying"
13447 When a message is delayed, Exim sends a warning message to the sender at
13448 intervals specified by this option. The data is a colon-separated list of times
13449 after which to send warning messages. If the value of the option is an empty
13450 string or a zero time, no warnings are sent. Up to 10 times may be given. If a
13451 message has been on the queue for longer than the last time, the last interval
13452 between the times is used to compute subsequent warning times. For example,
13455 delay_warning = 4h:8h:24h
13457 the first message is sent after 4 hours, the second after 8 hours, and
13458 the third one after 24 hours. After that, messages are sent every 16 hours,
13459 because that is the interval between the last two times on the list. If you set
13460 just one time, it specifies the repeat interval. For example, with:
13464 messages are repeated every six hours. To stop warnings after a given time, set
13465 a very large time at the end of the list. For example:
13467 delay_warning = 2h:12h:99d
13470 .option delay_warning_condition main string&!! "see below"
13471 .vindex "&$domain$&"
13472 The string is expanded at the time a warning message might be sent. If all the
13473 deferred addresses have the same domain, it is set in &$domain$& during the
13474 expansion. Otherwise &$domain$& is empty. If the result of the expansion is a
13475 forced failure, an empty string, or a string matching any of &"0"&, &"no"& or
13476 &"false"& (the comparison being done caselessly) then the warning message is
13477 not sent. The default is:
13479 delay_warning_condition = ${if or {\
13480 { !eq{$h_list-id:$h_list-post:$h_list-subscribe:}{} }\
13481 { match{$h_precedence:}{(?i)bulk|list|junk} }\
13482 { match{$h_auto-submitted:}{(?i)auto-generated|auto-replied} }\
13485 This suppresses the sending of warnings for messages that contain &'List-ID:'&,
13486 &'List-Post:'&, or &'List-Subscribe:'& headers, or have &"bulk"&, &"list"& or
13487 &"junk"& in a &'Precedence:'& header, or have &"auto-generated"& or
13488 &"auto-replied"& in an &'Auto-Submitted:'& header.
13490 .option deliver_drop_privilege main boolean false
13491 .cindex "unprivileged delivery"
13492 .cindex "delivery" "unprivileged"
13493 If this option is set true, Exim drops its root privilege at the start of a
13494 delivery process, and runs as the Exim user throughout. This severely restricts
13495 the kinds of local delivery that are possible, but is viable in certain types
13496 of configuration. There is a discussion about the use of root privilege in
13497 chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>&.
13499 .option deliver_queue_load_max main fixed-point unset
13500 .cindex "load average"
13501 .cindex "queue runner" "abandoning"
13502 When this option is set, a queue run is abandoned if the system load average
13503 becomes greater than the value of the option. The option has no effect on
13504 ancient operating systems on which Exim cannot determine the load average.
13505 See also &%queue_only_load%& and &%smtp_load_reserve%&.
13508 .option delivery_date_remove main boolean true
13509 .cindex "&'Delivery-date:'& header line"
13510 Exim's transports have an option for adding a &'Delivery-date:'& header to a
13511 message when it is delivered, in exactly the same way as &'Return-path:'& is
13512 handled. &'Delivery-date:'& records the actual time of delivery. Such headers
13513 should not be present in incoming messages, and this option causes them to be
13514 removed at the time the message is received, to avoid any problems that might
13515 occur when a delivered message is subsequently sent on to some other recipient.
13517 .option disable_fsync main boolean false
13518 .cindex "&[fsync()]&, disabling"
13519 This option is available only if Exim was built with the compile-time option
13520 ENABLE_DISABLE_FSYNC. When this is not set, a reference to &%disable_fsync%& in
13521 a runtime configuration generates an &"unknown option"& error. You should not
13522 build Exim with ENABLE_DISABLE_FSYNC or set &%disable_fsync%& unless you
13523 really, really, really understand what you are doing. &'No pre-compiled
13524 distributions of Exim should ever make this option available.'&
13526 When &%disable_fsync%& is set true, Exim no longer calls &[fsync()]& to force
13527 updated files' data to be written to disc before continuing. Unexpected events
13528 such as crashes and power outages may cause data to be lost or scrambled.
13529 Here be Dragons. &*Beware.*&
13532 .option disable_ipv6 main boolean false
13533 .cindex "IPv6" "disabling"
13534 If this option is set true, even if the Exim binary has IPv6 support, no IPv6
13535 activities take place. AAAA records are never looked up, and any IPv6 addresses
13536 that are listed in &%local_interfaces%&, data for the &%manualroute%& router,
13537 etc. are ignored. If IP literals are enabled, the &(ipliteral)& router declines
13538 to handle IPv6 literal addresses.
13541 .option dns_again_means_nonexist main "domain list&!!" unset
13542 .cindex "DNS" "&""try again""& response; overriding"
13543 DNS lookups give a &"try again"& response for the DNS errors
13544 &"non-authoritative host not found"& and &"SERVERFAIL"&. This can cause Exim to
13545 keep trying to deliver a message, or to give repeated temporary errors to
13546 incoming mail. Sometimes the effect is caused by a badly set up name server and
13547 may persist for a long time. If a domain which exhibits this problem matches
13548 anything in &%dns_again_means_nonexist%&, it is treated as if it did not exist.
13549 This option should be used with care. You can make it apply to reverse lookups
13550 by a setting such as this:
13552 dns_again_means_nonexist = *.in-addr.arpa
13554 This option applies to all DNS lookups that Exim does. It also applies when the
13555 &[gethostbyname()]& or &[getipnodebyname()]& functions give temporary errors,
13556 since these are most likely to be caused by DNS lookup problems. The
13557 &(dnslookup)& router has some options of its own for controlling what happens
13558 when lookups for MX or SRV records give temporary errors. These more specific
13559 options are applied after this global option.
13561 .option dns_check_names_pattern main string "see below"
13562 .cindex "DNS" "pre-check of name syntax"
13563 When this option is set to a non-empty string, it causes Exim to check domain
13564 names for characters that are not allowed in host names before handing them to
13565 the DNS resolver, because some resolvers give temporary errors for names that
13566 contain unusual characters. If a domain name contains any unwanted characters,
13567 a &"not found"& result is forced, and the resolver is not called. The check is
13568 done by matching the domain name against a regular expression, which is the
13569 value of this option. The default pattern is
13571 dns_check_names_pattern = \
13572 (?i)^(?>(?(1)\.|())[^\W_](?>[a-z0-9/-]*[^\W_])?)+$
13574 which permits only letters, digits, slashes, and hyphens in components, but
13575 they must start and end with a letter or digit. Slashes are not, in fact,
13576 permitted in host names, but they are found in certain NS records (which can be
13577 accessed in Exim by using a &%dnsdb%& lookup). If you set
13578 &%allow_utf8_domains%&, you must modify this pattern, or set the option to an
13581 .option dns_csa_search_limit main integer 5
13582 This option controls the depth of parental searching for CSA SRV records in the
13583 DNS, as described in more detail in section &<<SECTverifyCSA>>&.
13585 .option dns_csa_use_reverse main boolean true
13586 This option controls whether or not an IP address, given as a CSA domain, is
13587 reversed and looked up in the reverse DNS, as described in more detail in
13588 section &<<SECTverifyCSA>>&.
13590 .option dns_ipv4_lookup main "domain list&!!" unset
13591 .cindex "IPv6" "DNS lookup for AAAA records"
13592 .cindex "DNS" "IPv6 lookup for AAAA records"
13593 When Exim is compiled with IPv6 support and &%disable_ipv6%& is not set, it
13594 looks for IPv6 address records (AAAA records) as well as IPv4 address records
13595 (A records) when trying to find IP addresses for hosts, unless the host's
13596 domain matches this list.
13598 This is a fudge to help with name servers that give big delays or otherwise do
13599 not work for the AAAA record type. In due course, when the world's name
13600 servers have all been upgraded, there should be no need for this option.
13603 .option dns_retrans main time 0s
13604 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
13605 The options &%dns_retrans%& and &%dns_retry%& can be used to set the
13606 retransmission and retry parameters for DNS lookups. Values of zero (the
13607 defaults) leave the system default settings unchanged. The first value is the
13608 time between retries, and the second is the number of retries. It isn't
13609 totally clear exactly how these settings affect the total time a DNS lookup may
13610 take. I haven't found any documentation about timeouts on DNS lookups; these
13611 parameter values are available in the external resolver interface structure,
13612 but nowhere does it seem to describe how they are used or what you might want
13616 .option dns_retry main integer 0
13617 See &%dns_retrans%& above.
13621 .option dns_use_dnssec main integer -1
13622 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
13623 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
13624 If this option is set to a non-negative number then Exim will initialise the
13625 DNS resolver library to either use or not use DNSSEC, overriding the system
13626 default. A value of 0 coerces DNSSEC off, a value of 1 coerces DNSSEC on.
13628 If the resolver library does not support DNSSEC then this option has no effect.
13632 .option dns_use_edns0 main integer -1
13633 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
13634 .cindex "DNS" "EDNS0"
13635 If this option is set to a non-negative number then Exim will initialise the
13636 DNS resolver library to either use or not use EDNS0 extensions, overriding
13637 the system default. A value of 0 coerces EDNS0 off, a value of 1 coerces EDNS0
13640 If the resolver library does not support EDNS0 then this option has no effect.
13643 .option drop_cr main boolean false
13644 This is an obsolete option that is now a no-op. It used to affect the way Exim
13645 handled CR and LF characters in incoming messages. What happens now is
13646 described in section &<<SECTlineendings>>&.
13648 .option dsn_from main "string&!!" "see below"
13649 .cindex "&'From:'& header line" "in bounces"
13650 .cindex "bounce messages" "&'From:'& line, specifying"
13651 This option can be used to vary the contents of &'From:'& header lines in
13652 bounces and other automatically generated messages (&"Delivery Status
13653 Notifications"& &-- hence the name of the option). The default setting is:
13655 dsn_from = Mail Delivery System <Mailer-Daemon@$qualify_domain>
13657 The value is expanded every time it is needed. If the expansion fails, a
13658 panic is logged, and the default value is used.
13660 .option envelope_to_remove main boolean true
13661 .cindex "&'Envelope-to:'& header line"
13662 Exim's transports have an option for adding an &'Envelope-to:'& header to a
13663 message when it is delivered, in exactly the same way as &'Return-path:'& is
13664 handled. &'Envelope-to:'& records the original recipient address from the
13665 messages's envelope that caused the delivery to happen. Such headers should not
13666 be present in incoming messages, and this option causes them to be removed at
13667 the time the message is received, to avoid any problems that might occur when a
13668 delivered message is subsequently sent on to some other recipient.
13671 .option errors_copy main "string list&!!" unset
13672 .cindex "bounce message" "copy to other address"
13673 .cindex "copy of bounce message"
13674 Setting this option causes Exim to send bcc copies of bounce messages that it
13675 generates to other addresses. &*Note*&: This does not apply to bounce messages
13676 coming from elsewhere. The value of the option is a colon-separated list of
13677 items. Each item consists of a pattern, terminated by white space, followed by
13678 a comma-separated list of email addresses. If a pattern contains spaces, it
13679 must be enclosed in double quotes.
13681 Each pattern is processed in the same way as a single item in an address list
13682 (see section &<<SECTaddresslist>>&). When a pattern matches the recipient of
13683 the bounce message, the message is copied to the addresses on the list. The
13684 items are scanned in order, and once a matching one is found, no further items
13685 are examined. For example:
13687 errors_copy = spqr@mydomain postmaster@mydomain.example :\
13688 rqps@mydomain hostmaster@mydomain.example,\
13689 postmaster@mydomain.example
13691 .vindex "&$domain$&"
13692 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
13693 The address list is expanded before use. The expansion variables &$local_part$&
13694 and &$domain$& are set from the original recipient of the error message, and if
13695 there was any wildcard matching in the pattern, the expansion
13696 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &%errors_copy%&"
13697 variables &$0$&, &$1$&, etc. are set in the normal way.
13700 .option errors_reply_to main string unset
13701 .cindex "bounce message" "&'Reply-to:'& in"
13702 By default, Exim's bounce and delivery warning messages contain the header line
13704 &`From: Mail Delivery System <Mailer-Daemon@`&&'qualify-domain'&&`>`&
13706 .oindex &%quota_warn_message%&
13707 where &'qualify-domain'& is the value of the &%qualify_domain%& option.
13708 A warning message that is generated by the &%quota_warn_message%& option in an
13709 &(appendfile)& transport may contain its own &'From:'& header line that
13710 overrides the default.
13712 Experience shows that people reply to bounce messages. If the
13713 &%errors_reply_to%& option is set, a &'Reply-To:'& header is added to bounce
13714 and warning messages. For example:
13716 errors_reply_to = postmaster@my.domain.example
13718 The value of the option is not expanded. It must specify a valid RFC 2822
13719 address. However, if a warning message that is generated by the
13720 &%quota_warn_message%& option in an &(appendfile)& transport contain its
13721 own &'Reply-To:'& header line, the value of the &%errors_reply_to%& option is
13725 .option exim_group main string "compile-time configured"
13726 .cindex "gid (group id)" "Exim's own"
13727 .cindex "Exim group"
13728 This option changes the gid under which Exim runs when it gives up root
13729 privilege. The default value is compiled into the binary. The value of this
13730 option is used only when &%exim_user%& is also set. Unless it consists entirely
13731 of digits, the string is looked up using &[getgrnam()]&, and failure causes a
13732 configuration error. See chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>& for a discussion of
13736 .option exim_path main string "see below"
13737 .cindex "Exim binary, path name"
13738 This option specifies the path name of the Exim binary, which is used when Exim
13739 needs to re-exec itself. The default is set up to point to the file &'exim'& in
13740 the directory configured at compile time by the BIN_DIRECTORY setting. It
13741 is necessary to change &%exim_path%& if, exceptionally, Exim is run from some
13743 &*Warning*&: Do not use a macro to define the value of this option, because
13744 you will break those Exim utilities that scan the configuration file to find
13745 where the binary is. (They then use the &%-bP%& option to extract option
13746 settings such as the value of &%spool_directory%&.)
13749 .option exim_user main string "compile-time configured"
13750 .cindex "uid (user id)" "Exim's own"
13751 .cindex "Exim user"
13752 This option changes the uid under which Exim runs when it gives up root
13753 privilege. The default value is compiled into the binary. Ownership of the run
13754 time configuration file and the use of the &%-C%& and &%-D%& command line
13755 options is checked against the values in the binary, not what is set here.
13757 Unless it consists entirely of digits, the string is looked up using
13758 &[getpwnam()]&, and failure causes a configuration error. If &%exim_group%& is
13759 not also supplied, the gid is taken from the result of &[getpwnam()]& if it is
13760 used. See chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>& for a discussion of security issues.
13763 .option extra_local_interfaces main "string list" unset
13764 This option defines network interfaces that are to be considered local when
13765 routing, but which are not used for listening by the daemon. See section
13766 &<<SECTreclocipadd>>& for details.
13769 . Allow this long option name to split; give it unsplit as a fifth argument
13770 . for the automatic .oindex that is generated by .option.
13772 .option "extract_addresses_remove_ &~&~arguments" main boolean true &&&
13773 extract_addresses_remove_arguments
13775 .cindex "command line" "addresses with &%-t%&"
13776 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-t%& option"
13777 According to some Sendmail documentation (Sun, IRIX, HP-UX), if any addresses
13778 are present on the command line when the &%-t%& option is used to build an
13779 envelope from a message's &'To:'&, &'Cc:'& and &'Bcc:'& headers, the command
13780 line addresses are removed from the recipients list. This is also how Smail
13781 behaves. However, other Sendmail documentation (the O'Reilly book) states that
13782 command line addresses are added to those obtained from the header lines. When
13783 &%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%& is true (the default), Exim subtracts
13784 argument headers. If it is set false, Exim adds rather than removes argument
13788 .option finduser_retries main integer 0
13789 .cindex "NIS, retrying user lookups"
13790 On systems running NIS or other schemes in which user and group information is
13791 distributed from a remote system, there can be times when &[getpwnam()]& and
13792 related functions fail, even when given valid data, because things time out.
13793 Unfortunately these failures cannot be distinguished from genuine &"not found"&
13794 errors. If &%finduser_retries%& is set greater than zero, Exim will try that
13795 many extra times to find a user or a group, waiting for one second between
13798 .cindex "&_/etc/passwd_&" "multiple reading of"
13799 You should not set this option greater than zero if your user information is in
13800 a traditional &_/etc/passwd_& file, because it will cause Exim needlessly to
13801 search the file multiple times for non-existent users, and also cause delay.
13805 .option freeze_tell main "string list, comma separated" unset
13806 .cindex "freezing messages" "sending a message when freezing"
13807 On encountering certain errors, or when configured to do so in a system filter,
13808 ACL, or special router, Exim freezes a message. This means that no further
13809 delivery attempts take place until an administrator thaws the message, or the
13810 &%auto_thaw%&, &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&, or &%timeout_frozen_after%&
13811 feature cause it to be processed. If &%freeze_tell%& is set, Exim generates a
13812 warning message whenever it freezes something, unless the message it is
13813 freezing is a locally-generated bounce message. (Without this exception there
13814 is the possibility of looping.) The warning message is sent to the addresses
13815 supplied as the comma-separated value of this option. If several of the
13816 message's addresses cause freezing, only a single message is sent. If the
13817 freezing was automatic, the reason(s) for freezing can be found in the message
13818 log. If you configure freezing in a filter or ACL, you must arrange for any
13819 logging that you require.
13822 .option gecos_name main string&!! unset
13824 .cindex "&""gecos""& field, parsing"
13825 Some operating systems, notably HP-UX, use the &"gecos"& field in the system
13826 password file to hold other information in addition to users' real names. Exim
13827 looks up this field for use when it is creating &'Sender:'& or &'From:'&
13828 headers. If either &%gecos_pattern%& or &%gecos_name%& are unset, the contents
13829 of the field are used unchanged, except that, if an ampersand is encountered,
13830 it is replaced by the user's login name with the first character forced to
13831 upper case, since this is a convention that is observed on many systems.
13833 When these options are set, &%gecos_pattern%& is treated as a regular
13834 expression that is to be applied to the field (again with && replaced by the
13835 login name), and if it matches, &%gecos_name%& is expanded and used as the
13838 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &%gecos_name%&"
13839 Numeric variables such as &$1$&, &$2$&, etc. can be used in the expansion to
13840 pick up sub-fields that were matched by the pattern. In HP-UX, where the user's
13841 name terminates at the first comma, the following can be used:
13843 gecos_pattern = ([^,]*)
13847 .option gecos_pattern main string unset
13848 See &%gecos_name%& above.
13851 .option gnutls_compat_mode main boolean unset
13852 This option controls whether GnuTLS is used in compatibility mode in an Exim
13853 server. This reduces security slightly, but improves interworking with older
13854 implementations of TLS.
13856 .option headers_charset main string "see below"
13857 This option sets a default character set for translating from encoded MIME
13858 &"words"& in header lines, when referenced by an &$h_xxx$& expansion item. The
13859 default is the value of HEADERS_CHARSET in &_Local/Makefile_&. The
13860 ultimate default is ISO-8859-1. For more details see the description of header
13861 insertions in section &<<SECTexpansionitems>>&.
13865 .option header_maxsize main integer "see below"
13866 .cindex "header section" "maximum size of"
13867 .cindex "limit" "size of message header section"
13868 This option controls the overall maximum size of a message's header
13869 section. The default is the value of HEADER_MAXSIZE in
13870 &_Local/Makefile_&; the default for that is 1M. Messages with larger header
13871 sections are rejected.
13874 .option header_line_maxsize main integer 0
13875 .cindex "header lines" "maximum size of"
13876 .cindex "limit" "size of one header line"
13877 This option limits the length of any individual header line in a message, after
13878 all the continuations have been joined together. Messages with individual
13879 header lines that are longer than the limit are rejected. The default value of
13880 zero means &"no limit"&.
13885 .option helo_accept_junk_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
13886 .cindex "HELO" "accepting junk data"
13887 .cindex "EHLO" "accepting junk data"
13888 Exim checks the syntax of HELO and EHLO commands for incoming SMTP
13889 mail, and gives an error response for invalid data. Unfortunately, there are
13890 some SMTP clients that send syntactic junk. They can be accommodated by setting
13891 this option. Note that this is a syntax check only. See &%helo_verify_hosts%&
13892 if you want to do semantic checking.
13893 See also &%helo_allow_chars%& for a way of extending the permitted character
13897 .option helo_allow_chars main string unset
13898 .cindex "HELO" "underscores in"
13899 .cindex "EHLO" "underscores in"
13900 .cindex "underscore in EHLO/HELO"
13901 This option can be set to a string of rogue characters that are permitted in
13902 all EHLO and HELO names in addition to the standard letters, digits,
13903 hyphens, and dots. If you really must allow underscores, you can set
13905 helo_allow_chars = _
13907 Note that the value is one string, not a list.
13910 .option helo_lookup_domains main "domain list&!!" &`@:@[]`&
13911 .cindex "HELO" "forcing reverse lookup"
13912 .cindex "EHLO" "forcing reverse lookup"
13913 If the domain given by a client in a HELO or EHLO command matches this
13914 list, a reverse lookup is done in order to establish the host's true name. The
13915 default forces a lookup if the client host gives the server's name or any of
13916 its IP addresses (in brackets), something that broken clients have been seen to
13920 .option helo_try_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
13921 .cindex "HELO verifying" "optional"
13922 .cindex "EHLO" "verifying, optional"
13923 By default, Exim just checks the syntax of HELO and EHLO commands (see
13924 &%helo_accept_junk_hosts%& and &%helo_allow_chars%&). However, some sites like
13925 to do more extensive checking of the data supplied by these commands. The ACL
13926 condition &`verify = helo`& is provided to make this possible.
13927 Formerly, it was necessary also to set this option (&%helo_try_verify_hosts%&)
13928 to force the check to occur. From release 4.53 onwards, this is no longer
13929 necessary. If the check has not been done before &`verify = helo`& is
13930 encountered, it is done at that time. Consequently, this option is obsolete.
13931 Its specification is retained here for backwards compatibility.
13933 When an EHLO or HELO command is received, if the calling host matches
13934 &%helo_try_verify_hosts%&, Exim checks that the host name given in the HELO or
13935 EHLO command either:
13938 is an IP literal matching the calling address of the host, or
13940 .cindex "DNS" "reverse lookup"
13941 .cindex "reverse DNS lookup"
13942 matches the host name that Exim obtains by doing a reverse lookup of the
13943 calling host address, or
13945 when looked up using &[gethostbyname()]& (or &[getipnodebyname()]& when
13946 available) yields the calling host address.
13949 However, the EHLO or HELO command is not rejected if any of the checks
13950 fail. Processing continues, but the result of the check is remembered, and can
13951 be detected later in an ACL by the &`verify = helo`& condition.
13953 .option helo_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
13954 .cindex "HELO verifying" "mandatory"
13955 .cindex "EHLO" "verifying, mandatory"
13956 Like &%helo_try_verify_hosts%&, this option is obsolete, and retained only for
13957 backwards compatibility. For hosts that match this option, Exim checks the host
13958 name given in the HELO or EHLO in the same way as for
13959 &%helo_try_verify_hosts%&. If the check fails, the HELO or EHLO command is
13960 rejected with a 550 error, and entries are written to the main and reject logs.
13961 If a MAIL command is received before EHLO or HELO, it is rejected with a 503
13964 .option hold_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
13965 .cindex "domain" "delaying delivery"
13966 .cindex "delivery" "delaying certain domains"
13967 This option allows mail for particular domains to be held on the queue
13968 manually. The option is overridden if a message delivery is forced with the
13969 &%-M%&, &%-qf%&, &%-Rf%& or &%-Sf%& options, and also while testing or
13970 verifying addresses using &%-bt%& or &%-bv%&. Otherwise, if a domain matches an
13971 item in &%hold_domains%&, no routing or delivery for that address is done, and
13972 it is deferred every time the message is looked at.
13974 This option is intended as a temporary operational measure for delaying the
13975 delivery of mail while some problem is being sorted out, or some new
13976 configuration tested. If you just want to delay the processing of some
13977 domains until a queue run occurs, you should use &%queue_domains%& or
13978 &%queue_smtp_domains%&, not &%hold_domains%&.
13980 A setting of &%hold_domains%& does not override Exim's code for removing
13981 messages from the queue if they have been there longer than the longest retry
13982 time in any retry rule. If you want to hold messages for longer than the normal
13983 retry times, insert a dummy retry rule with a long retry time.
13986 .option host_lookup main "host list&!!" unset
13987 .cindex "host name" "lookup, forcing"
13988 Exim does not look up the name of a calling host from its IP address unless it
13989 is required to compare against some host list, or the host matches
13990 &%helo_try_verify_hosts%& or &%helo_verify_hosts%&, or the host matches this
13991 option (which normally contains IP addresses rather than host names). The
13992 default configuration file contains
13996 which causes a lookup to happen for all hosts. If the expense of these lookups
13997 is felt to be too great, the setting can be changed or removed.
13999 After a successful reverse lookup, Exim does a forward lookup on the name it
14000 has obtained, to verify that it yields the IP address that it started with. If
14001 this check fails, Exim behaves as if the name lookup failed.
14003 .vindex "&$host_lookup_failed$&"
14004 .vindex "&$sender_host_name$&"
14005 After any kind of failure, the host name (in &$sender_host_name$&) remains
14006 unset, and &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to the string &"1"&. See also
14007 &%dns_again_means_nonexist%&, &%helo_lookup_domains%&, and
14008 &`verify = reverse_host_lookup`& in ACLs.
14011 .option host_lookup_order main "string list" &`bydns:byaddr`&
14012 This option specifies the order of different lookup methods when Exim is trying
14013 to find a host name from an IP address. The default is to do a DNS lookup
14014 first, and then to try a local lookup (using &[gethostbyaddr()]& or equivalent)
14015 if that fails. You can change the order of these lookups, or omit one entirely,
14018 &*Warning*&: The &"byaddr"& method does not always yield aliases when there are
14019 multiple PTR records in the DNS and the IP address is not listed in
14020 &_/etc/hosts_&. Different operating systems give different results in this
14021 case. That is why the default tries a DNS lookup first.
14025 .option host_reject_connection main "host list&!!" unset
14026 .cindex "host" "rejecting connections from"
14027 If this option is set, incoming SMTP calls from the hosts listed are rejected
14028 as soon as the connection is made.
14029 This option is obsolete, and retained only for backward compatibility, because
14030 nowadays the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_connect%& can also reject incoming
14031 connections immediately.
14033 The ability to give an immediate rejection (either by this option or using an
14034 ACL) is provided for use in unusual cases. Many hosts will just try again,
14035 sometimes without much delay. Normally, it is better to use an ACL to reject
14036 incoming messages at a later stage, such as after RCPT commands. See
14037 chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&.
14040 .option hosts_connection_nolog main "host list&!!" unset
14041 .cindex "host" "not logging connections from"
14042 This option defines a list of hosts for which connection logging does not
14043 happen, even though the &%smtp_connection%& log selector is set. For example,
14044 you might want not to log SMTP connections from local processes, or from
14045 127.0.0.1, or from your local LAN. This option is consulted in the main loop of
14046 the daemon; you should therefore strive to restrict its value to a short inline
14047 list of IP addresses and networks. To disable logging SMTP connections from
14048 local processes, you must create a host list with an empty item. For example:
14050 hosts_connection_nolog = :
14052 If the &%smtp_connection%& log selector is not set, this option has no effect.
14056 .option hosts_treat_as_local main "domain list&!!" unset
14057 .cindex "local host" "domains treated as"
14058 .cindex "host" "treated as local"
14059 If this option is set, any host names that match the domain list are treated as
14060 if they were the local host when Exim is scanning host lists obtained from MX
14062 or other sources. Note that the value of this option is a domain list, not a
14063 host list, because it is always used to check host names, not IP addresses.
14065 This option also applies when Exim is matching the special items
14066 &`@mx_any`&, &`@mx_primary`&, and &`@mx_secondary`& in a domain list (see
14067 section &<<SECTdomainlist>>&), and when checking the &%hosts%& option in the
14068 &(smtp)& transport for the local host (see the &%allow_localhost%& option in
14069 that transport). See also &%local_interfaces%&, &%extra_local_interfaces%&, and
14070 chapter &<<CHAPinterfaces>>&, which contains a discussion about local network
14071 interfaces and recognizing the local host.
14074 .option ibase_servers main "string list" unset
14075 .cindex "InterBase" "server list"
14076 This option provides a list of InterBase servers and associated connection data,
14077 to be used in conjunction with &(ibase)& lookups (see section &<<SECID72>>&).
14078 The option is available only if Exim has been built with InterBase support.
14082 .option ignore_bounce_errors_after main time 10w
14083 .cindex "bounce message" "discarding"
14084 .cindex "discarding bounce message"
14085 This option affects the processing of bounce messages that cannot be delivered,
14086 that is, those that suffer a permanent delivery failure. (Bounce messages that
14087 suffer temporary delivery failures are of course retried in the usual way.)
14089 After a permanent delivery failure, bounce messages are frozen,
14090 because there is no sender to whom they can be returned. When a frozen bounce
14091 message has been on the queue for more than the given time, it is unfrozen at
14092 the next queue run, and a further delivery is attempted. If delivery fails
14093 again, the bounce message is discarded. This makes it possible to keep failed
14094 bounce messages around for a shorter time than the normal maximum retry time
14095 for frozen messages. For example,
14097 ignore_bounce_errors_after = 12h
14099 retries failed bounce message deliveries after 12 hours, discarding any further
14100 failures. If the value of this option is set to a zero time period, bounce
14101 failures are discarded immediately. Setting a very long time (as in the default
14102 value) has the effect of disabling this option. For ways of automatically
14103 dealing with other kinds of frozen message, see &%auto_thaw%& and
14104 &%timeout_frozen_after%&.
14107 .option ignore_fromline_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
14108 .cindex "&""From""& line"
14109 .cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
14110 Some broken SMTP clients insist on sending a UUCP-like &"From&~"& line before
14111 the headers of a message. By default this is treated as the start of the
14112 message's body, which means that any following headers are not recognized as
14113 such. Exim can be made to ignore it by setting &%ignore_fromline_hosts%& to
14114 match those hosts that insist on sending it. If the sender is actually a local
14115 process rather than a remote host, and is using &%-bs%& to inject the messages,
14116 &%ignore_fromline_local%& must be set to achieve this effect.
14119 .option ignore_fromline_local main boolean false
14120 See &%ignore_fromline_hosts%& above.
14123 .option keep_malformed main time 4d
14124 This option specifies the length of time to keep messages whose spool files
14125 have been corrupted in some way. This should, of course, never happen. At the
14126 next attempt to deliver such a message, it gets removed. The incident is
14130 .option ldap_ca_cert_dir main string unset
14131 .cindex "LDAP", "TLS CA certificate directory"
14132 This option indicates which directory contains CA certificates for verifying
14133 a TLS certificate presented by an LDAP server.
14134 While Exim does not provide a default value, your SSL library may.
14135 Analogous to &%tls_verify_certificates%& but as a client-side option for LDAP
14136 and constrained to be a directory.
14139 .option ldap_ca_cert_file main string unset
14140 .cindex "LDAP", "TLS CA certificate file"
14141 This option indicates which file contains CA certificates for verifying
14142 a TLS certificate presented by an LDAP server.
14143 While Exim does not provide a default value, your SSL library may.
14144 Analogous to &%tls_verify_certificates%& but as a client-side option for LDAP
14145 and constrained to be a file.
14148 .option ldap_cert_file main string unset
14149 .cindex "LDAP" "TLS client certificate file"
14150 This option indicates which file contains an TLS client certificate which
14151 Exim should present to the LDAP server during TLS negotiation.
14152 Should be used together with &%ldap_cert_key%&.
14155 .option ldap_cert_key main string unset
14156 .cindex "LDAP" "TLS client key file"
14157 This option indicates which file contains the secret/private key to use
14158 to prove identity to the LDAP server during TLS negotiation.
14159 Should be used together with &%ldap_cert_file%&, which contains the
14160 identity to be proven.
14163 .option ldap_cipher_suite main string unset
14164 .cindex "LDAP" "TLS cipher suite"
14165 This controls the TLS cipher-suite negotiation during TLS negotiation with
14166 the LDAP server. See &<<SECTreqciphssl>>& for more details of the format of
14167 cipher-suite options with OpenSSL (as used by LDAP client libraries).
14170 .option ldap_default_servers main "string list" unset
14171 .cindex "LDAP" "default servers"
14172 This option provides a list of LDAP servers which are tried in turn when an
14173 LDAP query does not contain a server. See section &<<SECTforldaque>>& for
14174 details of LDAP queries. This option is available only when Exim has been built
14178 .option ldap_require_cert main string unset.
14179 .cindex "LDAP" "policy for LDAP server TLS cert presentation"
14180 This should be one of the values "hard", "demand", "allow", "try" or "never".
14181 A value other than one of these is interpreted as "never".
14182 See the entry "TLS_REQCERT" in your system man page for ldap.conf(5).
14183 Although Exim does not set a default, the LDAP library probably defaults
14187 .option ldap_start_tls main boolean false
14188 .cindex "LDAP" "whether or not to negotiate TLS"
14189 If set, Exim will attempt to negotiate TLS with the LDAP server when
14190 connecting on a regular LDAP port. This is the LDAP equivalent of SMTP's
14191 "STARTTLS". This is distinct from using "ldaps", which is the LDAP form
14193 In the event of failure to negotiate TLS, the action taken is controlled
14194 by &%ldap_require_cert%&.
14197 .option ldap_version main integer unset
14198 .cindex "LDAP" "protocol version, forcing"
14199 This option can be used to force Exim to set a specific protocol version for
14200 LDAP. If it option is unset, it is shown by the &%-bP%& command line option as
14201 -1. When this is the case, the default is 3 if LDAP_VERSION3 is defined in
14202 the LDAP headers; otherwise it is 2. This option is available only when Exim
14203 has been built with LDAP support.
14207 .option local_from_check main boolean true
14208 .cindex "&'Sender:'& header line" "disabling addition of"
14209 .cindex "&'From:'& header line" "disabling checking of"
14210 When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP/IP connection) by
14211 an untrusted user, Exim removes any existing &'Sender:'& header line, and
14212 checks that the &'From:'& header line matches the login of the calling user and
14213 the domain specified by &%qualify_domain%&.
14215 &*Note*&: An unqualified address (no domain) in the &'From:'& header in a
14216 locally submitted message is automatically qualified by Exim, unless the
14217 &%-bnq%& command line option is used.
14219 You can use &%local_from_prefix%& and &%local_from_suffix%& to permit affixes
14220 on the local part. If the &'From:'& header line does not match, Exim adds a
14221 &'Sender:'& header with an address constructed from the calling user's login
14222 and the default qualify domain.
14224 If &%local_from_check%& is set false, the &'From:'& header check is disabled,
14225 and no &'Sender:'& header is ever added. If, in addition, you want to retain
14226 &'Sender:'& header lines supplied by untrusted users, you must also set
14227 &%local_sender_retain%& to be true.
14229 .cindex "envelope sender"
14230 These options affect only the header lines in the message. The envelope sender
14231 is still forced to be the login id at the qualify domain unless
14232 &%untrusted_set_sender%& permits the user to supply an envelope sender.
14234 For messages received over TCP/IP, an ACL can specify &"submission mode"& to
14235 request similar header line checking. See section &<<SECTthesenhea>>&, which
14236 has more details about &'Sender:'& processing.
14241 .option local_from_prefix main string unset
14242 When Exim checks the &'From:'& header line of locally submitted messages for
14243 matching the login id (see &%local_from_check%& above), it can be configured to
14244 ignore certain prefixes and suffixes in the local part of the address. This is
14245 done by setting &%local_from_prefix%& and/or &%local_from_suffix%& to
14246 appropriate lists, in the same form as the &%local_part_prefix%& and
14247 &%local_part_suffix%& router options (see chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&). For
14250 local_from_prefix = *-
14252 is set, a &'From:'& line containing
14254 From: anything-user@your.domain.example
14256 will not cause a &'Sender:'& header to be added if &'user@your.domain.example'&
14257 matches the actual sender address that is constructed from the login name and
14261 .option local_from_suffix main string unset
14262 See &%local_from_prefix%& above.
14265 .option local_interfaces main "string list" "see below"
14266 This option controls which network interfaces are used by the daemon for
14267 listening; they are also used to identify the local host when routing. Chapter
14268 &<<CHAPinterfaces>>& contains a full description of this option and the related
14269 options &%daemon_smtp_ports%&, &%extra_local_interfaces%&,
14270 &%hosts_treat_as_local%&, and &%tls_on_connect_ports%&. The default value for
14271 &%local_interfaces%& is
14273 local_interfaces = 0.0.0.0
14275 when Exim is built without IPv6 support; otherwise it is
14277 local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
14280 .option local_scan_timeout main time 5m
14281 .cindex "timeout" "for &[local_scan()]& function"
14282 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "timeout"
14283 This timeout applies to the &[local_scan()]& function (see chapter
14284 &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&). Zero means &"no timeout"&. If the timeout is exceeded,
14285 the incoming message is rejected with a temporary error if it is an SMTP
14286 message. For a non-SMTP message, the message is dropped and Exim ends with a
14287 non-zero code. The incident is logged on the main and reject logs.
14291 .option local_sender_retain main boolean false
14292 .cindex "&'Sender:'& header line" "retaining from local submission"
14293 When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP/IP connection) by
14294 an untrusted user, Exim removes any existing &'Sender:'& header line. If you
14295 do not want this to happen, you must set &%local_sender_retain%&, and you must
14296 also set &%local_from_check%& to be false (Exim will complain if you do not).
14297 See also the ACL modifier &`control = suppress_local_fixups`&. Section
14298 &<<SECTthesenhea>>& has more details about &'Sender:'& processing.
14303 .option localhost_number main string&!! unset
14304 .cindex "host" "locally unique number for"
14305 .cindex "message ids" "with multiple hosts"
14306 .vindex "&$localhost_number$&"
14307 Exim's message ids are normally unique only within the local host. If
14308 uniqueness among a set of hosts is required, each host must set a different
14309 value for the &%localhost_number%& option. The string is expanded immediately
14310 after reading the configuration file (so that a number can be computed from the
14311 host name, for example) and the result of the expansion must be a number in the
14312 range 0&--16 (or 0&--10 on operating systems with case-insensitive file
14313 systems). This is available in subsequent string expansions via the variable
14314 &$localhost_number$&. When &%localhost_number is set%&, the final two
14315 characters of the message id, instead of just being a fractional part of the
14316 time, are computed from the time and the local host number as described in
14317 section &<<SECTmessiden>>&.
14321 .option log_file_path main "string list&!!" "set at compile time"
14322 .cindex "log" "file path for"
14323 This option sets the path which is used to determine the names of Exim's log
14324 files, or indicates that logging is to be to syslog, or both. It is expanded
14325 when Exim is entered, so it can, for example, contain a reference to the host
14326 name. If no specific path is set for the log files at compile or run time, they
14327 are written in a sub-directory called &_log_& in Exim's spool directory.
14328 Chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& contains further details about Exim's logging, and
14329 section &<<SECTwhelogwri>>& describes how the contents of &%log_file_path%& are
14330 used. If this string is fixed at your installation (contains no expansion
14331 variables) it is recommended that you do not set this option in the
14332 configuration file, but instead supply the path using LOG_FILE_PATH in
14333 &_Local/Makefile_& so that it is available to Exim for logging errors detected
14334 early on &-- in particular, failure to read the configuration file.
14337 .option log_selector main string unset
14338 .cindex "log" "selectors"
14339 This option can be used to reduce or increase the number of things that Exim
14340 writes to its log files. Its argument is made up of names preceded by plus or
14341 minus characters. For example:
14343 log_selector = +arguments -retry_defer
14345 A list of possible names and what they control is given in the chapter on
14346 logging, in section &<<SECTlogselector>>&.
14349 .option log_timezone main boolean false
14350 .cindex "log" "timezone for entries"
14351 .vindex "&$tod_log$&"
14352 .vindex "&$tod_zone$&"
14353 By default, the timestamps on log lines are in local time without the
14354 timezone. This means that if your timezone changes twice a year, the timestamps
14355 in log lines are ambiguous for an hour when the clocks go back. One way of
14356 avoiding this problem is to set the timezone to UTC. An alternative is to set
14357 &%log_timezone%& true. This turns on the addition of the timezone offset to
14358 timestamps in log lines. Turning on this option can add quite a lot to the size
14359 of log files because each line is extended by 6 characters. Note that the
14360 &$tod_log$& variable contains the log timestamp without the zone, but there is
14361 another variable called &$tod_zone$& that contains just the timezone offset.
14364 .option lookup_open_max main integer 25
14365 .cindex "too many open files"
14366 .cindex "open files, too many"
14367 .cindex "file" "too many open"
14368 .cindex "lookup" "maximum open files"
14369 .cindex "limit" "open files for lookups"
14370 This option limits the number of simultaneously open files for single-key
14371 lookups that use regular files (that is, &(lsearch)&, &(dbm)&, and &(cdb)&).
14372 Exim normally keeps these files open during routing, because often the same
14373 file is required several times. If the limit is reached, Exim closes the least
14374 recently used file. Note that if you are using the &'ndbm'& library, it
14375 actually opens two files for each logical DBM database, though it still counts
14376 as one for the purposes of &%lookup_open_max%&. If you are getting &"too many
14377 open files"& errors with NDBM, you need to reduce the value of
14378 &%lookup_open_max%&.
14381 .option max_username_length main integer 0
14382 .cindex "length of login name"
14383 .cindex "user name" "maximum length"
14384 .cindex "limit" "user name length"
14385 Some operating systems are broken in that they truncate long arguments to
14386 &[getpwnam()]& to eight characters, instead of returning &"no such user"&. If
14387 this option is set greater than zero, any attempt to call &[getpwnam()]& with
14388 an argument that is longer behaves as if &[getpwnam()]& failed.
14391 .option message_body_newlines main bool false
14392 .cindex "message body" "newlines in variables"
14393 .cindex "newline" "in message body variables"
14394 .vindex "&$message_body$&"
14395 .vindex "&$message_body_end$&"
14396 By default, newlines in the message body are replaced by spaces when setting
14397 the &$message_body$& and &$message_body_end$& expansion variables. If this
14398 option is set true, this no longer happens.
14401 .option message_body_visible main integer 500
14402 .cindex "body of message" "visible size"
14403 .cindex "message body" "visible size"
14404 .vindex "&$message_body$&"
14405 .vindex "&$message_body_end$&"
14406 This option specifies how much of a message's body is to be included in the
14407 &$message_body$& and &$message_body_end$& expansion variables.
14410 .option message_id_header_domain main string&!! unset
14411 .cindex "&'Message-ID:'& header line"
14412 If this option is set, the string is expanded and used as the right hand side
14413 (domain) of the &'Message-ID:'& header that Exim creates if a
14414 locally-originated incoming message does not have one. &"Locally-originated"&
14415 means &"not received over TCP/IP."&
14416 Otherwise, the primary host name is used.
14417 Only letters, digits, dot and hyphen are accepted; any other characters are
14418 replaced by hyphens. If the expansion is forced to fail, or if the result is an
14419 empty string, the option is ignored.
14422 .option message_id_header_text main string&!! unset
14423 If this variable is set, the string is expanded and used to augment the text of
14424 the &'Message-id:'& header that Exim creates if a locally-originated incoming
14425 message does not have one. The text of this header is required by RFC 2822 to
14426 take the form of an address. By default, Exim uses its internal message id as
14427 the local part, and the primary host name as the domain. If this option is set,
14428 it is expanded, and provided the expansion is not forced to fail, and does not
14429 yield an empty string, the result is inserted into the header immediately
14430 before the @, separated from the internal message id by a dot. Any characters
14431 that are illegal in an address are automatically converted into hyphens. This
14432 means that variables such as &$tod_log$& can be used, because the spaces and
14433 colons will become hyphens.
14436 .option message_logs main boolean true
14437 .cindex "message logs" "disabling"
14438 .cindex "log" "message log; disabling"
14439 If this option is turned off, per-message log files are not created in the
14440 &_msglog_& spool sub-directory. This reduces the amount of disk I/O required by
14441 Exim, by reducing the number of files involved in handling a message from a
14442 minimum of four (header spool file, body spool file, delivery journal, and
14443 per-message log) to three. The other major I/O activity is Exim's main log,
14444 which is not affected by this option.
14447 .option message_size_limit main string&!! 50M
14448 .cindex "message" "size limit"
14449 .cindex "limit" "message size"
14450 .cindex "size" "of message, limit"
14451 This option limits the maximum size of message that Exim will process. The
14452 value is expanded for each incoming connection so, for example, it can be made
14453 to depend on the IP address of the remote host for messages arriving via
14454 TCP/IP. After expansion, the value must be a sequence of decimal digits,
14455 optionally followed by K or M.
14457 &*Note*&: This limit cannot be made to depend on a message's sender or any
14458 other properties of an individual message, because it has to be advertised in
14459 the server's response to EHLO. String expansion failure causes a temporary
14460 error. A value of zero means no limit, but its use is not recommended. See also
14461 &%bounce_return_size_limit%&.
14463 Incoming SMTP messages are failed with a 552 error if the limit is
14464 exceeded; locally-generated messages either get a stderr message or a delivery
14465 failure message to the sender, depending on the &%-oe%& setting. Rejection of
14466 an oversized message is logged in both the main and the reject logs. See also
14467 the generic transport option &%message_size_limit%&, which limits the size of
14468 message that an individual transport can process.
14470 If you use a virus-scanner and set this option to to a value larger than the
14471 maximum size that your virus-scanner is configured to support, you may get
14472 failures triggered by large mails. The right size to configure for the
14473 virus-scanner depends upon what data is passed and the options in use but it's
14474 probably safest to just set it to a little larger than this value. Eg, with a
14475 default Exim message size of 50M and a default ClamAV StreamMaxLength of 10M,
14476 some problems may result.
14478 A value of 0 will disable size limit checking; Exim will still advertise the
14479 SIZE extension in an EHLO response, but without a limit, so as to permit
14480 SMTP clients to still indicate the message size along with the MAIL verb.
14483 .option move_frozen_messages main boolean false
14484 .cindex "frozen messages" "moving"
14485 This option, which is available only if Exim has been built with the setting
14487 SUPPORT_MOVE_FROZEN_MESSAGES=yes
14489 in &_Local/Makefile_&, causes frozen messages and their message logs to be
14490 moved from the &_input_& and &_msglog_& directories on the spool to &_Finput_&
14491 and &_Fmsglog_&, respectively. There is currently no support in Exim or the
14492 standard utilities for handling such moved messages, and they do not show up in
14493 lists generated by &%-bp%& or by the Exim monitor.
14496 .option mua_wrapper main boolean false
14497 Setting this option true causes Exim to run in a very restrictive mode in which
14498 it passes messages synchronously to a smart host. Chapter &<<CHAPnonqueueing>>&
14499 contains a full description of this facility.
14503 .option mysql_servers main "string list" unset
14504 .cindex "MySQL" "server list"
14505 This option provides a list of MySQL servers and associated connection data, to
14506 be used in conjunction with &(mysql)& lookups (see section &<<SECID72>>&). The
14507 option is available only if Exim has been built with MySQL support.
14510 .option never_users main "string list&!!" unset
14511 This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. Local
14512 message deliveries are normally run in processes that are setuid to the
14513 recipient, and remote deliveries are normally run under Exim's own uid and gid.
14514 It is usually desirable to prevent any deliveries from running as root, as a
14517 When Exim is built, an option called FIXED_NEVER_USERS can be set to a
14518 list of users that must not be used for local deliveries. This list is fixed in
14519 the binary and cannot be overridden by the configuration file. By default, it
14520 contains just the single user name &"root"&. The &%never_users%& runtime option
14521 can be used to add more users to the fixed list.
14523 If a message is to be delivered as one of the users on the fixed list or the
14524 &%never_users%& list, an error occurs, and delivery is deferred. A common
14527 never_users = root:daemon:bin
14529 Including root is redundant if it is also on the fixed list, but it does no
14530 harm. This option overrides the &%pipe_as_creator%& option of the &(pipe)&
14534 .option openssl_options main "string list" "+no_sslv2"
14535 .cindex "OpenSSL "compatibility options"
14536 This option allows an administrator to adjust the SSL options applied
14537 by OpenSSL to connections. It is given as a space-separated list of items,
14538 each one to be +added or -subtracted from the current value.
14540 This option is only available if Exim is built against OpenSSL. The values
14541 available for this option vary according to the age of your OpenSSL install.
14542 The &"all"& value controls a subset of flags which are available, typically
14543 the bug workaround options. The &'SSL_CTX_set_options'& man page will
14544 list the values known on your system and Exim should support all the
14545 &"bug workaround"& options and many of the &"modifying"& options. The Exim
14546 names lose the leading &"SSL_OP_"& and are lower-cased.
14548 Note that adjusting the options can have severe impact upon the security of
14549 SSL as used by Exim. It is possible to disable safety checks and shoot
14550 yourself in the foot in various unpleasant ways. This option should not be
14551 adjusted lightly. An unrecognised item will be detected at startup, by
14552 invoking Exim with the &%-bV%& flag.
14554 Historical note: prior to release 4.80, Exim defaulted this value to
14555 "+dont_insert_empty_fragments", which may still be needed for compatibility
14556 with some clients, but which lowers security by increasing exposure to
14557 some now infamous attacks.
14561 # Make both old MS and old Eudora happy:
14562 openssl_options = -all +microsoft_big_sslv3_buffer \
14563 +dont_insert_empty_fragments
14566 Possible options may include:
14570 &`allow_unsafe_legacy_renegotiation`&
14572 &`cipher_server_preference`&
14574 &`dont_insert_empty_fragments`&
14578 &`legacy_server_connect`&
14580 &`microsoft_big_sslv3_buffer`&
14582 &`microsoft_sess_id_bug`&
14584 &`msie_sslv2_rsa_padding`&
14586 &`netscape_challenge_bug`&
14588 &`netscape_reuse_cipher_change_bug`&
14592 &`no_session_resumption_on_renegotiation`&
14608 &`single_ecdh_use`&
14610 &`ssleay_080_client_dh_bug`&
14612 &`sslref2_reuse_cert_type_bug`&
14614 &`tls_block_padding_bug`&
14618 &`tls_rollback_bug`&
14622 .option oracle_servers main "string list" unset
14623 .cindex "Oracle" "server list"
14624 This option provides a list of Oracle servers and associated connection data,
14625 to be used in conjunction with &(oracle)& lookups (see section &<<SECID72>>&).
14626 The option is available only if Exim has been built with Oracle support.
14629 .option percent_hack_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
14630 .cindex "&""percent hack""&"
14631 .cindex "source routing" "in email address"
14632 .cindex "address" "source-routed"
14633 The &"percent hack"& is the convention whereby a local part containing a
14634 percent sign is re-interpreted as a new email address, with the percent
14635 replaced by @. This is sometimes called &"source routing"&, though that term is
14636 also applied to RFC 2822 addresses that begin with an @ character. If this
14637 option is set, Exim implements the percent facility for those domains listed,
14638 but no others. This happens before an incoming SMTP address is tested against
14641 &*Warning*&: The &"percent hack"& has often been abused by people who are
14642 trying to get round relaying restrictions. For this reason, it is best avoided
14643 if at all possible. Unfortunately, a number of less security-conscious MTAs
14644 implement it unconditionally. If you are running Exim on a gateway host, and
14645 routing mail through to internal MTAs without processing the local parts, it is
14646 a good idea to reject recipient addresses with percent characters in their
14647 local parts. Exim's default configuration does this.
14650 .option perl_at_start main boolean false
14651 This option is available only when Exim is built with an embedded Perl
14652 interpreter. See chapter &<<CHAPperl>>& for details of its use.
14655 .option perl_startup main string unset
14656 This option is available only when Exim is built with an embedded Perl
14657 interpreter. See chapter &<<CHAPperl>>& for details of its use.
14660 .option pgsql_servers main "string list" unset
14661 .cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type" "server list"
14662 This option provides a list of PostgreSQL servers and associated connection
14663 data, to be used in conjunction with &(pgsql)& lookups (see section
14664 &<<SECID72>>&). The option is available only if Exim has been built with
14665 PostgreSQL support.
14668 .option pid_file_path main string&!! "set at compile time"
14669 .cindex "daemon" "pid file path"
14670 .cindex "pid file, path for"
14671 This option sets the name of the file to which the Exim daemon writes its
14672 process id. The string is expanded, so it can contain, for example, references
14675 pid_file_path = /var/log/$primary_hostname/exim.pid
14677 If no path is set, the pid is written to the file &_exim-daemon.pid_& in Exim's
14679 The value set by the option can be overridden by the &%-oP%& command line
14680 option. A pid file is not written if a &"non-standard"& daemon is run by means
14681 of the &%-oX%& option, unless a path is explicitly supplied by &%-oP%&.
14684 .option pipelining_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
14685 .cindex "PIPELINING" "suppressing advertising"
14686 This option can be used to suppress the advertisement of the SMTP
14687 PIPELINING extension to specific hosts. See also the &*no_pipelining*&
14688 control in section &<<SECTcontrols>>&. When PIPELINING is not advertised and
14689 &%smtp_enforce_sync%& is true, an Exim server enforces strict synchronization
14690 for each SMTP command and response. When PIPELINING is advertised, Exim assumes
14691 that clients will use it; &"out of order"& commands that are &"expected"& do
14692 not count as protocol errors (see &%smtp_max_synprot_errors%&).
14695 .option preserve_message_logs main boolean false
14696 .cindex "message logs" "preserving"
14697 If this option is set, message log files are not deleted when messages are
14698 completed. Instead, they are moved to a sub-directory of the spool directory
14699 called &_msglog.OLD_&, where they remain available for statistical or debugging
14700 purposes. This is a dangerous option to set on systems with any appreciable
14701 volume of mail. Use with care!
14704 .option primary_hostname main string "see below"
14705 .cindex "name" "of local host"
14706 .cindex "host" "name of local"
14707 .cindex "local host" "name of"
14708 .vindex "&$primary_hostname$&"
14709 This specifies the name of the current host. It is used in the default EHLO or
14710 HELO command for outgoing SMTP messages (changeable via the &%helo_data%&
14711 option in the &(smtp)& transport), and as the default for &%qualify_domain%&.
14712 The value is also used by default in some SMTP response messages from an Exim
14713 server. This can be changed dynamically by setting &%smtp_active_hostname%&.
14715 If &%primary_hostname%& is not set, Exim calls &[uname()]& to find the host
14716 name. If this fails, Exim panics and dies. If the name returned by &[uname()]&
14717 contains only one component, Exim passes it to &[gethostbyname()]& (or
14718 &[getipnodebyname()]& when available) in order to obtain the fully qualified
14719 version. The variable &$primary_hostname$& contains the host name, whether set
14720 explicitly by this option, or defaulted.
14723 .option print_topbitchars main boolean false
14724 .cindex "printing characters"
14725 .cindex "8-bit characters"
14726 By default, Exim considers only those characters whose codes lie in the range
14727 32&--126 to be printing characters. In a number of circumstances (for example,
14728 when writing log entries) non-printing characters are converted into escape
14729 sequences, primarily to avoid messing up the layout. If &%print_topbitchars%&
14730 is set, code values of 128 and above are also considered to be printing
14733 This option also affects the header syntax checks performed by the
14734 &(autoreply)& transport, and whether Exim uses RFC 2047 encoding of
14735 the user's full name when constructing From: and Sender: addresses (as
14736 described in section &<<SECTconstr>>&). Setting this option can cause
14737 Exim to generate eight bit message headers that do not conform to the
14741 .option process_log_path main string unset
14742 .cindex "process log path"
14743 .cindex "log" "process log"
14744 .cindex "&'exiwhat'&"
14745 This option sets the name of the file to which an Exim process writes its
14746 &"process log"& when sent a USR1 signal. This is used by the &'exiwhat'&
14747 utility script. If this option is unset, the file called &_exim-process.info_&
14748 in Exim's spool directory is used. The ability to specify the name explicitly
14749 can be useful in environments where two different Exims are running, using
14750 different spool directories.
14753 .option prod_requires_admin main boolean true
14757 The &%-M%&, &%-R%&, and &%-q%& command-line options require the caller to be an
14758 admin user unless &%prod_requires_admin%& is set false. See also
14759 &%queue_list_requires_admin%&.
14762 .option qualify_domain main string "see below"
14763 .cindex "domain" "for qualifying addresses"
14764 .cindex "address" "qualification"
14765 This option specifies the domain name that is added to any envelope sender
14766 addresses that do not have a domain qualification. It also applies to
14767 recipient addresses if &%qualify_recipient%& is not set. Unqualified addresses
14768 are accepted by default only for locally-generated messages. Qualification is
14769 also applied to addresses in header lines such as &'From:'& and &'To:'& for
14770 locally-generated messages, unless the &%-bnq%& command line option is used.
14772 Messages from external sources must always contain fully qualified addresses,
14773 unless the sending host matches &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& or
14774 &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%& (as appropriate), in which case incoming
14775 addresses are qualified with &%qualify_domain%& or &%qualify_recipient%& as
14776 necessary. Internally, Exim always works with fully qualified envelope
14777 addresses. If &%qualify_domain%& is not set, it defaults to the
14778 &%primary_hostname%& value.
14781 .option qualify_recipient main string "see below"
14782 This option allows you to specify a different domain for qualifying recipient
14783 addresses to the one that is used for senders. See &%qualify_domain%& above.
14787 .option queue_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
14788 .cindex "domain" "specifying non-immediate delivery"
14789 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
14790 .cindex "message" "queueing certain domains"
14791 This option lists domains for which immediate delivery is not required.
14792 A delivery process is started whenever a message is received, but only those
14793 domains that do not match are processed. All other deliveries wait until the
14794 next queue run. See also &%hold_domains%& and &%queue_smtp_domains%&.
14797 .option queue_list_requires_admin main boolean true
14799 The &%-bp%& command-line option, which lists the messages that are on the
14800 queue, requires the caller to be an admin user unless
14801 &%queue_list_requires_admin%& is set false. See also &%prod_requires_admin%&.
14804 .option queue_only main boolean false
14805 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
14806 .cindex "message" "queueing unconditionally"
14807 If &%queue_only%& is set, a delivery process is not automatically started
14808 whenever a message is received. Instead, the message waits on the queue for the
14809 next queue run. Even if &%queue_only%& is false, incoming messages may not get
14810 delivered immediately when certain conditions (such as heavy load) occur.
14812 The &%-odq%& command line has the same effect as &%queue_only%&. The &%-odb%&
14813 and &%-odi%& command line options override &%queue_only%& unless
14814 &%queue_only_override%& is set false. See also &%queue_only_file%&,
14815 &%queue_only_load%&, and &%smtp_accept_queue%&.
14818 .option queue_only_file main string unset
14819 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
14820 .cindex "message" "queueing by file existence"
14821 This option can be set to a colon-separated list of absolute path names, each
14822 one optionally preceded by &"smtp"&. When Exim is receiving a message,
14823 it tests for the existence of each listed path using a call to &[stat()]&. For
14824 each path that exists, the corresponding queueing option is set.
14825 For paths with no prefix, &%queue_only%& is set; for paths prefixed by
14826 &"smtp"&, &%queue_smtp_domains%& is set to match all domains. So, for example,
14828 queue_only_file = smtp/some/file
14830 causes Exim to behave as if &%queue_smtp_domains%& were set to &"*"& whenever
14831 &_/some/file_& exists.
14834 .option queue_only_load main fixed-point unset
14835 .cindex "load average"
14836 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
14837 .cindex "message" "queueing by load"
14838 If the system load average is higher than this value, incoming messages from
14839 all sources are queued, and no automatic deliveries are started. If this
14840 happens during local or remote SMTP input, all subsequent messages received on
14841 the same SMTP connection are queued by default, whatever happens to the load in
14842 the meantime, but this can be changed by setting &%queue_only_load_latch%&
14845 Deliveries will subsequently be performed by queue runner processes. This
14846 option has no effect on ancient operating systems on which Exim cannot
14847 determine the load average. See also &%deliver_queue_load_max%& and
14848 &%smtp_load_reserve%&.
14851 .option queue_only_load_latch main boolean true
14852 .cindex "load average" "re-evaluating per message"
14853 When this option is true (the default), once one message has been queued
14854 because the load average is higher than the value set by &%queue_only_load%&,
14855 all subsequent messages received on the same SMTP connection are also queued.
14856 This is a deliberate choice; even though the load average may fall below the
14857 threshold, it doesn't seem right to deliver later messages on the same
14858 connection when not delivering earlier ones. However, there are special
14859 circumstances such as very long-lived connections from scanning appliances
14860 where this is not the best strategy. In such cases, &%queue_only_load_latch%&
14861 should be set false. This causes the value of the load average to be
14862 re-evaluated for each message.
14865 .option queue_only_override main boolean true
14866 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
14867 When this option is true, the &%-od%&&'x'& command line options override the
14868 setting of &%queue_only%& or &%queue_only_file%& in the configuration file. If
14869 &%queue_only_override%& is set false, the &%-od%&&'x'& options cannot be used
14870 to override; they are accepted, but ignored.
14873 .option queue_run_in_order main boolean false
14874 .cindex "queue runner" "processing messages in order"
14875 If this option is set, queue runs happen in order of message arrival instead of
14876 in an arbitrary order. For this to happen, a complete list of the entire queue
14877 must be set up before the deliveries start. When the queue is all held in a
14878 single directory (the default), a single list is created for both the ordered
14879 and the non-ordered cases. However, if &%split_spool_directory%& is set, a
14880 single list is not created when &%queue_run_in_order%& is false. In this case,
14881 the sub-directories are processed one at a time (in a random order), and this
14882 avoids setting up one huge list for the whole queue. Thus, setting
14883 &%queue_run_in_order%& with &%split_spool_directory%& may degrade performance
14884 when the queue is large, because of the extra work in setting up the single,
14885 large list. In most situations, &%queue_run_in_order%& should not be set.
14889 .option queue_run_max main integer 5
14890 .cindex "queue runner" "maximum number of"
14891 This controls the maximum number of queue runner processes that an Exim daemon
14892 can run simultaneously. This does not mean that it starts them all at once,
14893 but rather that if the maximum number are still running when the time comes to
14894 start another one, it refrains from starting another one. This can happen with
14895 very large queues and/or very sluggish deliveries. This option does not,
14896 however, interlock with other processes, so additional queue runners can be
14897 started by other means, or by killing and restarting the daemon.
14899 Setting this option to zero does not suppress queue runs; rather, it disables
14900 the limit, allowing any number of simultaneous queue runner processes to be
14901 run. If you do not want queue runs to occur, omit the &%-q%&&'xx'& setting on
14902 the daemon's command line.
14904 .option queue_smtp_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
14905 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
14906 .cindex "message" "queueing remote deliveries"
14907 When this option is set, a delivery process is started whenever a message is
14908 received, routing is performed, and local deliveries take place.
14909 However, if any SMTP deliveries are required for domains that match
14910 &%queue_smtp_domains%&, they are not immediately delivered, but instead the
14911 message waits on the queue for the next queue run. Since routing of the message
14912 has taken place, Exim knows to which remote hosts it must be delivered, and so
14913 when the queue run happens, multiple messages for the same host are delivered
14914 over a single SMTP connection. The &%-odqs%& command line option causes all
14915 SMTP deliveries to be queued in this way, and is equivalent to setting
14916 &%queue_smtp_domains%& to &"*"&. See also &%hold_domains%& and
14920 .option receive_timeout main time 0s
14921 .cindex "timeout" "for non-SMTP input"
14922 This option sets the timeout for accepting a non-SMTP message, that is, the
14923 maximum time that Exim waits when reading a message on the standard input. If
14924 the value is zero, it will wait for ever. This setting is overridden by the
14925 &%-or%& command line option. The timeout for incoming SMTP messages is
14926 controlled by &%smtp_receive_timeout%&.
14928 .option received_header_text main string&!! "see below"
14929 .cindex "customizing" "&'Received:'& header"
14930 .cindex "&'Received:'& header line" "customizing"
14931 This string defines the contents of the &'Received:'& message header that is
14932 added to each message, except for the timestamp, which is automatically added
14933 on at the end (preceded by a semicolon). The string is expanded each time it is
14934 used. If the expansion yields an empty string, no &'Received:'& header line is
14935 added to the message. Otherwise, the string should start with the text
14936 &"Received:"& and conform to the RFC 2822 specification for &'Received:'&
14937 header lines. The default setting is:
14940 received_header_text = Received: \
14941 ${if def:sender_rcvhost {from $sender_rcvhost\n\t}\
14942 {${if def:sender_ident \
14943 {from ${quote_local_part:$sender_ident} }}\
14944 ${if def:sender_helo_name {(helo=$sender_helo_name)\n\t}}}}\
14945 by $primary_hostname \
14946 ${if def:received_protocol {with $received_protocol}} \
14947 ${if def:tls_in_cipher {($tls_in_cipher)\n\t}}\
14948 (Exim $version_number)\n\t\
14949 ${if def:sender_address \
14950 {(envelope-from <$sender_address>)\n\t}}\
14951 id $message_exim_id\
14952 ${if def:received_for {\n\tfor $received_for}}
14955 The reference to the TLS cipher is omitted when Exim is built without TLS
14956 support. The use of conditional expansions ensures that this works for both
14957 locally generated messages and messages received from remote hosts, giving
14958 header lines such as the following:
14960 Received: from scrooge.carol.example ([192.168.12.25] ident=root)
14961 by marley.carol.example with esmtp (Exim 4.00)
14962 (envelope-from <bob@carol.example>)
14963 id 16IOWa-00019l-00
14964 for chas@dickens.example; Tue, 25 Dec 2001 14:43:44 +0000
14965 Received: by scrooge.carol.example with local (Exim 4.00)
14966 id 16IOWW-000083-00; Tue, 25 Dec 2001 14:43:41 +0000
14968 Until the body of the message has been received, the timestamp is the time when
14969 the message started to be received. Once the body has arrived, and all policy
14970 checks have taken place, the timestamp is updated to the time at which the
14971 message was accepted.
14974 .option received_headers_max main integer 30
14975 .cindex "loop" "prevention"
14976 .cindex "mail loop prevention"
14977 .cindex "&'Received:'& header line" "counting"
14978 When a message is to be delivered, the number of &'Received:'& headers is
14979 counted, and if it is greater than this parameter, a mail loop is assumed to
14980 have occurred, the delivery is abandoned, and an error message is generated.
14981 This applies to both local and remote deliveries.
14984 .option recipient_unqualified_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
14985 .cindex "unqualified addresses"
14986 .cindex "host" "unqualified addresses from"
14987 This option lists those hosts from which Exim is prepared to accept unqualified
14988 recipient addresses in message envelopes. The addresses are made fully
14989 qualified by the addition of the &%qualify_recipient%& value. This option also
14990 affects message header lines. Exim does not reject unqualified recipient
14991 addresses in headers, but it qualifies them only if the message came from a
14992 host that matches &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&,
14993 or if the message was submitted locally (not using TCP/IP), and the &%-bnq%&
14994 option was not set.
14997 .option recipients_max main integer 0
14998 .cindex "limit" "number of recipients"
14999 .cindex "recipient" "maximum number"
15000 If this option is set greater than zero, it specifies the maximum number of
15001 original recipients for any message. Additional recipients that are generated
15002 by aliasing or forwarding do not count. SMTP messages get a 452 response for
15003 all recipients over the limit; earlier recipients are delivered as normal.
15004 Non-SMTP messages with too many recipients are failed, and no deliveries are
15007 .cindex "RCPT" "maximum number of incoming"
15008 &*Note*&: The RFCs specify that an SMTP server should accept at least 100
15009 RCPT commands in a single message.
15012 .option recipients_max_reject main boolean false
15013 If this option is set true, Exim rejects SMTP messages containing too many
15014 recipients by giving 552 errors to the surplus RCPT commands, and a 554
15015 error to the eventual DATA command. Otherwise (the default) it gives a 452
15016 error to the surplus RCPT commands and accepts the message on behalf of the
15017 initial set of recipients. The remote server should then re-send the message
15018 for the remaining recipients at a later time.
15021 .option remote_max_parallel main integer 2
15022 .cindex "delivery" "parallelism for remote"
15023 This option controls parallel delivery of one message to a number of remote
15024 hosts. If the value is less than 2, parallel delivery is disabled, and Exim
15025 does all the remote deliveries for a message one by one. Otherwise, if a single
15026 message has to be delivered to more than one remote host, or if several copies
15027 have to be sent to the same remote host, up to &%remote_max_parallel%&
15028 deliveries are done simultaneously. If more than &%remote_max_parallel%&
15029 deliveries are required, the maximum number of processes are started, and as
15030 each one finishes, another is begun. The order of starting processes is the
15031 same as if sequential delivery were being done, and can be controlled by the
15032 &%remote_sort_domains%& option. If parallel delivery takes place while running
15033 with debugging turned on, the debugging output from each delivery process is
15034 tagged with its process id.
15036 This option controls only the maximum number of parallel deliveries for one
15037 message in one Exim delivery process. Because Exim has no central queue
15038 manager, there is no way of controlling the total number of simultaneous
15039 deliveries if the configuration allows a delivery attempt as soon as a message
15042 .cindex "number of deliveries"
15043 .cindex "delivery" "maximum number of"
15044 If you want to control the total number of deliveries on the system, you
15045 need to set the &%queue_only%& option. This ensures that all incoming messages
15046 are added to the queue without starting a delivery process. Then set up an Exim
15047 daemon to start queue runner processes at appropriate intervals (probably
15048 fairly often, for example, every minute), and limit the total number of queue
15049 runners by setting the &%queue_run_max%& parameter. Because each queue runner
15050 delivers only one message at a time, the maximum number of deliveries that can
15051 then take place at once is &%queue_run_max%& multiplied by
15052 &%remote_max_parallel%&.
15054 If it is purely remote deliveries you want to control, use
15055 &%queue_smtp_domains%& instead of &%queue_only%&. This has the added benefit of
15056 doing the SMTP routing before queueing, so that several messages for the same
15057 host will eventually get delivered down the same connection.
15060 .option remote_sort_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
15061 .cindex "sorting remote deliveries"
15062 .cindex "delivery" "sorting remote"
15063 When there are a number of remote deliveries for a message, they are sorted by
15064 domain into the order given by this list. For example,
15066 remote_sort_domains = *.cam.ac.uk:*.uk
15068 would attempt to deliver to all addresses in the &'cam.ac.uk'& domain first,
15069 then to those in the &%uk%& domain, then to any others.
15072 .option retry_data_expire main time 7d
15073 .cindex "hints database" "data expiry"
15074 This option sets a &"use before"& time on retry information in Exim's hints
15075 database. Any older retry data is ignored. This means that, for example, once a
15076 host has not been tried for 7 days, Exim behaves as if it has no knowledge of
15080 .option retry_interval_max main time 24h
15081 .cindex "retry" "limit on interval"
15082 .cindex "limit" "on retry interval"
15083 Chapter &<<CHAPretry>>& describes Exim's mechanisms for controlling the
15084 intervals between delivery attempts for messages that cannot be delivered
15085 straight away. This option sets an overall limit to the length of time between
15086 retries. It cannot be set greater than 24 hours; any attempt to do so forces
15090 .option return_path_remove main boolean true
15091 .cindex "&'Return-path:'& header line" "removing"
15092 RFC 2821, section 4.4, states that an SMTP server must insert a
15093 &'Return-path:'& header line into a message when it makes a &"final delivery"&.
15094 The &'Return-path:'& header preserves the sender address as received in the
15095 MAIL command. This description implies that this header should not be present
15096 in an incoming message. If &%return_path_remove%& is true, any existing
15097 &'Return-path:'& headers are removed from messages at the time they are
15098 received. Exim's transports have options for adding &'Return-path:'& headers at
15099 the time of delivery. They are normally used only for final local deliveries.
15102 .option return_size_limit main integer 100K
15103 This option is an obsolete synonym for &%bounce_return_size_limit%&.
15106 .option rfc1413_hosts main "host list&!!" *
15108 .cindex "host" "for RFC 1413 calls"
15109 RFC 1413 identification calls are made to any client host which matches an item
15112 .option rfc1413_query_timeout main time 5s
15113 .cindex "RFC 1413" "query timeout"
15114 .cindex "timeout" "for RFC 1413 call"
15115 This sets the timeout on RFC 1413 identification calls. If it is set to zero,
15116 no RFC 1413 calls are ever made.
15119 .option sender_unqualified_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
15120 .cindex "unqualified addresses"
15121 .cindex "host" "unqualified addresses from"
15122 This option lists those hosts from which Exim is prepared to accept unqualified
15123 sender addresses. The addresses are made fully qualified by the addition of
15124 &%qualify_domain%&. This option also affects message header lines. Exim does
15125 not reject unqualified addresses in headers that contain sender addresses, but
15126 it qualifies them only if the message came from a host that matches
15127 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%&, or if the message was submitted locally (not
15128 using TCP/IP), and the &%-bnq%& option was not set.
15131 .option smtp_accept_keepalive main boolean true
15132 .cindex "keepalive" "on incoming connection"
15133 This option controls the setting of the SO_KEEPALIVE option on incoming
15134 TCP/IP socket connections. When set, it causes the kernel to probe idle
15135 connections periodically, by sending packets with &"old"& sequence numbers. The
15136 other end of the connection should send an acknowledgment if the connection is
15137 still okay or a reset if the connection has been aborted. The reason for doing
15138 this is that it has the beneficial effect of freeing up certain types of
15139 connection that can get stuck when the remote host is disconnected without
15140 tidying up the TCP/IP call properly. The keepalive mechanism takes several
15141 hours to detect unreachable hosts.
15145 .option smtp_accept_max main integer 20
15146 .cindex "limit" "incoming SMTP connections"
15147 .cindex "SMTP" "incoming connection count"
15149 This option specifies the maximum number of simultaneous incoming SMTP calls
15150 that Exim will accept. It applies only to the listening daemon; there is no
15151 control (in Exim) when incoming SMTP is being handled by &'inetd'&. If the
15152 value is set to zero, no limit is applied. However, it is required to be
15153 non-zero if either &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& or &%smtp_accept_queue%& is
15154 set. See also &%smtp_accept_reserve%& and &%smtp_load_reserve%&.
15156 A new SMTP connection is immediately rejected if the &%smtp_accept_max%& limit
15157 has been reached. If not, Exim first checks &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%&. If
15158 that limit has not been reached for the client host, &%smtp_accept_reserve%&
15159 and &%smtp_load_reserve%& are then checked before accepting the connection.
15162 .option smtp_accept_max_nonmail main integer 10
15163 .cindex "limit" "non-mail SMTP commands"
15164 .cindex "SMTP" "limiting non-mail commands"
15165 Exim counts the number of &"non-mail"& commands in an SMTP session, and drops
15166 the connection if there are too many. This option defines &"too many"&. The
15167 check catches some denial-of-service attacks, repeated failing AUTHs, or a mad
15168 client looping sending EHLO, for example. The check is applied only if the
15169 client host matches &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%&.
15171 When a new message is expected, one occurrence of RSET is not counted. This
15172 allows a client to send one RSET between messages (this is not necessary,
15173 but some clients do it). Exim also allows one uncounted occurrence of HELO
15174 or EHLO, and one occurrence of STARTTLS between messages. After
15175 starting up a TLS session, another EHLO is expected, and so it too is not
15176 counted. The first occurrence of AUTH in a connection, or immediately
15177 following STARTTLS is not counted. Otherwise, all commands other than
15178 MAIL, RCPT, DATA, and QUIT are counted.
15181 .option smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts main "host list&!!" *
15182 You can control which hosts are subject to the &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%&
15183 check by setting this option. The default value makes it apply to all hosts. By
15184 changing the value, you can exclude any badly-behaved hosts that you have to
15188 . Allow this long option name to split; give it unsplit as a fifth argument
15189 . for the automatic .oindex that is generated by .option.
15191 .option "smtp_accept_max_per_ &~&~connection" main integer 1000 &&&
15192 smtp_accept_max_per_connection
15193 .cindex "SMTP" "limiting incoming message count"
15194 .cindex "limit" "messages per SMTP connection"
15195 The value of this option limits the number of MAIL commands that Exim is
15196 prepared to accept over a single SMTP connection, whether or not each command
15197 results in the transfer of a message. After the limit is reached, a 421
15198 response is given to subsequent MAIL commands. This limit is a safety
15199 precaution against a client that goes mad (incidents of this type have been
15203 .option smtp_accept_max_per_host main string&!! unset
15204 .cindex "limit" "SMTP connections from one host"
15205 .cindex "host" "limiting SMTP connections from"
15206 This option restricts the number of simultaneous IP connections from a single
15207 host (strictly, from a single IP address) to the Exim daemon. The option is
15208 expanded, to enable different limits to be applied to different hosts by
15209 reference to &$sender_host_address$&. Once the limit is reached, additional
15210 connection attempts from the same host are rejected with error code 421. This
15211 is entirely independent of &%smtp_accept_reserve%&. The option's default value
15212 of zero imposes no limit. If this option is set greater than zero, it is
15213 required that &%smtp_accept_max%& be non-zero.
15215 &*Warning*&: When setting this option you should not use any expansion
15216 constructions that take an appreciable amount of time. The expansion and test
15217 happen in the main daemon loop, in order to reject additional connections
15218 without forking additional processes (otherwise a denial-of-service attack
15219 could cause a vast number or processes to be created). While the daemon is
15220 doing this processing, it cannot accept any other incoming connections.
15224 .option smtp_accept_queue main integer 0
15225 .cindex "SMTP" "incoming connection count"
15226 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
15227 .cindex "message" "queueing by SMTP connection count"
15228 If the number of simultaneous incoming SMTP connections being handled via the
15229 listening daemon exceeds this value, messages received by SMTP are just placed
15230 on the queue; no delivery processes are started automatically. The count is
15231 fixed at the start of an SMTP connection. It cannot be updated in the
15232 subprocess that receives messages, and so the queueing or not queueing applies
15233 to all messages received in the same connection.
15235 A value of zero implies no limit, and clearly any non-zero value is useful only
15236 if it is less than the &%smtp_accept_max%& value (unless that is zero). See
15237 also &%queue_only%&, &%queue_only_load%&, &%queue_smtp_domains%&, and the
15238 various &%-od%&&'x'& command line options.
15241 . Allow this long option name to split; give it unsplit as a fifth argument
15242 . for the automatic .oindex that is generated by .option.
15244 .option "smtp_accept_queue_per_ &~&~connection" main integer 10 &&&
15245 smtp_accept_queue_per_connection
15246 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
15247 .cindex "message" "queueing by message count"
15248 This option limits the number of delivery processes that Exim starts
15249 automatically when receiving messages via SMTP, whether via the daemon or by
15250 the use of &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&. If the value of the option is greater than zero,
15251 and the number of messages received in a single SMTP session exceeds this
15252 number, subsequent messages are placed on the queue, but no delivery processes
15253 are started. This helps to limit the number of Exim processes when a server
15254 restarts after downtime and there is a lot of mail waiting for it on other
15255 systems. On large systems, the default should probably be increased, and on
15256 dial-in client systems it should probably be set to zero (that is, disabled).
15259 .option smtp_accept_reserve main integer 0
15260 .cindex "SMTP" "incoming call count"
15261 .cindex "host" "reserved"
15262 When &%smtp_accept_max%& is set greater than zero, this option specifies a
15263 number of SMTP connections that are reserved for connections from the hosts
15264 that are specified in &%smtp_reserve_hosts%&. The value set in
15265 &%smtp_accept_max%& includes this reserve pool. The specified hosts are not
15266 restricted to this number of connections; the option specifies a minimum number
15267 of connection slots for them, not a maximum. It is a guarantee that this group
15268 of hosts can always get at least &%smtp_accept_reserve%& connections. However,
15269 the limit specified by &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& is still applied to each
15272 For example, if &%smtp_accept_max%& is set to 50 and &%smtp_accept_reserve%& is
15273 set to 5, once there are 45 active connections (from any hosts), new
15274 connections are accepted only from hosts listed in &%smtp_reserve_hosts%&,
15275 provided the other criteria for acceptance are met.
15278 .option smtp_active_hostname main string&!! unset
15279 .cindex "host" "name in SMTP responses"
15280 .cindex "SMTP" "host name in responses"
15281 .vindex "&$primary_hostname$&"
15282 This option is provided for multi-homed servers that want to masquerade as
15283 several different hosts. At the start of an incoming SMTP connection, its value
15284 is expanded and used instead of the value of &$primary_hostname$& in SMTP
15285 responses. For example, it is used as domain name in the response to an
15286 incoming HELO or EHLO command.
15288 .vindex "&$smtp_active_hostname$&"
15289 The active hostname is placed in the &$smtp_active_hostname$& variable, which
15290 is saved with any messages that are received. It is therefore available for use
15291 in routers and transports when the message is later delivered.
15293 If this option is unset, or if its expansion is forced to fail, or if the
15294 expansion results in an empty string, the value of &$primary_hostname$& is
15295 used. Other expansion failures cause a message to be written to the main and
15296 panic logs, and the SMTP command receives a temporary error. Typically, the
15297 value of &%smtp_active_hostname%& depends on the incoming interface address.
15300 smtp_active_hostname = ${if eq{$received_ip_address}{10.0.0.1}\
15301 {cox.mydomain}{box.mydomain}}
15304 Although &$smtp_active_hostname$& is primarily concerned with incoming
15305 messages, it is also used as the default for HELO commands in callout
15306 verification if there is no remote transport from which to obtain a
15307 &%helo_data%& value.
15309 .option smtp_banner main string&!! "see below"
15310 .cindex "SMTP" "welcome banner"
15311 .cindex "banner for SMTP"
15312 .cindex "welcome banner for SMTP"
15313 .cindex "customizing" "SMTP banner"
15314 This string, which is expanded every time it is used, is output as the initial
15315 positive response to an SMTP connection. The default setting is:
15317 smtp_banner = $smtp_active_hostname ESMTP Exim \
15318 $version_number $tod_full
15320 Failure to expand the string causes a panic error. If you want to create a
15321 multiline response to the initial SMTP connection, use &"\n"& in the string at
15322 appropriate points, but not at the end. Note that the 220 code is not included
15323 in this string. Exim adds it automatically (several times in the case of a
15324 multiline response).
15327 .option smtp_check_spool_space main boolean true
15328 .cindex "checking disk space"
15329 .cindex "disk space, checking"
15330 .cindex "spool directory" "checking space"
15331 When this option is set, if an incoming SMTP session encounters the SIZE
15332 option on a MAIL command, it checks that there is enough space in the
15333 spool directory's partition to accept a message of that size, while still
15334 leaving free the amount specified by &%check_spool_space%& (even if that value
15335 is zero). If there isn't enough space, a temporary error code is returned.
15338 .option smtp_connect_backlog main integer 20
15339 .cindex "connection backlog"
15340 .cindex "SMTP" "connection backlog"
15341 .cindex "backlog of connections"
15342 This option specifies a maximum number of waiting SMTP connections. Exim passes
15343 this value to the TCP/IP system when it sets up its listener. Once this number
15344 of connections are waiting for the daemon's attention, subsequent connection
15345 attempts are refused at the TCP/IP level. At least, that is what the manuals
15346 say; in some circumstances such connection attempts have been observed to time
15347 out instead. For large systems it is probably a good idea to increase the
15348 value (to 50, say). It also gives some protection against denial-of-service
15349 attacks by SYN flooding.
15352 .option smtp_enforce_sync main boolean true
15353 .cindex "SMTP" "synchronization checking"
15354 .cindex "synchronization checking in SMTP"
15355 The SMTP protocol specification requires the client to wait for a response from
15356 the server at certain points in the dialogue. Without PIPELINING these
15357 synchronization points are after every command; with PIPELINING they are
15358 fewer, but they still exist.
15360 Some spamming sites send out a complete set of SMTP commands without waiting
15361 for any response. Exim protects against this by rejecting a message if the
15362 client has sent further input when it should not have. The error response &"554
15363 SMTP synchronization error"& is sent, and the connection is dropped. Testing
15364 for this error cannot be perfect because of transmission delays (unexpected
15365 input may be on its way but not yet received when Exim checks). However, it
15366 does detect many instances.
15368 The check can be globally disabled by setting &%smtp_enforce_sync%& false.
15369 If you want to disable the check selectively (for example, only for certain
15370 hosts), you can do so by an appropriate use of a &%control%& modifier in an ACL
15371 (see section &<<SECTcontrols>>&). See also &%pipelining_advertise_hosts%&.
15375 .option smtp_etrn_command main string&!! unset
15376 .cindex "ETRN" "command to be run"
15377 .vindex "&$domain$&"
15378 If this option is set, the given command is run whenever an SMTP ETRN
15379 command is received from a host that is permitted to issue such commands (see
15380 chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&). The string is split up into separate arguments which
15381 are independently expanded. The expansion variable &$domain$& is set to the
15382 argument of the ETRN command, and no syntax checking is done on it. For
15385 smtp_etrn_command = /etc/etrn_command $domain \
15386 $sender_host_address
15388 A new process is created to run the command, but Exim does not wait for it to
15389 complete. Consequently, its status cannot be checked. If the command cannot be
15390 run, a line is written to the panic log, but the ETRN caller still receives
15391 a 250 success response. Exim is normally running under its own uid when
15392 receiving SMTP, so it is not possible for it to change the uid before running
15396 .option smtp_etrn_serialize main boolean true
15397 .cindex "ETRN" "serializing"
15398 When this option is set, it prevents the simultaneous execution of more than
15399 one identical command as a result of ETRN in an SMTP connection. See
15400 section &<<SECTETRN>>& for details.
15403 .option smtp_load_reserve main fixed-point unset
15404 .cindex "load average"
15405 If the system load average ever gets higher than this, incoming SMTP calls are
15406 accepted only from those hosts that match an entry in &%smtp_reserve_hosts%&.
15407 If &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& is not set, no incoming SMTP calls are accepted when
15408 the load is over the limit. The option has no effect on ancient operating
15409 systems on which Exim cannot determine the load average. See also
15410 &%deliver_queue_load_max%& and &%queue_only_load%&.
15414 .option smtp_max_synprot_errors main integer 3
15415 .cindex "SMTP" "limiting syntax and protocol errors"
15416 .cindex "limit" "SMTP syntax and protocol errors"
15417 Exim rejects SMTP commands that contain syntax or protocol errors. In
15418 particular, a syntactically invalid email address, as in this command:
15420 RCPT TO:<abc xyz@a.b.c>
15422 causes immediate rejection of the command, before any other tests are done.
15423 (The ACL cannot be run if there is no valid address to set up for it.) An
15424 example of a protocol error is receiving RCPT before MAIL. If there are
15425 too many syntax or protocol errors in one SMTP session, the connection is
15426 dropped. The limit is set by this option.
15428 .cindex "PIPELINING" "expected errors"
15429 When the PIPELINING extension to SMTP is in use, some protocol errors are
15430 &"expected"&, for instance, a RCPT command after a rejected MAIL command.
15431 Exim assumes that PIPELINING will be used if it advertises it (see
15432 &%pipelining_advertise_hosts%&), and in this situation, &"expected"& errors do
15433 not count towards the limit.
15437 .option smtp_max_unknown_commands main integer 3
15438 .cindex "SMTP" "limiting unknown commands"
15439 .cindex "limit" "unknown SMTP commands"
15440 If there are too many unrecognized commands in an incoming SMTP session, an
15441 Exim server drops the connection. This is a defence against some kinds of abuse
15444 into making connections to SMTP ports; in these circumstances, a number of
15445 non-SMTP command lines are sent first.
15449 .option smtp_ratelimit_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
15450 .cindex "SMTP" "rate limiting"
15451 .cindex "limit" "rate of message arrival"
15452 .cindex "RCPT" "rate limiting"
15453 Some sites find it helpful to be able to limit the rate at which certain hosts
15454 can send them messages, and the rate at which an individual message can specify
15457 Exim has two rate-limiting facilities. This section describes the older
15458 facility, which can limit rates within a single connection. The newer
15459 &%ratelimit%& ACL condition can limit rates across all connections. See section
15460 &<<SECTratelimiting>>& for details of the newer facility.
15462 When a host matches &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%&, the values of
15463 &%smtp_ratelimit_mail%& and &%smtp_ratelimit_rcpt%& are used to control the
15464 rate of acceptance of MAIL and RCPT commands in a single SMTP session,
15465 respectively. Each option, if set, must contain a set of four comma-separated
15469 A threshold, before which there is no rate limiting.
15471 An initial time delay. Unlike other times in Exim, numbers with decimal
15472 fractional parts are allowed here.
15474 A factor by which to increase the delay each time.
15476 A maximum value for the delay. This should normally be less than 5 minutes,
15477 because after that time, the client is liable to timeout the SMTP command.
15480 For example, these settings have been used successfully at the site which
15481 first suggested this feature, for controlling mail from their customers:
15483 smtp_ratelimit_mail = 2,0.5s,1.05,4m
15484 smtp_ratelimit_rcpt = 4,0.25s,1.015,4m
15486 The first setting specifies delays that are applied to MAIL commands after
15487 two have been received over a single connection. The initial delay is 0.5
15488 seconds, increasing by a factor of 1.05 each time. The second setting applies
15489 delays to RCPT commands when more than four occur in a single message.
15492 .option smtp_ratelimit_mail main string unset
15493 See &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%& above.
15496 .option smtp_ratelimit_rcpt main string unset
15497 See &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%& above.
15500 .option smtp_receive_timeout main time 5m
15501 .cindex "timeout" "for SMTP input"
15502 .cindex "SMTP" "input timeout"
15503 This sets a timeout value for SMTP reception. It applies to all forms of SMTP
15504 input, including batch SMTP. If a line of input (either an SMTP command or a
15505 data line) is not received within this time, the SMTP connection is dropped and
15506 the message is abandoned.
15507 A line is written to the log containing one of the following messages:
15509 SMTP command timeout on connection from...
15510 SMTP data timeout on connection from...
15512 The former means that Exim was expecting to read an SMTP command; the latter
15513 means that it was in the DATA phase, reading the contents of a message.
15517 The value set by this option can be overridden by the
15518 &%-os%& command-line option. A setting of zero time disables the timeout, but
15519 this should never be used for SMTP over TCP/IP. (It can be useful in some cases
15520 of local input using &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&.) For non-SMTP input, the reception
15521 timeout is controlled by &%receive_timeout%& and &%-or%&.
15524 .option smtp_reserve_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
15525 This option defines hosts for which SMTP connections are reserved; see
15526 &%smtp_accept_reserve%& and &%smtp_load_reserve%& above.
15529 .option smtp_return_error_details main boolean false
15530 .cindex "SMTP" "details policy failures"
15531 .cindex "policy control" "rejection, returning details"
15532 In the default state, Exim uses bland messages such as
15533 &"Administrative prohibition"& when it rejects SMTP commands for policy
15534 reasons. Many sysadmins like this because it gives away little information
15535 to spammers. However, some other sysadmins who are applying strict checking
15536 policies want to give out much fuller information about failures. Setting
15537 &%smtp_return_error_details%& true causes Exim to be more forthcoming. For
15538 example, instead of &"Administrative prohibition"&, it might give:
15540 550-Rejected after DATA: '>' missing at end of address:
15541 550 failing address in "From" header is: <user@dom.ain
15544 .option spamd_address main string "see below"
15545 This option is available when Exim is compiled with the content-scanning
15546 extension. It specifies how Exim connects to SpamAssassin's &%spamd%& daemon.
15547 The default value is
15551 See section &<<SECTscanspamass>>& for more details.
15555 .option split_spool_directory main boolean false
15556 .cindex "multiple spool directories"
15557 .cindex "spool directory" "split"
15558 .cindex "directories, multiple"
15559 If this option is set, it causes Exim to split its input directory into 62
15560 subdirectories, each with a single alphanumeric character as its name. The
15561 sixth character of the message id is used to allocate messages to
15562 subdirectories; this is the least significant base-62 digit of the time of
15563 arrival of the message.
15565 Splitting up the spool in this way may provide better performance on systems
15566 where there are long mail queues, by reducing the number of files in any one
15567 directory. The msglog directory is also split up in a similar way to the input
15568 directory; however, if &%preserve_message_logs%& is set, all old msglog files
15569 are still placed in the single directory &_msglog.OLD_&.
15571 It is not necessary to take any special action for existing messages when
15572 changing &%split_spool_directory%&. Exim notices messages that are in the
15573 &"wrong"& place, and continues to process them. If the option is turned off
15574 after a period of being on, the subdirectories will eventually empty and be
15575 automatically deleted.
15577 When &%split_spool_directory%& is set, the behaviour of queue runner processes
15578 changes. Instead of creating a list of all messages in the queue, and then
15579 trying to deliver each one in turn, it constructs a list of those in one
15580 sub-directory and tries to deliver them, before moving on to the next
15581 sub-directory. The sub-directories are processed in a random order. This
15582 spreads out the scanning of the input directories, and uses less memory. It is
15583 particularly beneficial when there are lots of messages on the queue. However,
15584 if &%queue_run_in_order%& is set, none of this new processing happens. The
15585 entire queue has to be scanned and sorted before any deliveries can start.
15588 .option spool_directory main string&!! "set at compile time"
15589 .cindex "spool directory" "path to"
15590 This defines the directory in which Exim keeps its spool, that is, the messages
15591 it is waiting to deliver. The default value is taken from the compile-time
15592 configuration setting, if there is one. If not, this option must be set. The
15593 string is expanded, so it can contain, for example, a reference to
15594 &$primary_hostname$&.
15596 If the spool directory name is fixed on your installation, it is recommended
15597 that you set it at build time rather than from this option, particularly if the
15598 log files are being written to the spool directory (see &%log_file_path%&).
15599 Otherwise log files cannot be used for errors that are detected early on, such
15600 as failures in the configuration file.
15602 By using this option to override the compiled-in path, it is possible to run
15603 tests of Exim without using the standard spool.
15605 .option sqlite_lock_timeout main time 5s
15606 .cindex "sqlite lookup type" "lock timeout"
15607 This option controls the timeout that the &(sqlite)& lookup uses when trying to
15608 access an SQLite database. See section &<<SECTsqlite>>& for more details.
15610 .option strict_acl_vars main boolean false
15611 .cindex "&ACL;" "variables, handling unset"
15612 This option controls what happens if a syntactically valid but undefined ACL
15613 variable is referenced. If it is false (the default), an empty string
15614 is substituted; if it is true, an error is generated. See section
15615 &<<SECTaclvariables>>& for details of ACL variables.
15617 .option strip_excess_angle_brackets main boolean false
15618 .cindex "angle brackets, excess"
15619 If this option is set, redundant pairs of angle brackets round &"route-addr"&
15620 items in addresses are stripped. For example, &'<<xxx@a.b.c.d>>'& is
15621 treated as &'<xxx@a.b.c.d>'&. If this is in the envelope and the message is
15622 passed on to another MTA, the excess angle brackets are not passed on. If this
15623 option is not set, multiple pairs of angle brackets cause a syntax error.
15626 .option strip_trailing_dot main boolean false
15627 .cindex "trailing dot on domain"
15628 .cindex "dot" "trailing on domain"
15629 If this option is set, a trailing dot at the end of a domain in an address is
15630 ignored. If this is in the envelope and the message is passed on to another
15631 MTA, the dot is not passed on. If this option is not set, a dot at the end of a
15632 domain causes a syntax error.
15633 However, addresses in header lines are checked only when an ACL requests header
15637 .option syslog_duplication main boolean true
15638 .cindex "syslog" "duplicate log lines; suppressing"
15639 When Exim is logging to syslog, it writes the log lines for its three
15640 separate logs at different syslog priorities so that they can in principle
15641 be separated on the logging hosts. Some installations do not require this
15642 separation, and in those cases, the duplication of certain log lines is a
15643 nuisance. If &%syslog_duplication%& is set false, only one copy of any
15644 particular log line is written to syslog. For lines that normally go to
15645 both the main log and the reject log, the reject log version (possibly
15646 containing message header lines) is written, at LOG_NOTICE priority.
15647 Lines that normally go to both the main and the panic log are written at
15648 the LOG_ALERT priority.
15651 .option syslog_facility main string unset
15652 .cindex "syslog" "facility; setting"
15653 This option sets the syslog &"facility"& name, used when Exim is logging to
15654 syslog. The value must be one of the strings &"mail"&, &"user"&, &"news"&,
15655 &"uucp"&, &"daemon"&, or &"local&'x'&"& where &'x'& is a digit between 0 and 7.
15656 If this option is unset, &"mail"& is used. See chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& for
15657 details of Exim's logging.
15661 .option syslog_processname main string &`exim`&
15662 .cindex "syslog" "process name; setting"
15663 This option sets the syslog &"ident"& name, used when Exim is logging to
15664 syslog. The value must be no longer than 32 characters. See chapter
15665 &<<CHAPlog>>& for details of Exim's logging.
15669 .option syslog_timestamp main boolean true
15670 .cindex "syslog" "timestamps"
15671 If &%syslog_timestamp%& is set false, the timestamps on Exim's log lines are
15672 omitted when these lines are sent to syslog. See chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& for
15673 details of Exim's logging.
15676 .option system_filter main string&!! unset
15677 .cindex "filter" "system filter"
15678 .cindex "system filter" "specifying"
15679 .cindex "Sieve filter" "not available for system filter"
15680 This option specifies an Exim filter file that is applied to all messages at
15681 the start of each delivery attempt, before any routing is done. System filters
15682 must be Exim filters; they cannot be Sieve filters. If the system filter
15683 generates any deliveries to files or pipes, or any new mail messages, the
15684 appropriate &%system_filter_..._transport%& option(s) must be set, to define
15685 which transports are to be used. Details of this facility are given in chapter
15686 &<<CHAPsystemfilter>>&.
15689 .option system_filter_directory_transport main string&!! unset
15690 .vindex "&$address_file$&"
15691 This sets the name of the transport driver that is to be used when the
15692 &%save%& command in a system message filter specifies a path ending in &"/"&,
15693 implying delivery of each message into a separate file in some directory.
15694 During the delivery, the variable &$address_file$& contains the path name.
15697 .option system_filter_file_transport main string&!! unset
15698 .cindex "file" "transport for system filter"
15699 This sets the name of the transport driver that is to be used when the &%save%&
15700 command in a system message filter specifies a path not ending in &"/"&. During
15701 the delivery, the variable &$address_file$& contains the path name.
15703 .option system_filter_group main string unset
15704 .cindex "gid (group id)" "system filter"
15705 This option is used only when &%system_filter_user%& is also set. It sets the
15706 gid under which the system filter is run, overriding any gid that is associated
15707 with the user. The value may be numerical or symbolic.
15709 .option system_filter_pipe_transport main string&!! unset
15710 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "for system filter"
15711 .vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
15712 This specifies the transport driver that is to be used when a &%pipe%& command
15713 is used in a system filter. During the delivery, the variable &$address_pipe$&
15714 contains the pipe command.
15717 .option system_filter_reply_transport main string&!! unset
15718 .cindex "&(autoreply)& transport" "for system filter"
15719 This specifies the transport driver that is to be used when a &%mail%& command
15720 is used in a system filter.
15723 .option system_filter_user main string unset
15724 .cindex "uid (user id)" "system filter"
15725 If this option is set to root, the system filter is run in the main Exim
15726 delivery process, as root. Otherwise, the system filter runs in a separate
15727 process, as the given user, defaulting to the Exim run-time user.
15728 Unless the string consists entirely of digits, it
15729 is looked up in the password data. Failure to find the named user causes a
15730 configuration error. The gid is either taken from the password data, or
15731 specified by &%system_filter_group%&. When the uid is specified numerically,
15732 &%system_filter_group%& is required to be set.
15734 If the system filter generates any pipe, file, or reply deliveries, the uid
15735 under which the filter is run is used when transporting them, unless a
15736 transport option overrides.
15739 .option tcp_nodelay main boolean true
15740 .cindex "daemon" "TCP_NODELAY on sockets"
15741 .cindex "Nagle algorithm"
15742 .cindex "TCP_NODELAY on listening sockets"
15743 If this option is set false, it stops the Exim daemon setting the
15744 TCP_NODELAY option on its listening sockets. Setting TCP_NODELAY
15745 turns off the &"Nagle algorithm"&, which is a way of improving network
15746 performance in interactive (character-by-character) situations. Turning it off
15747 should improve Exim's performance a bit, so that is what happens by default.
15748 However, it appears that some broken clients cannot cope, and time out. Hence
15749 this option. It affects only those sockets that are set up for listening by the
15750 daemon. Sockets created by the smtp transport for delivering mail always set
15754 .option timeout_frozen_after main time 0s
15755 .cindex "frozen messages" "timing out"
15756 .cindex "timeout" "frozen messages"
15757 If &%timeout_frozen_after%& is set to a time greater than zero, a frozen
15758 message of any kind that has been on the queue for longer than the given time
15759 is automatically cancelled at the next queue run. If the frozen message is a
15760 bounce message, it is just discarded; otherwise, a bounce is sent to the
15761 sender, in a similar manner to cancellation by the &%-Mg%& command line option.
15762 If you want to timeout frozen bounce messages earlier than other kinds of
15763 frozen message, see &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&.
15765 &*Note:*& the default value of zero means no timeouts; with this setting,
15766 frozen messages remain on the queue forever (except for any frozen bounce
15767 messages that are released by &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&).
15770 .option timezone main string unset
15771 .cindex "timezone, setting"
15772 The value of &%timezone%& is used to set the environment variable TZ while
15773 running Exim (if it is different on entry). This ensures that all timestamps
15774 created by Exim are in the required timezone. If you want all your timestamps
15775 to be in UTC (aka GMT) you should set
15779 The default value is taken from TIMEZONE_DEFAULT in &_Local/Makefile_&,
15780 or, if that is not set, from the value of the TZ environment variable when Exim
15781 is built. If &%timezone%& is set to the empty string, either at build or run
15782 time, any existing TZ variable is removed from the environment when Exim
15783 runs. This is appropriate behaviour for obtaining wall-clock time on some, but
15784 unfortunately not all, operating systems.
15787 .option tls_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
15788 .cindex "TLS" "advertising"
15789 .cindex "encryption" "on SMTP connection"
15790 .cindex "SMTP" "encrypted connection"
15791 When Exim is built with support for TLS encrypted connections, the availability
15792 of the STARTTLS command to set up an encrypted session is advertised in
15793 response to EHLO only to those client hosts that match this option. See
15794 chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of Exim's support for TLS.
15797 .option tls_certificate main string&!! unset
15798 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate; location of"
15799 .cindex "certificate" "server, location of"
15800 The value of this option is expanded, and must then be the absolute path to a
15801 file which contains the server's certificates. The server's private key is also
15802 assumed to be in this file if &%tls_privatekey%& is unset. See chapter
15803 &<<CHAPTLS>>& for further details.
15805 &*Note*&: The certificates defined by this option are used only when Exim is
15806 receiving incoming messages as a server. If you want to supply certificates for
15807 use when sending messages as a client, you must set the &%tls_certificate%&
15808 option in the relevant &(smtp)& transport.
15810 If the option contains &$tls_out_sni$& and Exim is built against OpenSSL, then
15811 if the OpenSSL build supports TLS extensions and the TLS client sends the
15812 Server Name Indication extension, then this option and others documented in
15813 &<<SECTtlssni>>& will be re-expanded.
15815 .option tls_crl main string&!! unset
15816 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate revocation list"
15817 .cindex "certificate" "revocation list for server"
15818 This option specifies a certificate revocation list. The expanded value must
15819 be the name of a file that contains a CRL in PEM format.
15821 See &<<SECTtlssni>>& for discussion of when this option might be re-expanded.
15824 .option tls_dh_max_bits main integer 2236
15825 .cindex "TLS" "D-H bit count"
15826 The number of bits used for Diffie-Hellman key-exchange may be suggested by
15827 the chosen TLS library. That value might prove to be too high for
15828 interoperability. This option provides a maximum clamp on the value
15829 suggested, trading off security for interoperability.
15831 The value must be at least 1024.
15833 The value 2236 was chosen because, at time of adding the option, it was the
15834 hard-coded maximum value supported by the NSS cryptographic library, as used
15835 by Thunderbird, while GnuTLS was suggesting 2432 bits as normal.
15837 If you prefer more security and are willing to break some clients, raise this
15840 Note that the value passed to GnuTLS for *generating* a new prime may be a
15841 little less than this figure, because GnuTLS is inexact and may produce a
15842 larger prime than requested.
15845 .option tls_dhparam main string&!! unset
15846 .cindex "TLS" "D-H parameters for server"
15847 The value of this option is expanded and indicates the source of DH parameters
15848 to be used by Exim.
15850 If it is a filename starting with a &`/`&, then it names a file from which DH
15851 parameters should be loaded. If the file exists, it should hold a PEM-encoded
15852 PKCS#3 representation of the DH prime. If the file does not exist, for
15853 OpenSSL it is an error. For GnuTLS, Exim will attempt to create the file and
15854 fill it with a generated DH prime. For OpenSSL, if the DH bit-count from
15855 loading the file is greater than &%tls_dh_max_bits%& then it will be ignored,
15856 and treated as though the &%tls_dhparam%& were set to "none".
15858 If this option expands to the string "none", then no DH parameters will be
15861 If this option expands to the string "historic" and Exim is using GnuTLS, then
15862 Exim will attempt to load a file from inside the spool directory. If the file
15863 does not exist, Exim will attempt to create it.
15864 See section &<<SECTgnutlsparam>>& for further details.
15866 If Exim is using OpenSSL and this option is empty or unset, then Exim will load
15867 a default DH prime; the default is the 2048 bit prime described in section
15868 2.2 of RFC 5114, "2048-bit MODP Group with 224-bit Prime Order Subgroup", which
15869 in IKE is assigned number 23.
15871 Otherwise, the option must expand to the name used by Exim for any of a number
15872 of DH primes specified in RFC 2409, RFC 3526 and RFC 5114. As names, Exim uses
15873 "ike" followed by the number used by IKE, of "default" which corresponds to
15876 The available primes are:
15877 &`ike1`&, &`ike2`&, &`ike5`&,
15878 &`ike14`&, &`ike15`&, &`ike16`&, &`ike17`&, &`ike18`&,
15879 &`ike22`&, &`ike23`& (aka &`default`&) and &`ike24`&.
15881 Some of these will be too small to be accepted by clients.
15882 Some may be too large to be accepted by clients.
15885 .option tls_on_connect_ports main "string list" unset
15886 This option specifies a list of incoming SSMTP (aka SMTPS) ports that should
15887 operate the obsolete SSMTP (SMTPS) protocol, where a TLS session is immediately
15888 set up without waiting for the client to issue a STARTTLS command. For
15889 further details, see section &<<SECTsupobssmt>>&.
15893 .option tls_privatekey main string&!! unset
15894 .cindex "TLS" "server private key; location of"
15895 The value of this option is expanded, and must then be the absolute path to a
15896 file which contains the server's private key. If this option is unset, or if
15897 the expansion is forced to fail, or the result is an empty string, the private
15898 key is assumed to be in the same file as the server's certificates. See chapter
15899 &<<CHAPTLS>>& for further details.
15901 See &<<SECTtlssni>>& for discussion of when this option might be re-expanded.
15904 .option tls_remember_esmtp main boolean false
15905 .cindex "TLS" "esmtp state; remembering"
15906 .cindex "TLS" "broken clients"
15907 If this option is set true, Exim violates the RFCs by remembering that it is in
15908 &"esmtp"& state after successfully negotiating a TLS session. This provides
15909 support for broken clients that fail to send a new EHLO after starting a
15913 .option tls_require_ciphers main string&!! unset
15914 .cindex "TLS" "requiring specific ciphers"
15915 .cindex "cipher" "requiring specific"
15916 This option controls which ciphers can be used for incoming TLS connections.
15917 The &(smtp)& transport has an option of the same name for controlling outgoing
15918 connections. This option is expanded for each connection, so can be varied for
15919 different clients if required. The value of this option must be a list of
15920 permitted cipher suites. The OpenSSL and GnuTLS libraries handle cipher control
15921 in somewhat different ways. If GnuTLS is being used, the client controls the
15922 preference order of the available ciphers. Details are given in sections
15923 &<<SECTreqciphssl>>& and &<<SECTreqciphgnu>>&.
15926 .option tls_try_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
15927 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
15928 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
15929 See &%tls_verify_hosts%& below.
15932 .option tls_verify_certificates main string&!! unset
15933 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
15934 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
15935 The value of this option is expanded, and must then be the absolute path to
15936 a file containing permitted certificates for clients that
15937 match &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&. Alternatively, if you
15938 are using OpenSSL, you can set &%tls_verify_certificates%& to the name of a
15939 directory containing certificate files. This does not work with GnuTLS; the
15940 option must be set to the name of a single file if you are using GnuTLS.
15942 These certificates should be for the certificate authorities trusted, rather
15943 than the public cert of individual clients. With both OpenSSL and GnuTLS, if
15944 the value is a file then the certificates are sent by Exim as a server to
15945 connecting clients, defining the list of accepted certificate authorities.
15946 Thus the values defined should be considered public data. To avoid this,
15947 use OpenSSL with a directory.
15949 See &<<SECTtlssni>>& for discussion of when this option might be re-expanded.
15952 .option tls_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
15953 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
15954 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
15955 This option, along with &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&, controls the checking of
15956 certificates from clients. The expected certificates are defined by
15957 &%tls_verify_certificates%&, which must be set. A configuration error occurs if
15958 either &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& is set and
15959 &%tls_verify_certificates%& is not set.
15961 Any client that matches &%tls_verify_hosts%& is constrained by
15962 &%tls_verify_certificates%&. When the client initiates a TLS session, it must
15963 present one of the listed certificates. If it does not, the connection is
15964 aborted. &*Warning*&: Including a host in &%tls_verify_hosts%& does not require
15965 the host to use TLS. It can still send SMTP commands through unencrypted
15966 connections. Forcing a client to use TLS has to be done separately using an
15967 ACL to reject inappropriate commands when the connection is not encrypted.
15969 A weaker form of checking is provided by &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&. If a client
15970 matches this option (but not &%tls_verify_hosts%&), Exim requests a
15971 certificate and checks it against &%tls_verify_certificates%&, but does not
15972 abort the connection if there is no certificate or if it does not match. This
15973 state can be detected in an ACL, which makes it possible to implement policies
15974 such as &"accept for relay only if a verified certificate has been received,
15975 but accept for local delivery if encrypted, even without a verified
15978 Client hosts that match neither of these lists are not asked to present
15982 .option trusted_groups main "string list&!!" unset
15983 .cindex "trusted groups"
15984 .cindex "groups" "trusted"
15985 This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. If this
15986 option is set, any process that is running in one of the listed groups, or
15987 which has one of them as a supplementary group, is trusted. The groups can be
15988 specified numerically or by name. See section &<<SECTtrustedadmin>>& for
15989 details of what trusted callers are permitted to do. If neither
15990 &%trusted_groups%& nor &%trusted_users%& is set, only root and the Exim user
15993 .option trusted_users main "string list&!!" unset
15994 .cindex "trusted users"
15995 .cindex "user" "trusted"
15996 This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. If this
15997 option is set, any process that is running as one of the listed users is
15998 trusted. The users can be specified numerically or by name. See section
15999 &<<SECTtrustedadmin>>& for details of what trusted callers are permitted to do.
16000 If neither &%trusted_groups%& nor &%trusted_users%& is set, only root and the
16001 Exim user are trusted.
16003 .option unknown_login main string&!! unset
16004 .cindex "uid (user id)" "unknown caller"
16005 .vindex "&$caller_uid$&"
16006 This is a specialized feature for use in unusual configurations. By default, if
16007 the uid of the caller of Exim cannot be looked up using &[getpwuid()]&, Exim
16008 gives up. The &%unknown_login%& option can be used to set a login name to be
16009 used in this circumstance. It is expanded, so values like &%user$caller_uid%&
16010 can be set. When &%unknown_login%& is used, the value of &%unknown_username%&
16011 is used for the user's real name (gecos field), unless this has been set by the
16014 .option unknown_username main string unset
16015 See &%unknown_login%&.
16017 .option untrusted_set_sender main "address list&!!" unset
16018 .cindex "trusted users"
16019 .cindex "sender" "setting by untrusted user"
16020 .cindex "untrusted user setting sender"
16021 .cindex "user" "untrusted setting sender"
16022 .cindex "envelope sender"
16023 When an untrusted user submits a message to Exim using the standard input, Exim
16024 normally creates an envelope sender address from the user's login and the
16025 default qualification domain. Data from the &%-f%& option (for setting envelope
16026 senders on non-SMTP messages) or the SMTP MAIL command (if &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&
16027 is used) is ignored.
16029 However, untrusted users are permitted to set an empty envelope sender address,
16030 to declare that a message should never generate any bounces. For example:
16032 exim -f '<>' user@domain.example
16034 .vindex "&$sender_ident$&"
16035 The &%untrusted_set_sender%& option allows you to permit untrusted users to set
16036 other envelope sender addresses in a controlled way. When it is set, untrusted
16037 users are allowed to set envelope sender addresses that match any of the
16038 patterns in the list. Like all address lists, the string is expanded. The
16039 identity of the user is in &$sender_ident$&, so you can, for example, restrict
16040 users to setting senders that start with their login ids
16041 followed by a hyphen
16042 by a setting like this:
16044 untrusted_set_sender = ^$sender_ident-
16046 If you want to allow untrusted users to set envelope sender addresses without
16047 restriction, you can use
16049 untrusted_set_sender = *
16051 The &%untrusted_set_sender%& option applies to all forms of local input, but
16052 only to the setting of the envelope sender. It does not permit untrusted users
16053 to use the other options which trusted user can use to override message
16054 parameters. Furthermore, it does not stop Exim from removing an existing
16055 &'Sender:'& header in the message, or from adding a &'Sender:'& header if
16056 necessary. See &%local_sender_retain%& and &%local_from_check%& for ways of
16057 overriding these actions. The handling of the &'Sender:'& header is also
16058 described in section &<<SECTthesenhea>>&.
16060 The log line for a message's arrival shows the envelope sender following
16061 &"<="&. For local messages, the user's login always follows, after &"U="&. In
16062 &%-bp%& displays, and in the Exim monitor, if an untrusted user sets an
16063 envelope sender address, the user's login is shown in parentheses after the
16067 .option uucp_from_pattern main string "see below"
16068 .cindex "&""From""& line"
16069 .cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
16070 Some applications that pass messages to an MTA via a command line interface use
16071 an initial line starting with &"From&~"& to pass the envelope sender. In
16072 particular, this is used by UUCP software. Exim recognizes such a line by means
16073 of a regular expression that is set in &%uucp_from_pattern%&. When the pattern
16074 matches, the sender address is constructed by expanding the contents of
16075 &%uucp_from_sender%&, provided that the caller of Exim is a trusted user. The
16076 default pattern recognizes lines in the following two forms:
16078 From ph10 Fri Jan 5 12:35 GMT 1996
16079 From ph10 Fri, 7 Jan 97 14:00:00 GMT
16081 The pattern can be seen by running
16083 exim -bP uucp_from_pattern
16085 It checks only up to the hours and minutes, and allows for a 2-digit or 4-digit
16086 year in the second case. The first word after &"From&~"& is matched in the
16087 regular expression by a parenthesized subpattern. The default value for
16088 &%uucp_from_sender%& is &"$1"&, which therefore just uses this first word
16089 (&"ph10"& in the example above) as the message's sender. See also
16090 &%ignore_fromline_hosts%&.
16093 .option uucp_from_sender main string&!! &`$1`&
16094 See &%uucp_from_pattern%& above.
16097 .option warn_message_file main string unset
16098 .cindex "warning of delay" "customizing the message"
16099 .cindex "customizing" "warning message"
16100 This option defines a template file containing paragraphs of text to be used
16101 for constructing the warning message which is sent by Exim when a message has
16102 been on the queue for a specified amount of time, as specified by
16103 &%delay_warning%&. Details of the file's contents are given in chapter
16104 &<<CHAPemsgcust>>&. See also &%bounce_message_file%&.
16107 .option write_rejectlog main boolean true
16108 .cindex "reject log" "disabling"
16109 If this option is set false, Exim no longer writes anything to the reject log.
16110 See chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& for details of what Exim writes to its logs.
16111 .ecindex IIDconfima
16112 .ecindex IIDmaiconf
16117 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
16118 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
16120 .chapter "Generic options for routers" "CHAProutergeneric"
16121 .scindex IIDgenoprou1 "options" "generic; for routers"
16122 .scindex IIDgenoprou2 "generic options" "router"
16123 This chapter describes the generic options that apply to all routers.
16124 Those that are preconditions are marked with ‡ in the &"use"& field.
16126 For a general description of how a router operates, see sections
16127 &<<SECTrunindrou>>& and &<<SECTrouprecon>>&. The latter specifies the order in
16128 which the preconditions are tested. The order of expansion of the options that
16129 provide data for a transport is: &%errors_to%&, &%headers_add%&,
16130 &%headers_remove%&, &%transport%&.
16134 .option address_data routers string&!! unset
16135 .cindex "router" "data attached to address"
16136 The string is expanded just before the router is run, that is, after all the
16137 precondition tests have succeeded. If the expansion is forced to fail, the
16138 router declines, the value of &%address_data%& remains unchanged, and the
16139 &%more%& option controls what happens next. Other expansion failures cause
16140 delivery of the address to be deferred.
16142 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
16143 When the expansion succeeds, the value is retained with the address, and can be
16144 accessed using the variable &$address_data$& in the current router, subsequent
16145 routers, and the eventual transport.
16147 &*Warning*&: If the current or any subsequent router is a &(redirect)& router
16148 that runs a user's filter file, the contents of &$address_data$& are accessible
16149 in the filter. This is not normally a problem, because such data is usually
16150 either not confidential or it &"belongs"& to the current user, but if you do
16151 put confidential data into &$address_data$& you need to remember this point.
16153 Even if the router declines or passes, the value of &$address_data$& remains
16154 with the address, though it can be changed by another &%address_data%& setting
16155 on a subsequent router. If a router generates child addresses, the value of
16156 &$address_data$& propagates to them. This also applies to the special kind of
16157 &"child"& that is generated by a router with the &%unseen%& option.
16159 The idea of &%address_data%& is that you can use it to look up a lot of data
16160 for the address once, and then pick out parts of the data later. For example,
16161 you could use a single LDAP lookup to return a string of the form
16163 uid=1234 gid=5678 mailbox=/mail/xyz forward=/home/xyz/.forward
16165 In the transport you could pick out the mailbox by a setting such as
16167 file = ${extract{mailbox}{$address_data}}
16169 This makes the configuration file less messy, and also reduces the number of
16170 lookups (though Exim does cache lookups).
16172 .vindex "&$sender_address_data$&"
16173 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
16174 The &%address_data%& facility is also useful as a means of passing information
16175 from one router to another, and from a router to a transport. In addition, if
16176 &$address_data$& is set by a router when verifying a recipient address from an
16177 ACL, it remains available for use in the rest of the ACL statement. After
16178 verifying a sender, the value is transferred to &$sender_address_data$&.
16182 .option address_test routers&!? boolean true
16184 .cindex "router" "skipping when address testing"
16185 If this option is set false, the router is skipped when routing is being tested
16186 by means of the &%-bt%& command line option. This can be a convenience when
16187 your first router sends messages to an external scanner, because it saves you
16188 having to set the &"already scanned"& indicator when testing real address
16193 .option cannot_route_message routers string&!! unset
16194 .cindex "router" "customizing &""cannot route""& message"
16195 .cindex "customizing" "&""cannot route""& message"
16196 This option specifies a text message that is used when an address cannot be
16197 routed because Exim has run out of routers. The default message is
16198 &"Unrouteable address"&. This option is useful only on routers that have
16199 &%more%& set false, or on the very last router in a configuration, because the
16200 value that is used is taken from the last router that is considered. This
16201 includes a router that is skipped because its preconditions are not met, as
16202 well as a router that declines. For example, using the default configuration,
16205 cannot_route_message = Remote domain not found in DNS
16207 on the first router, which is a &(dnslookup)& router with &%more%& set false,
16210 cannot_route_message = Unknown local user
16212 on the final router that checks for local users. If string expansion fails for
16213 this option, the default message is used. Unless the expansion failure was
16214 explicitly forced, a message about the failure is written to the main and panic
16215 logs, in addition to the normal message about the routing failure.
16218 .option caseful_local_part routers boolean false
16219 .cindex "case of local parts"
16220 .cindex "router" "case of local parts"
16221 By default, routers handle the local parts of addresses in a case-insensitive
16222 manner, though the actual case is preserved for transmission with the message.
16223 If you want the case of letters to be significant in a router, you must set
16224 this option true. For individual router options that contain address or local
16225 part lists (for example, &%local_parts%&), case-sensitive matching can be
16226 turned on by &"+caseful"& as a list item. See section &<<SECTcasletadd>>& for
16229 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
16230 .vindex "&$original_local_part$&"
16231 .vindex "&$parent_local_part$&"
16232 The value of the &$local_part$& variable is forced to lower case while a
16233 router is running unless &%caseful_local_part%& is set. When a router assigns
16234 an address to a transport, the value of &$local_part$& when the transport runs
16235 is the same as it was in the router. Similarly, when a router generates child
16236 addresses by aliasing or forwarding, the values of &$original_local_part$&
16237 and &$parent_local_part$& are those that were used by the redirecting router.
16239 This option applies to the processing of an address by a router. When a
16240 recipient address is being processed in an ACL, there is a separate &%control%&
16241 modifier that can be used to specify case-sensitive processing within the ACL
16242 (see section &<<SECTcontrols>>&).
16246 .option check_local_user routers&!? boolean false
16247 .cindex "local user, checking in router"
16248 .cindex "router" "checking for local user"
16249 .cindex "&_/etc/passwd_&"
16251 When this option is true, Exim checks that the local part of the recipient
16252 address (with affixes removed if relevant) is the name of an account on the
16253 local system. The check is done by calling the &[getpwnam()]& function rather
16254 than trying to read &_/etc/passwd_& directly. This means that other methods of
16255 holding password data (such as NIS) are supported. If the local part is a local
16256 user, &$home$& is set from the password data, and can be tested in other
16257 preconditions that are evaluated after this one (the order of evaluation is
16258 given in section &<<SECTrouprecon>>&). However, the value of &$home$& can be
16259 overridden by &%router_home_directory%&. If the local part is not a local user,
16260 the router is skipped.
16262 If you want to check that the local part is either the name of a local user
16263 or matches something else, you cannot combine &%check_local_user%& with a
16264 setting of &%local_parts%&, because that specifies the logical &'and'& of the
16265 two conditions. However, you can use a &(passwd)& lookup in a &%local_parts%&
16266 setting to achieve this. For example:
16268 local_parts = passwd;$local_part : lsearch;/etc/other/users
16270 Note, however, that the side effects of &%check_local_user%& (such as setting
16271 up a home directory) do not occur when a &(passwd)& lookup is used in a
16272 &%local_parts%& (or any other) precondition.
16276 .option condition routers&!? string&!! unset
16277 .cindex "router" "customized precondition"
16278 This option specifies a general precondition test that has to succeed for the
16279 router to be called. The &%condition%& option is the last precondition to be
16280 evaluated (see section &<<SECTrouprecon>>&). The string is expanded, and if the
16281 result is a forced failure, or an empty string, or one of the strings &"0"& or
16282 &"no"& or &"false"& (checked without regard to the case of the letters), the
16283 router is skipped, and the address is offered to the next one.
16285 If the result is any other value, the router is run (as this is the last
16286 precondition to be evaluated, all the other preconditions must be true).
16288 This option is unique in that multiple &%condition%& options may be present.
16289 All &%condition%& options must succeed.
16291 The &%condition%& option provides a means of applying custom conditions to the
16292 running of routers. Note that in the case of a simple conditional expansion,
16293 the default expansion values are exactly what is wanted. For example:
16295 condition = ${if >{$message_age}{600}}
16297 Because of the default behaviour of the string expansion, this is equivalent to
16299 condition = ${if >{$message_age}{600}{true}{}}
16302 A multiple condition example, which succeeds:
16304 condition = ${if >{$message_age}{600}}
16305 condition = ${if !eq{${lc:$local_part}}{postmaster}}
16309 If the expansion fails (other than forced failure) delivery is deferred. Some
16310 of the other precondition options are common special cases that could in fact
16311 be specified using &%condition%&.
16314 .option debug_print routers string&!! unset
16315 .cindex "testing" "variables in drivers"
16316 If this option is set and debugging is enabled (see the &%-d%& command line
16317 option), the string is expanded and included in the debugging output.
16318 If expansion of the string fails, the error message is written to the debugging
16319 output, and Exim carries on processing.
16320 This option is provided to help with checking out the values of variables and
16321 so on when debugging router configurations. For example, if a &%condition%&
16322 option appears not to be working, &%debug_print%& can be used to output the
16323 variables it references. The output happens after checks for &%domains%&,
16324 &%local_parts%&, and &%check_local_user%& but before any other preconditions
16325 are tested. A newline is added to the text if it does not end with one.
16329 .option disable_logging routers boolean false
16330 If this option is set true, nothing is logged for any routing errors
16331 or for any deliveries caused by this router. You should not set this option
16332 unless you really, really know what you are doing. See also the generic
16333 transport option of the same name.
16336 .option domains routers&!? "domain list&!!" unset
16337 .cindex "router" "restricting to specific domains"
16338 .vindex "&$domain_data$&"
16339 If this option is set, the router is skipped unless the current domain matches
16340 the list. If the match is achieved by means of a file lookup, the data that the
16341 lookup returned for the domain is placed in &$domain_data$& for use in string
16342 expansions of the driver's private options. See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for
16343 a list of the order in which preconditions are evaluated.
16347 .option driver routers string unset
16348 This option must always be set. It specifies which of the available routers is
16353 .option errors_to routers string&!! unset
16354 .cindex "envelope sender"
16355 .cindex "router" "changing address for errors"
16356 If a router successfully handles an address, it may assign the address to a
16357 transport for delivery or it may generate child addresses. In both cases, if
16358 there is a delivery problem during later processing, the resulting bounce
16359 message is sent to the address that results from expanding this string,
16360 provided that the address verifies successfully. The &%errors_to%& option is
16361 expanded before &%headers_add%&, &%headers_remove%&, and &%transport%&.
16363 The &%errors_to%& setting associated with an address can be overridden if it
16364 subsequently passes through other routers that have their own &%errors_to%&
16365 settings, or if the message is delivered by a transport with a &%return_path%&
16368 If &%errors_to%& is unset, or the expansion is forced to fail, or the result of
16369 the expansion fails to verify, the errors address associated with the incoming
16370 address is used. At top level, this is the envelope sender. A non-forced
16371 expansion failure causes delivery to be deferred.
16373 If an address for which &%errors_to%& has been set ends up being delivered over
16374 SMTP, the envelope sender for that delivery is the &%errors_to%& value, so that
16375 any bounces that are generated by other MTAs on the delivery route are also
16376 sent there. You can set &%errors_to%& to the empty string by either of these
16382 An expansion item that yields an empty string has the same effect. If you do
16383 this, a locally detected delivery error for addresses processed by this router
16384 no longer gives rise to a bounce message; the error is discarded. If the
16385 address is delivered to a remote host, the return path is set to &`<>`&, unless
16386 overridden by the &%return_path%& option on the transport.
16388 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
16389 If for some reason you want to discard local errors, but use a non-empty
16390 MAIL command for remote delivery, you can preserve the original return
16391 path in &$address_data$& in the router, and reinstate it in the transport by
16392 setting &%return_path%&.
16394 The most common use of &%errors_to%& is to direct mailing list bounces to the
16395 manager of the list, as described in section &<<SECTmailinglists>>&, or to
16396 implement VERP (Variable Envelope Return Paths) (see section &<<SECTverp>>&).
16400 .option expn routers&!? boolean true
16401 .cindex "address" "testing"
16402 .cindex "testing" "addresses"
16403 .cindex "EXPN" "router skipping"
16404 .cindex "router" "skipping for EXPN"
16405 If this option is turned off, the router is skipped when testing an address
16406 as a result of processing an SMTP EXPN command. You might, for example,
16407 want to turn it off on a router for users' &_.forward_& files, while leaving it
16408 on for the system alias file.
16409 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
16412 The use of the SMTP EXPN command is controlled by an ACL (see chapter
16413 &<<CHAPACL>>&). When Exim is running an EXPN command, it is similar to testing
16414 an address with &%-bt%&. Compare VRFY, whose counterpart is &%-bv%&.
16418 .option fail_verify routers boolean false
16419 .cindex "router" "forcing verification failure"
16420 Setting this option has the effect of setting both &%fail_verify_sender%& and
16421 &%fail_verify_recipient%& to the same value.
16425 .option fail_verify_recipient routers boolean false
16426 If this option is true and an address is accepted by this router when
16427 verifying a recipient, verification fails.
16431 .option fail_verify_sender routers boolean false
16432 If this option is true and an address is accepted by this router when
16433 verifying a sender, verification fails.
16437 .option fallback_hosts routers "string list" unset
16438 .cindex "router" "fallback hosts"
16439 .cindex "fallback" "hosts specified on router"
16440 String expansion is not applied to this option. The argument must be a
16441 colon-separated list of host names or IP addresses. The list separator can be
16442 changed (see section &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&), and a port can be specified with
16443 each name or address. In fact, the format of each item is exactly the same as
16444 defined for the list of hosts in a &(manualroute)& router (see section
16445 &<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&).
16447 If a router queues an address for a remote transport, this host list is
16448 associated with the address, and used instead of the transport's fallback host
16449 list. If &%hosts_randomize%& is set on the transport, the order of the list is
16450 randomized for each use. See the &%fallback_hosts%& option of the &(smtp)&
16451 transport for further details.
16454 .option group routers string&!! "see below"
16455 .cindex "gid (group id)" "local delivery"
16456 .cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
16457 .cindex "transport" "local"
16458 .cindex "router" "setting group"
16459 When a router queues an address for a transport, and the transport does not
16460 specify a group, the group given here is used when running the delivery
16462 The group may be specified numerically or by name. If expansion fails, the
16463 error is logged and delivery is deferred.
16464 The default is unset, unless &%check_local_user%& is set, when the default
16465 is taken from the password information. See also &%initgroups%& and &%user%&
16466 and the discussion in chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
16470 .option headers_add routers string&!! unset
16471 .cindex "header lines" "adding"
16472 .cindex "router" "adding header lines"
16473 This option specifies a string of text that is expanded at routing time, and
16474 associated with any addresses that are accepted by the router. However, this
16475 option has no effect when an address is just being verified. The way in which
16476 the text is used to add header lines at transport time is described in section
16477 &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. New header lines are not actually added until the
16478 message is in the process of being transported. This means that references to
16479 header lines in string expansions in the transport's configuration do not
16480 &"see"& the added header lines.
16482 The &%headers_add%& option is expanded after &%errors_to%&, but before
16483 &%headers_remove%& and &%transport%&. If the expanded string is empty, or if
16484 the expansion is forced to fail, the option has no effect. Other expansion
16485 failures are treated as configuration errors.
16487 &*Warning 1*&: The &%headers_add%& option cannot be used for a &(redirect)&
16488 router that has the &%one_time%& option set.
16490 .cindex "duplicate addresses"
16491 .oindex "&%unseen%&"
16492 &*Warning 2*&: If the &%unseen%& option is set on the router, all header
16493 additions are deleted when the address is passed on to subsequent routers.
16494 For a &%redirect%& router, if a generated address is the same as the incoming
16495 address, this can lead to duplicate addresses with different header
16496 modifications. Exim does not do duplicate deliveries (except, in certain
16497 circumstances, to pipes -- see section &<<SECTdupaddr>>&), but it is undefined
16498 which of the duplicates is discarded, so this ambiguous situation should be
16499 avoided. The &%repeat_use%& option of the &%redirect%& router may be of help.
16503 .option headers_remove routers string&!! unset
16504 .cindex "header lines" "removing"
16505 .cindex "router" "removing header lines"
16506 This option specifies a string of text that is expanded at routing time, and
16507 associated with any addresses that are accepted by the router. However, this
16508 option has no effect when an address is just being verified. The way in which
16509 the text is used to remove header lines at transport time is described in
16510 section &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. Header lines are not actually removed until
16511 the message is in the process of being transported. This means that references
16512 to header lines in string expansions in the transport's configuration still
16513 &"see"& the original header lines.
16515 The &%headers_remove%& option is expanded after &%errors_to%& and
16516 &%headers_add%&, but before &%transport%&. If the expansion is forced to fail,
16517 the option has no effect. Other expansion failures are treated as configuration
16520 &*Warning 1*&: The &%headers_remove%& option cannot be used for a &(redirect)&
16521 router that has the &%one_time%& option set.
16523 &*Warning 2*&: If the &%unseen%& option is set on the router, all header
16524 removal requests are deleted when the address is passed on to subsequent
16525 routers, and this can lead to problems with duplicates -- see the similar
16526 warning for &%headers_add%& above.
16529 .option ignore_target_hosts routers "host list&!!" unset
16530 .cindex "IP address" "discarding"
16531 .cindex "router" "discarding IP addresses"
16532 Although this option is a host list, it should normally contain IP address
16533 entries rather than names. If any host that is looked up by the router has an
16534 IP address that matches an item in this list, Exim behaves as if that IP
16535 address did not exist. This option allows you to cope with rogue DNS entries
16538 remote.domain.example. A 127.0.0.1
16542 ignore_target_hosts = 127.0.0.1
16544 on the relevant router. If all the hosts found by a &(dnslookup)& router are
16545 discarded in this way, the router declines. In a conventional configuration, an
16546 attempt to mail to such a domain would normally provoke the &"unrouteable
16547 domain"& error, and an attempt to verify an address in the domain would fail.
16548 Similarly, if &%ignore_target_hosts%& is set on an &(ipliteral)& router, the
16549 router declines if presented with one of the listed addresses.
16551 You can use this option to disable the use of IPv4 or IPv6 for mail delivery by
16552 means of the first or the second of the following settings, respectively:
16554 ignore_target_hosts = 0.0.0.0/0
16555 ignore_target_hosts = <; 0::0/0
16557 The pattern in the first line matches all IPv4 addresses, whereas the pattern
16558 in the second line matches all IPv6 addresses.
16560 This option may also be useful for ignoring link-local and site-local IPv6
16561 addresses. Because, like all host lists, the value of &%ignore_target_hosts%&
16562 is expanded before use as a list, it is possible to make it dependent on the
16563 domain that is being routed.
16565 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
16566 During its expansion, &$host_address$& is set to the IP address that is being
16569 .option initgroups routers boolean false
16570 .cindex "additional groups"
16571 .cindex "groups" "additional"
16572 .cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
16573 .cindex "transport" "local"
16574 If the router queues an address for a transport, and this option is true, and
16575 the uid supplied by the router is not overridden by the transport, the
16576 &[initgroups()]& function is called when running the transport to ensure that
16577 any additional groups associated with the uid are set up. See also &%group%&
16578 and &%user%& and the discussion in chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
16582 .option local_part_prefix routers&!? "string list" unset
16583 .cindex "router" "prefix for local part"
16584 .cindex "prefix" "for local part, used in router"
16585 If this option is set, the router is skipped unless the local part starts with
16586 one of the given strings, or &%local_part_prefix_optional%& is true. See
16587 section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions are
16590 The list is scanned from left to right, and the first prefix that matches is
16591 used. A limited form of wildcard is available; if the prefix begins with an
16592 asterisk, it matches the longest possible sequence of arbitrary characters at
16593 the start of the local part. An asterisk should therefore always be followed by
16594 some character that does not occur in normal local parts.
16595 .cindex "multiple mailboxes"
16596 .cindex "mailbox" "multiple"
16597 Wildcarding can be used to set up multiple user mailboxes, as described in
16598 section &<<SECTmulbox>>&.
16600 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
16601 .vindex "&$local_part_prefix$&"
16602 During the testing of the &%local_parts%& option, and while the router is
16603 running, the prefix is removed from the local part, and is available in the
16604 expansion variable &$local_part_prefix$&. When a message is being delivered, if
16605 the router accepts the address, this remains true during subsequent delivery by
16606 a transport. In particular, the local part that is transmitted in the RCPT
16607 command for LMTP, SMTP, and BSMTP deliveries has the prefix removed by default.
16608 This behaviour can be overridden by setting &%rcpt_include_affixes%& true on
16609 the relevant transport.
16611 When an address is being verified, &%local_part_prefix%& affects only the
16612 behaviour of the router. If the callout feature of verification is in use, this
16613 means that the full address, including the prefix, will be used during the
16616 The prefix facility is commonly used to handle local parts of the form
16617 &%owner-something%&. Another common use is to support local parts of the form
16618 &%real-username%& to bypass a user's &_.forward_& file &-- helpful when trying
16619 to tell a user their forwarding is broken &-- by placing a router like this one
16620 immediately before the router that handles &_.forward_& files:
16624 local_part_prefix = real-
16626 transport = local_delivery
16628 For security, it would probably be a good idea to restrict the use of this
16629 router to locally-generated messages, using a condition such as this:
16631 condition = ${if match {$sender_host_address}\
16632 {\N^(|127\.0\.0\.1)$\N}}
16635 If both &%local_part_prefix%& and &%local_part_suffix%& are set for a router,
16636 both conditions must be met if not optional. Care must be taken if wildcards
16637 are used in both a prefix and a suffix on the same router. Different
16638 separator characters must be used to avoid ambiguity.
16641 .option local_part_prefix_optional routers boolean false
16642 See &%local_part_prefix%& above.
16646 .option local_part_suffix routers&!? "string list" unset
16647 .cindex "router" "suffix for local part"
16648 .cindex "suffix for local part" "used in router"
16649 This option operates in the same way as &%local_part_prefix%&, except that the
16650 local part must end (rather than start) with the given string, the
16651 &%local_part_suffix_optional%& option determines whether the suffix is
16652 mandatory, and the wildcard * character, if present, must be the last
16653 character of the suffix. This option facility is commonly used to handle local
16654 parts of the form &%something-request%& and multiple user mailboxes of the form
16658 .option local_part_suffix_optional routers boolean false
16659 See &%local_part_suffix%& above.
16663 .option local_parts routers&!? "local part list&!!" unset
16664 .cindex "router" "restricting to specific local parts"
16665 .cindex "local part" "checking in router"
16666 The router is run only if the local part of the address matches the list.
16667 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
16669 section &<<SECTlocparlis>>& for a discussion of local part lists. Because the
16670 string is expanded, it is possible to make it depend on the domain, for
16673 local_parts = dbm;/usr/local/specials/$domain
16675 .vindex "&$local_part_data$&"
16676 If the match is achieved by a lookup, the data that the lookup returned
16677 for the local part is placed in the variable &$local_part_data$& for use in
16678 expansions of the router's private options. You might use this option, for
16679 example, if you have a large number of local virtual domains, and you want to
16680 send all postmaster mail to the same place without having to set up an alias in
16681 each virtual domain:
16685 local_parts = postmaster
16686 data = postmaster@real.domain.example
16690 .option log_as_local routers boolean "see below"
16691 .cindex "log" "delivery line"
16692 .cindex "delivery" "log line format"
16693 Exim has two logging styles for delivery, the idea being to make local
16694 deliveries stand out more visibly from remote ones. In the &"local"& style, the
16695 recipient address is given just as the local part, without a domain. The use of
16696 this style is controlled by this option. It defaults to true for the &(accept)&
16697 router, and false for all the others. This option applies only when a
16698 router assigns an address to a transport. It has no effect on routers that
16699 redirect addresses.
16703 .option more routers boolean&!! true
16704 The result of string expansion for this option must be a valid boolean value,
16705 that is, one of the strings &"yes"&, &"no"&, &"true"&, or &"false"&. Any other
16706 result causes an error, and delivery is deferred. If the expansion is forced to
16707 fail, the default value for the option (true) is used. Other failures cause
16708 delivery to be deferred.
16710 If this option is set false, and the router declines to handle the address, no
16711 further routers are tried, routing fails, and the address is bounced.
16713 However, if the router explicitly passes an address to the following router by
16714 means of the setting
16718 or otherwise, the setting of &%more%& is ignored. Also, the setting of &%more%&
16719 does not affect the behaviour if one of the precondition tests fails. In that
16720 case, the address is always passed to the next router.
16722 Note that &%address_data%& is not considered to be a precondition. If its
16723 expansion is forced to fail, the router declines, and the value of &%more%&
16724 controls what happens next.
16727 .option pass_on_timeout routers boolean false
16728 .cindex "timeout" "of router"
16729 .cindex "router" "timeout"
16730 If a router times out during a host lookup, it normally causes deferral of the
16731 address. If &%pass_on_timeout%& is set, the address is passed on to the next
16732 router, overriding &%no_more%&. This may be helpful for systems that are
16733 intermittently connected to the Internet, or those that want to pass to a smart
16734 host any messages that cannot immediately be delivered.
16736 There are occasional other temporary errors that can occur while doing DNS
16737 lookups. They are treated in the same way as a timeout, and this option
16738 applies to all of them.
16742 .option pass_router routers string unset
16743 .cindex "router" "go to after &""pass""&"
16744 Routers that recognize the generic &%self%& option (&(dnslookup)&,
16745 &(ipliteral)&, and &(manualroute)&) are able to return &"pass"&, forcing
16746 routing to continue, and overriding a false setting of &%more%&. When one of
16747 these routers returns &"pass"&, the address is normally handed on to the next
16748 router in sequence. This can be changed by setting &%pass_router%& to the name
16749 of another router. However (unlike &%redirect_router%&) the named router must
16750 be below the current router, to avoid loops. Note that this option applies only
16751 to the special case of &"pass"&. It does not apply when a router returns
16752 &"decline"& because it cannot handle an address.
16756 .option redirect_router routers string unset
16757 .cindex "router" "start at after redirection"
16758 Sometimes an administrator knows that it is pointless to reprocess addresses
16759 generated from alias or forward files with the same router again. For
16760 example, if an alias file translates real names into login ids there is no
16761 point searching the alias file a second time, especially if it is a large file.
16763 The &%redirect_router%& option can be set to the name of any router instance.
16764 It causes the routing of any generated addresses to start at the named router
16765 instead of at the first router. This option has no effect if the router in
16766 which it is set does not generate new addresses.
16770 .option require_files routers&!? "string list&!!" unset
16771 .cindex "file" "requiring for router"
16772 .cindex "router" "requiring file existence"
16773 This option provides a general mechanism for predicating the running of a
16774 router on the existence or non-existence of certain files or directories.
16775 Before running a router, as one of its precondition tests, Exim works its way
16776 through the &%require_files%& list, expanding each item separately.
16778 Because the list is split before expansion, any colons in expansion items must
16779 be doubled, or the facility for using a different list separator must be used.
16780 If any expansion is forced to fail, the item is ignored. Other expansion
16781 failures cause routing of the address to be deferred.
16783 If any expanded string is empty, it is ignored. Otherwise, except as described
16784 below, each string must be a fully qualified file path, optionally preceded by
16785 &"!"&. The paths are passed to the &[stat()]& function to test for the
16786 existence of the files or directories. The router is skipped if any paths not
16787 preceded by &"!"& do not exist, or if any paths preceded by &"!"& do exist.
16790 If &[stat()]& cannot determine whether a file exists or not, delivery of
16791 the message is deferred. This can happen when NFS-mounted filesystems are
16794 This option is checked after the &%domains%&, &%local_parts%&, and &%senders%&
16795 options, so you cannot use it to check for the existence of a file in which to
16796 look up a domain, local part, or sender. (See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a
16797 full list of the order in which preconditions are evaluated.) However, as
16798 these options are all expanded, you can use the &%exists%& expansion condition
16799 to make such tests. The &%require_files%& option is intended for checking files
16800 that the router may be going to use internally, or which are needed by a
16801 transport (for example &_.procmailrc_&).
16803 During delivery, the &[stat()]& function is run as root, but there is a
16804 facility for some checking of the accessibility of a file by another user.
16805 This is not a proper permissions check, but just a &"rough"& check that
16806 operates as follows:
16808 If an item in a &%require_files%& list does not contain any forward slash
16809 characters, it is taken to be the user (and optional group, separated by a
16810 comma) to be checked for subsequent files in the list. If no group is specified
16811 but the user is specified symbolically, the gid associated with the uid is
16814 require_files = mail:/some/file
16815 require_files = $local_part:$home/.procmailrc
16817 If a user or group name in a &%require_files%& list does not exist, the
16818 &%require_files%& condition fails.
16820 Exim performs the check by scanning along the components of the file path, and
16821 checking the access for the given uid and gid. It checks for &"x"& access on
16822 directories, and &"r"& access on the final file. Note that this means that file
16823 access control lists, if the operating system has them, are ignored.
16825 &*Warning 1*&: When the router is being run to verify addresses for an
16826 incoming SMTP message, Exim is not running as root, but under its own uid. This
16827 may affect the result of a &%require_files%& check. In particular, &[stat()]&
16828 may yield the error EACCES (&"Permission denied"&). This means that the Exim
16829 user is not permitted to read one of the directories on the file's path.
16831 &*Warning 2*&: Even when Exim is running as root while delivering a message,
16832 &[stat()]& can yield EACCES for a file in an NFS directory that is mounted
16833 without root access. In this case, if a check for access by a particular user
16834 is requested, Exim creates a subprocess that runs as that user, and tries the
16835 check again in that process.
16837 The default action for handling an unresolved EACCES is to consider it to
16838 be caused by a configuration error, and routing is deferred because the
16839 existence or non-existence of the file cannot be determined. However, in some
16840 circumstances it may be desirable to treat this condition as if the file did
16841 not exist. If the file name (or the exclamation mark that precedes the file
16842 name for non-existence) is preceded by a plus sign, the EACCES error is treated
16843 as if the file did not exist. For example:
16845 require_files = +/some/file
16847 If the router is not an essential part of verification (for example, it
16848 handles users' &_.forward_& files), another solution is to set the &%verify%&
16849 option false so that the router is skipped when verifying.
16853 .option retry_use_local_part routers boolean "see below"
16854 .cindex "hints database" "retry keys"
16855 .cindex "local part" "in retry keys"
16856 When a delivery suffers a temporary routing failure, a retry record is created
16857 in Exim's hints database. For addresses whose routing depends only on the
16858 domain, the key for the retry record should not involve the local part, but for
16859 other addresses, both the domain and the local part should be included.
16860 Usually, remote routing is of the former kind, and local routing is of the
16863 This option controls whether the local part is used to form the key for retry
16864 hints for addresses that suffer temporary errors while being handled by this
16865 router. The default value is true for any router that has &%check_local_user%&
16866 set, and false otherwise. Note that this option does not apply to hints keys
16867 for transport delays; they are controlled by a generic transport option of the
16870 The setting of &%retry_use_local_part%& applies only to the router on which it
16871 appears. If the router generates child addresses, they are routed
16872 independently; this setting does not become attached to them.
16876 .option router_home_directory routers string&!! unset
16877 .cindex "router" "home directory for"
16878 .cindex "home directory" "for router"
16880 This option sets a home directory for use while the router is running. (Compare
16881 &%transport_home_directory%&, which sets a home directory for later
16882 transporting.) In particular, if used on a &(redirect)& router, this option
16883 sets a value for &$home$& while a filter is running. The value is expanded;
16884 forced expansion failure causes the option to be ignored &-- other failures
16885 cause the router to defer.
16887 Expansion of &%router_home_directory%& happens immediately after the
16888 &%check_local_user%& test (if configured), before any further expansions take
16890 (See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
16892 While the router is running, &%router_home_directory%& overrides the value of
16893 &$home$& that came from &%check_local_user%&.
16895 When a router accepts an address and assigns it to a local transport (including
16896 the cases when a &(redirect)& router generates a pipe, file, or autoreply
16897 delivery), the home directory setting for the transport is taken from the first
16898 of these values that is set:
16901 The &%home_directory%& option on the transport;
16903 The &%transport_home_directory%& option on the router;
16905 The password data if &%check_local_user%& is set on the router;
16907 The &%router_home_directory%& option on the router.
16910 In other words, &%router_home_directory%& overrides the password data for the
16911 router, but not for the transport.
16915 .option self routers string freeze
16916 .cindex "MX record" "pointing to local host"
16917 .cindex "local host" "MX pointing to"
16918 This option applies to those routers that use a recipient address to find a
16919 list of remote hosts. Currently, these are the &(dnslookup)&, &(ipliteral)&,
16920 and &(manualroute)& routers.
16921 Certain configurations of the &(queryprogram)& router can also specify a list
16923 Usually such routers are configured to send the message to a remote host via an
16924 &(smtp)& transport. The &%self%& option specifies what happens when the first
16925 host on the list turns out to be the local host.
16926 The way in which Exim checks for the local host is described in section
16927 &<<SECTreclocipadd>>&.
16929 Normally this situation indicates either an error in Exim's configuration (for
16930 example, the router should be configured not to process this domain), or an
16931 error in the DNS (for example, the MX should not point to this host). For this
16932 reason, the default action is to log the incident, defer the address, and
16933 freeze the message. The following alternatives are provided for use in special
16938 Delivery of the message is tried again later, but the message is not frozen.
16940 .vitem "&%reroute%&: <&'domain'&>"
16941 The domain is changed to the given domain, and the address is passed back to
16942 be reprocessed by the routers. No rewriting of headers takes place. This
16943 behaviour is essentially a redirection.
16945 .vitem "&%reroute: rewrite:%& <&'domain'&>"
16946 The domain is changed to the given domain, and the address is passed back to be
16947 reprocessed by the routers. Any headers that contain the original domain are
16952 .vindex "&$self_hostname$&"
16953 The router passes the address to the next router, or to the router named in the
16954 &%pass_router%& option if it is set. This overrides &%no_more%&. During
16955 subsequent routing and delivery, the variable &$self_hostname$& contains the
16956 name of the local host that the router encountered. This can be used to
16957 distinguish between different cases for hosts with multiple names. The
16963 ensures that only those addresses that routed to the local host are passed on.
16964 Without &%no_more%&, addresses that were declined for other reasons would also
16965 be passed to the next router.
16968 Delivery fails and an error report is generated.
16971 .cindex "local host" "sending to"
16972 The anomaly is ignored and the address is queued for the transport. This
16973 setting should be used with extreme caution. For an &(smtp)& transport, it
16974 makes sense only in cases where the program that is listening on the SMTP port
16975 is not this version of Exim. That is, it must be some other MTA, or Exim with a
16976 different configuration file that handles the domain in another way.
16981 .option senders routers&!? "address list&!!" unset
16982 .cindex "router" "checking senders"
16983 If this option is set, the router is skipped unless the message's sender
16984 address matches something on the list.
16985 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
16988 There are issues concerning verification when the running of routers is
16989 dependent on the sender. When Exim is verifying the address in an &%errors_to%&
16990 setting, it sets the sender to the null string. When using the &%-bt%& option
16991 to check a configuration file, it is necessary also to use the &%-f%& option to
16992 set an appropriate sender. For incoming mail, the sender is unset when
16993 verifying the sender, but is available when verifying any recipients. If the
16994 SMTP VRFY command is enabled, it must be used after MAIL if the sender address
16998 .option translate_ip_address routers string&!! unset
16999 .cindex "IP address" "translating"
17000 .cindex "packet radio"
17001 .cindex "router" "IP address translation"
17002 There exist some rare networking situations (for example, packet radio) where
17003 it is helpful to be able to translate IP addresses generated by normal routing
17004 mechanisms into other IP addresses, thus performing a kind of manual IP
17005 routing. This should be done only if the normal IP routing of the TCP/IP stack
17006 is inadequate or broken. Because this is an extremely uncommon requirement, the
17007 code to support this option is not included in the Exim binary unless
17008 SUPPORT_TRANSLATE_IP_ADDRESS=yes is set in &_Local/Makefile_&.
17010 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
17011 The &%translate_ip_address%& string is expanded for every IP address generated
17012 by the router, with the generated address set in &$host_address$&. If the
17013 expansion is forced to fail, no action is taken.
17014 For any other expansion error, delivery of the message is deferred.
17015 If the result of the expansion is an IP address, that replaces the original
17016 address; otherwise the result is assumed to be a host name &-- this is looked
17017 up using &[gethostbyname()]& (or &[getipnodebyname()]& when available) to
17018 produce one or more replacement IP addresses. For example, to subvert all IP
17019 addresses in some specific networks, this could be added to a router:
17021 translate_ip_address = \
17022 ${lookup{${mask:$host_address/26}}lsearch{/some/file}\
17025 The file would contain lines like
17027 10.2.3.128/26 some.host
17028 10.8.4.34/26 10.44.8.15
17030 You should not make use of this facility unless you really understand what you
17035 .option transport routers string&!! unset
17036 This option specifies the transport to be used when a router accepts an address
17037 and sets it up for delivery. A transport is never needed if a router is used
17038 only for verification. The value of the option is expanded at routing time,
17039 after the expansion of &%errors_to%&, &%headers_add%&, and &%headers_remove%&,
17040 and result must be the name of one of the configured transports. If it is not,
17041 delivery is deferred.
17043 The &%transport%& option is not used by the &(redirect)& router, but it does
17044 have some private options that set up transports for pipe and file deliveries
17045 (see chapter &<<CHAPredirect>>&).
17049 .option transport_current_directory routers string&!! unset
17050 .cindex "current directory for local transport"
17051 This option associates a current directory with any address that is routed
17052 to a local transport. This can happen either because a transport is
17053 explicitly configured for the router, or because it generates a delivery to a
17054 file or a pipe. During the delivery process (that is, at transport time), this
17055 option string is expanded and is set as the current directory, unless
17056 overridden by a setting on the transport.
17057 If the expansion fails for any reason, including forced failure, an error is
17058 logged, and delivery is deferred.
17059 See chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>& for details of the local delivery
17065 .option transport_home_directory routers string&!! "see below"
17066 .cindex "home directory" "for local transport"
17067 This option associates a home directory with any address that is routed to a
17068 local transport. This can happen either because a transport is explicitly
17069 configured for the router, or because it generates a delivery to a file or a
17070 pipe. During the delivery process (that is, at transport time), the option
17071 string is expanded and is set as the home directory, unless overridden by a
17072 setting of &%home_directory%& on the transport.
17073 If the expansion fails for any reason, including forced failure, an error is
17074 logged, and delivery is deferred.
17076 If the transport does not specify a home directory, and
17077 &%transport_home_directory%& is not set for the router, the home directory for
17078 the transport is taken from the password data if &%check_local_user%& is set for
17079 the router. Otherwise it is taken from &%router_home_directory%& if that option
17080 is set; if not, no home directory is set for the transport.
17082 See chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>& for further details of the local delivery
17088 .option unseen routers boolean&!! false
17089 .cindex "router" "carrying on after success"
17090 The result of string expansion for this option must be a valid boolean value,
17091 that is, one of the strings &"yes"&, &"no"&, &"true"&, or &"false"&. Any other
17092 result causes an error, and delivery is deferred. If the expansion is forced to
17093 fail, the default value for the option (false) is used. Other failures cause
17094 delivery to be deferred.
17096 When this option is set true, routing does not cease if the router accepts the
17097 address. Instead, a copy of the incoming address is passed to the next router,
17098 overriding a false setting of &%more%&. There is little point in setting
17099 &%more%& false if &%unseen%& is always true, but it may be useful in cases when
17100 the value of &%unseen%& contains expansion items (and therefore, presumably, is
17101 sometimes true and sometimes false).
17103 .cindex "copy of message (&%unseen%& option)"
17104 Setting the &%unseen%& option has a similar effect to the &%unseen%& command
17105 qualifier in filter files. It can be used to cause copies of messages to be
17106 delivered to some other destination, while also carrying out a normal delivery.
17107 In effect, the current address is made into a &"parent"& that has two children
17108 &-- one that is delivered as specified by this router, and a clone that goes on
17109 to be routed further. For this reason, &%unseen%& may not be combined with the
17110 &%one_time%& option in a &(redirect)& router.
17112 &*Warning*&: Header lines added to the address (or specified for removal) by
17113 this router or by previous routers affect the &"unseen"& copy of the message
17114 only. The clone that continues to be processed by further routers starts with
17115 no added headers and none specified for removal. For a &%redirect%& router, if
17116 a generated address is the same as the incoming address, this can lead to
17117 duplicate addresses with different header modifications. Exim does not do
17118 duplicate deliveries (except, in certain circumstances, to pipes -- see section
17119 &<<SECTdupaddr>>&), but it is undefined which of the duplicates is discarded,
17120 so this ambiguous situation should be avoided. The &%repeat_use%& option of the
17121 &%redirect%& router may be of help.
17123 Unlike the handling of header modifications, any data that was set by the
17124 &%address_data%& option in the current or previous routers &'is'& passed on to
17125 subsequent routers.
17128 .option user routers string&!! "see below"
17129 .cindex "uid (user id)" "local delivery"
17130 .cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
17131 .cindex "transport" "local"
17132 .cindex "router" "user for filter processing"
17133 .cindex "filter" "user for processing"
17134 When a router queues an address for a transport, and the transport does not
17135 specify a user, the user given here is used when running the delivery process.
17136 The user may be specified numerically or by name. If expansion fails, the
17137 error is logged and delivery is deferred.
17138 This user is also used by the &(redirect)& router when running a filter file.
17139 The default is unset, except when &%check_local_user%& is set. In this case,
17140 the default is taken from the password information. If the user is specified as
17141 a name, and &%group%& is not set, the group associated with the user is used.
17142 See also &%initgroups%& and &%group%& and the discussion in chapter
17143 &<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
17147 .option verify routers&!? boolean true
17148 Setting this option has the effect of setting &%verify_sender%& and
17149 &%verify_recipient%& to the same value.
17152 .option verify_only routers&!? boolean false
17153 .cindex "EXPN" "with &%verify_only%&"
17155 .cindex "router" "used only when verifying"
17156 If this option is set, the router is used only when verifying an address or
17157 testing with the &%-bv%& option, not when actually doing a delivery, testing
17158 with the &%-bt%& option, or running the SMTP EXPN command. It can be further
17159 restricted to verifying only senders or recipients by means of
17160 &%verify_sender%& and &%verify_recipient%&.
17162 &*Warning*&: When the router is being run to verify addresses for an incoming
17163 SMTP message, Exim is not running as root, but under its own uid. If the router
17164 accesses any files, you need to make sure that they are accessible to the Exim
17168 .option verify_recipient routers&!? boolean true
17169 If this option is false, the router is skipped when verifying recipient
17171 or testing recipient verification using &%-bv%&.
17172 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
17176 .option verify_sender routers&!? boolean true
17177 If this option is false, the router is skipped when verifying sender addresses
17178 or testing sender verification using &%-bvs%&.
17179 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
17181 .ecindex IIDgenoprou1
17182 .ecindex IIDgenoprou2
17189 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
17190 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
17192 .chapter "The accept router" "CHID4"
17193 .cindex "&(accept)& router"
17194 .cindex "routers" "&(accept)&"
17195 The &(accept)& router has no private options of its own. Unless it is being
17196 used purely for verification (see &%verify_only%&) a transport is required to
17197 be defined by the generic &%transport%& option. If the preconditions that are
17198 specified by generic options are met, the router accepts the address and queues
17199 it for the given transport. The most common use of this router is for setting
17200 up deliveries to local mailboxes. For example:
17204 domains = mydomain.example
17206 transport = local_delivery
17208 The &%domains%& condition in this example checks the domain of the address, and
17209 &%check_local_user%& checks that the local part is the login of a local user.
17210 When both preconditions are met, the &(accept)& router runs, and queues the
17211 address for the &(local_delivery)& transport.
17218 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
17219 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
17221 .chapter "The dnslookup router" "CHAPdnslookup"
17222 .scindex IIDdnsrou1 "&(dnslookup)& router"
17223 .scindex IIDdnsrou2 "routers" "&(dnslookup)&"
17224 The &(dnslookup)& router looks up the hosts that handle mail for the
17225 recipient's domain in the DNS. A transport must always be set for this router,
17226 unless &%verify_only%& is set.
17228 If SRV support is configured (see &%check_srv%& below), Exim first searches for
17229 SRV records. If none are found, or if SRV support is not configured,
17230 MX records are looked up. If no MX records exist, address records are sought.
17231 However, &%mx_domains%& can be set to disable the direct use of address
17234 MX records of equal priority are sorted by Exim into a random order. Exim then
17235 looks for address records for the host names obtained from MX or SRV records.
17236 When a host has more than one IP address, they are sorted into a random order,
17237 except that IPv6 addresses are always sorted before IPv4 addresses. If all the
17238 IP addresses found are discarded by a setting of the &%ignore_target_hosts%&
17239 generic option, the router declines.
17241 Unless they have the highest priority (lowest MX value), MX records that point
17242 to the local host, or to any host name that matches &%hosts_treat_as_local%&,
17243 are discarded, together with any other MX records of equal or lower priority.
17245 .cindex "MX record" "pointing to local host"
17246 .cindex "local host" "MX pointing to"
17247 .oindex "&%self%&" "in &(dnslookup)& router"
17248 If the host pointed to by the highest priority MX record, or looked up as an
17249 address record, is the local host, or matches &%hosts_treat_as_local%&, what
17250 happens is controlled by the generic &%self%& option.
17253 .section "Problems with DNS lookups" "SECTprowitdnsloo"
17254 There have been problems with DNS servers when SRV records are looked up.
17255 Some mis-behaving servers return a DNS error or timeout when a non-existent
17256 SRV record is sought. Similar problems have in the past been reported for
17257 MX records. The global &%dns_again_means_nonexist%& option can help with this
17258 problem, but it is heavy-handed because it is a global option.
17260 For this reason, there are two options, &%srv_fail_domains%& and
17261 &%mx_fail_domains%&, that control what happens when a DNS lookup in a
17262 &(dnslookup)& router results in a DNS failure or a &"try again"& response. If
17263 an attempt to look up an SRV or MX record causes one of these results, and the
17264 domain matches the relevant list, Exim behaves as if the DNS had responded &"no
17265 such record"&. In the case of an SRV lookup, this means that the router
17266 proceeds to look for MX records; in the case of an MX lookup, it proceeds to
17267 look for A or AAAA records, unless the domain matches &%mx_domains%&, in which
17268 case routing fails.
17271 .section "Declining addresses by dnslookup" "SECTdnslookupdecline"
17272 .cindex "&(dnslookup)& router" "declines"
17273 There are a few cases where a &(dnslookup)& router will decline to accept
17274 an address; if such a router is expected to handle "all remaining non-local
17275 domains", then it is important to set &%no_more%&.
17277 Reasons for a &(dnslookup)& router to decline currently include:
17279 The domain does not exist in DNS
17281 The domain exists but the MX record's host part is just "."; this is a common
17282 convention (borrowed from SRV) used to indicate that there is no such service
17283 for this domain and to not fall back to trying A/AAAA records.
17285 Ditto, but for SRV records, when &%check_srv%& is set on this router.
17287 MX record points to a non-existent host.
17289 MX record points to an IP address and the main section option
17290 &%allow_mx_to_ip%& is not set.
17292 MX records exist and point to valid hosts, but all hosts resolve only to
17293 addresses blocked by the &%ignore_target_hosts%& generic option on this router.
17295 The domain is not syntactically valid (see also &%allow_utf8_domains%& and
17296 &%dns_check_names_pattern%& for handling one variant of this)
17298 &%check_secondary_mx%& is set on this router but the local host can
17299 not be found in the MX records (see below)
17305 .section "Private options for dnslookup" "SECID118"
17306 .cindex "options" "&(dnslookup)& router"
17307 The private options for the &(dnslookup)& router are as follows:
17309 .option check_secondary_mx dnslookup boolean false
17310 .cindex "MX record" "checking for secondary"
17311 If this option is set, the router declines unless the local host is found in
17312 (and removed from) the list of hosts obtained by MX lookup. This can be used to
17313 process domains for which the local host is a secondary mail exchanger
17314 differently to other domains. The way in which Exim decides whether a host is
17315 the local host is described in section &<<SECTreclocipadd>>&.
17318 .option check_srv dnslookup string&!! unset
17319 .cindex "SRV record" "enabling use of"
17320 The &(dnslookup)& router supports the use of SRV records (see RFC 2782) in
17321 addition to MX and address records. The support is disabled by default. To
17322 enable SRV support, set the &%check_srv%& option to the name of the service
17323 required. For example,
17327 looks for SRV records that refer to the normal smtp service. The option is
17328 expanded, so the service name can vary from message to message or address
17329 to address. This might be helpful if SRV records are being used for a
17330 submission service. If the expansion is forced to fail, the &%check_srv%&
17331 option is ignored, and the router proceeds to look for MX records in the
17334 When the expansion succeeds, the router searches first for SRV records for
17335 the given service (it assumes TCP protocol). A single SRV record with a
17336 host name that consists of just a single dot indicates &"no such service for
17337 this domain"&; if this is encountered, the router declines. If other kinds of
17338 SRV record are found, they are used to construct a host list for delivery
17339 according to the rules of RFC 2782. MX records are not sought in this case.
17341 When no SRV records are found, MX records (and address records) are sought in
17342 the traditional way. In other words, SRV records take precedence over MX
17343 records, just as MX records take precedence over address records. Note that
17344 this behaviour is not sanctioned by RFC 2782, though a previous draft RFC
17345 defined it. It is apparently believed that MX records are sufficient for email
17346 and that SRV records should not be used for this purpose. However, SRV records
17347 have an additional &"weight"& feature which some people might find useful when
17348 trying to split an SMTP load between hosts of different power.
17350 See section &<<SECTprowitdnsloo>>& above for a discussion of Exim's behaviour
17351 when there is a DNS lookup error.
17355 .option mx_domains dnslookup "domain list&!!" unset
17356 .cindex "MX record" "required to exist"
17357 .cindex "SRV record" "required to exist"
17358 A domain that matches &%mx_domains%& is required to have either an MX or an SRV
17359 record in order to be recognized. (The name of this option could be improved.)
17360 For example, if all the mail hosts in &'fict.example'& are known to have MX
17361 records, except for those in &'discworld.fict.example'&, you could use this
17364 mx_domains = ! *.discworld.fict.example : *.fict.example
17366 This specifies that messages addressed to a domain that matches the list but
17367 has no MX record should be bounced immediately instead of being routed using
17368 the address record.
17371 .option mx_fail_domains dnslookup "domain list&!!" unset
17372 If the DNS lookup for MX records for one of the domains in this list causes a
17373 DNS lookup error, Exim behaves as if no MX records were found. See section
17374 &<<SECTprowitdnsloo>>& for more discussion.
17379 .option qualify_single dnslookup boolean true
17380 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
17381 .cindex "DNS" "qualifying single-component names"
17382 When this option is true, the resolver option RES_DEFNAMES is set for DNS
17383 lookups. Typically, but not standardly, this causes the resolver to qualify
17384 single-component names with the default domain. For example, on a machine
17385 called &'dictionary.ref.example'&, the domain &'thesaurus'& would be changed to
17386 &'thesaurus.ref.example'& inside the resolver. For details of what your
17387 resolver actually does, consult your man pages for &'resolver'& and
17392 .option rewrite_headers dnslookup boolean true
17393 .cindex "rewriting" "header lines"
17394 .cindex "header lines" "rewriting"
17395 If the domain name in the address that is being processed is not fully
17396 qualified, it may be expanded to its full form by a DNS lookup. For example, if
17397 an address is specified as &'dormouse@teaparty'&, the domain might be
17398 expanded to &'teaparty.wonderland.fict.example'&. Domain expansion can also
17399 occur as a result of setting the &%widen_domains%& option. If
17400 &%rewrite_headers%& is true, all occurrences of the abbreviated domain name in
17401 any &'Bcc:'&, &'Cc:'&, &'From:'&, &'Reply-to:'&, &'Sender:'&, and &'To:'&
17402 header lines of the message are rewritten with the full domain name.
17404 This option should be turned off only when it is known that no message is
17405 ever going to be sent outside an environment where the abbreviation makes
17408 When an MX record is looked up in the DNS and matches a wildcard record, name
17409 servers normally return a record containing the name that has been looked up,
17410 making it impossible to detect whether a wildcard was present or not. However,
17411 some name servers have recently been seen to return the wildcard entry. If the
17412 name returned by a DNS lookup begins with an asterisk, it is not used for
17416 .option same_domain_copy_routing dnslookup boolean false
17417 .cindex "address" "copying routing"
17418 Addresses with the same domain are normally routed by the &(dnslookup)& router
17419 to the same list of hosts. However, this cannot be presumed, because the router
17420 options and preconditions may refer to the local part of the address. By
17421 default, therefore, Exim routes each address in a message independently. DNS
17422 servers run caches, so repeated DNS lookups are not normally expensive, and in
17423 any case, personal messages rarely have more than a few recipients.
17425 If you are running mailing lists with large numbers of subscribers at the same
17426 domain, and you are using a &(dnslookup)& router which is independent of the
17427 local part, you can set &%same_domain_copy_routing%& to bypass repeated DNS
17428 lookups for identical domains in one message. In this case, when &(dnslookup)&
17429 routes an address to a remote transport, any other unrouted addresses in the
17430 message that have the same domain are automatically given the same routing
17431 without processing them independently,
17432 provided the following conditions are met:
17435 No router that processed the address specified &%headers_add%& or
17436 &%headers_remove%&.
17438 The router did not change the address in any way, for example, by &"widening"&
17445 .option search_parents dnslookup boolean false
17446 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
17447 When this option is true, the resolver option RES_DNSRCH is set for DNS
17448 lookups. This is different from the &%qualify_single%& option in that it
17449 applies to domains containing dots. Typically, but not standardly, it causes
17450 the resolver to search for the name in the current domain and in parent
17451 domains. For example, on a machine in the &'fict.example'& domain, if looking
17452 up &'teaparty.wonderland'& failed, the resolver would try
17453 &'teaparty.wonderland.fict.example'&. For details of what your resolver
17454 actually does, consult your man pages for &'resolver'& and &'resolv.conf'&.
17456 Setting this option true can cause problems in domains that have a wildcard MX
17457 record, because any domain that does not have its own MX record matches the
17462 .option srv_fail_domains dnslookup "domain list&!!" unset
17463 If the DNS lookup for SRV records for one of the domains in this list causes a
17464 DNS lookup error, Exim behaves as if no SRV records were found. See section
17465 &<<SECTprowitdnsloo>>& for more discussion.
17470 .option widen_domains dnslookup "string list" unset
17471 .cindex "domain" "partial; widening"
17472 If a DNS lookup fails and this option is set, each of its strings in turn is
17473 added onto the end of the domain, and the lookup is tried again. For example,
17476 widen_domains = fict.example:ref.example
17478 is set and a lookup of &'klingon.dictionary'& fails,
17479 &'klingon.dictionary.fict.example'& is looked up, and if this fails,
17480 &'klingon.dictionary.ref.example'& is tried. Note that the &%qualify_single%&
17481 and &%search_parents%& options can cause some widening to be undertaken inside
17482 the DNS resolver. &%widen_domains%& is not applied to sender addresses
17483 when verifying, unless &%rewrite_headers%& is false (not the default).
17486 .section "Effect of qualify_single and search_parents" "SECID119"
17487 When a domain from an envelope recipient is changed by the resolver as a result
17488 of the &%qualify_single%& or &%search_parents%& options, Exim rewrites the
17489 corresponding address in the message's header lines unless &%rewrite_headers%&
17490 is set false. Exim then re-routes the address, using the full domain.
17492 These two options affect only the DNS lookup that takes place inside the router
17493 for the domain of the address that is being routed. They do not affect lookups
17494 such as that implied by
17498 that may happen while processing a router precondition before the router is
17499 entered. No widening ever takes place for these lookups.
17500 .ecindex IIDdnsrou1
17501 .ecindex IIDdnsrou2
17511 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
17512 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
17514 .chapter "The ipliteral router" "CHID5"
17515 .cindex "&(ipliteral)& router"
17516 .cindex "domain literal" "routing"
17517 .cindex "routers" "&(ipliteral)&"
17518 This router has no private options. Unless it is being used purely for
17519 verification (see &%verify_only%&) a transport is required to be defined by the
17520 generic &%transport%& option. The router accepts the address if its domain part
17521 takes the form of an RFC 2822 domain literal. For example, the &(ipliteral)&
17522 router handles the address
17526 by setting up delivery to the host with that IP address. IPv4 domain literals
17527 consist of an IPv4 address enclosed in square brackets. IPv6 domain literals
17528 are similar, but the address is preceded by &`ipv6:`&. For example:
17530 postmaster@[ipv6:fe80::a00:20ff:fe86:a061.5678]
17532 Exim allows &`ipv4:`& before IPv4 addresses, for consistency, and on the
17533 grounds that sooner or later somebody will try it.
17535 .oindex "&%self%&" "in &(ipliteral)& router"
17536 If the IP address matches something in &%ignore_target_hosts%&, the router
17537 declines. If an IP literal turns out to refer to the local host, the generic
17538 &%self%& option determines what happens.
17540 The RFCs require support for domain literals; however, their use is
17541 controversial in today's Internet. If you want to use this router, you must
17542 also set the main configuration option &%allow_domain_literals%&. Otherwise,
17543 Exim will not recognize the domain literal syntax in addresses.
17547 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
17548 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
17550 .chapter "The iplookup router" "CHID6"
17551 .cindex "&(iplookup)& router"
17552 .cindex "routers" "&(iplookup)&"
17553 The &(iplookup)& router was written to fulfil a specific requirement in
17554 Cambridge University (which in fact no longer exists). For this reason, it is
17555 not included in the binary of Exim by default. If you want to include it, you
17558 ROUTER_IPLOOKUP=yes
17560 in your &_Local/Makefile_& configuration file.
17562 The &(iplookup)& router routes an address by sending it over a TCP or UDP
17563 connection to one or more specific hosts. The host can then return the same or
17564 a different address &-- in effect rewriting the recipient address in the
17565 message's envelope. The new address is then passed on to subsequent routers. If
17566 this process fails, the address can be passed on to other routers, or delivery
17567 can be deferred. Since &(iplookup)& is just a rewriting router, a transport
17568 must not be specified for it.
17570 .cindex "options" "&(iplookup)& router"
17571 .option hosts iplookup string unset
17572 This option must be supplied. Its value is a colon-separated list of host
17573 names. The hosts are looked up using &[gethostbyname()]&
17574 (or &[getipnodebyname()]& when available)
17575 and are tried in order until one responds to the query. If none respond, what
17576 happens is controlled by &%optional%&.
17579 .option optional iplookup boolean false
17580 If &%optional%& is true, if no response is obtained from any host, the address
17581 is passed to the next router, overriding &%no_more%&. If &%optional%& is false,
17582 delivery to the address is deferred.
17585 .option port iplookup integer 0
17586 .cindex "port" "&(iplookup)& router"
17587 This option must be supplied. It specifies the port number for the TCP or UDP
17591 .option protocol iplookup string udp
17592 This option can be set to &"udp"& or &"tcp"& to specify which of the two
17593 protocols is to be used.
17596 .option query iplookup string&!! "see below"
17597 This defines the content of the query that is sent to the remote hosts. The
17600 $local_part@$domain $local_part@$domain
17602 The repetition serves as a way of checking that a response is to the correct
17603 query in the default case (see &%response_pattern%& below).
17606 .option reroute iplookup string&!! unset
17607 If this option is not set, the rerouted address is precisely the byte string
17608 returned by the remote host, up to the first white space, if any. If set, the
17609 string is expanded to form the rerouted address. It can include parts matched
17610 in the response by &%response_pattern%& by means of numeric variables such as
17611 &$1$&, &$2$&, etc. The variable &$0$& refers to the entire input string,
17612 whether or not a pattern is in use. In all cases, the rerouted address must end
17613 up in the form &'local_part@domain'&.
17616 .option response_pattern iplookup string unset
17617 This option can be set to a regular expression that is applied to the string
17618 returned from the remote host. If the pattern does not match the response, the
17619 router declines. If &%response_pattern%& is not set, no checking of the
17620 response is done, unless the query was defaulted, in which case there is a
17621 check that the text returned after the first white space is the original
17622 address. This checks that the answer that has been received is in response to
17623 the correct question. For example, if the response is just a new domain, the
17624 following could be used:
17626 response_pattern = ^([^@]+)$
17627 reroute = $local_part@$1
17630 .option timeout iplookup time 5s
17631 This specifies the amount of time to wait for a response from the remote
17632 machine. The same timeout is used for the &[connect()]& function for a TCP
17633 call. It does not apply to UDP.
17638 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
17639 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
17641 .chapter "The manualroute router" "CHID7"
17642 .scindex IIDmanrou1 "&(manualroute)& router"
17643 .scindex IIDmanrou2 "routers" "&(manualroute)&"
17644 .cindex "domain" "manually routing"
17645 The &(manualroute)& router is so-called because it provides a way of manually
17646 routing an address according to its domain. It is mainly used when you want to
17647 route addresses to remote hosts according to your own rules, bypassing the
17648 normal DNS routing that looks up MX records. However, &(manualroute)& can also
17649 route to local transports, a facility that may be useful if you want to save
17650 messages for dial-in hosts in local files.
17652 The &(manualroute)& router compares a list of domain patterns with the domain
17653 it is trying to route. If there is no match, the router declines. Each pattern
17654 has associated with it a list of hosts and some other optional data, which may
17655 include a transport. The combination of a pattern and its data is called a
17656 &"routing rule"&. For patterns that do not have an associated transport, the
17657 generic &%transport%& option must specify a transport, unless the router is
17658 being used purely for verification (see &%verify_only%&).
17661 In the case of verification, matching the domain pattern is sufficient for the
17662 router to accept the address. When actually routing an address for delivery,
17663 an address that matches a domain pattern is queued for the associated
17664 transport. If the transport is not a local one, a host list must be associated
17665 with the pattern; IP addresses are looked up for the hosts, and these are
17666 passed to the transport along with the mail address. For local transports, a
17667 host list is optional. If it is present, it is passed in &$host$& as a single
17670 The list of routing rules can be provided as an inline string in
17671 &%route_list%&, or the data can be obtained by looking up the domain in a file
17672 or database by setting &%route_data%&. Only one of these settings may appear in
17673 any one instance of &(manualroute)&. The format of routing rules is described
17674 below, following the list of private options.
17677 .section "Private options for manualroute" "SECTprioptman"
17679 .cindex "options" "&(manualroute)& router"
17680 The private options for the &(manualroute)& router are as follows:
17682 .option host_all_ignored manualroute string defer
17683 See &%host_find_failed%&.
17685 .option host_find_failed manualroute string freeze
17686 This option controls what happens when &(manualroute)& tries to find an IP
17687 address for a host, and the host does not exist. The option can be set to one
17688 of the following values:
17697 The default (&"freeze"&) assumes that this state is a serious configuration
17698 error. The difference between &"pass"& and &"decline"& is that the former
17699 forces the address to be passed to the next router (or the router defined by
17702 overriding &%no_more%&, whereas the latter passes the address to the next
17703 router only if &%more%& is true.
17705 The value &"ignore"& causes Exim to completely ignore a host whose IP address
17706 cannot be found. If all the hosts in the list are ignored, the behaviour is
17707 controlled by the &%host_all_ignored%& option. This takes the same values
17708 as &%host_find_failed%&, except that it cannot be set to &"ignore"&.
17710 The &%host_find_failed%& option applies only to a definite &"does not exist"&
17711 state; if a host lookup gets a temporary error, delivery is deferred unless the
17712 generic &%pass_on_timeout%& option is set.
17715 .option hosts_randomize manualroute boolean false
17716 .cindex "randomized host list"
17717 .cindex "host" "list of; randomized"
17718 If this option is set, the order of the items in a host list in a routing rule
17719 is randomized each time the list is used, unless an option in the routing rule
17720 overrides (see below). Randomizing the order of a host list can be used to do
17721 crude load sharing. However, if more than one mail address is routed by the
17722 same router to the same host list, the host lists are considered to be the same
17723 (even though they may be randomized into different orders) for the purpose of
17724 deciding whether to batch the deliveries into a single SMTP transaction.
17726 When &%hosts_randomize%& is true, a host list may be split
17727 into groups whose order is separately randomized. This makes it possible to
17728 set up MX-like behaviour. The boundaries between groups are indicated by an
17729 item that is just &`+`& in the host list. For example:
17731 route_list = * host1:host2:host3:+:host4:host5
17733 The order of the first three hosts and the order of the last two hosts is
17734 randomized for each use, but the first three always end up before the last two.
17735 If &%hosts_randomize%& is not set, a &`+`& item in the list is ignored. If a
17736 randomized host list is passed to an &(smtp)& transport that also has
17737 &%hosts_randomize set%&, the list is not re-randomized.
17740 .option route_data manualroute string&!! unset
17741 If this option is set, it must expand to yield the data part of a routing rule.
17742 Typically, the expansion string includes a lookup based on the domain. For
17745 route_data = ${lookup{$domain}dbm{/etc/routes}}
17747 If the expansion is forced to fail, or the result is an empty string, the
17748 router declines. Other kinds of expansion failure cause delivery to be
17752 .option route_list manualroute "string list" unset
17753 This string is a list of routing rules, in the form defined below. Note that,
17754 unlike most string lists, the items are separated by semicolons. This is so
17755 that they may contain colon-separated host lists.
17758 .option same_domain_copy_routing manualroute boolean false
17759 .cindex "address" "copying routing"
17760 Addresses with the same domain are normally routed by the &(manualroute)&
17761 router to the same list of hosts. However, this cannot be presumed, because the
17762 router options and preconditions may refer to the local part of the address. By
17763 default, therefore, Exim routes each address in a message independently. DNS
17764 servers run caches, so repeated DNS lookups are not normally expensive, and in
17765 any case, personal messages rarely have more than a few recipients.
17767 If you are running mailing lists with large numbers of subscribers at the same
17768 domain, and you are using a &(manualroute)& router which is independent of the
17769 local part, you can set &%same_domain_copy_routing%& to bypass repeated DNS
17770 lookups for identical domains in one message. In this case, when
17771 &(manualroute)& routes an address to a remote transport, any other unrouted
17772 addresses in the message that have the same domain are automatically given the
17773 same routing without processing them independently. However, this is only done
17774 if &%headers_add%& and &%headers_remove%& are unset.
17779 .section "Routing rules in route_list" "SECID120"
17780 The value of &%route_list%& is a string consisting of a sequence of routing
17781 rules, separated by semicolons. If a semicolon is needed in a rule, it can be
17782 entered as two semicolons. Alternatively, the list separator can be changed as
17783 described (for colon-separated lists) in section &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&.
17784 Empty rules are ignored. The format of each rule is
17786 <&'domain pattern'&> <&'list of hosts'&> <&'options'&>
17788 The following example contains two rules, each with a simple domain pattern and
17792 dict.ref.example mail-1.ref.example:mail-2.ref.example ; \
17793 thes.ref.example mail-3.ref.example:mail-4.ref.example
17795 The three parts of a rule are separated by white space. The pattern and the
17796 list of hosts can be enclosed in quotes if necessary, and if they are, the
17797 usual quoting rules apply. Each rule in a &%route_list%& must start with a
17798 single domain pattern, which is the only mandatory item in the rule. The
17799 pattern is in the same format as one item in a domain list (see section
17800 &<<SECTdomainlist>>&),
17801 except that it may not be the name of an interpolated file.
17802 That is, it may be wildcarded, or a regular expression, or a file or database
17803 lookup (with semicolons doubled, because of the use of semicolon as a separator
17804 in a &%route_list%&).
17806 The rules in &%route_list%& are searched in order until one of the patterns
17807 matches the domain that is being routed. The list of hosts and then options are
17808 then used as described below. If there is no match, the router declines. When
17809 &%route_list%& is set, &%route_data%& must not be set.
17813 .section "Routing rules in route_data" "SECID121"
17814 The use of &%route_list%& is convenient when there are only a small number of
17815 routing rules. For larger numbers, it is easier to use a file or database to
17816 hold the routing information, and use the &%route_data%& option instead.
17817 The value of &%route_data%& is a list of hosts, followed by (optional) options.
17818 Most commonly, &%route_data%& is set as a string that contains an
17819 expansion lookup. For example, suppose we place two routing rules in a file
17822 dict.ref.example: mail-1.ref.example:mail-2.ref.example
17823 thes.ref.example: mail-3.ref.example:mail-4.ref.example
17825 This data can be accessed by setting
17827 route_data = ${lookup{$domain}lsearch{/the/file/name}}
17829 Failure of the lookup results in an empty string, causing the router to
17830 decline. However, you do not have to use a lookup in &%route_data%&. The only
17831 requirement is that the result of expanding the string is a list of hosts,
17832 possibly followed by options, separated by white space. The list of hosts must
17833 be enclosed in quotes if it contains white space.
17838 .section "Format of the list of hosts" "SECID122"
17839 A list of hosts, whether obtained via &%route_data%& or &%route_list%&, is
17840 always separately expanded before use. If the expansion fails, the router
17841 declines. The result of the expansion must be a colon-separated list of names
17842 and/or IP addresses, optionally also including ports. The format of each item
17843 in the list is described in the next section. The list separator can be changed
17844 as described in section &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&.
17846 If the list of hosts was obtained from a &%route_list%& item, the following
17847 variables are set during its expansion:
17850 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &(manualroute)& router"
17851 If the domain was matched against a regular expression, the numeric variables
17852 &$1$&, &$2$&, etc. may be set. For example:
17854 route_list = ^domain(\d+) host-$1.text.example
17857 &$0$& is always set to the entire domain.
17859 &$1$& is also set when partial matching is done in a file lookup.
17862 .vindex "&$value$&"
17863 If the pattern that matched the domain was a lookup item, the data that was
17864 looked up is available in the expansion variable &$value$&. For example:
17866 route_list = lsearch;;/some/file.routes $value
17870 Note the doubling of the semicolon in the pattern that is necessary because
17871 semicolon is the default route list separator.
17875 .section "Format of one host item" "SECTformatonehostitem"
17876 Each item in the list of hosts is either a host name or an IP address,
17877 optionally with an attached port number. When no port is given, an IP address
17878 is not enclosed in brackets. When a port is specified, it overrides the port
17879 specification on the transport. The port is separated from the name or address
17880 by a colon. This leads to some complications:
17883 Because colon is the default separator for the list of hosts, either
17884 the colon that specifies a port must be doubled, or the list separator must
17885 be changed. The following two examples have the same effect:
17887 route_list = * "host1.tld::1225 : host2.tld::1226"
17888 route_list = * "<+ host1.tld:1225 + host2.tld:1226"
17891 When IPv6 addresses are involved, it gets worse, because they contain
17892 colons of their own. To make this case easier, it is permitted to
17893 enclose an IP address (either v4 or v6) in square brackets if a port
17894 number follows. For example:
17896 route_list = * "</ [10.1.1.1]:1225 / [::1]:1226"
17900 .section "How the list of hosts is used" "SECThostshowused"
17901 When an address is routed to an &(smtp)& transport by &(manualroute)&, each of
17902 the hosts is tried, in the order specified, when carrying out the SMTP
17903 delivery. However, the order can be changed by setting the &%hosts_randomize%&
17904 option, either on the router (see section &<<SECTprioptman>>& above), or on the
17907 Hosts may be listed by name or by IP address. An unadorned name in the list of
17908 hosts is interpreted as a host name. A name that is followed by &`/MX`& is
17909 interpreted as an indirection to a sublist of hosts obtained by looking up MX
17910 records in the DNS. For example:
17912 route_list = * x.y.z:p.q.r/MX:e.f.g
17914 If this feature is used with a port specifier, the port must come last. For
17917 route_list = * dom1.tld/mx::1225
17919 If the &%hosts_randomize%& option is set, the order of the items in the list is
17920 randomized before any lookups are done. Exim then scans the list; for any name
17921 that is not followed by &`/MX`& it looks up an IP address. If this turns out to
17922 be an interface on the local host and the item is not the first in the list,
17923 Exim discards it and any subsequent items. If it is the first item, what
17924 happens is controlled by the
17925 .oindex "&%self%&" "in &(manualroute)& router"
17926 &%self%& option of the router.
17928 A name on the list that is followed by &`/MX`& is replaced with the list of
17929 hosts obtained by looking up MX records for the name. This is always a DNS
17930 lookup; the &%bydns%& and &%byname%& options (see section &<<SECThowoptused>>&
17931 below) are not relevant here. The order of these hosts is determined by the
17932 preference values in the MX records, according to the usual rules. Because
17933 randomizing happens before the MX lookup, it does not affect the order that is
17934 defined by MX preferences.
17936 If the local host is present in the sublist obtained from MX records, but is
17937 not the most preferred host in that list, it and any equally or less
17938 preferred hosts are removed before the sublist is inserted into the main list.
17940 If the local host is the most preferred host in the MX list, what happens
17941 depends on where in the original list of hosts the &`/MX`& item appears. If it
17942 is not the first item (that is, there are previous hosts in the main list),
17943 Exim discards this name and any subsequent items in the main list.
17945 If the MX item is first in the list of hosts, and the local host is the
17946 most preferred host, what happens is controlled by the &%self%& option of the
17949 DNS failures when lookup up the MX records are treated in the same way as DNS
17950 failures when looking up IP addresses: &%pass_on_timeout%& and
17951 &%host_find_failed%& are used when relevant.
17953 The generic &%ignore_target_hosts%& option applies to all hosts in the list,
17954 whether obtained from an MX lookup or not.
17958 .section "How the options are used" "SECThowoptused"
17959 The options are a sequence of words; in practice no more than three are ever
17960 present. One of the words can be the name of a transport; this overrides the
17961 &%transport%& option on the router for this particular routing rule only. The
17962 other words (if present) control randomization of the list of hosts on a
17963 per-rule basis, and how the IP addresses of the hosts are to be found when
17964 routing to a remote transport. These options are as follows:
17967 &%randomize%&: randomize the order of the hosts in this list, overriding the
17968 setting of &%hosts_randomize%& for this routing rule only.
17970 &%no_randomize%&: do not randomize the order of the hosts in this list,
17971 overriding the setting of &%hosts_randomize%& for this routing rule only.
17973 &%byname%&: use &[getipnodebyname()]& (&[gethostbyname()]& on older systems) to
17974 find IP addresses. This function may ultimately cause a DNS lookup, but it may
17975 also look in &_/etc/hosts_& or other sources of information.
17977 &%bydns%&: look up address records for the hosts directly in the DNS; fail if
17978 no address records are found. If there is a temporary DNS error (such as a
17979 timeout), delivery is deferred.
17984 route_list = domain1 host1:host2:host3 randomize bydns;\
17985 domain2 host4:host5
17987 If neither &%byname%& nor &%bydns%& is given, Exim behaves as follows: First, a
17988 DNS lookup is done. If this yields anything other than HOST_NOT_FOUND, that
17989 result is used. Otherwise, Exim goes on to try a call to &[getipnodebyname()]&
17990 or &[gethostbyname()]&, and the result of the lookup is the result of that
17993 &*Warning*&: It has been discovered that on some systems, if a DNS lookup
17994 called via &[getipnodebyname()]& times out, HOST_NOT_FOUND is returned
17995 instead of TRY_AGAIN. That is why the default action is to try a DNS
17996 lookup first. Only if that gives a definite &"no such host"& is the local
18001 If no IP address for a host can be found, what happens is controlled by the
18002 &%host_find_failed%& option.
18005 When an address is routed to a local transport, IP addresses are not looked up.
18006 The host list is passed to the transport in the &$host$& variable.
18010 .section "Manualroute examples" "SECID123"
18011 In some of the examples that follow, the presence of the &%remote_smtp%&
18012 transport, as defined in the default configuration file, is assumed:
18015 .cindex "smart host" "example router"
18016 The &(manualroute)& router can be used to forward all external mail to a
18017 &'smart host'&. If you have set up, in the main part of the configuration, a
18018 named domain list that contains your local domains, for example:
18020 domainlist local_domains = my.domain.example
18022 You can arrange for all other domains to be routed to a smart host by making
18023 your first router something like this:
18026 driver = manualroute
18027 domains = !+local_domains
18028 transport = remote_smtp
18029 route_list = * smarthost.ref.example
18031 This causes all non-local addresses to be sent to the single host
18032 &'smarthost.ref.example'&. If a colon-separated list of smart hosts is given,
18033 they are tried in order
18034 (but you can use &%hosts_randomize%& to vary the order each time).
18035 Another way of configuring the same thing is this:
18038 driver = manualroute
18039 transport = remote_smtp
18040 route_list = !+local_domains smarthost.ref.example
18042 There is no difference in behaviour between these two routers as they stand.
18043 However, they behave differently if &%no_more%& is added to them. In the first
18044 example, the router is skipped if the domain does not match the &%domains%&
18045 precondition; the following router is always tried. If the router runs, it
18046 always matches the domain and so can never decline. Therefore, &%no_more%&
18047 would have no effect. In the second case, the router is never skipped; it
18048 always runs. However, if it doesn't match the domain, it declines. In this case
18049 &%no_more%& would prevent subsequent routers from running.
18052 .cindex "mail hub example"
18053 A &'mail hub'& is a host which receives mail for a number of domains via MX
18054 records in the DNS and delivers it via its own private routing mechanism. Often
18055 the final destinations are behind a firewall, with the mail hub being the one
18056 machine that can connect to machines both inside and outside the firewall. The
18057 &(manualroute)& router is usually used on a mail hub to route incoming messages
18058 to the correct hosts. For a small number of domains, the routing can be inline,
18059 using the &%route_list%& option, but for a larger number a file or database
18060 lookup is easier to manage.
18062 If the domain names are in fact the names of the machines to which the mail is
18063 to be sent by the mail hub, the configuration can be quite simple. For
18067 driver = manualroute
18068 transport = remote_smtp
18069 route_list = *.rhodes.tvs.example $domain
18071 This configuration routes domains that match &`*.rhodes.tvs.example`& to hosts
18072 whose names are the same as the mail domains. A similar approach can be taken
18073 if the host name can be obtained from the domain name by a string manipulation
18074 that the expansion facilities can handle. Otherwise, a lookup based on the
18075 domain can be used to find the host:
18078 driver = manualroute
18079 transport = remote_smtp
18080 route_data = ${lookup {$domain} cdb {/internal/host/routes}}
18082 The result of the lookup must be the name or IP address of the host (or
18083 hosts) to which the address is to be routed. If the lookup fails, the route
18084 data is empty, causing the router to decline. The address then passes to the
18088 .cindex "batched SMTP output example"
18089 .cindex "SMTP" "batched outgoing; example"
18090 You can use &(manualroute)& to deliver messages to pipes or files in batched
18091 SMTP format for onward transportation by some other means. This is one way of
18092 storing mail for a dial-up host when it is not connected. The route list entry
18093 can be as simple as a single domain name in a configuration like this:
18096 driver = manualroute
18097 transport = batchsmtp_appendfile
18098 route_list = saved.domain.example
18100 though often a pattern is used to pick up more than one domain. If there are
18101 several domains or groups of domains with different transport requirements,
18102 different transports can be listed in the routing information:
18105 driver = manualroute
18107 *.saved.domain1.example $domain batch_appendfile; \
18108 *.saved.domain2.example \
18109 ${lookup{$domain}dbm{/domain2/hosts}{$value}fail} \
18112 .vindex "&$domain$&"
18114 The first of these just passes the domain in the &$host$& variable, which
18115 doesn't achieve much (since it is also in &$domain$&), but the second does a
18116 file lookup to find a value to pass, causing the router to decline to handle
18117 the address if the lookup fails.
18120 .cindex "UUCP" "example of router for"
18121 Routing mail directly to UUCP software is a specific case of the use of
18122 &(manualroute)& in a gateway to another mail environment. This is an example of
18123 one way it can be done:
18129 command = /usr/local/bin/uux -r - \
18130 ${substr_-5:$host}!rmail ${local_part}
18131 return_fail_output = true
18136 driver = manualroute
18138 ${lookup{$domain}lsearch{/usr/local/exim/uucphosts}}
18140 The file &_/usr/local/exim/uucphosts_& contains entries like
18142 darksite.ethereal.example: darksite.UUCP
18144 It can be set up more simply without adding and removing &".UUCP"& but this way
18145 makes clear the distinction between the domain name
18146 &'darksite.ethereal.example'& and the UUCP host name &'darksite'&.
18148 .ecindex IIDmanrou1
18149 .ecindex IIDmanrou2
18158 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18159 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18161 .chapter "The queryprogram router" "CHAPdriverlast"
18162 .scindex IIDquerou1 "&(queryprogram)& router"
18163 .scindex IIDquerou2 "routers" "&(queryprogram)&"
18164 .cindex "routing" "by external program"
18165 The &(queryprogram)& router routes an address by running an external command
18166 and acting on its output. This is an expensive way to route, and is intended
18167 mainly for use in lightly-loaded systems, or for performing experiments.
18168 However, if it is possible to use the precondition options (&%domains%&,
18169 &%local_parts%&, etc) to skip this router for most addresses, it could sensibly
18170 be used in special cases, even on a busy host. There are the following private
18172 .cindex "options" "&(queryprogram)& router"
18174 .option command queryprogram string&!! unset
18175 This option must be set. It specifies the command that is to be run. The
18176 command is split up into a command name and arguments, and then each is
18177 expanded separately (exactly as for a &(pipe)& transport, described in chapter
18178 &<<CHAPpipetransport>>&).
18181 .option command_group queryprogram string unset
18182 .cindex "gid (group id)" "in &(queryprogram)& router"
18183 This option specifies a gid to be set when running the command while routing an
18184 address for deliver. It must be set if &%command_user%& specifies a numerical
18185 uid. If it begins with a digit, it is interpreted as the numerical value of the
18186 gid. Otherwise it is looked up using &[getgrnam()]&.
18189 .option command_user queryprogram string unset
18190 .cindex "uid (user id)" "for &(queryprogram)&"
18191 This option must be set. It specifies the uid which is set when running the
18192 command while routing an address for delivery. If the value begins with a digit,
18193 it is interpreted as the numerical value of the uid. Otherwise, it is looked up
18194 using &[getpwnam()]& to obtain a value for the uid and, if &%command_group%& is
18195 not set, a value for the gid also.
18197 &*Warning:*& Changing uid and gid is possible only when Exim is running as
18198 root, which it does during a normal delivery in a conventional configuration.
18199 However, when an address is being verified during message reception, Exim is
18200 usually running as the Exim user, not as root. If the &(queryprogram)& router
18201 is called from a non-root process, Exim cannot change uid or gid before running
18202 the command. In this circumstance the command runs under the current uid and
18206 .option current_directory queryprogram string /
18207 This option specifies an absolute path which is made the current directory
18208 before running the command.
18211 .option timeout queryprogram time 1h
18212 If the command does not complete within the timeout period, its process group
18213 is killed and the message is frozen. A value of zero time specifies no
18217 The standard output of the command is connected to a pipe, which is read when
18218 the command terminates. It should consist of a single line of output,
18219 containing up to five fields, separated by white space. The maximum length of
18220 the line is 1023 characters. Longer lines are silently truncated. The first
18221 field is one of the following words (case-insensitive):
18224 &'Accept'&: routing succeeded; the remaining fields specify what to do (see
18227 &'Decline'&: the router declines; pass the address to the next router, unless
18228 &%no_more%& is set.
18230 &'Fail'&: routing failed; do not pass the address to any more routers. Any
18231 subsequent text on the line is an error message. If the router is run as part
18232 of address verification during an incoming SMTP message, the message is
18233 included in the SMTP response.
18235 &'Defer'&: routing could not be completed at this time; try again later. Any
18236 subsequent text on the line is an error message which is logged. It is not
18237 included in any SMTP response.
18239 &'Freeze'&: the same as &'defer'&, except that the message is frozen.
18241 &'Pass'&: pass the address to the next router (or the router specified by
18242 &%pass_router%&), overriding &%no_more%&.
18244 &'Redirect'&: the message is redirected. The remainder of the line is a list of
18245 new addresses, which are routed independently, starting with the first router,
18246 or the router specified by &%redirect_router%&, if set.
18249 When the first word is &'accept'&, the remainder of the line consists of a
18250 number of keyed data values, as follows (split into two lines here, to fit on
18253 ACCEPT TRANSPORT=<transport> HOSTS=<list of hosts>
18254 LOOKUP=byname|bydns DATA=<text>
18256 The data items can be given in any order, and all are optional. If no transport
18257 is included, the transport specified by the generic &%transport%& option is
18258 used. The list of hosts and the lookup type are needed only if the transport is
18259 an &(smtp)& transport that does not itself supply a list of hosts.
18261 The format of the list of hosts is the same as for the &(manualroute)& router.
18262 As well as host names and IP addresses with optional port numbers, as described
18263 in section &<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&, it may contain names followed by
18264 &`/MX`& to specify sublists of hosts that are obtained by looking up MX records
18265 (see section &<<SECThostshowused>>&).
18267 If the lookup type is not specified, Exim behaves as follows when trying to
18268 find an IP address for each host: First, a DNS lookup is done. If this yields
18269 anything other than HOST_NOT_FOUND, that result is used. Otherwise, Exim
18270 goes on to try a call to &[getipnodebyname()]& or &[gethostbyname()]&, and the
18271 result of the lookup is the result of that call.
18273 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
18274 If the DATA field is set, its value is placed in the &$address_data$&
18275 variable. For example, this return line
18277 accept hosts=x1.y.example:x2.y.example data="rule1"
18279 routes the address to the default transport, passing a list of two hosts. When
18280 the transport runs, the string &"rule1"& is in &$address_data$&.
18281 .ecindex IIDquerou1
18282 .ecindex IIDquerou2
18287 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18288 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18290 .chapter "The redirect router" "CHAPredirect"
18291 .scindex IIDredrou1 "&(redirect)& router"
18292 .scindex IIDredrou2 "routers" "&(redirect)&"
18293 .cindex "alias file" "in a &(redirect)& router"
18294 .cindex "address redirection" "&(redirect)& router"
18295 The &(redirect)& router handles several kinds of address redirection. Its most
18296 common uses are for resolving local part aliases from a central alias file
18297 (usually called &_/etc/aliases_&) and for handling users' personal &_.forward_&
18298 files, but it has many other potential uses. The incoming address can be
18299 redirected in several different ways:
18302 It can be replaced by one or more new addresses which are themselves routed
18305 It can be routed to be delivered to a given file or directory.
18307 It can be routed to be delivered to a specified pipe command.
18309 It can cause an automatic reply to be generated.
18311 It can be forced to fail, optionally with a custom error message.
18313 It can be temporarily deferred, optionally with a custom message.
18315 It can be discarded.
18318 The generic &%transport%& option must not be set for &(redirect)& routers.
18319 However, there are some private options which define transports for delivery to
18320 files and pipes, and for generating autoreplies. See the &%file_transport%&,
18321 &%pipe_transport%& and &%reply_transport%& descriptions below.
18325 .section "Redirection data" "SECID124"
18326 The router operates by interpreting a text string which it obtains either by
18327 expanding the contents of the &%data%& option, or by reading the entire
18328 contents of a file whose name is given in the &%file%& option. These two
18329 options are mutually exclusive. The first is commonly used for handling system
18330 aliases, in a configuration like this:
18334 data = ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/etc/aliases}}
18336 If the lookup fails, the expanded string in this example is empty. When the
18337 expansion of &%data%& results in an empty string, the router declines. A forced
18338 expansion failure also causes the router to decline; other expansion failures
18339 cause delivery to be deferred.
18341 A configuration using &%file%& is commonly used for handling users'
18342 &_.forward_& files, like this:
18347 file = $home/.forward
18350 If the file does not exist, or causes no action to be taken (for example, it is
18351 empty or consists only of comments), the router declines. &*Warning*&: This
18352 is not the case when the file contains syntactically valid items that happen to
18353 yield empty addresses, for example, items containing only RFC 2822 address
18358 .section "Forward files and address verification" "SECID125"
18359 .cindex "address redirection" "while verifying"
18360 It is usual to set &%no_verify%& on &(redirect)& routers which handle users'
18361 &_.forward_& files, as in the example above. There are two reasons for this:
18364 When Exim is receiving an incoming SMTP message from a remote host, it is
18365 running under the Exim uid, not as root. Exim is unable to change uid to read
18366 the file as the user, and it may not be able to read it as the Exim user. So in
18367 practice the router may not be able to operate.
18369 However, even when the router can operate, the existence of a &_.forward_& file
18370 is unimportant when verifying an address. What should be checked is whether the
18371 local part is a valid user name or not. Cutting out the redirection processing
18372 saves some resources.
18380 .section "Interpreting redirection data" "SECID126"
18381 .cindex "Sieve filter" "specifying in redirection data"
18382 .cindex "filter" "specifying in redirection data"
18383 The contents of the data string, whether obtained from &%data%& or &%file%&,
18384 can be interpreted in two different ways:
18387 If the &%allow_filter%& option is set true, and the data begins with the text
18388 &"#Exim filter"& or &"#Sieve filter"&, it is interpreted as a list of
18389 &'filtering'& instructions in the form of an Exim or Sieve filter file,
18390 respectively. Details of the syntax and semantics of filter files are described
18391 in a separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'&; this
18392 document is intended for use by end users.
18394 Otherwise, the data must be a comma-separated list of redirection items, as
18395 described in the next section.
18398 When a message is redirected to a file (a &"mail folder"&), the file name given
18399 in a non-filter redirection list must always be an absolute path. A filter may
18400 generate a relative path &-- how this is handled depends on the transport's
18401 configuration. See section &<<SECTfildiropt>>& for a discussion of this issue
18402 for the &(appendfile)& transport.
18406 .section "Items in a non-filter redirection list" "SECTitenonfilred"
18407 .cindex "address redirection" "non-filter list items"
18408 When the redirection data is not an Exim or Sieve filter, for example, if it
18409 comes from a conventional alias or forward file, it consists of a list of
18410 addresses, file names, pipe commands, or certain special items (see section
18411 &<<SECTspecitredli>>& below). The special items can be individually enabled or
18412 disabled by means of options whose names begin with &%allow_%& or &%forbid_%&,
18413 depending on their default values. The items in the list are separated by
18414 commas or newlines.
18415 If a comma is required in an item, the entire item must be enclosed in double
18418 Lines starting with a # character are comments, and are ignored, and # may
18419 also appear following a comma, in which case everything between the # and the
18420 next newline character is ignored.
18422 If an item is entirely enclosed in double quotes, these are removed. Otherwise
18423 double quotes are retained because some forms of mail address require their use
18424 (but never to enclose the entire address). In the following description,
18425 &"item"& refers to what remains after any surrounding double quotes have been
18428 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
18429 &*Warning*&: If you use an Exim expansion to construct a redirection address,
18430 and the expansion contains a reference to &$local_part$&, you should make use
18431 of the &%quote_local_part%& expansion operator, in case the local part contains
18432 special characters. For example, to redirect all mail for the domain
18433 &'obsolete.example'&, retaining the existing local part, you could use this
18436 data = ${quote_local_part:$local_part}@newdomain.example
18440 .section "Redirecting to a local mailbox" "SECTredlocmai"
18441 .cindex "routing" "loops in"
18442 .cindex "loop" "while routing, avoidance of"
18443 .cindex "address redirection" "to local mailbox"
18444 A redirection item may safely be the same as the address currently under
18445 consideration. This does not cause a routing loop, because a router is
18446 automatically skipped if any ancestor of the address that is being processed
18447 is the same as the current address and was processed by the current router.
18448 Such an address is therefore passed to the following routers, so it is handled
18449 as if there were no redirection. When making this loop-avoidance test, the
18450 complete local part, including any prefix or suffix, is used.
18452 .cindex "address redirection" "local part without domain"
18453 Specifying the same local part without a domain is a common usage in personal
18454 filter files when the user wants to have messages delivered to the local
18455 mailbox and also forwarded elsewhere. For example, the user whose login is
18456 &'cleo'& might have a &_.forward_& file containing this:
18458 cleo, cleopatra@egypt.example
18460 .cindex "backslash in alias file"
18461 .cindex "alias file" "backslash in"
18462 For compatibility with other MTAs, such unqualified local parts may be
18463 preceded by &"\"&, but this is not a requirement for loop prevention. However,
18464 it does make a difference if more than one domain is being handled
18467 If an item begins with &"\"& and the rest of the item parses as a valid RFC
18468 2822 address that does not include a domain, the item is qualified using the
18469 domain of the incoming address. In the absence of a leading &"\"&, unqualified
18470 addresses are qualified using the value in &%qualify_recipient%&, but you can
18471 force the incoming domain to be used by setting &%qualify_preserve_domain%&.
18473 Care must be taken if there are alias names for local users.
18474 Consider an MTA handling a single local domain where the system alias file
18479 Now suppose that Sam (whose login id is &'spqr'&) wants to save copies of
18480 messages in the local mailbox, and also forward copies elsewhere. He creates
18483 Sam.Reman, spqr@reme.elsewhere.example
18485 With these settings, an incoming message addressed to &'Sam.Reman'& fails. The
18486 &(redirect)& router for system aliases does not process &'Sam.Reman'& the
18487 second time round, because it has previously routed it,
18488 and the following routers presumably cannot handle the alias. The forward file
18489 should really contain
18491 spqr, spqr@reme.elsewhere.example
18493 but because this is such a common error, the &%check_ancestor%& option (see
18494 below) exists to provide a way to get round it. This is normally set on a
18495 &(redirect)& router that is handling users' &_.forward_& files.
18499 .section "Special items in redirection lists" "SECTspecitredli"
18500 In addition to addresses, the following types of item may appear in redirection
18501 lists (that is, in non-filter redirection data):
18504 .cindex "pipe" "in redirection list"
18505 .cindex "address redirection" "to pipe"
18506 An item is treated as a pipe command if it begins with &"|"& and does not parse
18507 as a valid RFC 2822 address that includes a domain. A transport for running the
18508 command must be specified by the &%pipe_transport%& option.
18509 Normally, either the router or the transport specifies a user and a group under
18510 which to run the delivery. The default is to use the Exim user and group.
18512 Single or double quotes can be used for enclosing the individual arguments of
18513 the pipe command; no interpretation of escapes is done for single quotes. If
18514 the command contains a comma character, it is necessary to put the whole item
18515 in double quotes, for example:
18517 "|/some/command ready,steady,go"
18519 since items in redirection lists are terminated by commas. Do not, however,
18520 quote just the command. An item such as
18522 |"/some/command ready,steady,go"
18524 is interpreted as a pipe with a rather strange command name, and no arguments.
18527 Note that the above example assumes that the text comes from a lookup source
18528 of some sort, so that the quotes are part of the data. If composing a
18529 redirect router with a &%data%& option directly specifying this command, the
18530 quotes will be used by the configuration parser to define the extent of one
18531 string, but will not be passed down into the redirect router itself. There
18532 are two main approaches to get around this: escape quotes to be part of the
18533 data itself, or avoid using this mechanism and instead create a custom
18534 transport with the &%command%& option set and reference that transport from
18535 an &%accept%& router.
18539 .cindex "file" "in redirection list"
18540 .cindex "address redirection" "to file"
18541 An item is interpreted as a path name if it begins with &"/"& and does not
18542 parse as a valid RFC 2822 address that includes a domain. For example,
18544 /home/world/minbari
18546 is treated as a file name, but
18548 /s=molari/o=babylon/@x400gate.way
18550 is treated as an address. For a file name, a transport must be specified using
18551 the &%file_transport%& option. However, if the generated path name ends with a
18552 forward slash character, it is interpreted as a directory name rather than a
18553 file name, and &%directory_transport%& is used instead.
18555 Normally, either the router or the transport specifies a user and a group under
18556 which to run the delivery. The default is to use the Exim user and group.
18558 .cindex "&_/dev/null_&"
18559 However, if a redirection item is the path &_/dev/null_&, delivery to it is
18560 bypassed at a high level, and the log entry shows &"**bypassed**"&
18561 instead of a transport name. In this case the user and group are not used.
18564 .cindex "included address list"
18565 .cindex "address redirection" "included external list"
18566 If an item is of the form
18568 :include:<path name>
18570 a list of further items is taken from the given file and included at that
18571 point. &*Note*&: Such a file can not be a filter file; it is just an
18572 out-of-line addition to the list. The items in the included list are separated
18573 by commas or newlines and are not subject to expansion. If this is the first
18574 item in an alias list in an &(lsearch)& file, a colon must be used to terminate
18575 the alias name. This example is incorrect:
18577 list1 :include:/opt/lists/list1
18579 It must be given as
18581 list1: :include:/opt/lists/list1
18584 .cindex "address redirection" "to black hole"
18585 Sometimes you want to throw away mail to a particular local part. Making the
18586 &%data%& option expand to an empty string does not work, because that causes
18587 the router to decline. Instead, the alias item
18588 .cindex "black hole"
18589 .cindex "abandoning mail"
18590 &':blackhole:'& can be used. It does what its name implies. No delivery is
18591 done, and no error message is generated. This has the same effect as specifing
18592 &_/dev/null_& as a destination, but it can be independently disabled.
18594 &*Warning*&: If &':blackhole:'& appears anywhere in a redirection list, no
18595 delivery is done for the original local part, even if other redirection items
18596 are present. If you are generating a multi-item list (for example, by reading a
18597 database) and need the ability to provide a no-op item, you must use
18601 .cindex "delivery" "forcing failure"
18602 .cindex "delivery" "forcing deferral"
18603 .cindex "failing delivery" "forcing"
18604 .cindex "deferred delivery, forcing"
18605 .cindex "customizing" "failure message"
18606 An attempt to deliver a particular address can be deferred or forced to fail by
18607 redirection items of the form
18612 respectively. When a redirection list contains such an item, it applies
18613 to the entire redirection; any other items in the list are ignored. Any
18614 text following &':fail:'& or &':defer:'& is placed in the error text
18615 associated with the failure. For example, an alias file might contain:
18617 X.Employee: :fail: Gone away, no forwarding address
18619 In the case of an address that is being verified from an ACL or as the subject
18621 .cindex "VRFY" "error text, display of"
18622 VRFY command, the text is included in the SMTP error response by
18624 .cindex "EXPN" "error text, display of"
18625 The text is not included in the response to an EXPN command. In non-SMTP cases
18626 the text is included in the error message that Exim generates.
18628 .cindex "SMTP" "error codes"
18629 By default, Exim sends a 451 SMTP code for a &':defer:'&, and 550 for
18630 &':fail:'&. However, if the message starts with three digits followed by a
18631 space, optionally followed by an extended code of the form &'n.n.n'&, also
18632 followed by a space, and the very first digit is the same as the default error
18633 code, the code from the message is used instead. If the very first digit is
18634 incorrect, a panic error is logged, and the default code is used. You can
18635 suppress the use of the supplied code in a redirect router by setting the
18636 &%forbid_smtp_code%& option true. In this case, any SMTP code is quietly
18639 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
18640 In an ACL, an explicitly provided message overrides the default, but the
18641 default message is available in the variable &$acl_verify_message$& and can
18642 therefore be included in a custom message if this is desired.
18644 Normally the error text is the rest of the redirection list &-- a comma does
18645 not terminate it &-- but a newline does act as a terminator. Newlines are not
18646 normally present in alias expansions. In &(lsearch)& lookups they are removed
18647 as part of the continuation process, but they may exist in other kinds of
18648 lookup and in &':include:'& files.
18650 During routing for message delivery (as opposed to verification), a redirection
18651 containing &':fail:'& causes an immediate failure of the incoming address,
18652 whereas &':defer:'& causes the message to remain on the queue so that a
18653 subsequent delivery attempt can happen at a later time. If an address is
18654 deferred for too long, it will ultimately fail, because the normal retry
18658 .cindex "alias file" "exception to default"
18659 Sometimes it is useful to use a single-key search type with a default (see
18660 chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&) to look up aliases. However, there may be a need
18661 for exceptions to the default. These can be handled by aliasing them to
18662 &':unknown:'&. This differs from &':fail:'& in that it causes the &(redirect)&
18663 router to decline, whereas &':fail:'& forces routing to fail. A lookup which
18664 results in an empty redirection list has the same effect.
18668 .section "Duplicate addresses" "SECTdupaddr"
18669 .cindex "duplicate addresses"
18670 .cindex "address duplicate, discarding"
18671 .cindex "pipe" "duplicated"
18672 Exim removes duplicate addresses from the list to which it is delivering, so as
18673 to deliver just one copy to each address. This does not apply to deliveries
18674 routed to pipes by different immediate parent addresses, but an indirect
18675 aliasing scheme of the type
18677 pipe: |/some/command $local_part
18681 does not work with a message that is addressed to both local parts, because
18682 when the second is aliased to the intermediate local part &"pipe"& it gets
18683 discarded as being the same as a previously handled address. However, a scheme
18686 localpart1: |/some/command $local_part
18687 localpart2: |/some/command $local_part
18689 does result in two different pipe deliveries, because the immediate parents of
18690 the pipes are distinct.
18694 .section "Repeated redirection expansion" "SECID128"
18695 .cindex "repeated redirection expansion"
18696 .cindex "address redirection" "repeated for each delivery attempt"
18697 When a message cannot be delivered to all of its recipients immediately,
18698 leading to two or more delivery attempts, redirection expansion is carried out
18699 afresh each time for those addresses whose children were not all previously
18700 delivered. If redirection is being used as a mailing list, this can lead to new
18701 members of the list receiving copies of old messages. The &%one_time%& option
18702 can be used to avoid this.
18705 .section "Errors in redirection lists" "SECID129"
18706 .cindex "address redirection" "errors"
18707 If &%skip_syntax_errors%& is set, a malformed address that causes a parsing
18708 error is skipped, and an entry is written to the main log. This may be useful
18709 for mailing lists that are automatically managed. Otherwise, if an error is
18710 detected while generating the list of new addresses, the original address is
18711 deferred. See also &%syntax_errors_to%&.
18715 .section "Private options for the redirect router" "SECID130"
18717 .cindex "options" "&(redirect)& router"
18718 The private options for the &(redirect)& router are as follows:
18721 .option allow_defer redirect boolean false
18722 Setting this option allows the use of &':defer:'& in non-filter redirection
18723 data, or the &%defer%& command in an Exim filter file.
18726 .option allow_fail redirect boolean false
18727 .cindex "failing delivery" "from filter"
18728 If this option is true, the &':fail:'& item can be used in a redirection list,
18729 and the &%fail%& command may be used in an Exim filter file.
18732 .option allow_filter redirect boolean false
18733 .cindex "filter" "enabling use of"
18734 .cindex "Sieve filter" "enabling use of"
18735 Setting this option allows Exim to interpret redirection data that starts with
18736 &"#Exim filter"& or &"#Sieve filter"& as a set of filtering instructions. There
18737 are some features of Exim filter files that some administrators may wish to
18738 lock out; see the &%forbid_filter_%&&'xxx'& options below.
18740 It is also possible to lock out Exim filters or Sieve filters while allowing
18741 the other type; see &%forbid_exim_filter%& and &%forbid_sieve_filter%&.
18744 The filter is run using the uid and gid set by the generic &%user%& and
18745 &%group%& options. These take their defaults from the password data if
18746 &%check_local_user%& is set, so in the normal case of users' personal filter
18747 files, the filter is run as the relevant user. When &%allow_filter%& is set
18748 true, Exim insists that either &%check_local_user%& or &%user%& is set.
18752 .option allow_freeze redirect boolean false
18753 .cindex "freezing messages" "allowing in filter"
18754 Setting this option allows the use of the &%freeze%& command in an Exim filter.
18755 This command is more normally encountered in system filters, and is disabled by
18756 default for redirection filters because it isn't something you usually want to
18757 let ordinary users do.
18761 .option check_ancestor redirect boolean false
18762 This option is concerned with handling generated addresses that are the same
18763 as some address in the list of redirection ancestors of the current address.
18764 Although it is turned off by default in the code, it is set in the default
18765 configuration file for handling users' &_.forward_& files. It is recommended
18766 for this use of the &(redirect)& router.
18768 When &%check_ancestor%& is set, if a generated address (including the domain)
18769 is the same as any ancestor of the current address, it is replaced by a copy of
18770 the current address. This helps in the case where local part A is aliased to B,
18771 and B has a &_.forward_& file pointing back to A. For example, within a single
18772 domain, the local part &"Joe.Bloggs"& is aliased to &"jb"& and
18773 &_&~jb/.forward_& contains:
18775 \Joe.Bloggs, <other item(s)>
18777 Without the &%check_ancestor%& setting, either local part (&"jb"& or
18778 &"joe.bloggs"&) gets processed once by each router and so ends up as it was
18779 originally. If &"jb"& is the real mailbox name, mail to &"jb"& gets delivered
18780 (having been turned into &"joe.bloggs"& by the &_.forward_& file and back to
18781 &"jb"& by the alias), but mail to &"joe.bloggs"& fails. Setting
18782 &%check_ancestor%& on the &(redirect)& router that handles the &_.forward_&
18783 file prevents it from turning &"jb"& back into &"joe.bloggs"& when that was the
18784 original address. See also the &%repeat_use%& option below.
18787 .option check_group redirect boolean "see below"
18788 When the &%file%& option is used, the group owner of the file is checked only
18789 when this option is set. The permitted groups are those listed in the
18790 &%owngroups%& option, together with the user's default group if
18791 &%check_local_user%& is set. If the file has the wrong group, routing is
18792 deferred. The default setting for this option is true if &%check_local_user%&
18793 is set and the &%modemask%& option permits the group write bit, or if the
18794 &%owngroups%& option is set. Otherwise it is false, and no group check occurs.
18798 .option check_owner redirect boolean "see below"
18799 When the &%file%& option is used, the owner of the file is checked only when
18800 this option is set. If &%check_local_user%& is set, the local user is
18801 permitted; otherwise the owner must be one of those listed in the &%owners%&
18802 option. The default value for this option is true if &%check_local_user%& or
18803 &%owners%& is set. Otherwise the default is false, and no owner check occurs.
18806 .option data redirect string&!! unset
18807 This option is mutually exclusive with &%file%&. One or other of them must be
18808 set, but not both. The contents of &%data%& are expanded, and then used as the
18809 list of forwarding items, or as a set of filtering instructions. If the
18810 expansion is forced to fail, or the result is an empty string or a string that
18811 has no effect (consists entirely of comments), the router declines.
18813 When filtering instructions are used, the string must begin with &"#Exim
18814 filter"&, and all comments in the string, including this initial one, must be
18815 terminated with newline characters. For example:
18817 data = #Exim filter\n\
18818 if $h_to: contains Exim then save $home/mail/exim endif
18820 If you are reading the data from a database where newlines cannot be included,
18821 you can use the &${sg}$& expansion item to turn the escape string of your
18822 choice into a newline.
18825 .option directory_transport redirect string&!! unset
18826 A &(redirect)& router sets up a direct delivery to a directory when a path name
18827 ending with a slash is specified as a new &"address"&. The transport used is
18828 specified by this option, which, after expansion, must be the name of a
18829 configured transport. This should normally be an &(appendfile)& transport.
18832 .option file redirect string&!! unset
18833 This option specifies the name of a file that contains the redirection data. It
18834 is mutually exclusive with the &%data%& option. The string is expanded before
18835 use; if the expansion is forced to fail, the router declines. Other expansion
18836 failures cause delivery to be deferred. The result of a successful expansion
18837 must be an absolute path. The entire file is read and used as the redirection
18838 data. If the data is an empty string or a string that has no effect (consists
18839 entirely of comments), the router declines.
18841 .cindex "NFS" "checking for file existence"
18842 If the attempt to open the file fails with a &"does not exist"& error, Exim
18843 runs a check on the containing directory,
18844 unless &%ignore_enotdir%& is true (see below).
18845 If the directory does not appear to exist, delivery is deferred. This can
18846 happen when users' &_.forward_& files are in NFS-mounted directories, and there
18847 is a mount problem. If the containing directory does exist, but the file does
18848 not, the router declines.
18851 .option file_transport redirect string&!! unset
18852 .vindex "&$address_file$&"
18853 A &(redirect)& router sets up a direct delivery to a file when a path name not
18854 ending in a slash is specified as a new &"address"&. The transport used is
18855 specified by this option, which, after expansion, must be the name of a
18856 configured transport. This should normally be an &(appendfile)& transport. When
18857 it is running, the file name is in &$address_file$&.
18860 .option filter_prepend_home redirect boolean true
18861 When this option is true, if a &(save)& command in an Exim filter specifies a
18862 relative path, and &$home$& is defined, it is automatically prepended to the
18863 relative path. If this option is set false, this action does not happen. The
18864 relative path is then passed to the transport unmodified.
18867 .option forbid_blackhole redirect boolean false
18868 If this option is true, the &':blackhole:'& item may not appear in a
18872 .option forbid_exim_filter redirect boolean false
18873 If this option is set true, only Sieve filters are permitted when
18874 &%allow_filter%& is true.
18879 .option forbid_file redirect boolean false
18880 .cindex "delivery" "to file; forbidding"
18881 .cindex "Sieve filter" "forbidding delivery to a file"
18882 .cindex "Sieve filter" "&""keep""& facility; disabling"
18883 If this option is true, this router may not generate a new address that
18884 specifies delivery to a local file or directory, either from a filter or from a
18885 conventional forward file. This option is forced to be true if &%one_time%& is
18886 set. It applies to Sieve filters as well as to Exim filters, but if true, it
18887 locks out the Sieve's &"keep"& facility.
18890 .option forbid_filter_dlfunc redirect boolean false
18891 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
18892 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filters are not allowed to
18893 make use of the &%dlfunc%& expansion facility to run dynamically loaded
18896 .option forbid_filter_existstest redirect boolean false
18897 .cindex "expansion" "statting a file"
18898 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filters are not allowed to
18899 make use of the &%exists%& condition or the &%stat%& expansion item.
18901 .option forbid_filter_logwrite redirect boolean false
18902 If this option is true, use of the logging facility in Exim filters is not
18903 permitted. Logging is in any case available only if the filter is being run
18904 under some unprivileged uid (which is normally the case for ordinary users'
18905 &_.forward_& files).
18908 .option forbid_filter_lookup redirect boolean false
18909 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
18910 to make use of &%lookup%& items.
18913 .option forbid_filter_perl redirect boolean false
18914 This option has an effect only if Exim is built with embedded Perl support. If
18915 it is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed to make use
18916 of the embedded Perl support.
18919 .option forbid_filter_readfile redirect boolean false
18920 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
18921 to make use of &%readfile%& items.
18924 .option forbid_filter_readsocket redirect boolean false
18925 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
18926 to make use of &%readsocket%& items.
18929 .option forbid_filter_reply redirect boolean false
18930 If this option is true, this router may not generate an automatic reply
18931 message. Automatic replies can be generated only from Exim or Sieve filter
18932 files, not from traditional forward files. This option is forced to be true if
18933 &%one_time%& is set.
18936 .option forbid_filter_run redirect boolean false
18937 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
18938 to make use of &%run%& items.
18941 .option forbid_include redirect boolean false
18942 If this option is true, items of the form
18944 :include:<path name>
18946 are not permitted in non-filter redirection lists.
18949 .option forbid_pipe redirect boolean false
18950 .cindex "delivery" "to pipe; forbidding"
18951 If this option is true, this router may not generate a new address which
18952 specifies delivery to a pipe, either from an Exim filter or from a conventional
18953 forward file. This option is forced to be true if &%one_time%& is set.
18956 .option forbid_sieve_filter redirect boolean false
18957 If this option is set true, only Exim filters are permitted when
18958 &%allow_filter%& is true.
18961 .cindex "SMTP" "error codes"
18962 .option forbid_smtp_code redirect boolean false
18963 If this option is set true, any SMTP error codes that are present at the start
18964 of messages specified for &`:defer:`& or &`:fail:`& are quietly ignored, and
18965 the default codes (451 and 550, respectively) are always used.
18970 .option hide_child_in_errmsg redirect boolean false
18971 .cindex "bounce message" "redirection details; suppressing"
18972 If this option is true, it prevents Exim from quoting a child address if it
18973 generates a bounce or delay message for it. Instead it says &"an address
18974 generated from <&'the top level address'&>"&. Of course, this applies only to
18975 bounces generated locally. If a message is forwarded to another host, &'its'&
18976 bounce may well quote the generated address.
18979 .option ignore_eacces redirect boolean false
18981 If this option is set and an attempt to open a redirection file yields the
18982 EACCES error (permission denied), the &(redirect)& router behaves as if the
18983 file did not exist.
18986 .option ignore_enotdir redirect boolean false
18988 If this option is set and an attempt to open a redirection file yields the
18989 ENOTDIR error (something on the path is not a directory), the &(redirect)&
18990 router behaves as if the file did not exist.
18992 Setting &%ignore_enotdir%& has another effect as well: When a &(redirect)&
18993 router that has the &%file%& option set discovers that the file does not exist
18994 (the ENOENT error), it tries to &[stat()]& the parent directory, as a check
18995 against unmounted NFS directories. If the parent can not be statted, delivery
18996 is deferred. However, it seems wrong to do this check when &%ignore_enotdir%&
18997 is set, because that option tells Exim to ignore &"something on the path is not
18998 a directory"& (the ENOTDIR error). This is a confusing area, because it seems
18999 that some operating systems give ENOENT where others give ENOTDIR.
19003 .option include_directory redirect string unset
19004 If this option is set, the path names of any &':include:'& items in a
19005 redirection list must start with this directory.
19008 .option modemask redirect "octal integer" 022
19009 This specifies mode bits which must not be set for a file specified by the
19010 &%file%& option. If any of the forbidden bits are set, delivery is deferred.
19013 .option one_time redirect boolean false
19014 .cindex "one-time aliasing/forwarding expansion"
19015 .cindex "alias file" "one-time expansion"
19016 .cindex "forward file" "one-time expansion"
19017 .cindex "mailing lists" "one-time expansion"
19018 .cindex "address redirection" "one-time expansion"
19019 Sometimes the fact that Exim re-evaluates aliases and reprocesses redirection
19020 files each time it tries to deliver a message causes a problem when one or more
19021 of the generated addresses fails be delivered at the first attempt. The problem
19022 is not one of duplicate delivery &-- Exim is clever enough to handle that &--
19023 but of what happens when the redirection list changes during the time that the
19024 message is on Exim's queue. This is particularly true in the case of mailing
19025 lists, where new subscribers might receive copies of messages that were posted
19026 before they subscribed.
19028 If &%one_time%& is set and any addresses generated by the router fail to
19029 deliver at the first attempt, the failing addresses are added to the message as
19030 &"top level"& addresses, and the parent address that generated them is marked
19031 &"delivered"&. Thus, redirection does not happen again at the next delivery
19034 &*Warning 1*&: Any header line addition or removal that is specified by this
19035 router would be lost if delivery did not succeed at the first attempt. For this
19036 reason, the &%headers_add%& and &%headers_remove%& generic options are not
19037 permitted when &%one_time%& is set.
19039 &*Warning 2*&: To ensure that the router generates only addresses (as opposed
19040 to pipe or file deliveries or auto-replies) &%forbid_file%&, &%forbid_pipe%&,
19041 and &%forbid_filter_reply%& are forced to be true when &%one_time%& is set.
19043 &*Warning 3*&: The &%unseen%& generic router option may not be set with
19046 The original top-level address is remembered with each of the generated
19047 addresses, and is output in any log messages. However, any intermediate parent
19048 addresses are not recorded. This makes a difference to the log only if
19049 &%all_parents%& log selector is set. It is expected that &%one_time%& will
19050 typically be used for mailing lists, where there is normally just one level of
19054 .option owners redirect "string list" unset
19055 .cindex "ownership" "alias file"
19056 .cindex "ownership" "forward file"
19057 .cindex "alias file" "ownership"
19058 .cindex "forward file" "ownership"
19059 This specifies a list of permitted owners for the file specified by &%file%&.
19060 This list is in addition to the local user when &%check_local_user%& is set.
19061 See &%check_owner%& above.
19064 .option owngroups redirect "string list" unset
19065 This specifies a list of permitted groups for the file specified by &%file%&.
19066 The list is in addition to the local user's primary group when
19067 &%check_local_user%& is set. See &%check_group%& above.
19070 .option pipe_transport redirect string&!! unset
19071 .vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
19072 A &(redirect)& router sets up a direct delivery to a pipe when a string
19073 starting with a vertical bar character is specified as a new &"address"&. The
19074 transport used is specified by this option, which, after expansion, must be the
19075 name of a configured transport. This should normally be a &(pipe)& transport.
19076 When the transport is run, the pipe command is in &$address_pipe$&.
19079 .option qualify_domain redirect string&!! unset
19080 .vindex "&$qualify_recipient$&"
19081 If this option is set, and an unqualified address (one without a domain) is
19082 generated, and that address would normally be qualified by the global setting
19083 in &%qualify_recipient%&, it is instead qualified with the domain specified by
19084 expanding this string. If the expansion fails, the router declines. If you want
19085 to revert to the default, you can have the expansion generate
19086 &$qualify_recipient$&.
19088 This option applies to all unqualified addresses generated by Exim filters,
19089 but for traditional &_.forward_& files, it applies only to addresses that are
19090 not preceded by a backslash. Sieve filters cannot generate unqualified
19093 .option qualify_preserve_domain redirect boolean false
19094 .cindex "domain" "in redirection; preserving"
19095 .cindex "preserving domain in redirection"
19096 .cindex "address redirection" "domain; preserving"
19097 If this option is set, the router's local &%qualify_domain%& option must not be
19098 set (a configuration error occurs if it is). If an unqualified address (one
19099 without a domain) is generated, it is qualified with the domain of the parent
19100 address (the immediately preceding ancestor) instead of the global
19101 &%qualify_recipient%& value. In the case of a traditional &_.forward_& file,
19102 this applies whether or not the address is preceded by a backslash.
19105 .option repeat_use redirect boolean true
19106 If this option is set false, the router is skipped for a child address that has
19107 any ancestor that was routed by this router. This test happens before any of
19108 the other preconditions are tested. Exim's default anti-looping rules skip
19109 only when the ancestor is the same as the current address. See also
19110 &%check_ancestor%& above and the generic &%redirect_router%& option.
19113 .option reply_transport redirect string&!! unset
19114 A &(redirect)& router sets up an automatic reply when a &%mail%& or
19115 &%vacation%& command is used in a filter file. The transport used is specified
19116 by this option, which, after expansion, must be the name of a configured
19117 transport. This should normally be an &(autoreply)& transport. Other transports
19118 are unlikely to do anything sensible or useful.
19121 .option rewrite redirect boolean true
19122 .cindex "address redirection" "disabling rewriting"
19123 If this option is set false, addresses generated by the router are not
19124 subject to address rewriting. Otherwise, they are treated like new addresses
19125 and are rewritten according to the global rewriting rules.
19128 .option sieve_subaddress redirect string&!! unset
19129 The value of this option is passed to a Sieve filter to specify the
19130 :subaddress part of an address.
19132 .option sieve_useraddress redirect string&!! unset
19133 The value of this option is passed to a Sieve filter to specify the :user part
19134 of an address. However, if it is unset, the entire original local part
19135 (including any prefix or suffix) is used for :user.
19138 .option sieve_vacation_directory redirect string&!! unset
19139 .cindex "Sieve filter" "vacation directory"
19140 To enable the &"vacation"& extension for Sieve filters, you must set
19141 &%sieve_vacation_directory%& to the directory where vacation databases are held
19142 (do not put anything else in that directory), and ensure that the
19143 &%reply_transport%& option refers to an &(autoreply)& transport. Each user
19144 needs their own directory; Exim will create it if necessary.
19148 .option skip_syntax_errors redirect boolean false
19149 .cindex "forward file" "broken"
19150 .cindex "address redirection" "broken files"
19151 .cindex "alias file" "broken"
19152 .cindex "broken alias or forward files"
19153 .cindex "ignoring faulty addresses"
19154 .cindex "skipping faulty addresses"
19155 .cindex "error" "skipping bad syntax"
19156 If &%skip_syntax_errors%& is set, syntactically malformed addresses in
19157 non-filter redirection data are skipped, and each failing address is logged. If
19158 &%syntax_errors_to%& is set, a message is sent to the address it defines,
19159 giving details of the failures. If &%syntax_errors_text%& is set, its contents
19160 are expanded and placed at the head of the error message generated by
19161 &%syntax_errors_to%&. Usually it is appropriate to set &%syntax_errors_to%& to
19162 be the same address as the generic &%errors_to%& option. The
19163 &%skip_syntax_errors%& option is often used when handling mailing lists.
19165 If all the addresses in a redirection list are skipped because of syntax
19166 errors, the router declines to handle the original address, and it is passed to
19167 the following routers.
19169 If &%skip_syntax_errors%& is set when an Exim filter is interpreted, any syntax
19170 error in the filter causes filtering to be abandoned without any action being
19171 taken. The incident is logged, and the router declines to handle the address,
19172 so it is passed to the following routers.
19174 .cindex "Sieve filter" "syntax errors in"
19175 Syntax errors in a Sieve filter file cause the &"keep"& action to occur. This
19176 action is specified by RFC 3028. The values of &%skip_syntax_errors%&,
19177 &%syntax_errors_to%&, and &%syntax_errors_text%& are not used.
19179 &%skip_syntax_errors%& can be used to specify that errors in users' forward
19180 lists or filter files should not prevent delivery. The &%syntax_errors_to%&
19181 option, used with an address that does not get redirected, can be used to
19182 notify users of these errors, by means of a router like this:
19188 file = $home/.forward
19189 file_transport = address_file
19190 pipe_transport = address_pipe
19191 reply_transport = address_reply
19194 syntax_errors_to = real-$local_part@$domain
19195 syntax_errors_text = \
19196 This is an automatically generated message. An error has\n\
19197 been found in your .forward file. Details of the error are\n\
19198 reported below. While this error persists, you will receive\n\
19199 a copy of this message for every message that is addressed\n\
19200 to you. If your .forward file is a filter file, or if it is\n\
19201 a non-filter file containing no valid forwarding addresses,\n\
19202 a copy of each incoming message will be put in your normal\n\
19203 mailbox. If a non-filter file contains at least one valid\n\
19204 forwarding address, forwarding to the valid addresses will\n\
19205 happen, and those will be the only deliveries that occur.
19207 You also need a router to ensure that local addresses that are prefixed by
19208 &`real-`& are recognized, but not forwarded or filtered. For example, you could
19209 put this immediately before the &(userforward)& router:
19214 local_part_prefix = real-
19215 transport = local_delivery
19217 For security, it would probably be a good idea to restrict the use of this
19218 router to locally-generated messages, using a condition such as this:
19220 condition = ${if match {$sender_host_address}\
19221 {\N^(|127\.0\.0\.1)$\N}}
19225 .option syntax_errors_text redirect string&!! unset
19226 See &%skip_syntax_errors%& above.
19229 .option syntax_errors_to redirect string unset
19230 See &%skip_syntax_errors%& above.
19231 .ecindex IIDredrou1
19232 .ecindex IIDredrou2
19239 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19240 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19242 .chapter "Environment for running local transports" "CHAPenvironment" &&&
19243 "Environment for local transports"
19244 .scindex IIDenvlotra1 "local transports" "environment for"
19245 .scindex IIDenvlotra2 "environment for local transports"
19246 .scindex IIDenvlotra3 "transport" "local; environment for"
19247 Local transports handle deliveries to files and pipes. (The &(autoreply)&
19248 transport can be thought of as similar to a pipe.) Exim always runs transports
19249 in subprocesses, under specified uids and gids. Typical deliveries to local
19250 mailboxes run under the uid and gid of the local user.
19252 Exim also sets a specific current directory while running the transport; for
19253 some transports a home directory setting is also relevant. The &(pipe)&
19254 transport is the only one that sets up environment variables; see section
19255 &<<SECTpipeenv>>& for details.
19257 The values used for the uid, gid, and the directories may come from several
19258 different places. In many cases, the router that handles the address associates
19259 settings with that address as a result of its &%check_local_user%&, &%group%&,
19260 or &%user%& options. However, values may also be given in the transport's own
19261 configuration, and these override anything that comes from the router.
19265 .section "Concurrent deliveries" "SECID131"
19266 .cindex "concurrent deliveries"
19267 .cindex "simultaneous deliveries"
19268 If two different messages for the same local recipient arrive more or less
19269 simultaneously, the two delivery processes are likely to run concurrently. When
19270 the &(appendfile)& transport is used to write to a file, Exim applies locking
19271 rules to stop concurrent processes from writing to the same file at the same
19274 However, when you use a &(pipe)& transport, it is up to you to arrange any
19275 locking that is needed. Here is a silly example:
19279 command = /bin/sh -c 'cat >>/some/file'
19281 This is supposed to write the message at the end of the file. However, if two
19282 messages arrive at the same time, the file will be scrambled. You can use the
19283 &%exim_lock%& utility program (see section &<<SECTmailboxmaint>>&) to lock a
19284 file using the same algorithm that Exim itself uses.
19289 .section "Uids and gids" "SECTenvuidgid"
19290 .cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
19291 .cindex "transport" "local; uid and gid"
19292 All transports have the options &%group%& and &%user%&. If &%group%& is set, it
19293 overrides any group that the router set in the address, even if &%user%& is not
19294 set for the transport. This makes it possible, for example, to run local mail
19295 delivery under the uid of the recipient (set by the router), but in a special
19296 group (set by the transport). For example:
19299 # User/group are set by check_local_user in this router
19303 transport = group_delivery
19306 # This transport overrides the group
19308 driver = appendfile
19309 file = /var/spool/mail/$local_part
19312 If &%user%& is set for a transport, its value overrides what is set in the
19313 address by the router. If &%user%& is non-numeric and &%group%& is not set, the
19314 gid associated with the user is used. If &%user%& is numeric, &%group%& must be
19317 .oindex "&%initgroups%&"
19318 When the uid is taken from the transport's configuration, the &[initgroups()]&
19319 function is called for the groups associated with that uid if the
19320 &%initgroups%& option is set for the transport. When the uid is not specified
19321 by the transport, but is associated with the address by a router, the option
19322 for calling &[initgroups()]& is taken from the router configuration.
19324 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "uid for"
19325 The &(pipe)& transport contains the special option &%pipe_as_creator%&. If this
19326 is set and &%user%& is not set, the uid of the process that called Exim to
19327 receive the message is used, and if &%group%& is not set, the corresponding
19328 original gid is also used.
19330 This is the detailed preference order for obtaining a gid; the first of the
19331 following that is set is used:
19334 A &%group%& setting of the transport;
19336 A &%group%& setting of the router;
19338 A gid associated with a user setting of the router, either as a result of
19339 &%check_local_user%& or an explicit non-numeric &%user%& setting;
19341 The group associated with a non-numeric &%user%& setting of the transport;
19343 In a &(pipe)& transport, the creator's gid if &%deliver_as_creator%& is set and
19344 the uid is the creator's uid;
19346 The Exim gid if the Exim uid is being used as a default.
19349 If, for example, the user is specified numerically on the router and there are
19350 no group settings, no gid is available. In this situation, an error occurs.
19351 This is different for the uid, for which there always is an ultimate default.
19352 The first of the following that is set is used:
19355 A &%user%& setting of the transport;
19357 In a &(pipe)& transport, the creator's uid if &%deliver_as_creator%& is set;
19359 A &%user%& setting of the router;
19361 A &%check_local_user%& setting of the router;
19366 Of course, an error will still occur if the uid that is chosen is on the
19367 &%never_users%& list.
19373 .section "Current and home directories" "SECID132"
19374 .cindex "current directory for local transport"
19375 .cindex "home directory" "for local transport"
19376 .cindex "transport" "local; home directory for"
19377 .cindex "transport" "local; current directory for"
19378 Routers may set current and home directories for local transports by means of
19379 the &%transport_current_directory%& and &%transport_home_directory%& options.
19380 However, if the transport's &%current_directory%& or &%home_directory%& options
19381 are set, they override the router's values. In detail, the home directory
19382 for a local transport is taken from the first of these values that is set:
19385 The &%home_directory%& option on the transport;
19387 The &%transport_home_directory%& option on the router;
19389 The password data if &%check_local_user%& is set on the router;
19391 The &%router_home_directory%& option on the router.
19394 The current directory is taken from the first of these values that is set:
19397 The &%current_directory%& option on the transport;
19399 The &%transport_current_directory%& option on the router.
19403 If neither the router nor the transport sets a current directory, Exim uses the
19404 value of the home directory, if it is set. Otherwise it sets the current
19405 directory to &_/_& before running a local transport.
19409 .section "Expansion variables derived from the address" "SECID133"
19410 .vindex "&$domain$&"
19411 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
19412 .vindex "&$original_domain$&"
19413 Normally a local delivery is handling a single address, and in that case the
19414 variables such as &$domain$& and &$local_part$& are set during local
19415 deliveries. However, in some circumstances more than one address may be handled
19416 at once (for example, while writing batch SMTP for onward transmission by some
19417 other means). In this case, the variables associated with the local part are
19418 never set, &$domain$& is set only if all the addresses have the same domain,
19419 and &$original_domain$& is never set.
19420 .ecindex IIDenvlotra1
19421 .ecindex IIDenvlotra2
19422 .ecindex IIDenvlotra3
19430 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19431 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19433 .chapter "Generic options for transports" "CHAPtransportgeneric"
19434 .scindex IIDgenoptra1 "generic options" "transport"
19435 .scindex IIDgenoptra2 "options" "generic; for transports"
19436 .scindex IIDgenoptra3 "transport" "generic options for"
19437 The following generic options apply to all transports:
19440 .option body_only transports boolean false
19441 .cindex "transport" "body only"
19442 .cindex "message" "transporting body only"
19443 .cindex "body of message" "transporting"
19444 If this option is set, the message's headers are not transported. It is
19445 mutually exclusive with &%headers_only%&. If it is used with the &(appendfile)&
19446 or &(pipe)& transports, the settings of &%message_prefix%& and
19447 &%message_suffix%& should be checked, because this option does not
19448 automatically suppress them.
19451 .option current_directory transports string&!! unset
19452 .cindex "transport" "current directory for"
19453 This specifies the current directory that is to be set while running the
19454 transport, overriding any value that may have been set by the router.
19455 If the expansion fails for any reason, including forced failure, an error is
19456 logged, and delivery is deferred.
19459 .option disable_logging transports boolean false
19460 If this option is set true, nothing is logged for any
19461 deliveries by the transport or for any
19462 transport errors. You should not set this option unless you really, really know
19463 what you are doing.
19466 .option debug_print transports string&!! unset
19467 .cindex "testing" "variables in drivers"
19468 If this option is set and debugging is enabled (see the &%-d%& command line
19469 option), the string is expanded and included in the debugging output when the
19471 If expansion of the string fails, the error message is written to the debugging
19472 output, and Exim carries on processing.
19473 This facility is provided to help with checking out the values of variables and
19474 so on when debugging driver configurations. For example, if a &%headers_add%&
19475 option is not working properly, &%debug_print%& could be used to output the
19476 variables it references. A newline is added to the text if it does not end with
19480 .option delivery_date_add transports boolean false
19481 .cindex "&'Delivery-date:'& header line"
19482 If this option is true, a &'Delivery-date:'& header is added to the message.
19483 This gives the actual time the delivery was made. As this is not a standard
19484 header, Exim has a configuration option (&%delivery_date_remove%&) which
19485 requests its removal from incoming messages, so that delivered messages can
19486 safely be resent to other recipients.
19489 .option driver transports string unset
19490 This specifies which of the available transport drivers is to be used.
19491 There is no default, and this option must be set for every transport.
19494 .option envelope_to_add transports boolean false
19495 .cindex "&'Envelope-to:'& header line"
19496 If this option is true, an &'Envelope-to:'& header is added to the message.
19497 This gives the original address(es) in the incoming envelope that caused this
19498 delivery to happen. More than one address may be present if the transport is
19499 configured to handle several addresses at once, or if more than one original
19500 address was redirected to the same final address. As this is not a standard
19501 header, Exim has a configuration option (&%envelope_to_remove%&) which requests
19502 its removal from incoming messages, so that delivered messages can safely be
19503 resent to other recipients.
19506 .option group transports string&!! "Exim group"
19507 .cindex "transport" "group; specifying"
19508 This option specifies a gid for running the transport process, overriding any
19509 value that the router supplies, and also overriding any value associated with
19510 &%user%& (see below).
19513 .option headers_add transports string&!! unset
19514 .cindex "header lines" "adding in transport"
19515 .cindex "transport" "header lines; adding"
19516 This option specifies a string of text that is expanded and added to the header
19517 portion of a message as it is transported, as described in section
19518 &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. Additional header lines can also be specified by
19519 routers. If the result of the expansion is an empty string, or if the expansion
19520 is forced to fail, no action is taken. Other expansion failures are treated as
19521 errors and cause the delivery to be deferred.
19525 .option headers_only transports boolean false
19526 .cindex "transport" "header lines only"
19527 .cindex "message" "transporting headers only"
19528 .cindex "header lines" "transporting"
19529 If this option is set, the message's body is not transported. It is mutually
19530 exclusive with &%body_only%&. If it is used with the &(appendfile)& or &(pipe)&
19531 transports, the settings of &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& should be
19532 checked, since this option does not automatically suppress them.
19535 .option headers_remove transports string&!! unset
19536 .cindex "header lines" "removing"
19537 .cindex "transport" "header lines; removing"
19538 This option specifies a string that is expanded into a list of header names;
19539 these headers are omitted from the message as it is transported, as described
19540 in section &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. Header removal can also be specified by
19541 routers. If the result of the expansion is an empty string, or if the expansion
19542 is forced to fail, no action is taken. Other expansion failures are treated as
19543 errors and cause the delivery to be deferred.
19547 .option headers_rewrite transports string unset
19548 .cindex "transport" "header lines; rewriting"
19549 .cindex "rewriting" "at transport time"
19550 This option allows addresses in header lines to be rewritten at transport time,
19551 that is, as the message is being copied to its destination. The contents of the
19552 option are a colon-separated list of rewriting rules. Each rule is in exactly
19553 the same form as one of the general rewriting rules that are applied when a
19554 message is received. These are described in chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&. For
19557 headers_rewrite = a@b c@d f : \
19560 changes &'a@b'& into &'c@d'& in &'From:'& header lines, and &'x@y'& into
19561 &'w@z'& in all address-bearing header lines. The rules are applied to the
19562 header lines just before they are written out at transport time, so they affect
19563 only those copies of the message that pass through the transport. However, only
19564 the message's original header lines, and any that were added by a system
19565 filter, are rewritten. If a router or transport adds header lines, they are not
19566 affected by this option. These rewriting rules are &'not'& applied to the
19567 envelope. You can change the return path using &%return_path%&, but you cannot
19568 change envelope recipients at this time.
19571 .option home_directory transports string&!! unset
19572 .cindex "transport" "home directory for"
19574 This option specifies a home directory setting for a local transport,
19575 overriding any value that may be set by the router. The home directory is
19576 placed in &$home$& while expanding the transport's private options. It is also
19577 used as the current directory if no current directory is set by the
19578 &%current_directory%& option on the transport or the
19579 &%transport_current_directory%& option on the router. If the expansion fails
19580 for any reason, including forced failure, an error is logged, and delivery is
19584 .option initgroups transports boolean false
19585 .cindex "additional groups"
19586 .cindex "groups" "additional"
19587 .cindex "transport" "group; additional"
19588 If this option is true and the uid for the delivery process is provided by the
19589 transport, the &[initgroups()]& function is called when running the transport
19590 to ensure that any additional groups associated with the uid are set up.
19593 .option message_size_limit transports string&!! 0
19594 .cindex "limit" "message size per transport"
19595 .cindex "size" "of message, limit"
19596 .cindex "transport" "message size; limiting"
19597 This option controls the size of messages passed through the transport. It is
19598 expanded before use; the result of the expansion must be a sequence of decimal
19599 digits, optionally followed by K or M. If the expansion fails for any reason,
19600 including forced failure, or if the result is not of the required form,
19601 delivery is deferred. If the value is greater than zero and the size of a
19602 message exceeds this limit, the address is failed. If there is any chance that
19603 the resulting bounce message could be routed to the same transport, you should
19604 ensure that &%return_size_limit%& is less than the transport's
19605 &%message_size_limit%&, as otherwise the bounce message will fail to get
19610 .option rcpt_include_affixes transports boolean false
19611 .cindex "prefix" "for local part, including in envelope"
19612 .cindex "suffix for local part" "including in envelope"
19613 .cindex "local part" "prefix"
19614 .cindex "local part" "suffix"
19615 When this option is false (the default), and an address that has had any
19616 affixes (prefixes or suffixes) removed from the local part is delivered by any
19617 form of SMTP or LMTP, the affixes are not included. For example, if a router
19620 local_part_prefix = *-
19622 routes the address &'abc-xyz@some.domain'& to an SMTP transport, the envelope
19625 RCPT TO:<xyz@some.domain>
19627 This is also the case when an ACL-time callout is being used to verify a
19628 recipient address. However, if &%rcpt_include_affixes%& is set true, the
19629 whole local part is included in the RCPT command. This option applies to BSMTP
19630 deliveries by the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports as well as to the
19631 &(lmtp)& and &(smtp)& transports.
19634 .option retry_use_local_part transports boolean "see below"
19635 .cindex "hints database" "retry keys"
19636 When a delivery suffers a temporary failure, a retry record is created
19637 in Exim's hints database. For remote deliveries, the key for the retry record
19638 is based on the name and/or IP address of the failing remote host. For local
19639 deliveries, the key is normally the entire address, including both the local
19640 part and the domain. This is suitable for most common cases of local delivery
19641 temporary failure &-- for example, exceeding a mailbox quota should delay only
19642 deliveries to that mailbox, not to the whole domain.
19644 However, in some special cases you may want to treat a temporary local delivery
19645 as a failure associated with the domain, and not with a particular local part.
19646 (For example, if you are storing all mail for some domain in files.) You can do
19647 this by setting &%retry_use_local_part%& false.
19649 For all the local transports, its default value is true. For remote transports,
19650 the default value is false for tidiness, but changing the value has no effect
19651 on a remote transport in the current implementation.
19654 .option return_path transports string&!! unset
19655 .cindex "envelope sender"
19656 .cindex "transport" "return path; changing"
19657 .cindex "return path" "changing in transport"
19658 If this option is set, the string is expanded at transport time and replaces
19659 the existing return path (envelope sender) value in the copy of the message
19660 that is being delivered. An empty return path is permitted. This feature is
19661 designed for remote deliveries, where the value of this option is used in the
19662 SMTP MAIL command. If you set &%return_path%& for a local transport, the
19663 only effect is to change the address that is placed in the &'Return-path:'&
19664 header line, if one is added to the message (see the next option).
19666 &*Note:*& A changed return path is not logged unless you add
19667 &%return_path_on_delivery%& to the log selector.
19669 .vindex "&$return_path$&"
19670 The expansion can refer to the existing value via &$return_path$&. This is
19671 either the message's envelope sender, or an address set by the
19672 &%errors_to%& option on a router. If the expansion is forced to fail, no
19673 replacement occurs; if it fails for another reason, delivery is deferred. This
19674 option can be used to support VERP (Variable Envelope Return Paths) &-- see
19675 section &<<SECTverp>>&.
19677 &*Note*&: If a delivery error is detected locally, including the case when a
19678 remote server rejects a message at SMTP time, the bounce message is not sent to
19679 the value of this option. It is sent to the previously set errors address.
19680 This defaults to the incoming sender address, but can be changed by setting
19681 &%errors_to%& in a router.
19685 .option return_path_add transports boolean false
19686 .cindex "&'Return-path:'& header line"
19687 If this option is true, a &'Return-path:'& header is added to the message.
19688 Although the return path is normally available in the prefix line of BSD
19689 mailboxes, this is commonly not displayed by MUAs, and so the user does not
19690 have easy access to it.
19692 RFC 2821 states that the &'Return-path:'& header is added to a message &"when
19693 the delivery SMTP server makes the final delivery"&. This implies that this
19694 header should not be present in incoming messages. Exim has a configuration
19695 option, &%return_path_remove%&, which requests removal of this header from
19696 incoming messages, so that delivered messages can safely be resent to other
19700 .option shadow_condition transports string&!! unset
19701 See &%shadow_transport%& below.
19704 .option shadow_transport transports string unset
19705 .cindex "shadow transport"
19706 .cindex "transport" "shadow"
19707 A local transport may set the &%shadow_transport%& option to the name of
19708 another local transport. Shadow remote transports are not supported.
19710 Whenever a delivery to the main transport succeeds, and either
19711 &%shadow_condition%& is unset, or its expansion does not result in the empty
19712 string or one of the strings &"0"& or &"no"& or &"false"&, the message is also
19713 passed to the shadow transport, with the same delivery address or addresses. If
19714 expansion fails, no action is taken except that non-forced expansion failures
19715 cause a log line to be written.
19717 The result of the shadow transport is discarded and does not affect the
19718 subsequent processing of the message. Only a single level of shadowing is
19719 provided; the &%shadow_transport%& option is ignored on any transport when it
19720 is running as a shadow. Options concerned with output from pipes are also
19721 ignored. The log line for the successful delivery has an item added on the end,
19724 ST=<shadow transport name>
19726 If the shadow transport did not succeed, the error message is put in
19727 parentheses afterwards. Shadow transports can be used for a number of different
19728 purposes, including keeping more detailed log information than Exim normally
19729 provides, and implementing automatic acknowledgment policies based on message
19730 headers that some sites insist on.
19733 .option transport_filter transports string&!! unset
19734 .cindex "transport" "filter"
19735 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
19736 This option sets up a filtering (in the Unix shell sense) process for messages
19737 at transport time. It should not be confused with mail filtering as set up by
19738 individual users or via a system filter.
19740 When the message is about to be written out, the command specified by
19741 &%transport_filter%& is started up in a separate, parallel process, and
19742 the entire message, including the header lines, is passed to it on its standard
19743 input (this in fact is done from a third process, to avoid deadlock). The
19744 command must be specified as an absolute path.
19746 The lines of the message that are written to the transport filter are
19747 terminated by newline (&"\n"&). The message is passed to the filter before any
19748 SMTP-specific processing, such as turning &"\n"& into &"\r\n"& and escaping
19749 lines beginning with a dot, and also before any processing implied by the
19750 settings of &%check_string%& and &%escape_string%& in the &(appendfile)& or
19751 &(pipe)& transports.
19753 The standard error for the filter process is set to the same destination as its
19754 standard output; this is read and written to the message's ultimate
19755 destination. The process that writes the message to the filter, the
19756 filter itself, and the original process that reads the result and delivers it
19757 are all run in parallel, like a shell pipeline.
19759 The filter can perform any transformations it likes, but of course should take
19760 care not to break RFC 2822 syntax. Exim does not check the result, except to
19761 test for a final newline when SMTP is in use. All messages transmitted over
19762 SMTP must end with a newline, so Exim supplies one if it is missing.
19764 .cindex "content scanning" "per user"
19765 A transport filter can be used to provide content-scanning on a per-user basis
19766 at delivery time if the only required effect of the scan is to modify the
19767 message. For example, a content scan could insert a new header line containing
19768 a spam score. This could be interpreted by a filter in the user's MUA. It is
19769 not possible to discard a message at this stage.
19771 .cindex "SMTP" "SIZE"
19772 A problem might arise if the filter increases the size of a message that is
19773 being sent down an SMTP connection. If the receiving SMTP server has indicated
19774 support for the SIZE parameter, Exim will have sent the size of the message
19775 at the start of the SMTP session. If what is actually sent is substantially
19776 more, the server might reject the message. This can be worked round by setting
19777 the &%size_addition%& option on the &(smtp)& transport, either to allow for
19778 additions to the message, or to disable the use of SIZE altogether.
19780 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
19781 The value of the &%transport_filter%& option is the command string for starting
19782 the filter, which is run directly from Exim, not under a shell. The string is
19783 parsed by Exim in the same way as a command string for the &(pipe)& transport:
19784 Exim breaks it up into arguments and then expands each argument separately (see
19785 section &<<SECThowcommandrun>>&). Any kind of expansion failure causes delivery
19786 to be deferred. The special argument &$pipe_addresses$& is replaced by a number
19787 of arguments, one for each address that applies to this delivery. (This isn't
19788 an ideal name for this feature here, but as it was already implemented for the
19789 &(pipe)& transport, it seemed sensible not to change it.)
19792 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
19793 The expansion variables &$host$& and &$host_address$& are available when the
19794 transport is a remote one. They contain the name and IP address of the host to
19795 which the message is being sent. For example:
19797 transport_filter = /some/directory/transport-filter.pl \
19798 $host $host_address $sender_address $pipe_addresses
19801 Two problems arise if you want to use more complicated expansion items to
19802 generate transport filter commands, both of which due to the fact that the
19803 command is split up &'before'& expansion.
19805 If an expansion item contains white space, you must quote it, so that it is all
19806 part of the same command item. If the entire option setting is one such
19807 expansion item, you have to take care what kind of quoting you use. For
19810 transport_filter = '/bin/cmd${if eq{$host}{a.b.c}{1}{2}}'
19812 This runs the command &(/bin/cmd1)& if the host name is &'a.b.c'&, and
19813 &(/bin/cmd2)& otherwise. If double quotes had been used, they would have been
19814 stripped by Exim when it read the option's value. When the value is used, if
19815 the single quotes were missing, the line would be split into two items,
19816 &`/bin/cmd${if`& and &`eq{$host}{a.b.c}{1}{2}`&, and an error would occur when
19817 Exim tried to expand the first one.
19819 Except for the special case of &$pipe_addresses$& that is mentioned above, an
19820 expansion cannot generate multiple arguments, or a command name followed by
19821 arguments. Consider this example:
19823 transport_filter = ${lookup{$host}lsearch{/a/file}\
19824 {$value}{/bin/cat}}
19826 The result of the lookup is interpreted as the name of the command, even
19827 if it contains white space. The simplest way round this is to use a shell:
19829 transport_filter = /bin/sh -c ${lookup{$host}lsearch{/a/file}\
19830 {$value}{/bin/cat}}
19834 The filter process is run under the same uid and gid as the normal delivery.
19835 For remote deliveries this is the Exim uid/gid by default. The command should
19836 normally yield a zero return code. Transport filters are not supposed to fail.
19837 A non-zero code is taken to mean that the transport filter encountered some
19838 serious problem. Delivery of the message is deferred; the message remains on
19839 the queue and is tried again later. It is not possible to cause a message to be
19840 bounced from a transport filter.
19842 If a transport filter is set on an autoreply transport, the original message is
19843 passed through the filter as it is being copied into the newly generated
19844 message, which happens if the &%return_message%& option is set.
19847 .option transport_filter_timeout transports time 5m
19848 .cindex "transport" "filter, timeout"
19849 When Exim is reading the output of a transport filter, it a applies a timeout
19850 that can be set by this option. Exceeding the timeout is normally treated as a
19851 temporary delivery failure. However, if a transport filter is used with a
19852 &(pipe)& transport, a timeout in the transport filter is treated in the same
19853 way as a timeout in the pipe command itself. By default, a timeout is a hard
19854 error, but if the &(pipe)& transport's &%timeout_defer%& option is set true, it
19855 becomes a temporary error.
19858 .option user transports string&!! "Exim user"
19859 .cindex "uid (user id)" "local delivery"
19860 .cindex "transport" "user, specifying"
19861 This option specifies the user under whose uid the delivery process is to be
19862 run, overriding any uid that may have been set by the router. If the user is
19863 given as a name, the uid is looked up from the password data, and the
19864 associated group is taken as the value of the gid to be used if the &%group%&
19867 For deliveries that use local transports, a user and group are normally
19868 specified explicitly or implicitly (for example, as a result of
19869 &%check_local_user%&) by the router or transport.
19871 .cindex "hints database" "access by remote transport"
19872 For remote transports, you should leave this option unset unless you really are
19873 sure you know what you are doing. When a remote transport is running, it needs
19874 to be able to access Exim's hints databases, because each host may have its own
19876 .ecindex IIDgenoptra1
19877 .ecindex IIDgenoptra2
19878 .ecindex IIDgenoptra3
19885 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19886 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19888 .chapter "Address batching in local transports" "CHAPbatching" &&&
19890 .cindex "transport" "local; address batching in"
19891 The only remote transport (&(smtp)&) is normally configured to handle more than
19892 one address at a time, so that when several addresses are routed to the same
19893 remote host, just one copy of the message is sent. Local transports, however,
19894 normally handle one address at a time. That is, a separate instance of the
19895 transport is run for each address that is routed to the transport. A separate
19896 copy of the message is delivered each time.
19898 .cindex "batched local delivery"
19899 .oindex "&%batch_max%&"
19900 .oindex "&%batch_id%&"
19901 In special cases, it may be desirable to handle several addresses at once in a
19902 local transport, for example:
19905 In an &(appendfile)& transport, when storing messages in files for later
19906 delivery by some other means, a single copy of the message with multiple
19907 recipients saves space.
19909 In an &(lmtp)& transport, when delivering over &"local SMTP"& to some process,
19910 a single copy saves time, and is the normal way LMTP is expected to work.
19912 In a &(pipe)& transport, when passing the message
19913 to a scanner program or
19914 to some other delivery mechanism such as UUCP, multiple recipients may be
19918 These three local transports all have the same options for controlling multiple
19919 (&"batched"&) deliveries, namely &%batch_max%& and &%batch_id%&. To save
19920 repeating the information for each transport, these options are described here.
19922 The &%batch_max%& option specifies the maximum number of addresses that can be
19923 delivered together in a single run of the transport. Its default value is one
19924 (no batching). When more than one address is routed to a transport that has a
19925 &%batch_max%& value greater than one, the addresses are delivered in a batch
19926 (that is, in a single run of the transport with multiple recipients), subject
19927 to certain conditions:
19930 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
19931 If any of the transport's options contain a reference to &$local_part$&, no
19932 batching is possible.
19934 .vindex "&$domain$&"
19935 If any of the transport's options contain a reference to &$domain$&, only
19936 addresses with the same domain are batched.
19938 .cindex "customizing" "batching condition"
19939 If &%batch_id%& is set, it is expanded for each address, and only those
19940 addresses with the same expanded value are batched. This allows you to specify
19941 customized batching conditions. Failure of the expansion for any reason,
19942 including forced failure, disables batching, but it does not stop the delivery
19945 Batched addresses must also have the same errors address (where to send
19946 delivery errors), the same header additions and removals, the same user and
19947 group for the transport, and if a host list is present, the first host must
19951 In the case of the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports, batching applies
19952 both when the file or pipe command is specified in the transport, and when it
19953 is specified by a &(redirect)& router, but all the batched addresses must of
19954 course be routed to the same file or pipe command. These two transports have an
19955 option called &%use_bsmtp%&, which causes them to deliver the message in
19956 &"batched SMTP"& format, with the envelope represented as SMTP commands. The
19957 &%check_string%& and &%escape_string%& options are forced to the values
19960 escape_string = ".."
19962 when batched SMTP is in use. A full description of the batch SMTP mechanism is
19963 given in section &<<SECTbatchSMTP>>&. The &(lmtp)& transport does not have a
19964 &%use_bsmtp%& option, because it always delivers using the SMTP protocol.
19966 .cindex "&'Envelope-to:'& header line"
19967 If the generic &%envelope_to_add%& option is set for a batching transport, the
19968 &'Envelope-to:'& header that is added to the message contains all the addresses
19969 that are being processed together. If you are using a batching &(appendfile)&
19970 transport without &%use_bsmtp%&, the only way to preserve the recipient
19971 addresses is to set the &%envelope_to_add%& option.
19973 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "with multiple addresses"
19974 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
19975 If you are using a &(pipe)& transport without BSMTP, and setting the
19976 transport's &%command%& option, you can include &$pipe_addresses$& as part of
19977 the command. This is not a true variable; it is a bit of magic that causes each
19978 of the recipient addresses to be inserted into the command as a separate
19979 argument. This provides a way of accessing all the addresses that are being
19980 delivered in the batch. &*Note:*& This is not possible for pipe commands that
19981 are specified by a &(redirect)& router.
19986 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19987 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19989 .chapter "The appendfile transport" "CHAPappendfile"
19990 .scindex IIDapptra1 "&(appendfile)& transport"
19991 .scindex IIDapptra2 "transports" "&(appendfile)&"
19992 .cindex "directory creation"
19993 .cindex "creating directories"
19994 The &(appendfile)& transport delivers a message by appending it to an existing
19995 file, or by creating an entirely new file in a specified directory. Single
19996 files to which messages are appended can be in the traditional Unix mailbox
19997 format, or optionally in the MBX format supported by the Pine MUA and
19998 University of Washington IMAP daemon, &'inter alia'&. When each message is
19999 being delivered as a separate file, &"maildir"& format can optionally be used
20000 to give added protection against failures that happen part-way through the
20001 delivery. A third form of separate-file delivery known as &"mailstore"& is also
20002 supported. For all file formats, Exim attempts to create as many levels of
20003 directory as necessary, provided that &%create_directory%& is set.
20005 The code for the optional formats is not included in the Exim binary by
20006 default. It is necessary to set SUPPORT_MBX, SUPPORT_MAILDIR and/or
20007 SUPPORT_MAILSTORE in &_Local/Makefile_& to have the appropriate code
20010 .cindex "quota" "system"
20011 Exim recognizes system quota errors, and generates an appropriate message. Exim
20012 also supports its own quota control within the transport, for use when the
20013 system facility is unavailable or cannot be used for some reason.
20015 If there is an error while appending to a file (for example, quota exceeded or
20016 partition filled), Exim attempts to reset the file's length and last
20017 modification time back to what they were before. If there is an error while
20018 creating an entirely new file, the new file is removed.
20020 Before appending to a file, a number of security checks are made, and the
20021 file is locked. A detailed description is given below, after the list of
20024 The &(appendfile)& transport is most commonly used for local deliveries to
20025 users' mailboxes. However, it can also be used as a pseudo-remote transport for
20026 putting messages into files for remote delivery by some means other than Exim.
20027 &"Batch SMTP"& format is often used in this case (see the &%use_bsmtp%&
20032 .section "The file and directory options" "SECTfildiropt"
20033 The &%file%& option specifies a single file, to which the message is appended;
20034 the &%directory%& option specifies a directory, in which a new file containing
20035 the message is created. Only one of these two options can be set, and for
20036 normal deliveries to mailboxes, one of them &'must'& be set.
20038 .vindex "&$address_file$&"
20039 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
20040 However, &(appendfile)& is also used for delivering messages to files or
20041 directories whose names (or parts of names) are obtained from alias,
20042 forwarding, or filtering operations (for example, a &%save%& command in a
20043 user's Exim filter). When such a transport is running, &$local_part$& contains
20044 the local part that was aliased or forwarded, and &$address_file$& contains the
20045 name (or partial name) of the file or directory generated by the redirection
20046 operation. There are two cases:
20049 If neither &%file%& nor &%directory%& is set, the redirection operation
20050 must specify an absolute path (one that begins with &`/`&). This is the most
20051 common case when users with local accounts use filtering to sort mail into
20052 different folders. See for example, the &(address_file)& transport in the
20053 default configuration. If the path ends with a slash, it is assumed to be the
20054 name of a directory. A delivery to a directory can also be forced by setting
20055 &%maildir_format%& or &%mailstore_format%&.
20057 If &%file%& or &%directory%& is set for a delivery from a redirection, it is
20058 used to determine the file or directory name for the delivery. Normally, the
20059 contents of &$address_file$& are used in some way in the string expansion.
20063 .cindex "Sieve filter" "configuring &(appendfile)&"
20064 .cindex "Sieve filter" "relative mailbox path handling"
20065 As an example of the second case, consider an environment where users do not
20066 have home directories. They may be permitted to use Exim filter commands of the
20071 or Sieve filter commands of the form:
20073 require "fileinto";
20074 fileinto "folder23";
20076 In this situation, the expansion of &%file%& or &%directory%& in the transport
20077 must transform the relative path into an appropriate absolute file name. In the
20078 case of Sieve filters, the name &'inbox'& must be handled. It is the name that
20079 is used as a result of a &"keep"& action in the filter. This example shows one
20080 way of handling this requirement:
20082 file = ${if eq{$address_file}{inbox} \
20083 {/var/mail/$local_part} \
20084 {${if eq{${substr_0_1:$address_file}}{/} \
20086 {$home/mail/$address_file} \
20090 With this setting of &%file%&, &'inbox'& refers to the standard mailbox
20091 location, absolute paths are used without change, and other folders are in the
20092 &_mail_& directory within the home directory.
20094 &*Note 1*&: While processing an Exim filter, a relative path such as
20095 &_folder23_& is turned into an absolute path if a home directory is known to
20096 the router. In particular, this is the case if &%check_local_user%& is set. If
20097 you want to prevent this happening at routing time, you can set
20098 &%router_home_directory%& empty. This forces the router to pass the relative
20099 path to the transport.
20101 &*Note 2*&: An absolute path in &$address_file$& is not treated specially;
20102 the &%file%& or &%directory%& option is still used if it is set.
20107 .section "Private options for appendfile" "SECID134"
20108 .cindex "options" "&(appendfile)& transport"
20112 .option allow_fifo appendfile boolean false
20113 .cindex "fifo (named pipe)"
20114 .cindex "named pipe (fifo)"
20115 .cindex "pipe" "named (fifo)"
20116 Setting this option permits delivery to named pipes (FIFOs) as well as to
20117 regular files. If no process is reading the named pipe at delivery time, the
20118 delivery is deferred.
20121 .option allow_symlink appendfile boolean false
20122 .cindex "symbolic link" "to mailbox"
20123 .cindex "mailbox" "symbolic link"
20124 By default, &(appendfile)& will not deliver if the path name for the file is
20125 that of a symbolic link. Setting this option relaxes that constraint, but there
20126 are security issues involved in the use of symbolic links. Be sure you know
20127 what you are doing if you set this. Details of exactly what this option affects
20128 are included in the discussion which follows this list of options.
20131 .option batch_id appendfile string&!! unset
20132 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
20133 However, batching is automatically disabled for &(appendfile)& deliveries that
20134 happen as a result of forwarding or aliasing or other redirection directly to a
20138 .option batch_max appendfile integer 1
20139 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
20142 .option check_group appendfile boolean false
20143 When this option is set, the group owner of the file defined by the &%file%&
20144 option is checked to see that it is the same as the group under which the
20145 delivery process is running. The default setting is false because the default
20146 file mode is 0600, which means that the group is irrelevant.
20149 .option check_owner appendfile boolean true
20150 When this option is set, the owner of the file defined by the &%file%& option
20151 is checked to ensure that it is the same as the user under which the delivery
20152 process is running.
20155 .option check_string appendfile string "see below"
20156 .cindex "&""From""& line"
20157 As &(appendfile)& writes the message, the start of each line is tested for
20158 matching &%check_string%&, and if it does, the initial matching characters are
20159 replaced by the contents of &%escape_string%&. The value of &%check_string%& is
20160 a literal string, not a regular expression, and the case of any letters it
20161 contains is significant.
20163 If &%use_bsmtp%& is set the values of &%check_string%& and &%escape_string%&
20164 are forced to &"."& and &".."& respectively, and any settings in the
20165 configuration are ignored. Otherwise, they default to &"From&~"& and
20166 &">From&~"& when the &%file%& option is set, and unset when any of the
20167 &%directory%&, &%maildir%&, or &%mailstore%& options are set.
20169 The default settings, along with &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%&, are
20170 suitable for traditional &"BSD"& mailboxes, where a line beginning with
20171 &"From&~"& indicates the start of a new message. All four options need changing
20172 if another format is used. For example, to deliver to mailboxes in MMDF format:
20173 .cindex "MMDF format mailbox"
20174 .cindex "mailbox" "MMDF format"
20176 check_string = "\1\1\1\1\n"
20177 escape_string = "\1\1\1\1 \n"
20178 message_prefix = "\1\1\1\1\n"
20179 message_suffix = "\1\1\1\1\n"
20181 .option create_directory appendfile boolean true
20182 .cindex "directory creation"
20183 When this option is true, Exim attempts to create any missing superior
20184 directories for the file that it is about to write. A created directory's mode
20185 is given by the &%directory_mode%& option.
20187 The group ownership of a newly created directory is highly dependent on the
20188 operating system (and possibly the file system) that is being used. For
20189 example, in Solaris, if the parent directory has the setgid bit set, its group
20190 is propagated to the child; if not, the currently set group is used. However,
20191 in FreeBSD, the parent's group is always used.
20195 .option create_file appendfile string anywhere
20196 This option constrains the location of files and directories that are created
20197 by this transport. It applies to files defined by the &%file%& option and
20198 directories defined by the &%directory%& option. In the case of maildir
20199 delivery, it applies to the top level directory, not the maildir directories
20202 The option must be set to one of the words &"anywhere"&, &"inhome"&, or
20203 &"belowhome"&. In the second and third cases, a home directory must have been
20204 set for the transport. This option is not useful when an explicit file name is
20205 given for normal mailbox deliveries. It is intended for the case when file
20206 names are generated from users' &_.forward_& files. These are usually handled
20207 by an &(appendfile)& transport called &%address_file%&. See also
20208 &%file_must_exist%&.
20211 .option directory appendfile string&!! unset
20212 This option is mutually exclusive with the &%file%& option, but one of &%file%&
20213 or &%directory%& must be set, unless the delivery is the direct result of a
20214 redirection (see section &<<SECTfildiropt>>&).
20216 When &%directory%& is set, the string is expanded, and the message is delivered
20217 into a new file or files in or below the given directory, instead of being
20218 appended to a single mailbox file. A number of different formats are provided
20219 (see &%maildir_format%& and &%mailstore_format%&), and see section
20220 &<<SECTopdir>>& for further details of this form of delivery.
20223 .option directory_file appendfile string&!! "see below"
20225 .vindex "&$inode$&"
20226 When &%directory%& is set, but neither &%maildir_format%& nor
20227 &%mailstore_format%& is set, &(appendfile)& delivers each message into a file
20228 whose name is obtained by expanding this string. The default value is:
20230 q${base62:$tod_epoch}-$inode
20232 This generates a unique name from the current time, in base 62 form, and the
20233 inode of the file. The variable &$inode$& is available only when expanding this
20237 .option directory_mode appendfile "octal integer" 0700
20238 If &(appendfile)& creates any directories as a result of the
20239 &%create_directory%& option, their mode is specified by this option.
20242 .option escape_string appendfile string "see description"
20243 See &%check_string%& above.
20246 .option file appendfile string&!! unset
20247 This option is mutually exclusive with the &%directory%& option, but one of
20248 &%file%& or &%directory%& must be set, unless the delivery is the direct result
20249 of a redirection (see section &<<SECTfildiropt>>&). The &%file%& option
20250 specifies a single file, to which the message is appended. One or more of
20251 &%use_fcntl_lock%&, &%use_flock_lock%&, or &%use_lockfile%& must be set with
20254 .cindex "NFS" "lock file"
20255 .cindex "locking files"
20256 .cindex "lock files"
20257 If you are using more than one host to deliver over NFS into the same
20258 mailboxes, you should always use lock files.
20260 The string value is expanded for each delivery, and must yield an absolute
20261 path. The most common settings of this option are variations on one of these
20264 file = /var/spool/mail/$local_part
20265 file = /home/$local_part/inbox
20268 .cindex "&""sticky""& bit"
20269 In the first example, all deliveries are done into the same directory. If Exim
20270 is configured to use lock files (see &%use_lockfile%& below) it must be able to
20271 create a file in the directory, so the &"sticky"& bit must be turned on for
20272 deliveries to be possible, or alternatively the &%group%& option can be used to
20273 run the delivery under a group id which has write access to the directory.
20277 .option file_format appendfile string unset
20278 .cindex "file" "mailbox; checking existing format"
20279 This option requests the transport to check the format of an existing file
20280 before adding to it. The check consists of matching a specific string at the
20281 start of the file. The value of the option consists of an even number of
20282 colon-separated strings. The first of each pair is the test string, and the
20283 second is the name of a transport. If the transport associated with a matched
20284 string is not the current transport, control is passed over to the other
20285 transport. For example, suppose the standard &(local_delivery)& transport has
20288 file_format = "From : local_delivery :\
20289 \1\1\1\1\n : local_mmdf_delivery"
20291 Mailboxes that begin with &"From"& are still handled by this transport, but if
20292 a mailbox begins with four binary ones followed by a newline, control is passed
20293 to a transport called &%local_mmdf_delivery%&, which presumably is configured
20294 to do the delivery in MMDF format. If a mailbox does not exist or is empty, it
20295 is assumed to match the current transport. If the start of a mailbox doesn't
20296 match any string, or if the transport named for a given string is not defined,
20297 delivery is deferred.
20300 .option file_must_exist appendfile boolean false
20301 If this option is true, the file specified by the &%file%& option must exist.
20302 A temporary error occurs if it does not, causing delivery to be deferred.
20303 If this option is false, the file is created if it does not exist.
20306 .option lock_fcntl_timeout appendfile time 0s
20307 .cindex "timeout" "mailbox locking"
20308 .cindex "mailbox" "locking, blocking and non-blocking"
20309 .cindex "locking files"
20310 By default, the &(appendfile)& transport uses non-blocking calls to &[fcntl()]&
20311 when locking an open mailbox file. If the call fails, the delivery process
20312 sleeps for &%lock_interval%& and tries again, up to &%lock_retries%& times.
20313 Non-blocking calls are used so that the file is not kept open during the wait
20314 for the lock; the reason for this is to make it as safe as possible for
20315 deliveries over NFS in the case when processes might be accessing an NFS
20316 mailbox without using a lock file. This should not be done, but
20317 misunderstandings and hence misconfigurations are not unknown.
20319 On a busy system, however, the performance of a non-blocking lock approach is
20320 not as good as using a blocking lock with a timeout. In this case, the waiting
20321 is done inside the system call, and Exim's delivery process acquires the lock
20322 and can proceed as soon as the previous lock holder releases it.
20324 If &%lock_fcntl_timeout%& is set to a non-zero time, blocking locks, with that
20325 timeout, are used. There may still be some retrying: the maximum number of
20328 (lock_retries * lock_interval) / lock_fcntl_timeout
20330 rounded up to the next whole number. In other words, the total time during
20331 which &(appendfile)& is trying to get a lock is roughly the same, unless
20332 &%lock_fcntl_timeout%& is set very large.
20334 You should consider setting this option if you are getting a lot of delayed
20335 local deliveries because of errors of the form
20337 failed to lock mailbox /some/file (fcntl)
20340 .option lock_flock_timeout appendfile time 0s
20341 This timeout applies to file locking when using &[flock()]& (see
20342 &%use_flock%&); the timeout operates in a similar manner to
20343 &%lock_fcntl_timeout%&.
20346 .option lock_interval appendfile time 3s
20347 This specifies the time to wait between attempts to lock the file. See below
20348 for details of locking.
20351 .option lock_retries appendfile integer 10
20352 This specifies the maximum number of attempts to lock the file. A value of zero
20353 is treated as 1. See below for details of locking.
20356 .option lockfile_mode appendfile "octal integer" 0600
20357 This specifies the mode of the created lock file, when a lock file is being
20358 used (see &%use_lockfile%& and &%use_mbx_lock%&).
20361 .option lockfile_timeout appendfile time 30m
20362 .cindex "timeout" "mailbox locking"
20363 When a lock file is being used (see &%use_lockfile%&), if a lock file already
20364 exists and is older than this value, it is assumed to have been left behind by
20365 accident, and Exim attempts to remove it.
20368 .option mailbox_filecount appendfile string&!! unset
20369 .cindex "mailbox" "specifying size of"
20370 .cindex "size" "of mailbox"
20371 If this option is set, it is expanded, and the result is taken as the current
20372 number of files in the mailbox. It must be a decimal number, optionally
20373 followed by K or M. This provides a way of obtaining this information from an
20374 external source that maintains the data.
20377 .option mailbox_size appendfile string&!! unset
20378 .cindex "mailbox" "specifying size of"
20379 .cindex "size" "of mailbox"
20380 If this option is set, it is expanded, and the result is taken as the current
20381 size the mailbox. It must be a decimal number, optionally followed by K or M.
20382 This provides a way of obtaining this information from an external source that
20383 maintains the data. This is likely to be helpful for maildir deliveries where
20384 it is computationally expensive to compute the size of a mailbox.
20388 .option maildir_format appendfile boolean false
20389 .cindex "maildir format" "specifying"
20390 If this option is set with the &%directory%& option, the delivery is into a new
20391 file, in the &"maildir"& format that is used by other mail software. When the
20392 transport is activated directly from a &(redirect)& router (for example, the
20393 &(address_file)& transport in the default configuration), setting
20394 &%maildir_format%& causes the path received from the router to be treated as a
20395 directory, whether or not it ends with &`/`&. This option is available only if
20396 SUPPORT_MAILDIR is present in &_Local/Makefile_&. See section
20397 &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below for further details.
20400 .option maildir_quota_directory_regex appendfile string "See below"
20401 .cindex "maildir format" "quota; directories included in"
20402 .cindex "quota" "maildir; directories included in"
20403 This option is relevant only when &%maildir_use_size_file%& is set. It defines
20404 a regular expression for specifying directories, relative to the quota
20405 directory (see &%quota_directory%&), that should be included in the quota
20406 calculation. The default value is:
20408 maildir_quota_directory_regex = ^(?:cur|new|\..*)$
20410 This includes the &_cur_& and &_new_& directories, and any maildir++ folders
20411 (directories whose names begin with a dot). If you want to exclude the
20413 folder from the count (as some sites do), you need to change this setting to
20415 maildir_quota_directory_regex = ^(?:cur|new|\.(?!Trash).*)$
20417 This uses a negative lookahead in the regular expression to exclude the
20418 directory whose name is &_.Trash_&. When a directory is excluded from quota
20419 calculations, quota processing is bypassed for any messages that are delivered
20420 directly into that directory.
20423 .option maildir_retries appendfile integer 10
20424 This option specifies the number of times to retry when writing a file in
20425 &"maildir"& format. See section &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below.
20428 .option maildir_tag appendfile string&!! unset
20429 This option applies only to deliveries in maildir format, and is described in
20430 section &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below.
20433 .option maildir_use_size_file appendfile&!! boolean false
20434 .cindex "maildir format" "&_maildirsize_& file"
20435 The result of string expansion for this option must be a valid boolean value.
20436 If it is true, it enables support for &_maildirsize_& files. Exim
20437 creates a &_maildirsize_& file in a maildir if one does not exist, taking the
20438 quota from the &%quota%& option of the transport. If &%quota%& is unset, the
20439 value is zero. See &%maildir_quota_directory_regex%& above and section
20440 &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below for further details.
20442 .option maildirfolder_create_regex appendfile string unset
20443 .cindex "maildir format" "&_maildirfolder_& file"
20444 .cindex "&_maildirfolder_&, creating"
20445 The value of this option is a regular expression. If it is unset, it has no
20446 effect. Otherwise, before a maildir delivery takes place, the pattern is
20447 matched against the name of the maildir directory, that is, the directory
20448 containing the &_new_& and &_tmp_& subdirectories that will be used for the
20449 delivery. If there is a match, Exim checks for the existence of a file called
20450 &_maildirfolder_& in the directory, and creates it if it does not exist.
20451 See section &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& for more details.
20454 .option mailstore_format appendfile boolean false
20455 .cindex "mailstore format" "specifying"
20456 If this option is set with the &%directory%& option, the delivery is into two
20457 new files in &"mailstore"& format. The option is available only if
20458 SUPPORT_MAILSTORE is present in &_Local/Makefile_&. See section &<<SECTopdir>>&
20459 below for further details.
20462 .option mailstore_prefix appendfile string&!! unset
20463 This option applies only to deliveries in mailstore format, and is described in
20464 section &<<SECTopdir>>& below.
20467 .option mailstore_suffix appendfile string&!! unset
20468 This option applies only to deliveries in mailstore format, and is described in
20469 section &<<SECTopdir>>& below.
20472 .option mbx_format appendfile boolean false
20473 .cindex "locking files"
20474 .cindex "file" "locking"
20475 .cindex "file" "MBX format"
20476 .cindex "MBX format, specifying"
20477 This option is available only if Exim has been compiled with SUPPORT_MBX
20478 set in &_Local/Makefile_&. If &%mbx_format%& is set with the &%file%& option,
20479 the message is appended to the mailbox file in MBX format instead of
20480 traditional Unix format. This format is supported by Pine4 and its associated
20481 IMAP and POP daemons, by means of the &'c-client'& library that they all use.
20483 &*Note*&: The &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& options are not
20484 automatically changed by the use of &%mbx_format%&. They should normally be set
20485 empty when using MBX format, so this option almost always appears in this
20492 If none of the locking options are mentioned in the configuration,
20493 &%use_mbx_lock%& is assumed and the other locking options default to false. It
20494 is possible to specify the other kinds of locking with &%mbx_format%&, but
20495 &%use_fcntl_lock%& and &%use_mbx_lock%& are mutually exclusive. MBX locking
20496 interworks with &'c-client'&, providing for shared access to the mailbox. It
20497 should not be used if any program that does not use this form of locking is
20498 going to access the mailbox, nor should it be used if the mailbox file is NFS
20499 mounted, because it works only when the mailbox is accessed from a single host.
20501 If you set &%use_fcntl_lock%& with an MBX-format mailbox, you cannot use
20502 the standard version of &'c-client'&, because as long as it has a mailbox open
20503 (this means for the whole of a Pine or IMAP session), Exim will not be able to
20504 append messages to it.
20507 .option message_prefix appendfile string&!! "see below"
20508 .cindex "&""From""& line"
20509 The string specified here is expanded and output at the start of every message.
20510 The default is unset unless &%file%& is specified and &%use_bsmtp%& is not set,
20511 in which case it is:
20513 message_prefix = "From ${if def:return_path{$return_path}\
20514 {MAILER-DAEMON}} $tod_bsdinbox\n"
20516 &*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
20517 &`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_prefix%&.
20519 .option message_suffix appendfile string&!! "see below"
20520 The string specified here is expanded and output at the end of every message.
20521 The default is unset unless &%file%& is specified and &%use_bsmtp%& is not set,
20522 in which case it is a single newline character. The suffix can be suppressed by
20527 &*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
20528 &`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_suffix%&.
20530 .option mode appendfile "octal integer" 0600
20531 If the output file is created, it is given this mode. If it already exists and
20532 has wider permissions, they are reduced to this mode. If it has narrower
20533 permissions, an error occurs unless &%mode_fail_narrower%& is false. However,
20534 if the delivery is the result of a &%save%& command in a filter file specifying
20535 a particular mode, the mode of the output file is always forced to take that
20536 value, and this option is ignored.
20539 .option mode_fail_narrower appendfile boolean true
20540 This option applies in the case when an existing mailbox file has a narrower
20541 mode than that specified by the &%mode%& option. If &%mode_fail_narrower%& is
20542 true, the delivery is deferred (&"mailbox has the wrong mode"&); otherwise Exim
20543 continues with the delivery attempt, using the existing mode of the file.
20546 .option notify_comsat appendfile boolean false
20547 If this option is true, the &'comsat'& daemon is notified after every
20548 successful delivery to a user mailbox. This is the daemon that notifies logged
20549 on users about incoming mail.
20552 .option quota appendfile string&!! unset
20553 .cindex "quota" "imposed by Exim"
20554 This option imposes a limit on the size of the file to which Exim is appending,
20555 or to the total space used in the directory tree when the &%directory%& option
20556 is set. In the latter case, computation of the space used is expensive, because
20557 all the files in the directory (and any sub-directories) have to be
20558 individually inspected and their sizes summed. (See &%quota_size_regex%& and
20559 &%maildir_use_size_file%& for ways to avoid this in environments where users
20560 have no shell access to their mailboxes).
20562 As there is no interlock against two simultaneous deliveries into a
20563 multi-file mailbox, it is possible for the quota to be overrun in this case.
20564 For single-file mailboxes, of course, an interlock is a necessity.
20566 A file's size is taken as its &'used'& value. Because of blocking effects, this
20567 may be a lot less than the actual amount of disk space allocated to the file.
20568 If the sizes of a number of files are being added up, the rounding effect can
20569 become quite noticeable, especially on systems that have large block sizes.
20570 Nevertheless, it seems best to stick to the &'used'& figure, because this is
20571 the obvious value which users understand most easily.
20573 The value of the option is expanded, and must then be a numerical value
20574 (decimal point allowed), optionally followed by one of the letters K, M, or G,
20575 for kilobytes, megabytes, or gigabytes. If Exim is running on a system with
20576 large file support (Linux and FreeBSD have this), mailboxes larger than 2G can
20579 &*Note*&: A value of zero is interpreted as &"no quota"&.
20581 The expansion happens while Exim is running as root, before it changes uid for
20582 the delivery. This means that files that are inaccessible to the end user can
20583 be used to hold quota values that are looked up in the expansion. When delivery
20584 fails because this quota is exceeded, the handling of the error is as for
20585 system quota failures.
20587 By default, Exim's quota checking mimics system quotas, and restricts the
20588 mailbox to the specified maximum size, though the value is not accurate to the
20589 last byte, owing to separator lines and additional headers that may get added
20590 during message delivery. When a mailbox is nearly full, large messages may get
20591 refused even though small ones are accepted, because the size of the current
20592 message is added to the quota when the check is made. This behaviour can be
20593 changed by setting &%quota_is_inclusive%& false. When this is done, the check
20594 for exceeding the quota does not include the current message. Thus, deliveries
20595 continue until the quota has been exceeded; thereafter, no further messages are
20596 delivered. See also &%quota_warn_threshold%&.
20599 .option quota_directory appendfile string&!! unset
20600 This option defines the directory to check for quota purposes when delivering
20601 into individual files. The default is the delivery directory, or, if a file
20602 called &_maildirfolder_& exists in a maildir directory, the parent of the
20603 delivery directory.
20606 .option quota_filecount appendfile string&!! 0
20607 This option applies when the &%directory%& option is set. It limits the total
20608 number of files in the directory (compare the inode limit in system quotas). It
20609 can only be used if &%quota%& is also set. The value is expanded; an expansion
20610 failure causes delivery to be deferred. A value of zero is interpreted as
20614 .option quota_is_inclusive appendfile boolean true
20615 See &%quota%& above.
20618 .option quota_size_regex appendfile string unset
20619 This option applies when one of the delivery modes that writes a separate file
20620 for each message is being used. When Exim wants to find the size of one of
20621 these files in order to test the quota, it first checks &%quota_size_regex%&.
20622 If this is set to a regular expression that matches the file name, and it
20623 captures one string, that string is interpreted as a representation of the
20624 file's size. The value of &%quota_size_regex%& is not expanded.
20626 This feature is useful only when users have no shell access to their mailboxes
20627 &-- otherwise they could defeat the quota simply by renaming the files. This
20628 facility can be used with maildir deliveries, by setting &%maildir_tag%& to add
20629 the file length to the file name. For example:
20631 maildir_tag = ,S=$message_size
20632 quota_size_regex = ,S=(\d+)
20634 An alternative to &$message_size$& is &$message_linecount$&, which contains the
20635 number of lines in the message.
20637 The regular expression should not assume that the length is at the end of the
20638 file name (even though &%maildir_tag%& puts it there) because maildir MUAs
20639 sometimes add other information onto the ends of message file names.
20641 Section &<<SECID136>>& contains further information.
20644 .option quota_warn_message appendfile string&!! "see below"
20645 See below for the use of this option. If it is not set when
20646 &%quota_warn_threshold%& is set, it defaults to
20648 quota_warn_message = "\
20649 To: $local_part@$domain\n\
20650 Subject: Your mailbox\n\n\
20651 This message is automatically created \
20652 by mail delivery software.\n\n\
20653 The size of your mailbox has exceeded \
20654 a warning threshold that is\n\
20655 set by the system administrator.\n"
20659 .option quota_warn_threshold appendfile string&!! 0
20660 .cindex "quota" "warning threshold"
20661 .cindex "mailbox" "size warning"
20662 .cindex "size" "of mailbox"
20663 This option is expanded in the same way as &%quota%& (see above). If the
20664 resulting value is greater than zero, and delivery of the message causes the
20665 size of the file or total space in the directory tree to cross the given
20666 threshold, a warning message is sent. If &%quota%& is also set, the threshold
20667 may be specified as a percentage of it by following the value with a percent
20671 quota_warn_threshold = 75%
20673 If &%quota%& is not set, a setting of &%quota_warn_threshold%& that ends with a
20674 percent sign is ignored.
20676 The warning message itself is specified by the &%quota_warn_message%& option,
20677 and it must start with a &'To:'& header line containing the recipient(s) of the
20678 warning message. These do not necessarily have to include the recipient(s) of
20679 the original message. A &'Subject:'& line should also normally be supplied. You
20680 can include any other header lines that you want. If you do not include a
20681 &'From:'& line, the default is:
20683 From: Mail Delivery System <mailer-daemon@$qualify_domain_sender>
20685 .oindex &%errors_reply_to%&
20686 If you supply a &'Reply-To:'& line, it overrides the global &%errors_reply_to%&
20689 The &%quota%& option does not have to be set in order to use this option; they
20690 are independent of one another except when the threshold is specified as a
20694 .option use_bsmtp appendfile boolean false
20695 .cindex "envelope sender"
20696 If this option is set true, &(appendfile)& writes messages in &"batch SMTP"&
20697 format, with the envelope sender and recipient(s) included as SMTP commands. If
20698 you want to include a leading HELO command with such messages, you can do
20699 so by setting the &%message_prefix%& option. See section &<<SECTbatchSMTP>>&
20700 for details of batch SMTP.
20703 .option use_crlf appendfile boolean false
20704 .cindex "carriage return"
20706 This option causes lines to be terminated with the two-character CRLF sequence
20707 (carriage return, linefeed) instead of just a linefeed character. In the case
20708 of batched SMTP, the byte sequence written to the file is then an exact image
20709 of what would be sent down a real SMTP connection.
20711 &*Note:*& The contents of the &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& options
20712 (which are used to supply the traditional &"From&~"& and blank line separators
20713 in Berkeley-style mailboxes) are written verbatim, so must contain their own
20714 carriage return characters if these are needed. In cases where these options
20715 have non-empty defaults, the values end with a single linefeed, so they must be
20716 changed to end with &`\r\n`& if &%use_crlf%& is set.
20719 .option use_fcntl_lock appendfile boolean "see below"
20720 This option controls the use of the &[fcntl()]& function to lock a file for
20721 exclusive use when a message is being appended. It is set by default unless
20722 &%use_flock_lock%& is set. Otherwise, it should be turned off only if you know
20723 that all your MUAs use lock file locking. When both &%use_fcntl_lock%& and
20724 &%use_flock_lock%& are unset, &%use_lockfile%& must be set.
20727 .option use_flock_lock appendfile boolean false
20728 This option is provided to support the use of &[flock()]& for file locking, for
20729 the few situations where it is needed. Most modern operating systems support
20730 &[fcntl()]& and &[lockf()]& locking, and these two functions interwork with
20731 each other. Exim uses &[fcntl()]& locking by default.
20733 This option is required only if you are using an operating system where
20734 &[flock()]& is used by programs that access mailboxes (typically MUAs), and
20735 where &[flock()]& does not correctly interwork with &[fcntl()]&. You can use
20736 both &[fcntl()]& and &[flock()]& locking simultaneously if you want.
20738 .cindex "Solaris" "&[flock()]& support"
20739 Not all operating systems provide &[flock()]&. Some versions of Solaris do not
20740 have it (and some, I think, provide a not quite right version built on top of
20741 &[lockf()]&). If the OS does not have &[flock()]&, Exim will be built without
20742 the ability to use it, and any attempt to do so will cause a configuration
20745 &*Warning*&: &[flock()]& locks do not work on NFS files (unless &[flock()]&
20746 is just being mapped onto &[fcntl()]& by the OS).
20749 .option use_lockfile appendfile boolean "see below"
20750 If this option is turned off, Exim does not attempt to create a lock file when
20751 appending to a mailbox file. In this situation, the only locking is by
20752 &[fcntl()]&. You should only turn &%use_lockfile%& off if you are absolutely
20753 sure that every MUA that is ever going to look at your users' mailboxes uses
20754 &[fcntl()]& rather than a lock file, and even then only when you are not
20755 delivering over NFS from more than one host.
20757 .cindex "NFS" "lock file"
20758 In order to append to an NFS file safely from more than one host, it is
20759 necessary to take out a lock &'before'& opening the file, and the lock file
20760 achieves this. Otherwise, even with &[fcntl()]& locking, there is a risk of
20763 The &%use_lockfile%& option is set by default unless &%use_mbx_lock%& is set.
20764 It is not possible to turn both &%use_lockfile%& and &%use_fcntl_lock%& off,
20765 except when &%mbx_format%& is set.
20768 .option use_mbx_lock appendfile boolean "see below"
20769 This option is available only if Exim has been compiled with SUPPORT_MBX
20770 set in &_Local/Makefile_&. Setting the option specifies that special MBX
20771 locking rules be used. It is set by default if &%mbx_format%& is set and none
20772 of the locking options are mentioned in the configuration. The locking rules
20773 are the same as are used by the &'c-client'& library that underlies Pine and
20774 the IMAP4 and POP daemons that come with it (see the discussion below). The
20775 rules allow for shared access to the mailbox. However, this kind of locking
20776 does not work when the mailbox is NFS mounted.
20778 You can set &%use_mbx_lock%& with either (or both) of &%use_fcntl_lock%& and
20779 &%use_flock_lock%& to control what kind of locking is used in implementing the
20780 MBX locking rules. The default is to use &[fcntl()]& if &%use_mbx_lock%& is set
20781 without &%use_fcntl_lock%& or &%use_flock_lock%&.
20786 .section "Operational details for appending" "SECTopappend"
20787 .cindex "appending to a file"
20788 .cindex "file" "appending"
20789 Before appending to a file, the following preparations are made:
20792 If the name of the file is &_/dev/null_&, no action is taken, and a success
20796 .cindex "directory creation"
20797 If any directories on the file's path are missing, Exim creates them if the
20798 &%create_directory%& option is set. A created directory's mode is given by the
20799 &%directory_mode%& option.
20802 If &%file_format%& is set, the format of an existing file is checked. If this
20803 indicates that a different transport should be used, control is passed to that
20807 .cindex "file" "locking"
20808 .cindex "locking files"
20809 .cindex "NFS" "lock file"
20810 If &%use_lockfile%& is set, a lock file is built in a way that will work
20811 reliably over NFS, as follows:
20814 Create a &"hitching post"& file whose name is that of the lock file with the
20815 current time, primary host name, and process id added, by opening for writing
20816 as a new file. If this fails with an access error, delivery is deferred.
20818 Close the hitching post file, and hard link it to the lock file name.
20820 If the call to &[link()]& succeeds, creation of the lock file has succeeded.
20821 Unlink the hitching post name.
20823 Otherwise, use &[stat()]& to get information about the hitching post file, and
20824 then unlink hitching post name. If the number of links is exactly two, creation
20825 of the lock file succeeded but something (for example, an NFS server crash and
20826 restart) caused this fact not to be communicated to the &[link()]& call.
20828 If creation of the lock file failed, wait for &%lock_interval%& and try again,
20829 up to &%lock_retries%& times. However, since any program that writes to a
20830 mailbox should complete its task very quickly, it is reasonable to time out old
20831 lock files that are normally the result of user agent and system crashes. If an
20832 existing lock file is older than &%lockfile_timeout%& Exim attempts to unlink
20833 it before trying again.
20837 A call is made to &[lstat()]& to discover whether the main file exists, and if
20838 so, what its characteristics are. If &[lstat()]& fails for any reason other
20839 than non-existence, delivery is deferred.
20842 .cindex "symbolic link" "to mailbox"
20843 .cindex "mailbox" "symbolic link"
20844 If the file does exist and is a symbolic link, delivery is deferred, unless the
20845 &%allow_symlink%& option is set, in which case the ownership of the link is
20846 checked, and then &[stat()]& is called to find out about the real file, which
20847 is then subjected to the checks below. The check on the top-level link
20848 ownership prevents one user creating a link for another's mailbox in a sticky
20849 directory, though allowing symbolic links in this case is definitely not a good
20850 idea. If there is a chain of symbolic links, the intermediate ones are not
20854 If the file already exists but is not a regular file, or if the file's owner
20855 and group (if the group is being checked &-- see &%check_group%& above) are
20856 different from the user and group under which the delivery is running,
20857 delivery is deferred.
20860 If the file's permissions are more generous than specified, they are reduced.
20861 If they are insufficient, delivery is deferred, unless &%mode_fail_narrower%&
20862 is set false, in which case the delivery is tried using the existing
20866 The file's inode number is saved, and the file is then opened for appending.
20867 If this fails because the file has vanished, &(appendfile)& behaves as if it
20868 hadn't existed (see below). For any other failures, delivery is deferred.
20871 If the file is opened successfully, check that the inode number hasn't
20872 changed, that it is still a regular file, and that the owner and permissions
20873 have not changed. If anything is wrong, defer delivery and freeze the message.
20876 If the file did not exist originally, defer delivery if the &%file_must_exist%&
20877 option is set. Otherwise, check that the file is being created in a permitted
20878 directory if the &%create_file%& option is set (deferring on failure), and then
20879 open for writing as a new file, with the O_EXCL and O_CREAT options,
20880 except when dealing with a symbolic link (the &%allow_symlink%& option must be
20881 set). In this case, which can happen if the link points to a non-existent file,
20882 the file is opened for writing using O_CREAT but not O_EXCL, because
20883 that prevents link following.
20886 .cindex "loop" "while file testing"
20887 If opening fails because the file exists, obey the tests given above for
20888 existing files. However, to avoid looping in a situation where the file is
20889 being continuously created and destroyed, the exists/not-exists loop is broken
20890 after 10 repetitions, and the message is then frozen.
20893 If opening fails with any other error, defer delivery.
20896 .cindex "file" "locking"
20897 .cindex "locking files"
20898 Once the file is open, unless both &%use_fcntl_lock%& and &%use_flock_lock%&
20899 are false, it is locked using &[fcntl()]& or &[flock()]& or both. If
20900 &%use_mbx_lock%& is false, an exclusive lock is requested in each case.
20901 However, if &%use_mbx_lock%& is true, Exim takes out a shared lock on the open
20902 file, and an exclusive lock on the file whose name is
20904 /tmp/.<device-number>.<inode-number>
20906 using the device and inode numbers of the open mailbox file, in accordance with
20907 the MBX locking rules. This file is created with a mode that is specified by
20908 the &%lockfile_mode%& option.
20910 If Exim fails to lock the file, there are two possible courses of action,
20911 depending on the value of the locking timeout. This is obtained from
20912 &%lock_fcntl_timeout%& or &%lock_flock_timeout%&, as appropriate.
20914 If the timeout value is zero, the file is closed, Exim waits for
20915 &%lock_interval%&, and then goes back and re-opens the file as above and tries
20916 to lock it again. This happens up to &%lock_retries%& times, after which the
20917 delivery is deferred.
20919 If the timeout has a value greater than zero, blocking calls to &[fcntl()]& or
20920 &[flock()]& are used (with the given timeout), so there has already been some
20921 waiting involved by the time locking fails. Nevertheless, Exim does not give up
20922 immediately. It retries up to
20924 (lock_retries * lock_interval) / <timeout>
20926 times (rounded up).
20929 At the end of delivery, Exim closes the file (which releases the &[fcntl()]&
20930 and/or &[flock()]& locks) and then deletes the lock file if one was created.
20933 .section "Operational details for delivery to a new file" "SECTopdir"
20934 .cindex "delivery" "to single file"
20935 .cindex "&""From""& line"
20936 When the &%directory%& option is set instead of &%file%&, each message is
20937 delivered into a newly-created file or set of files. When &(appendfile)& is
20938 activated directly from a &(redirect)& router, neither &%file%& nor
20939 &%directory%& is normally set, because the path for delivery is supplied by the
20940 router. (See for example, the &(address_file)& transport in the default
20941 configuration.) In this case, delivery is to a new file if either the path name
20942 ends in &`/`&, or the &%maildir_format%& or &%mailstore_format%& option is set.
20944 No locking is required while writing the message to a new file, so the various
20945 locking options of the transport are ignored. The &"From"& line that by default
20946 separates messages in a single file is not normally needed, nor is the escaping
20947 of message lines that start with &"From"&, and there is no need to ensure a
20948 newline at the end of each message. Consequently, the default values for
20949 &%check_string%&, &%message_prefix%&, and &%message_suffix%& are all unset when
20950 any of &%directory%&, &%maildir_format%&, or &%mailstore_format%& is set.
20952 If Exim is required to check a &%quota%& setting, it adds up the sizes of all
20953 the files in the delivery directory by default. However, you can specify a
20954 different directory by setting &%quota_directory%&. Also, for maildir
20955 deliveries (see below) the &_maildirfolder_& convention is honoured.
20958 .cindex "maildir format"
20959 .cindex "mailstore format"
20960 There are three different ways in which delivery to individual files can be
20961 done, controlled by the settings of the &%maildir_format%& and
20962 &%mailstore_format%& options. Note that code to support maildir or mailstore
20963 formats is not included in the binary unless SUPPORT_MAILDIR or
20964 SUPPORT_MAILSTORE, respectively, is set in &_Local/Makefile_&.
20966 .cindex "directory creation"
20967 In all three cases an attempt is made to create the directory and any necessary
20968 sub-directories if they do not exist, provided that the &%create_directory%&
20969 option is set (the default). The location of a created directory can be
20970 constrained by setting &%create_file%&. A created directory's mode is given by
20971 the &%directory_mode%& option. If creation fails, or if the
20972 &%create_directory%& option is not set when creation is required, delivery is
20977 .section "Maildir delivery" "SECTmaildirdelivery"
20978 .cindex "maildir format" "description of"
20979 If the &%maildir_format%& option is true, Exim delivers each message by writing
20980 it to a file whose name is &_tmp/<stime>.H<mtime>P<pid>.<host>_& in the
20981 directory that is defined by the &%directory%& option (the &"delivery
20982 directory"&). If the delivery is successful, the file is renamed into the
20983 &_new_& subdirectory.
20985 In the file name, <&'stime'&> is the current time of day in seconds, and
20986 <&'mtime'&> is the microsecond fraction of the time. After a maildir delivery,
20987 Exim checks that the time-of-day clock has moved on by at least one microsecond
20988 before terminating the delivery process. This guarantees uniqueness for the
20989 file name. However, as a precaution, Exim calls &[stat()]& for the file before
20990 opening it. If any response other than ENOENT (does not exist) is given,
20991 Exim waits 2 seconds and tries again, up to &%maildir_retries%& times.
20993 Before Exim carries out a maildir delivery, it ensures that subdirectories
20994 called &_new_&, &_cur_&, and &_tmp_& exist in the delivery directory. If they
20995 do not exist, Exim tries to create them and any superior directories in their
20996 path, subject to the &%create_directory%& and &%create_file%& options. If the
20997 &%maildirfolder_create_regex%& option is set, and the regular expression it
20998 contains matches the delivery directory, Exim also ensures that a file called
20999 &_maildirfolder_& exists in the delivery directory. If a missing directory or
21000 &_maildirfolder_& file cannot be created, delivery is deferred.
21002 These features make it possible to use Exim to create all the necessary files
21003 and directories in a maildir mailbox, including subdirectories for maildir++
21004 folders. Consider this example:
21006 maildir_format = true
21007 directory = /var/mail/$local_part\
21008 ${if eq{$local_part_suffix}{}{}\
21009 {/.${substr_1:$local_part_suffix}}}
21010 maildirfolder_create_regex = /\.[^/]+$
21012 If &$local_part_suffix$& is empty (there was no suffix for the local part),
21013 delivery is into a toplevel maildir with a name like &_/var/mail/pimbo_& (for
21014 the user called &'pimbo'&). The pattern in &%maildirfolder_create_regex%& does
21015 not match this name, so Exim will not look for or create the file
21016 &_/var/mail/pimbo/maildirfolder_&, though it will create
21017 &_/var/mail/pimbo/{cur,new,tmp}_& if necessary.
21019 However, if &$local_part_suffix$& contains &`-eximusers`& (for example),
21020 delivery is into the maildir++ folder &_/var/mail/pimbo/.eximusers_&, which
21021 does match &%maildirfolder_create_regex%&. In this case, Exim will create
21022 &_/var/mail/pimbo/.eximusers/maildirfolder_& as well as the three maildir
21023 directories &_/var/mail/pimbo/.eximusers/{cur,new,tmp}_&.
21025 &*Warning:*& Take care when setting &%maildirfolder_create_regex%& that it does
21026 not inadvertently match the toplevel maildir directory, because a
21027 &_maildirfolder_& file at top level would completely break quota calculations.
21029 .cindex "quota" "in maildir delivery"
21030 .cindex "maildir++"
21031 If Exim is required to check a &%quota%& setting before a maildir delivery, and
21032 &%quota_directory%& is not set, it looks for a file called &_maildirfolder_& in
21033 the maildir directory (alongside &_new_&, &_cur_&, &_tmp_&). If this exists,
21034 Exim assumes the directory is a maildir++ folder directory, which is one level
21035 down from the user's top level mailbox directory. This causes it to start at
21036 the parent directory instead of the current directory when calculating the
21037 amount of space used.
21039 One problem with delivering into a multi-file mailbox is that it is
21040 computationally expensive to compute the size of the mailbox for quota
21041 checking. Various approaches have been taken to reduce the amount of work
21042 needed. The next two sections describe two of them. A third alternative is to
21043 use some external process for maintaining the size data, and use the expansion
21044 of the &%mailbox_size%& option as a way of importing it into Exim.
21049 .section "Using tags to record message sizes" "SECID135"
21050 If &%maildir_tag%& is set, the string is expanded for each delivery.
21051 When the maildir file is renamed into the &_new_& sub-directory, the
21052 tag is added to its name. However, if adding the tag takes the length of the
21053 name to the point where the test &[stat()]& call fails with ENAMETOOLONG,
21054 the tag is dropped and the maildir file is created with no tag.
21057 .vindex "&$message_size$&"
21058 Tags can be used to encode the size of files in their names; see
21059 &%quota_size_regex%& above for an example. The expansion of &%maildir_tag%&
21060 happens after the message has been written. The value of the &$message_size$&
21061 variable is set to the number of bytes actually written. If the expansion is
21062 forced to fail, the tag is ignored, but a non-forced failure causes delivery to
21063 be deferred. The expanded tag may contain any printing characters except &"/"&.
21064 Non-printing characters in the string are ignored; if the resulting string is
21065 empty, it is ignored. If it starts with an alphanumeric character, a leading
21066 colon is inserted; this default has not proven to be the path that popular
21067 maildir implementations have chosen (but changing it in Exim would break
21068 backwards compatibility).
21070 For one common implementation, you might set:
21072 maildir_tag = ,S=${message_size}
21074 but you should check the documentation of the other software to be sure.
21076 It is advisable to also set &%quota_size_regex%& when setting &%maildir_tag%&
21077 as this allows Exim to extract the size from your tag, instead of having to
21078 &[stat()]& each message file.
21081 .section "Using a maildirsize file" "SECID136"
21082 .cindex "quota" "in maildir delivery"
21083 .cindex "maildir format" "&_maildirsize_& file"
21084 If &%maildir_use_size_file%& is true, Exim implements the maildir++ rules for
21085 storing quota and message size information in a file called &_maildirsize_&
21086 within the toplevel maildir directory. If this file does not exist, Exim
21087 creates it, setting the quota from the &%quota%& option of the transport. If
21088 the maildir directory itself does not exist, it is created before any attempt
21089 to write a &_maildirsize_& file.
21091 The &_maildirsize_& file is used to hold information about the sizes of
21092 messages in the maildir, thus speeding up quota calculations. The quota value
21093 in the file is just a cache; if the quota is changed in the transport, the new
21094 value overrides the cached value when the next message is delivered. The cache
21095 is maintained for the benefit of other programs that access the maildir and
21096 need to know the quota.
21098 If the &%quota%& option in the transport is unset or zero, the &_maildirsize_&
21099 file is maintained (with a zero quota setting), but no quota is imposed.
21101 A regular expression is available for controlling which directories in the
21102 maildir participate in quota calculations when a &_maildirsizefile_& is in use.
21103 See the description of the &%maildir_quota_directory_regex%& option above for
21107 .section "Mailstore delivery" "SECID137"
21108 .cindex "mailstore format" "description of"
21109 If the &%mailstore_format%& option is true, each message is written as two
21110 files in the given directory. A unique base name is constructed from the
21111 message id and the current delivery process, and the files that are written use
21112 this base name plus the suffixes &_.env_& and &_.msg_&. The &_.env_& file
21113 contains the message's envelope, and the &_.msg_& file contains the message
21114 itself. The base name is placed in the variable &$mailstore_basename$&.
21116 During delivery, the envelope is first written to a file with the suffix
21117 &_.tmp_&. The &_.msg_& file is then written, and when it is complete, the
21118 &_.tmp_& file is renamed as the &_.env_& file. Programs that access messages in
21119 mailstore format should wait for the presence of both a &_.msg_& and a &_.env_&
21120 file before accessing either of them. An alternative approach is to wait for
21121 the absence of a &_.tmp_& file.
21123 The envelope file starts with any text defined by the &%mailstore_prefix%&
21124 option, expanded and terminated by a newline if there isn't one. Then follows
21125 the sender address on one line, then all the recipient addresses, one per line.
21126 There can be more than one recipient only if the &%batch_max%& option is set
21127 greater than one. Finally, &%mailstore_suffix%& is expanded and the result
21128 appended to the file, followed by a newline if it does not end with one.
21130 If expansion of &%mailstore_prefix%& or &%mailstore_suffix%& ends with a forced
21131 failure, it is ignored. Other expansion errors are treated as serious
21132 configuration errors, and delivery is deferred. The variable
21133 &$mailstore_basename$& is available for use during these expansions.
21136 .section "Non-special new file delivery" "SECID138"
21137 If neither &%maildir_format%& nor &%mailstore_format%& is set, a single new
21138 file is created directly in the named directory. For example, when delivering
21139 messages into files in batched SMTP format for later delivery to some host (see
21140 section &<<SECTbatchSMTP>>&), a setting such as
21142 directory = /var/bsmtp/$host
21144 might be used. A message is written to a file with a temporary name, which is
21145 then renamed when the delivery is complete. The final name is obtained by
21146 expanding the contents of the &%directory_file%& option.
21147 .ecindex IIDapptra1
21148 .ecindex IIDapptra2
21155 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21156 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21158 .chapter "The autoreply transport" "CHID8"
21159 .scindex IIDauttra1 "transports" "&(autoreply)&"
21160 .scindex IIDauttra2 "&(autoreply)& transport"
21161 The &(autoreply)& transport is not a true transport in that it does not cause
21162 the message to be transmitted. Instead, it generates a new mail message as an
21163 automatic reply to the incoming message. &'References:'& and
21164 &'Auto-Submitted:'& header lines are included. These are constructed according
21165 to the rules in RFCs 2822 and 3834, respectively.
21167 If the router that passes the message to this transport does not have the
21168 &%unseen%& option set, the original message (for the current recipient) is not
21169 delivered anywhere. However, when the &%unseen%& option is set on the router
21170 that passes the message to this transport, routing of the address continues, so
21171 another router can set up a normal message delivery.
21174 The &(autoreply)& transport is usually run as the result of mail filtering, a
21175 &"vacation"& message being the standard example. However, it can also be run
21176 directly from a router like any other transport. To reduce the possibility of
21177 message cascades, messages created by the &(autoreply)& transport always have
21178 empty envelope sender addresses, like bounce messages.
21180 The parameters of the message to be sent can be specified in the configuration
21181 by options described below. However, these are used only when the address
21182 passed to the transport does not contain its own reply information. When the
21183 transport is run as a consequence of a
21185 or &%vacation%& command in a filter file, the parameters of the message are
21186 supplied by the filter, and passed with the address. The transport's options
21187 that define the message are then ignored (so they are not usually set in this
21188 case). The message is specified entirely by the filter or by the transport; it
21189 is never built from a mixture of options. However, the &%file_optional%&,
21190 &%mode%&, and &%return_message%& options apply in all cases.
21192 &(Autoreply)& is implemented as a local transport. When used as a result of a
21193 command in a user's filter file, &(autoreply)& normally runs under the uid and
21194 gid of the user, and with appropriate current and home directories (see chapter
21195 &<<CHAPenvironment>>&).
21197 There is a subtle difference between routing a message to a &(pipe)& transport
21198 that generates some text to be returned to the sender, and routing it to an
21199 &(autoreply)& transport. This difference is noticeable only if more than one
21200 address from the same message is so handled. In the case of a pipe, the
21201 separate outputs from the different addresses are gathered up and returned to
21202 the sender in a single message, whereas if &(autoreply)& is used, a separate
21203 message is generated for each address that is passed to it.
21205 Non-printing characters are not permitted in the header lines generated for the
21206 message that &(autoreply)& creates, with the exception of newlines that are
21207 immediately followed by white space. If any non-printing characters are found,
21208 the transport defers.
21209 Whether characters with the top bit set count as printing characters or not is
21210 controlled by the &%print_topbitchars%& global option.
21212 If any of the generic options for manipulating headers (for example,
21213 &%headers_add%&) are set on an &(autoreply)& transport, they apply to the copy
21214 of the original message that is included in the generated message when
21215 &%return_message%& is set. They do not apply to the generated message itself.
21217 .vindex "&$sender_address$&"
21218 If the &(autoreply)& transport receives return code 2 from Exim when it submits
21219 the message, indicating that there were no recipients, it does not treat this
21220 as an error. This means that autoreplies sent to &$sender_address$& when this
21221 is empty (because the incoming message is a bounce message) do not cause
21222 problems. They are just discarded.
21226 .section "Private options for autoreply" "SECID139"
21227 .cindex "options" "&(autoreply)& transport"
21229 .option bcc autoreply string&!! unset
21230 This specifies the addresses that are to receive &"blind carbon copies"& of the
21231 message when the message is specified by the transport.
21234 .option cc autoreply string&!! unset
21235 This specifies recipients of the message and the contents of the &'Cc:'& header
21236 when the message is specified by the transport.
21239 .option file autoreply string&!! unset
21240 The contents of the file are sent as the body of the message when the message
21241 is specified by the transport. If both &%file%& and &%text%& are set, the text
21242 string comes first.
21245 .option file_expand autoreply boolean false
21246 If this is set, the contents of the file named by the &%file%& option are
21247 subjected to string expansion as they are added to the message.
21250 .option file_optional autoreply boolean false
21251 If this option is true, no error is generated if the file named by the &%file%&
21252 option or passed with the address does not exist or cannot be read.
21255 .option from autoreply string&!! unset
21256 This specifies the contents of the &'From:'& header when the message is
21257 specified by the transport.
21260 .option headers autoreply string&!! unset
21261 This specifies additional RFC 2822 headers that are to be added to the message
21262 when the message is specified by the transport. Several can be given by using
21263 &"\n"& to separate them. There is no check on the format.
21266 .option log autoreply string&!! unset
21267 This option names a file in which a record of every message sent is logged when
21268 the message is specified by the transport.
21271 .option mode autoreply "octal integer" 0600
21272 If either the log file or the &"once"& file has to be created, this mode is
21276 .option never_mail autoreply "address list&!!" unset
21277 If any run of the transport creates a message with a recipient that matches any
21278 item in the list, that recipient is quietly discarded. If all recipients are
21279 discarded, no message is created. This applies both when the recipients are
21280 generated by a filter and when they are specified in the transport.
21284 .option once autoreply string&!! unset
21285 This option names a file or DBM database in which a record of each &'To:'&
21286 recipient is kept when the message is specified by the transport. &*Note*&:
21287 This does not apply to &'Cc:'& or &'Bcc:'& recipients.
21289 If &%once%& is unset, or is set to an empty string, the message is always sent.
21290 By default, if &%once%& is set to a non-empty file name, the message
21291 is not sent if a potential recipient is already listed in the database.
21292 However, if the &%once_repeat%& option specifies a time greater than zero, the
21293 message is sent if that much time has elapsed since a message was last sent to
21294 this recipient. A setting of zero time for &%once_repeat%& (the default)
21295 prevents a message from being sent a second time &-- in this case, zero means
21298 If &%once_file_size%& is zero, a DBM database is used to remember recipients,
21299 and it is allowed to grow as large as necessary. If &%once_file_size%& is set
21300 greater than zero, it changes the way Exim implements the &%once%& option.
21301 Instead of using a DBM file to record every recipient it sends to, it uses a
21302 regular file, whose size will never get larger than the given value.
21304 In the file, Exim keeps a linear list of recipient addresses and the times at
21305 which they were sent messages. If the file is full when a new address needs to
21306 be added, the oldest address is dropped. If &%once_repeat%& is not set, this
21307 means that a given recipient may receive multiple messages, but at
21308 unpredictable intervals that depend on the rate of turnover of addresses in the
21309 file. If &%once_repeat%& is set, it specifies a maximum time between repeats.
21312 .option once_file_size autoreply integer 0
21313 See &%once%& above.
21316 .option once_repeat autoreply time&!! 0s
21317 See &%once%& above.
21318 After expansion, the value of this option must be a valid time value.
21321 .option reply_to autoreply string&!! unset
21322 This specifies the contents of the &'Reply-To:'& header when the message is
21323 specified by the transport.
21326 .option return_message autoreply boolean false
21327 If this is set, a copy of the original message is returned with the new
21328 message, subject to the maximum size set in the &%return_size_limit%& global
21329 configuration option.
21332 .option subject autoreply string&!! unset
21333 This specifies the contents of the &'Subject:'& header when the message is
21334 specified by the transport. It is tempting to quote the original subject in
21335 automatic responses. For example:
21337 subject = Re: $h_subject:
21339 There is a danger in doing this, however. It may allow a third party to
21340 subscribe your users to an opt-in mailing list, provided that the list accepts
21341 bounce messages as subscription confirmations. Well-managed lists require a
21342 non-bounce message to confirm a subscription, so the danger is relatively
21347 .option text autoreply string&!! unset
21348 This specifies a single string to be used as the body of the message when the
21349 message is specified by the transport. If both &%text%& and &%file%& are set,
21350 the text comes first.
21353 .option to autoreply string&!! unset
21354 This specifies recipients of the message and the contents of the &'To:'& header
21355 when the message is specified by the transport.
21356 .ecindex IIDauttra1
21357 .ecindex IIDauttra2
21362 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21363 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21365 .chapter "The lmtp transport" "CHAPLMTP"
21366 .cindex "transports" "&(lmtp)&"
21367 .cindex "&(lmtp)& transport"
21368 .cindex "LMTP" "over a pipe"
21369 .cindex "LMTP" "over a socket"
21370 The &(lmtp)& transport runs the LMTP protocol (RFC 2033) over a pipe to a
21372 or by interacting with a Unix domain socket.
21373 This transport is something of a cross between the &(pipe)& and &(smtp)&
21374 transports. Exim also has support for using LMTP over TCP/IP; this is
21375 implemented as an option for the &(smtp)& transport. Because LMTP is expected
21376 to be of minority interest, the default build-time configure in &_src/EDITME_&
21377 has it commented out. You need to ensure that
21381 .cindex "options" "&(lmtp)& transport"
21382 is present in your &_Local/Makefile_& in order to have the &(lmtp)& transport
21383 included in the Exim binary. The private options of the &(lmtp)& transport are
21386 .option batch_id lmtp string&!! unset
21387 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
21390 .option batch_max lmtp integer 1
21391 This limits the number of addresses that can be handled in a single delivery.
21392 Most LMTP servers can handle several addresses at once, so it is normally a
21393 good idea to increase this value. See the description of local delivery
21394 batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
21397 .option command lmtp string&!! unset
21398 This option must be set if &%socket%& is not set. The string is a command which
21399 is run in a separate process. It is split up into a command name and list of
21400 arguments, each of which is separately expanded (so expansion cannot change the
21401 number of arguments). The command is run directly, not via a shell. The message
21402 is passed to the new process using the standard input and output to operate the
21405 .option ignore_quota lmtp boolean false
21406 .cindex "LMTP" "ignoring quota errors"
21407 If this option is set true, the string &`IGNOREQUOTA`& is added to RCPT
21408 commands, provided that the LMTP server has advertised support for IGNOREQUOTA
21409 in its response to the LHLO command.
21411 .option socket lmtp string&!! unset
21412 This option must be set if &%command%& is not set. The result of expansion must
21413 be the name of a Unix domain socket. The transport connects to the socket and
21414 delivers the message to it using the LMTP protocol.
21417 .option timeout lmtp time 5m
21418 The transport is aborted if the created process or Unix domain socket does not
21419 respond to LMTP commands or message input within this timeout. Delivery
21420 is deferred, and will be tried again later. Here is an example of a typical
21425 command = /some/local/lmtp/delivery/program
21429 This delivers up to 20 addresses at a time, in a mixture of domains if
21430 necessary, running as the user &'exim'&.
21434 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21435 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21437 .chapter "The pipe transport" "CHAPpipetransport"
21438 .scindex IIDpiptra1 "transports" "&(pipe)&"
21439 .scindex IIDpiptra2 "&(pipe)& transport"
21440 The &(pipe)& transport is used to deliver messages via a pipe to a command
21441 running in another process. One example is the use of &(pipe)& as a
21442 pseudo-remote transport for passing messages to some other delivery mechanism
21443 (such as UUCP). Another is the use by individual users to automatically process
21444 their incoming messages. The &(pipe)& transport can be used in one of the
21448 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
21449 A router routes one address to a transport in the normal way, and the
21450 transport is configured as a &(pipe)& transport. In this case, &$local_part$&
21451 contains the local part of the address (as usual), and the command that is run
21452 is specified by the &%command%& option on the transport.
21454 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
21455 If the &%batch_max%& option is set greater than 1 (the default is 1), the
21456 transport can handle more than one address in a single run. In this case, when
21457 more than one address is routed to the transport, &$local_part$& is not set
21458 (because it is not unique). However, the pseudo-variable &$pipe_addresses$&
21459 (described in section &<<SECThowcommandrun>>& below) contains all the addresses
21460 that are routed to the transport.
21462 .vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
21463 A router redirects an address directly to a pipe command (for example, from an
21464 alias or forward file). In this case, &$address_pipe$& contains the text of the
21465 pipe command, and the &%command%& option on the transport is ignored. If only
21466 one address is being transported (&%batch_max%& is not greater than one, or
21467 only one address was redirected to this pipe command), &$local_part$& contains
21468 the local part that was redirected.
21472 The &(pipe)& transport is a non-interactive delivery method. Exim can also
21473 deliver messages over pipes using the LMTP interactive protocol. This is
21474 implemented by the &(lmtp)& transport.
21476 In the case when &(pipe)& is run as a consequence of an entry in a local user's
21477 &_.forward_& file, the command runs under the uid and gid of that user. In
21478 other cases, the uid and gid have to be specified explicitly, either on the
21479 transport or on the router that handles the address. Current and &"home"&
21480 directories are also controllable. See chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>& for
21481 details of the local delivery environment and chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&
21482 for a discussion of local delivery batching.
21485 .section "Concurrent delivery" "SECID140"
21486 If two messages arrive at almost the same time, and both are routed to a pipe
21487 delivery, the two pipe transports may be run concurrently. You must ensure that
21488 any pipe commands you set up are robust against this happening. If the commands
21489 write to a file, the &%exim_lock%& utility might be of use.
21494 .section "Returned status and data" "SECID141"
21495 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "returned data"
21496 If the command exits with a non-zero return code, the delivery is deemed to
21497 have failed, unless either the &%ignore_status%& option is set (in which case
21498 the return code is treated as zero), or the return code is one of those listed
21499 in the &%temp_errors%& option, which are interpreted as meaning &"try again
21500 later"&. In this case, delivery is deferred. Details of a permanent failure are
21501 logged, but are not included in the bounce message, which merely contains
21502 &"local delivery failed"&.
21504 If the command exits on a signal and the &%freeze_signal%& option is set then
21505 the message will be frozen in the queue. If that option is not set, a bounce
21506 will be sent as normal.
21508 If the return code is greater than 128 and the command being run is a shell
21509 script, it normally means that the script was terminated by a signal whose
21510 value is the return code minus 128. The &%freeze_signal%& option does not
21511 apply in this case.
21513 If Exim is unable to run the command (that is, if &[execve()]& fails), the
21514 return code is set to 127. This is the value that a shell returns if it is
21515 asked to run a non-existent command. The wording for the log line suggests that
21516 a non-existent command may be the problem.
21518 The &%return_output%& option can affect the result of a pipe delivery. If it is
21519 set and the command produces any output on its standard output or standard
21520 error streams, the command is considered to have failed, even if it gave a zero
21521 return code or if &%ignore_status%& is set. The output from the command is
21522 included as part of the bounce message. The &%return_fail_output%& option is
21523 similar, except that output is returned only when the command exits with a
21524 failure return code, that is, a value other than zero or a code that matches
21529 .section "How the command is run" "SECThowcommandrun"
21530 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "path for command"
21531 The command line is (by default) broken down into a command name and arguments
21532 by the &(pipe)& transport itself. The &%allow_commands%& and
21533 &%restrict_to_path%& options can be used to restrict the commands that may be
21536 .cindex "quoting" "in pipe command"
21537 Unquoted arguments are delimited by white space. If an argument appears in
21538 double quotes, backslash is interpreted as an escape character in the usual
21539 way. If an argument appears in single quotes, no escaping is done.
21541 String expansion is applied to the command line except when it comes from a
21542 traditional &_.forward_& file (commands from a filter file are expanded). The
21543 expansion is applied to each argument in turn rather than to the whole line.
21544 For this reason, any string expansion item that contains white space must be
21545 quoted so as to be contained within a single argument. A setting such as
21547 command = /some/path ${if eq{$local_part}{postmaster}{xx}{yy}}
21549 will not work, because the expansion item gets split between several
21550 arguments. You have to write
21552 command = /some/path "${if eq{$local_part}{postmaster}{xx}{yy}}"
21554 to ensure that it is all in one argument. The expansion is done in this way,
21555 argument by argument, so that the number of arguments cannot be changed as a
21556 result of expansion, and quotes or backslashes in inserted variables do not
21557 interact with external quoting. However, this leads to problems if you want to
21558 generate multiple arguments (or the command name plus arguments) from a single
21559 expansion. In this situation, the simplest solution is to use a shell. For
21562 command = /bin/sh -c ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/some/file}}
21565 .cindex "transport" "filter"
21566 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
21567 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
21568 Special handling takes place when an argument consists of precisely the text
21569 &`$pipe_addresses`&. This is not a general expansion variable; the only
21570 place this string is recognized is when it appears as an argument for a pipe or
21571 transport filter command. It causes each address that is being handled to be
21572 inserted in the argument list at that point &'as a separate argument'&. This
21573 avoids any problems with spaces or shell metacharacters, and is of use when a
21574 &(pipe)& transport is handling groups of addresses in a batch.
21576 After splitting up into arguments and expansion, the resulting command is run
21577 in a subprocess directly from the transport, &'not'& under a shell. The
21578 message that is being delivered is supplied on the standard input, and the
21579 standard output and standard error are both connected to a single pipe that is
21580 read by Exim. The &%max_output%& option controls how much output the command
21581 may produce, and the &%return_output%& and &%return_fail_output%& options
21582 control what is done with it.
21584 Not running the command under a shell (by default) lessens the security risks
21585 in cases when a command from a user's filter file is built out of data that was
21586 taken from an incoming message. If a shell is required, it can of course be
21587 explicitly specified as the command to be run. However, there are circumstances
21588 where existing commands (for example, in &_.forward_& files) expect to be run
21589 under a shell and cannot easily be modified. To allow for these cases, there is
21590 an option called &%use_shell%&, which changes the way the &(pipe)& transport
21591 works. Instead of breaking up the command line as just described, it expands it
21592 as a single string and passes the result to &_/bin/sh_&. The
21593 &%restrict_to_path%& option and the &$pipe_addresses$& facility cannot be used
21594 with &%use_shell%&, and the whole mechanism is inherently less secure.
21598 .section "Environment variables" "SECTpipeenv"
21599 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "environment for command"
21600 .cindex "environment for pipe transport"
21601 The environment variables listed below are set up when the command is invoked.
21602 This list is a compromise for maximum compatibility with other MTAs. Note that
21603 the &%environment%& option can be used to add additional variables to this
21606 &`DOMAIN `& the domain of the address
21607 &`HOME `& the home directory, if set
21608 &`HOST `& the host name when called from a router (see below)
21609 &`LOCAL_PART `& see below
21610 &`LOCAL_PART_PREFIX `& see below
21611 &`LOCAL_PART_SUFFIX `& see below
21612 &`LOGNAME `& see below
21613 &`MESSAGE_ID `& Exim's local ID for the message
21614 &`PATH `& as specified by the &%path%& option below
21615 &`QUALIFY_DOMAIN `& the sender qualification domain
21616 &`RECIPIENT `& the complete recipient address
21617 &`SENDER `& the sender of the message (empty if a bounce)
21618 &`SHELL `& &`/bin/sh`&
21619 &`TZ `& the value of the &%timezone%& option, if set
21620 &`USER `& see below
21622 When a &(pipe)& transport is called directly from (for example) an &(accept)&
21623 router, LOCAL_PART is set to the local part of the address. When it is
21624 called as a result of a forward or alias expansion, LOCAL_PART is set to
21625 the local part of the address that was expanded. In both cases, any affixes are
21626 removed from the local part, and made available in LOCAL_PART_PREFIX and
21627 LOCAL_PART_SUFFIX, respectively. LOGNAME and USER are set to the
21628 same value as LOCAL_PART for compatibility with other MTAs.
21631 HOST is set only when a &(pipe)& transport is called from a router that
21632 associates hosts with an address, typically when using &(pipe)& as a
21633 pseudo-remote transport. HOST is set to the first host name specified by
21637 If the transport's generic &%home_directory%& option is set, its value is used
21638 for the HOME environment variable. Otherwise, a home directory may be set
21639 by the router's &%transport_home_directory%& option, which defaults to the
21640 user's home directory if &%check_local_user%& is set.
21643 .section "Private options for pipe" "SECID142"
21644 .cindex "options" "&(pipe)& transport"
21648 .option allow_commands pipe "string list&!!" unset
21649 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "permitted commands"
21650 The string is expanded, and is then interpreted as a colon-separated list of
21651 permitted commands. If &%restrict_to_path%& is not set, the only commands
21652 permitted are those in the &%allow_commands%& list. They need not be absolute
21653 paths; the &%path%& option is still used for relative paths. If
21654 &%restrict_to_path%& is set with &%allow_commands%&, the command must either be
21655 in the &%allow_commands%& list, or a name without any slashes that is found on
21656 the path. In other words, if neither &%allow_commands%& nor
21657 &%restrict_to_path%& is set, there is no restriction on the command, but
21658 otherwise only commands that are permitted by one or the other are allowed. For
21661 allow_commands = /usr/bin/vacation
21663 and &%restrict_to_path%& is not set, the only permitted command is
21664 &_/usr/bin/vacation_&. The &%allow_commands%& option may not be set if
21665 &%use_shell%& is set.
21668 .option batch_id pipe string&!! unset
21669 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
21672 .option batch_max pipe integer 1
21673 This limits the number of addresses that can be handled in a single delivery.
21674 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
21677 .option check_string pipe string unset
21678 As &(pipe)& writes the message, the start of each line is tested for matching
21679 &%check_string%&, and if it does, the initial matching characters are replaced
21680 by the contents of &%escape_string%&, provided both are set. The value of
21681 &%check_string%& is a literal string, not a regular expression, and the case of
21682 any letters it contains is significant. When &%use_bsmtp%& is set, the contents
21683 of &%check_string%& and &%escape_string%& are forced to values that implement
21684 the SMTP escaping protocol. Any settings made in the configuration file are
21688 .option command pipe string&!! unset
21689 This option need not be set when &(pipe)& is being used to deliver to pipes
21690 obtained directly from address redirections. In other cases, the option must be
21691 set, to provide a command to be run. It need not yield an absolute path (see
21692 the &%path%& option below). The command is split up into separate arguments by
21693 Exim, and each argument is separately expanded, as described in section
21694 &<<SECThowcommandrun>>& above.
21697 .option environment pipe string&!! unset
21698 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "environment for command"
21699 .cindex "environment for &(pipe)& transport"
21700 This option is used to add additional variables to the environment in which the
21701 command runs (see section &<<SECTpipeenv>>& for the default list). Its value is
21702 a string which is expanded, and then interpreted as a colon-separated list of
21703 environment settings of the form <&'name'&>=<&'value'&>.
21706 .option escape_string pipe string unset
21707 See &%check_string%& above.
21710 .option freeze_exec_fail pipe boolean false
21711 .cindex "exec failure"
21712 .cindex "failure of exec"
21713 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "failure of exec"
21714 Failure to exec the command in a pipe transport is by default treated like
21715 any other failure while running the command. However, if &%freeze_exec_fail%&
21716 is set, failure to exec is treated specially, and causes the message to be
21717 frozen, whatever the setting of &%ignore_status%&.
21720 .option freeze_signal pipe boolean false
21721 .cindex "signal exit"
21722 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport", "signal exit"
21723 Normally if the process run by a command in a pipe transport exits on a signal,
21724 a bounce message is sent. If &%freeze_signal%& is set, the message will be
21725 frozen in Exim's queue instead.
21728 .option ignore_status pipe boolean false
21729 If this option is true, the status returned by the subprocess that is set up to
21730 run the command is ignored, and Exim behaves as if zero had been returned.
21731 Otherwise, a non-zero status or termination by signal causes an error return
21732 from the transport unless the status value is one of those listed in
21733 &%temp_errors%&; these cause the delivery to be deferred and tried again later.
21735 &*Note*&: This option does not apply to timeouts, which do not return a status.
21736 See the &%timeout_defer%& option for how timeouts are handled.
21738 .option log_defer_output pipe boolean false
21739 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "logging output"
21740 If this option is set, and the status returned by the command is
21741 one of the codes listed in &%temp_errors%& (that is, delivery was deferred),
21742 and any output was produced, the first line of it is written to the main log.
21745 .option log_fail_output pipe boolean false
21746 If this option is set, and the command returns any output, and also ends with a
21747 return code that is neither zero nor one of the return codes listed in
21748 &%temp_errors%& (that is, the delivery failed), the first line of output is
21749 written to the main log. This option and &%log_output%& are mutually exclusive.
21750 Only one of them may be set.
21754 .option log_output pipe boolean false
21755 If this option is set and the command returns any output, the first line of
21756 output is written to the main log, whatever the return code. This option and
21757 &%log_fail_output%& are mutually exclusive. Only one of them may be set.
21761 .option max_output pipe integer 20K
21762 This specifies the maximum amount of output that the command may produce on its
21763 standard output and standard error file combined. If the limit is exceeded, the
21764 process running the command is killed. This is intended as a safety measure to
21765 catch runaway processes. The limit is applied independently of the settings of
21766 the options that control what is done with such output (for example,
21767 &%return_output%&). Because of buffering effects, the amount of output may
21768 exceed the limit by a small amount before Exim notices.
21771 .option message_prefix pipe string&!! "see below"
21772 The string specified here is expanded and output at the start of every message.
21773 The default is unset if &%use_bsmtp%& is set. Otherwise it is
21776 From ${if def:return_path{$return_path}{MAILER-DAEMON}}\
21780 .cindex "&%tmail%&"
21781 .cindex "&""From""& line"
21782 This is required by the commonly used &_/usr/bin/vacation_& program.
21783 However, it must &'not'& be present if delivery is to the Cyrus IMAP server,
21784 or to the &%tmail%& local delivery agent. The prefix can be suppressed by
21789 &*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
21790 &`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_prefix%&.
21793 .option message_suffix pipe string&!! "see below"
21794 The string specified here is expanded and output at the end of every message.
21795 The default is unset if &%use_bsmtp%& is set. Otherwise it is a single newline.
21796 The suffix can be suppressed by setting
21800 &*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
21801 &`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_suffix%&.
21804 .option path pipe string "see below"
21805 This option specifies the string that is set up in the PATH environment
21806 variable of the subprocess. The default is:
21810 If the &%command%& option does not yield an absolute path name, the command is
21811 sought in the PATH directories, in the usual way. &*Warning*&: This does not
21812 apply to a command specified as a transport filter.
21815 .option permit_coredump pipe boolean false
21816 Normally Exim inhibits core-dumps during delivery. If you have a need to get
21817 a core-dump of a pipe command, enable this command. This enables core-dumps
21818 during delivery and affects both the Exim binary and the pipe command run.
21819 It is recommended that this option remain off unless and until you have a need
21820 for it and that this only be enabled when needed, as the risk of excessive
21821 resource consumption can be quite high. Note also that Exim is typically
21822 installed as a setuid binary and most operating systems will inhibit coredumps
21823 of these by default, so further OS-specific action may be required.
21826 .option pipe_as_creator pipe boolean false
21827 .cindex "uid (user id)" "local delivery"
21828 If the generic &%user%& option is not set and this option is true, the delivery
21829 process is run under the uid that was in force when Exim was originally called
21830 to accept the message. If the group id is not otherwise set (via the generic
21831 &%group%& option), the gid that was in force when Exim was originally called to
21832 accept the message is used.
21835 .option restrict_to_path pipe boolean false
21836 When this option is set, any command name not listed in &%allow_commands%& must
21837 contain no slashes. The command is searched for only in the directories listed
21838 in the &%path%& option. This option is intended for use in the case when a pipe
21839 command has been generated from a user's &_.forward_& file. This is usually
21840 handled by a &(pipe)& transport called &%address_pipe%&.
21843 .option return_fail_output pipe boolean false
21844 If this option is true, and the command produced any output and ended with a
21845 return code other than zero or one of the codes listed in &%temp_errors%& (that
21846 is, the delivery failed), the output is returned in the bounce message.
21847 However, if the message has a null sender (that is, it is itself a bounce
21848 message), output from the command is discarded. This option and
21849 &%return_output%& are mutually exclusive. Only one of them may be set.
21853 .option return_output pipe boolean false
21854 If this option is true, and the command produced any output, the delivery is
21855 deemed to have failed whatever the return code from the command, and the output
21856 is returned in the bounce message. Otherwise, the output is just discarded.
21857 However, if the message has a null sender (that is, it is a bounce message),
21858 output from the command is always discarded, whatever the setting of this
21859 option. This option and &%return_fail_output%& are mutually exclusive. Only one
21860 of them may be set.
21864 .option temp_errors pipe "string list" "see below"
21865 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "temporary failure"
21866 This option contains either a colon-separated list of numbers, or a single
21867 asterisk. If &%ignore_status%& is false
21868 and &%return_output%& is not set,
21869 and the command exits with a non-zero return code, the failure is treated as
21870 temporary and the delivery is deferred if the return code matches one of the
21871 numbers, or if the setting is a single asterisk. Otherwise, non-zero return
21872 codes are treated as permanent errors. The default setting contains the codes
21873 defined by EX_TEMPFAIL and EX_CANTCREAT in &_sysexits.h_&. If Exim is
21874 compiled on a system that does not define these macros, it assumes values of 75
21875 and 73, respectively.
21878 .option timeout pipe time 1h
21879 If the command fails to complete within this time, it is killed. This normally
21880 causes the delivery to fail (but see &%timeout_defer%&). A zero time interval
21881 specifies no timeout. In order to ensure that any subprocesses created by the
21882 command are also killed, Exim makes the initial process a process group leader,
21883 and kills the whole process group on a timeout. However, this can be defeated
21884 if one of the processes starts a new process group.
21886 .option timeout_defer pipe boolean false
21887 A timeout in a &(pipe)& transport, either in the command that the transport
21888 runs, or in a transport filter that is associated with it, is by default
21889 treated as a hard error, and the delivery fails. However, if &%timeout_defer%&
21890 is set true, both kinds of timeout become temporary errors, causing the
21891 delivery to be deferred.
21893 .option umask pipe "octal integer" 022
21894 This specifies the umask setting for the subprocess that runs the command.
21897 .option use_bsmtp pipe boolean false
21898 .cindex "envelope sender"
21899 If this option is set true, the &(pipe)& transport writes messages in &"batch
21900 SMTP"& format, with the envelope sender and recipient(s) included as SMTP
21901 commands. If you want to include a leading HELO command with such messages,
21902 you can do so by setting the &%message_prefix%& option. See section
21903 &<<SECTbatchSMTP>>& for details of batch SMTP.
21905 .option use_classresources pipe boolean false
21906 .cindex "class resources (BSD)"
21907 This option is available only when Exim is running on FreeBSD, NetBSD, or
21908 BSD/OS. If it is set true, the &[setclassresources()]& function is used to set
21909 resource limits when a &(pipe)& transport is run to perform a delivery. The
21910 limits for the uid under which the pipe is to run are obtained from the login
21914 .option use_crlf pipe boolean false
21915 .cindex "carriage return"
21917 This option causes lines to be terminated with the two-character CRLF sequence
21918 (carriage return, linefeed) instead of just a linefeed character. In the case
21919 of batched SMTP, the byte sequence written to the pipe is then an exact image
21920 of what would be sent down a real SMTP connection.
21922 The contents of the &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& options are
21923 written verbatim, so must contain their own carriage return characters if these
21924 are needed. When &%use_bsmtp%& is not set, the default values for both
21925 &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& end with a single linefeed, so their
21926 values must be changed to end with &`\r\n`& if &%use_crlf%& is set.
21929 .option use_shell pipe boolean false
21930 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
21931 If this option is set, it causes the command to be passed to &_/bin/sh_&
21932 instead of being run directly from the transport, as described in section
21933 &<<SECThowcommandrun>>&. This is less secure, but is needed in some situations
21934 where the command is expected to be run under a shell and cannot easily be
21935 modified. The &%allow_commands%& and &%restrict_to_path%& options, and the
21936 &`$pipe_addresses`& facility are incompatible with &%use_shell%&. The
21937 command is expanded as a single string, and handed to &_/bin/sh_& as data for
21942 .section "Using an external local delivery agent" "SECID143"
21943 .cindex "local delivery" "using an external agent"
21944 .cindex "&'procmail'&"
21945 .cindex "external local delivery"
21946 .cindex "delivery" "&'procmail'&"
21947 .cindex "delivery" "by external agent"
21948 The &(pipe)& transport can be used to pass all messages that require local
21949 delivery to a separate local delivery agent such as &%procmail%&. When doing
21950 this, care must be taken to ensure that the pipe is run under an appropriate
21951 uid and gid. In some configurations one wants this to be a uid that is trusted
21952 by the delivery agent to supply the correct sender of the message. It may be
21953 necessary to recompile or reconfigure the delivery agent so that it trusts an
21954 appropriate user. The following is an example transport and router
21955 configuration for &%procmail%&:
21960 command = /usr/local/bin/procmail -d $local_part
21964 check_string = "From "
21965 escape_string = ">From "
21974 transport = procmail_pipe
21976 In this example, the pipe is run as the local user, but with the group set to
21977 &'mail'&. An alternative is to run the pipe as a specific user such as &'mail'&
21978 or &'exim'&, but in this case you must arrange for &%procmail%& to trust that
21979 user to supply a correct sender address. If you do not specify either a
21980 &%group%& or a &%user%& option, the pipe command is run as the local user. The
21981 home directory is the user's home directory by default.
21983 &*Note*&: The command that the pipe transport runs does &'not'& begin with
21987 as shown in some &%procmail%& documentation, because Exim does not by default
21988 use a shell to run pipe commands.
21991 The next example shows a transport and a router for a system where local
21992 deliveries are handled by the Cyrus IMAP server.
21995 local_delivery_cyrus:
21997 command = /usr/cyrus/bin/deliver \
21998 -m ${substr_1:$local_part_suffix} -- $local_part
22010 local_part_suffix = .*
22011 transport = local_delivery_cyrus
22013 Note the unsetting of &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%&, and the use of
22014 &%return_output%& to cause any text written by Cyrus to be returned to the
22016 .ecindex IIDpiptra1
22017 .ecindex IIDpiptra2
22020 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22021 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22023 .chapter "The smtp transport" "CHAPsmtptrans"
22024 .scindex IIDsmttra1 "transports" "&(smtp)&"
22025 .scindex IIDsmttra2 "&(smtp)& transport"
22026 The &(smtp)& transport delivers messages over TCP/IP connections using the SMTP
22027 or LMTP protocol. The list of hosts to try can either be taken from the address
22028 that is being processed (having been set up by the router), or specified
22029 explicitly for the transport. Timeout and retry processing (see chapter
22030 &<<CHAPretry>>&) is applied to each IP address independently.
22033 .section "Multiple messages on a single connection" "SECID144"
22034 The sending of multiple messages over a single TCP/IP connection can arise in
22038 If a message contains more than &%max_rcpt%& (see below) addresses that are
22039 routed to the same host, more than one copy of the message has to be sent to
22040 that host. In this situation, multiple copies may be sent in a single run of
22041 the &(smtp)& transport over a single TCP/IP connection. (What Exim actually
22042 does when it has too many addresses to send in one message also depends on the
22043 value of the global &%remote_max_parallel%& option. Details are given in
22044 section &<<SECToutSMTPTCP>>&.)
22046 .cindex "hints database" "remembering routing"
22047 When a message has been successfully delivered over a TCP/IP connection, Exim
22048 looks in its hints database to see if there are any other messages awaiting a
22049 connection to the same host. If there are, a new delivery process is started
22050 for one of them, and the current TCP/IP connection is passed on to it. The new
22051 process may in turn send multiple copies and possibly create yet another
22056 For each copy sent over the same TCP/IP connection, a sequence counter is
22057 incremented, and if it ever gets to the value of &%connection_max_messages%&,
22058 no further messages are sent over that connection.
22062 .section "Use of the $host and $host_address variables" "SECID145"
22064 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
22065 At the start of a run of the &(smtp)& transport, the values of &$host$& and
22066 &$host_address$& are the name and IP address of the first host on the host list
22067 passed by the router. However, when the transport is about to connect to a
22068 specific host, and while it is connected to that host, &$host$& and
22069 &$host_address$& are set to the values for that host. These are the values
22070 that are in force when the &%helo_data%&, &%hosts_try_auth%&, &%interface%&,
22071 &%serialize_hosts%&, and the various TLS options are expanded.
22074 .section "Use of $tls_cipher and $tls_peerdn" "usecippeer"
22075 .vindex &$tls_bits$&
22076 .vindex &$tls_cipher$&
22077 .vindex &$tls_peerdn$&
22078 .vindex &$tls_sni$&
22079 At the start of a run of the &(smtp)& transport, the values of &$tls_bits$&,
22080 &$tls_cipher$&, &$tls_peerdn$& and &$tls_sni$&
22081 are the values that were set when the message was received.
22082 These are the values that are used for options that are expanded before any
22083 SMTP connections are made. Just before each connection is made, these four
22084 variables are emptied. If TLS is subsequently started, they are set to the
22085 appropriate values for the outgoing connection, and these are the values that
22086 are in force when any authenticators are run and when the
22087 &%authenticated_sender%& option is expanded.
22089 These variables are deprecated in favour of &$tls_in_cipher$& et. al.
22090 and will be removed in a future release.
22093 .section "Private options for smtp" "SECID146"
22094 .cindex "options" "&(smtp)& transport"
22095 The private options of the &(smtp)& transport are as follows:
22098 .option address_retry_include_sender smtp boolean true
22099 .cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "retrying after"
22100 When an address is delayed because of a 4&'xx'& response to a RCPT command, it
22101 is the combination of sender and recipient that is delayed in subsequent queue
22102 runs until the retry time is reached. You can delay the recipient without
22103 reference to the sender (which is what earlier versions of Exim did), by
22104 setting &%address_retry_include_sender%& false. However, this can lead to
22105 problems with servers that regularly issue 4&'xx'& responses to RCPT commands.
22107 .option allow_localhost smtp boolean false
22108 .cindex "local host" "sending to"
22109 .cindex "fallback" "hosts specified on transport"
22110 When a host specified in &%hosts%& or &%fallback_hosts%& (see below) turns out
22111 to be the local host, or is listed in &%hosts_treat_as_local%&, delivery is
22112 deferred by default. However, if &%allow_localhost%& is set, Exim goes on to do
22113 the delivery anyway. This should be used only in special cases when the
22114 configuration ensures that no looping will result (for example, a differently
22115 configured Exim is listening on the port to which the message is sent).
22118 .option authenticated_sender smtp string&!! unset
22120 When Exim has authenticated as a client, or if &%authenticated_sender_force%&
22121 is true, this option sets a value for the AUTH= item on outgoing MAIL commands,
22122 overriding any existing authenticated sender value. If the string expansion is
22123 forced to fail, the option is ignored. Other expansion failures cause delivery
22124 to be deferred. If the result of expansion is an empty string, that is also
22127 The expansion happens after the outgoing connection has been made and TLS
22128 started, if required. This means that the &$host$&, &$host_address$&,
22129 &$tls_out_cipher$&, and &$tls_out_peerdn$& variables are set according to the
22130 particular connection.
22132 If the SMTP session is not authenticated, the expansion of
22133 &%authenticated_sender%& still happens (and can cause the delivery to be
22134 deferred if it fails), but no AUTH= item is added to MAIL commands
22135 unless &%authenticated_sender_force%& is true.
22137 This option allows you to use the &(smtp)& transport in LMTP mode to
22138 deliver mail to Cyrus IMAP and provide the proper local part as the
22139 &"authenticated sender"&, via a setting such as:
22141 authenticated_sender = $local_part
22143 This removes the need for IMAP subfolders to be assigned special ACLs to
22144 allow direct delivery to those subfolders.
22146 Because of expected uses such as that just described for Cyrus (when no
22147 domain is involved), there is no checking on the syntax of the provided
22151 .option authenticated_sender_force smtp boolean false
22152 If this option is set true, the &%authenticated_sender%& option's value
22153 is used for the AUTH= item on outgoing MAIL commands, even if Exim has not
22154 authenticated as a client.
22157 .option command_timeout smtp time 5m
22158 This sets a timeout for receiving a response to an SMTP command that has been
22159 sent out. It is also used when waiting for the initial banner line from the
22160 remote host. Its value must not be zero.
22163 .option connect_timeout smtp time 5m
22164 This sets a timeout for the &[connect()]& function, which sets up a TCP/IP call
22165 to a remote host. A setting of zero allows the system timeout (typically
22166 several minutes) to act. To have any effect, the value of this option must be
22167 less than the system timeout. However, it has been observed that on some
22168 systems there is no system timeout, which is why the default value for this
22169 option is 5 minutes, a value recommended by RFC 1123.
22172 .option connection_max_messages smtp integer 500
22173 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
22174 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
22175 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
22176 This controls the maximum number of separate message deliveries that are sent
22177 over a single TCP/IP connection. If the value is zero, there is no limit.
22178 For testing purposes, this value can be overridden by the &%-oB%& command line
22182 .option data_timeout smtp time 5m
22183 This sets a timeout for the transmission of each block in the data portion of
22184 the message. As a result, the overall timeout for a message depends on the size
22185 of the message. Its value must not be zero. See also &%final_timeout%&.
22188 .option delay_after_cutoff smtp boolean true
22189 This option controls what happens when all remote IP addresses for a given
22190 domain have been inaccessible for so long that they have passed their retry
22193 In the default state, if the next retry time has not been reached for any of
22194 them, the address is bounced without trying any deliveries. In other words,
22195 Exim delays retrying an IP address after the final cutoff time until a new
22196 retry time is reached, and can therefore bounce an address without ever trying
22197 a delivery, when machines have been down for a long time. Some people are
22198 unhappy at this prospect, so...
22200 If &%delay_after_cutoff%& is set false, Exim behaves differently. If all IP
22201 addresses are past their final cutoff time, Exim tries to deliver to those
22202 IP addresses that have not been tried since the message arrived. If there are
22203 none, of if they all fail, the address is bounced. In other words, it does not
22204 delay when a new message arrives, but immediately tries those expired IP
22205 addresses that haven't been tried since the message arrived. If there is a
22206 continuous stream of messages for the dead hosts, unsetting
22207 &%delay_after_cutoff%& means that there will be many more attempts to deliver
22211 .option dns_qualify_single smtp boolean true
22212 If the &%hosts%& or &%fallback_hosts%& option is being used,
22213 and the &%gethostbyname%& option is false,
22214 the RES_DEFNAMES resolver option is set. See the &%qualify_single%& option
22215 in chapter &<<CHAPdnslookup>>& for more details.
22218 .option dns_search_parents smtp boolean false
22219 If the &%hosts%& or &%fallback_hosts%& option is being used, and the
22220 &%gethostbyname%& option is false, the RES_DNSRCH resolver option is set.
22221 See the &%search_parents%& option in chapter &<<CHAPdnslookup>>& for more
22226 .option dscp smtp string&!! unset
22227 .cindex "DCSP" "outbound"
22228 This option causes the DSCP value associated with a socket to be set to one
22229 of a number of fixed strings or to numeric value.
22230 The &%-bI:dscp%& option may be used to ask Exim which names it knows of.
22231 Common values include &`throughput`&, &`mincost`&, and on newer systems
22232 &`ef`&, &`af41`&, etc. Numeric values may be in the range 0 to 0x3F.
22234 The outbound packets from Exim will be marked with this value in the header
22235 (for IPv4, the TOS field; for IPv6, the TCLASS field); there is no guarantee
22236 that these values will have any effect, not be stripped by networking
22237 equipment, or do much of anything without cooperation with your Network
22238 Engineer and those of all network operators between the source and destination.
22242 .option fallback_hosts smtp "string list" unset
22243 .cindex "fallback" "hosts specified on transport"
22244 String expansion is not applied to this option. The argument must be a
22245 colon-separated list of host names or IP addresses, optionally also including
22246 port numbers, though the separator can be changed, as described in section
22247 &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&. Each individual item in the list is the same as an
22248 item in a &%route_list%& setting for the &(manualroute)& router, as described
22249 in section &<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&.
22251 Fallback hosts can also be specified on routers, which associate them with the
22252 addresses they process. As for the &%hosts%& option without &%hosts_override%&,
22253 &%fallback_hosts%& specified on the transport is used only if the address does
22254 not have its own associated fallback host list. Unlike &%hosts%&, a setting of
22255 &%fallback_hosts%& on an address is not overridden by &%hosts_override%&.
22256 However, &%hosts_randomize%& does apply to fallback host lists.
22258 If Exim is unable to deliver to any of the hosts for a particular address, and
22259 the errors are not permanent rejections, the address is put on a separate
22260 transport queue with its host list replaced by the fallback hosts, unless the
22261 address was routed via MX records and the current host was in the original MX
22262 list. In that situation, the fallback host list is not used.
22264 Once normal deliveries are complete, the fallback queue is delivered by
22265 re-running the same transports with the new host lists. If several failing
22266 addresses have the same fallback hosts (and &%max_rcpt%& permits it), a single
22267 copy of the message is sent.
22269 The resolution of the host names on the fallback list is controlled by the
22270 &%gethostbyname%& option, as for the &%hosts%& option. Fallback hosts apply
22271 both to cases when the host list comes with the address and when it is taken
22272 from &%hosts%&. This option provides a &"use a smart host only if delivery
22276 .option final_timeout smtp time 10m
22277 This is the timeout that applies while waiting for the response to the final
22278 line containing just &"."& that terminates a message. Its value must not be
22281 .option gethostbyname smtp boolean false
22282 If this option is true when the &%hosts%& and/or &%fallback_hosts%& options are
22283 being used, names are looked up using &[gethostbyname()]&
22284 (or &[getipnodebyname()]& when available)
22285 instead of using the DNS. Of course, that function may in fact use the DNS, but
22286 it may also consult other sources of information such as &_/etc/hosts_&.
22288 .option gnutls_compat_mode smtp boolean unset
22289 This option controls whether GnuTLS is used in compatibility mode in an Exim
22290 server. This reduces security slightly, but improves interworking with older
22291 implementations of TLS.
22293 .option helo_data smtp string&!! "see below"
22294 .cindex "HELO" "argument, setting"
22295 .cindex "EHLO" "argument, setting"
22296 .cindex "LHLO argument setting"
22297 The value of this option is expanded after a connection to a another host has
22298 been set up. The result is used as the argument for the EHLO, HELO, or LHLO
22299 command that starts the outgoing SMTP or LMTP session. The default value of the
22304 During the expansion, the variables &$host$& and &$host_address$& are set to
22305 the identity of the remote host, and the variables &$sending_ip_address$& and
22306 &$sending_port$& are set to the local IP address and port number that are being
22307 used. These variables can be used to generate different values for different
22308 servers or different local IP addresses. For example, if you want the string
22309 that is used for &%helo_data%& to be obtained by a DNS lookup of the outgoing
22310 interface address, you could use this:
22312 helo_data = ${lookup dnsdb{ptr=$sending_ip_address}{$value}\
22313 {$primary_hostname}}
22315 The use of &%helo_data%& applies both to sending messages and when doing
22318 .option hosts smtp "string list&!!" unset
22319 Hosts are associated with an address by a router such as &(dnslookup)&, which
22320 finds the hosts by looking up the address domain in the DNS, or by
22321 &(manualroute)&, which has lists of hosts in its configuration. However,
22322 email addresses can be passed to the &(smtp)& transport by any router, and not
22323 all of them can provide an associated list of hosts.
22325 The &%hosts%& option specifies a list of hosts to be used if the address being
22326 processed does not have any hosts associated with it. The hosts specified by
22327 &%hosts%& are also used, whether or not the address has its own hosts, if
22328 &%hosts_override%& is set.
22330 The string is first expanded, before being interpreted as a colon-separated
22331 list of host names or IP addresses, possibly including port numbers. The
22332 separator may be changed to something other than colon, as described in section
22333 &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&. Each individual item in the list is the same as an
22334 item in a &%route_list%& setting for the &(manualroute)& router, as described
22335 in section &<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&. However, note that the &`/MX`& facility
22336 of the &(manualroute)& router is not available here.
22338 If the expansion fails, delivery is deferred. Unless the failure was caused by
22339 the inability to complete a lookup, the error is logged to the panic log as
22340 well as the main log. Host names are looked up either by searching directly for
22341 address records in the DNS or by calling &[gethostbyname()]& (or
22342 &[getipnodebyname()]& when available), depending on the setting of the
22343 &%gethostbyname%& option. When Exim is compiled with IPv6 support, if a host
22344 that is looked up in the DNS has both IPv4 and IPv6 addresses, both types of
22347 During delivery, the hosts are tried in order, subject to their retry status,
22348 unless &%hosts_randomize%& is set.
22351 .option hosts_avoid_esmtp smtp "host list&!!" unset
22352 .cindex "ESMTP, avoiding use of"
22353 .cindex "HELO" "forcing use of"
22354 .cindex "EHLO" "avoiding use of"
22355 .cindex "PIPELINING" "avoiding the use of"
22356 This option is for use with broken hosts that announce ESMTP facilities (for
22357 example, PIPELINING) and then fail to implement them properly. When a host
22358 matches &%hosts_avoid_esmtp%&, Exim sends HELO rather than EHLO at the
22359 start of the SMTP session. This means that it cannot use any of the ESMTP
22360 facilities such as AUTH, PIPELINING, SIZE, and STARTTLS.
22363 .option hosts_avoid_pipelining smtp "host list&!!" unset
22364 .cindex "PIPELINING" "avoiding the use of"
22365 Exim will not use the SMTP PIPELINING extension when delivering to any host
22366 that matches this list, even if the server host advertises PIPELINING support.
22369 .option hosts_avoid_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
22370 .cindex "TLS" "avoiding for certain hosts"
22371 Exim will not try to start a TLS session when delivering to any host that
22372 matches this list. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
22374 .option hosts_verify_avoid_tls smtp "host list&!!" *
22375 .cindex "TLS" "avoiding for certain hosts"
22376 Exim will not try to start a TLS session for a verify callout,
22377 or when delivering in cutthrough mode,
22378 to any host that matches this list.
22379 Note that the default is to not use TLS.
22382 .option hosts_max_try smtp integer 5
22383 .cindex "host" "maximum number to try"
22384 .cindex "limit" "number of hosts tried"
22385 .cindex "limit" "number of MX tried"
22386 .cindex "MX record" "maximum tried"
22387 This option limits the number of IP addresses that are tried for any one
22388 delivery in cases where there are temporary delivery errors. Section
22389 &<<SECTvalhosmax>>& describes in detail how the value of this option is used.
22392 .option hosts_max_try_hardlimit smtp integer 50
22393 This is an additional check on the maximum number of IP addresses that Exim
22394 tries for any one delivery. Section &<<SECTvalhosmax>>& describes its use and
22399 .option hosts_nopass_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
22400 .cindex "TLS" "passing connection"
22401 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
22402 .cindex "TLS" "multiple message deliveries"
22403 For any host that matches this list, a connection on which a TLS session has
22404 been started will not be passed to a new delivery process for sending another
22405 message on the same connection. See section &<<SECTmulmessam>>& for an
22406 explanation of when this might be needed.
22409 .option hosts_override smtp boolean false
22410 If this option is set and the &%hosts%& option is also set, any hosts that are
22411 attached to the address are ignored, and instead the hosts specified by the
22412 &%hosts%& option are always used. This option does not apply to
22413 &%fallback_hosts%&.
22416 .option hosts_randomize smtp boolean false
22417 .cindex "randomized host list"
22418 .cindex "host" "list of; randomized"
22419 .cindex "fallback" "randomized hosts"
22420 If this option is set, and either the list of hosts is taken from the
22421 &%hosts%& or the &%fallback_hosts%& option, or the hosts supplied by the router
22422 were not obtained from MX records (this includes fallback hosts from the
22423 router), and were not randomized by the router, the order of trying the hosts
22424 is randomized each time the transport runs. Randomizing the order of a host
22425 list can be used to do crude load sharing.
22427 When &%hosts_randomize%& is true, a host list may be split into groups whose
22428 order is separately randomized. This makes it possible to set up MX-like
22429 behaviour. The boundaries between groups are indicated by an item that is just
22430 &`+`& in the host list. For example:
22432 hosts = host1:host2:host3:+:host4:host5
22434 The order of the first three hosts and the order of the last two hosts is
22435 randomized for each use, but the first three always end up before the last two.
22436 If &%hosts_randomize%& is not set, a &`+`& item in the list is ignored.
22438 .option hosts_require_auth smtp "host list&!!" unset
22439 .cindex "authentication" "required by client"
22440 This option provides a list of servers for which authentication must succeed
22441 before Exim will try to transfer a message. If authentication fails for
22442 servers which are not in this list, Exim tries to send unauthenticated. If
22443 authentication fails for one of these servers, delivery is deferred. This
22444 temporary error is detectable in the retry rules, so it can be turned into a
22445 hard failure if required. See also &%hosts_try_auth%&, and chapter
22446 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details of authentication.
22449 .option hosts_require_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
22450 .cindex "TLS" "requiring for certain servers"
22451 Exim will insist on using a TLS session when delivering to any host that
22452 matches this list. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
22453 &*Note*&: This option affects outgoing mail only. To insist on TLS for
22454 incoming messages, use an appropriate ACL.
22456 .option hosts_try_auth smtp "host list&!!" unset
22457 .cindex "authentication" "optional in client"
22458 This option provides a list of servers to which, provided they announce
22459 authentication support, Exim will attempt to authenticate as a client when it
22460 connects. If authentication fails, Exim will try to transfer the message
22461 unauthenticated. See also &%hosts_require_auth%&, and chapter
22462 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details of authentication.
22464 .option interface smtp "string list&!!" unset
22465 .cindex "bind IP address"
22466 .cindex "IP address" "binding"
22468 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
22469 This option specifies which interface to bind to when making an outgoing SMTP
22470 call. The value is an IP address, not an interface name such as
22471 &`eth0`&. Do not confuse this with the interface address that was used when a
22472 message was received, which is in &$received_ip_address$&, formerly known as
22473 &$interface_address$&. The name was changed to minimize confusion with the
22474 outgoing interface address. There is no variable that contains an outgoing
22475 interface address because, unless it is set by this option, its value is
22478 During the expansion of the &%interface%& option the variables &$host$& and
22479 &$host_address$& refer to the host to which a connection is about to be made
22480 during the expansion of the string. Forced expansion failure, or an empty
22481 string result causes the option to be ignored. Otherwise, after expansion, the
22482 string must be a list of IP addresses, colon-separated by default, but the
22483 separator can be changed in the usual way. For example:
22485 interface = <; 192.168.123.123 ; 3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061
22487 The first interface of the correct type (IPv4 or IPv6) is used for the outgoing
22488 connection. If none of them are the correct type, the option is ignored. If
22489 &%interface%& is not set, or is ignored, the system's IP functions choose which
22490 interface to use if the host has more than one.
22493 .option keepalive smtp boolean true
22494 .cindex "keepalive" "on outgoing connection"
22495 This option controls the setting of SO_KEEPALIVE on outgoing TCP/IP socket
22496 connections. When set, it causes the kernel to probe idle connections
22497 periodically, by sending packets with &"old"& sequence numbers. The other end
22498 of the connection should send a acknowledgment if the connection is still okay
22499 or a reset if the connection has been aborted. The reason for doing this is
22500 that it has the beneficial effect of freeing up certain types of connection
22501 that can get stuck when the remote host is disconnected without tidying up the
22502 TCP/IP call properly. The keepalive mechanism takes several hours to detect
22506 .option lmtp_ignore_quota smtp boolean false
22507 .cindex "LMTP" "ignoring quota errors"
22508 If this option is set true when the &%protocol%& option is set to &"lmtp"&, the
22509 string &`IGNOREQUOTA`& is added to RCPT commands, provided that the LMTP server
22510 has advertised support for IGNOREQUOTA in its response to the LHLO command.
22512 .option max_rcpt smtp integer 100
22513 .cindex "RCPT" "maximum number of outgoing"
22514 This option limits the number of RCPT commands that are sent in a single
22515 SMTP message transaction. Each set of addresses is treated independently, and
22516 so can cause parallel connections to the same host if &%remote_max_parallel%&
22520 .option multi_domain smtp boolean true
22521 .vindex "&$domain$&"
22522 When this option is set, the &(smtp)& transport can handle a number of
22523 addresses containing a mixture of different domains provided they all resolve
22524 to the same list of hosts. Turning the option off restricts the transport to
22525 handling only one domain at a time. This is useful if you want to use
22526 &$domain$& in an expansion for the transport, because it is set only when there
22527 is a single domain involved in a remote delivery.
22530 .option port smtp string&!! "see below"
22531 .cindex "port" "sending TCP/IP"
22532 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting outgoing port"
22533 This option specifies the TCP/IP port on the server to which Exim connects.
22534 &*Note:*& Do not confuse this with the port that was used when a message was
22535 received, which is in &$received_port$&, formerly known as &$interface_port$&.
22536 The name was changed to minimize confusion with the outgoing port. There is no
22537 variable that contains an outgoing port.
22539 If the value of this option begins with a digit it is taken as a port number;
22540 otherwise it is looked up using &[getservbyname()]&. The default value is
22541 normally &"smtp"&, but if &%protocol%& is set to &"lmtp"&, the default is
22542 &"lmtp"&. If the expansion fails, or if a port number cannot be found, delivery
22547 .option protocol smtp string smtp
22548 .cindex "LMTP" "over TCP/IP"
22549 .cindex "ssmtp protocol" "outbound"
22550 .cindex "TLS" "SSL-on-connect outbound"
22552 If this option is set to &"lmtp"& instead of &"smtp"&, the default value for
22553 the &%port%& option changes to &"lmtp"&, and the transport operates the LMTP
22554 protocol (RFC 2033) instead of SMTP. This protocol is sometimes used for local
22555 deliveries into closed message stores. Exim also has support for running LMTP
22556 over a pipe to a local process &-- see chapter &<<CHAPLMTP>>&.
22558 If this option is set to &"smtps"&, the default vaule for the &%port%& option
22559 changes to &"smtps"&, and the transport initiates TLS immediately after
22560 connecting, as an outbound SSL-on-connect, instead of using STARTTLS to upgrade.
22561 The Internet standards bodies strongly discourage use of this mode.
22564 .option retry_include_ip_address smtp boolean true
22565 Exim normally includes both the host name and the IP address in the key it
22566 constructs for indexing retry data after a temporary delivery failure. This
22567 means that when one of several IP addresses for a host is failing, it gets
22568 tried periodically (controlled by the retry rules), but use of the other IP
22569 addresses is not affected.
22571 However, in some dialup environments hosts are assigned a different IP address
22572 each time they connect. In this situation the use of the IP address as part of
22573 the retry key leads to undesirable behaviour. Setting this option false causes
22574 Exim to use only the host name. This should normally be done on a separate
22575 instance of the &(smtp)& transport, set up specially to handle the dialup
22579 .option serialize_hosts smtp "host list&!!" unset
22580 .cindex "serializing connections"
22581 .cindex "host" "serializing connections"
22582 Because Exim operates in a distributed manner, if several messages for the same
22583 host arrive at around the same time, more than one simultaneous connection to
22584 the remote host can occur. This is not usually a problem except when there is a
22585 slow link between the hosts. In that situation it may be helpful to restrict
22586 Exim to one connection at a time. This can be done by setting
22587 &%serialize_hosts%& to match the relevant hosts.
22589 .cindex "hints database" "serializing deliveries to a host"
22590 Exim implements serialization by means of a hints database in which a record is
22591 written whenever a process connects to one of the restricted hosts. The record
22592 is deleted when the connection is completed. Obviously there is scope for
22593 records to get left lying around if there is a system or program crash. To
22594 guard against this, Exim ignores any records that are more than six hours old.
22596 If you set up this kind of serialization, you should also arrange to delete the
22597 relevant hints database whenever your system reboots. The names of the files
22598 start with &_misc_& and they are kept in the &_spool/db_& directory. There
22599 may be one or two files, depending on the type of DBM in use. The same files
22600 are used for ETRN serialization.
22603 .option size_addition smtp integer 1024
22604 .cindex "SMTP" "SIZE"
22605 .cindex "message" "size issue for transport filter"
22606 .cindex "size" "of message"
22607 .cindex "transport" "filter"
22608 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
22609 If a remote SMTP server indicates that it supports the SIZE option of the
22610 MAIL command, Exim uses this to pass over the message size at the start of
22611 an SMTP transaction. It adds the value of &%size_addition%& to the value it
22612 sends, to allow for headers and other text that may be added during delivery by
22613 configuration options or in a transport filter. It may be necessary to increase
22614 this if a lot of text is added to messages.
22616 Alternatively, if the value of &%size_addition%& is set negative, it disables
22617 the use of the SIZE option altogether.
22620 .option tls_certificate smtp string&!! unset
22621 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate, location of"
22622 .cindex "certificate" "client, location of"
22624 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
22625 The value of this option must be the absolute path to a file which contains the
22626 client's certificate, for possible use when sending a message over an encrypted
22627 connection. The values of &$host$& and &$host_address$& are set to the name and
22628 address of the server during the expansion. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for
22631 &*Note*&: This option must be set if you want Exim to be able to use a TLS
22632 certificate when sending messages as a client. The global option of the same
22633 name specifies the certificate for Exim as a server; it is not automatically
22634 assumed that the same certificate should be used when Exim is operating as a
22638 .option tls_crl smtp string&!! unset
22639 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate revocation list"
22640 .cindex "certificate" "revocation list for client"
22641 This option specifies a certificate revocation list. The expanded value must
22642 be the name of a file that contains a CRL in PEM format.
22646 .option tls_dh_min_bits smtp integer 1024
22647 .cindex "TLS" "Diffie-Hellman minimum acceptable size"
22648 When establishing a TLS session, if a ciphersuite which uses Diffie-Hellman
22649 key agreement is negotiated, the server will provide a large prime number
22650 for use. This option establishes the minimum acceptable size of that number.
22651 If the parameter offered by the server is too small, then the TLS handshake
22654 Only supported when using GnuTLS.
22658 .option tls_privatekey smtp string&!! unset
22659 .cindex "TLS" "client private key, location of"
22661 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
22662 The value of this option must be the absolute path to a file which contains the
22663 client's private key. This is used when sending a message over an encrypted
22664 connection using a client certificate. The values of &$host$& and
22665 &$host_address$& are set to the name and address of the server during the
22666 expansion. If this option is unset, or the expansion is forced to fail, or the
22667 result is an empty string, the private key is assumed to be in the same file as
22668 the certificate. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
22671 .option tls_require_ciphers smtp string&!! unset
22672 .cindex "TLS" "requiring specific ciphers"
22673 .cindex "cipher" "requiring specific"
22675 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
22676 The value of this option must be a list of permitted cipher suites, for use
22677 when setting up an outgoing encrypted connection. (There is a global option of
22678 the same name for controlling incoming connections.) The values of &$host$& and
22679 &$host_address$& are set to the name and address of the server during the
22680 expansion. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS; note that this option
22681 is used in different ways by OpenSSL and GnuTLS (see sections
22682 &<<SECTreqciphssl>>& and &<<SECTreqciphgnu>>&). For GnuTLS, the order of the
22683 ciphers is a preference order.
22687 .option tls_sni smtp string&!! unset
22688 .cindex "TLS" "Server Name Indication"
22689 .vindex "&$tls_sni$&"
22690 If this option is set then it sets the $tls_out_sni variable and causes any
22691 TLS session to pass this value as the Server Name Indication extension to
22692 the remote side, which can be used by the remote side to select an appropriate
22693 certificate and private key for the session.
22695 See &<<SECTtlssni>>& for more information.
22697 Note that for OpenSSL, this feature requires a build of OpenSSL that supports
22703 .option tls_tempfail_tryclear smtp boolean true
22704 .cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "to STARTTLS"
22705 When the server host is not in &%hosts_require_tls%&, and there is a problem in
22706 setting up a TLS session, this option determines whether or not Exim should try
22707 to deliver the message unencrypted. If it is set false, delivery to the
22708 current host is deferred; if there are other hosts, they are tried. If this
22709 option is set true, Exim attempts to deliver unencrypted after a 4&'xx'&
22710 response to STARTTLS. Also, if STARTTLS is accepted, but the subsequent
22711 TLS negotiation fails, Exim closes the current connection (because it is in an
22712 unknown state), opens a new one to the same host, and then tries the delivery
22716 .option tls_verify_certificates smtp string&!! unset
22717 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate verification"
22718 .cindex "certificate" "verification of server"
22720 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
22721 The value of this option must be the absolute path to a file containing
22722 permitted server certificates, for use when setting up an encrypted connection.
22723 Alternatively, if you are using OpenSSL, you can set
22724 &%tls_verify_certificates%& to the name of a directory containing certificate
22725 files. This does not work with GnuTLS; the option must be set to the name of a
22726 single file if you are using GnuTLS. The values of &$host$& and
22727 &$host_address$& are set to the name and address of the server during the
22728 expansion of this option. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
22733 .section "How the limits for the number of hosts to try are used" &&&
22735 .cindex "host" "maximum number to try"
22736 .cindex "limit" "hosts; maximum number tried"
22737 There are two options that are concerned with the number of hosts that are
22738 tried when an SMTP delivery takes place. They are &%hosts_max_try%& and
22739 &%hosts_max_try_hardlimit%&.
22742 The &%hosts_max_try%& option limits the number of hosts that are tried
22743 for a single delivery. However, despite the term &"host"& in its name, the
22744 option actually applies to each IP address independently. In other words, a
22745 multihomed host is treated as several independent hosts, just as it is for
22748 Many of the larger ISPs have multiple MX records which often point to
22749 multihomed hosts. As a result, a list of a dozen or more IP addresses may be
22750 created as a result of routing one of these domains.
22752 Trying every single IP address on such a long list does not seem sensible; if
22753 several at the top of the list fail, it is reasonable to assume there is some
22754 problem that is likely to affect all of them. Roughly speaking, the value of
22755 &%hosts_max_try%& is the maximum number that are tried before deferring the
22756 delivery. However, the logic cannot be quite that simple.
22758 Firstly, IP addresses that are skipped because their retry times have not
22759 arrived do not count, and in addition, addresses that are past their retry
22760 limits are also not counted, even when they are tried. This means that when
22761 some IP addresses are past their retry limits, more than the value of
22762 &%hosts_max_retry%& may be tried. The reason for this behaviour is to ensure
22763 that all IP addresses are considered before timing out an email address (but
22764 see below for an exception).
22766 Secondly, when the &%hosts_max_try%& limit is reached, Exim looks down the host
22767 list to see if there is a subsequent host with a different (higher valued) MX.
22768 If there is, that host is considered next, and the current IP address is used
22769 but not counted. This behaviour helps in the case of a domain with a retry rule
22770 that hardly ever delays any hosts, as is now explained:
22772 Consider the case of a long list of hosts with one MX value, and a few with a
22773 higher MX value. If &%hosts_max_try%& is small (the default is 5) only a few
22774 hosts at the top of the list are tried at first. With the default retry rule,
22775 which specifies increasing retry times, the higher MX hosts are eventually
22776 tried when those at the top of the list are skipped because they have not
22777 reached their retry times.
22779 However, it is common practice to put a fixed short retry time on domains for
22780 large ISPs, on the grounds that their servers are rarely down for very long.
22781 Unfortunately, these are exactly the domains that tend to resolve to long lists
22782 of hosts. The short retry time means that the lowest MX hosts are tried every
22783 time. The attempts may be in a different order because of random sorting, but
22784 without the special MX check, the higher MX hosts would never be tried until
22785 all the lower MX hosts had timed out (which might be several days), because
22786 there are always some lower MX hosts that have reached their retry times. With
22787 the special check, Exim considers at least one IP address from each MX value at
22788 every delivery attempt, even if the &%hosts_max_try%& limit has already been
22791 The above logic means that &%hosts_max_try%& is not a hard limit, and in
22792 particular, Exim normally eventually tries all the IP addresses before timing
22793 out an email address. When &%hosts_max_try%& was implemented, this seemed a
22794 reasonable thing to do. Recently, however, some lunatic DNS configurations have
22795 been set up with hundreds of IP addresses for some domains. It can
22796 take a very long time indeed for an address to time out in these cases.
22798 The &%hosts_max_try_hardlimit%& option was added to help with this problem.
22799 Exim never tries more than this number of IP addresses; if it hits this limit
22800 and they are all timed out, the email address is bounced, even though not all
22801 possible IP addresses have been tried.
22802 .ecindex IIDsmttra1
22803 .ecindex IIDsmttra2
22809 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22810 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22812 .chapter "Address rewriting" "CHAPrewrite"
22813 .scindex IIDaddrew "rewriting" "addresses"
22814 There are some circumstances in which Exim automatically rewrites domains in
22815 addresses. The two most common are when an address is given without a domain
22816 (referred to as an &"unqualified address"&) or when an address contains an
22817 abbreviated domain that is expanded by DNS lookup.
22819 Unqualified envelope addresses are accepted only for locally submitted
22820 messages, or for messages that are received from hosts matching
22821 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& or &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&, as
22822 appropriate. Unqualified addresses in header lines are qualified if they are in
22823 locally submitted messages, or messages from hosts that are permitted to send
22824 unqualified envelope addresses. Otherwise, unqualified addresses in header
22825 lines are neither qualified nor rewritten.
22827 One situation in which Exim does &'not'& automatically rewrite a domain is
22828 when it is the name of a CNAME record in the DNS. The older RFCs suggest that
22829 such a domain should be rewritten using the &"canonical"& name, and some MTAs
22830 do this. The new RFCs do not contain this suggestion.
22833 .section "Explicitly configured address rewriting" "SECID147"
22834 This chapter describes the rewriting rules that can be used in the
22835 main rewrite section of the configuration file, and also in the generic
22836 &%headers_rewrite%& option that can be set on any transport.
22838 Some people believe that configured address rewriting is a Mortal Sin.
22839 Others believe that life is not possible without it. Exim provides the
22840 facility; you do not have to use it.
22842 The main rewriting rules that appear in the &"rewrite"& section of the
22843 configuration file are applied to addresses in incoming messages, both envelope
22844 addresses and addresses in header lines. Each rule specifies the types of
22845 address to which it applies.
22847 Whether or not addresses in header lines are rewritten depends on the origin of
22848 the headers and the type of rewriting. Global rewriting, that is, rewriting
22849 rules from the rewrite section of the configuration file, is applied only to
22850 those headers that were received with the message. Header lines that are added
22851 by ACLs or by a system filter or by individual routers or transports (which
22852 are specific to individual recipient addresses) are not rewritten by the global
22855 Rewriting at transport time, by means of the &%headers_rewrite%& option,
22856 applies all headers except those added by routers and transports. That is, as
22857 well as the headers that were received with the message, it also applies to
22858 headers that were added by an ACL or a system filter.
22861 In general, rewriting addresses from your own system or domain has some
22862 legitimacy. Rewriting other addresses should be done only with great care and
22863 in special circumstances. The author of Exim believes that rewriting should be
22864 used sparingly, and mainly for &"regularizing"& addresses in your own domains.
22865 Although it can sometimes be used as a routing tool, this is very strongly
22868 There are two commonly encountered circumstances where rewriting is used, as
22869 illustrated by these examples:
22872 The company whose domain is &'hitch.fict.example'& has a number of hosts that
22873 exchange mail with each other behind a firewall, but there is only a single
22874 gateway to the outer world. The gateway rewrites &'*.hitch.fict.example'& as
22875 &'hitch.fict.example'& when sending mail off-site.
22877 A host rewrites the local parts of its own users so that, for example,
22878 &'fp42@hitch.fict.example'& becomes &'Ford.Prefect@hitch.fict.example'&.
22883 .section "When does rewriting happen?" "SECID148"
22884 .cindex "rewriting" "timing of"
22885 .cindex "&ACL;" "rewriting addresses in"
22886 Configured address rewriting can take place at several different stages of a
22887 message's processing.
22889 .vindex "&$sender_address$&"
22890 At the start of an ACL for MAIL, the sender address may have been rewritten
22891 by a special SMTP-time rewrite rule (see section &<<SECTrewriteS>>&), but no
22892 ordinary rewrite rules have yet been applied. If, however, the sender address
22893 is verified in the ACL, it is rewritten before verification, and remains
22894 rewritten thereafter. The subsequent value of &$sender_address$& is the
22895 rewritten address. This also applies if sender verification happens in a
22896 RCPT ACL. Otherwise, when the sender address is not verified, it is
22897 rewritten as soon as a message's header lines have been received.
22899 .vindex "&$domain$&"
22900 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
22901 Similarly, at the start of an ACL for RCPT, the current recipient's address
22902 may have been rewritten by a special SMTP-time rewrite rule, but no ordinary
22903 rewrite rules have yet been applied to it. However, the behaviour is different
22904 from the sender address when a recipient is verified. The address is rewritten
22905 for the verification, but the rewriting is not remembered at this stage. The
22906 value of &$local_part$& and &$domain$& after verification are always the same
22907 as they were before (that is, they contain the unrewritten &-- except for
22908 SMTP-time rewriting &-- address).
22910 As soon as a message's header lines have been received, all the envelope
22911 recipient addresses are permanently rewritten, and rewriting is also applied to
22912 the addresses in the header lines (if configured). This happens before adding
22913 any header lines that were specified in MAIL or RCPT ACLs, and
22914 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "address rewriting; timing of"
22915 before the DATA ACL and &[local_scan()]& functions are run.
22917 When an address is being routed, either for delivery or for verification,
22918 rewriting is applied immediately to child addresses that are generated by
22919 redirection, unless &%no_rewrite%& is set on the router.
22921 .cindex "envelope sender" "rewriting at transport time"
22922 .cindex "rewriting" "at transport time"
22923 .cindex "header lines" "rewriting at transport time"
22924 At transport time, additional rewriting of addresses in header lines can be
22925 specified by setting the generic &%headers_rewrite%& option on a transport.
22926 This option contains rules that are identical in form to those in the rewrite
22927 section of the configuration file. They are applied to the original message
22928 header lines and any that were added by ACLs or a system filter. They are not
22929 applied to header lines that are added by routers or the transport.
22931 The outgoing envelope sender can be rewritten by means of the &%return_path%&
22932 transport option. However, it is not possible to rewrite envelope recipients at
22938 .section "Testing the rewriting rules that apply on input" "SECID149"
22939 .cindex "rewriting" "testing"
22940 .cindex "testing" "rewriting"
22941 Exim's input rewriting configuration appears in a part of the run time
22942 configuration file headed by &"begin rewrite"&. It can be tested by the
22943 &%-brw%& command line option. This takes an address (which can be a full RFC
22944 2822 address) as its argument. The output is a list of how the address would be
22945 transformed by the rewriting rules for each of the different places it might
22946 appear in an incoming message, that is, for each different header and for the
22947 envelope sender and recipient fields. For example,
22949 exim -brw ph10@exim.workshop.example
22951 might produce the output
22953 sender: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
22954 from: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
22955 to: ph10@exim.workshop.example
22956 cc: ph10@exim.workshop.example
22957 bcc: ph10@exim.workshop.example
22958 reply-to: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
22959 env-from: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
22960 env-to: ph10@exim.workshop.example
22962 which shows that rewriting has been set up for that address when used in any of
22963 the source fields, but not when it appears as a recipient address. At the
22964 present time, there is no equivalent way of testing rewriting rules that are
22965 set for a particular transport.
22968 .section "Rewriting rules" "SECID150"
22969 .cindex "rewriting" "rules"
22970 The rewrite section of the configuration file consists of lines of rewriting
22973 <&'source pattern'&> <&'replacement'&> <&'flags'&>
22975 Rewriting rules that are specified for the &%headers_rewrite%& generic
22976 transport option are given as a colon-separated list. Each item in the list
22977 takes the same form as a line in the main rewriting configuration (except that
22978 any colons must be doubled, of course).
22980 The formats of source patterns and replacement strings are described below.
22981 Each is terminated by white space, unless enclosed in double quotes, in which
22982 case normal quoting conventions apply inside the quotes. The flags are single
22983 characters which may appear in any order. Spaces and tabs between them are
22986 For each address that could potentially be rewritten, the rules are scanned in
22987 order, and replacements for the address from earlier rules can themselves be
22988 replaced by later rules (but see the &"q"& and &"R"& flags).
22990 The order in which addresses are rewritten is undefined, may change between
22991 releases, and must not be relied on, with one exception: when a message is
22992 received, the envelope sender is always rewritten first, before any header
22993 lines are rewritten. For example, the replacement string for a rewrite of an
22994 address in &'To:'& must not assume that the message's address in &'From:'& has
22995 (or has not) already been rewritten. However, a rewrite of &'From:'& may assume
22996 that the envelope sender has already been rewritten.
22998 .vindex "&$domain$&"
22999 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
23000 The variables &$local_part$& and &$domain$& can be used in the replacement
23001 string to refer to the address that is being rewritten. Note that lookup-driven
23002 rewriting can be done by a rule of the form
23006 where the lookup key uses &$1$& and &$2$& or &$local_part$& and &$domain$& to
23007 refer to the address that is being rewritten.
23010 .section "Rewriting patterns" "SECID151"
23011 .cindex "rewriting" "patterns"
23012 .cindex "address list" "in a rewriting pattern"
23013 The source pattern in a rewriting rule is any item which may appear in an
23014 address list (see section &<<SECTaddresslist>>&). It is in fact processed as a
23015 single-item address list, which means that it is expanded before being tested
23016 against the address. As always, if you use a regular expression as a pattern,
23017 you must take care to escape dollar and backslash characters, or use the &`\N`&
23018 facility to suppress string expansion within the regular expression.
23020 Domains in patterns should be given in lower case. Local parts in patterns are
23021 case-sensitive. If you want to do case-insensitive matching of local parts, you
23022 can use a regular expression that starts with &`^(?i)`&.
23024 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in rewriting rules"
23025 After matching, the numerical variables &$1$&, &$2$&, etc. may be set,
23026 depending on the type of match which occurred. These can be used in the
23027 replacement string to insert portions of the incoming address. &$0$& always
23028 refers to the complete incoming address. When a regular expression is used, the
23029 numerical variables are set from its capturing subexpressions. For other types
23030 of pattern they are set as follows:
23033 If a local part or domain starts with an asterisk, the numerical variables
23034 refer to the character strings matched by asterisks, with &$1$& associated with
23035 the first asterisk, and &$2$& with the second, if present. For example, if the
23038 *queen@*.fict.example
23040 is matched against the address &'hearts-queen@wonderland.fict.example'& then
23042 $0 = hearts-queen@wonderland.fict.example
23046 Note that if the local part does not start with an asterisk, but the domain
23047 does, it is &$1$& that contains the wild part of the domain.
23050 If the domain part of the pattern is a partial lookup, the wild and fixed parts
23051 of the domain are placed in the next available numerical variables. Suppose,
23052 for example, that the address &'foo@bar.baz.example'& is processed by a
23053 rewriting rule of the form
23055 &`*@partial-dbm;/some/dbm/file`& <&'replacement string'&>
23057 and the key in the file that matches the domain is &`*.baz.example`&. Then
23063 If the address &'foo@baz.example'& is looked up, this matches the same
23064 wildcard file entry, and in this case &$2$& is set to the empty string, but
23065 &$3$& is still set to &'baz.example'&. If a non-wild key is matched in a
23066 partial lookup, &$2$& is again set to the empty string and &$3$& is set to the
23067 whole domain. For non-partial domain lookups, no numerical variables are set.
23071 .section "Rewriting replacements" "SECID152"
23072 .cindex "rewriting" "replacements"
23073 If the replacement string for a rule is a single asterisk, addresses that
23074 match the pattern and the flags are &'not'& rewritten, and no subsequent
23075 rewriting rules are scanned. For example,
23077 hatta@lookingglass.fict.example * f
23079 specifies that &'hatta@lookingglass.fict.example'& is never to be rewritten in
23082 .vindex "&$domain$&"
23083 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
23084 If the replacement string is not a single asterisk, it is expanded, and must
23085 yield a fully qualified address. Within the expansion, the variables
23086 &$local_part$& and &$domain$& refer to the address that is being rewritten.
23087 Any letters they contain retain their original case &-- they are not lower
23088 cased. The numerical variables are set up according to the type of pattern that
23089 matched the address, as described above. If the expansion is forced to fail by
23090 the presence of &"fail"& in a conditional or lookup item, rewriting by the
23091 current rule is abandoned, but subsequent rules may take effect. Any other
23092 expansion failure causes the entire rewriting operation to be abandoned, and an
23093 entry written to the panic log.
23097 .section "Rewriting flags" "SECID153"
23098 There are three different kinds of flag that may appear on rewriting rules:
23101 Flags that specify which headers and envelope addresses to rewrite: E, F, T, b,
23104 A flag that specifies rewriting at SMTP time: S.
23106 Flags that control the rewriting process: Q, q, R, w.
23109 For rules that are part of the &%headers_rewrite%& generic transport option,
23110 E, F, T, and S are not permitted.
23114 .section "Flags specifying which headers and envelope addresses to rewrite" &&&
23116 .cindex "rewriting" "flags"
23117 If none of the following flag letters, nor the &"S"& flag (see section
23118 &<<SECTrewriteS>>&) are present, a main rewriting rule applies to all headers
23119 and to both the sender and recipient fields of the envelope, whereas a
23120 transport-time rewriting rule just applies to all headers. Otherwise, the
23121 rewriting rule is skipped unless the relevant addresses are being processed.
23123 &`E`& rewrite all envelope fields
23124 &`F`& rewrite the envelope From field
23125 &`T`& rewrite the envelope To field
23126 &`b`& rewrite the &'Bcc:'& header
23127 &`c`& rewrite the &'Cc:'& header
23128 &`f`& rewrite the &'From:'& header
23129 &`h`& rewrite all headers
23130 &`r`& rewrite the &'Reply-To:'& header
23131 &`s`& rewrite the &'Sender:'& header
23132 &`t`& rewrite the &'To:'& header
23134 "All headers" means all of the headers listed above that can be selected
23135 individually, plus their &'Resent-'& versions. It does not include
23136 other headers such as &'Subject:'& etc.
23138 You should be particularly careful about rewriting &'Sender:'& headers, and
23139 restrict this to special known cases in your own domains.
23142 .section "The SMTP-time rewriting flag" "SECTrewriteS"
23143 .cindex "SMTP" "rewriting malformed addresses"
23144 .cindex "RCPT" "rewriting argument of"
23145 .cindex "MAIL" "rewriting argument of"
23146 The rewrite flag &"S"& specifies a rewrite of incoming envelope addresses at
23147 SMTP time, as soon as an address is received in a MAIL or RCPT command, and
23148 before any other processing; even before syntax checking. The pattern is
23149 required to be a regular expression, and it is matched against the whole of the
23150 data for the command, including any surrounding angle brackets.
23152 .vindex "&$domain$&"
23153 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
23154 This form of rewrite rule allows for the handling of addresses that are not
23155 compliant with RFCs 2821 and 2822 (for example, &"bang paths"& in batched SMTP
23156 input). Because the input is not required to be a syntactically valid address,
23157 the variables &$local_part$& and &$domain$& are not available during the
23158 expansion of the replacement string. The result of rewriting replaces the
23159 original address in the MAIL or RCPT command.
23162 .section "Flags controlling the rewriting process" "SECID155"
23163 There are four flags which control the way the rewriting process works. These
23164 take effect only when a rule is invoked, that is, when the address is of the
23165 correct type (matches the flags) and matches the pattern:
23168 If the &"Q"& flag is set on a rule, the rewritten address is permitted to be an
23169 unqualified local part. It is qualified with &%qualify_recipient%&. In the
23170 absence of &"Q"& the rewritten address must always include a domain.
23172 If the &"q"& flag is set on a rule, no further rewriting rules are considered,
23173 even if no rewriting actually takes place because of a &"fail"& in the
23174 expansion. The &"q"& flag is not effective if the address is of the wrong type
23175 (does not match the flags) or does not match the pattern.
23177 The &"R"& flag causes a successful rewriting rule to be re-applied to the new
23178 address, up to ten times. It can be combined with the &"q"& flag, to stop
23179 rewriting once it fails to match (after at least one successful rewrite).
23181 .cindex "rewriting" "whole addresses"
23182 When an address in a header is rewritten, the rewriting normally applies only
23183 to the working part of the address, with any comments and RFC 2822 &"phrase"&
23184 left unchanged. For example, rewriting might change
23186 From: Ford Prefect <fp42@restaurant.hitch.fict.example>
23190 From: Ford Prefect <prefectf@hitch.fict.example>
23193 Sometimes there is a need to replace the whole address item, and this can be
23194 done by adding the flag letter &"w"& to a rule. If this is set on a rule that
23195 causes an address in a header line to be rewritten, the entire address is
23196 replaced, not just the working part. The replacement must be a complete RFC
23197 2822 address, including the angle brackets if necessary. If text outside angle
23198 brackets contains a character whose value is greater than 126 or less than 32
23199 (except for tab), the text is encoded according to RFC 2047. The character set
23200 is taken from &%headers_charset%&, which defaults to ISO-8859-1.
23202 When the &"w"& flag is set on a rule that causes an envelope address to be
23203 rewritten, all but the working part of the replacement address is discarded.
23207 .section "Rewriting examples" "SECID156"
23208 Here is an example of the two common rewriting paradigms:
23210 *@*.hitch.fict.example $1@hitch.fict.example
23211 *@hitch.fict.example ${lookup{$1}dbm{/etc/realnames}\
23212 {$value}fail}@hitch.fict.example bctfrF
23214 Note the use of &"fail"& in the lookup expansion in the second rule, forcing
23215 the string expansion to fail if the lookup does not succeed. In this context it
23216 has the effect of leaving the original address unchanged, but Exim goes on to
23217 consider subsequent rewriting rules, if any, because the &"q"& flag is not
23218 present in that rule. An alternative to &"fail"& would be to supply &$1$&
23219 explicitly, which would cause the rewritten address to be the same as before,
23220 at the cost of a small bit of processing. Not supplying either of these is an
23221 error, since the rewritten address would then contain no local part.
23223 The first example above replaces the domain with a superior, more general
23224 domain. This may not be desirable for certain local parts. If the rule
23226 root@*.hitch.fict.example *
23228 were inserted before the first rule, rewriting would be suppressed for the
23229 local part &'root'& at any domain ending in &'hitch.fict.example'&.
23231 Rewriting can be made conditional on a number of tests, by making use of
23232 &${if$& in the expansion item. For example, to apply a rewriting rule only to
23233 messages that originate outside the local host:
23235 *@*.hitch.fict.example "${if !eq {$sender_host_address}{}\
23236 {$1@hitch.fict.example}fail}"
23238 The replacement string is quoted in this example because it contains white
23241 .cindex "rewriting" "bang paths"
23242 .cindex "bang paths" "rewriting"
23243 Exim does not handle addresses in the form of &"bang paths"&. If it sees such
23244 an address it treats it as an unqualified local part which it qualifies with
23245 the local qualification domain (if the source of the message is local or if the
23246 remote host is permitted to send unqualified addresses). Rewriting can
23247 sometimes be used to handle simple bang paths with a fixed number of
23248 components. For example, the rule
23250 \N^([^!]+)!(.*)@your.domain.example$\N $2@$1
23252 rewrites a two-component bang path &'host.name!user'& as the domain address
23253 &'user@host.name'&. However, there is a security implication in using this as
23254 a global rewriting rule for envelope addresses. It can provide a backdoor
23255 method for using your system as a relay, because the incoming addresses appear
23256 to be local. If the bang path addresses are received via SMTP, it is safer to
23257 use the &"S"& flag to rewrite them as they are received, so that relay checking
23258 can be done on the rewritten addresses.
23265 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23266 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23268 .chapter "Retry configuration" "CHAPretry"
23269 .scindex IIDretconf1 "retry" "configuration, description of"
23270 .scindex IIDregconf2 "configuration file" "retry section"
23271 The &"retry"& section of the runtime configuration file contains a list of
23272 retry rules that control how often Exim tries to deliver messages that cannot
23273 be delivered at the first attempt. If there are no retry rules (the section is
23274 empty or not present), there are no retries. In this situation, temporary
23275 errors are treated as permanent. The default configuration contains a single,
23276 general-purpose retry rule (see section &<<SECID57>>&). The &%-brt%& command
23277 line option can be used to test which retry rule will be used for a given
23278 address, domain and error.
23280 The most common cause of retries is temporary failure to deliver to a remote
23281 host because the host is down, or inaccessible because of a network problem.
23282 Exim's retry processing in this case is applied on a per-host (strictly, per IP
23283 address) basis, not on a per-message basis. Thus, if one message has recently
23284 been delayed, delivery of a new message to the same host is not immediately
23285 tried, but waits for the host's retry time to arrive. If the &%retry_defer%&
23286 log selector is set, the message
23287 .cindex "retry" "time not reached"
23288 &"retry time not reached"& is written to the main log whenever a delivery is
23289 skipped for this reason. Section &<<SECToutSMTPerr>>& contains more details of
23290 the handling of errors during remote deliveries.
23292 Retry processing applies to routing as well as to delivering, except as covered
23293 in the next paragraph. The retry rules do not distinguish between these
23294 actions. It is not possible, for example, to specify different behaviour for
23295 failures to route the domain &'snark.fict.example'& and failures to deliver to
23296 the host &'snark.fict.example'&. I didn't think anyone would ever need this
23297 added complication, so did not implement it. However, although they share the
23298 same retry rule, the actual retry times for routing and transporting a given
23299 domain are maintained independently.
23301 When a delivery is not part of a queue run (typically an immediate delivery on
23302 receipt of a message), the routers are always run, and local deliveries are
23303 always attempted, even if retry times are set for them. This makes for better
23304 behaviour if one particular message is causing problems (for example, causing
23305 quota overflow, or provoking an error in a filter file). If such a delivery
23306 suffers a temporary failure, the retry data is updated as normal, and
23307 subsequent delivery attempts from queue runs occur only when the retry time for
23308 the local address is reached.
23310 .section "Changing retry rules" "SECID157"
23311 If you change the retry rules in your configuration, you should consider
23312 whether or not to delete the retry data that is stored in Exim's spool area in
23313 files with names like &_db/retry_&. Deleting any of Exim's hints files is
23314 always safe; that is why they are called &"hints"&.
23316 The hints retry data contains suggested retry times based on the previous
23317 rules. In the case of a long-running problem with a remote host, it might
23318 record the fact that the host has timed out. If your new rules increase the
23319 timeout time for such a host, you should definitely remove the old retry data
23320 and let Exim recreate it, based on the new rules. Otherwise Exim might bounce
23321 messages that it should now be retaining.
23325 .section "Format of retry rules" "SECID158"
23326 .cindex "retry" "rules"
23327 Each retry rule occupies one line and consists of three or four parts,
23328 separated by white space: a pattern, an error name, an optional list of sender
23329 addresses, and a list of retry parameters. The pattern and sender lists must be
23330 enclosed in double quotes if they contain white space. The rules are searched
23331 in order until one is found where the pattern, error name, and sender list (if
23332 present) match the failing host or address, the error that occurred, and the
23333 message's sender, respectively.
23336 The pattern is any single item that may appear in an address list (see section
23337 &<<SECTaddresslist>>&). It is in fact processed as a one-item address list,
23338 which means that it is expanded before being tested against the address that
23339 has been delayed. A negated address list item is permitted. Address
23340 list processing treats a plain domain name as if it were preceded by &"*@"&,
23341 which makes it possible for many retry rules to start with just a domain. For
23344 lookingglass.fict.example * F,24h,30m;
23346 provides a rule for any address in the &'lookingglass.fict.example'& domain,
23349 alice@lookingglass.fict.example * F,24h,30m;
23351 applies only to temporary failures involving the local part &%alice%&.
23352 In practice, almost all rules start with a domain name pattern without a local
23355 .cindex "regular expressions" "in retry rules"
23356 &*Warning*&: If you use a regular expression in a routing rule pattern, it
23357 must match a complete address, not just a domain, because that is how regular
23358 expressions work in address lists.
23360 &`^\Nxyz\d+\.abc\.example$\N * G,1h,10m,2`& &%Wrong%&
23361 &`^\N[^@]+@xyz\d+\.abc\.example$\N * G,1h,10m,2`& &%Right%&
23365 .section "Choosing which retry rule to use for address errors" "SECID159"
23366 When Exim is looking for a retry rule after a routing attempt has failed (for
23367 example, after a DNS timeout), each line in the retry configuration is tested
23368 against the complete address only if &%retry_use_local_part%& is set for the
23369 router. Otherwise, only the domain is used, except when matching against a
23370 regular expression, when the local part of the address is replaced with &"*"&.
23371 A domain on its own can match a domain pattern, or a pattern that starts with
23372 &"*@"&. By default, &%retry_use_local_part%& is true for routers where
23373 &%check_local_user%& is true, and false for other routers.
23375 Similarly, when Exim is looking for a retry rule after a local delivery has
23376 failed (for example, after a mailbox full error), each line in the retry
23377 configuration is tested against the complete address only if
23378 &%retry_use_local_part%& is set for the transport (it defaults true for all
23381 .cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "retry rules for"
23382 However, when Exim is looking for a retry rule after a remote delivery attempt
23383 suffers an address error (a 4&'xx'& SMTP response for a recipient address), the
23384 whole address is always used as the key when searching the retry rules. The
23385 rule that is found is used to create a retry time for the combination of the
23386 failing address and the message's sender. It is the combination of sender and
23387 recipient that is delayed in subsequent queue runs until its retry time is
23388 reached. You can delay the recipient without regard to the sender by setting
23389 &%address_retry_include_sender%& false in the &(smtp)& transport but this can
23390 lead to problems with servers that regularly issue 4&'xx'& responses to RCPT
23395 .section "Choosing which retry rule to use for host and message errors" &&&
23397 For a temporary error that is not related to an individual address (for
23398 example, a connection timeout), each line in the retry configuration is checked
23399 twice. First, the name of the remote host is used as a domain name (preceded by
23400 &"*@"& when matching a regular expression). If this does not match the line,
23401 the domain from the email address is tried in a similar fashion. For example,
23402 suppose the MX records for &'a.b.c.example'& are
23404 a.b.c.example MX 5 x.y.z.example
23408 and the retry rules are
23410 p.q.r.example * F,24h,30m;
23411 a.b.c.example * F,4d,45m;
23413 and a delivery to the host &'x.y.z.example'& suffers a connection failure. The
23414 first rule matches neither the host nor the domain, so Exim looks at the second
23415 rule. This does not match the host, but it does match the domain, so it is used
23416 to calculate the retry time for the host &'x.y.z.example'&. Meanwhile, Exim
23417 tries to deliver to &'p.q.r.example'&. If this also suffers a host error, the
23418 first retry rule is used, because it matches the host.
23420 In other words, temporary failures to deliver to host &'p.q.r.example'& use the
23421 first rule to determine retry times, but for all the other hosts for the domain
23422 &'a.b.c.example'&, the second rule is used. The second rule is also used if
23423 routing to &'a.b.c.example'& suffers a temporary failure.
23425 &*Note*&: The host name is used when matching the patterns, not its IP address.
23426 However, if a message is routed directly to an IP address without the use of a
23427 host name, for example, if a &(manualroute)& router contains a setting such as:
23429 route_list = *.a.example 192.168.34.23
23431 then the &"host name"& that is used when searching for a retry rule is the
23432 textual form of the IP address.
23434 .section "Retry rules for specific errors" "SECID161"
23435 .cindex "retry" "specific errors; specifying"
23436 The second field in a retry rule is the name of a particular error, or an
23437 asterisk, which matches any error. The errors that can be tested for are:
23440 .vitem &%auth_failed%&
23441 Authentication failed when trying to send to a host in the
23442 &%hosts_require_auth%& list in an &(smtp)& transport.
23444 .vitem &%data_4xx%&
23445 A 4&'xx'& error was received for an outgoing DATA command, either immediately
23446 after the command, or after sending the message's data.
23448 .vitem &%mail_4xx%&
23449 A 4&'xx'& error was received for an outgoing MAIL command.
23451 .vitem &%rcpt_4xx%&
23452 A 4&'xx'& error was received for an outgoing RCPT command.
23455 For the three 4&'xx'& errors, either the first or both of the x's can be given
23456 as specific digits, for example: &`mail_45x`& or &`rcpt_436`&. For example, to
23457 recognize 452 errors given to RCPT commands for addresses in a certain domain,
23458 and have retries every ten minutes with a one-hour timeout, you could set up a
23459 retry rule of this form:
23461 the.domain.name rcpt_452 F,1h,10m
23463 These errors apply to both outgoing SMTP (the &(smtp)& transport) and outgoing
23464 LMTP (either the &(lmtp)& transport, or the &(smtp)& transport in LMTP mode).
23467 .vitem &%lost_connection%&
23468 A server unexpectedly closed the SMTP connection. There may, of course,
23469 legitimate reasons for this (host died, network died), but if it repeats a lot
23470 for the same host, it indicates something odd.
23472 .vitem &%refused_MX%&
23473 A connection to a host obtained from an MX record was refused.
23475 .vitem &%refused_A%&
23476 A connection to a host not obtained from an MX record was refused.
23479 A connection was refused.
23481 .vitem &%timeout_connect_MX%&
23482 A connection attempt to a host obtained from an MX record timed out.
23484 .vitem &%timeout_connect_A%&
23485 A connection attempt to a host not obtained from an MX record timed out.
23487 .vitem &%timeout_connect%&
23488 A connection attempt timed out.
23490 .vitem &%timeout_MX%&
23491 There was a timeout while connecting or during an SMTP session with a host
23492 obtained from an MX record.
23494 .vitem &%timeout_A%&
23495 There was a timeout while connecting or during an SMTP session with a host not
23496 obtained from an MX record.
23499 There was a timeout while connecting or during an SMTP session.
23501 .vitem &%tls_required%&
23502 The server was required to use TLS (it matched &%hosts_require_tls%& in the
23503 &(smtp)& transport), but either did not offer TLS, or it responded with 4&'xx'&
23504 to STARTTLS, or there was a problem setting up the TLS connection.
23507 A mailbox quota was exceeded in a local delivery by the &(appendfile)&
23510 .vitem &%quota_%&<&'time'&>
23511 .cindex "quota" "error testing in retry rule"
23512 .cindex "retry" "quota error testing"
23513 A mailbox quota was exceeded in a local delivery by the &(appendfile)&
23514 transport, and the mailbox has not been accessed for <&'time'&>. For example,
23515 &'quota_4d'& applies to a quota error when the mailbox has not been accessed
23519 .cindex "mailbox" "time of last read"
23520 The idea of &%quota_%&<&'time'&> is to make it possible to have shorter
23521 timeouts when the mailbox is full and is not being read by its owner. Ideally,
23522 it should be based on the last time that the user accessed the mailbox.
23523 However, it is not always possible to determine this. Exim uses the following
23527 If the mailbox is a single file, the time of last access (the &"atime"&) is
23528 used. As no new messages are being delivered (because the mailbox is over
23529 quota), Exim does not access the file, so this is the time of last user access.
23531 .cindex "maildir format" "time of last read"
23532 For a maildir delivery, the time of last modification of the &_new_&
23533 subdirectory is used. As the mailbox is over quota, no new files are created in
23534 the &_new_& subdirectory, because no new messages are being delivered. Any
23535 change to the &_new_& subdirectory is therefore assumed to be the result of an
23536 MUA moving a new message to the &_cur_& directory when it is first read. The
23537 time that is used is therefore the last time that the user read a new message.
23539 For other kinds of multi-file mailbox, the time of last access cannot be
23540 obtained, so a retry rule that uses this type of error field is never matched.
23543 The quota errors apply both to system-enforced quotas and to Exim's own quota
23544 mechanism in the &(appendfile)& transport. The &'quota'& error also applies
23545 when a local delivery is deferred because a partition is full (the ENOSPC
23550 .section "Retry rules for specified senders" "SECID162"
23551 .cindex "retry" "rules; sender-specific"
23552 You can specify retry rules that apply only when the failing message has a
23553 specific sender. In particular, this can be used to define retry rules that
23554 apply only to bounce messages. The third item in a retry rule can be of this
23557 &`senders=`&<&'address list'&>
23559 The retry timings themselves are then the fourth item. For example:
23561 * rcpt_4xx senders=: F,1h,30m
23563 matches recipient 4&'xx'& errors for bounce messages sent to any address at any
23564 host. If the address list contains white space, it must be enclosed in quotes.
23567 a.domain rcpt_452 senders="xb.dom : yc.dom" G,8h,10m,1.5
23569 &*Warning*&: This facility can be unhelpful if it is used for host errors
23570 (which do not depend on the recipient). The reason is that the sender is used
23571 only to match the retry rule. Once the rule has been found for a host error,
23572 its contents are used to set a retry time for the host, and this will apply to
23573 all messages, not just those with specific senders.
23575 When testing retry rules using &%-brt%&, you can supply a sender using the
23576 &%-f%& command line option, like this:
23578 exim -f "" -brt user@dom.ain
23580 If you do not set &%-f%& with &%-brt%&, a retry rule that contains a senders
23581 list is never matched.
23587 .section "Retry parameters" "SECID163"
23588 .cindex "retry" "parameters in rules"
23589 The third (or fourth, if a senders list is present) field in a retry rule is a
23590 sequence of retry parameter sets, separated by semicolons. Each set consists of
23592 <&'letter'&>,<&'cutoff time'&>,<&'arguments'&>
23594 The letter identifies the algorithm for computing a new retry time; the cutoff
23595 time is the time beyond which this algorithm no longer applies, and the
23596 arguments vary the algorithm's action. The cutoff time is measured from the
23597 time that the first failure for the domain (combined with the local part if
23598 relevant) was detected, not from the time the message was received.
23600 .cindex "retry" "algorithms"
23601 .cindex "retry" "fixed intervals"
23602 .cindex "retry" "increasing intervals"
23603 .cindex "retry" "random intervals"
23604 The available algorithms are:
23607 &'F'&: retry at fixed intervals. There is a single time parameter specifying
23610 &'G'&: retry at geometrically increasing intervals. The first argument
23611 specifies a starting value for the interval, and the second a multiplier, which
23612 is used to increase the size of the interval at each retry.
23614 &'H'&: retry at randomized intervals. The arguments are as for &'G'&. For each
23615 retry, the previous interval is multiplied by the factor in order to get a
23616 maximum for the next interval. The minimum interval is the first argument of
23617 the parameter, and an actual interval is chosen randomly between them. Such a
23618 rule has been found to be helpful in cluster configurations when all the
23619 members of the cluster restart at once, and may therefore synchronize their
23620 queue processing times.
23623 When computing the next retry time, the algorithm definitions are scanned in
23624 order until one whose cutoff time has not yet passed is reached. This is then
23625 used to compute a new retry time that is later than the current time. In the
23626 case of fixed interval retries, this simply means adding the interval to the
23627 current time. For geometrically increasing intervals, retry intervals are
23628 computed from the rule's parameters until one that is greater than the previous
23629 interval is found. The main configuration variable
23630 .cindex "limit" "retry interval"
23631 .cindex "retry" "interval, maximum"
23632 .oindex "&%retry_interval_max%&"
23633 &%retry_interval_max%& limits the maximum interval between retries. It
23634 cannot be set greater than &`24h`&, which is its default value.
23636 A single remote domain may have a number of hosts associated with it, and each
23637 host may have more than one IP address. Retry algorithms are selected on the
23638 basis of the domain name, but are applied to each IP address independently. If,
23639 for example, a host has two IP addresses and one is unusable, Exim will
23640 generate retry times for it and will not try to use it until its next retry
23641 time comes. Thus the good IP address is likely to be tried first most of the
23644 .cindex "hints database" "use for retrying"
23645 Retry times are hints rather than promises. Exim does not make any attempt to
23646 run deliveries exactly at the computed times. Instead, a queue runner process
23647 starts delivery processes for delayed messages periodically, and these attempt
23648 new deliveries only for those addresses that have passed their next retry time.
23649 If a new message arrives for a deferred address, an immediate delivery attempt
23650 occurs only if the address has passed its retry time. In the absence of new
23651 messages, the minimum time between retries is the interval between queue runner
23652 processes. There is not much point in setting retry times of five minutes if
23653 your queue runners happen only once an hour, unless there are a significant
23654 number of incoming messages (which might be the case on a system that is
23655 sending everything to a smart host, for example).
23657 The data in the retry hints database can be inspected by using the
23658 &'exim_dumpdb'& or &'exim_fixdb'& utility programs (see chapter
23659 &<<CHAPutils>>&). The latter utility can also be used to change the data. The
23660 &'exinext'& utility script can be used to find out what the next retry times
23661 are for the hosts associated with a particular mail domain, and also for local
23662 deliveries that have been deferred.
23665 .section "Retry rule examples" "SECID164"
23666 Here are some example retry rules:
23668 alice@wonderland.fict.example quota_5d F,7d,3h
23669 wonderland.fict.example quota_5d
23670 wonderland.fict.example * F,1h,15m; G,2d,1h,2;
23671 lookingglass.fict.example * F,24h,30m;
23672 * refused_A F,2h,20m;
23673 * * F,2h,15m; G,16h,1h,1.5; F,5d,8h
23675 The first rule sets up special handling for mail to
23676 &'alice@wonderland.fict.example'& when there is an over-quota error and the
23677 mailbox has not been read for at least 5 days. Retries continue every three
23678 hours for 7 days. The second rule handles over-quota errors for all other local
23679 parts at &'wonderland.fict.example'&; the absence of a local part has the same
23680 effect as supplying &"*@"&. As no retry algorithms are supplied, messages that
23681 fail are bounced immediately if the mailbox has not been read for at least 5
23684 The third rule handles all other errors at &'wonderland.fict.example'&; retries
23685 happen every 15 minutes for an hour, then with geometrically increasing
23686 intervals until two days have passed since a delivery first failed. After the
23687 first hour there is a delay of one hour, then two hours, then four hours, and
23688 so on (this is a rather extreme example).
23690 The fourth rule controls retries for the domain &'lookingglass.fict.example'&.
23691 They happen every 30 minutes for 24 hours only. The remaining two rules handle
23692 all other domains, with special action for connection refusal from hosts that
23693 were not obtained from an MX record.
23695 The final rule in a retry configuration should always have asterisks in the
23696 first two fields so as to provide a general catch-all for any addresses that do
23697 not have their own special handling. This example tries every 15 minutes for 2
23698 hours, then with intervals starting at one hour and increasing by a factor of
23699 1.5 up to 16 hours, then every 8 hours up to 5 days.
23703 .section "Timeout of retry data" "SECID165"
23704 .cindex "timeout" "of retry data"
23705 .oindex "&%retry_data_expire%&"
23706 .cindex "hints database" "data expiry"
23707 .cindex "retry" "timeout of data"
23708 Exim timestamps the data that it writes to its retry hints database. When it
23709 consults the data during a delivery it ignores any that is older than the value
23710 set in &%retry_data_expire%& (default 7 days). If, for example, a host hasn't
23711 been tried for 7 days, Exim will try to deliver to it immediately a message
23712 arrives, and if that fails, it will calculate a retry time as if it were
23713 failing for the first time.
23715 This improves the behaviour for messages routed to rarely-used hosts such as MX
23716 backups. If such a host was down at one time, and happens to be down again when
23717 Exim tries a month later, using the old retry data would imply that it had been
23718 down all the time, which is not a justified assumption.
23720 If a host really is permanently dead, this behaviour causes a burst of retries
23721 every now and again, but only if messages routed to it are rare. If there is a
23722 message at least once every 7 days the retry data never expires.
23727 .section "Long-term failures" "SECID166"
23728 .cindex "delivery failure, long-term"
23729 .cindex "retry" "after long-term failure"
23730 Special processing happens when an email address has been failing for so long
23731 that the cutoff time for the last algorithm is reached. For example, using the
23732 default retry rule:
23734 * * F,2h,15m; G,16h,1h,1.5; F,4d,6h
23736 the cutoff time is four days. Reaching the retry cutoff is independent of how
23737 long any specific message has been failing; it is the length of continuous
23738 failure for the recipient address that counts.
23740 When the cutoff time is reached for a local delivery, or for all the IP
23741 addresses associated with a remote delivery, a subsequent delivery failure
23742 causes Exim to give up on the address, and a bounce message is generated.
23743 In order to cater for new messages that use the failing address, a next retry
23744 time is still computed from the final algorithm, and is used as follows:
23746 For local deliveries, one delivery attempt is always made for any subsequent
23747 messages. If this delivery fails, the address fails immediately. The
23748 post-cutoff retry time is not used.
23750 If the delivery is remote, there are two possibilities, controlled by the
23751 .oindex "&%delay_after_cutoff%&"
23752 &%delay_after_cutoff%& option of the &(smtp)& transport. The option is true by
23753 default. Until the post-cutoff retry time for one of the IP addresses is
23754 reached, the failing email address is bounced immediately, without a delivery
23755 attempt taking place. After that time, one new delivery attempt is made to
23756 those IP addresses that are past their retry times, and if that still fails,
23757 the address is bounced and new retry times are computed.
23759 In other words, when all the hosts for a given email address have been failing
23760 for a long time, Exim bounces rather then defers until one of the hosts' retry
23761 times is reached. Then it tries once, and bounces if that attempt fails. This
23762 behaviour ensures that few resources are wasted in repeatedly trying to deliver
23763 to a broken destination, but if the host does recover, Exim will eventually
23766 If &%delay_after_cutoff%& is set false, Exim behaves differently. If all IP
23767 addresses are past their final cutoff time, Exim tries to deliver to those IP
23768 addresses that have not been tried since the message arrived. If there are
23769 no suitable IP addresses, or if they all fail, the address is bounced. In other
23770 words, it does not delay when a new message arrives, but tries the expired
23771 addresses immediately, unless they have been tried since the message arrived.
23772 If there is a continuous stream of messages for the failing domains, setting
23773 &%delay_after_cutoff%& false means that there will be many more attempts to
23774 deliver to permanently failing IP addresses than when &%delay_after_cutoff%& is
23777 .section "Deliveries that work intermittently" "SECID167"
23778 .cindex "retry" "intermittently working deliveries"
23779 Some additional logic is needed to cope with cases where a host is
23780 intermittently available, or when a message has some attribute that prevents
23781 its delivery when others to the same address get through. In this situation,
23782 because some messages are successfully delivered, the &"retry clock"& for the
23783 host or address keeps getting reset by the successful deliveries, and so
23784 failing messages remain on the queue for ever because the cutoff time is never
23787 Two exceptional actions are applied to prevent this happening. The first
23788 applies to errors that are related to a message rather than a remote host.
23789 Section &<<SECToutSMTPerr>>& has a discussion of the different kinds of error;
23790 examples of message-related errors are 4&'xx'& responses to MAIL or DATA
23791 commands, and quota failures. For this type of error, if a message's arrival
23792 time is earlier than the &"first failed"& time for the error, the earlier time
23793 is used when scanning the retry rules to decide when to try next and when to
23794 time out the address.
23796 The exceptional second action applies in all cases. If a message has been on
23797 the queue for longer than the cutoff time of any applicable retry rule for a
23798 given address, a delivery is attempted for that address, even if it is not yet
23799 time, and if this delivery fails, the address is timed out. A new retry time is
23800 not computed in this case, so that other messages for the same address are
23801 considered immediately.
23802 .ecindex IIDretconf1
23803 .ecindex IIDregconf2
23810 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23811 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23813 .chapter "SMTP authentication" "CHAPSMTPAUTH"
23814 .scindex IIDauthconf1 "SMTP" "authentication configuration"
23815 .scindex IIDauthconf2 "authentication"
23816 The &"authenticators"& section of Exim's run time configuration is concerned
23817 with SMTP authentication. This facility is an extension to the SMTP protocol,
23818 described in RFC 2554, which allows a client SMTP host to authenticate itself
23819 to a server. This is a common way for a server to recognize clients that are
23820 permitted to use it as a relay. SMTP authentication is not of relevance to the
23821 transfer of mail between servers that have no managerial connection with each
23824 .cindex "AUTH" "description of"
23825 Very briefly, the way SMTP authentication works is as follows:
23828 The server advertises a number of authentication &'mechanisms'& in response to
23829 the client's EHLO command.
23831 The client issues an AUTH command, naming a specific mechanism. The command
23832 may, optionally, contain some authentication data.
23834 The server may issue one or more &'challenges'&, to which the client must send
23835 appropriate responses. In simple authentication mechanisms, the challenges are
23836 just prompts for user names and passwords. The server does not have to issue
23837 any challenges &-- in some mechanisms the relevant data may all be transmitted
23838 with the AUTH command.
23840 The server either accepts or denies authentication.
23842 If authentication succeeds, the client may optionally make use of the AUTH
23843 option on the MAIL command to pass an authenticated sender in subsequent
23844 mail transactions. Authentication lasts for the remainder of the SMTP
23847 If authentication fails, the client may give up, or it may try a different
23848 authentication mechanism, or it may try transferring mail over the
23849 unauthenticated connection.
23852 If you are setting up a client, and want to know which authentication
23853 mechanisms the server supports, you can use Telnet to connect to port 25 (the
23854 SMTP port) on the server, and issue an EHLO command. The response to this
23855 includes the list of supported mechanisms. For example:
23857 &`$ `&&*&`telnet server.example 25`&*&
23858 &`Trying 192.168.34.25...`&
23859 &`Connected to server.example.`&
23860 &`Escape character is '^]'.`&
23861 &`220 server.example ESMTP Exim 4.20 ...`&
23862 &*&`ehlo client.example`&*&
23863 &`250-server.example Hello client.example [10.8.4.5]`&
23864 &`250-SIZE 52428800`&
23869 The second-last line of this example output shows that the server supports
23870 authentication using the PLAIN mechanism. In Exim, the different authentication
23871 mechanisms are configured by specifying &'authenticator'& drivers. Like the
23872 routers and transports, which authenticators are included in the binary is
23873 controlled by build-time definitions. The following are currently available,
23874 included by setting
23877 AUTH_CYRUS_SASL=yes
23880 AUTH_HEIMDAL_GSSAPI=yes
23884 in &_Local/Makefile_&, respectively. The first of these supports the CRAM-MD5
23885 authentication mechanism (RFC 2195), and the second provides an interface to
23886 the Cyrus SASL authentication library.
23887 The third is an interface to Dovecot's authentication system, delegating the
23888 work via a socket interface.
23889 The fourth provides an interface to the GNU SASL authentication library, which
23890 provides mechanisms but typically not data sources.
23891 The fifth provides direct access to Heimdal GSSAPI, geared for Kerberos, but
23892 supporting setting a server keytab.
23893 The sixth can be configured to support
23894 the PLAIN authentication mechanism (RFC 2595) or the LOGIN mechanism, which is
23895 not formally documented, but used by several MUAs. The seventh authenticator
23896 supports Microsoft's &'Secure Password Authentication'& mechanism.
23898 The authenticators are configured using the same syntax as other drivers (see
23899 section &<<SECTfordricon>>&). If no authenticators are required, no
23900 authentication section need be present in the configuration file. Each
23901 authenticator can in principle have both server and client functions. When Exim
23902 is receiving SMTP mail, it is acting as a server; when it is sending out
23903 messages over SMTP, it is acting as a client. Authenticator configuration
23904 options are provided for use in both these circumstances.
23906 To make it clear which options apply to which situation, the prefixes
23907 &%server_%& and &%client_%& are used on option names that are specific to
23908 either the server or the client function, respectively. Server and client
23909 functions are disabled if none of their options are set. If an authenticator is
23910 to be used for both server and client functions, a single definition, using
23911 both sets of options, is required. For example:
23915 public_name = CRAM-MD5
23916 server_secret = ${if eq{$auth1}{ph10}{secret1}fail}
23918 client_secret = secret2
23920 The &%server_%& option is used when Exim is acting as a server, and the
23921 &%client_%& options when it is acting as a client.
23923 Descriptions of the individual authenticators are given in subsequent chapters.
23924 The remainder of this chapter covers the generic options for the
23925 authenticators, followed by general discussion of the way authentication works
23928 &*Beware:*& the meaning of &$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, ... varies on a per-driver and
23929 per-mechanism basis. Please read carefully to determine which variables hold
23930 account labels such as usercodes and which hold passwords or other
23931 authenticating data.
23933 Note that some mechanisms support two different identifiers for accounts: the
23934 &'authentication id'& and the &'authorization id'&. The contractions &'authn'&
23935 and &'authz'& are commonly encountered. The American spelling is standard here.
23936 Conceptually, authentication data such as passwords are tied to the identifier
23937 used to authenticate; servers may have rules to permit one user to act as a
23938 second user, so that after login the session is treated as though that second
23939 user had logged in. That second user is the &'authorization id'&. A robust
23940 configuration might confirm that the &'authz'& field is empty or matches the
23941 &'authn'& field. Often this is just ignored. The &'authn'& can be considered
23942 as verified data, the &'authz'& as an unverified request which the server might
23945 A &'realm'& is a text string, typically a domain name, presented by a server
23946 to a client to help it select an account and credentials to use. In some
23947 mechanisms, the client and server provably agree on the realm, but clients
23948 typically can not treat the realm as secure data to be blindly trusted.
23952 .section "Generic options for authenticators" "SECID168"
23953 .cindex "authentication" "generic options"
23954 .cindex "options" "generic; for authenticators"
23956 .option client_condition authenticators string&!! unset
23957 When Exim is authenticating as a client, it skips any authenticator whose
23958 &%client_condition%& expansion yields &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&. This can be
23959 used, for example, to skip plain text authenticators when the connection is not
23960 encrypted by a setting such as:
23962 client_condition = ${if !eq{$tls_out_cipher}{}}
23966 .option driver authenticators string unset
23967 This option must always be set. It specifies which of the available
23968 authenticators is to be used.
23971 .option public_name authenticators string unset
23972 This option specifies the name of the authentication mechanism that the driver
23973 implements, and by which it is known to the outside world. These names should
23974 contain only upper case letters, digits, underscores, and hyphens (RFC 2222),
23975 but Exim in fact matches them caselessly. If &%public_name%& is not set, it
23976 defaults to the driver's instance name.
23979 .option server_advertise_condition authenticators string&!! unset
23980 When a server is about to advertise an authentication mechanism, the condition
23981 is expanded. If it yields the empty string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, the
23982 mechanism is not advertised.
23983 If the expansion fails, the mechanism is not advertised. If the failure was not
23984 forced, and was not caused by a lookup defer, the incident is logged.
23985 See section &<<SECTauthexiser>>& below for further discussion.
23988 .option server_condition authenticators string&!! unset
23989 This option must be set for a &%plaintext%& server authenticator, where it
23990 is used directly to control authentication. See section &<<SECTplainserver>>&
23993 For the &(gsasl)& authenticator, this option is required for various
23994 mechanisms; see chapter &<<CHAPgsasl>>& for details.
23996 For the other authenticators, &%server_condition%& can be used as an additional
23997 authentication or authorization mechanism that is applied after the other
23998 authenticator conditions succeed. If it is set, it is expanded when the
23999 authenticator would otherwise return a success code. If the expansion is forced
24000 to fail, authentication fails. Any other expansion failure causes a temporary
24001 error code to be returned. If the result of a successful expansion is an empty
24002 string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, authentication fails. If the result of the
24003 expansion is &"1"&, &"yes"&, or &"true"&, authentication succeeds. For any
24004 other result, a temporary error code is returned, with the expanded string as
24008 .option server_debug_print authenticators string&!! unset
24009 If this option is set and authentication debugging is enabled (see the &%-d%&
24010 command line option), the string is expanded and included in the debugging
24011 output when the authenticator is run as a server. This can help with checking
24012 out the values of variables.
24013 If expansion of the string fails, the error message is written to the debugging
24014 output, and Exim carries on processing.
24017 .option server_set_id authenticators string&!! unset
24018 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
24019 When an Exim server successfully authenticates a client, this string is
24020 expanded using data from the authentication, and preserved for any incoming
24021 messages in the variable &$authenticated_id$&. It is also included in the log
24022 lines for incoming messages. For example, a user/password authenticator
24023 configuration might preserve the user name that was used to authenticate, and
24024 refer to it subsequently during delivery of the message.
24025 If expansion fails, the option is ignored.
24028 .option server_mail_auth_condition authenticators string&!! unset
24029 This option allows a server to discard authenticated sender addresses supplied
24030 as part of MAIL commands in SMTP connections that are authenticated by the
24031 driver on which &%server_mail_auth_condition%& is set. The option is not used
24032 as part of the authentication process; instead its (unexpanded) value is
24033 remembered for later use.
24034 How it is used is described in the following section.
24040 .section "The AUTH parameter on MAIL commands" "SECTauthparamail"
24041 .cindex "authentication" "sender; authenticated"
24042 .cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
24043 When a client supplied an AUTH= item on a MAIL command, Exim applies
24044 the following checks before accepting it as the authenticated sender of the
24048 If the connection is not using extended SMTP (that is, HELO was used rather
24049 than EHLO), the use of AUTH= is a syntax error.
24051 If the value of the AUTH= parameter is &"<>"&, it is ignored.
24053 .vindex "&$authenticated_sender$&"
24054 If &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& is defined, the ACL it specifies is run. While it is
24055 running, the value of &$authenticated_sender$& is set to the value obtained
24056 from the AUTH= parameter. If the ACL does not yield &"accept"&, the value of
24057 &$authenticated_sender$& is deleted. The &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& ACL may not
24058 return &"drop"& or &"discard"&. If it defers, a temporary error code (451) is
24059 given for the MAIL command.
24061 If &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& is not defined, the value of the AUTH= parameter
24062 is accepted and placed in &$authenticated_sender$& only if the client has
24065 If the AUTH= value was accepted by either of the two previous rules, and
24066 the client has authenticated, and the authenticator has a setting for the
24067 &%server_mail_auth_condition%&, the condition is checked at this point. The
24068 valued that was saved from the authenticator is expanded. If the expansion
24069 fails, or yields an empty string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, the value of
24070 &$authenticated_sender$& is deleted. If the expansion yields any other value,
24071 the value of &$authenticated_sender$& is retained and passed on with the
24076 When &$authenticated_sender$& is set for a message, it is passed on to other
24077 hosts to which Exim authenticates as a client. Do not confuse this value with
24078 &$authenticated_id$&, which is a string obtained from the authentication
24079 process, and which is not usually a complete email address.
24081 .vindex "&$sender_address$&"
24082 Whenever an AUTH= value is ignored, the incident is logged. The ACL for
24083 MAIL, if defined, is run after AUTH= is accepted or ignored. It can
24084 therefore make use of &$authenticated_sender$&. The converse is not true: the
24085 value of &$sender_address$& is not yet set up when the &%acl_smtp_mailauth%&
24090 .section "Authentication on an Exim server" "SECTauthexiser"
24091 .cindex "authentication" "on an Exim server"
24092 When Exim receives an EHLO command, it advertises the public names of those
24093 authenticators that are configured as servers, subject to the following
24097 The client host must match &%auth_advertise_hosts%& (default *).
24099 It the &%server_advertise_condition%& option is set, its expansion must not
24100 yield the empty string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&.
24103 The order in which the authenticators are defined controls the order in which
24104 the mechanisms are advertised.
24106 Some mail clients (for example, some versions of Netscape) require the user to
24107 provide a name and password for authentication whenever AUTH is advertised,
24108 even though authentication may not in fact be needed (for example, Exim may be
24109 set up to allow unconditional relaying from the client by an IP address check).
24110 You can make such clients more friendly by not advertising AUTH to them.
24111 For example, if clients on the 10.9.8.0/24 network are permitted (by the ACL
24112 that runs for RCPT) to relay without authentication, you should set
24114 auth_advertise_hosts = ! 10.9.8.0/24
24116 so that no authentication mechanisms are advertised to them.
24118 The &%server_advertise_condition%& controls the advertisement of individual
24119 authentication mechanisms. For example, it can be used to restrict the
24120 advertisement of a particular mechanism to encrypted connections, by a setting
24123 server_advertise_condition = ${if eq{$tls_in_cipher}{}{no}{yes}}
24125 .vindex "&$tls_in_cipher$&"
24126 If the session is encrypted, &$tls_in_cipher$& is not empty, and so the expansion
24127 yields &"yes"&, which allows the advertisement to happen.
24129 When an Exim server receives an AUTH command from a client, it rejects it
24130 immediately if AUTH was not advertised in response to an earlier EHLO
24131 command. This is the case if
24134 The client host does not match &%auth_advertise_hosts%&; or
24136 No authenticators are configured with server options; or
24138 Expansion of &%server_advertise_condition%& blocked the advertising of all the
24139 server authenticators.
24143 Otherwise, Exim runs the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_auth%& in order
24144 to decide whether to accept the command. If &%acl_smtp_auth%& is not set,
24145 AUTH is accepted from any client host.
24147 If AUTH is not rejected by the ACL, Exim searches its configuration for a
24148 server authentication mechanism that was advertised in response to EHLO and
24149 that matches the one named in the AUTH command. If it finds one, it runs
24150 the appropriate authentication protocol, and authentication either succeeds or
24151 fails. If there is no matching advertised mechanism, the AUTH command is
24152 rejected with a 504 error.
24154 .vindex "&$received_protocol$&"
24155 .vindex "&$sender_host_authenticated$&"
24156 When a message is received from an authenticated host, the value of
24157 &$received_protocol$& is set to &"esmtpa"& or &"esmtpsa"& instead of &"esmtp"&
24158 or &"esmtps"&, and &$sender_host_authenticated$& contains the name (not the
24159 public name) of the authenticator driver that successfully authenticated the
24160 client from which the message was received. This variable is empty if there was
24161 no successful authentication.
24166 .section "Testing server authentication" "SECID169"
24167 .cindex "authentication" "testing a server"
24168 .cindex "AUTH" "testing a server"
24169 .cindex "base64 encoding" "creating authentication test data"
24170 Exim's &%-bh%& option can be useful for testing server authentication
24171 configurations. The data for the AUTH command has to be sent using base64
24172 encoding. A quick way to produce such data for testing is the following Perl
24176 printf ("%s", encode_base64(eval "\"$ARGV[0]\""));
24178 .cindex "binary zero" "in authentication data"
24179 This interprets its argument as a Perl string, and then encodes it. The
24180 interpretation as a Perl string allows binary zeros, which are required for
24181 some kinds of authentication, to be included in the data. For example, a
24182 command line to run this script on such data might be
24184 encode '\0user\0password'
24186 Note the use of single quotes to prevent the shell interpreting the
24187 backslashes, so that they can be interpreted by Perl to specify characters
24188 whose code value is zero.
24190 &*Warning 1*&: If either of the user or password strings starts with an octal
24191 digit, you must use three zeros instead of one after the leading backslash. If
24192 you do not, the octal digit that starts your string will be incorrectly
24193 interpreted as part of the code for the first character.
24195 &*Warning 2*&: If there are characters in the strings that Perl interprets
24196 specially, you must use a Perl escape to prevent them being misinterpreted. For
24197 example, a command such as
24199 encode '\0user@domain.com\0pas$$word'
24201 gives an incorrect answer because of the unescaped &"@"& and &"$"& characters.
24203 If you have the &%mimencode%& command installed, another way to do produce
24204 base64-encoded strings is to run the command
24206 echo -e -n `\0user\0password' | mimencode
24208 The &%-e%& option of &%echo%& enables the interpretation of backslash escapes
24209 in the argument, and the &%-n%& option specifies no newline at the end of its
24210 output. However, not all versions of &%echo%& recognize these options, so you
24211 should check your version before relying on this suggestion.
24215 .section "Authentication by an Exim client" "SECID170"
24216 .cindex "authentication" "on an Exim client"
24217 The &(smtp)& transport has two options called &%hosts_require_auth%& and
24218 &%hosts_try_auth%&. When the &(smtp)& transport connects to a server that
24219 announces support for authentication, and the host matches an entry in either
24220 of these options, Exim (as a client) tries to authenticate as follows:
24223 For each authenticator that is configured as a client, in the order in which
24224 they are defined in the configuration, it searches the authentication
24225 mechanisms announced by the server for one whose name matches the public name
24226 of the authenticator.
24229 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
24230 When it finds one that matches, it runs the authenticator's client code. The
24231 variables &$host$& and &$host_address$& are available for any string expansions
24232 that the client might do. They are set to the server's name and IP address. If
24233 any expansion is forced to fail, the authentication attempt is abandoned, and
24234 Exim moves on to the next authenticator. Otherwise an expansion failure causes
24235 delivery to be deferred.
24237 If the result of the authentication attempt is a temporary error or a timeout,
24238 Exim abandons trying to send the message to the host for the moment. It will
24239 try again later. If there are any backup hosts available, they are tried in the
24242 If the response to authentication is a permanent error (5&'xx'& code), Exim
24243 carries on searching the list of authenticators and tries another one if
24244 possible. If all authentication attempts give permanent errors, or if there are
24245 no attempts because no mechanisms match (or option expansions force failure),
24246 what happens depends on whether the host matches &%hosts_require_auth%& or
24247 &%hosts_try_auth%&. In the first case, a temporary error is generated, and
24248 delivery is deferred. The error can be detected in the retry rules, and thereby
24249 turned into a permanent error if you wish. In the second case, Exim tries to
24250 deliver the message unauthenticated.
24253 .cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
24254 When Exim has authenticated itself to a remote server, it adds the AUTH
24255 parameter to the MAIL commands it sends, if it has an authenticated sender for
24256 the message. If the message came from a remote host, the authenticated sender
24257 is the one that was receiving on an incoming MAIL command, provided that the
24258 incoming connection was authenticated and the &%server_mail_auth%& condition
24259 allowed the authenticated sender to be retained. If a local process calls Exim
24260 to send a message, the sender address that is built from the login name and
24261 &%qualify_domain%& is treated as authenticated. However, if the
24262 &%authenticated_sender%& option is set on the &(smtp)& transport, it overrides
24263 the authenticated sender that was received with the message.
24264 .ecindex IIDauthconf1
24265 .ecindex IIDauthconf2
24272 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24273 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24275 .chapter "The plaintext authenticator" "CHAPplaintext"
24276 .scindex IIDplaiauth1 "&(plaintext)& authenticator"
24277 .scindex IIDplaiauth2 "authenticators" "&(plaintext)&"
24278 The &(plaintext)& authenticator can be configured to support the PLAIN and
24279 LOGIN authentication mechanisms, both of which transfer authentication data as
24280 plain (unencrypted) text (though base64 encoded). The use of plain text is a
24281 security risk; you are strongly advised to insist on the use of SMTP encryption
24282 (see chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&) if you use the PLAIN or LOGIN mechanisms. If you do
24283 use unencrypted plain text, you should not use the same passwords for SMTP
24284 connections as you do for login accounts.
24286 .section "Plaintext options" "SECID171"
24287 .cindex "options" "&(plaintext)& authenticator (server)"
24288 When configured as a server, &(plaintext)& uses the following options:
24290 .option server_condition authenticators string&!! unset
24291 This is actually a global authentication option, but it must be set in order to
24292 configure the &(plaintext)& driver as a server. Its use is described below.
24294 .option server_prompts plaintext string&!! unset
24295 The contents of this option, after expansion, must be a colon-separated list of
24296 prompt strings. If expansion fails, a temporary authentication rejection is
24299 .section "Using plaintext in a server" "SECTplainserver"
24300 .cindex "AUTH" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
24301 .cindex "binary zero" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
24302 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" &&&
24303 "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
24304 .vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
24305 .cindex "base64 encoding" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
24307 When running as a server, &(plaintext)& performs the authentication test by
24308 expanding a string. The data sent by the client with the AUTH command, or in
24309 response to subsequent prompts, is base64 encoded, and so may contain any byte
24310 values when decoded. If any data is supplied with the command, it is treated as
24311 a list of strings, separated by NULs (binary zeros), the first three of which
24312 are placed in the expansion variables &$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, and &$auth3$&
24313 (neither LOGIN nor PLAIN uses more than three strings).
24315 For compatibility with previous releases of Exim, the values are also placed in
24316 the expansion variables &$1$&, &$2$&, and &$3$&. However, the use of these
24317 variables for this purpose is now deprecated, as it can lead to confusion in
24318 string expansions that also use them for other things.
24320 If there are more strings in &%server_prompts%& than the number of strings
24321 supplied with the AUTH command, the remaining prompts are used to obtain more
24322 data. Each response from the client may be a list of NUL-separated strings.
24324 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
24325 Once a sufficient number of data strings have been received,
24326 &%server_condition%& is expanded. If the expansion is forced to fail,
24327 authentication fails. Any other expansion failure causes a temporary error code
24328 to be returned. If the result of a successful expansion is an empty string,
24329 &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, authentication fails. If the result of the
24330 expansion is &"1"&, &"yes"&, or &"true"&, authentication succeeds and the
24331 generic &%server_set_id%& option is expanded and saved in &$authenticated_id$&.
24332 For any other result, a temporary error code is returned, with the expanded
24333 string as the error text.
24335 &*Warning*&: If you use a lookup in the expansion to find the user's
24336 password, be sure to make the authentication fail if the user is unknown.
24337 There are good and bad examples at the end of the next section.
24341 .section "The PLAIN authentication mechanism" "SECID172"
24342 .cindex "PLAIN authentication mechanism"
24343 .cindex "authentication" "PLAIN mechanism"
24344 .cindex "binary zero" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
24345 The PLAIN authentication mechanism (RFC 2595) specifies that three strings be
24346 sent as one item of data (that is, one combined string containing two NUL
24347 separators). The data is sent either as part of the AUTH command, or
24348 subsequently in response to an empty prompt from the server.
24350 The second and third strings are a user name and a corresponding password.
24351 Using a single fixed user name and password as an example, this could be
24352 configured as follows:
24356 public_name = PLAIN
24358 server_condition = \
24359 ${if and {{eq{$auth2}{username}}{eq{$auth3}{mysecret}}}}
24360 server_set_id = $auth2
24362 Note that the default result strings from &%if%& (&"true"& or an empty string)
24363 are exactly what we want here, so they need not be specified. Obviously, if the
24364 password contains expansion-significant characters such as dollar, backslash,
24365 or closing brace, they have to be escaped.
24367 The &%server_prompts%& setting specifies a single, empty prompt (empty items at
24368 the end of a string list are ignored). If all the data comes as part of the
24369 AUTH command, as is commonly the case, the prompt is not used. This
24370 authenticator is advertised in the response to EHLO as
24374 and a client host can authenticate itself by sending the command
24376 AUTH PLAIN AHVzZXJuYW1lAG15c2VjcmV0
24378 As this contains three strings (more than the number of prompts), no further
24379 data is required from the client. Alternatively, the client may just send
24383 to initiate authentication, in which case the server replies with an empty
24384 prompt. The client must respond with the combined data string.
24386 The data string is base64 encoded, as required by the RFC. This example,
24387 when decoded, is <&'NUL'&>&`username`&<&'NUL'&>&`mysecret`&, where <&'NUL'&>
24388 represents a zero byte. This is split up into three strings, the first of which
24389 is empty. The &%server_condition%& option in the authenticator checks that the
24390 second two are &`username`& and &`mysecret`& respectively.
24392 Having just one fixed user name and password, as in this example, is not very
24393 realistic, though for a small organization with only a handful of
24394 authenticating clients it could make sense.
24396 A more sophisticated instance of this authenticator could use the user name in
24397 &$auth2$& to look up a password in a file or database, and maybe do an encrypted
24398 comparison (see &%crypteq%& in chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&). Here is a example of
24399 this approach, where the passwords are looked up in a DBM file. &*Warning*&:
24400 This is an incorrect example:
24402 server_condition = \
24403 ${if eq{$auth3}{${lookup{$auth2}dbm{/etc/authpwd}}}}
24405 The expansion uses the user name (&$auth2$&) as the key to look up a password,
24406 which it then compares to the supplied password (&$auth3$&). Why is this example
24407 incorrect? It works fine for existing users, but consider what happens if a
24408 non-existent user name is given. The lookup fails, but as no success/failure
24409 strings are given for the lookup, it yields an empty string. Thus, to defeat
24410 the authentication, all a client has to do is to supply a non-existent user
24411 name and an empty password. The correct way of writing this test is:
24413 server_condition = ${lookup{$auth2}dbm{/etc/authpwd}\
24414 {${if eq{$value}{$auth3}}} {false}}
24416 In this case, if the lookup succeeds, the result is checked; if the lookup
24417 fails, &"false"& is returned and authentication fails. If &%crypteq%& is being
24418 used instead of &%eq%&, the first example is in fact safe, because &%crypteq%&
24419 always fails if its second argument is empty. However, the second way of
24420 writing the test makes the logic clearer.
24423 .section "The LOGIN authentication mechanism" "SECID173"
24424 .cindex "LOGIN authentication mechanism"
24425 .cindex "authentication" "LOGIN mechanism"
24426 The LOGIN authentication mechanism is not documented in any RFC, but is in use
24427 in a number of programs. No data is sent with the AUTH command. Instead, a
24428 user name and password are supplied separately, in response to prompts. The
24429 plaintext authenticator can be configured to support this as in this example:
24433 public_name = LOGIN
24434 server_prompts = User Name : Password
24435 server_condition = \
24436 ${if and {{eq{$auth1}{username}}{eq{$auth2}{mysecret}}}}
24437 server_set_id = $auth1
24439 Because of the way plaintext operates, this authenticator accepts data supplied
24440 with the AUTH command (in contravention of the specification of LOGIN), but
24441 if the client does not supply it (as is the case for LOGIN clients), the prompt
24442 strings are used to obtain two data items.
24444 Some clients are very particular about the precise text of the prompts. For
24445 example, Outlook Express is reported to recognize only &"Username:"& and
24446 &"Password:"&. Here is an example of a LOGIN authenticator that uses those
24447 strings. It uses the &%ldapauth%& expansion condition to check the user
24448 name and password by binding to an LDAP server:
24452 public_name = LOGIN
24453 server_prompts = Username:: : Password::
24454 server_condition = ${if and{{ \
24457 user="uid=${quote_ldap_dn:$auth1},ou=people,o=example.org" \
24458 pass=${quote:$auth2} \
24459 ldap://ldap.example.org/} }} }
24460 server_set_id = uid=$auth1,ou=people,o=example.org
24462 We have to check that the username is not empty before using it, because LDAP
24463 does not permit empty DN components. We must also use the &%quote_ldap_dn%&
24464 operator to correctly quote the DN for authentication. However, the basic
24465 &%quote%& operator, rather than any of the LDAP quoting operators, is the
24466 correct one to use for the password, because quoting is needed only to make
24467 the password conform to the Exim syntax. At the LDAP level, the password is an
24468 uninterpreted string.
24471 .section "Support for different kinds of authentication" "SECID174"
24472 A number of string expansion features are provided for the purpose of
24473 interfacing to different ways of user authentication. These include checking
24474 traditionally encrypted passwords from &_/etc/passwd_& (or equivalent), PAM,
24475 Radius, &%ldapauth%&, &'pwcheck'&, and &'saslauthd'&. For details see section
24481 .section "Using plaintext in a client" "SECID175"
24482 .cindex "options" "&(plaintext)& authenticator (client)"
24483 The &(plaintext)& authenticator has two client options:
24485 .option client_ignore_invalid_base64 plaintext boolean false
24486 If the client receives a server prompt that is not a valid base64 string,
24487 authentication is abandoned by default. However, if this option is set true,
24488 the error in the challenge is ignored and the client sends the response as
24491 .option client_send plaintext string&!! unset
24492 The string is a colon-separated list of authentication data strings. Each
24493 string is independently expanded before being sent to the server. The first
24494 string is sent with the AUTH command; any more strings are sent in response
24495 to prompts from the server. Before each string is expanded, the value of the
24496 most recent prompt is placed in the next &$auth$&<&'n'&> variable, starting
24497 with &$auth1$& for the first prompt. Up to three prompts are stored in this
24498 way. Thus, the prompt that is received in response to sending the first string
24499 (with the AUTH command) can be used in the expansion of the second string, and
24500 so on. If an invalid base64 string is received when
24501 &%client_ignore_invalid_base64%& is set, an empty string is put in the
24502 &$auth$&<&'n'&> variable.
24504 &*Note*&: You cannot use expansion to create multiple strings, because
24505 splitting takes priority and happens first.
24507 Because the PLAIN authentication mechanism requires NUL (binary zero) bytes in
24508 the data, further processing is applied to each string before it is sent. If
24509 there are any single circumflex characters in the string, they are converted to
24510 NULs. Should an actual circumflex be required as data, it must be doubled in
24513 This is an example of a client configuration that implements the PLAIN
24514 authentication mechanism with a fixed user name and password:
24518 public_name = PLAIN
24519 client_send = ^username^mysecret
24521 The lack of colons means that the entire text is sent with the AUTH
24522 command, with the circumflex characters converted to NULs. A similar example
24523 that uses the LOGIN mechanism is:
24527 public_name = LOGIN
24528 client_send = : username : mysecret
24530 The initial colon means that the first string is empty, so no data is sent with
24531 the AUTH command itself. The remaining strings are sent in response to
24533 .ecindex IIDplaiauth1
24534 .ecindex IIDplaiauth2
24539 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24540 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24542 .chapter "The cram_md5 authenticator" "CHID9"
24543 .scindex IIDcramauth1 "&(cram_md5)& authenticator"
24544 .scindex IIDcramauth2 "authenticators" "&(cram_md5)&"
24545 .cindex "CRAM-MD5 authentication mechanism"
24546 .cindex "authentication" "CRAM-MD5 mechanism"
24547 The CRAM-MD5 authentication mechanism is described in RFC 2195. The server
24548 sends a challenge string to the client, and the response consists of a user
24549 name and the CRAM-MD5 digest of the challenge string combined with a secret
24550 string (password) which is known to both server and client. Thus, the secret
24551 is not sent over the network as plain text, which makes this authenticator more
24552 secure than &(plaintext)&. However, the downside is that the secret has to be
24553 available in plain text at either end.
24556 .section "Using cram_md5 as a server" "SECID176"
24557 .cindex "options" "&(cram_md5)& authenticator (server)"
24558 This authenticator has one server option, which must be set to configure the
24559 authenticator as a server:
24561 .option server_secret cram_md5 string&!! unset
24562 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &(cram_md5)& authenticator"
24563 When the server receives the client's response, the user name is placed in
24564 the expansion variable &$auth1$&, and &%server_secret%& is expanded to
24565 obtain the password for that user. The server then computes the CRAM-MD5 digest
24566 that the client should have sent, and checks that it received the correct
24567 string. If the expansion of &%server_secret%& is forced to fail, authentication
24568 fails. If the expansion fails for some other reason, a temporary error code is
24569 returned to the client.
24571 For compatibility with previous releases of Exim, the user name is also placed
24572 in &$1$&. However, the use of this variables for this purpose is now
24573 deprecated, as it can lead to confusion in string expansions that also use
24574 numeric variables for other things.
24576 For example, the following authenticator checks that the user name given by the
24577 client is &"ph10"&, and if so, uses &"secret"& as the password. For any other
24578 user name, authentication fails.
24582 public_name = CRAM-MD5
24583 server_secret = ${if eq{$auth1}{ph10}{secret}fail}
24584 server_set_id = $auth1
24586 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
24587 If authentication succeeds, the setting of &%server_set_id%& preserves the user
24588 name in &$authenticated_id$&. A more typical configuration might look up the
24589 secret string in a file, using the user name as the key. For example:
24593 public_name = CRAM-MD5
24594 server_secret = ${lookup{$auth1}lsearch{/etc/authpwd}\
24596 server_set_id = $auth1
24598 Note that this expansion explicitly forces failure if the lookup fails
24599 because &$auth1$& contains an unknown user name.
24601 As another example, if you wish to re-use a Cyrus SASL sasldb2 file without
24602 using the relevant libraries, you need to know the realm to specify in the
24603 lookup and then ask for the &"userPassword"& attribute for that user in that
24608 public_name = CRAM-MD5
24609 server_secret = ${lookup{$auth1:mail.example.org:userPassword}\
24610 dbmjz{/etc/sasldb2}}
24611 server_set_id = $auth1
24614 .section "Using cram_md5 as a client" "SECID177"
24615 .cindex "options" "&(cram_md5)& authenticator (client)"
24616 When used as a client, the &(cram_md5)& authenticator has two options:
24620 .option client_name cram_md5 string&!! "the primary host name"
24621 This string is expanded, and the result used as the user name data when
24622 computing the response to the server's challenge.
24625 .option client_secret cram_md5 string&!! unset
24626 This option must be set for the authenticator to work as a client. Its value is
24627 expanded and the result used as the secret string when computing the response.
24631 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
24632 Different user names and secrets can be used for different servers by referring
24633 to &$host$& or &$host_address$& in the options. Forced failure of either
24634 expansion string is treated as an indication that this authenticator is not
24635 prepared to handle this case. Exim moves on to the next configured client
24636 authenticator. Any other expansion failure causes Exim to give up trying to
24637 send the message to the current server.
24639 A simple example configuration of a &(cram_md5)& authenticator, using fixed
24644 public_name = CRAM-MD5
24646 client_secret = secret
24648 .ecindex IIDcramauth1
24649 .ecindex IIDcramauth2
24653 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24654 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24656 .chapter "The cyrus_sasl authenticator" "CHID10"
24657 .scindex IIDcyrauth1 "&(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator"
24658 .scindex IIDcyrauth2 "authenticators" "&(cyrus_sasl)&"
24659 .cindex "Cyrus" "SASL library"
24661 The code for this authenticator was provided by Matthew Byng-Maddick of A L
24662 Digital Ltd (&url(http://www.aldigital.co.uk)).
24664 The &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator provides server support for the Cyrus SASL
24665 library implementation of the RFC 2222 (&"Simple Authentication and Security
24666 Layer"&). This library supports a number of authentication mechanisms,
24667 including PLAIN and LOGIN, but also several others that Exim does not support
24668 directly. In particular, there is support for Kerberos authentication.
24670 The &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator provides a gatewaying mechanism directly to
24671 the Cyrus interface, so if your Cyrus library can do, for example, CRAM-MD5,
24672 then so can the &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator. By default it uses the public
24673 name of the driver to determine which mechanism to support.
24675 Where access to some kind of secret file is required, for example in GSSAPI
24676 or CRAM-MD5, it is worth noting that the authenticator runs as the Exim
24677 user, and that the Cyrus SASL library has no way of escalating privileges
24678 by default. You may also find you need to set environment variables,
24679 depending on the driver you are using.
24681 The application name provided by Exim is &"exim"&, so various SASL options may
24682 be set in &_exim.conf_& in your SASL directory. If you are using GSSAPI for
24683 Kerberos, note that because of limitations in the GSSAPI interface,
24684 changing the server keytab might need to be communicated down to the Kerberos
24685 layer independently. The mechanism for doing so is dependent upon the Kerberos
24688 For example, for older releases of Heimdal, the environment variable KRB5_KTNAME
24689 may be set to point to an alternative keytab file. Exim will pass this
24690 variable through from its own inherited environment when started as root or the
24691 Exim user. The keytab file needs to be readable by the Exim user.
24692 With newer releases of Heimdal, a setuid Exim may cause Heimdal to discard the
24693 environment variable. In practice, for those releases, the Cyrus authenticator
24694 is not a suitable interface for GSSAPI (Kerberos) support. Instead, consider
24695 the &(heimdal_gssapi)& authenticator, described in chapter &<<CHAPheimdalgss>>&
24698 .section "Using cyrus_sasl as a server" "SECID178"
24699 The &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator has four private options. It puts the username
24700 (on a successful authentication) into &$auth1$&. For compatibility with
24701 previous releases of Exim, the username is also placed in &$1$&. However, the
24702 use of this variable for this purpose is now deprecated, as it can lead to
24703 confusion in string expansions that also use numeric variables for other
24707 .option server_hostname cyrus_sasl string&!! "see below"
24708 This option selects the hostname that is used when communicating with the
24709 library. The default value is &`$primary_hostname`&. It is up to the underlying
24710 SASL plug-in what it does with this data.
24713 .option server_mech cyrus_sasl string "see below"
24714 This option selects the authentication mechanism this driver should use. The
24715 default is the value of the generic &%public_name%& option. This option allows
24716 you to use a different underlying mechanism from the advertised name. For
24720 driver = cyrus_sasl
24721 public_name = X-ANYTHING
24722 server_mech = CRAM-MD5
24723 server_set_id = $auth1
24726 .option server_realm cyrus_sasl string&!! unset
24727 This specifies the SASL realm that the server claims to be in.
24730 .option server_service cyrus_sasl string &`smtp`&
24731 This is the SASL service that the server claims to implement.
24734 For straightforward cases, you do not need to set any of the authenticator's
24735 private options. All you need to do is to specify an appropriate mechanism as
24736 the public name. Thus, if you have a SASL library that supports CRAM-MD5 and
24737 PLAIN, you could have two authenticators as follows:
24740 driver = cyrus_sasl
24741 public_name = CRAM-MD5
24742 server_set_id = $auth1
24745 driver = cyrus_sasl
24746 public_name = PLAIN
24747 server_set_id = $auth2
24749 Cyrus SASL does implement the LOGIN authentication method, even though it is
24750 not a standard method. It is disabled by default in the source distribution,
24751 but it is present in many binary distributions.
24752 .ecindex IIDcyrauth1
24753 .ecindex IIDcyrauth2
24758 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24759 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24760 .chapter "The dovecot authenticator" "CHAPdovecot"
24761 .scindex IIDdcotauth1 "&(dovecot)& authenticator"
24762 .scindex IIDdcotauth2 "authenticators" "&(dovecot)&"
24763 This authenticator is an interface to the authentication facility of the
24764 Dovecot POP/IMAP server, which can support a number of authentication methods.
24765 If you are using Dovecot to authenticate POP/IMAP clients, it might be helpful
24766 to use the same mechanisms for SMTP authentication. This is a server
24767 authenticator only. There is only one option:
24769 .option server_socket dovecot string unset
24771 This option must specify the socket that is the interface to Dovecot
24772 authentication. The &%public_name%& option must specify an authentication
24773 mechanism that Dovecot is configured to support. You can have several
24774 authenticators for different mechanisms. For example:
24778 public_name = PLAIN
24779 server_socket = /var/run/dovecot/auth-client
24780 server_set_id = $auth2
24785 server_socket = /var/run/dovecot/auth-client
24786 server_set_id = $auth1
24788 If the SMTP connection is encrypted, or if &$sender_host_address$& is equal to
24789 &$received_ip_address$& (that is, the connection is local), the &"secured"&
24790 option is passed in the Dovecot authentication command. If, for a TLS
24791 connection, a client certificate has been verified, the &"valid-client-cert"&
24792 option is passed. When authentication succeeds, the identity of the user
24793 who authenticated is placed in &$auth1$&.
24794 .ecindex IIDdcotauth1
24795 .ecindex IIDdcotauth2
24798 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24799 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24800 .chapter "The gsasl authenticator" "CHAPgsasl"
24801 .scindex IIDgsaslauth1 "&(gsasl)& authenticator"
24802 .scindex IIDgsaslauth2 "authenticators" "&(gsasl)&"
24803 .cindex "authentication" "GNU SASL"
24804 .cindex "authentication" "SASL"
24805 .cindex "authentication" "EXTERNAL"
24806 .cindex "authentication" "ANONYMOUS"
24807 .cindex "authentication" "PLAIN"
24808 .cindex "authentication" "LOGIN"
24809 .cindex "authentication" "DIGEST-MD5"
24810 .cindex "authentication" "CRAM-MD5"
24811 .cindex "authentication" "SCRAM-SHA-1"
24812 The &(gsasl)& authenticator provides server integration for the GNU SASL
24813 library and the mechanisms it provides. This is new as of the 4.80 release
24814 and there are a few areas where the library does not let Exim smoothly
24815 scale to handle future authentication mechanisms, so no guarantee can be
24816 made that any particular new authentication mechanism will be supported
24817 without code changes in Exim.
24820 .option server_channelbinding gsasl boolean false
24821 Some authentication mechanisms are able to use external context at both ends
24822 of the session to bind the authentication to that context, and fail the
24823 authentication process if that context differs. Specifically, some TLS
24824 ciphersuites can provide identifying information about the cryptographic
24827 This means that certificate identity and verification becomes a non-issue,
24828 as a man-in-the-middle attack will cause the correct client and server to
24829 see different identifiers and authentication will fail.
24831 This is currently only supported when using the GnuTLS library. This is
24832 only usable by mechanisms which support "channel binding"; at time of
24833 writing, that's the SCRAM family.
24835 This defaults off to ensure smooth upgrade across Exim releases, in case
24836 this option causes some clients to start failing. Some future release
24837 of Exim may switch the default to be true.
24840 .option server_hostname gsasl string&!! "see below"
24841 This option selects the hostname that is used when communicating with the
24842 library. The default value is &`$primary_hostname`&.
24843 Some mechanisms will use this data.
24846 .option server_mech gsasl string "see below"
24847 This option selects the authentication mechanism this driver should use. The
24848 default is the value of the generic &%public_name%& option. This option allows
24849 you to use a different underlying mechanism from the advertised name. For
24854 public_name = X-ANYTHING
24855 server_mech = CRAM-MD5
24856 server_set_id = $auth1
24860 .option server_password gsasl string&!! unset
24861 Various mechanisms need access to the cleartext password on the server, so
24862 that proof-of-possession can be demonstrated on the wire, without sending
24863 the password itself.
24865 The data available for lookup varies per mechanism.
24866 In all cases, &$auth1$& is set to the &'authentication id'&.
24867 The &$auth2$& variable will always be the &'authorization id'& (&'authz'&)
24868 if available, else the empty string.
24869 The &$auth3$& variable will always be the &'realm'& if available,
24870 else the empty string.
24872 A forced failure will cause authentication to defer.
24874 If using this option, it may make sense to set the &%server_condition%&
24875 option to be simply "true".
24878 .option server_realm gsasl string&!! unset
24879 This specifies the SASL realm that the server claims to be in.
24880 Some mechanisms will use this data.
24883 .option server_scram_iter gsasl string&!! unset
24884 This option provides data for the SCRAM family of mechanisms.
24885 &$auth1$& is not available at evaluation time.
24886 (This may change, as we receive feedback on use)
24889 .option server_scram_salt gsasl string&!! unset
24890 This option provides data for the SCRAM family of mechanisms.
24891 &$auth1$& is not available at evaluation time.
24892 (This may change, as we receive feedback on use)
24895 .option server_service gsasl string &`smtp`&
24896 This is the SASL service that the server claims to implement.
24897 Some mechanisms will use this data.
24900 .section "&(gsasl)& auth variables" "SECTgsaslauthvar"
24901 .vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
24902 These may be set when evaluating specific options, as detailed above.
24903 They will also be set when evaluating &%server_condition%&.
24905 Unless otherwise stated below, the &(gsasl)& integration will use the following
24906 meanings for these variables:
24909 .vindex "&$auth1$&"
24910 &$auth1$&: the &'authentication id'&
24912 .vindex "&$auth2$&"
24913 &$auth2$&: the &'authorization id'&
24915 .vindex "&$auth3$&"
24916 &$auth3$&: the &'realm'&
24919 On a per-mechanism basis:
24922 .cindex "authentication" "EXTERNAL"
24923 EXTERNAL: only &$auth1$& is set, to the possibly empty &'authorization id'&;
24924 the &%server_condition%& option must be present.
24926 .cindex "authentication" "ANONYMOUS"
24927 ANONYMOUS: only &$auth1$& is set, to the possibly empty &'anonymous token'&;
24928 the &%server_condition%& option must be present.
24930 .cindex "authentication" "GSSAPI"
24931 GSSAPI: &$auth1$& will be set to the &'GSSAPI Display Name'&;
24932 &$auth2$& will be set to the &'authorization id'&,
24933 the &%server_condition%& option must be present.
24936 An &'anonymous token'& is something passed along as an unauthenticated
24937 identifier; this is analogous to FTP anonymous authentication passing an
24938 email address, or software-identifier@, as the "password".
24941 An example showing the password having the realm specified in the callback
24942 and demonstrating a Cyrus SASL to GSASL migration approach is:
24944 gsasl_cyrusless_crammd5:
24946 public_name = CRAM-MD5
24947 server_realm = imap.example.org
24948 server_password = ${lookup{$auth1:$auth3:userPassword}\
24949 dbmjz{/etc/sasldb2}{$value}fail}
24950 server_set_id = ${quote:$auth1}
24951 server_condition = yes
24955 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24956 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24958 .chapter "The heimdal_gssapi authenticator" "CHAPheimdalgss"
24959 .scindex IIDheimdalgssauth1 "&(heimdal_gssapi)& authenticator"
24960 .scindex IIDheimdalgssauth2 "authenticators" "&(heimdal_gssapi)&"
24961 .cindex "authentication" "GSSAPI"
24962 .cindex "authentication" "Kerberos"
24963 The &(heimdal_gssapi)& authenticator provides server integration for the
24964 Heimdal GSSAPI/Kerberos library, permitting Exim to set a keytab pathname
24967 .option server_hostname heimdal_gssapi string&!! "see below"
24968 This option selects the hostname that is used, with &%server_service%&,
24969 for constructing the GSS server name, as a &'GSS_C_NT_HOSTBASED_SERVICE'&
24970 identifier. The default value is &`$primary_hostname`&.
24972 .option server_keytab heimdal_gssapi string&!! unset
24973 If set, then Heimdal will not use the system default keytab (typically
24974 &_/etc/krb5.keytab_&) but instead the pathname given in this option.
24975 The value should be a pathname, with no &"file:"& prefix.
24977 .option server_service heimdal_gssapi string&!! "smtp"
24978 This option specifies the service identifier used, in conjunction with
24979 &%server_hostname%&, for building the identifer for finding credentials
24983 .section "&(heimdal_gssapi)& auth variables" "SECTheimdalgssauthvar"
24984 Beware that these variables will typically include a realm, thus will appear
24985 to be roughly like an email address already. The &'authzid'& in &$auth2$& is
24986 not verified, so a malicious client can set it to anything.
24988 The &$auth1$& field should be safely trustable as a value from the Key
24989 Distribution Center. Note that these are not quite email addresses.
24990 Each identifier is for a role, and so the left-hand-side may include a
24991 role suffix. For instance, &"joe/admin@EXAMPLE.ORG"&.
24993 .vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
24995 .vindex "&$auth1$&"
24996 &$auth1$&: the &'authentication id'&, set to the GSS Display Name.
24998 .vindex "&$auth2$&"
24999 &$auth2$&: the &'authorization id'&, sent within SASL encapsulation after
25000 authentication. If that was empty, this will also be set to the
25005 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25006 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25008 .chapter "The spa authenticator" "CHAPspa"
25009 .scindex IIDspaauth1 "&(spa)& authenticator"
25010 .scindex IIDspaauth2 "authenticators" "&(spa)&"
25011 .cindex "authentication" "Microsoft Secure Password"
25012 .cindex "authentication" "NTLM"
25013 .cindex "Microsoft Secure Password Authentication"
25014 .cindex "NTLM authentication"
25015 The &(spa)& authenticator provides client support for Microsoft's &'Secure
25016 Password Authentication'& mechanism,
25017 which is also sometimes known as NTLM (NT LanMan). The code for client side of
25018 this authenticator was contributed by Marc Prud'hommeaux, and much of it is
25019 taken from the Samba project (&url(http://www.samba.org)). The code for the
25020 server side was subsequently contributed by Tom Kistner. The mechanism works as
25024 After the AUTH command has been accepted, the client sends an SPA
25025 authentication request based on the user name and optional domain.
25027 The server sends back a challenge.
25029 The client builds a challenge response which makes use of the user's password
25030 and sends it to the server, which then accepts or rejects it.
25033 Encryption is used to protect the password in transit.
25037 .section "Using spa as a server" "SECID179"
25038 .cindex "options" "&(spa)& authenticator (server)"
25039 The &(spa)& authenticator has just one server option:
25041 .option server_password spa string&!! unset
25042 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &(spa)& authenticator"
25043 This option is expanded, and the result must be the cleartext password for the
25044 authenticating user, whose name is at this point in &$auth1$&. For
25045 compatibility with previous releases of Exim, the user name is also placed in
25046 &$1$&. However, the use of this variable for this purpose is now deprecated, as
25047 it can lead to confusion in string expansions that also use numeric variables
25048 for other things. For example:
25053 server_password = \
25054 ${lookup{$auth1}lsearch{/etc/exim/spa_clearpass}{$value}fail}
25056 If the expansion is forced to fail, authentication fails. Any other expansion
25057 failure causes a temporary error code to be returned.
25063 .section "Using spa as a client" "SECID180"
25064 .cindex "options" "&(spa)& authenticator (client)"
25065 The &(spa)& authenticator has the following client options:
25069 .option client_domain spa string&!! unset
25070 This option specifies an optional domain for the authentication.
25073 .option client_password spa string&!! unset
25074 This option specifies the user's password, and must be set.
25077 .option client_username spa string&!! unset
25078 This option specifies the user name, and must be set. Here is an example of a
25079 configuration of this authenticator for use with the mail servers at
25085 client_username = msn/msn_username
25086 client_password = msn_plaintext_password
25087 client_domain = DOMAIN_OR_UNSET
25089 .ecindex IIDspaauth1
25090 .ecindex IIDspaauth2
25096 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25097 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25099 .chapter "Encrypted SMTP connections using TLS/SSL" "CHAPTLS" &&&
25100 "Encrypted SMTP connections"
25101 .scindex IIDencsmtp1 "encryption" "on SMTP connection"
25102 .scindex IIDencsmtp2 "SMTP" "encryption"
25103 .cindex "TLS" "on SMTP connection"
25106 Support for TLS (Transport Layer Security), formerly known as SSL (Secure
25107 Sockets Layer), is implemented by making use of the OpenSSL library or the
25108 GnuTLS library (Exim requires GnuTLS release 1.0 or later). There is no
25109 cryptographic code in the Exim distribution itself for implementing TLS. In
25110 order to use this feature you must install OpenSSL or GnuTLS, and then build a
25111 version of Exim that includes TLS support (see section &<<SECTinctlsssl>>&).
25112 You also need to understand the basic concepts of encryption at a managerial
25113 level, and in particular, the way that public keys, private keys, and
25114 certificates are used.
25116 RFC 3207 defines how SMTP connections can make use of encryption. Once a
25117 connection is established, the client issues a STARTTLS command. If the
25118 server accepts this, the client and the server negotiate an encryption
25119 mechanism. If the negotiation succeeds, the data that subsequently passes
25120 between them is encrypted.
25122 Exim's ACLs can detect whether the current SMTP session is encrypted or not,
25123 and if so, what cipher suite is in use, whether the client supplied a
25124 certificate, and whether or not that certificate was verified. This makes it
25125 possible for an Exim server to deny or accept certain commands based on the
25128 &*Warning*&: Certain types of firewall and certain anti-virus products can
25129 disrupt TLS connections. You need to turn off SMTP scanning for these products
25130 in order to get TLS to work.
25134 .section "Support for the legacy &""ssmtp""& (aka &""smtps""&) protocol" &&&
25136 .cindex "ssmtp protocol"
25137 .cindex "smtps protocol"
25138 .cindex "SMTP" "ssmtp protocol"
25139 .cindex "SMTP" "smtps protocol"
25140 Early implementations of encrypted SMTP used a different TCP port from normal
25141 SMTP, and expected an encryption negotiation to start immediately, instead of
25142 waiting for a STARTTLS command from the client using the standard SMTP
25143 port. The protocol was called &"ssmtp"& or &"smtps"&, and port 465 was
25144 allocated for this purpose.
25146 This approach was abandoned when encrypted SMTP was standardized, but there are
25147 still some legacy clients that use it. Exim supports these clients by means of
25148 the &%tls_on_connect_ports%& global option. Its value must be a list of port
25149 numbers; the most common use is expected to be:
25151 tls_on_connect_ports = 465
25153 The port numbers specified by this option apply to all SMTP connections, both
25154 via the daemon and via &'inetd'&. You still need to specify all the ports that
25155 the daemon uses (by setting &%daemon_smtp_ports%& or &%local_interfaces%& or
25156 the &%-oX%& command line option) because &%tls_on_connect_ports%& does not add
25157 an extra port &-- rather, it specifies different behaviour on a port that is
25160 There is also a &%-tls-on-connect%& command line option. This overrides
25161 &%tls_on_connect_ports%&; it forces the legacy behaviour for all ports.
25168 .section "OpenSSL vs GnuTLS" "SECTopenvsgnu"
25169 .cindex "TLS" "OpenSSL &'vs'& GnuTLS"
25170 The first TLS support in Exim was implemented using OpenSSL. Support for GnuTLS
25171 followed later, when the first versions of GnuTLS were released. To build Exim
25172 to use GnuTLS, you need to set
25176 in Local/Makefile, in addition to
25180 You must also set TLS_LIBS and TLS_INCLUDE appropriately, so that the
25181 include files and libraries for GnuTLS can be found.
25183 There are some differences in usage when using GnuTLS instead of OpenSSL:
25186 The &%tls_verify_certificates%& option must contain the name of a file, not the
25187 name of a directory (for OpenSSL it can be either).
25189 The default value for &%tls_dhparam%& differs for historical reasons.
25191 .vindex "&$tls_in_peerdn$&"
25192 .vindex "&$tls_out_peerdn$&"
25193 Distinguished Name (DN) strings reported by the OpenSSL library use a slash for
25194 separating fields; GnuTLS uses commas, in accordance with RFC 2253. This
25195 affects the value of the &$tls_in_peerdn$& and &$tls_out_peerdn$& variables.
25197 OpenSSL identifies cipher suites using hyphens as separators, for example:
25198 DES-CBC3-SHA. GnuTLS historically used underscores, for example:
25199 RSA_ARCFOUR_SHA. What is more, OpenSSL complains if underscores are present
25200 in a cipher list. To make life simpler, Exim changes underscores to hyphens
25201 for OpenSSL and passes the string unchanged to GnuTLS (expecting the library
25202 to handle its own older variants) when processing lists of cipher suites in the
25203 &%tls_require_ciphers%& options (the global option and the &(smtp)& transport
25206 The &%tls_require_ciphers%& options operate differently, as described in the
25207 sections &<<SECTreqciphssl>>& and &<<SECTreqciphgnu>>&.
25210 The &%tls_dh_min_bits%& SMTP transport option is only honoured by GnuTLS.
25211 When using OpenSSL, this option is ignored.
25212 (If an API is found to let OpenSSL be configured in this way,
25213 let the Exim Maintainers know and we'll likely use it).
25216 Some other recently added features may only be available in one or the other.
25217 This should be documented with the feature. If the documentation does not
25218 explicitly state that the feature is infeasible in the other TLS
25219 implementation, then patches are welcome.
25223 .section "GnuTLS parameter computation" "SECTgnutlsparam"
25224 This section only applies if &%tls_dhparam%& is set to &`historic`& or to
25225 an explicit path; if the latter, then the text about generation still applies,
25226 but not the chosen filename.
25227 By default, as of Exim 4.80 a hard-coded D-H prime is used.
25228 See the documentation of &%tls_dhparam%& for more information.
25230 GnuTLS uses D-H parameters that may take a substantial amount of time
25231 to compute. It is unreasonable to re-compute them for every TLS session.
25232 Therefore, Exim keeps this data in a file in its spool directory, called
25233 &_gnutls-params-NNNN_& for some value of NNNN, corresponding to the number
25235 The file is owned by the Exim user and is readable only by
25236 its owner. Every Exim process that start up GnuTLS reads the D-H
25237 parameters from this file. If the file does not exist, the first Exim process
25238 that needs it computes the data and writes it to a temporary file which is
25239 renamed once it is complete. It does not matter if several Exim processes do
25240 this simultaneously (apart from wasting a few resources). Once a file is in
25241 place, new Exim processes immediately start using it.
25243 For maximum security, the parameters that are stored in this file should be
25244 recalculated periodically, the frequency depending on your paranoia level.
25245 If you are avoiding using the fixed D-H primes published in RFCs, then you
25246 are concerned about some advanced attacks and will wish to do this; if you do
25247 not regenerate then you might as well stick to the standard primes.
25249 Arranging this is easy in principle; just delete the file when you want new
25250 values to be computed. However, there may be a problem. The calculation of new
25251 parameters needs random numbers, and these are obtained from &_/dev/random_&.
25252 If the system is not very active, &_/dev/random_& may delay returning data
25253 until enough randomness (entropy) is available. This may cause Exim to hang for
25254 a substantial amount of time, causing timeouts on incoming connections.
25256 The solution is to generate the parameters externally to Exim. They are stored
25257 in &_gnutls-params-N_& in PEM format, which means that they can be
25258 generated externally using the &(certtool)& command that is part of GnuTLS.
25260 To replace the parameters with new ones, instead of deleting the file
25261 and letting Exim re-create it, you can generate new parameters using
25262 &(certtool)& and, when this has been done, replace Exim's cache file by
25263 renaming. The relevant commands are something like this:
25266 [ look for file; assume gnutls-params-2236 is the most recent ]
25269 # chown exim:exim new-params
25270 # chmod 0600 new-params
25271 # certtool --generate-dh-params --bits 2236 >>new-params
25272 # openssl dhparam -noout -text -in new-params | head
25273 [ check the first line, make sure it's not more than 2236;
25274 if it is, then go back to the start ("rm") and repeat
25275 until the size generated is at most the size requested ]
25276 # chmod 0400 new-params
25277 # mv new-params gnutls-params-2236
25279 If Exim never has to generate the parameters itself, the possibility of
25280 stalling is removed.
25282 The filename changed in Exim 4.80, to gain the -bits suffix. The value which
25283 Exim will choose depends upon the version of GnuTLS in use. For older GnuTLS,
25284 the value remains hard-coded in Exim as 1024. As of GnuTLS 2.12.x, there is
25285 a way for Exim to ask for the "normal" number of bits for D-H public-key usage,
25286 and Exim does so. This attempt to remove Exim from TLS policy decisions
25287 failed, as GnuTLS 2.12 returns a value higher than the current hard-coded limit
25288 of the NSS library. Thus Exim gains the &%tls_dh_max_bits%& global option,
25289 which applies to all D-H usage, client or server. If the value returned by
25290 GnuTLS is greater than &%tls_dh_max_bits%& then the value will be clamped down
25291 to &%tls_dh_max_bits%&. The default value has been set at the current NSS
25292 limit, which is still much higher than Exim historically used.
25294 The filename and bits used will change as the GnuTLS maintainers change the
25295 value for their parameter &`GNUTLS_SEC_PARAM_NORMAL`&, as clamped by
25296 &%tls_dh_max_bits%&. At the time of writing (mid 2012), GnuTLS 2.12 recommends
25297 2432 bits, while NSS is limited to 2236 bits.
25299 In fact, the requested value will be *lower* than &%tls_dh_max_bits%&, to
25300 increase the chance of the generated prime actually being within acceptable
25301 bounds, as GnuTLS has been observed to overshoot. Note the check step in the
25302 procedure above. There is no sane procedure available to Exim to double-check
25303 the size of the generated prime, so it might still be too large.
25306 .section "Requiring specific ciphers in OpenSSL" "SECTreqciphssl"
25307 .cindex "TLS" "requiring specific ciphers (OpenSSL)"
25308 .oindex "&%tls_require_ciphers%&" "OpenSSL"
25309 There is a function in the OpenSSL library that can be passed a list of cipher
25310 suites before the cipher negotiation takes place. This specifies which ciphers
25311 are acceptable. The list is colon separated and may contain names like
25312 DES-CBC3-SHA. Exim passes the expanded value of &%tls_require_ciphers%&
25313 directly to this function call.
25314 Many systems will install the OpenSSL manual-pages, so you may have
25315 &'ciphers(1)'& available to you.
25316 The following quotation from the OpenSSL
25317 documentation specifies what forms of item are allowed in the cipher string:
25320 It can consist of a single cipher suite such as RC4-SHA.
25322 It can represent a list of cipher suites containing a certain algorithm,
25323 or cipher suites of a certain type. For example SHA1 represents all
25324 ciphers suites using the digest algorithm SHA1 and SSLv3 represents all
25327 Lists of cipher suites can be combined in a single cipher string using
25328 the + character. This is used as a logical and operation. For example
25329 SHA1+DES represents all cipher suites containing the SHA1 and the DES
25333 Each cipher string can be optionally preceded by one of the characters &`!`&,
25336 If &`!`& is used, the ciphers are permanently deleted from the list. The
25337 ciphers deleted can never reappear in the list even if they are explicitly
25340 If &`-`& is used, the ciphers are deleted from the list, but some or all
25341 of the ciphers can be added again by later options.
25343 If &`+`& is used, the ciphers are moved to the end of the list. This
25344 option does not add any new ciphers; it just moves matching existing ones.
25347 If none of these characters is present, the string is interpreted as
25348 a list of ciphers to be appended to the current preference list. If the list
25349 includes any ciphers already present they will be ignored: that is, they will
25350 not be moved to the end of the list.
25353 The OpenSSL &'ciphers(1)'& command may be used to test the results of a given
25356 # note single-quotes to get ! past any shell history expansion
25357 $ openssl ciphers 'HIGH:!MD5:!SHA1'
25360 This example will let the library defaults be permitted on the MX port, where
25361 there's probably no identity verification anyway, but ups the ante on the
25362 submission ports where the administrator might have some influence on the
25363 choice of clients used:
25365 # OpenSSL variant; see man ciphers(1)
25366 tls_require_ciphers = ${if =={$received_port}{25}\
25373 .section "Requiring specific ciphers or other parameters in GnuTLS" &&&
25375 .cindex "GnuTLS" "specifying parameters for"
25376 .cindex "TLS" "specifying ciphers (GnuTLS)"
25377 .cindex "TLS" "specifying key exchange methods (GnuTLS)"
25378 .cindex "TLS" "specifying MAC algorithms (GnuTLS)"
25379 .cindex "TLS" "specifying protocols (GnuTLS)"
25380 .cindex "TLS" "specifying priority string (GnuTLS)"
25381 .oindex "&%tls_require_ciphers%&" "GnuTLS"
25382 The GnuTLS library allows the caller to provide a "priority string", documented
25383 as part of the &[gnutls_priority_init]& function. This is very similar to the
25384 ciphersuite specification in OpenSSL.
25386 The &%tls_require_ciphers%& option is treated as the GnuTLS priority string.
25388 The &%tls_require_ciphers%& option is available both as an global option,
25389 controlling how Exim behaves as a server, and also as an option of the
25390 &(smtp)& transport, controlling how Exim behaves as a client. In both cases
25391 the value is string expanded. The resulting string is not an Exim list and
25392 the string is given to the GnuTLS library, so that Exim does not need to be
25393 aware of future feature enhancements of GnuTLS.
25395 Documentation of the strings accepted may be found in the GnuTLS manual, under
25396 "Priority strings". This is online as
25397 &url(http://www.gnu.org/software/gnutls/manual/html_node/Priority-Strings.html),
25398 but beware that this relates to GnuTLS 3, which may be newer than the version
25399 installed on your system. If you are using GnuTLS 3,
25400 &url(http://www.gnu.org/software/gnutls/manual/html_node/Listing-the-ciphersuites-in-a-priority-string.html, then the example code)
25401 on that site can be used to test a given string.
25403 Prior to Exim 4.80, an older API of GnuTLS was used, and Exim supported three
25404 additional options, "&%gnutls_require_kx%&", "&%gnutls_require_mac%&" and
25405 "&%gnutls_require_protocols%&". &%tls_require_ciphers%& was an Exim list.
25407 This example will let the library defaults be permitted on the MX port, where
25408 there's probably no identity verification anyway, and lowers security further
25409 by increasing compatibility; but this ups the ante on the submission ports
25410 where the administrator might have some influence on the choice of clients
25414 tls_require_ciphers = ${if =={$received_port}{25}\
25420 .section "Configuring an Exim server to use TLS" "SECID182"
25421 .cindex "TLS" "configuring an Exim server"
25422 When Exim has been built with TLS support, it advertises the availability of
25423 the STARTTLS command to client hosts that match &%tls_advertise_hosts%&,
25424 but not to any others. The default value of this option is unset, which means
25425 that STARTTLS is not advertised at all. This default is chosen because you
25426 need to set some other options in order to make TLS available, and also it is
25427 sensible for systems that want to use TLS only as a client.
25429 If a client issues a STARTTLS command and there is some configuration
25430 problem in the server, the command is rejected with a 454 error. If the client
25431 persists in trying to issue SMTP commands, all except QUIT are rejected
25434 554 Security failure
25436 If a STARTTLS command is issued within an existing TLS session, it is
25437 rejected with a 554 error code.
25439 To enable TLS operations on a server, you must set &%tls_advertise_hosts%& to
25440 match some hosts. You can, of course, set it to * to match all hosts.
25441 However, this is not all you need to do. TLS sessions to a server won't work
25442 without some further configuration at the server end.
25444 It is rumoured that all existing clients that support TLS/SSL use RSA
25445 encryption. To make this work you need to set, in the server,
25447 tls_certificate = /some/file/name
25448 tls_privatekey = /some/file/name
25450 These options are, in fact, expanded strings, so you can make them depend on
25451 the identity of the client that is connected if you wish. The first file
25452 contains the server's X509 certificate, and the second contains the private key
25453 that goes with it. These files need to be readable by the Exim user, and must
25454 always be given as full path names. They can be the same file if both the
25455 certificate and the key are contained within it. If &%tls_privatekey%& is not
25456 set, or if its expansion is forced to fail or results in an empty string, this
25457 is assumed to be the case. The certificate file may also contain intermediate
25458 certificates that need to be sent to the client to enable it to authenticate
25459 the server's certificate.
25461 If you do not understand about certificates and keys, please try to find a
25462 source of this background information, which is not Exim-specific. (There are a
25463 few comments below in section &<<SECTcerandall>>&.)
25465 &*Note*&: These options do not apply when Exim is operating as a client &--
25466 they apply only in the case of a server. If you need to use a certificate in an
25467 Exim client, you must set the options of the same names in an &(smtp)&
25470 With just these options, an Exim server will be able to use TLS. It does not
25471 require the client to have a certificate (but see below for how to insist on
25472 this). There is one other option that may be needed in other situations. If
25474 tls_dhparam = /some/file/name
25476 is set, the SSL library is initialized for the use of Diffie-Hellman ciphers
25477 with the parameters contained in the file.
25478 Set this to &`none`& to disable use of DH entirely, by making no prime
25483 This may also be set to a string identifying a standard prime to be used for
25484 DH; if it is set to &`default`& or, for OpenSSL, is unset, then the prime
25485 used is &`ike23`&. There are a few standard primes available, see the
25486 documetnation for &%tls_dhparam%& for the complete list.
25492 for a way of generating file data.
25494 The strings supplied for these three options are expanded every time a client
25495 host connects. It is therefore possible to use different certificates and keys
25496 for different hosts, if you so wish, by making use of the client's IP address
25497 in &$sender_host_address$& to control the expansion. If a string expansion is
25498 forced to fail, Exim behaves as if the option is not set.
25500 .cindex "cipher" "logging"
25501 .cindex "log" "TLS cipher"
25502 .vindex "&$tls_in_cipher$&"
25503 The variable &$tls_in_cipher$& is set to the cipher suite that was negotiated for
25504 an incoming TLS connection. It is included in the &'Received:'& header of an
25505 incoming message (by default &-- you can, of course, change this), and it is
25506 also included in the log line that records a message's arrival, keyed by
25507 &"X="&, unless the &%tls_cipher%& log selector is turned off. The &%encrypted%&
25508 condition can be used to test for specific cipher suites in ACLs.
25510 Once TLS has been established, the ACLs that run for subsequent SMTP commands
25511 can check the name of the cipher suite and vary their actions accordingly. The
25512 cipher suite names vary, depending on which TLS library is being used. For
25513 example, OpenSSL uses the name DES-CBC3-SHA for the cipher suite which in other
25514 contexts is known as TLS_RSA_WITH_3DES_EDE_CBC_SHA. Check the OpenSSL or GnuTLS
25515 documentation for more details.
25517 For outgoing SMTP deliveries, &$tls_out_cipher$& is used and logged
25518 (again depending on the &%tls_cipher%& log selector).
25521 .section "Requesting and verifying client certificates" "SECID183"
25522 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
25523 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
25524 If you want an Exim server to request a certificate when negotiating a TLS
25525 session with a client, you must set either &%tls_verify_hosts%& or
25526 &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&. You can, of course, set either of them to * to
25527 apply to all TLS connections. For any host that matches one of these options,
25528 Exim requests a certificate as part of the setup of the TLS session. The
25529 contents of the certificate are verified by comparing it with a list of
25530 expected certificates. These must be available in a file or,
25531 for OpenSSL only (not GnuTLS), a directory, identified by
25532 &%tls_verify_certificates%&.
25534 A file can contain multiple certificates, concatenated end to end. If a
25537 each certificate must be in a separate file, with a name (or a symbolic link)
25538 of the form <&'hash'&>.0, where <&'hash'&> is a hash value constructed from the
25539 certificate. You can compute the relevant hash by running the command
25541 openssl x509 -hash -noout -in /cert/file
25543 where &_/cert/file_& contains a single certificate.
25545 The difference between &%tls_verify_hosts%& and &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& is
25546 what happens if the client does not supply a certificate, or if the certificate
25547 does not match any of the certificates in the collection named by
25548 &%tls_verify_certificates%&. If the client matches &%tls_verify_hosts%&, the
25549 attempt to set up a TLS session is aborted, and the incoming connection is
25550 dropped. If the client matches &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&, the (encrypted) SMTP
25551 session continues. ACLs that run for subsequent SMTP commands can detect the
25552 fact that no certificate was verified, and vary their actions accordingly. For
25553 example, you can insist on a certificate before accepting a message for
25554 relaying, but not when the message is destined for local delivery.
25556 .vindex "&$tls_in_peerdn$&"
25557 When a client supplies a certificate (whether it verifies or not), the value of
25558 the Distinguished Name of the certificate is made available in the variable
25559 &$tls_in_peerdn$& during subsequent processing of the message.
25561 .cindex "log" "distinguished name"
25562 Because it is often a long text string, it is not included in the log line or
25563 &'Received:'& header by default. You can arrange for it to be logged, keyed by
25564 &"DN="&, by setting the &%tls_peerdn%& log selector, and you can use
25565 &%received_header_text%& to change the &'Received:'& header. When no
25566 certificate is supplied, &$tls_in_peerdn$& is empty.
25569 .section "Revoked certificates" "SECID184"
25570 .cindex "TLS" "revoked certificates"
25571 .cindex "revocation list"
25572 .cindex "certificate" "revocation list"
25573 Certificate issuing authorities issue Certificate Revocation Lists (CRLs) when
25574 certificates are revoked. If you have such a list, you can pass it to an Exim
25575 server using the global option called &%tls_crl%& and to an Exim client using
25576 an identically named option for the &(smtp)& transport. In each case, the value
25577 of the option is expanded and must then be the name of a file that contains a
25581 .section "Configuring an Exim client to use TLS" "SECID185"
25582 .cindex "cipher" "logging"
25583 .cindex "log" "TLS cipher"
25584 .cindex "log" "distinguished name"
25585 .cindex "TLS" "configuring an Exim client"
25586 The &%tls_cipher%& and &%tls_peerdn%& log selectors apply to outgoing SMTP
25587 deliveries as well as to incoming, the latter one causing logging of the
25588 server certificate's DN. The remaining client configuration for TLS is all
25589 within the &(smtp)& transport.
25591 It is not necessary to set any options to have TLS work in the &(smtp)&
25592 transport. If Exim is built with TLS support, and TLS is advertised by a
25593 server, the &(smtp)& transport always tries to start a TLS session. However,
25594 this can be prevented by setting &%hosts_avoid_tls%& (an option of the
25595 transport) to a list of server hosts for which TLS should not be used.
25597 If you do not want Exim to attempt to send messages unencrypted when an attempt
25598 to set up an encrypted connection fails in any way, you can set
25599 &%hosts_require_tls%& to a list of hosts for which encryption is mandatory. For
25600 those hosts, delivery is always deferred if an encrypted connection cannot be
25601 set up. If there are any other hosts for the address, they are tried in the
25604 When the server host is not in &%hosts_require_tls%&, Exim may try to deliver
25605 the message unencrypted. It always does this if the response to STARTTLS is
25606 a 5&'xx'& code. For a temporary error code, or for a failure to negotiate a TLS
25607 session after a success response code, what happens is controlled by the
25608 &%tls_tempfail_tryclear%& option of the &(smtp)& transport. If it is false,
25609 delivery to this host is deferred, and other hosts (if available) are tried. If
25610 it is true, Exim attempts to deliver unencrypted after a 4&'xx'& response to
25611 STARTTLS, and if STARTTLS is accepted, but the subsequent TLS
25612 negotiation fails, Exim closes the current connection (because it is in an
25613 unknown state), opens a new one to the same host, and then tries the delivery
25616 The &%tls_certificate%& and &%tls_privatekey%& options of the &(smtp)&
25617 transport provide the client with a certificate, which is passed to the server
25618 if it requests it. If the server is Exim, it will request a certificate only if
25619 &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& matches the client.
25621 If the &%tls_verify_certificates%& option is set on the &(smtp)& transport, it
25622 must name a file or,
25623 for OpenSSL only (not GnuTLS), a directory, that contains a collection of
25624 expected server certificates. The client verifies the server's certificate
25625 against this collection, taking into account any revoked certificates that are
25626 in the list defined by &%tls_crl%&.
25629 &%tls_require_ciphers%& is set on the &(smtp)& transport, it must contain a
25630 list of permitted cipher suites. If either of these checks fails, delivery to
25631 the current host is abandoned, and the &(smtp)& transport tries to deliver to
25632 alternative hosts, if any.
25635 These options must be set in the &(smtp)& transport for Exim to use TLS when it
25636 is operating as a client. Exim does not assume that a server certificate (set
25637 by the global options of the same name) should also be used when operating as a
25641 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
25642 All the TLS options in the &(smtp)& transport are expanded before use, with
25643 &$host$& and &$host_address$& containing the name and address of the server to
25644 which the client is connected. Forced failure of an expansion causes Exim to
25645 behave as if the relevant option were unset.
25647 .vindex &$tls_out_bits$&
25648 .vindex &$tls_out_cipher$&
25649 .vindex &$tls_out_peerdn$&
25650 .vindex &$tls_out_sni$&
25651 Before an SMTP connection is established, the
25652 &$tls_out_bits$&, &$tls_out_cipher$&, &$tls_out_peerdn$& and &$tls_out_sni$&
25653 variables are emptied. (Until the first connection, they contain the values
25654 that were set when the message was received.) If STARTTLS is subsequently
25655 successfully obeyed, these variables are set to the relevant values for the
25656 outgoing connection.
25660 .section "Use of TLS Server Name Indication" "SECTtlssni"
25661 .cindex "TLS" "Server Name Indication"
25662 .vindex "&$tls_in_sni$&"
25663 .oindex "&%tls_in_sni%&"
25664 With TLS1.0 or above, there is an extension mechanism by which extra
25665 information can be included at various points in the protocol. One of these
25666 extensions, documented in RFC 6066 (and before that RFC 4366) is
25667 &"Server Name Indication"&, commonly &"SNI"&. This extension is sent by the
25668 client in the initial handshake, so that the server can examine the servername
25669 within and possibly choose to use different certificates and keys (and more)
25672 This is analagous to HTTP's &"Host:"& header, and is the main mechanism by
25673 which HTTPS-enabled web-sites can be virtual-hosted, many sites to one IP
25676 With SMTP to MX, there are the same problems here as in choosing the identity
25677 against which to validate a certificate: you can't rely on insecure DNS to
25678 provide the identity which you then cryptographically verify. So this will
25679 be of limited use in that environment.
25681 With SMTP to Submission, there is a well-defined hostname which clients are
25682 connecting to and can validate certificates against. Thus clients &*can*&
25683 choose to include this information in the TLS negotiation. If this becomes
25684 wide-spread, then hosters can choose to present different certificates to
25685 different clients. Or even negotiate different cipher suites.
25687 The &%tls_sni%& option on an SMTP transport is an expanded string; the result,
25688 if not empty, will be sent on a TLS session as part of the handshake. There's
25689 nothing more to it. Choosing a sensible value not derived insecurely is the
25690 only point of caution. The &$tls_out_sni$& variable will be set to this string
25691 for the lifetime of the client connection (including during authentication).
25693 Except during SMTP client sessions, if &$tls_in_sni$& is set then it is a string
25694 received from a client.
25695 It can be logged with the &%log_selector%& item &`+tls_sni`&.
25697 If the string &`tls_in_sni`& appears in the main section's &%tls_certificate%&
25698 option (prior to expansion) then the following options will be re-expanded
25699 during TLS session handshake, to permit alternative values to be chosen:
25702 .vindex "&%tls_certificate%&"
25703 &%tls_certificate%&
25705 .vindex "&%tls_crl%&"
25708 .vindex "&%tls_privatekey%&"
25711 .vindex "&%tls_verify_certificates%&"
25712 &%tls_verify_certificates%&
25715 Great care should be taken to deal with matters of case, various injection
25716 attacks in the string (&`../`& or SQL), and ensuring that a valid filename
25717 can always be referenced; it is important to remember that &$tls_sni$& is
25718 arbitrary unverified data provided prior to authentication.
25720 The Exim developers are proceeding cautiously and so far no other TLS options
25723 When Exim is built againt OpenSSL, OpenSSL must have been built with support
25724 for TLS Extensions. This holds true for OpenSSL 1.0.0+ and 0.9.8+ with
25725 enable-tlsext in EXTRACONFIGURE. If you invoke &(openssl s_client -h)& and
25726 see &`-servername`& in the output, then OpenSSL has support.
25728 When Exim is built against GnuTLS, SNI support is available as of GnuTLS
25729 0.5.10. (Its presence predates the current API which Exim uses, so if Exim
25730 built, then you have SNI support).
25734 .section "Multiple messages on the same encrypted TCP/IP connection" &&&
25736 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries with TLS"
25737 .cindex "TLS" "multiple message deliveries"
25738 Exim sends multiple messages down the same TCP/IP connection by starting up
25739 an entirely new delivery process for each message, passing the socket from
25740 one process to the next. This implementation does not fit well with the use
25741 of TLS, because there is quite a lot of state information associated with a TLS
25742 connection, not just a socket identification. Passing all the state information
25743 to a new process is not feasible. Consequently, Exim shuts down an existing TLS
25744 session before passing the socket to a new process. The new process may then
25745 try to start a new TLS session, and if successful, may try to re-authenticate
25746 if AUTH is in use, before sending the next message.
25748 The RFC is not clear as to whether or not an SMTP session continues in clear
25749 after TLS has been shut down, or whether TLS may be restarted again later, as
25750 just described. However, if the server is Exim, this shutdown and
25751 reinitialization works. It is not known which (if any) other servers operate
25752 successfully if the client closes a TLS session and continues with unencrypted
25753 SMTP, but there are certainly some that do not work. For such servers, Exim
25754 should not pass the socket to another process, because the failure of the
25755 subsequent attempt to use it would cause Exim to record a temporary host error,
25756 and delay other deliveries to that host.
25758 To test for this case, Exim sends an EHLO command to the server after
25759 closing down the TLS session. If this fails in any way, the connection is
25760 closed instead of being passed to a new delivery process, but no retry
25761 information is recorded.
25763 There is also a manual override; you can set &%hosts_nopass_tls%& on the
25764 &(smtp)& transport to match those hosts for which Exim should not pass
25765 connections to new processes if TLS has been used.
25770 .section "Certificates and all that" "SECTcerandall"
25771 .cindex "certificate" "references to discussion"
25772 In order to understand fully how TLS works, you need to know about
25773 certificates, certificate signing, and certificate authorities. This is not the
25774 place to give a tutorial, especially as I do not know very much about it
25775 myself. Some helpful introduction can be found in the FAQ for the SSL addition
25776 to Apache, currently at
25778 &url(http://www.modssl.org/docs/2.7/ssl_faq.html#ToC24)
25780 Other parts of the &'modssl'& documentation are also helpful, and have
25781 links to further files.
25782 Eric Rescorla's book, &'SSL and TLS'&, published by Addison-Wesley (ISBN
25783 0-201-61598-3), contains both introductory and more in-depth descriptions.
25784 Some sample programs taken from the book are available from
25786 &url(http://www.rtfm.com/openssl-examples/)
25790 .section "Certificate chains" "SECID186"
25791 The file named by &%tls_certificate%& may contain more than one
25792 certificate. This is useful in the case where the certificate that is being
25793 sent is validated by an intermediate certificate which the other end does
25794 not have. Multiple certificates must be in the correct order in the file.
25795 First the host's certificate itself, then the first intermediate
25796 certificate to validate the issuer of the host certificate, then the next
25797 intermediate certificate to validate the issuer of the first intermediate
25798 certificate, and so on, until finally (optionally) the root certificate.
25799 The root certificate must already be trusted by the recipient for
25800 validation to succeed, of course, but if it's not preinstalled, sending the
25801 root certificate along with the rest makes it available for the user to
25802 install if the receiving end is a client MUA that can interact with a user.
25805 .section "Self-signed certificates" "SECID187"
25806 .cindex "certificate" "self-signed"
25807 You can create a self-signed certificate using the &'req'& command provided
25808 with OpenSSL, like this:
25810 openssl req -x509 -newkey rsa:1024 -keyout file1 -out file2 \
25813 &_file1_& and &_file2_& can be the same file; the key and the certificate are
25814 delimited and so can be identified independently. The &%-days%& option
25815 specifies a period for which the certificate is valid. The &%-nodes%& option is
25816 important: if you do not set it, the key is encrypted with a passphrase
25817 that you are prompted for, and any use that is made of the key causes more
25818 prompting for the passphrase. This is not helpful if you are going to use
25819 this certificate and key in an MTA, where prompting is not possible.
25821 A self-signed certificate made in this way is sufficient for testing, and
25822 may be adequate for all your requirements if you are mainly interested in
25823 encrypting transfers, and not in secure identification.
25825 However, many clients require that the certificate presented by the server be a
25826 user (also called &"leaf"& or &"site"&) certificate, and not a self-signed
25827 certificate. In this situation, the self-signed certificate described above
25828 must be installed on the client host as a trusted root &'certification
25829 authority'& (CA), and the certificate used by Exim must be a user certificate
25830 signed with that self-signed certificate.
25832 For information on creating self-signed CA certificates and using them to sign
25833 user certificates, see the &'General implementation overview'& chapter of the
25834 Open-source PKI book, available online at
25835 &url(http://ospkibook.sourceforge.net/).
25836 .ecindex IIDencsmtp1
25837 .ecindex IIDencsmtp2
25841 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25842 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25844 .chapter "Access control lists" "CHAPACL"
25845 .scindex IIDacl "&ACL;" "description"
25846 .cindex "control of incoming mail"
25847 .cindex "message" "controlling incoming"
25848 .cindex "policy control" "access control lists"
25849 Access Control Lists (ACLs) are defined in a separate section of the run time
25850 configuration file, headed by &"begin acl"&. Each ACL definition starts with a
25851 name, terminated by a colon. Here is a complete ACL section that contains just
25852 one very small ACL:
25856 accept hosts = one.host.only
25858 You can have as many lists as you like in the ACL section, and the order in
25859 which they appear does not matter. The lists are self-terminating.
25861 The majority of ACLs are used to control Exim's behaviour when it receives
25862 certain SMTP commands. This applies both to incoming TCP/IP connections, and
25863 when a local process submits a message using SMTP by specifying the &%-bs%&
25864 option. The most common use is for controlling which recipients are accepted
25865 in incoming messages. In addition, you can define an ACL that is used to check
25866 local non-SMTP messages. The default configuration file contains an example of
25867 a realistic ACL for checking RCPT commands. This is discussed in chapter
25868 &<<CHAPdefconfil>>&.
25871 .section "Testing ACLs" "SECID188"
25872 The &%-bh%& command line option provides a way of testing your ACL
25873 configuration locally by running a fake SMTP session with which you interact.
25874 The host &'relay-test.mail-abuse.org'& provides a service for checking your
25875 relaying configuration (see section &<<SECTcheralcon>>& for more details).
25879 .section "Specifying when ACLs are used" "SECID189"
25880 .cindex "&ACL;" "options for specifying"
25881 In order to cause an ACL to be used, you have to name it in one of the relevant
25882 options in the main part of the configuration. These options are:
25883 .cindex "AUTH" "ACL for"
25884 .cindex "DATA" "ACLs for"
25885 .cindex "ETRN" "ACL for"
25886 .cindex "EXPN" "ACL for"
25887 .cindex "HELO" "ACL for"
25888 .cindex "EHLO" "ACL for"
25889 .cindex "MAIL" "ACL for"
25890 .cindex "QUIT, ACL for"
25891 .cindex "RCPT" "ACL for"
25892 .cindex "STARTTLS, ACL for"
25893 .cindex "VRFY" "ACL for"
25894 .cindex "SMTP" "connection, ACL for"
25895 .cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
25896 .cindex "MIME content scanning" "ACL for"
25899 .irow &%acl_not_smtp%& "ACL for non-SMTP messages"
25900 .irow &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& "ACL for non-SMTP MIME parts"
25901 .irow &%acl_not_smtp_start%& "ACL at start of non-SMTP message"
25902 .irow &%acl_smtp_auth%& "ACL for AUTH"
25903 .irow &%acl_smtp_connect%& "ACL for start of SMTP connection"
25904 .irow &%acl_smtp_data%& "ACL after DATA is complete"
25905 .irow &%acl_smtp_etrn%& "ACL for ETRN"
25906 .irow &%acl_smtp_expn%& "ACL for EXPN"
25907 .irow &%acl_smtp_helo%& "ACL for HELO or EHLO"
25908 .irow &%acl_smtp_mail%& "ACL for MAIL"
25909 .irow &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& "ACL for the AUTH parameter of MAIL"
25910 .irow &%acl_smtp_mime%& "ACL for content-scanning MIME parts"
25911 .irow &%acl_smtp_notquit%& "ACL for non-QUIT terminations"
25912 .irow &%acl_smtp_predata%& "ACL at start of DATA command"
25913 .irow &%acl_smtp_quit%& "ACL for QUIT"
25914 .irow &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& "ACL for RCPT"
25915 .irow &%acl_smtp_starttls%& "ACL for STARTTLS"
25916 .irow &%acl_smtp_vrfy%& "ACL for VRFY"
25919 For example, if you set
25921 acl_smtp_rcpt = small_acl
25923 the little ACL defined above is used whenever Exim receives a RCPT command
25924 in an SMTP dialogue. The majority of policy tests on incoming messages can be
25925 done when RCPT commands arrive. A rejection of RCPT should cause the
25926 sending MTA to give up on the recipient address contained in the RCPT
25927 command, whereas rejection at other times may cause the client MTA to keep on
25928 trying to deliver the message. It is therefore recommended that you do as much
25929 testing as possible at RCPT time.
25932 .section "The non-SMTP ACLs" "SECID190"
25933 .cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
25934 The non-SMTP ACLs apply to all non-interactive incoming messages, that is, they
25935 apply to batched SMTP as well as to non-SMTP messages. (Batched SMTP is not
25936 really SMTP.) Many of the ACL conditions (for example, host tests, and tests on
25937 the state of the SMTP connection such as encryption and authentication) are not
25938 relevant and are forbidden in these ACLs. However, the sender and recipients
25939 are known, so the &%senders%& and &%sender_domains%& conditions and the
25940 &$sender_address$& and &$recipients$& variables can be used. Variables such as
25941 &$authenticated_sender$& are also available. You can specify added header lines
25942 in any of these ACLs.
25944 The &%acl_not_smtp_start%& ACL is run right at the start of receiving a
25945 non-SMTP message, before any of the message has been read. (This is the
25946 analogue of the &%acl_smtp_predata%& ACL for SMTP input.) In the case of
25947 batched SMTP input, it runs after the DATA command has been reached. The
25948 result of this ACL is ignored; it cannot be used to reject a message. If you
25949 really need to, you could set a value in an ACL variable here and reject based
25950 on that in the &%acl_not_smtp%& ACL. However, this ACL can be used to set
25951 controls, and in particular, it can be used to set
25953 control = suppress_local_fixups
25955 This cannot be used in the other non-SMTP ACLs because by the time they are
25956 run, it is too late.
25958 The &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& ACL is available only when Exim is compiled with the
25959 content-scanning extension. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
25961 The &%acl_not_smtp%& ACL is run just before the &[local_scan()]& function. Any
25962 kind of rejection is treated as permanent, because there is no way of sending a
25963 temporary error for these kinds of message.
25966 .section "The SMTP connect ACL" "SECID191"
25967 .cindex "SMTP" "connection, ACL for"
25968 .oindex &%smtp_banner%&
25969 The ACL test specified by &%acl_smtp_connect%& happens at the start of an SMTP
25970 session, after the test specified by &%host_reject_connection%& (which is now
25971 an anomaly) and any TCP Wrappers testing (if configured). If the connection is
25972 accepted by an &%accept%& verb that has a &%message%& modifier, the contents of
25973 the message override the banner message that is otherwise specified by the
25974 &%smtp_banner%& option.
25977 .section "The EHLO/HELO ACL" "SECID192"
25978 .cindex "EHLO" "ACL for"
25979 .cindex "HELO" "ACL for"
25980 The ACL test specified by &%acl_smtp_helo%& happens when the client issues an
25981 EHLO or HELO command, after the tests specified by &%helo_accept_junk_hosts%&,
25982 &%helo_allow_chars%&, &%helo_verify_hosts%&, and &%helo_try_verify_hosts%&.
25983 Note that a client may issue more than one EHLO or HELO command in an SMTP
25984 session, and indeed is required to issue a new EHLO or HELO after successfully
25985 setting up encryption following a STARTTLS command.
25987 If the command is accepted by an &%accept%& verb that has a &%message%&
25988 modifier, the message may not contain more than one line (it will be truncated
25989 at the first newline and a panic logged if it does). Such a message cannot
25990 affect the EHLO options that are listed on the second and subsequent lines of
25994 .section "The DATA ACLs" "SECID193"
25995 .cindex "DATA" "ACLs for"
25996 Two ACLs are associated with the DATA command, because it is two-stage
25997 command, with two responses being sent to the client.
25998 When the DATA command is received, the ACL defined by &%acl_smtp_predata%&
25999 is obeyed. This gives you control after all the RCPT commands, but before
26000 the message itself is received. It offers the opportunity to give a negative
26001 response to the DATA command before the data is transmitted. Header lines
26002 added by MAIL or RCPT ACLs are not visible at this time, but any that
26003 are defined here are visible when the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL is run.
26005 You cannot test the contents of the message, for example, to verify addresses
26006 in the headers, at RCPT time or when the DATA command is received. Such
26007 tests have to appear in the ACL that is run after the message itself has been
26008 received, before the final response to the DATA command is sent. This is
26009 the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_data%&, which is the second ACL that is
26010 associated with the DATA command.
26012 For both of these ACLs, it is not possible to reject individual recipients. An
26013 error response rejects the entire message. Unfortunately, it is known that some
26014 MTAs do not treat hard (5&'xx'&) responses to the DATA command (either
26015 before or after the data) correctly &-- they keep the message on their queues
26016 and try again later, but that is their problem, though it does waste some of
26020 .section "The SMTP DKIM ACL" "SECTDKIMACL"
26021 The &%acl_smtp_dkim%& ACL is available only when Exim is compiled with DKIM support
26022 enabled (which is the default).
26024 The ACL test specified by &%acl_smtp_dkim%& happens after a message has been
26025 received, and is executed for each DKIM signature found in a message. If not
26026 otherwise specified, the default action is to accept.
26028 For details on the operation of DKIM, see chapter &<<CHID12>>&.
26031 .section "The SMTP MIME ACL" "SECID194"
26032 The &%acl_smtp_mime%& option is available only when Exim is compiled with the
26033 content-scanning extension. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
26036 .section "The QUIT ACL" "SECTQUITACL"
26037 .cindex "QUIT, ACL for"
26038 The ACL for the SMTP QUIT command is anomalous, in that the outcome of the ACL
26039 does not affect the response code to QUIT, which is always 221. Thus, the ACL
26040 does not in fact control any access. For this reason, the only verbs that are
26041 permitted are &%accept%& and &%warn%&.
26043 This ACL can be used for tasks such as custom logging at the end of an SMTP
26044 session. For example, you can use ACL variables in other ACLs to count
26045 messages, recipients, etc., and log the totals at QUIT time using one or
26046 more &%logwrite%& modifiers on a &%warn%& verb.
26048 &*Warning*&: Only the &$acl_c$&&'x'& variables can be used for this, because
26049 the &$acl_m$&&'x'& variables are reset at the end of each incoming message.
26051 You do not need to have a final &%accept%&, but if you do, you can use a
26052 &%message%& modifier to specify custom text that is sent as part of the 221
26055 This ACL is run only for a &"normal"& QUIT. For certain kinds of disastrous
26056 failure (for example, failure to open a log file, or when Exim is bombing out
26057 because it has detected an unrecoverable error), all SMTP commands from the
26058 client are given temporary error responses until QUIT is received or the
26059 connection is closed. In these special cases, the QUIT ACL does not run.
26062 .section "The not-QUIT ACL" "SECTNOTQUITACL"
26063 .vindex &$acl_smtp_notquit$&
26064 The not-QUIT ACL, specified by &%acl_smtp_notquit%&, is run in most cases when
26065 an SMTP session ends without sending QUIT. However, when Exim itself is is bad
26066 trouble, such as being unable to write to its log files, this ACL is not run,
26067 because it might try to do things (such as write to log files) that make the
26068 situation even worse.
26070 Like the QUIT ACL, this ACL is provided to make it possible to do customized
26071 logging or to gather statistics, and its outcome is ignored. The &%delay%&
26072 modifier is forbidden in this ACL, and the only permitted verbs are &%accept%&
26075 .vindex &$smtp_notquit_reason$&
26076 When the not-QUIT ACL is running, the variable &$smtp_notquit_reason$& is set
26077 to a string that indicates the reason for the termination of the SMTP
26078 connection. The possible values are:
26080 .irow &`acl-drop`& "Another ACL issued a &%drop%& command"
26081 .irow &`bad-commands`& "Too many unknown or non-mail commands"
26082 .irow &`command-timeout`& "Timeout while reading SMTP commands"
26083 .irow &`connection-lost`& "The SMTP connection has been lost"
26084 .irow &`data-timeout`& "Timeout while reading message data"
26085 .irow &`local-scan-error`& "The &[local_scan()]& function crashed"
26086 .irow &`local-scan-timeout`& "The &[local_scan()]& function timed out"
26087 .irow &`signal-exit`& "SIGTERM or SIGINT"
26088 .irow &`synchronization-error`& "SMTP synchronization error"
26089 .irow &`tls-failed`& "TLS failed to start"
26091 In most cases when an SMTP connection is closed without having received QUIT,
26092 Exim sends an SMTP response message before actually closing the connection.
26093 With the exception of the &`acl-drop`& case, the default message can be
26094 overridden by the &%message%& modifier in the not-QUIT ACL. In the case of a
26095 &%drop%& verb in another ACL, it is the message from the other ACL that is
26099 .section "Finding an ACL to use" "SECID195"
26100 .cindex "&ACL;" "finding which to use"
26101 The value of an &%acl_smtp_%&&'xxx'& option is expanded before use, so
26102 you can use different ACLs in different circumstances. For example,
26104 acl_smtp_rcpt = ${if ={25}{$interface_port} \
26105 {acl_check_rcpt} {acl_check_rcpt_submit} }
26107 In the default configuration file there are some example settings for
26108 providing an RFC 4409 message submission service on port 587 and a
26109 non-standard &"smtps"& service on port 465. You can use a string
26110 expansion like this to choose an ACL for MUAs on these ports which is
26111 more appropriate for this purpose than the default ACL on port 25.
26113 The expanded string does not have to be the name of an ACL in the
26114 configuration file; there are other possibilities. Having expanded the
26115 string, Exim searches for an ACL as follows:
26118 If the string begins with a slash, Exim uses it as a file name, and reads its
26119 contents as an ACL. The lines are processed in the same way as lines in the
26120 Exim configuration file. In particular, continuation lines are supported, blank
26121 lines are ignored, as are lines whose first non-whitespace character is &"#"&.
26122 If the file does not exist or cannot be read, an error occurs (typically
26123 causing a temporary failure of whatever caused the ACL to be run). For example:
26125 acl_smtp_data = /etc/acls/\
26126 ${lookup{$sender_host_address}lsearch\
26127 {/etc/acllist}{$value}{default}}
26129 This looks up an ACL file to use on the basis of the host's IP address, falling
26130 back to a default if the lookup fails. If an ACL is successfully read from a
26131 file, it is retained in memory for the duration of the Exim process, so that it
26132 can be re-used without having to re-read the file.
26134 If the string does not start with a slash, and does not contain any spaces,
26135 Exim searches the ACL section of the configuration for an ACL whose name
26136 matches the string.
26138 If no named ACL is found, or if the string contains spaces, Exim parses
26139 the string as an inline ACL. This can save typing in cases where you just
26140 want to have something like
26142 acl_smtp_vrfy = accept
26144 in order to allow free use of the VRFY command. Such a string may contain
26145 newlines; it is processed in the same way as an ACL that is read from a file.
26151 .section "ACL return codes" "SECID196"
26152 .cindex "&ACL;" "return codes"
26153 Except for the QUIT ACL, which does not affect the SMTP return code (see
26154 section &<<SECTQUITACL>>& above), the result of running an ACL is either
26155 &"accept"& or &"deny"&, or, if some test cannot be completed (for example, if a
26156 database is down), &"defer"&. These results cause 2&'xx'&, 5&'xx'&, and 4&'xx'&
26157 return codes, respectively, to be used in the SMTP dialogue. A fourth return,
26158 &"error"&, occurs when there is an error such as invalid syntax in the ACL.
26159 This also causes a 4&'xx'& return code.
26161 For the non-SMTP ACL, &"defer"& and &"error"& are treated in the same way as
26162 &"deny"&, because there is no mechanism for passing temporary errors to the
26163 submitters of non-SMTP messages.
26166 ACLs that are relevant to message reception may also return &"discard"&. This
26167 has the effect of &"accept"&, but causes either the entire message or an
26168 individual recipient address to be discarded. In other words, it is a
26169 blackholing facility. Use it with care.
26171 If the ACL for MAIL returns &"discard"&, all recipients are discarded, and no
26172 ACL is run for subsequent RCPT commands. The effect of &"discard"& in a
26173 RCPT ACL is to discard just the one recipient address. If there are no
26174 recipients left when the message's data is received, the DATA ACL is not
26175 run. A &"discard"& return from the DATA or the non-SMTP ACL discards all the
26176 remaining recipients. The &"discard"& return is not permitted for the
26177 &%acl_smtp_predata%& ACL.
26180 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "when all recipients discarded"
26181 The &[local_scan()]& function is always run, even if there are no remaining
26182 recipients; it may create new recipients.
26186 .section "Unset ACL options" "SECID197"
26187 .cindex "&ACL;" "unset options"
26188 The default actions when any of the &%acl_%&&'xxx'& options are unset are not
26189 all the same. &*Note*&: These defaults apply only when the relevant ACL is
26190 not defined at all. For any defined ACL, the default action when control
26191 reaches the end of the ACL statements is &"deny"&.
26193 For &%acl_smtp_quit%& and &%acl_not_smtp_start%& there is no default because
26194 these two are ACLs that are used only for their side effects. They cannot be
26195 used to accept or reject anything.
26197 For &%acl_not_smtp%&, &%acl_smtp_auth%&, &%acl_smtp_connect%&,
26198 &%acl_smtp_data%&, &%acl_smtp_helo%&, &%acl_smtp_mail%&, &%acl_smtp_mailauth%&,
26199 &%acl_smtp_mime%&, &%acl_smtp_predata%&, and &%acl_smtp_starttls%&, the action
26200 when the ACL is not defined is &"accept"&.
26202 For the others (&%acl_smtp_etrn%&, &%acl_smtp_expn%&, &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&, and
26203 &%acl_smtp_vrfy%&), the action when the ACL is not defined is &"deny"&.
26204 This means that &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& must be defined in order to receive any
26205 messages over an SMTP connection. For an example, see the ACL in the default
26206 configuration file.
26211 .section "Data for message ACLs" "SECID198"
26212 .cindex "&ACL;" "data for message ACL"
26214 .vindex &$local_part$&
26215 .vindex &$sender_address$&
26216 .vindex &$sender_host_address$&
26217 .vindex &$smtp_command$&
26218 When a MAIL or RCPT ACL, or either of the DATA ACLs, is running, the variables
26219 that contain information about the host and the message's sender (for example,
26220 &$sender_host_address$& and &$sender_address$&) are set, and can be used in ACL
26221 statements. In the case of RCPT (but not MAIL or DATA), &$domain$& and
26222 &$local_part$& are set from the argument address. The entire SMTP command
26223 is available in &$smtp_command$&.
26225 When an ACL for the AUTH parameter of MAIL is running, the variables that
26226 contain information about the host are set, but &$sender_address$& is not yet
26227 set. Section &<<SECTauthparamail>>& contains a discussion of this parameter and
26230 .vindex "&$message_size$&"
26231 The &$message_size$& variable is set to the value of the SIZE parameter on
26232 the MAIL command at MAIL, RCPT and pre-data time, or to -1 if
26233 that parameter is not given. The value is updated to the true message size by
26234 the time the final DATA ACL is run (after the message data has been
26237 .vindex "&$rcpt_count$&"
26238 .vindex "&$recipients_count$&"
26239 The &$rcpt_count$& variable increases by one for each RCPT command received.
26240 The &$recipients_count$& variable increases by one each time a RCPT command is
26241 accepted, so while an ACL for RCPT is being processed, it contains the number
26242 of previously accepted recipients. At DATA time (for both the DATA ACLs),
26243 &$rcpt_count$& contains the total number of RCPT commands, and
26244 &$recipients_count$& contains the total number of accepted recipients.
26250 .section "Data for non-message ACLs" "SECTdatfornon"
26251 .cindex "&ACL;" "data for non-message ACL"
26252 .vindex &$smtp_command_argument$&
26253 .vindex &$smtp_command$&
26254 When an ACL is being run for AUTH, EHLO, ETRN, EXPN, HELO, STARTTLS, or VRFY,
26255 the remainder of the SMTP command line is placed in &$smtp_command_argument$&,
26256 and the entire SMTP command is available in &$smtp_command$&.
26257 These variables can be tested using a &%condition%& condition. For example,
26258 here is an ACL for use with AUTH, which insists that either the session is
26259 encrypted, or the CRAM-MD5 authentication method is used. In other words, it
26260 does not permit authentication methods that use cleartext passwords on
26261 unencrypted connections.
26264 accept encrypted = *
26265 accept condition = ${if eq{${uc:$smtp_command_argument}}\
26267 deny message = TLS encryption or CRAM-MD5 required
26269 (Another way of applying this restriction is to arrange for the authenticators
26270 that use cleartext passwords not to be advertised when the connection is not
26271 encrypted. You can use the generic &%server_advertise_condition%& authenticator
26272 option to do this.)
26276 .section "Format of an ACL" "SECID199"
26277 .cindex "&ACL;" "format of"
26278 .cindex "&ACL;" "verbs, definition of"
26279 An individual ACL consists of a number of statements. Each statement starts
26280 with a verb, optionally followed by a number of conditions and &"modifiers"&.
26281 Modifiers can change the way the verb operates, define error and log messages,
26282 set variables, insert delays, and vary the processing of accepted messages.
26284 If all the conditions are met, the verb is obeyed. The same condition may be
26285 used (with different arguments) more than once in the same statement. This
26286 provides a means of specifying an &"and"& conjunction between conditions. For
26289 deny dnslists = list1.example
26290 dnslists = list2.example
26292 If there are no conditions, the verb is always obeyed. Exim stops evaluating
26293 the conditions and modifiers when it reaches a condition that fails. What
26294 happens then depends on the verb (and in one case, on a special modifier). Not
26295 all the conditions make sense at every testing point. For example, you cannot
26296 test a sender address in the ACL that is run for a VRFY command.
26299 .section "ACL verbs" "SECID200"
26300 The ACL verbs are as follows:
26303 .cindex "&%accept%& ACL verb"
26304 &%accept%&: If all the conditions are met, the ACL returns &"accept"&. If any
26305 of the conditions are not met, what happens depends on whether &%endpass%&
26306 appears among the conditions (for syntax see below). If the failing condition
26307 is before &%endpass%&, control is passed to the next ACL statement; if it is
26308 after &%endpass%&, the ACL returns &"deny"&. Consider this statement, used to
26309 check a RCPT command:
26311 accept domains = +local_domains
26315 If the recipient domain does not match the &%domains%& condition, control
26316 passes to the next statement. If it does match, the recipient is verified, and
26317 the command is accepted if verification succeeds. However, if verification
26318 fails, the ACL yields &"deny"&, because the failing condition is after
26321 The &%endpass%& feature has turned out to be confusing to many people, so its
26322 use is not recommended nowadays. It is always possible to rewrite an ACL so
26323 that &%endpass%& is not needed, and it is no longer used in the default
26326 .cindex "&%message%& ACL modifier" "with &%accept%&"
26327 If a &%message%& modifier appears on an &%accept%& statement, its action
26328 depends on whether or not &%endpass%& is present. In the absence of &%endpass%&
26329 (when an &%accept%& verb either accepts or passes control to the next
26330 statement), &%message%& can be used to vary the message that is sent when an
26331 SMTP command is accepted. For example, in a RCPT ACL you could have:
26333 &`accept `&<&'some conditions'&>
26334 &` message = OK, I will allow you through today`&
26336 You can specify an SMTP response code, optionally followed by an &"extended
26337 response code"& at the start of the message, but the first digit must be the
26338 same as would be sent by default, which is 2 for an &%accept%& verb.
26340 If &%endpass%& is present in an &%accept%& statement, &%message%& specifies
26341 an error message that is used when access is denied. This behaviour is retained
26342 for backward compatibility, but current &"best practice"& is to avoid the use
26347 .cindex "&%defer%& ACL verb"
26348 &%defer%&: If all the conditions are true, the ACL returns &"defer"& which, in
26349 an SMTP session, causes a 4&'xx'& response to be given. For a non-SMTP ACL,
26350 &%defer%& is the same as &%deny%&, because there is no way of sending a
26351 temporary error. For a RCPT command, &%defer%& is much the same as using a
26352 &(redirect)& router and &`:defer:`& while verifying, but the &%defer%& verb can
26353 be used in any ACL, and even for a recipient it might be a simpler approach.
26357 .cindex "&%deny%& ACL verb"
26358 &%deny%&: If all the conditions are met, the ACL returns &"deny"&. If any of
26359 the conditions are not met, control is passed to the next ACL statement. For
26362 deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org
26364 rejects commands from hosts that are on a DNS black list.
26368 .cindex "&%discard%& ACL verb"
26369 &%discard%&: This verb behaves like &%accept%&, except that it returns
26370 &"discard"& from the ACL instead of &"accept"&. It is permitted only on ACLs
26371 that are concerned with receiving messages. When all the conditions are true,
26372 the sending entity receives a &"success"& response. However, &%discard%& causes
26373 recipients to be discarded. If it is used in an ACL for RCPT, just the one
26374 recipient is discarded; if used for MAIL, DATA or in the non-SMTP ACL, all the
26375 message's recipients are discarded. Recipients that are discarded before DATA
26376 do not appear in the log line when the &%received_recipients%& log selector is set.
26378 If the &%log_message%& modifier is set when &%discard%& operates,
26379 its contents are added to the line that is automatically written to the log.
26380 The &%message%& modifier operates exactly as it does for &%accept%&.
26384 .cindex "&%drop%& ACL verb"
26385 &%drop%&: This verb behaves like &%deny%&, except that an SMTP connection is
26386 forcibly closed after the 5&'xx'& error message has been sent. For example:
26388 drop message = I don't take more than 20 RCPTs
26389 condition = ${if > {$rcpt_count}{20}}
26391 There is no difference between &%deny%& and &%drop%& for the connect-time ACL.
26392 The connection is always dropped after sending a 550 response.
26395 .cindex "&%require%& ACL verb"
26396 &%require%&: If all the conditions are met, control is passed to the next ACL
26397 statement. If any of the conditions are not met, the ACL returns &"deny"&. For
26398 example, when checking a RCPT command,
26400 require message = Sender did not verify
26403 passes control to subsequent statements only if the message's sender can be
26404 verified. Otherwise, it rejects the command. Note the positioning of the
26405 &%message%& modifier, before the &%verify%& condition. The reason for this is
26406 discussed in section &<<SECTcondmodproc>>&.
26409 .cindex "&%warn%& ACL verb"
26410 &%warn%&: If all the conditions are true, a line specified by the
26411 &%log_message%& modifier is written to Exim's main log. Control always passes
26412 to the next ACL statement. If any condition is false, the log line is not
26413 written. If an identical log line is requested several times in the same
26414 message, only one copy is actually written to the log. If you want to force
26415 duplicates to be written, use the &%logwrite%& modifier instead.
26417 If &%log_message%& is not present, a &%warn%& verb just checks its conditions
26418 and obeys any &"immediate"& modifiers (such as &%control%&, &%set%&,
26419 &%logwrite%&, and &%add_header%&) that appear before the first failing
26420 condition. There is more about adding header lines in section
26421 &<<SECTaddheadacl>>&.
26423 If any condition on a &%warn%& statement cannot be completed (that is, there is
26424 some sort of defer), the log line specified by &%log_message%& is not written.
26425 This does not include the case of a forced failure from a lookup, which
26426 is considered to be a successful completion. After a defer, no further
26427 conditions or modifiers in the &%warn%& statement are processed. The incident
26428 is logged, and the ACL continues to be processed, from the next statement
26432 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
26433 When one of the &%warn%& conditions is an address verification that fails, the
26434 text of the verification failure message is in &$acl_verify_message$&. If you
26435 want this logged, you must set it up explicitly. For example:
26437 warn !verify = sender
26438 log_message = sender verify failed: $acl_verify_message
26442 At the end of each ACL there is an implicit unconditional &%deny%&.
26444 As you can see from the examples above, the conditions and modifiers are
26445 written one to a line, with the first one on the same line as the verb, and
26446 subsequent ones on following lines. If you have a very long condition, you can
26447 continue it onto several physical lines by the usual backslash continuation
26448 mechanism. It is conventional to align the conditions vertically.
26452 .section "ACL variables" "SECTaclvariables"
26453 .cindex "&ACL;" "variables"
26454 There are some special variables that can be set during ACL processing. They
26455 can be used to pass information between different ACLs, different invocations
26456 of the same ACL in the same SMTP connection, and between ACLs and the routers,
26457 transports, and filters that are used to deliver a message. The names of these
26458 variables must begin with &$acl_c$& or &$acl_m$&, followed either by a digit or
26459 an underscore, but the remainder of the name can be any sequence of
26460 alphanumeric characters and underscores that you choose. There is no limit on
26461 the number of ACL variables. The two sets act as follows:
26463 The values of those variables whose names begin with &$acl_c$& persist
26464 throughout an SMTP connection. They are never reset. Thus, a value that is set
26465 while receiving one message is still available when receiving the next message
26466 on the same SMTP connection.
26468 The values of those variables whose names begin with &$acl_m$& persist only
26469 while a message is being received. They are reset afterwards. They are also
26470 reset by MAIL, RSET, EHLO, HELO, and after starting up a TLS session.
26473 When a message is accepted, the current values of all the ACL variables are
26474 preserved with the message and are subsequently made available at delivery
26475 time. The ACL variables are set by a modifier called &%set%&. For example:
26477 accept hosts = whatever
26478 set acl_m4 = some value
26479 accept authenticated = *
26480 set acl_c_auth = yes
26482 &*Note*&: A leading dollar sign is not used when naming a variable that is to
26483 be set. If you want to set a variable without taking any action, you can use a
26484 &%warn%& verb without any other modifiers or conditions.
26486 .oindex &%strict_acl_vars%&
26487 What happens if a syntactically valid but undefined ACL variable is
26488 referenced depends on the setting of the &%strict_acl_vars%& option. If it is
26489 false (the default), an empty string is substituted; if it is true, an
26490 error is generated.
26492 Versions of Exim before 4.64 have a limited set of numbered variables, but
26493 their names are compatible, so there is no problem with upgrading.
26496 .section "Condition and modifier processing" "SECTcondmodproc"
26497 .cindex "&ACL;" "conditions; processing"
26498 .cindex "&ACL;" "modifiers; processing"
26499 An exclamation mark preceding a condition negates its result. For example:
26501 deny domains = *.dom.example
26502 !verify = recipient
26504 causes the ACL to return &"deny"& if the recipient domain ends in
26505 &'dom.example'& and the recipient address cannot be verified. Sometimes
26506 negation can be used on the right-hand side of a condition. For example, these
26507 two statements are equivalent:
26509 deny hosts = !192.168.3.4
26510 deny !hosts = 192.168.3.4
26512 However, for many conditions (&%verify%& being a good example), only left-hand
26513 side negation of the whole condition is possible.
26515 The arguments of conditions and modifiers are expanded. A forced failure
26516 of an expansion causes a condition to be ignored, that is, it behaves as if the
26517 condition is true. Consider these two statements:
26519 accept senders = ${lookup{$host_name}lsearch\
26520 {/some/file}{$value}fail}
26521 accept senders = ${lookup{$host_name}lsearch\
26522 {/some/file}{$value}{}}
26524 Each attempts to look up a list of acceptable senders. If the lookup succeeds,
26525 the returned list is searched, but if the lookup fails the behaviour is
26526 different in the two cases. The &%fail%& in the first statement causes the
26527 condition to be ignored, leaving no further conditions. The &%accept%& verb
26528 therefore succeeds. The second statement, however, generates an empty list when
26529 the lookup fails. No sender can match an empty list, so the condition fails,
26530 and therefore the &%accept%& also fails.
26532 ACL modifiers appear mixed in with conditions in ACL statements. Some of them
26533 specify actions that are taken as the conditions for a statement are checked;
26534 others specify text for messages that are used when access is denied or a
26535 warning is generated. The &%control%& modifier affects the way an incoming
26536 message is handled.
26538 The positioning of the modifiers in an ACL statement important, because the
26539 processing of a verb ceases as soon as its outcome is known. Only those
26540 modifiers that have already been encountered will take effect. For example,
26541 consider this use of the &%message%& modifier:
26543 require message = Can't verify sender
26545 message = Can't verify recipient
26547 message = This message cannot be used
26549 If sender verification fails, Exim knows that the result of the statement is
26550 &"deny"&, so it goes no further. The first &%message%& modifier has been seen,
26551 so its text is used as the error message. If sender verification succeeds, but
26552 recipient verification fails, the second message is used. If recipient
26553 verification succeeds, the third message becomes &"current"&, but is never used
26554 because there are no more conditions to cause failure.
26556 For the &%deny%& verb, on the other hand, it is always the last &%message%&
26557 modifier that is used, because all the conditions must be true for rejection to
26558 happen. Specifying more than one &%message%& modifier does not make sense, and
26559 the message can even be specified after all the conditions. For example:
26562 !senders = *@my.domain.example
26563 message = Invalid sender from client host
26565 The &"deny"& result does not happen until the end of the statement is reached,
26566 by which time Exim has set up the message.
26570 .section "ACL modifiers" "SECTACLmodi"
26571 .cindex "&ACL;" "modifiers; list of"
26572 The ACL modifiers are as follows:
26575 .vitem &*add_header*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
26576 This modifier specifies one or more header lines that are to be added to an
26577 incoming message, assuming, of course, that the message is ultimately
26578 accepted. For details, see section &<<SECTaddheadacl>>&.
26580 .vitem &*continue*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
26581 .cindex "&%continue%& ACL modifier"
26582 .cindex "database" "updating in ACL"
26583 This modifier does nothing of itself, and processing of the ACL always
26584 continues with the next condition or modifier. The value of &%continue%& is in
26585 the side effects of expanding its argument. Typically this could be used to
26586 update a database. It is really just a syntactic tidiness, to avoid having to
26587 write rather ugly lines like this:
26589 &`condition = ${if eq{0}{`&<&'some expansion'&>&`}{true}{true}}`&
26591 Instead, all you need is
26593 &`continue = `&<&'some expansion'&>
26596 .vitem &*control*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
26597 .cindex "&%control%& ACL modifier"
26598 This modifier affects the subsequent processing of the SMTP connection or of an
26599 incoming message that is accepted. The effect of the first type of control
26600 lasts for the duration of the connection, whereas the effect of the second type
26601 lasts only until the current message has been received. The message-specific
26602 controls always apply to the whole message, not to individual recipients,
26603 even if the &%control%& modifier appears in a RCPT ACL.
26605 As there are now quite a few controls that can be applied, they are described
26606 separately in section &<<SECTcontrols>>&. The &%control%& modifier can be used
26607 in several different ways. For example:
26609 . ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
26610 . ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left. That comment applies only
26611 . ==== when xmlto and fop are used; formatting with sdop gets it right either
26615 It can be at the end of an &%accept%& statement:
26617 accept ...some conditions
26618 control = queue_only
26620 In this case, the control is applied when this statement yields &"accept"&, in
26621 other words, when the conditions are all true.
26624 It can be in the middle of an &%accept%& statement:
26626 accept ...some conditions...
26627 control = queue_only
26628 ...some more conditions...
26630 If the first set of conditions are true, the control is applied, even if the
26631 statement does not accept because one of the second set of conditions is false.
26632 In this case, some subsequent statement must yield &"accept"& for the control
26636 It can be used with &%warn%& to apply the control, leaving the
26637 decision about accepting or denying to a subsequent verb. For
26640 warn ...some conditions...
26644 This example of &%warn%& does not contain &%message%&, &%log_message%&, or
26645 &%logwrite%&, so it does not add anything to the message and does not write a
26649 If you want to apply a control unconditionally, you can use it with a
26650 &%require%& verb. For example:
26652 require control = no_multiline_responses
26656 .vitem &*delay*&&~=&~<&'time'&>
26657 .cindex "&%delay%& ACL modifier"
26659 This modifier may appear in any ACL. It causes Exim to wait for the time
26660 interval before proceeding. However, when testing Exim using the &%-bh%&
26661 option, the delay is not actually imposed (an appropriate message is output
26662 instead). The time is given in the usual Exim notation, and the delay happens
26663 as soon as the modifier is processed. In an SMTP session, pending output is
26664 flushed before the delay is imposed.
26666 Like &%control%&, &%delay%& can be used with &%accept%& or &%deny%&, for
26669 deny ...some conditions...
26672 The delay happens if all the conditions are true, before the statement returns
26673 &"deny"&. Compare this with:
26676 ...some conditions...
26678 which waits for 30s before processing the conditions. The &%delay%& modifier
26679 can also be used with &%warn%& and together with &%control%&:
26681 warn ...some conditions...
26687 If &%delay%& is encountered when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in use,
26688 responses to several commands are no longer buffered and sent in one packet (as
26689 they would normally be) because all output is flushed before imposing the
26690 delay. This optimization is disabled so that a number of small delays do not
26691 appear to the client as one large aggregated delay that might provoke an
26692 unwanted timeout. You can, however, disable output flushing for &%delay%& by
26693 using a &%control%& modifier to set &%no_delay_flush%&.
26697 .cindex "&%endpass%& ACL modifier"
26698 This modifier, which has no argument, is recognized only in &%accept%& and
26699 &%discard%& statements. It marks the boundary between the conditions whose
26700 failure causes control to pass to the next statement, and the conditions whose
26701 failure causes the ACL to return &"deny"&. This concept has proved to be
26702 confusing to some people, so the use of &%endpass%& is no longer recommended as
26703 &"best practice"&. See the description of &%accept%& above for more details.
26706 .vitem &*log_message*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
26707 .cindex "&%log_message%& ACL modifier"
26708 This modifier sets up a message that is used as part of the log message if the
26709 ACL denies access or a &%warn%& statement's conditions are true. For example:
26711 require log_message = wrong cipher suite $tls_in_cipher
26712 encrypted = DES-CBC3-SHA
26714 &%log_message%& is also used when recipients are discarded by &%discard%&. For
26717 &`discard `&<&'some conditions'&>
26718 &` log_message = Discarded $local_part@$domain because...`&
26720 When access is denied, &%log_message%& adds to any underlying error message
26721 that may exist because of a condition failure. For example, while verifying a
26722 recipient address, a &':fail:'& redirection might have already set up a
26725 The message may be defined before the conditions to which it applies, because
26726 the string expansion does not happen until Exim decides that access is to be
26727 denied. This means that any variables that are set by the condition are
26728 available for inclusion in the message. For example, the &$dnslist_$&<&'xxx'&>
26729 variables are set after a DNS black list lookup succeeds. If the expansion of
26730 &%log_message%& fails, or if the result is an empty string, the modifier is
26733 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
26734 If you want to use a &%warn%& statement to log the result of an address
26735 verification, you can use &$acl_verify_message$& to include the verification
26738 If &%log_message%& is used with a &%warn%& statement, &"Warning:"& is added to
26739 the start of the logged message. If the same warning log message is requested
26740 more than once while receiving a single email message, only one copy is
26741 actually logged. If you want to log multiple copies, use &%logwrite%& instead
26742 of &%log_message%&. In the absence of &%log_message%& and &%logwrite%&, nothing
26743 is logged for a successful &%warn%& statement.
26745 If &%log_message%& is not present and there is no underlying error message (for
26746 example, from the failure of address verification), but &%message%& is present,
26747 the &%message%& text is used for logging rejections. However, if any text for
26748 logging contains newlines, only the first line is logged. In the absence of
26749 both &%log_message%& and &%message%&, a default built-in message is used for
26750 logging rejections.
26753 .vitem "&*log_reject_target*&&~=&~<&'log name list'&>"
26754 .cindex "&%log_reject_target%& ACL modifier"
26755 .cindex "logging in ACL" "specifying which log"
26756 This modifier makes it possible to specify which logs are used for messages
26757 about ACL rejections. Its argument is a colon-separated list of words that can
26758 be &"main"&, &"reject"&, or &"panic"&. The default is &`main:reject`&. The list
26759 may be empty, in which case a rejection is not logged at all. For example, this
26760 ACL fragment writes no logging information when access is denied:
26762 &`deny `&<&'some conditions'&>
26763 &` log_reject_target =`&
26765 This modifier can be used in SMTP and non-SMTP ACLs. It applies to both
26766 permanent and temporary rejections. Its effect lasts for the rest of the
26770 .vitem &*logwrite*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
26771 .cindex "&%logwrite%& ACL modifier"
26772 .cindex "logging in ACL" "immediate"
26773 This modifier writes a message to a log file as soon as it is encountered when
26774 processing an ACL. (Compare &%log_message%&, which, except in the case of
26775 &%warn%& and &%discard%&, is used only if the ACL statement denies
26776 access.) The &%logwrite%& modifier can be used to log special incidents in
26779 &`accept `&<&'some special conditions'&>
26780 &` control = freeze`&
26781 &` logwrite = froze message because ...`&
26783 By default, the message is written to the main log. However, it may begin
26784 with a colon, followed by a comma-separated list of log names, and then
26785 another colon, to specify exactly which logs are to be written. For
26788 logwrite = :main,reject: text for main and reject logs
26789 logwrite = :panic: text for panic log only
26793 .vitem &*message*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
26794 .cindex "&%message%& ACL modifier"
26795 This modifier sets up a text string that is expanded and used as a response
26796 message when an ACL statement terminates the ACL with an &"accept"&, &"deny"&,
26797 or &"defer"& response. (In the case of the &%accept%& and &%discard%& verbs,
26798 there is some complication if &%endpass%& is involved; see the description of
26799 &%accept%& for details.)
26801 The expansion of the message happens at the time Exim decides that the ACL is
26802 to end, not at the time it processes &%message%&. If the expansion fails, or
26803 generates an empty string, the modifier is ignored. Here is an example where
26804 &%message%& must be specified first, because the ACL ends with a rejection if
26805 the &%hosts%& condition fails:
26807 require message = Host not recognized
26810 (Once a condition has failed, no further conditions or modifiers are
26813 .cindex "SMTP" "error codes"
26814 .oindex "&%smtp_banner%&
26815 For ACLs that are triggered by SMTP commands, the message is returned as part
26816 of the SMTP response. The use of &%message%& with &%accept%& (or &%discard%&)
26817 is meaningful only for SMTP, as no message is returned when a non-SMTP message
26818 is accepted. In the case of the connect ACL, accepting with a message modifier
26819 overrides the value of &%smtp_banner%&. For the EHLO/HELO ACL, a customized
26820 accept message may not contain more than one line (otherwise it will be
26821 truncated at the first newline and a panic logged), and it cannot affect the
26824 When SMTP is involved, the message may begin with an overriding response code,
26825 consisting of three digits optionally followed by an &"extended response code"&
26826 of the form &'n.n.n'&, each code being followed by a space. For example:
26828 deny message = 599 1.2.3 Host not welcome
26829 hosts = 192.168.34.0/24
26831 The first digit of the supplied response code must be the same as would be sent
26832 by default. A panic occurs if it is not. Exim uses a 550 code when it denies
26833 access, but for the predata ACL, note that the default success code is 354, not
26836 Notwithstanding the previous paragraph, for the QUIT ACL, unlike the others,
26837 the message modifier cannot override the 221 response code.
26839 The text in a &%message%& modifier is literal; any quotes are taken as
26840 literals, but because the string is expanded, backslash escapes are processed
26841 anyway. If the message contains newlines, this gives rise to a multi-line SMTP
26844 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
26845 If &%message%& is used on a statement that verifies an address, the message
26846 specified overrides any message that is generated by the verification process.
26847 However, the original message is available in the variable
26848 &$acl_verify_message$&, so you can incorporate it into your message if you
26849 wish. In particular, if you want the text from &%:fail:%& items in &(redirect)&
26850 routers to be passed back as part of the SMTP response, you should either not
26851 use a &%message%& modifier, or make use of &$acl_verify_message$&.
26853 For compatibility with previous releases of Exim, a &%message%& modifier that
26854 is used with a &%warn%& verb behaves in a similar way to the &%add_header%&
26855 modifier, but this usage is now deprecated. However, &%message%& acts only when
26856 all the conditions are true, wherever it appears in an ACL command, whereas
26857 &%add_header%& acts as soon as it is encountered. If &%message%& is used with
26858 &%warn%& in an ACL that is not concerned with receiving a message, it has no
26862 .vitem &*set*&&~<&'acl_name'&>&~=&~<&'value'&>
26863 .cindex "&%set%& ACL modifier"
26864 This modifier puts a value into one of the ACL variables (see section
26865 &<<SECTaclvariables>>&).
26872 .section "Use of the control modifier" "SECTcontrols"
26873 .cindex "&%control%& ACL modifier"
26874 The &%control%& modifier supports the following settings:
26877 .vitem &*control&~=&~allow_auth_unadvertised*&
26878 This modifier allows a client host to use the SMTP AUTH command even when it
26879 has not been advertised in response to EHLO. Furthermore, because there are
26880 apparently some really broken clients that do this, Exim will accept AUTH after
26881 HELO (rather than EHLO) when this control is set. It should be used only if you
26882 really need it, and you should limit its use to those broken clients that do
26883 not work without it. For example:
26885 warn hosts = 192.168.34.25
26886 control = allow_auth_unadvertised
26888 Normally, when an Exim server receives an AUTH command, it checks the name of
26889 the authentication mechanism that is given in the command to ensure that it
26890 matches an advertised mechanism. When this control is set, the check that a
26891 mechanism has been advertised is bypassed. Any configured mechanism can be used
26892 by the client. This control is permitted only in the connection and HELO ACLs.
26895 .vitem &*control&~=&~caseful_local_part*& &&&
26896 &*control&~=&~caselower_local_part*&
26897 .cindex "&ACL;" "case of local part in"
26898 .cindex "case of local parts"
26899 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
26900 These two controls are permitted only in the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&
26901 (that is, during RCPT processing). By default, the contents of &$local_part$&
26902 are lower cased before ACL processing. If &"caseful_local_part"& is specified,
26903 any uppercase letters in the original local part are restored in &$local_part$&
26904 for the rest of the ACL, or until a control that sets &"caselower_local_part"&
26907 These controls affect only the current recipient. Moreover, they apply only to
26908 local part handling that takes place directly in the ACL (for example, as a key
26909 in lookups). If a test to verify the recipient is obeyed, the case-related
26910 handling of the local part during the verification is controlled by the router
26911 configuration (see the &%caseful_local_part%& generic router option).
26913 This facility could be used, for example, to add a spam score to local parts
26914 containing upper case letters. For example, using &$acl_m4$& to accumulate the
26917 warn control = caseful_local_part
26918 set acl_m4 = ${eval:\
26920 ${if match{$local_part}{[A-Z]}{1}{0}}\
26922 control = caselower_local_part
26924 Notice that we put back the lower cased version afterwards, assuming that
26925 is what is wanted for subsequent tests.
26929 .vitem &*control&~=&~cutthrough_delivery*&
26930 .cindex "&ACL;" "cutthrough routing"
26931 This option requests delivery be attempted while the item is being received.
26932 It is usable in the RCPT ACL and valid only for single-recipient mails forwarded
26933 from one SMTP connection to another. If a recipient-verify callout connection is
26934 requested in the same ACL it is held open and used for the data, otherwise one is made
26935 after the ACL completes.
26937 Should the ultimate destination system positively accept or reject the mail,
26938 a corresponding indication is given to the source system and nothing is queued.
26939 If there is a temporary error the item is queued for later delivery in the
26940 usual fashion. If the item is successfully delivered in cutthrough mode the log line
26941 is tagged with ">>" rather than "=>" and appears before the acceptance "<="
26944 Delivery in this mode avoids the generation of a bounce mail to a (possibly faked)
26945 sender when the destination system is doing content-scan based rejection.
26950 .vitem &*control&~=&~dscp/*&<&'value'&>
26951 .cindex "&ACL;" "setting DSCP value"
26952 .cindex "DSCP" "inbound"
26953 This option causes the DSCP value associated with the socket for the inbound
26954 connection to be adjusted to a given value, given as one of a number of fixed
26955 strings or to numeric value.
26956 The &%-bI:dscp%& option may be used to ask Exim which names it knows of.
26957 Common values include &`throughput`&, &`mincost`&, and on newer systems
26958 &`ef`&, &`af41`&, etc. Numeric values may be in the range 0 to 0x3F.
26960 The outbound packets from Exim will be marked with this value in the header
26961 (for IPv4, the TOS field; for IPv6, the TCLASS field); there is no guarantee
26962 that these values will have any effect, not be stripped by networking
26963 equipment, or do much of anything without cooperation with your Network
26964 Engineer and those of all network operators between the source and destination.
26968 .vitem &*control&~=&~debug/*&<&'options'&>
26969 .cindex "&ACL;" "enabling debug logging"
26970 .cindex "debugging" "enabling from an ACL"
26971 This control turns on debug logging, almost as though Exim had been invoked
26972 with &`-d`&, with the output going to a new logfile, by default called
26973 &'debuglog'&. The filename can be adjusted with the &'tag'& option, which
26974 may access any variables already defined. The logging may be adjusted with
26975 the &'opts'& option, which takes the same values as the &`-d`& command-line
26976 option. Some examples (which depend on variables that don't exist in all
26980 control = debug/tag=.$sender_host_address
26981 control = debug/opts=+expand+acl
26982 control = debug/tag=.$message_exim_id/opts=+expand
26986 .vitem &*control&~=&~enforce_sync*& &&&
26987 &*control&~=&~no_enforce_sync*&
26988 .cindex "SMTP" "synchronization checking"
26989 .cindex "synchronization checking in SMTP"
26990 These controls make it possible to be selective about when SMTP synchronization
26991 is enforced. The global option &%smtp_enforce_sync%& specifies the initial
26992 state of the switch (it is true by default). See the description of this option
26993 in chapter &<<CHAPmainconfig>>& for details of SMTP synchronization checking.
26995 The effect of these two controls lasts for the remainder of the SMTP
26996 connection. They can appear in any ACL except the one for the non-SMTP
26997 messages. The most straightforward place to put them is in the ACL defined by
26998 &%acl_smtp_connect%&, which is run at the start of an incoming SMTP connection,
26999 before the first synchronization check. The expected use is to turn off the
27000 synchronization checks for badly-behaved hosts that you nevertheless need to
27004 .vitem &*control&~=&~fakedefer/*&<&'message'&>
27005 .cindex "fake defer"
27006 .cindex "defer, fake"
27007 This control works in exactly the same way as &%fakereject%& (described below)
27008 except that it causes an SMTP 450 response after the message data instead of a
27009 550 response. You must take care when using &%fakedefer%& because it causes the
27010 messages to be duplicated when the sender retries. Therefore, you should not
27011 use &%fakedefer%& if the message is to be delivered normally.
27013 .vitem &*control&~=&~fakereject/*&<&'message'&>
27014 .cindex "fake rejection"
27015 .cindex "rejection, fake"
27016 This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, and DATA ACLs, in other
27017 words, only when an SMTP message is being received. If Exim accepts the
27018 message, instead the final 250 response, a 550 rejection message is sent.
27019 However, Exim proceeds to deliver the message as normal. The control applies
27020 only to the current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be received in
27021 the same SMTP connection.
27023 The text for the 550 response is taken from the &%control%& modifier. If no
27024 message is supplied, the following is used:
27026 550-Your message has been rejected but is being
27027 550-kept for evaluation.
27028 550-If it was a legitimate message, it may still be
27029 550 delivered to the target recipient(s).
27031 This facility should be used with extreme caution.
27033 .vitem &*control&~=&~freeze*&
27034 .cindex "frozen messages" "forcing in ACL"
27035 This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, DATA, and non-SMTP ACLs, in
27036 other words, only when a message is being received. If the message is accepted,
27037 it is placed on Exim's queue and frozen. The control applies only to the
27038 current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be received in the same
27041 This modifier can optionally be followed by &`/no_tell`&. If the global option
27042 &%freeze_tell%& is set, it is ignored for the current message (that is, nobody
27043 is told about the freezing), provided all the &*control=freeze*& modifiers that
27044 are obeyed for the current message have the &`/no_tell`& option.
27046 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_delay_flush*&
27047 .cindex "SMTP" "output flushing, disabling for delay"
27048 Exim normally flushes SMTP output before implementing a delay in an ACL, to
27049 avoid unexpected timeouts in clients when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in
27050 use. This control, as long as it is encountered before the &%delay%& modifier,
27051 disables such output flushing.
27053 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_callout_flush*&
27054 .cindex "SMTP" "output flushing, disabling for callout"
27055 Exim normally flushes SMTP output before performing a callout in an ACL, to
27056 avoid unexpected timeouts in clients when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in
27057 use. This control, as long as it is encountered before the &%verify%& condition
27058 that causes the callout, disables such output flushing.
27060 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_mbox_unspool*&
27061 This control is available when Exim is compiled with the content scanning
27062 extension. Content scanning may require a copy of the current message, or parts
27063 of it, to be written in &"mbox format"& to a spool file, for passing to a virus
27064 or spam scanner. Normally, such copies are deleted when they are no longer
27065 needed. If this control is set, the copies are not deleted. The control applies
27066 only to the current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be received in
27067 the same SMTP connection. It is provided for debugging purposes and is unlikely
27068 to be useful in production.
27070 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_multiline_responses*&
27071 .cindex "multiline responses, suppressing"
27072 This control is permitted for any ACL except the one for non-SMTP messages.
27073 It seems that there are broken clients in use that cannot handle multiline
27074 SMTP responses, despite the fact that RFC 821 defined them over 20 years ago.
27076 If this control is set, multiline SMTP responses from ACL rejections are
27077 suppressed. One way of doing this would have been to put out these responses as
27078 one long line. However, RFC 2821 specifies a maximum of 512 bytes per response
27079 (&"use multiline responses for more"& it says &-- ha!), and some of the
27080 responses might get close to that. So this facility, which is after all only a
27081 sop to broken clients, is implemented by doing two very easy things:
27084 Extra information that is normally output as part of a rejection caused by
27085 sender verification failure is omitted. Only the final line (typically &"sender
27086 verification failed"&) is sent.
27088 If a &%message%& modifier supplies a multiline response, only the first
27092 The setting of the switch can, of course, be made conditional on the
27093 calling host. Its effect lasts until the end of the SMTP connection.
27095 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_pipelining*&
27096 .cindex "PIPELINING" "suppressing advertising"
27097 This control turns off the advertising of the PIPELINING extension to SMTP in
27098 the current session. To be useful, it must be obeyed before Exim sends its
27099 response to an EHLO command. Therefore, it should normally appear in an ACL
27100 controlled by &%acl_smtp_connect%& or &%acl_smtp_helo%&. See also
27101 &%pipelining_advertise_hosts%&.
27103 .vitem &*control&~=&~queue_only*&
27104 .oindex "&%queue_only%&"
27105 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
27106 This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, DATA, and non-SMTP ACLs, in
27107 other words, only when a message is being received. If the message is accepted,
27108 it is placed on Exim's queue and left there for delivery by a subsequent queue
27109 runner. No immediate delivery process is started. In other words, it has the
27110 effect as the &%queue_only%& global option. However, the control applies only
27111 to the current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be received in the
27112 same SMTP connection.
27114 .vitem &*control&~=&~submission/*&<&'options'&>
27115 .cindex "message" "submission"
27116 .cindex "submission mode"
27117 This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, and start of data ACLs (the
27118 latter is the one defined by &%acl_smtp_predata%&). Setting it tells Exim that
27119 the current message is a submission from a local MUA. In this case, Exim
27120 operates in &"submission mode"&, and applies certain fixups to the message if
27121 necessary. For example, it adds a &'Date:'& header line if one is not present.
27122 This control is not permitted in the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL, because that is too
27123 late (the message has already been created).
27125 Chapter &<<CHAPmsgproc>>& describes the processing that Exim applies to
27126 messages. Section &<<SECTsubmodnon>>& covers the processing that happens in
27127 submission mode; the available options for this control are described there.
27128 The control applies only to the current message, not to any subsequent ones
27129 that may be received in the same SMTP connection.
27131 .vitem &*control&~=&~suppress_local_fixups*&
27132 .cindex "submission fixups, suppressing"
27133 This control applies to locally submitted (non TCP/IP) messages, and is the
27134 complement of &`control = submission`&. It disables the fixups that are
27135 normally applied to locally-submitted messages. Specifically:
27138 Any &'Sender:'& header line is left alone (in this respect, it is a
27139 dynamic version of &%local_sender_retain%&).
27141 No &'Message-ID:'&, &'From:'&, or &'Date:'& header lines are added.
27143 There is no check that &'From:'& corresponds to the actual sender.
27146 This control may be useful when a remotely-originated message is accepted,
27147 passed to some scanning program, and then re-submitted for delivery. It can be
27148 used only in the &%acl_smtp_mail%&, &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&, &%acl_smtp_predata%&,
27149 and &%acl_not_smtp_start%& ACLs, because it has to be set before the message's
27152 &*Note:*& This control applies only to the current message, not to any others
27153 that are being submitted at the same time using &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&.
27157 .section "Summary of message fixup control" "SECTsummesfix"
27158 All four possibilities for message fixups can be specified:
27161 Locally submitted, fixups applied: the default.
27163 Locally submitted, no fixups applied: use
27164 &`control = suppress_local_fixups`&.
27166 Remotely submitted, no fixups applied: the default.
27168 Remotely submitted, fixups applied: use &`control = submission`&.
27173 .section "Adding header lines in ACLs" "SECTaddheadacl"
27174 .cindex "header lines" "adding in an ACL"
27175 .cindex "header lines" "position of added lines"
27176 .cindex "&%message%& ACL modifier"
27177 The &%add_header%& modifier can be used to add one or more extra header lines
27178 to an incoming message, as in this example:
27180 warn dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
27181 dialup.mail-abuse.org
27182 add_header = X-blacklisted-at: $dnslist_domain
27184 The &%add_header%& modifier is permitted in the MAIL, RCPT, PREDATA, DATA,
27185 MIME, and non-SMTP ACLs (in other words, those that are concerned with
27186 receiving a message). The message must ultimately be accepted for
27187 &%add_header%& to have any significant effect. You can use &%add_header%& with
27188 any ACL verb, including &%deny%& (though this is potentially useful only in a
27191 If the data for the &%add_header%& modifier contains one or more newlines that
27192 are not followed by a space or a tab, it is assumed to contain multiple header
27193 lines. Each one is checked for valid syntax; &`X-ACL-Warn:`& is added to the
27194 front of any line that is not a valid header line.
27196 Added header lines are accumulated during the MAIL, RCPT, and predata ACLs.
27197 They are added to the message before processing the DATA and MIME ACLs.
27198 However, if an identical header line is requested more than once, only one copy
27199 is actually added to the message. Further header lines may be accumulated
27200 during the DATA and MIME ACLs, after which they are added to the message, again
27201 with duplicates suppressed. Thus, it is possible to add two identical header
27202 lines to an SMTP message, but only if one is added before DATA and one after.
27203 In the case of non-SMTP messages, new headers are accumulated during the
27204 non-SMTP ACLs, and are added to the message after all the ACLs have run. If a
27205 message is rejected after DATA or by the non-SMTP ACL, all added header lines
27206 are included in the entry that is written to the reject log.
27208 .cindex "header lines" "added; visibility of"
27209 Header lines are not visible in string expansions until they are added to the
27210 message. It follows that header lines defined in the MAIL, RCPT, and predata
27211 ACLs are not visible until the DATA ACL and MIME ACLs are run. Similarly,
27212 header lines that are added by the DATA or MIME ACLs are not visible in those
27213 ACLs. Because of this restriction, you cannot use header lines as a way of
27214 passing data between (for example) the MAIL and RCPT ACLs. If you want to do
27215 this, you can use ACL variables, as described in section
27216 &<<SECTaclvariables>>&.
27218 The &%add_header%& modifier acts immediately it is encountered during the
27219 processing of an ACL. Notice the difference between these two cases:
27221 &`accept add_header = ADDED: some text`&
27222 &` `&<&'some condition'&>
27224 &`accept `&<&'some condition'&>
27225 &` add_header = ADDED: some text`&
27227 In the first case, the header line is always added, whether or not the
27228 condition is true. In the second case, the header line is added only if the
27229 condition is true. Multiple occurrences of &%add_header%& may occur in the same
27230 ACL statement. All those that are encountered before a condition fails are
27233 .cindex "&%warn%& ACL verb"
27234 For compatibility with previous versions of Exim, a &%message%& modifier for a
27235 &%warn%& verb acts in the same way as &%add_header%&, except that it takes
27236 effect only if all the conditions are true, even if it appears before some of
27237 them. Furthermore, only the last occurrence of &%message%& is honoured. This
27238 usage of &%message%& is now deprecated. If both &%add_header%& and &%message%&
27239 are present on a &%warn%& verb, both are processed according to their
27242 By default, new header lines are added to a message at the end of the existing
27243 header lines. However, you can specify that any particular header line should
27244 be added right at the start (before all the &'Received:'& lines), immediately
27245 after the first block of &'Received:'& lines, or immediately before any line
27246 that is not a &'Received:'& or &'Resent-something:'& header.
27248 This is done by specifying &":at_start:"&, &":after_received:"&, or
27249 &":at_start_rfc:"& (or, for completeness, &":at_end:"&) before the text of the
27250 header line, respectively. (Header text cannot start with a colon, as there has
27251 to be a header name first.) For example:
27253 warn add_header = \
27254 :after_received:X-My-Header: something or other...
27256 If more than one header line is supplied in a single &%add_header%& modifier,
27257 each one is treated independently and can therefore be placed differently. If
27258 you add more than one line at the start, or after the Received: block, they end
27259 up in reverse order.
27261 &*Warning*&: This facility currently applies only to header lines that are
27262 added in an ACL. It does NOT work for header lines that are added in a
27263 system filter or in a router or transport.
27268 .section "ACL conditions" "SECTaclconditions"
27269 .cindex "&ACL;" "conditions; list of"
27270 Some of conditions listed in this section are available only when Exim is
27271 compiled with the content-scanning extension. They are included here briefly
27272 for completeness. More detailed descriptions can be found in the discussion on
27273 content scanning in chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
27275 Not all conditions are relevant in all circumstances. For example, testing
27276 senders and recipients does not make sense in an ACL that is being run as the
27277 result of the arrival of an ETRN command, and checks on message headers can be
27278 done only in the ACLs specified by &%acl_smtp_data%& and &%acl_not_smtp%&. You
27279 can use the same condition (with different parameters) more than once in the
27280 same ACL statement. This provides a way of specifying an &"and"& conjunction.
27281 The conditions are as follows:
27285 .vitem &*acl&~=&~*&<&'name&~of&~acl&~or&~ACL&~string&~or&~file&~name&~'&>
27286 .cindex "&ACL;" "nested"
27287 .cindex "&ACL;" "indirect"
27288 .cindex "&%acl%& ACL condition"
27289 The possible values of the argument are the same as for the
27290 &%acl_smtp_%&&'xxx'& options. The named or inline ACL is run. If it returns
27291 &"accept"& the condition is true; if it returns &"deny"& the condition is
27292 false. If it returns &"defer"&, the current ACL returns &"defer"& unless the
27293 condition is on a &%warn%& verb. In that case, a &"defer"& return makes the
27294 condition false. This means that further processing of the &%warn%& verb
27295 ceases, but processing of the ACL continues.
27297 If the nested &%acl%& returns &"drop"& and the outer condition denies access,
27298 the connection is dropped. If it returns &"discard"&, the verb must be
27299 &%accept%& or &%discard%&, and the action is taken immediately &-- no further
27300 conditions are tested.
27302 ACLs may be nested up to 20 deep; the limit exists purely to catch runaway
27303 loops. This condition allows you to use different ACLs in different
27304 circumstances. For example, different ACLs can be used to handle RCPT commands
27305 for different local users or different local domains.
27307 .vitem &*authenticated&~=&~*&<&'string&~list'&>
27308 .cindex "&%authenticated%& ACL condition"
27309 .cindex "authentication" "ACL checking"
27310 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing for authentication"
27311 If the SMTP connection is not authenticated, the condition is false. Otherwise,
27312 the name of the authenticator is tested against the list. To test for
27313 authentication by any authenticator, you can set
27318 .vitem &*condition&~=&~*&<&'string'&>
27319 .cindex "&%condition%& ACL condition"
27320 .cindex "customizing" "ACL condition"
27321 .cindex "&ACL;" "customized test"
27322 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing, customized"
27323 This feature allows you to make up custom conditions. If the result of
27324 expanding the string is an empty string, the number zero, or one of the strings
27325 &"no"& or &"false"&, the condition is false. If the result is any non-zero
27326 number, or one of the strings &"yes"& or &"true"&, the condition is true. For
27327 any other value, some error is assumed to have occurred, and the ACL returns
27328 &"defer"&. However, if the expansion is forced to fail, the condition is
27329 ignored. The effect is to treat it as true, whether it is positive or
27332 .vitem &*decode&~=&~*&<&'location'&>
27333 .cindex "&%decode%& ACL condition"
27334 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
27335 content-scanning extension, and it is allowed only in the ACL defined by
27336 &%acl_smtp_mime%&. It causes the current MIME part to be decoded into a file.
27337 If all goes well, the condition is true. It is false only if there are
27338 problems such as a syntax error or a memory shortage. For more details, see
27339 chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
27341 .vitem &*demime&~=&~*&<&'extension&~list'&>
27342 .cindex "&%demime%& ACL condition"
27343 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
27344 content-scanning extension. Its use is described in section
27345 &<<SECTdemimecond>>&.
27347 .vitem &*dnslists&~=&~*&<&'list&~of&~domain&~names&~and&~other&~data'&>
27348 .cindex "&%dnslists%& ACL condition"
27349 .cindex "DNS list" "in ACL"
27350 .cindex "black list (DNS)"
27351 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a DNS list"
27352 This condition checks for entries in DNS black lists. These are also known as
27353 &"RBL lists"&, after the original Realtime Blackhole List, but note that the
27354 use of the lists at &'mail-abuse.org'& now carries a charge. There are too many
27355 different variants of this condition to describe briefly here. See sections
27356 &<<SECTmorednslists>>&&--&<<SECTmorednslistslast>>& for details.
27358 .vitem &*domains&~=&~*&<&'domain&~list'&>
27359 .cindex "&%domains%& ACL condition"
27360 .cindex "domain" "ACL checking"
27361 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a recipient domain"
27362 .vindex "&$domain_data$&"
27363 This condition is relevant only after a RCPT command. It checks that the domain
27364 of the recipient address is in the domain list. If percent-hack processing is
27365 enabled, it is done before this test is done. If the check succeeds with a
27366 lookup, the result of the lookup is placed in &$domain_data$& until the next
27369 &*Note carefully*& (because many people seem to fall foul of this): you cannot
27370 use &%domains%& in a DATA ACL.
27373 .vitem &*encrypted&~=&~*&<&'string&~list'&>
27374 .cindex "&%encrypted%& ACL condition"
27375 .cindex "encryption" "checking in an ACL"
27376 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing for encryption"
27377 If the SMTP connection is not encrypted, the condition is false. Otherwise, the
27378 name of the cipher suite in use is tested against the list. To test for
27379 encryption without testing for any specific cipher suite(s), set
27385 .vitem &*hosts&~=&~*&<&'&~host&~list'&>
27386 .cindex "&%hosts%& ACL condition"
27387 .cindex "host" "ACL checking"
27388 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing the client host"
27389 This condition tests that the calling host matches the host list. If you have
27390 name lookups or wildcarded host names and IP addresses in the same host list,
27391 you should normally put the IP addresses first. For example, you could have:
27393 accept hosts = 10.9.8.7 : dbm;/etc/friendly/hosts
27395 The lookup in this example uses the host name for its key. This is implied by
27396 the lookup type &"dbm"&. (For a host address lookup you would use &"net-dbm"&
27397 and it wouldn't matter which way round you had these two items.)
27399 The reason for the problem with host names lies in the left-to-right way that
27400 Exim processes lists. It can test IP addresses without doing any DNS lookups,
27401 but when it reaches an item that requires a host name, it fails if it cannot
27402 find a host name to compare with the pattern. If the above list is given in the
27403 opposite order, the &%accept%& statement fails for a host whose name cannot be
27404 found, even if its IP address is 10.9.8.7.
27406 If you really do want to do the name check first, and still recognize the IP
27407 address even if the name lookup fails, you can rewrite the ACL like this:
27409 accept hosts = dbm;/etc/friendly/hosts
27410 accept hosts = 10.9.8.7
27412 The default action on failing to find the host name is to assume that the host
27413 is not in the list, so the first &%accept%& statement fails. The second
27414 statement can then check the IP address.
27416 .vindex "&$host_data$&"
27417 If a &%hosts%& condition is satisfied by means of a lookup, the result
27418 of the lookup is made available in the &$host_data$& variable. This
27419 allows you, for example, to set up a statement like this:
27421 deny hosts = net-lsearch;/some/file
27422 message = $host_data
27424 which gives a custom error message for each denied host.
27426 .vitem &*local_parts&~=&~*&<&'local&~part&~list'&>
27427 .cindex "&%local_parts%& ACL condition"
27428 .cindex "local part" "ACL checking"
27429 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a local part"
27430 .vindex "&$local_part_data$&"
27431 This condition is relevant only after a RCPT command. It checks that the local
27432 part of the recipient address is in the list. If percent-hack processing is
27433 enabled, it is done before this test. If the check succeeds with a lookup, the
27434 result of the lookup is placed in &$local_part_data$&, which remains set until
27435 the next &%local_parts%& test.
27437 .vitem &*malware&~=&~*&<&'option'&>
27438 .cindex "&%malware%& ACL condition"
27439 .cindex "&ACL;" "virus scanning"
27440 .cindex "&ACL;" "scanning for viruses"
27441 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
27442 content-scanning extension. It causes the incoming message to be scanned for
27443 viruses. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
27445 .vitem &*mime_regex&~=&~*&<&'list&~of&~regular&~expressions'&>
27446 .cindex "&%mime_regex%& ACL condition"
27447 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing by regex matching"
27448 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
27449 content-scanning extension, and it is allowed only in the ACL defined by
27450 &%acl_smtp_mime%&. It causes the current MIME part to be scanned for a match
27451 with any of the regular expressions. For details, see chapter
27454 .vitem &*ratelimit&~=&~*&<&'parameters'&>
27455 .cindex "rate limiting"
27456 This condition can be used to limit the rate at which a user or host submits
27457 messages. Details are given in section &<<SECTratelimiting>>&.
27459 .vitem &*recipients&~=&~*&<&'address&~list'&>
27460 .cindex "&%recipients%& ACL condition"
27461 .cindex "recipient" "ACL checking"
27462 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a recipient"
27463 This condition is relevant only after a RCPT command. It checks the entire
27464 recipient address against a list of recipients.
27466 .vitem &*regex&~=&~*&<&'list&~of&~regular&~expressions'&>
27467 .cindex "&%regex%& ACL condition"
27468 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing by regex matching"
27469 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
27470 content-scanning extension, and is available only in the DATA, MIME, and
27471 non-SMTP ACLs. It causes the incoming message to be scanned for a match with
27472 any of the regular expressions. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
27474 .vitem &*sender_domains&~=&~*&<&'domain&~list'&>
27475 .cindex "&%sender_domains%& ACL condition"
27476 .cindex "sender" "ACL checking"
27477 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a sender domain"
27478 .vindex "&$domain$&"
27479 .vindex "&$sender_address_domain$&"
27480 This condition tests the domain of the sender of the message against the given
27481 domain list. &*Note*&: The domain of the sender address is in
27482 &$sender_address_domain$&. It is &'not'& put in &$domain$& during the testing
27483 of this condition. This is an exception to the general rule for testing domain
27484 lists. It is done this way so that, if this condition is used in an ACL for a
27485 RCPT command, the recipient's domain (which is in &$domain$&) can be used to
27486 influence the sender checking.
27488 &*Warning*&: It is a bad idea to use this condition on its own as a control on
27489 relaying, because sender addresses are easily, and commonly, forged.
27491 .vitem &*senders&~=&~*&<&'address&~list'&>
27492 .cindex "&%senders%& ACL condition"
27493 .cindex "sender" "ACL checking"
27494 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a sender"
27495 This condition tests the sender of the message against the given list. To test
27496 for a bounce message, which has an empty sender, set
27500 &*Warning*&: It is a bad idea to use this condition on its own as a control on
27501 relaying, because sender addresses are easily, and commonly, forged.
27503 .vitem &*spam&~=&~*&<&'username'&>
27504 .cindex "&%spam%& ACL condition"
27505 .cindex "&ACL;" "scanning for spam"
27506 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
27507 content-scanning extension. It causes the incoming message to be scanned by
27508 SpamAssassin. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
27510 .vitem &*verify&~=&~certificate*&
27511 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
27512 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
27513 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
27514 .cindex "&ACL;" "certificate verification"
27515 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a TLS certificate"
27516 This condition is true in an SMTP session if the session is encrypted, and a
27517 certificate was received from the client, and the certificate was verified. The
27518 server requests a certificate only if the client matches &%tls_verify_hosts%&
27519 or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& (see chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&).
27521 .vitem &*verify&~=&~csa*&
27522 .cindex "CSA verification"
27523 This condition checks whether the sending host (the client) is authorized to
27524 send email. Details of how this works are given in section
27525 &<<SECTverifyCSA>>&.
27527 .vitem &*verify&~=&~header_sender/*&<&'options'&>
27528 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
27529 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying sender in the header"
27530 .cindex "header lines" "verifying the sender in"
27531 .cindex "sender" "verifying in header"
27532 .cindex "verifying" "sender in header"
27533 This condition is relevant only in an ACL that is run after a message has been
27534 received, that is, in an ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_data%& or
27535 &%acl_not_smtp%&. It checks that there is a verifiable address in at least one
27536 of the &'Sender:'&, &'Reply-To:'&, or &'From:'& header lines. Such an address
27537 is loosely thought of as a &"sender"& address (hence the name of the test).
27538 However, an address that appears in one of these headers need not be an address
27539 that accepts bounce messages; only sender addresses in envelopes are required
27540 to accept bounces. Therefore, if you use the callout option on this check, you
27541 might want to arrange for a non-empty address in the MAIL command.
27543 Details of address verification and the options are given later, starting at
27544 section &<<SECTaddressverification>>& (callouts are described in section
27545 &<<SECTcallver>>&). You can combine this condition with the &%senders%&
27546 condition to restrict it to bounce messages only:
27549 message = A valid sender header is required for bounces
27550 !verify = header_sender
27553 .vitem &*verify&~=&~header_syntax*&
27554 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
27555 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying header syntax"
27556 .cindex "header lines" "verifying syntax"
27557 .cindex "verifying" "header syntax"
27558 This condition is relevant only in an ACL that is run after a message has been
27559 received, that is, in an ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_data%& or
27560 &%acl_not_smtp%&. It checks the syntax of all header lines that can contain
27561 lists of addresses (&'Sender:'&, &'From:'&, &'Reply-To:'&, &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&,
27562 and &'Bcc:'&). Unqualified addresses (local parts without domains) are
27563 permitted only in locally generated messages and from hosts that match
27564 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& or &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&, as
27567 Note that this condition is a syntax check only. However, a common spamming
27568 ploy used to be to send syntactically invalid headers such as
27572 and this condition can be used to reject such messages, though they are not as
27573 common as they used to be.
27575 .vitem &*verify&~=&~helo*&
27576 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
27577 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying HELO/EHLO"
27578 .cindex "HELO" "verifying"
27579 .cindex "EHLO" "verifying"
27580 .cindex "verifying" "EHLO"
27581 .cindex "verifying" "HELO"
27582 This condition is true if a HELO or EHLO command has been received from the
27583 client host, and its contents have been verified. If there has been no previous
27584 attempt to verify the HELO/EHLO contents, it is carried out when this
27585 condition is encountered. See the description of the &%helo_verify_hosts%& and
27586 &%helo_try_verify_hosts%& options for details of how to request verification
27587 independently of this condition.
27589 For SMTP input that does not come over TCP/IP (the &%-bs%& command line
27590 option), this condition is always true.
27593 .vitem &*verify&~=&~not_blind*&
27594 .cindex "verifying" "not blind"
27595 .cindex "bcc recipients, verifying none"
27596 This condition checks that there are no blind (bcc) recipients in the message.
27597 Every envelope recipient must appear either in a &'To:'& header line or in a
27598 &'Cc:'& header line for this condition to be true. Local parts are checked
27599 case-sensitively; domains are checked case-insensitively. If &'Resent-To:'& or
27600 &'Resent-Cc:'& header lines exist, they are also checked. This condition can be
27601 used only in a DATA or non-SMTP ACL.
27603 There are, of course, many legitimate messages that make use of blind (bcc)
27604 recipients. This check should not be used on its own for blocking messages.
27607 .vitem &*verify&~=&~recipient/*&<&'options'&>
27608 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
27609 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying recipient"
27610 .cindex "recipient" "verifying"
27611 .cindex "verifying" "recipient"
27612 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
27613 This condition is relevant only after a RCPT command. It verifies the current
27614 recipient. Details of address verification are given later, starting at section
27615 &<<SECTaddressverification>>&. After a recipient has been verified, the value
27616 of &$address_data$& is the last value that was set while routing the address.
27617 This applies even if the verification fails. When an address that is being
27618 verified is redirected to a single address, verification continues with the new
27619 address, and in that case, the subsequent value of &$address_data$& is the
27620 value for the child address.
27622 .vitem &*verify&~=&~reverse_host_lookup*&
27623 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
27624 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying host reverse lookup"
27625 .cindex "host" "verifying reverse lookup"
27626 This condition ensures that a verified host name has been looked up from the IP
27627 address of the client host. (This may have happened already if the host name
27628 was needed for checking a host list, or if the host matched &%host_lookup%&.)
27629 Verification ensures that the host name obtained from a reverse DNS lookup, or
27630 one of its aliases, does, when it is itself looked up in the DNS, yield the
27631 original IP address.
27633 If this condition is used for a locally generated message (that is, when there
27634 is no client host involved), it always succeeds.
27636 .vitem &*verify&~=&~sender/*&<&'options'&>
27637 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
27638 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying sender"
27639 .cindex "sender" "verifying"
27640 .cindex "verifying" "sender"
27641 This condition is relevant only after a MAIL or RCPT command, or after a
27642 message has been received (the &%acl_smtp_data%& or &%acl_not_smtp%& ACLs). If
27643 the message's sender is empty (that is, this is a bounce message), the
27644 condition is true. Otherwise, the sender address is verified.
27646 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
27647 .vindex "&$sender_address_data$&"
27648 If there is data in the &$address_data$& variable at the end of routing, its
27649 value is placed in &$sender_address_data$& at the end of verification. This
27650 value can be used in subsequent conditions and modifiers in the same ACL
27651 statement. It does not persist after the end of the current statement. If you
27652 want to preserve the value for longer, you can save it in an ACL variable.
27654 Details of verification are given later, starting at section
27655 &<<SECTaddressverification>>&. Exim caches the result of sender verification,
27656 to avoid doing it more than once per message.
27658 .vitem &*verify&~=&~sender=*&<&'address'&>&*/*&<&'options'&>
27659 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
27660 This is a variation of the previous option, in which a modified address is
27661 verified as a sender.
27666 .section "Using DNS lists" "SECTmorednslists"
27667 .cindex "DNS list" "in ACL"
27668 .cindex "black list (DNS)"
27669 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a DNS list"
27670 In its simplest form, the &%dnslists%& condition tests whether the calling host
27671 is on at least one of a number of DNS lists by looking up the inverted IP
27672 address in one or more DNS domains. (Note that DNS list domains are not mail
27673 domains, so the &`+`& syntax for named lists doesn't work - it is used for
27674 special options instead.) For example, if the calling host's IP
27675 address is 192.168.62.43, and the ACL statement is
27677 deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org : \
27678 dialups.mail-abuse.org
27680 the following records are looked up:
27682 43.62.168.192.blackholes.mail-abuse.org
27683 43.62.168.192.dialups.mail-abuse.org
27685 As soon as Exim finds an existing DNS record, processing of the list stops.
27686 Thus, multiple entries on the list provide an &"or"& conjunction. If you want
27687 to test that a host is on more than one list (an &"and"& conjunction), you can
27688 use two separate conditions:
27690 deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org
27691 dnslists = dialups.mail-abuse.org
27693 If a DNS lookup times out or otherwise fails to give a decisive answer, Exim
27694 behaves as if the host does not match the list item, that is, as if the DNS
27695 record does not exist. If there are further items in the DNS list, they are
27698 This is usually the required action when &%dnslists%& is used with &%deny%&
27699 (which is the most common usage), because it prevents a DNS failure from
27700 blocking mail. However, you can change this behaviour by putting one of the
27701 following special items in the list:
27703 &`+include_unknown `& behave as if the item is on the list
27704 &`+exclude_unknown `& behave as if the item is not on the list (default)
27705 &`+defer_unknown `& give a temporary error
27707 .cindex "&`+include_unknown`&"
27708 .cindex "&`+exclude_unknown`&"
27709 .cindex "&`+defer_unknown`&"
27710 Each of these applies to any subsequent items on the list. For example:
27712 deny dnslists = +defer_unknown : foo.bar.example
27714 Testing the list of domains stops as soon as a match is found. If you want to
27715 warn for one list and block for another, you can use two different statements:
27717 deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org
27718 warn message = X-Warn: sending host is on dialups list
27719 dnslists = dialups.mail-abuse.org
27721 DNS list lookups are cached by Exim for the duration of the SMTP session,
27722 so a lookup based on the IP address is done at most once for any incoming
27723 connection. Exim does not share information between multiple incoming
27724 connections (but your local name server cache should be active).
27728 .section "Specifying the IP address for a DNS list lookup" "SECID201"
27729 .cindex "DNS list" "keyed by explicit IP address"
27730 By default, the IP address that is used in a DNS list lookup is the IP address
27731 of the calling host. However, you can specify another IP address by listing it
27732 after the domain name, introduced by a slash. For example:
27734 deny dnslists = black.list.tld/192.168.1.2
27736 This feature is not very helpful with explicit IP addresses; it is intended for
27737 use with IP addresses that are looked up, for example, the IP addresses of the
27738 MX hosts or nameservers of an email sender address. For an example, see section
27739 &<<SECTmulkeyfor>>& below.
27744 .section "DNS lists keyed on domain names" "SECID202"
27745 .cindex "DNS list" "keyed by domain name"
27746 There are some lists that are keyed on domain names rather than inverted IP
27747 addresses (see for example the &'domain based zones'& link at
27748 &url(http://www.rfc-ignorant.org/)). No reversing of components is used
27749 with these lists. You can change the name that is looked up in a DNS list by
27750 listing it after the domain name, introduced by a slash. For example,
27752 deny message = Sender's domain is listed at $dnslist_domain
27753 dnslists = dsn.rfc-ignorant.org/$sender_address_domain
27755 This particular example is useful only in ACLs that are obeyed after the
27756 RCPT or DATA commands, when a sender address is available. If (for
27757 example) the message's sender is &'user@tld.example'& the name that is looked
27758 up by this example is
27760 tld.example.dsn.rfc-ignorant.org
27762 A single &%dnslists%& condition can contain entries for both names and IP
27763 addresses. For example:
27765 deny dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
27766 dsn.rfc-ignorant.org/$sender_address_domain
27768 The first item checks the sending host's IP address; the second checks a domain
27769 name. The whole condition is true if either of the DNS lookups succeeds.
27774 .section "Multiple explicit keys for a DNS list" "SECTmulkeyfor"
27775 .cindex "DNS list" "multiple keys for"
27776 The syntax described above for looking up explicitly-defined values (either
27777 names or IP addresses) in a DNS blacklist is a simplification. After the domain
27778 name for the DNS list, what follows the slash can in fact be a list of items.
27779 As with all lists in Exim, the default separator is a colon. However, because
27780 this is a sublist within the list of DNS blacklist domains, it is necessary
27781 either to double the separators like this:
27783 dnslists = black.list.tld/name.1::name.2
27785 or to change the separator character, like this:
27787 dnslists = black.list.tld/<;name.1;name.2
27789 If an item in the list is an IP address, it is inverted before the DNS
27790 blacklist domain is appended. If it is not an IP address, no inversion
27791 occurs. Consider this condition:
27793 dnslists = black.list.tld/<;192.168.1.2;a.domain
27795 The DNS lookups that occur are:
27797 2.1.168.192.black.list.tld
27798 a.domain.black.list.tld
27800 Once a DNS record has been found (that matches a specific IP return
27801 address, if specified &-- see section &<<SECTaddmatcon>>&), no further lookups
27802 are done. If there is a temporary DNS error, the rest of the sublist of domains
27803 or IP addresses is tried. A temporary error for the whole dnslists item occurs
27804 only if no other DNS lookup in this sublist succeeds. In other words, a
27805 successful lookup for any of the items in the sublist overrides a temporary
27806 error for a previous item.
27808 The ability to supply a list of items after the slash is in some sense just a
27809 syntactic convenience. These two examples have the same effect:
27811 dnslists = black.list.tld/a.domain : black.list.tld/b.domain
27812 dnslists = black.list.tld/a.domain::b.domain
27814 However, when the data for the list is obtained from a lookup, the second form
27815 is usually much more convenient. Consider this example:
27817 deny message = The mail servers for the domain \
27818 $sender_address_domain \
27819 are listed at $dnslist_domain ($dnslist_value); \
27821 dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org/<|${lookup dnsdb {>|a=<|\
27822 ${lookup dnsdb {>|mxh=\
27823 $sender_address_domain} }} }
27825 Note the use of &`>|`& in the dnsdb lookup to specify the separator for
27826 multiple DNS records. The inner dnsdb lookup produces a list of MX hosts
27827 and the outer dnsdb lookup finds the IP addresses for these hosts. The result
27828 of expanding the condition might be something like this:
27830 dnslists = sbl.spahmaus.org/<|192.168.2.3|192.168.5.6|...
27832 Thus, this example checks whether or not the IP addresses of the sender
27833 domain's mail servers are on the Spamhaus black list.
27835 The key that was used for a successful DNS list lookup is put into the variable
27836 &$dnslist_matched$& (see section &<<SECID204>>&).
27841 .section "Data returned by DNS lists" "SECID203"
27842 .cindex "DNS list" "data returned from"
27843 DNS lists are constructed using address records in the DNS. The original RBL
27844 just used the address 127.0.0.1 on the right hand side of each record, but the
27845 RBL+ list and some other lists use a number of values with different meanings.
27846 The values used on the RBL+ list are:
27850 127.1.0.3 DUL and RBL
27852 127.1.0.5 RSS and RBL
27853 127.1.0.6 RSS and DUL
27854 127.1.0.7 RSS and DUL and RBL
27856 Section &<<SECTaddmatcon>>& below describes how you can distinguish between
27857 different values. Some DNS lists may return more than one address record;
27858 see section &<<SECThanmuldnsrec>>& for details of how they are checked.
27861 .section "Variables set from DNS lists" "SECID204"
27862 .cindex "expansion" "variables, set from DNS list"
27863 .cindex "DNS list" "variables set from"
27864 .vindex "&$dnslist_domain$&"
27865 .vindex "&$dnslist_matched$&"
27866 .vindex "&$dnslist_text$&"
27867 .vindex "&$dnslist_value$&"
27868 When an entry is found in a DNS list, the variable &$dnslist_domain$& contains
27869 the name of the overall domain that matched (for example,
27870 &`spamhaus.example`&), &$dnslist_matched$& contains the key within that domain
27871 (for example, &`192.168.5.3`&), and &$dnslist_value$& contains the data from
27872 the DNS record. When the key is an IP address, it is not reversed in
27873 &$dnslist_matched$& (though it is, of course, in the actual lookup). In simple
27874 cases, for example:
27876 deny dnslists = spamhaus.example
27878 the key is also available in another variable (in this case,
27879 &$sender_host_address$&). In more complicated cases, however, this is not true.
27880 For example, using a data lookup (as described in section &<<SECTmulkeyfor>>&)
27881 might generate a dnslists lookup like this:
27883 deny dnslists = spamhaus.example/<|192.168.1.2|192.168.6.7|...
27885 If this condition succeeds, the value in &$dnslist_matched$& might be
27886 &`192.168.6.7`& (for example).
27888 If more than one address record is returned by the DNS lookup, all the IP
27889 addresses are included in &$dnslist_value$&, separated by commas and spaces.
27890 The variable &$dnslist_text$& contains the contents of any associated TXT
27891 record. For lists such as RBL+ the TXT record for a merged entry is often not
27892 very meaningful. See section &<<SECTmordetinf>>& for a way of obtaining more
27895 You can use the DNS list variables in &%message%& or &%log_message%& modifiers
27896 &-- although these appear before the condition in the ACL, they are not
27897 expanded until after it has failed. For example:
27899 deny hosts = !+local_networks
27900 message = $sender_host_address is listed \
27902 dnslists = rbl-plus.mail-abuse.example
27907 .section "Additional matching conditions for DNS lists" "SECTaddmatcon"
27908 .cindex "DNS list" "matching specific returned data"
27909 You can add an equals sign and an IP address after a &%dnslists%& domain name
27910 in order to restrict its action to DNS records with a matching right hand side.
27913 deny dnslists = rblplus.mail-abuse.org=127.0.0.2
27915 rejects only those hosts that yield 127.0.0.2. Without this additional data,
27916 any address record is considered to be a match. For the moment, we assume
27917 that the DNS lookup returns just one record. Section &<<SECThanmuldnsrec>>&
27918 describes how multiple records are handled.
27920 More than one IP address may be given for checking, using a comma as a
27921 separator. These are alternatives &-- if any one of them matches, the
27922 &%dnslists%& condition is true. For example:
27924 deny dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
27926 If you want to specify a constraining address list and also specify names or IP
27927 addresses to be looked up, the constraining address list must be specified
27928 first. For example:
27930 deny dnslists = dsn.rfc-ignorant.org\
27931 =127.0.0.2/$sender_address_domain
27934 If the character &`&&`& is used instead of &`=`&, the comparison for each
27935 listed IP address is done by a bitwise &"and"& instead of by an equality test.
27936 In other words, the listed addresses are used as bit masks. The comparison is
27937 true if all the bits in the mask are present in the address that is being
27938 tested. For example:
27940 dnslists = a.b.c&0.0.0.3
27942 matches if the address is &'x.x.x.'&3, &'x.x.x.'&7, &'x.x.x.'&11, etc. If you
27943 want to test whether one bit or another bit is present (as opposed to both
27944 being present), you must use multiple values. For example:
27946 dnslists = a.b.c&0.0.0.1,0.0.0.2
27948 matches if the final component of the address is an odd number or two times
27953 .section "Negated DNS matching conditions" "SECID205"
27954 You can supply a negative list of IP addresses as part of a &%dnslists%&
27957 deny dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
27959 means &"deny if the host is in the black list at the domain &'a.b.c'& and the
27960 IP address yielded by the list is either 127.0.0.2 or 127.0.0.3"&,
27962 deny dnslists = a.b.c!=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
27964 means &"deny if the host is in the black list at the domain &'a.b.c'& and the
27965 IP address yielded by the list is not 127.0.0.2 and not 127.0.0.3"&. In other
27966 words, the result of the test is inverted if an exclamation mark appears before
27967 the &`=`& (or the &`&&`&) sign.
27969 &*Note*&: This kind of negation is not the same as negation in a domain,
27970 host, or address list (which is why the syntax is different).
27972 If you are using just one list, the negation syntax does not gain you much. The
27973 previous example is precisely equivalent to
27975 deny dnslists = a.b.c
27976 !dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
27978 However, if you are using multiple lists, the negation syntax is clearer.
27979 Consider this example:
27981 deny dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
27983 dnsbl.njabl.org!=127.0.0.3 : \
27986 Using only positive lists, this would have to be:
27988 deny dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
27990 deny dnslists = dnsbl.njabl.org
27991 !dnslists = dnsbl.njabl.org=127.0.0.3
27992 deny dnslists = relays.ordb.org
27994 which is less clear, and harder to maintain.
27999 .section "Handling multiple DNS records from a DNS list" "SECThanmuldnsrec"
28000 A DNS lookup for a &%dnslists%& condition may return more than one DNS record,
28001 thereby providing more than one IP address. When an item in a &%dnslists%& list
28002 is followed by &`=`& or &`&&`& and a list of IP addresses, in order to restrict
28003 the match to specific results from the DNS lookup, there are two ways in which
28004 the checking can be handled. For example, consider the condition:
28006 dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.1
28008 What happens if the DNS lookup for the incoming IP address yields both
28009 127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2 by means of two separate DNS records? Is the
28010 condition true because at least one given value was found, or is it false
28011 because at least one of the found values was not listed? And how does this
28012 affect negated conditions? Both possibilities are provided for with the help of
28013 additional separators &`==`& and &`=&&`&.
28016 If &`=`& or &`&&`& is used, the condition is true if any one of the looked up
28017 IP addresses matches one of the listed addresses. For the example above, the
28018 condition is true because 127.0.0.1 matches.
28020 If &`==`& or &`=&&`& is used, the condition is true only if every one of the
28021 looked up IP addresses matches one of the listed addresses. If the condition is
28024 dnslists = a.b.c==127.0.0.1
28026 and the DNS lookup yields both 127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2, the condition is
28027 false because 127.0.0.2 is not listed. You would need to have:
28029 dnslists = a.b.c==127.0.0.1,127.0.0.2
28031 for the condition to be true.
28034 When &`!`& is used to negate IP address matching, it inverts the result, giving
28035 the precise opposite of the behaviour above. Thus:
28037 If &`!=`& or &`!&&`& is used, the condition is true if none of the looked up IP
28038 addresses matches one of the listed addresses. Consider:
28040 dnslists = a.b.c!&0.0.0.1
28042 If the DNS lookup yields both 127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2, the condition is
28043 false because 127.0.0.1 matches.
28045 If &`!==`& or &`!=&&`& is used, the condition is true there is at least one
28046 looked up IP address that does not match. Consider:
28048 dnslists = a.b.c!=&0.0.0.1
28050 If the DNS lookup yields both 127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2, the condition is
28051 true, because 127.0.0.2 does not match. You would need to have:
28053 dnslists = a.b.c!=&0.0.0.1,0.0.0.2
28055 for the condition to be false.
28057 When the DNS lookup yields only a single IP address, there is no difference
28058 between &`=`& and &`==`& and between &`&&`& and &`=&&`&.
28063 .section "Detailed information from merged DNS lists" "SECTmordetinf"
28064 .cindex "DNS list" "information from merged"
28065 When the facility for restricting the matching IP values in a DNS list is used,
28066 the text from the TXT record that is set in &$dnslist_text$& may not reflect
28067 the true reason for rejection. This happens when lists are merged and the IP
28068 address in the A record is used to distinguish them; unfortunately there is
28069 only one TXT record. One way round this is not to use merged lists, but that
28070 can be inefficient because it requires multiple DNS lookups where one would do
28071 in the vast majority of cases when the host of interest is not on any of the
28074 A less inefficient way of solving this problem is available. If
28075 two domain names, comma-separated, are given, the second is used first to
28076 do an initial check, making use of any IP value restrictions that are set.
28077 If there is a match, the first domain is used, without any IP value
28078 restrictions, to get the TXT record. As a byproduct of this, there is also
28079 a check that the IP being tested is indeed on the first list. The first
28080 domain is the one that is put in &$dnslist_domain$&. For example:
28083 rejected because $sender_host_address is blacklisted \
28084 at $dnslist_domain\n$dnslist_text
28086 sbl.spamhaus.org,sbl-xbl.spamhaus.org=127.0.0.2 : \
28087 dul.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.10
28089 For the first blacklist item, this starts by doing a lookup in
28090 &'sbl-xbl.spamhaus.org'& and testing for a 127.0.0.2 return. If there is a
28091 match, it then looks in &'sbl.spamhaus.org'&, without checking the return
28092 value, and as long as something is found, it looks for the corresponding TXT
28093 record. If there is no match in &'sbl-xbl.spamhaus.org'&, nothing more is done.
28094 The second blacklist item is processed similarly.
28096 If you are interested in more than one merged list, the same list must be
28097 given several times, but because the results of the DNS lookups are cached,
28098 the DNS calls themselves are not repeated. For example:
28100 reject dnslists = \
28101 http.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.2 : \
28102 socks.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.3 : \
28103 misc.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.4 : \
28104 dul.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.10
28106 In this case there is one lookup in &'dnsbl.sorbs.net'&, and if none of the IP
28107 values matches (or if no record is found), this is the only lookup that is
28108 done. Only if there is a match is one of the more specific lists consulted.
28112 .section "DNS lists and IPv6" "SECTmorednslistslast"
28113 .cindex "IPv6" "DNS black lists"
28114 .cindex "DNS list" "IPv6 usage"
28115 If Exim is asked to do a dnslist lookup for an IPv6 address, it inverts it
28116 nibble by nibble. For example, if the calling host's IP address is
28117 3ffe:ffff:836f:0a00:000a:0800:200a:c031, Exim might look up
28119 1.3.0.c.a.0.0.2.0.0.8.0.a.0.0.0.0.0.a.0.f.6.3.8.
28120 f.f.f.f.e.f.f.3.blackholes.mail-abuse.org
28122 (split over two lines here to fit on the page). Unfortunately, some of the DNS
28123 lists contain wildcard records, intended for IPv4, that interact badly with
28124 IPv6. For example, the DNS entry
28126 *.3.some.list.example. A 127.0.0.1
28128 is probably intended to put the entire 3.0.0.0/8 IPv4 network on the list.
28129 Unfortunately, it also matches the entire 3::/4 IPv6 network.
28131 You can exclude IPv6 addresses from DNS lookups by making use of a suitable
28132 &%condition%& condition, as in this example:
28134 deny condition = ${if isip4{$sender_host_address}}
28135 dnslists = some.list.example
28138 .section "Rate limiting incoming messages" "SECTratelimiting"
28139 .cindex "rate limiting" "client sending"
28140 .cindex "limiting client sending rates"
28141 .oindex "&%smtp_ratelimit_*%&"
28142 The &%ratelimit%& ACL condition can be used to measure and control the rate at
28143 which clients can send email. This is more powerful than the
28144 &%smtp_ratelimit_*%& options, because those options control the rate of
28145 commands in a single SMTP session only, whereas the &%ratelimit%& condition
28146 works across all connections (concurrent and sequential) from the same client
28147 host. The syntax of the &%ratelimit%& condition is:
28149 &`ratelimit =`& <&'m'&> &`/`& <&'p'&> &`/`& <&'options'&> &`/`& <&'key'&>
28151 If the average client sending rate is less than &'m'& messages per time
28152 period &'p'& then the condition is false; otherwise it is true.
28154 As a side-effect, the &%ratelimit%& condition sets the expansion variable
28155 &$sender_rate$& to the client's computed rate, &$sender_rate_limit$& to the
28156 configured value of &'m'&, and &$sender_rate_period$& to the configured value
28159 The parameter &'p'& is the smoothing time constant, in the form of an Exim
28160 time interval, for example, &`8h`& for eight hours. A larger time constant
28161 means that it takes Exim longer to forget a client's past behaviour. The
28162 parameter &'m'& is the maximum number of messages that a client is permitted to
28163 send in each time interval. It also specifies the number of messages permitted
28164 in a fast burst. By increasing both &'m'& and &'p'& but keeping &'m/p'&
28165 constant, you can allow a client to send more messages in a burst without
28166 changing its long-term sending rate limit. Conversely, if &'m'& and &'p'& are
28167 both small, messages must be sent at an even rate.
28169 There is a script in &_util/ratelimit.pl_& which extracts sending rates from
28170 log files, to assist with choosing appropriate settings for &'m'& and &'p'&
28171 when deploying the &%ratelimit%& ACL condition. The script prints usage
28172 instructions when it is run with no arguments.
28174 The key is used to look up the data for calculating the client's average
28175 sending rate. This data is stored in Exim's spool directory, alongside the
28176 retry and other hints databases. The default key is &$sender_host_address$&,
28177 which means Exim computes the sending rate of each client host IP address.
28178 By changing the key you can change how Exim identifies clients for the purpose
28179 of ratelimiting. For example, to limit the sending rate of each authenticated
28180 user, independent of the computer they are sending from, set the key to
28181 &$authenticated_id$&. You must ensure that the lookup key is meaningful; for
28182 example, &$authenticated_id$& is only meaningful if the client has
28183 authenticated (which you can check with the &%authenticated%& ACL condition).
28185 The lookup key does not have to identify clients: If you want to limit the
28186 rate at which a recipient receives messages, you can use the key
28187 &`$local_part@$domain`& with the &%per_rcpt%& option (see below) in a RCPT
28190 Each &%ratelimit%& condition can have up to four options. A &%per_*%& option
28191 specifies what Exim measures the rate of, for example messages or recipients
28192 or bytes. You can adjust the measurement using the &%unique=%& and/or
28193 &%count=%& options. You can also control when Exim updates the recorded rate
28194 using a &%strict%&, &%leaky%&, or &%readonly%& option. The options are
28195 separated by a slash, like the other parameters. They may appear in any order.
28197 Internally, Exim appends the smoothing constant &'p'& onto the lookup key with
28198 any options that alter the meaning of the stored data. The limit &'m'& is not
28199 stored, so you can alter the configured maximum rate and Exim will still
28200 remember clients' past behaviour. If you change the &%per_*%& mode or add or
28201 remove the &%unique=%& option, the lookup key changes so Exim will forget past
28202 behaviour. The lookup key is not affected by changes to the update mode and
28203 the &%count=%& option.
28206 .section "Ratelimit options for what is being measured" "ratoptmea"
28207 .cindex "rate limiting" "per_* options"
28208 The &%per_conn%& option limits the client's connection rate. It is not
28209 normally used in the &%acl_not_smtp%&, &%acl_not_smtp_mime%&, or
28210 &%acl_not_smtp_start%& ACLs.
28212 The &%per_mail%& option limits the client's rate of sending messages. This is
28213 the default if none of the &%per_*%& options is specified. It can be used in
28214 &%acl_smtp_mail%&, &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&, &%acl_smtp_predata%&, &%acl_smtp_mime%&,
28215 &%acl_smtp_data%&, or &%acl_not_smtp%&.
28217 The &%per_byte%& option limits the sender's email bandwidth. It can be used in
28218 the same ACLs as the &%per_mail%& option, though it is best to use this option
28219 in the &%acl_smtp_mime%&, &%acl_smtp_data%& or &%acl_not_smtp%& ACLs; if it is
28220 used in an earlier ACL, Exim relies on the SIZE parameter given by the client
28221 in its MAIL command, which may be inaccurate or completely missing. You can
28222 follow the limit &'m'& in the configuration with K, M, or G to specify limits
28223 in kilobytes, megabytes, or gigabytes, respectively.
28225 The &%per_rcpt%& option causes Exim to limit the rate at which recipients are
28226 accepted. It can be used in the &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&, &%acl_smtp_predata%&,
28227 &%acl_smtp_mime%&, &%acl_smtp_data%&, or &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& ACLs. In
28228 &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& the rate is updated one recipient at a time; in the other
28229 ACLs the rate is updated with the total recipient count in one go. Note that
28230 in either case the rate limiting engine will see a message with many
28231 recipients as a large high-speed burst.
28233 The &%per_addr%& option is like the &%per_rcpt%& option, except it counts the
28234 number of different recipients that the client has sent messages to in the
28235 last time period. That is, if the client repeatedly sends messages to the same
28236 recipient, its measured rate is not increased. This option can only be used in
28239 The &%per_cmd%& option causes Exim to recompute the rate every time the
28240 condition is processed. This can be used to limit the rate of any SMTP
28241 command. If it is used in multiple ACLs it can limit the aggregate rate of
28242 multiple different commands.
28244 The &%count=%& option can be used to alter how much Exim adds to the client's
28245 measured rate. For example, the &%per_byte%& option is equivalent to
28246 &`per_mail/count=$message_size`&. If there is no &%count=%& option, Exim
28247 increases the measured rate by one (except for the &%per_rcpt%& option in ACLs
28248 other than &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&). The count does not have to be an integer.
28250 The &%unique=%& option is described in section &<<ratoptuniq>>& below.
28253 .section "Ratelimit update modes" "ratoptupd"
28254 .cindex "rate limiting" "reading data without updating"
28255 You can specify one of three options with the &%ratelimit%& condition to
28256 control when its database is updated. This section describes the &%readonly%&
28257 mode, and the next section describes the &%strict%& and &%leaky%& modes.
28259 If the &%ratelimit%& condition is used in &%readonly%& mode, Exim looks up a
28260 previously-computed rate to check against the limit.
28262 For example, you can test the client's sending rate and deny it access (when
28263 it is too fast) in the connect ACL. If the client passes this check then it
28264 can go on to send a message, in which case its recorded rate will be updated
28265 in the MAIL ACL. Subsequent connections from the same client will check this
28269 deny ratelimit = 100 / 5m / readonly
28270 log_message = RATE CHECK: $sender_rate/$sender_rate_period \
28271 (max $sender_rate_limit)
28274 warn ratelimit = 100 / 5m / strict
28275 log_message = RATE UPDATE: $sender_rate/$sender_rate_period \
28276 (max $sender_rate_limit)
28279 If Exim encounters multiple &%ratelimit%& conditions with the same key when
28280 processing a message then it may increase the client's measured rate more than
28281 it should. For example, this will happen if you check the &%per_rcpt%& option
28282 in both &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& and &%acl_smtp_data%&. However it's OK to check the
28283 same &%ratelimit%& condition multiple times in the same ACL. You can avoid any
28284 multiple update problems by using the &%readonly%& option on later ratelimit
28287 The &%per_*%& options described above do not make sense in some ACLs. If you
28288 use a &%per_*%& option in an ACL where it is not normally permitted then the
28289 update mode defaults to &%readonly%& and you cannot specify the &%strict%& or
28290 &%leaky%& modes. In other ACLs the default update mode is &%leaky%& (see the
28291 next section) so you must specify the &%readonly%& option explicitly.
28294 .section "Ratelimit options for handling fast clients" "ratoptfast"
28295 .cindex "rate limiting" "strict and leaky modes"
28296 If a client's average rate is greater than the maximum, the rate limiting
28297 engine can react in two possible ways, depending on the presence of the
28298 &%strict%& or &%leaky%& update modes. This is independent of the other
28299 counter-measures (such as rejecting the message) that may be specified by the
28302 The &%leaky%& (default) option means that the client's recorded rate is not
28303 updated if it is above the limit. The effect of this is that Exim measures the
28304 client's average rate of successfully sent email, which cannot be greater than
28305 the maximum allowed. If the client is over the limit it may suffer some
28306 counter-measures (as specified in the ACL), but it will still be able to send
28307 email at the configured maximum rate, whatever the rate of its attempts. This
28308 is generally the better choice if you have clients that retry automatically.
28309 For example, it does not prevent a sender with an over-aggressive retry rate
28310 from getting any email through.
28312 The &%strict%& option means that the client's recorded rate is always
28313 updated. The effect of this is that Exim measures the client's average rate
28314 of attempts to send email, which can be much higher than the maximum it is
28315 actually allowed. If the client is over the limit it may be subjected to
28316 counter-measures by the ACL. It must slow down and allow sufficient time to
28317 pass that its computed rate falls below the maximum before it can send email
28318 again. The time (the number of smoothing periods) it must wait and not
28319 attempt to send mail can be calculated with this formula:
28321 ln(peakrate/maxrate)
28325 .section "Limiting the rate of different events" "ratoptuniq"
28326 .cindex "rate limiting" "counting unique events"
28327 The &%ratelimit%& &%unique=%& option controls a mechanism for counting the
28328 rate of different events. For example, the &%per_addr%& option uses this
28329 mechanism to count the number of different recipients that the client has
28330 sent messages to in the last time period; it is equivalent to
28331 &`per_rcpt/unique=$local_part@$domain`&. You could use this feature to
28332 measure the rate that a client uses different sender addresses with the
28333 options &`per_mail/unique=$sender_address`&.
28335 For each &%ratelimit%& key Exim stores the set of &%unique=%& values that it
28336 has seen for that key. The whole set is thrown away when it is older than the
28337 rate smoothing period &'p'&, so each different event is counted at most once
28338 per period. In the &%leaky%& update mode, an event that causes the client to
28339 go over the limit is not added to the set, in the same way that the client's
28340 recorded rate is not updated in the same situation.
28342 When you combine the &%unique=%& and &%readonly%& options, the specific
28343 &%unique=%& value is ignored, and Exim just retrieves the client's stored
28346 The &%unique=%& mechanism needs more space in the ratelimit database than the
28347 other &%ratelimit%& options in order to store the event set. The number of
28348 unique values is potentially as large as the rate limit, so the extra space
28349 required increases with larger limits.
28351 The uniqueification is not perfect: there is a small probability that Exim
28352 will think a new event has happened before. If the sender's rate is less than
28353 the limit, Exim should be more than 99.9% correct. However in &%strict%& mode
28354 the measured rate can go above the limit, in which case Exim may under-count
28355 events by a significant margin. Fortunately, if the rate is high enough (2.7
28356 times the limit) that the false positive rate goes above 9%, then Exim will
28357 throw away the over-full event set before the measured rate falls below the
28358 limit. Therefore the only harm should be that exceptionally high sending rates
28359 are logged incorrectly; any countermeasures you configure will be as effective
28363 .section "Using rate limiting" "useratlim"
28364 Exim's other ACL facilities are used to define what counter-measures are taken
28365 when the rate limit is exceeded. This might be anything from logging a warning
28366 (for example, while measuring existing sending rates in order to define
28367 policy), through time delays to slow down fast senders, up to rejecting the
28368 message. For example:
28370 # Log all senders' rates
28371 warn ratelimit = 0 / 1h / strict
28372 log_message = Sender rate $sender_rate / $sender_rate_period
28374 # Slow down fast senders; note the need to truncate $sender_rate
28375 # at the decimal point.
28376 warn ratelimit = 100 / 1h / per_rcpt / strict
28377 delay = ${eval: ${sg{$sender_rate}{[.].*}{}} - \
28378 $sender_rate_limit }s
28380 # Keep authenticated users under control
28381 deny authenticated = *
28382 ratelimit = 100 / 1d / strict / $authenticated_id
28384 # System-wide rate limit
28385 defer message = Sorry, too busy. Try again later.
28386 ratelimit = 10 / 1s / $primary_hostname
28388 # Restrict incoming rate from each host, with a default
28389 # set using a macro and special cases looked up in a table.
28390 defer message = Sender rate exceeds $sender_rate_limit \
28391 messages per $sender_rate_period
28392 ratelimit = ${lookup {$sender_host_address} \
28393 cdb {DB/ratelimits.cdb} \
28394 {$value} {RATELIMIT} }
28396 &*Warning*&: If you have a busy server with a lot of &%ratelimit%& tests,
28397 especially with the &%per_rcpt%& option, you may suffer from a performance
28398 bottleneck caused by locking on the ratelimit hints database. Apart from
28399 making your ACLs less complicated, you can reduce the problem by using a
28400 RAM disk for Exim's hints directory (usually &_/var/spool/exim/db/_&). However
28401 this means that Exim will lose its hints data after a reboot (including retry
28402 hints, the callout cache, and ratelimit data).
28406 .section "Address verification" "SECTaddressverification"
28407 .cindex "verifying address" "options for"
28408 .cindex "policy control" "address verification"
28409 Several of the &%verify%& conditions described in section
28410 &<<SECTaclconditions>>& cause addresses to be verified. Section
28411 &<<SECTsenaddver>>& discusses the reporting of sender verification failures.
28412 The verification conditions can be followed by options that modify the
28413 verification process. The options are separated from the keyword and from each
28414 other by slashes, and some of them contain parameters. For example:
28416 verify = sender/callout
28417 verify = recipient/defer_ok/callout=10s,defer_ok
28419 The first stage of address verification, which always happens, is to run the
28420 address through the routers, in &"verify mode"&. Routers can detect the
28421 difference between verification and routing for delivery, and their actions can
28422 be varied by a number of generic options such as &%verify%& and &%verify_only%&
28423 (see chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&). If routing fails, verification fails.
28424 The available options are as follows:
28427 If the &%callout%& option is specified, successful routing to one or more
28428 remote hosts is followed by a &"callout"& to those hosts as an additional
28429 check. Callouts and their sub-options are discussed in the next section.
28431 If there is a defer error while doing verification routing, the ACL
28432 normally returns &"defer"&. However, if you include &%defer_ok%& in the
28433 options, the condition is forced to be true instead. Note that this is a main
28434 verification option as well as a suboption for callouts.
28436 The &%no_details%& option is covered in section &<<SECTsenaddver>>&, which
28437 discusses the reporting of sender address verification failures.
28439 The &%success_on_redirect%& option causes verification always to succeed
28440 immediately after a successful redirection. By default, if a redirection
28441 generates just one address, that address is also verified. See further
28442 discussion in section &<<SECTredirwhilveri>>&.
28445 .cindex "verifying address" "differentiating failures"
28446 .vindex "&$recipient_verify_failure$&"
28447 .vindex "&$sender_verify_failure$&"
28448 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
28449 After an address verification failure, &$acl_verify_message$& contains the
28450 error message that is associated with the failure. It can be preserved by
28453 warn !verify = sender
28454 set acl_m0 = $acl_verify_message
28456 If you are writing your own custom rejection message or log message when
28457 denying access, you can use this variable to include information about the
28458 verification failure.
28460 In addition, &$sender_verify_failure$& or &$recipient_verify_failure$& (as
28461 appropriate) contains one of the following words:
28464 &%qualify%&: The address was unqualified (no domain), and the message
28465 was neither local nor came from an exempted host.
28467 &%route%&: Routing failed.
28469 &%mail%&: Routing succeeded, and a callout was attempted; rejection
28470 occurred at or before the MAIL command (that is, on initial
28471 connection, HELO, or MAIL).
28473 &%recipient%&: The RCPT command in a callout was rejected.
28475 &%postmaster%&: The postmaster check in a callout was rejected.
28478 The main use of these variables is expected to be to distinguish between
28479 rejections of MAIL and rejections of RCPT in callouts.
28484 .section "Callout verification" "SECTcallver"
28485 .cindex "verifying address" "by callout"
28486 .cindex "callout" "verification"
28487 .cindex "SMTP" "callout verification"
28488 For non-local addresses, routing verifies the domain, but is unable to do any
28489 checking of the local part. There are situations where some means of verifying
28490 the local part is desirable. One way this can be done is to make an SMTP
28491 &'callback'& to a delivery host for the sender address or a &'callforward'& to
28492 a subsequent host for a recipient address, to see if the host accepts the
28493 address. We use the term &'callout'& to cover both cases. Note that for a
28494 sender address, the callback is not to the client host that is trying to
28495 deliver the message, but to one of the hosts that accepts incoming mail for the
28498 Exim does not do callouts by default. If you want them to happen, you must
28499 request them by setting appropriate options on the &%verify%& condition, as
28500 described below. This facility should be used with care, because it can add a
28501 lot of resource usage to the cost of verifying an address. However, Exim does
28502 cache the results of callouts, which helps to reduce the cost. Details of
28503 caching are in section &<<SECTcallvercache>>&.
28505 Recipient callouts are usually used only between hosts that are controlled by
28506 the same administration. For example, a corporate gateway host could use
28507 callouts to check for valid recipients on an internal mailserver. A successful
28508 callout does not guarantee that a real delivery to the address would succeed;
28509 on the other hand, a failing callout does guarantee that a delivery would fail.
28511 If the &%callout%& option is present on a condition that verifies an address, a
28512 second stage of verification occurs if the address is successfully routed to
28513 one or more remote hosts. The usual case is routing by a &(dnslookup)& or a
28514 &(manualroute)& router, where the router specifies the hosts. However, if a
28515 router that does not set up hosts routes to an &(smtp)& transport with a
28516 &%hosts%& setting, the transport's hosts are used. If an &(smtp)& transport has
28517 &%hosts_override%& set, its hosts are always used, whether or not the router
28518 supplies a host list.
28520 The port that is used is taken from the transport, if it is specified and is a
28521 remote transport. (For routers that do verification only, no transport need be
28522 specified.) Otherwise, the default SMTP port is used. If a remote transport
28523 specifies an outgoing interface, this is used; otherwise the interface is not
28524 specified. Likewise, the text that is used for the HELO command is taken from
28525 the transport's &%helo_data%& option; if there is no transport, the value of
28526 &$smtp_active_hostname$& is used.
28528 For a sender callout check, Exim makes SMTP connections to the remote hosts, to
28529 test whether a bounce message could be delivered to the sender address. The
28530 following SMTP commands are sent:
28532 &`HELO `&<&'local host name'&>
28534 &`RCPT TO:`&<&'the address to be tested'&>
28537 LHLO is used instead of HELO if the transport's &%protocol%& option is
28540 A recipient callout check is similar. By default, it also uses an empty address
28541 for the sender. This default is chosen because most hosts do not make use of
28542 the sender address when verifying a recipient. Using the same address means
28543 that a single cache entry can be used for each recipient. Some sites, however,
28544 do make use of the sender address when verifying. These are catered for by the
28545 &%use_sender%& and &%use_postmaster%& options, described in the next section.
28547 If the response to the RCPT command is a 2&'xx'& code, the verification
28548 succeeds. If it is 5&'xx'&, the verification fails. For any other condition,
28549 Exim tries the next host, if any. If there is a problem with all the remote
28550 hosts, the ACL yields &"defer"&, unless the &%defer_ok%& parameter of the
28551 &%callout%& option is given, in which case the condition is forced to succeed.
28553 .cindex "SMTP" "output flushing, disabling for callout"
28554 A callout may take a little time. For this reason, Exim normally flushes SMTP
28555 output before performing a callout in an ACL, to avoid unexpected timeouts in
28556 clients when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in use. The flushing can be
28557 disabled by using a &%control%& modifier to set &%no_callout_flush%&.
28562 .section "Additional parameters for callouts" "CALLaddparcall"
28563 .cindex "callout" "additional parameters for"
28564 The &%callout%& option can be followed by an equals sign and a number of
28565 optional parameters, separated by commas. For example:
28567 verify = recipient/callout=10s,defer_ok
28569 The old syntax, which had &%callout_defer_ok%& and &%check_postmaster%& as
28570 separate verify options, is retained for backwards compatibility, but is now
28571 deprecated. The additional parameters for &%callout%& are as follows:
28575 .vitem <&'a&~time&~interval'&>
28576 .cindex "callout" "timeout, specifying"
28577 This specifies the timeout that applies for the callout attempt to each host.
28580 verify = sender/callout=5s
28582 The default is 30 seconds. The timeout is used for each response from the
28583 remote host. It is also used for the initial connection, unless overridden by
28584 the &%connect%& parameter.
28587 .vitem &*connect&~=&~*&<&'time&~interval'&>
28588 .cindex "callout" "connection timeout, specifying"
28589 This parameter makes it possible to set a different (usually smaller) timeout
28590 for making the SMTP connection. For example:
28592 verify = sender/callout=5s,connect=1s
28594 If not specified, this timeout defaults to the general timeout value.
28596 .vitem &*defer_ok*&
28597 .cindex "callout" "defer, action on"
28598 When this parameter is present, failure to contact any host, or any other kind
28599 of temporary error, is treated as success by the ACL. However, the cache is not
28600 updated in this circumstance.
28602 .vitem &*fullpostmaster*&
28603 .cindex "callout" "full postmaster check"
28604 This operates like the &%postmaster%& option (see below), but if the check for
28605 &'postmaster@domain'& fails, it tries just &'postmaster'&, without a domain, in
28606 accordance with the specification in RFC 2821. The RFC states that the
28607 unqualified address &'postmaster'& should be accepted.
28610 .vitem &*mailfrom&~=&~*&<&'email&~address'&>
28611 .cindex "callout" "sender when verifying header"
28612 When verifying addresses in header lines using the &%header_sender%&
28613 verification option, Exim behaves by default as if the addresses are envelope
28614 sender addresses from a message. Callout verification therefore tests to see
28615 whether a bounce message could be delivered, by using an empty address in the
28616 MAIL command. However, it is arguable that these addresses might never be used
28617 as envelope senders, and could therefore justifiably reject bounce messages
28618 (empty senders). The &%mailfrom%& callout parameter allows you to specify what
28619 address to use in the MAIL command. For example:
28621 require verify = header_sender/callout=mailfrom=abcd@x.y.z
28623 This parameter is available only for the &%header_sender%& verification option.
28626 .vitem &*maxwait&~=&~*&<&'time&~interval'&>
28627 .cindex "callout" "overall timeout, specifying"
28628 This parameter sets an overall timeout for performing a callout verification.
28631 verify = sender/callout=5s,maxwait=30s
28633 This timeout defaults to four times the callout timeout for individual SMTP
28634 commands. The overall timeout applies when there is more than one host that can
28635 be tried. The timeout is checked before trying the next host. This prevents
28636 very long delays if there are a large number of hosts and all are timing out
28637 (for example, when network connections are timing out).
28640 .vitem &*no_cache*&
28641 .cindex "callout" "cache, suppressing"
28642 .cindex "caching callout, suppressing"
28643 When this parameter is given, the callout cache is neither read nor updated.
28645 .vitem &*postmaster*&
28646 .cindex "callout" "postmaster; checking"
28647 When this parameter is set, a successful callout check is followed by a similar
28648 check for the local part &'postmaster'& at the same domain. If this address is
28649 rejected, the callout fails (but see &%fullpostmaster%& above). The result of
28650 the postmaster check is recorded in a cache record; if it is a failure, this is
28651 used to fail subsequent callouts for the domain without a connection being
28652 made, until the cache record expires.
28654 .vitem &*postmaster_mailfrom&~=&~*&<&'email&~address'&>
28655 The postmaster check uses an empty sender in the MAIL command by default.
28656 You can use this parameter to do a postmaster check using a different address.
28659 require verify = sender/callout=postmaster_mailfrom=abc@x.y.z
28661 If both &%postmaster%& and &%postmaster_mailfrom%& are present, the rightmost
28662 one overrides. The &%postmaster%& parameter is equivalent to this example:
28664 require verify = sender/callout=postmaster_mailfrom=
28666 &*Warning*&: The caching arrangements for postmaster checking do not take
28667 account of the sender address. It is assumed that either the empty address or
28668 a fixed non-empty address will be used. All that Exim remembers is that the
28669 postmaster check for the domain succeeded or failed.
28673 .cindex "callout" "&""random""& check"
28674 When this parameter is set, before doing the normal callout check, Exim does a
28675 check for a &"random"& local part at the same domain. The local part is not
28676 really random &-- it is defined by the expansion of the option
28677 &%callout_random_local_part%&, which defaults to
28679 $primary_hostname-$tod_epoch-testing
28681 The idea here is to try to determine whether the remote host accepts all local
28682 parts without checking. If it does, there is no point in doing callouts for
28683 specific local parts. If the &"random"& check succeeds, the result is saved in
28684 a cache record, and used to force the current and subsequent callout checks to
28685 succeed without a connection being made, until the cache record expires.
28687 .vitem &*use_postmaster*&
28688 .cindex "callout" "sender for recipient check"
28689 This parameter applies to recipient callouts only. For example:
28691 deny !verify = recipient/callout=use_postmaster
28693 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
28694 It causes a non-empty postmaster address to be used in the MAIL command when
28695 performing the callout for the recipient, and also for a &"random"& check if
28696 that is configured. The local part of the address is &`postmaster`& and the
28697 domain is the contents of &$qualify_domain$&.
28699 .vitem &*use_sender*&
28700 This option applies to recipient callouts only. For example:
28702 require verify = recipient/callout=use_sender
28704 It causes the message's actual sender address to be used in the MAIL
28705 command when performing the callout, instead of an empty address. There is no
28706 need to use this option unless you know that the called hosts make use of the
28707 sender when checking recipients. If used indiscriminately, it reduces the
28708 usefulness of callout caching.
28711 If you use any of the parameters that set a non-empty sender for the MAIL
28712 command (&%mailfrom%&, &%postmaster_mailfrom%&, &%use_postmaster%&, or
28713 &%use_sender%&), you should think about possible loops. Recipient checking is
28714 usually done between two hosts that are under the same management, and the host
28715 that receives the callouts is not normally configured to do callouts itself.
28716 Therefore, it is normally safe to use &%use_postmaster%& or &%use_sender%& in
28717 these circumstances.
28719 However, if you use a non-empty sender address for a callout to an arbitrary
28720 host, there is the likelihood that the remote host will itself initiate a
28721 callout check back to your host. As it is checking what appears to be a message
28722 sender, it is likely to use an empty address in MAIL, thus avoiding a
28723 callout loop. However, to be on the safe side it would be best to set up your
28724 own ACLs so that they do not do sender verification checks when the recipient
28725 is the address you use for header sender or postmaster callout checking.
28727 Another issue to think about when using non-empty senders for callouts is
28728 caching. When you set &%mailfrom%& or &%use_sender%&, the cache record is keyed
28729 by the sender/recipient combination; thus, for any given recipient, many more
28730 actual callouts are performed than when an empty sender or postmaster is used.
28735 .section "Callout caching" "SECTcallvercache"
28736 .cindex "hints database" "callout cache"
28737 .cindex "callout" "cache, description of"
28738 .cindex "caching" "callout"
28739 Exim caches the results of callouts in order to reduce the amount of resources
28740 used, unless you specify the &%no_cache%& parameter with the &%callout%&
28741 option. A hints database called &"callout"& is used for the cache. Two
28742 different record types are used: one records the result of a callout check for
28743 a specific address, and the other records information that applies to the
28744 entire domain (for example, that it accepts the local part &'postmaster'&).
28746 When an original callout fails, a detailed SMTP error message is given about
28747 the failure. However, for subsequent failures use the cache data, this message
28750 The expiry times for negative and positive address cache records are
28751 independent, and can be set by the global options &%callout_negative_expire%&
28752 (default 2h) and &%callout_positive_expire%& (default 24h), respectively.
28754 If a host gives a negative response to an SMTP connection, or rejects any
28755 commands up to and including
28759 (but not including the MAIL command with a non-empty address),
28760 any callout attempt is bound to fail. Exim remembers such failures in a
28761 domain cache record, which it uses to fail callouts for the domain without
28762 making new connections, until the domain record times out. There are two
28763 separate expiry times for domain cache records:
28764 &%callout_domain_negative_expire%& (default 3h) and
28765 &%callout_domain_positive_expire%& (default 7d).
28767 Domain records expire when the negative expiry time is reached if callouts
28768 cannot be made for the domain, or if the postmaster check failed.
28769 Otherwise, they expire when the positive expiry time is reached. This
28770 ensures that, for example, a host that stops accepting &"random"& local parts
28771 will eventually be noticed.
28773 The callout caching mechanism is based on the domain of the address that is
28774 being tested. If the domain routes to several hosts, it is assumed that their
28775 behaviour will be the same.
28779 .section "Sender address verification reporting" "SECTsenaddver"
28780 .cindex "verifying" "suppressing error details"
28781 See section &<<SECTaddressverification>>& for a general discussion of
28782 verification. When sender verification fails in an ACL, the details of the
28783 failure are given as additional output lines before the 550 response to the
28784 relevant SMTP command (RCPT or DATA). For example, if sender callout is in use,
28787 MAIL FROM:<xyz@abc.example>
28789 RCPT TO:<pqr@def.example>
28790 550-Verification failed for <xyz@abc.example>
28791 550-Called: 192.168.34.43
28792 550-Sent: RCPT TO:<xyz@abc.example>
28793 550-Response: 550 Unknown local part xyz in <xyz@abc.example>
28794 550 Sender verification failed
28796 If more than one RCPT command fails in the same way, the details are given
28797 only for the first of them. However, some administrators do not want to send
28798 out this much information. You can suppress the details by adding
28799 &`/no_details`& to the ACL statement that requests sender verification. For
28802 verify = sender/no_details
28805 .section "Redirection while verifying" "SECTredirwhilveri"
28806 .cindex "verifying" "redirection while"
28807 .cindex "address redirection" "while verifying"
28808 A dilemma arises when a local address is redirected by aliasing or forwarding
28809 during verification: should the generated addresses themselves be verified,
28810 or should the successful expansion of the original address be enough to verify
28811 it? By default, Exim takes the following pragmatic approach:
28814 When an incoming address is redirected to just one child address, verification
28815 continues with the child address, and if that fails to verify, the original
28816 verification also fails.
28818 When an incoming address is redirected to more than one child address,
28819 verification does not continue. A success result is returned.
28822 This seems the most reasonable behaviour for the common use of aliasing as a
28823 way of redirecting different local parts to the same mailbox. It means, for
28824 example, that a pair of alias entries of the form
28827 aw123: :fail: Gone away, no forwarding address
28829 work as expected, with both local parts causing verification failure. When a
28830 redirection generates more than one address, the behaviour is more like a
28831 mailing list, where the existence of the alias itself is sufficient for
28832 verification to succeed.
28834 It is possible, however, to change the default behaviour so that all successful
28835 redirections count as successful verifications, however many new addresses are
28836 generated. This is specified by the &%success_on_redirect%& verification
28837 option. For example:
28839 require verify = recipient/success_on_redirect/callout=10s
28841 In this example, verification succeeds if a router generates a new address, and
28842 the callout does not occur, because no address was routed to a remote host.
28844 When verification is being tested via the &%-bv%& option, the treatment of
28845 redirections is as just described, unless the &%-v%& or any debugging option is
28846 also specified. In that case, full verification is done for every generated
28847 address and a report is output for each of them.
28851 .section "Client SMTP authorization (CSA)" "SECTverifyCSA"
28852 .cindex "CSA" "verifying"
28853 Client SMTP Authorization is a system that allows a site to advertise
28854 which machines are and are not permitted to send email. This is done by placing
28855 special SRV records in the DNS; these are looked up using the client's HELO
28856 domain. At the time of writing, CSA is still an Internet Draft. Client SMTP
28857 Authorization checks in Exim are performed by the ACL condition:
28861 This fails if the client is not authorized. If there is a DNS problem, or if no
28862 valid CSA SRV record is found, or if the client is authorized, the condition
28863 succeeds. These three cases can be distinguished using the expansion variable
28864 &$csa_status$&, which can take one of the values &"fail"&, &"defer"&,
28865 &"unknown"&, or &"ok"&. The condition does not itself defer because that would
28866 be likely to cause problems for legitimate email.
28868 The error messages produced by the CSA code include slightly more
28869 detail. If &$csa_status$& is &"defer"&, this may be because of problems
28870 looking up the CSA SRV record, or problems looking up the CSA target
28871 address record. There are four reasons for &$csa_status$& being &"fail"&:
28874 The client's host name is explicitly not authorized.
28876 The client's IP address does not match any of the CSA target IP addresses.
28878 The client's host name is authorized but it has no valid target IP addresses
28879 (for example, the target's addresses are IPv6 and the client is using IPv4).
28881 The client's host name has no CSA SRV record but a parent domain has asserted
28882 that all subdomains must be explicitly authorized.
28885 The &%csa%& verification condition can take an argument which is the domain to
28886 use for the DNS query. The default is:
28888 verify = csa/$sender_helo_name
28890 This implementation includes an extension to CSA. If the query domain
28891 is an address literal such as [192.0.2.95], or if it is a bare IP
28892 address, Exim searches for CSA SRV records in the reverse DNS as if
28893 the HELO domain was (for example) &'95.2.0.192.in-addr.arpa'&. Therefore it is
28896 verify = csa/$sender_host_address
28898 In fact, this is the check that Exim performs if the client does not say HELO.
28899 This extension can be turned off by setting the main configuration option
28900 &%dns_csa_use_reverse%& to be false.
28902 If a CSA SRV record is not found for the domain itself, a search
28903 is performed through its parent domains for a record which might be
28904 making assertions about subdomains. The maximum depth of this search is limited
28905 using the main configuration option &%dns_csa_search_limit%&, which is 5 by
28906 default. Exim does not look for CSA SRV records in a top level domain, so the
28907 default settings handle HELO domains as long as seven
28908 (&'hostname.five.four.three.two.one.com'&). This encompasses the vast majority
28909 of legitimate HELO domains.
28911 The &'dnsdb'& lookup also has support for CSA. Although &'dnsdb'& also supports
28912 direct SRV lookups, this is not sufficient because of the extra parent domain
28913 search behaviour of CSA, and (as with PTR lookups) &'dnsdb'& also turns IP
28914 addresses into lookups in the reverse DNS space. The result of a successful
28917 ${lookup dnsdb {csa=$sender_helo_name}}
28919 has two space-separated fields: an authorization code and a target host name.
28920 The authorization code can be &"Y"& for yes, &"N"& for no, &"X"& for explicit
28921 authorization required but absent, or &"?"& for unknown.
28926 .section "Bounce address tag validation" "SECTverifyPRVS"
28927 .cindex "BATV, verifying"
28928 Bounce address tag validation (BATV) is a scheme whereby the envelope senders
28929 of outgoing messages have a cryptographic, timestamped &"tag"& added to them.
28930 Genuine incoming bounce messages should therefore always be addressed to
28931 recipients that have a valid tag. This scheme is a way of detecting unwanted
28932 bounce messages caused by sender address forgeries (often called &"collateral
28933 spam"&), because the recipients of such messages do not include valid tags.
28935 There are two expansion items to help with the implementation of the BATV
28936 &"prvs"& (private signature) scheme in an Exim configuration. This scheme signs
28937 the original envelope sender address by using a simple key to add a hash of the
28938 address and some time-based randomizing information. The &%prvs%& expansion
28939 item creates a signed address, and the &%prvscheck%& expansion item checks one.
28940 The syntax of these expansion items is described in section
28941 &<<SECTexpansionitems>>&.
28943 As an example, suppose the secret per-address keys are stored in an MySQL
28944 database. A query to look up the key for an address could be defined as a macro
28947 PRVSCHECK_SQL = ${lookup mysql{SELECT secret FROM batv_prvs \
28948 WHERE sender='${quote_mysql:$prvscheck_address}'\
28951 Suppose also that the senders who make use of BATV are defined by an address
28952 list called &%batv_senders%&. Then, in the ACL for RCPT commands, you could
28955 # Bounces: drop unsigned addresses for BATV senders
28956 deny message = This address does not send an unsigned reverse path
28958 recipients = +batv_senders
28960 # Bounces: In case of prvs-signed address, check signature.
28961 deny message = Invalid reverse path signature.
28963 condition = ${prvscheck {$local_part@$domain}\
28964 {PRVSCHECK_SQL}{1}}
28965 !condition = $prvscheck_result
28967 The first statement rejects recipients for bounce messages that are addressed
28968 to plain BATV sender addresses, because it is known that BATV senders do not
28969 send out messages with plain sender addresses. The second statement rejects
28970 recipients that are prvs-signed, but with invalid signatures (either because
28971 the key is wrong, or the signature has timed out).
28973 A non-prvs-signed address is not rejected by the second statement, because the
28974 &%prvscheck%& expansion yields an empty string if its first argument is not a
28975 prvs-signed address, thus causing the &%condition%& condition to be false. If
28976 the first argument is a syntactically valid prvs-signed address, the yield is
28977 the third string (in this case &"1"&), whether or not the cryptographic and
28978 timeout checks succeed. The &$prvscheck_result$& variable contains the result
28979 of the checks (empty for failure, &"1"& for success).
28981 There is one more issue you must consider when implementing prvs-signing:
28982 you have to ensure that the routers accept prvs-signed addresses and
28983 deliver them correctly. The easiest way to handle this is to use a &(redirect)&
28984 router to remove the signature with a configuration along these lines:
28988 data = ${prvscheck {$local_part@$domain}{PRVSCHECK_SQL}}
28990 This works because, if the third argument of &%prvscheck%& is empty, the result
28991 of the expansion of a prvs-signed address is the decoded value of the original
28992 address. This router should probably be the first of your routers that handles
28995 To create BATV-signed addresses in the first place, a transport of this form
28998 external_smtp_batv:
29000 return_path = ${prvs {$return_path} \
29001 {${lookup mysql{SELECT \
29002 secret FROM batv_prvs WHERE \
29003 sender='${quote_mysql:$sender_address}'} \
29006 If no key can be found for the existing return path, no signing takes place.
29010 .section "Using an ACL to control relaying" "SECTrelaycontrol"
29011 .cindex "&ACL;" "relay control"
29012 .cindex "relaying" "control by ACL"
29013 .cindex "policy control" "relay control"
29014 An MTA is said to &'relay'& a message if it receives it from some host and
29015 delivers it directly to another host as a result of a remote address contained
29016 within it. Redirecting a local address via an alias or forward file and then
29017 passing the message on to another host is not relaying,
29018 .cindex "&""percent hack""&"
29019 but a redirection as a result of the &"percent hack"& is.
29021 Two kinds of relaying exist, which are termed &"incoming"& and &"outgoing"&.
29022 A host which is acting as a gateway or an MX backup is concerned with incoming
29023 relaying from arbitrary hosts to a specific set of domains. On the other hand,
29024 a host which is acting as a smart host for a number of clients is concerned
29025 with outgoing relaying from those clients to the Internet at large. Often the
29026 same host is fulfilling both functions,
29028 . as illustrated in the diagram below,
29030 but in principle these two kinds of relaying are entirely independent. What is
29031 not wanted is the transmission of mail from arbitrary remote hosts through your
29032 system to arbitrary domains.
29035 You can implement relay control by means of suitable statements in the ACL that
29036 runs for each RCPT command. For convenience, it is often easiest to use
29037 Exim's named list facility to define the domains and hosts involved. For
29038 example, suppose you want to do the following:
29041 Deliver a number of domains to mailboxes on the local host (or process them
29042 locally in some other way). Let's say these are &'my.dom1.example'& and
29043 &'my.dom2.example'&.
29045 Relay mail for a number of other domains for which you are the secondary MX.
29046 These might be &'friend1.example'& and &'friend2.example'&.
29048 Relay mail from the hosts on your local LAN, to whatever domains are involved.
29049 Suppose your LAN is 192.168.45.0/24.
29053 In the main part of the configuration, you put the following definitions:
29055 domainlist local_domains = my.dom1.example : my.dom2.example
29056 domainlist relay_domains = friend1.example : friend2.example
29057 hostlist relay_hosts = 192.168.45.0/24
29059 Now you can use these definitions in the ACL that is run for every RCPT
29063 accept domains = +local_domains : +relay_domains
29064 accept hosts = +relay_hosts
29066 The first statement accepts any RCPT command that contains an address in
29067 the local or relay domains. For any other domain, control passes to the second
29068 statement, which accepts the command only if it comes from one of the relay
29069 hosts. In practice, you will probably want to make your ACL more sophisticated
29070 than this, for example, by including sender and recipient verification. The
29071 default configuration includes a more comprehensive example, which is described
29072 in chapter &<<CHAPdefconfil>>&.
29076 .section "Checking a relay configuration" "SECTcheralcon"
29077 .cindex "relaying" "checking control of"
29078 You can check the relay characteristics of your configuration in the same way
29079 that you can test any ACL behaviour for an incoming SMTP connection, by using
29080 the &%-bh%& option to run a fake SMTP session with which you interact.
29082 For specifically testing for unwanted relaying, the host
29083 &'relay-test.mail-abuse.org'& provides a useful service. If you telnet to this
29084 host from the host on which Exim is running, using the normal telnet port, you
29085 will see a normal telnet connection message and then quite a long delay. Be
29086 patient. The remote host is making an SMTP connection back to your host, and
29087 trying a number of common probes to test for open relay vulnerability. The
29088 results of the tests will eventually appear on your terminal.
29093 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
29094 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
29096 .chapter "Content scanning at ACL time" "CHAPexiscan"
29097 .scindex IIDcosca "content scanning" "at ACL time"
29098 The extension of Exim to include content scanning at ACL time, formerly known
29099 as &"exiscan"&, was originally implemented as a patch by Tom Kistner. The code
29100 was integrated into the main source for Exim release 4.50, and Tom continues to
29101 maintain it. Most of the wording of this chapter is taken from Tom's
29104 It is also possible to scan the content of messages at other times. The
29105 &[local_scan()]& function (see chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&) allows for content
29106 scanning after all the ACLs have run. A transport filter can be used to scan
29107 messages at delivery time (see the &%transport_filter%& option, described in
29108 chapter &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&).
29110 If you want to include the ACL-time content-scanning features when you compile
29111 Exim, you need to arrange for WITH_CONTENT_SCAN to be defined in your
29112 &_Local/Makefile_&. When you do that, the Exim binary is built with:
29115 Two additional ACLs (&%acl_smtp_mime%& and &%acl_not_smtp_mime%&) that are run
29116 for all MIME parts for SMTP and non-SMTP messages, respectively.
29118 Additional ACL conditions and modifiers: &%decode%&, &%malware%&,
29119 &%mime_regex%&, &%regex%&, and &%spam%&. These can be used in the ACL that is
29120 run at the end of message reception (the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL).
29122 An additional control feature (&"no_mbox_unspool"&) that saves spooled copies
29123 of messages, or parts of messages, for debugging purposes.
29125 Additional expansion variables that are set in the new ACL and by the new
29128 Two new main configuration options: &%av_scanner%& and &%spamd_address%&.
29131 There is another content-scanning configuration option for &_Local/Makefile_&,
29132 called WITH_OLD_DEMIME. If this is set, the old, deprecated &%demime%& ACL
29133 condition is compiled, in addition to all the other content-scanning features.
29135 Content-scanning is continually evolving, and new features are still being
29136 added. While such features are still unstable and liable to incompatible
29137 changes, they are made available in Exim by setting options whose names begin
29138 EXPERIMENTAL_ in &_Local/Makefile_&. Such features are not documented in
29139 this manual. You can find out about them by reading the file called
29140 &_doc/experimental.txt_&.
29142 All the content-scanning facilities work on a MBOX copy of the message that is
29143 temporarily created in a file called:
29145 <&'spool_directory'&>&`/scan/`&<&'message_id'&>/<&'message_id'&>&`.eml`&
29147 The &_.eml_& extension is a friendly hint to virus scanners that they can
29148 expect an MBOX-like structure inside that file. The file is created when the
29149 first content scanning facility is called. Subsequent calls to content
29150 scanning conditions open the same file again. The directory is recursively
29151 removed when the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL has finished running, unless
29153 control = no_mbox_unspool
29155 has been encountered. When the MIME ACL decodes files, they are put into the
29156 same directory by default.
29160 .section "Scanning for viruses" "SECTscanvirus"
29161 .cindex "virus scanning"
29162 .cindex "content scanning" "for viruses"
29163 .cindex "content scanning" "the &%malware%& condition"
29164 The &%malware%& ACL condition lets you connect virus scanner software to Exim.
29165 It supports a &"generic"& interface to scanners called via the shell, and
29166 specialized interfaces for &"daemon"& type virus scanners, which are resident
29167 in memory and thus are much faster.
29170 .oindex "&%av_scanner%&"
29171 You can set the &%av_scanner%& option in first part of the Exim configuration
29172 file to specify which scanner to use, together with any additional options that
29173 are needed. The basic syntax is as follows:
29175 &`av_scanner = <`&&'scanner-type'&&`>:<`&&'option1'&&`>:<`&&'option2'&&`>:[...]`&
29177 If you do not set &%av_scanner%&, it defaults to
29179 av_scanner = sophie:/var/run/sophie
29181 If the value of &%av_scanner%& starts with a dollar character, it is expanded
29182 before use. The following scanner types are supported in this release:
29185 .vitem &%aveserver%&
29186 .cindex "virus scanners" "Kaspersky"
29187 This is the scanner daemon of Kaspersky Version 5. You can get a trial version
29188 at &url(http://www.kaspersky.com). This scanner type takes one option,
29189 which is the path to the daemon's UNIX socket. The default is shown in this
29192 av_scanner = aveserver:/var/run/aveserver
29197 .cindex "virus scanners" "clamd"
29198 This daemon-type scanner is GPL and free. You can get it at
29199 &url(http://www.clamav.net/). Some older versions of clamd do not seem to
29200 unpack MIME containers, so it used to be recommended to unpack MIME attachments
29201 in the MIME ACL. This no longer believed to be necessary. One option is
29202 required: either the path and name of a UNIX socket file, or a hostname or IP
29203 number, and a port, separated by space, as in the second of these examples:
29205 av_scanner = clamd:/opt/clamd/socket
29206 av_scanner = clamd:192.0.2.3 1234
29207 av_scanner = clamd:192.0.2.3 1234:local
29209 If the value of av_scanner points to a UNIX socket file or contains the local
29210 keyword, then the ClamAV interface will pass a filename containing the data
29211 to be scanned, which will should normally result in less I/O happening and be
29212 more efficient. Normally in the TCP case, the data is streamed to ClamAV as
29213 Exim does not assume that there is a common filesystem with the remote host.
29214 There is an option WITH_OLD_CLAMAV_STREAM in &_src/EDITME_& available, should
29215 you be running a version of ClamAV prior to 0.95.
29216 If the option is unset, the default is &_/tmp/clamd_&. Thanks to David Saez for
29217 contributing the code for this scanner.
29220 .cindex "virus scanners" "command line interface"
29221 This is the keyword for the generic command line scanner interface. It can be
29222 used to attach virus scanners that are invoked from the shell. This scanner
29223 type takes 3 mandatory options:
29226 The full path and name of the scanner binary, with all command line options,
29227 and a placeholder (&`%s`&) for the directory to scan.
29230 A regular expression to match against the STDOUT and STDERR output of the
29231 virus scanner. If the expression matches, a virus was found. You must make
29232 absolutely sure that this expression matches on &"virus found"&. This is called
29233 the &"trigger"& expression.
29236 Another regular expression, containing exactly one pair of parentheses, to
29237 match the name of the virus found in the scanners output. This is called the
29238 &"name"& expression.
29241 For example, Sophos Sweep reports a virus on a line like this:
29243 Virus 'W32/Magistr-B' found in file ./those.bat
29245 For the trigger expression, we can match the phrase &"found in file"&. For the
29246 name expression, we want to extract the W32/Magistr-B string, so we can match
29247 for the single quotes left and right of it. Altogether, this makes the
29248 configuration setting:
29250 av_scanner = cmdline:\
29251 /path/to/sweep -ss -all -rec -archive %s:\
29252 found in file:'(.+)'
29255 .cindex "virus scanners" "DrWeb"
29256 The DrWeb daemon scanner (&url(http://www.sald.com/)) interface takes one
29257 argument, either a full path to a UNIX socket, or an IP address and port
29258 separated by white space, as in these examples:
29260 av_scanner = drweb:/var/run/drwebd.sock
29261 av_scanner = drweb:192.168.2.20 31337
29263 If you omit the argument, the default path &_/usr/local/drweb/run/drwebd.sock_&
29264 is used. Thanks to Alex Miller for contributing the code for this scanner.
29267 .cindex "virus scanners" "F-Secure"
29268 The F-Secure daemon scanner (&url(http://www.f-secure.com)) takes one
29269 argument which is the path to a UNIX socket. For example:
29271 av_scanner = fsecure:/path/to/.fsav
29273 If no argument is given, the default is &_/var/run/.fsav_&. Thanks to Johan
29274 Thelmen for contributing the code for this scanner.
29276 .vitem &%kavdaemon%&
29277 .cindex "virus scanners" "Kaspersky"
29278 This is the scanner daemon of Kaspersky Version 4. This version of the
29279 Kaspersky scanner is outdated. Please upgrade (see &%aveserver%& above). This
29280 scanner type takes one option, which is the path to the daemon's UNIX socket.
29283 av_scanner = kavdaemon:/opt/AVP/AvpCtl
29285 The default path is &_/var/run/AvpCtl_&.
29288 .cindex "virus scanners" "mksd"
29289 This is a daemon type scanner that is aimed mainly at Polish users, though some
29290 parts of documentation are now available in English. You can get it at
29291 &url(http://linux.mks.com.pl/). The only option for this scanner type is
29292 the maximum number of processes used simultaneously to scan the attachments,
29293 provided that the demime facility is employed and also provided that mksd has
29294 been run with at least the same number of child processes. For example:
29296 av_scanner = mksd:2
29298 You can safely omit this option (the default value is 1).
29301 .cindex "virus scanners" "Sophos and Sophie"
29302 Sophie is a daemon that uses Sophos' &%libsavi%& library to scan for viruses.
29303 You can get Sophie at &url(http://www.clanfield.info/sophie/). The only option
29304 for this scanner type is the path to the UNIX socket that Sophie uses for
29305 client communication. For example:
29307 av_scanner = sophie:/tmp/sophie
29309 The default path is &_/var/run/sophie_&, so if you are using this, you can omit
29313 When &%av_scanner%& is correctly set, you can use the &%malware%& condition in
29314 the DATA ACL. &*Note*&: You cannot use the &%malware%& condition in the MIME
29317 The &%av_scanner%& option is expanded each time &%malware%& is called. This
29318 makes it possible to use different scanners. See further below for an example.
29319 The &%malware%& condition caches its results, so when you use it multiple times
29320 for the same message, the actual scanning process is only carried out once.
29321 However, using expandable items in &%av_scanner%& disables this caching, in
29322 which case each use of the &%malware%& condition causes a new scan of the
29325 The &%malware%& condition takes a right-hand argument that is expanded before
29326 use. It can then be one of
29329 &"true"&, &"*"&, or &"1"&, in which case the message is scanned for viruses.
29330 The condition succeeds if a virus was found, and fail otherwise. This is the
29333 &"false"& or &"0"& or an empty string, in which case no scanning is done and
29334 the condition fails immediately.
29336 A regular expression, in which case the message is scanned for viruses. The
29337 condition succeeds if a virus is found and its name matches the regular
29338 expression. This allows you to take special actions on certain types of virus.
29341 You can append &`/defer_ok`& to the &%malware%& condition to accept messages
29342 even if there is a problem with the virus scanner. Otherwise, such a problem
29343 causes the ACL to defer.
29345 .vindex "&$malware_name$&"
29346 When a virus is found, the condition sets up an expansion variable called
29347 &$malware_name$& that contains the name of the virus. You can use it in a
29348 &%message%& modifier that specifies the error returned to the sender, and/or in
29351 If your virus scanner cannot unpack MIME and TNEF containers itself, you should
29352 use the &%demime%& condition (see section &<<SECTdemimecond>>&) before the
29353 &%malware%& condition.
29355 Beware the interaction of Exim's &%message_size_limit%& with any size limits
29356 imposed by your anti-virus scanner.
29358 Here is a very simple scanning example:
29360 deny message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
29364 The next example accepts messages when there is a problem with the scanner:
29366 deny message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
29368 malware = */defer_ok
29370 The next example shows how to use an ACL variable to scan with both sophie and
29371 aveserver. It assumes you have set:
29373 av_scanner = $acl_m0
29375 in the main Exim configuration.
29377 deny message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
29378 set acl_m0 = sophie
29381 deny message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
29382 set acl_m0 = aveserver
29387 .section "Scanning with SpamAssassin" "SECTscanspamass"
29388 .cindex "content scanning" "for spam"
29389 .cindex "spam scanning"
29390 .cindex "SpamAssassin"
29391 The &%spam%& ACL condition calls SpamAssassin's &%spamd%& daemon to get a spam
29392 score and a report for the message. You can get SpamAssassin at
29393 &url(http://www.spamassassin.org), or, if you have a working Perl
29394 installation, you can use CPAN by running:
29396 perl -MCPAN -e 'install Mail::SpamAssassin'
29398 SpamAssassin has its own set of configuration files. Please review its
29399 documentation to see how you can tweak it. The default installation should work
29402 .oindex "&%spamd_address%&"
29403 After having installed and configured SpamAssassin, start the &%spamd%& daemon.
29404 By default, it listens on 127.0.0.1, TCP port 783. If you use another host or
29405 port for &%spamd%&, you must set the &%spamd_address%& option in the global
29406 part of the Exim configuration as follows (example):
29408 spamd_address = 192.168.99.45 387
29410 You do not need to set this option if you use the default. As of version 2.60,
29411 &%spamd%& also supports communication over UNIX sockets. If you want to use
29412 these, supply &%spamd_address%& with an absolute file name instead of a
29415 spamd_address = /var/run/spamd_socket
29417 You can have multiple &%spamd%& servers to improve scalability. These can
29418 reside on other hardware reachable over the network. To specify multiple
29419 &%spamd%& servers, put multiple address/port pairs in the &%spamd_address%&
29420 option, separated with colons:
29422 spamd_address = 192.168.2.10 783 : \
29423 192.168.2.11 783 : \
29426 Up to 32 &%spamd%& servers are supported. The servers are queried in a random
29427 fashion. When a server fails to respond to the connection attempt, all other
29428 servers are tried until one succeeds. If no server responds, the &%spam%&
29431 &*Warning*&: It is not possible to use the UNIX socket connection method with
29432 multiple &%spamd%& servers.
29434 The &%spamd_address%& variable is expanded before use if it starts with
29435 a dollar sign. In this case, the expansion may return a string that is
29436 used as the list so that multiple spamd servers can be the result of an
29439 .section "Calling SpamAssassin from an Exim ACL" "SECID206"
29440 Here is a simple example of the use of the &%spam%& condition in a DATA ACL:
29442 deny message = This message was classified as SPAM
29445 The right-hand side of the &%spam%& condition specifies a name. This is
29446 relevant if you have set up multiple SpamAssassin profiles. If you do not want
29447 to scan using a specific profile, but rather use the SpamAssassin system-wide
29448 default profile, you can scan for an unknown name, or simply use &"nobody"&.
29449 However, you must put something on the right-hand side.
29451 The name allows you to use per-domain or per-user antispam profiles in
29452 principle, but this is not straightforward in practice, because a message may
29453 have multiple recipients, not necessarily all in the same domain. Because the
29454 &%spam%& condition has to be called from a DATA ACL in order to be able to
29455 read the contents of the message, the variables &$local_part$& and &$domain$&
29458 The right-hand side of the &%spam%& condition is expanded before being used, so
29459 you can put lookups or conditions there. When the right-hand side evaluates to
29460 &"0"& or &"false"&, no scanning is done and the condition fails immediately.
29463 Scanning with SpamAssassin uses a lot of resources. If you scan every message,
29464 large ones may cause significant performance degradation. As most spam messages
29465 are quite small, it is recommended that you do not scan the big ones. For
29468 deny message = This message was classified as SPAM
29469 condition = ${if < {$message_size}{10K}}
29473 The &%spam%& condition returns true if the threshold specified in the user's
29474 SpamAssassin profile has been matched or exceeded. If you want to use the
29475 &%spam%& condition for its side effects (see the variables below), you can make
29476 it always return &"true"& by appending &`:true`& to the username.
29478 .cindex "spam scanning" "returned variables"
29479 When the &%spam%& condition is run, it sets up a number of expansion
29480 variables. These variables are saved with the received message, thus they are
29481 available for use at delivery time.
29484 .vitem &$spam_score$&
29485 The spam score of the message, for example &"3.4"& or &"30.5"&. This is useful
29486 for inclusion in log or reject messages.
29488 .vitem &$spam_score_int$&
29489 The spam score of the message, multiplied by ten, as an integer value. For
29490 example &"34"& or &"305"&. It may appear to disagree with &$spam_score$&
29491 because &$spam_score$& is rounded and &$spam_score_int$& is truncated.
29492 The integer value is useful for numeric comparisons in conditions.
29494 .vitem &$spam_bar$&
29495 A string consisting of a number of &"+"& or &"-"& characters, representing the
29496 integer part of the spam score value. A spam score of 4.4 would have a
29497 &$spam_bar$& value of &"++++"&. This is useful for inclusion in warning
29498 headers, since MUAs can match on such strings.
29500 .vitem &$spam_report$&
29501 A multiline text table, containing the full SpamAssassin report for the
29502 message. Useful for inclusion in headers or reject messages.
29505 The &%spam%& condition caches its results unless expansion in
29506 spamd_address was used. If you call it again with the same user name, it
29507 does not scan again, but rather returns the same values as before.
29509 The &%spam%& condition returns DEFER if there is any error while running
29510 the message through SpamAssassin or if the expansion of spamd_address
29511 failed. If you want to treat DEFER as FAIL (to pass on to the next ACL
29512 statement block), append &`/defer_ok`& to the right-hand side of the
29513 spam condition, like this:
29515 deny message = This message was classified as SPAM
29516 spam = joe/defer_ok
29518 This causes messages to be accepted even if there is a problem with &%spamd%&.
29520 Here is a longer, commented example of the use of the &%spam%&
29523 # put headers in all messages (no matter if spam or not)
29524 warn spam = nobody:true
29525 add_header = X-Spam-Score: $spam_score ($spam_bar)
29526 add_header = X-Spam-Report: $spam_report
29528 # add second subject line with *SPAM* marker when message
29529 # is over threshold
29531 add_header = Subject: *SPAM* $h_Subject:
29533 # reject spam at high scores (> 12)
29534 deny message = This message scored $spam_score spam points.
29536 condition = ${if >{$spam_score_int}{120}{1}{0}}
29541 .section "Scanning MIME parts" "SECTscanmimepart"
29542 .cindex "content scanning" "MIME parts"
29543 .cindex "MIME content scanning"
29544 .oindex "&%acl_smtp_mime%&"
29545 .oindex "&%acl_not_smtp_mime%&"
29546 The &%acl_smtp_mime%& global option specifies an ACL that is called once for
29547 each MIME part of an SMTP message, including multipart types, in the sequence
29548 of their position in the message. Similarly, the &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& option
29549 specifies an ACL that is used for the MIME parts of non-SMTP messages. These
29550 options may both refer to the same ACL if you want the same processing in both
29553 These ACLs are called (possibly many times) just before the &%acl_smtp_data%&
29554 ACL in the case of an SMTP message, or just before the &%acl_not_smtp%& ACL in
29555 the case of a non-SMTP message. However, a MIME ACL is called only if the
29556 message contains a &'Content-Type:'& header line. When a call to a MIME
29557 ACL does not yield &"accept"&, ACL processing is aborted and the appropriate
29558 result code is sent to the client. In the case of an SMTP message, the
29559 &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL is not called when this happens.
29561 You cannot use the &%malware%& or &%spam%& conditions in a MIME ACL; these can
29562 only be used in the DATA or non-SMTP ACLs. However, you can use the &%regex%&
29563 condition to match against the raw MIME part. You can also use the
29564 &%mime_regex%& condition to match against the decoded MIME part (see section
29565 &<<SECTscanregex>>&).
29567 At the start of a MIME ACL, a number of variables are set from the header
29568 information for the relevant MIME part. These are described below. The contents
29569 of the MIME part are not by default decoded into a disk file except for MIME
29570 parts whose content-type is &"message/rfc822"&. If you want to decode a MIME
29571 part into a disk file, you can use the &%decode%& condition. The general
29574 &`decode = [/`&<&'path'&>&`/]`&<&'filename'&>
29576 The right hand side is expanded before use. After expansion,
29580 &"0"& or &"false"&, in which case no decoding is done.
29582 The string &"default"&. In that case, the file is put in the temporary
29583 &"default"& directory <&'spool_directory'&>&_/scan/_&<&'message_id'&>&_/_& with
29584 a sequential file name consisting of the message id and a sequence number. The
29585 full path and name is available in &$mime_decoded_filename$& after decoding.
29587 A full path name starting with a slash. If the full name is an existing
29588 directory, it is used as a replacement for the default directory. The filename
29589 is then sequentially assigned. If the path does not exist, it is used as
29590 the full path and file name.
29592 If the string does not start with a slash, it is used as the
29593 filename, and the default path is then used.
29595 The &%decode%& condition normally succeeds. It is only false for syntax
29596 errors or unusual circumstances such as memory shortages. You can easily decode
29597 a file with its original, proposed filename using
29599 decode = $mime_filename
29601 However, you should keep in mind that &$mime_filename$& might contain
29602 anything. If you place files outside of the default path, they are not
29603 automatically unlinked.
29605 For RFC822 attachments (these are messages attached to messages, with a
29606 content-type of &"message/rfc822"&), the ACL is called again in the same manner
29607 as for the primary message, only that the &$mime_is_rfc822$& expansion
29608 variable is set (see below). Attached messages are always decoded to disk
29609 before being checked, and the files are unlinked once the check is done.
29611 The MIME ACL supports the &%regex%& and &%mime_regex%& conditions. These can be
29612 used to match regular expressions against raw and decoded MIME parts,
29613 respectively. They are described in section &<<SECTscanregex>>&.
29615 .cindex "MIME content scanning" "returned variables"
29616 The following list describes all expansion variables that are
29617 available in the MIME ACL:
29620 .vitem &$mime_boundary$&
29621 If the current part is a multipart (see &$mime_is_multipart$&) below, it should
29622 have a boundary string, which is stored in this variable. If the current part
29623 has no boundary parameter in the &'Content-Type:'& header, this variable
29624 contains the empty string.
29626 .vitem &$mime_charset$&
29627 This variable contains the character set identifier, if one was found in the
29628 &'Content-Type:'& header. Examples for charset identifiers are:
29634 Please note that this value is not normalized, so you should do matches
29635 case-insensitively.
29637 .vitem &$mime_content_description$&
29638 This variable contains the normalized content of the &'Content-Description:'&
29639 header. It can contain a human-readable description of the parts content. Some
29640 implementations repeat the filename for attachments here, but they are usually
29641 only used for display purposes.
29643 .vitem &$mime_content_disposition$&
29644 This variable contains the normalized content of the &'Content-Disposition:'&
29645 header. You can expect strings like &"attachment"& or &"inline"& here.
29647 .vitem &$mime_content_id$&
29648 This variable contains the normalized content of the &'Content-ID:'& header.
29649 This is a unique ID that can be used to reference a part from another part.
29651 .vitem &$mime_content_size$&
29652 This variable is set only after the &%decode%& modifier (see above) has been
29653 successfully run. It contains the size of the decoded part in kilobytes. The
29654 size is always rounded up to full kilobytes, so only a completely empty part
29655 has a &$mime_content_size$& of zero.
29657 .vitem &$mime_content_transfer_encoding$&
29658 This variable contains the normalized content of the
29659 &'Content-transfer-encoding:'& header. This is a symbolic name for an encoding
29660 type. Typical values are &"base64"& and &"quoted-printable"&.
29662 .vitem &$mime_content_type$&
29663 If the MIME part has a &'Content-Type:'& header, this variable contains its
29664 value, lowercased, and without any options (like &"name"& or &"charset"&). Here
29665 are some examples of popular MIME types, as they may appear in this variable:
29669 application/octet-stream
29673 If the MIME part has no &'Content-Type:'& header, this variable contains the
29676 .vitem &$mime_decoded_filename$&
29677 This variable is set only after the &%decode%& modifier (see above) has been
29678 successfully run. It contains the full path and file name of the file
29679 containing the decoded data.
29684 .vitem &$mime_filename$&
29685 This is perhaps the most important of the MIME variables. It contains a
29686 proposed filename for an attachment, if one was found in either the
29687 &'Content-Type:'& or &'Content-Disposition:'& headers. The filename will be
29688 RFC2047 decoded, but no additional sanity checks are done. If no filename was
29689 found, this variable contains the empty string.
29691 .vitem &$mime_is_coverletter$&
29692 This variable attempts to differentiate the &"cover letter"& of an e-mail from
29693 attached data. It can be used to clamp down on flashy or unnecessarily encoded
29694 content in the cover letter, while not restricting attachments at all.
29696 The variable contains 1 (true) for a MIME part believed to be part of the
29697 cover letter, and 0 (false) for an attachment. At present, the algorithm is as
29701 The outermost MIME part of a message is always a cover letter.
29704 If a multipart/alternative or multipart/related MIME part is a cover letter,
29705 so are all MIME subparts within that multipart.
29708 If any other multipart is a cover letter, the first subpart is a cover letter,
29709 and the rest are attachments.
29712 All parts contained within an attachment multipart are attachments.
29715 As an example, the following will ban &"HTML mail"& (including that sent with
29716 alternative plain text), while allowing HTML files to be attached. HTML
29717 coverletter mail attached to non-HMTL coverletter mail will also be allowed:
29719 deny message = HTML mail is not accepted here
29720 !condition = $mime_is_rfc822
29721 condition = $mime_is_coverletter
29722 condition = ${if eq{$mime_content_type}{text/html}{1}{0}}
29724 .vitem &$mime_is_multipart$&
29725 This variable has the value 1 (true) when the current part has the main type
29726 &"multipart"&, for example &"multipart/alternative"& or &"multipart/mixed"&.
29727 Since multipart entities only serve as containers for other parts, you may not
29728 want to carry out specific actions on them.
29730 .vitem &$mime_is_rfc822$&
29731 This variable has the value 1 (true) if the current part is not a part of the
29732 checked message itself, but part of an attached message. Attached message
29733 decoding is fully recursive.
29735 .vitem &$mime_part_count$&
29736 This variable is a counter that is raised for each processed MIME part. It
29737 starts at zero for the very first part (which is usually a multipart). The
29738 counter is per-message, so it is reset when processing RFC822 attachments (see
29739 &$mime_is_rfc822$&). The counter stays set after &%acl_smtp_mime%& is
29740 complete, so you can use it in the DATA ACL to determine the number of MIME
29741 parts of a message. For non-MIME messages, this variable contains the value -1.
29746 .section "Scanning with regular expressions" "SECTscanregex"
29747 .cindex "content scanning" "with regular expressions"
29748 .cindex "regular expressions" "content scanning with"
29749 You can specify your own custom regular expression matches on the full body of
29750 the message, or on individual MIME parts.
29752 The &%regex%& condition takes one or more regular expressions as arguments and
29753 matches them against the full message (when called in the DATA ACL) or a raw
29754 MIME part (when called in the MIME ACL). The &%regex%& condition matches
29755 linewise, with a maximum line length of 32K characters. That means you cannot
29756 have multiline matches with the &%regex%& condition.
29758 The &%mime_regex%& condition can be called only in the MIME ACL. It matches up
29759 to 32K of decoded content (the whole content at once, not linewise). If the
29760 part has not been decoded with the &%decode%& modifier earlier in the ACL, it
29761 is decoded automatically when &%mime_regex%& is executed (using default path
29762 and filename values). If the decoded data is larger than 32K, only the first
29763 32K characters are checked.
29765 The regular expressions are passed as a colon-separated list. To include a
29766 literal colon, you must double it. Since the whole right-hand side string is
29767 expanded before being used, you must also escape dollar signs and backslashes
29768 with more backslashes, or use the &`\N`& facility to disable expansion.
29769 Here is a simple example that contains two regular expressions:
29771 deny message = contains blacklisted regex ($regex_match_string)
29772 regex = [Mm]ortgage : URGENT BUSINESS PROPOSAL
29774 The conditions returns true if any one of the regular expressions matches. The
29775 &$regex_match_string$& expansion variable is then set up and contains the
29776 matching regular expression.
29778 &*Warning*&: With large messages, these conditions can be fairly
29784 .section "The demime condition" "SECTdemimecond"
29785 .cindex "content scanning" "MIME checking"
29786 .cindex "MIME content scanning"
29787 The &%demime%& ACL condition provides MIME unpacking, sanity checking and file
29788 extension blocking. It is usable only in the DATA and non-SMTP ACLs. The
29789 &%demime%& condition uses a simpler interface to MIME decoding than the MIME
29790 ACL functionality, but provides no additional facilities. Please note that this
29791 condition is deprecated and kept only for backward compatibility. You must set
29792 the WITH_OLD_DEMIME option in &_Local/Makefile_& at build time to be able to
29793 use the &%demime%& condition.
29795 The &%demime%& condition unpacks MIME containers in the message. It detects
29796 errors in MIME containers and can match file extensions found in the message
29797 against a list. Using this facility produces files containing the unpacked MIME
29798 parts of the message in the temporary scan directory. If you do antivirus
29799 scanning, it is recommended that you use the &%demime%& condition before the
29800 antivirus (&%malware%&) condition.
29802 On the right-hand side of the &%demime%& condition you can pass a
29803 colon-separated list of file extensions that it should match against. For
29806 deny message = Found blacklisted file attachment
29807 demime = vbs:com:bat:pif:prf:lnk
29809 If one of the file extensions is found, the condition is true, otherwise it is
29810 false. If there is a temporary error while demimeing (for example, &"disk
29811 full"&), the condition defers, and the message is temporarily rejected (unless
29812 the condition is on a &%warn%& verb).
29814 The right-hand side is expanded before being treated as a list, so you can have
29815 conditions and lookups there. If it expands to an empty string, &"false"&, or
29816 zero (&"0"&), no demimeing is done and the condition is false.
29818 The &%demime%& condition set the following variables:
29821 .vitem &$demime_errorlevel$&
29822 .vindex "&$demime_errorlevel$&"
29823 When an error is detected in a MIME container, this variable contains the
29824 severity of the error, as an integer number. The higher the value, the more
29825 severe the error (the current maximum value is 3). If this variable is unset or
29826 zero, no error occurred.
29828 .vitem &$demime_reason$&
29829 .vindex "&$demime_reason$&"
29830 When &$demime_errorlevel$& is greater than zero, this variable contains a
29831 human-readable text string describing the MIME error that occurred.
29835 .vitem &$found_extension$&
29836 .vindex "&$found_extension$&"
29837 When the &%demime%& condition is true, this variable contains the file
29838 extension it found.
29841 Both &$demime_errorlevel$& and &$demime_reason$& are set by the first call of
29842 the &%demime%& condition, and are not changed on subsequent calls.
29844 If you do not want to check for file extensions, but rather use the &%demime%&
29845 condition for unpacking or error checking purposes, pass &"*"& as the
29846 right-hand side value. Here is a more elaborate example of how to use this
29849 # Reject messages with serious MIME container errors
29850 deny message = Found MIME error ($demime_reason).
29852 condition = ${if >{$demime_errorlevel}{2}{1}{0}}
29854 # Reject known virus spreading file extensions.
29855 # Accepting these is pretty much braindead.
29856 deny message = contains $found_extension file (blacklisted).
29857 demime = com:vbs:bat:pif:scr
29859 # Freeze .exe and .doc files. Postmaster can
29860 # examine them and eventually thaw them.
29861 deny log_message = Another $found_extension file.
29870 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
29871 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
29873 .chapter "Adding a local scan function to Exim" "CHAPlocalscan" &&&
29874 "Local scan function"
29875 .scindex IIDlosca "&[local_scan()]& function" "description of"
29876 .cindex "customizing" "input scan using C function"
29877 .cindex "policy control" "by local scan function"
29878 In these days of email worms, viruses, and ever-increasing spam, some sites
29879 want to apply a lot of checking to messages before accepting them.
29881 The content scanning extension (chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&) has facilities for
29882 passing messages to external virus and spam scanning software. You can also do
29883 a certain amount in Exim itself through string expansions and the &%condition%&
29884 condition in the ACL that runs after the SMTP DATA command or the ACL for
29885 non-SMTP messages (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&), but this has its limitations.
29887 To allow for further customization to a site's own requirements, there is the
29888 possibility of linking Exim with a private message scanning function, written
29889 in C. If you want to run code that is written in something other than C, you
29890 can of course use a little C stub to call it.
29892 The local scan function is run once for every incoming message, at the point
29893 when Exim is just about to accept the message.
29894 It can therefore be used to control non-SMTP messages from local processes as
29895 well as messages arriving via SMTP.
29897 Exim applies a timeout to calls of the local scan function, and there is an
29898 option called &%local_scan_timeout%& for setting it. The default is 5 minutes.
29899 Zero means &"no timeout"&.
29900 Exim also sets up signal handlers for SIGSEGV, SIGILL, SIGFPE, and SIGBUS
29901 before calling the local scan function, so that the most common types of crash
29902 are caught. If the timeout is exceeded or one of those signals is caught, the
29903 incoming message is rejected with a temporary error if it is an SMTP message.
29904 For a non-SMTP message, the message is dropped and Exim ends with a non-zero
29905 code. The incident is logged on the main and reject logs.
29909 .section "Building Exim to use a local scan function" "SECID207"
29910 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "building Exim to use"
29911 To make use of the local scan function feature, you must tell Exim where your
29912 function is before building Exim, by setting LOCAL_SCAN_SOURCE in your
29913 &_Local/Makefile_&. A recommended place to put it is in the &_Local_&
29914 directory, so you might set
29916 LOCAL_SCAN_SOURCE=Local/local_scan.c
29918 for example. The function must be called &[local_scan()]&. It is called by
29919 Exim after it has received a message, when the success return code is about to
29920 be sent. This is after all the ACLs have been run. The return code from your
29921 function controls whether the message is actually accepted or not. There is a
29922 commented template function (that just accepts the message) in the file
29923 _src/local_scan.c_.
29925 If you want to make use of Exim's run time configuration file to set options
29926 for your &[local_scan()]& function, you must also set
29928 LOCAL_SCAN_HAS_OPTIONS=yes
29930 in &_Local/Makefile_& (see section &<<SECTconoptloc>>& below).
29935 .section "API for local_scan()" "SECTapiforloc"
29936 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "API description"
29937 You must include this line near the start of your code:
29939 #include "local_scan.h"
29941 This header file defines a number of variables and other values, and the
29942 prototype for the function itself. Exim is coded to use unsigned char values
29943 almost exclusively, and one of the things this header defines is a shorthand
29944 for &`unsigned char`& called &`uschar`&.
29945 It also contains the following macro definitions, to simplify casting character
29946 strings and pointers to character strings:
29948 #define CS (char *)
29949 #define CCS (const char *)
29950 #define CSS (char **)
29951 #define US (unsigned char *)
29952 #define CUS (const unsigned char *)
29953 #define USS (unsigned char **)
29955 The function prototype for &[local_scan()]& is:
29957 extern int local_scan(int fd, uschar **return_text);
29959 The arguments are as follows:
29962 &%fd%& is a file descriptor for the file that contains the body of the message
29963 (the -D file). The file is open for reading and writing, but updating it is not
29964 recommended. &*Warning*&: You must &'not'& close this file descriptor.
29966 The descriptor is positioned at character 19 of the file, which is the first
29967 character of the body itself, because the first 19 characters are the message
29968 id followed by &`-D`& and a newline. If you rewind the file, you should use the
29969 macro SPOOL_DATA_START_OFFSET to reset to the start of the data, just in
29970 case this changes in some future version.
29972 &%return_text%& is an address which you can use to return a pointer to a text
29973 string at the end of the function. The value it points to on entry is NULL.
29976 The function must return an &%int%& value which is one of the following macros:
29979 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT`&
29980 .vindex "&$local_scan_data$&"
29981 The message is accepted. If you pass back a string of text, it is saved with
29982 the message, and made available in the variable &$local_scan_data$&. No
29983 newlines are permitted (if there are any, they are turned into spaces) and the
29984 maximum length of text is 1000 characters.
29986 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT_FREEZE`&
29987 This behaves as LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT, except that the accepted message is
29988 queued without immediate delivery, and is frozen.
29990 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT_QUEUE`&
29991 This behaves as LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT, except that the accepted message is
29992 queued without immediate delivery.
29994 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT`&
29995 The message is rejected; the returned text is used as an error message which is
29996 passed back to the sender and which is also logged. Newlines are permitted &--
29997 they cause a multiline response for SMTP rejections, but are converted to
29998 &`\n`& in log lines. If no message is given, &"Administrative prohibition"& is
30001 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT`&
30002 The message is temporarily rejected; the returned text is used as an error
30003 message as for LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT. If no message is given, &"Temporary local
30006 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT_NOLOGHDR`&
30007 This behaves as LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT, except that the header of the rejected
30008 message is not written to the reject log. It has the effect of unsetting the
30009 &%rejected_header%& log selector for just this rejection. If
30010 &%rejected_header%& is already unset (see the discussion of the
30011 &%log_selection%& option in section &<<SECTlogselector>>&), this code is the
30012 same as LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT.
30014 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT_NOLOGHDR`&
30015 This code is a variation of LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT in the same way that
30016 LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT_NOLOGHDR is a variation of LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT.
30019 If the message is not being received by interactive SMTP, rejections are
30020 reported by writing to &%stderr%& or by sending an email, as configured by the
30021 &%-oe%& command line options.
30025 .section "Configuration options for local_scan()" "SECTconoptloc"
30026 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "configuration options"
30027 It is possible to have option settings in the main configuration file
30028 that set values in static variables in the &[local_scan()]& module. If you
30029 want to do this, you must have the line
30031 LOCAL_SCAN_HAS_OPTIONS=yes
30033 in your &_Local/Makefile_& when you build Exim. (This line is in
30034 &_OS/Makefile-Default_&, commented out). Then, in the &[local_scan()]& source
30035 file, you must define static variables to hold the option values, and a table
30038 The table must be a vector called &%local_scan_options%&, of type
30039 &`optionlist`&. Each entry is a triplet, consisting of a name, an option type,
30040 and a pointer to the variable that holds the value. The entries must appear in
30041 alphabetical order. Following &%local_scan_options%& you must also define a
30042 variable called &%local_scan_options_count%& that contains the number of
30043 entries in the table. Here is a short example, showing two kinds of option:
30045 static int my_integer_option = 42;
30046 static uschar *my_string_option = US"a default string";
30048 optionlist local_scan_options[] = {
30049 { "my_integer", opt_int, &my_integer_option },
30050 { "my_string", opt_stringptr, &my_string_option }
30053 int local_scan_options_count =
30054 sizeof(local_scan_options)/sizeof(optionlist);
30056 The values of the variables can now be changed from Exim's runtime
30057 configuration file by including a local scan section as in this example:
30061 my_string = some string of text...
30063 The available types of option data are as follows:
30066 .vitem &*opt_bool*&
30067 This specifies a boolean (true/false) option. The address should point to a
30068 variable of type &`BOOL`&, which will be set to TRUE or FALSE, which are macros
30069 that are defined as &"1"& and &"0"&, respectively. If you want to detect
30070 whether such a variable has been set at all, you can initialize it to
30071 TRUE_UNSET. (BOOL variables are integers underneath, so can hold more than two
30074 .vitem &*opt_fixed*&
30075 This specifies a fixed point number, such as is used for load averages.
30076 The address should point to a variable of type &`int`&. The value is stored
30077 multiplied by 1000, so, for example, 1.4142 is truncated and stored as 1414.
30080 This specifies an integer; the address should point to a variable of type
30081 &`int`&. The value may be specified in any of the integer formats accepted by
30084 .vitem &*opt_mkint*&
30085 This is the same as &%opt_int%&, except that when such a value is output in a
30086 &%-bP%& listing, if it is an exact number of kilobytes or megabytes, it is
30087 printed with the suffix K or M.
30089 .vitem &*opt_octint*&
30090 This also specifies an integer, but the value is always interpreted as an
30091 octal integer, whether or not it starts with the digit zero, and it is
30092 always output in octal.
30094 .vitem &*opt_stringptr*&
30095 This specifies a string value; the address must be a pointer to a
30096 variable that points to a string (for example, of type &`uschar *`&).
30098 .vitem &*opt_time*&
30099 This specifies a time interval value. The address must point to a variable of
30100 type &`int`&. The value that is placed there is a number of seconds.
30103 If the &%-bP%& command line option is followed by &`local_scan`&, Exim prints
30104 out the values of all the &[local_scan()]& options.
30108 .section "Available Exim variables" "SECID208"
30109 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "available Exim variables"
30110 The header &_local_scan.h_& gives you access to a number of C variables. These
30111 are the only ones that are guaranteed to be maintained from release to release.
30112 Note, however, that you can obtain the value of any Exim expansion variable,
30113 including &$recipients$&, by calling &'expand_string()'&. The exported
30114 C variables are as follows:
30117 .vitem &*int&~body_linecount*&
30118 This variable contains the number of lines in the message's body.
30120 .vitem &*int&~body_zerocount*&
30121 This variable contains the number of binary zero bytes in the message's body.
30123 .vitem &*unsigned&~int&~debug_selector*&
30124 This variable is set to zero when no debugging is taking place. Otherwise, it
30125 is a bitmap of debugging selectors. Two bits are identified for use in
30126 &[local_scan()]&; they are defined as macros:
30129 The &`D_v`& bit is set when &%-v%& was present on the command line. This is a
30130 testing option that is not privileged &-- any caller may set it. All the
30131 other selector bits can be set only by admin users.
30134 The &`D_local_scan`& bit is provided for use by &[local_scan()]&; it is set
30135 by the &`+local_scan`& debug selector. It is not included in the default set
30139 Thus, to write to the debugging output only when &`+local_scan`& has been
30140 selected, you should use code like this:
30142 if ((debug_selector & D_local_scan) != 0)
30143 debug_printf("xxx", ...);
30145 .vitem &*uschar&~*expand_string_message*&
30146 After a failing call to &'expand_string()'& (returned value NULL), the
30147 variable &%expand_string_message%& contains the error message, zero-terminated.
30149 .vitem &*header_line&~*header_list*&
30150 A pointer to a chain of header lines. The &%header_line%& structure is
30153 .vitem &*header_line&~*header_last*&
30154 A pointer to the last of the header lines.
30156 .vitem &*uschar&~*headers_charset*&
30157 The value of the &%headers_charset%& configuration option.
30159 .vitem &*BOOL&~host_checking*&
30160 This variable is TRUE during a host checking session that is initiated by the
30161 &%-bh%& command line option.
30163 .vitem &*uschar&~*interface_address*&
30164 The IP address of the interface that received the message, as a string. This
30165 is NULL for locally submitted messages.
30167 .vitem &*int&~interface_port*&
30168 The port on which this message was received. When testing with the &%-bh%&
30169 command line option, the value of this variable is -1 unless a port has been
30170 specified via the &%-oMi%& option.
30172 .vitem &*uschar&~*message_id*&
30173 This variable contains Exim's message id for the incoming message (the value of
30174 &$message_exim_id$&) as a zero-terminated string.
30176 .vitem &*uschar&~*received_protocol*&
30177 The name of the protocol by which the message was received.
30179 .vitem &*int&~recipients_count*&
30180 The number of accepted recipients.
30182 .vitem &*recipient_item&~*recipients_list*&
30183 .cindex "recipient" "adding in local scan"
30184 .cindex "recipient" "removing in local scan"
30185 The list of accepted recipients, held in a vector of length
30186 &%recipients_count%&. The &%recipient_item%& structure is discussed below. You
30187 can add additional recipients by calling &'receive_add_recipient()'& (see
30188 below). You can delete recipients by removing them from the vector and
30189 adjusting the value in &%recipients_count%&. In particular, by setting
30190 &%recipients_count%& to zero you remove all recipients. If you then return the
30191 value &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT`&, the message is accepted, but immediately
30192 blackholed. To replace the recipients, you can set &%recipients_count%& to zero
30193 and then call &'receive_add_recipient()'& as often as needed.
30195 .vitem &*uschar&~*sender_address*&
30196 The envelope sender address. For bounce messages this is the empty string.
30198 .vitem &*uschar&~*sender_host_address*&
30199 The IP address of the sending host, as a string. This is NULL for
30200 locally-submitted messages.
30202 .vitem &*uschar&~*sender_host_authenticated*&
30203 The name of the authentication mechanism that was used, or NULL if the message
30204 was not received over an authenticated SMTP connection.
30206 .vitem &*uschar&~*sender_host_name*&
30207 The name of the sending host, if known.
30209 .vitem &*int&~sender_host_port*&
30210 The port on the sending host.
30212 .vitem &*BOOL&~smtp_input*&
30213 This variable is TRUE for all SMTP input, including BSMTP.
30215 .vitem &*BOOL&~smtp_batched_input*&
30216 This variable is TRUE for BSMTP input.
30218 .vitem &*int&~store_pool*&
30219 The contents of this variable control which pool of memory is used for new
30220 requests. See section &<<SECTmemhanloc>>& for details.
30224 .section "Structure of header lines" "SECID209"
30225 The &%header_line%& structure contains the members listed below.
30226 You can add additional header lines by calling the &'header_add()'& function
30227 (see below). You can cause header lines to be ignored (deleted) by setting
30232 .vitem &*struct&~header_line&~*next*&
30233 A pointer to the next header line, or NULL for the last line.
30235 .vitem &*int&~type*&
30236 A code identifying certain headers that Exim recognizes. The codes are printing
30237 characters, and are documented in chapter &<<CHAPspool>>& of this manual.
30238 Notice in particular that any header line whose type is * is not transmitted
30239 with the message. This flagging is used for header lines that have been
30240 rewritten, or are to be removed (for example, &'Envelope-sender:'& header
30241 lines.) Effectively, * means &"deleted"&.
30243 .vitem &*int&~slen*&
30244 The number of characters in the header line, including the terminating and any
30247 .vitem &*uschar&~*text*&
30248 A pointer to the text of the header. It always ends with a newline, followed by
30249 a zero byte. Internal newlines are preserved.
30254 .section "Structure of recipient items" "SECID210"
30255 The &%recipient_item%& structure contains these members:
30258 .vitem &*uschar&~*address*&
30259 This is a pointer to the recipient address as it was received.
30261 .vitem &*int&~pno*&
30262 This is used in later Exim processing when top level addresses are created by
30263 the &%one_time%& option. It is not relevant at the time &[local_scan()]& is run
30264 and must always contain -1 at this stage.
30266 .vitem &*uschar&~*errors_to*&
30267 If this value is not NULL, bounce messages caused by failing to deliver to the
30268 recipient are sent to the address it contains. In other words, it overrides the
30269 envelope sender for this one recipient. (Compare the &%errors_to%& generic
30270 router option.) If a &[local_scan()]& function sets an &%errors_to%& field to
30271 an unqualified address, Exim qualifies it using the domain from
30272 &%qualify_recipient%&. When &[local_scan()]& is called, the &%errors_to%& field
30273 is NULL for all recipients.
30278 .section "Available Exim functions" "SECID211"
30279 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "available Exim functions"
30280 The header &_local_scan.h_& gives you access to a number of Exim functions.
30281 These are the only ones that are guaranteed to be maintained from release to
30285 .vitem "&*pid_t&~child_open(uschar&~**argv,&~uschar&~**envp,&~int&~newumask,&&&
30286 &~int&~*infdptr,&~int&~*outfdptr, &~&~BOOL&~make_leader)*&"
30288 This function creates a child process that runs the command specified by
30289 &%argv%&. The environment for the process is specified by &%envp%&, which can
30290 be NULL if no environment variables are to be passed. A new umask is supplied
30291 for the process in &%newumask%&.
30293 Pipes to the standard input and output of the new process are set up
30294 and returned to the caller via the &%infdptr%& and &%outfdptr%& arguments. The
30295 standard error is cloned to the standard output. If there are any file
30296 descriptors &"in the way"& in the new process, they are closed. If the final
30297 argument is TRUE, the new process is made into a process group leader.
30299 The function returns the pid of the new process, or -1 if things go wrong.
30301 .vitem &*int&~child_close(pid_t&~pid,&~int&~timeout)*&
30302 This function waits for a child process to terminate, or for a timeout (in
30303 seconds) to expire. A timeout value of zero means wait as long as it takes. The
30304 return value is as follows:
30309 The process terminated by a normal exit and the value is the process
30315 The process was terminated by a signal and the value is the negation of the
30321 The process timed out.
30325 The was some other error in wait(); &%errno%& is still set.
30328 .vitem &*pid_t&~child_open_exim(int&~*fd)*&
30329 This function provide you with a means of submitting a new message to
30330 Exim. (Of course, you can also call &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& yourself if you
30331 want, but this packages it all up for you.) The function creates a pipe,
30332 forks a subprocess that is running
30334 exim -t -oem -oi -f <>
30336 and returns to you (via the &`int *`& argument) a file descriptor for the pipe
30337 that is connected to the standard input. The yield of the function is the PID
30338 of the subprocess. You can then write a message to the file descriptor, with
30339 recipients in &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&, and/or &'Bcc:'& header lines.
30341 When you have finished, call &'child_close()'& to wait for the process to
30342 finish and to collect its ending status. A timeout value of zero is usually
30343 fine in this circumstance. Unless you have made a mistake with the recipient
30344 addresses, you should get a return code of zero.
30347 .vitem &*pid_t&~child_open_exim2(int&~*fd,&~uschar&~*sender,&~uschar&~&&&
30348 *sender_authentication)*&
30349 This function is a more sophisticated version of &'child_open()'&. The command
30352 &`exim -t -oem -oi -f `&&'sender'&&` -oMas `&&'sender_authentication'&
30354 The third argument may be NULL, in which case the &%-oMas%& option is omitted.
30357 .vitem &*void&~debug_printf(char&~*,&~...)*&
30358 This is Exim's debugging function, with arguments as for &'(printf()'&. The
30359 output is written to the standard error stream. If no debugging is selected,
30360 calls to &'debug_printf()'& have no effect. Normally, you should make calls
30361 conditional on the &`local_scan`& debug selector by coding like this:
30363 if ((debug_selector & D_local_scan) != 0)
30364 debug_printf("xxx", ...);
30367 .vitem &*uschar&~*expand_string(uschar&~*string)*&
30368 This is an interface to Exim's string expansion code. The return value is the
30369 expanded string, or NULL if there was an expansion failure.
30370 The C variable &%expand_string_message%& contains an error message after an
30371 expansion failure. If expansion does not change the string, the return value is
30372 the pointer to the input string. Otherwise, the return value points to a new
30373 block of memory that was obtained by a call to &'store_get()'&. See section
30374 &<<SECTmemhanloc>>& below for a discussion of memory handling.
30376 .vitem &*void&~header_add(int&~type,&~char&~*format,&~...)*&
30377 This function allows you to an add additional header line at the end of the
30378 existing ones. The first argument is the type, and should normally be a space
30379 character. The second argument is a format string and any number of
30380 substitution arguments as for &[sprintf()]&. You may include internal newlines
30381 if you want, and you must ensure that the string ends with a newline.
30383 .vitem "&*void&~header_add_at_position(BOOL&~after,&~uschar&~*name,&~&&&
30384 BOOL&~topnot,&~int&~type,&~char&~*format, &~&~...)*&"
30385 This function adds a new header line at a specified point in the header
30386 chain. The header itself is specified as for &'header_add()'&.
30388 If &%name%& is NULL, the new header is added at the end of the chain if
30389 &%after%& is true, or at the start if &%after%& is false. If &%name%& is not
30390 NULL, the header lines are searched for the first non-deleted header that
30391 matches the name. If one is found, the new header is added before it if
30392 &%after%& is false. If &%after%& is true, the new header is added after the
30393 found header and any adjacent subsequent ones with the same name (even if
30394 marked &"deleted"&). If no matching non-deleted header is found, the &%topnot%&
30395 option controls where the header is added. If it is true, addition is at the
30396 top; otherwise at the bottom. Thus, to add a header after all the &'Received:'&
30397 headers, or at the top if there are no &'Received:'& headers, you could use
30399 header_add_at_position(TRUE, US"Received", TRUE,
30400 ' ', "X-xxx: ...");
30402 Normally, there is always at least one non-deleted &'Received:'& header, but
30403 there may not be if &%received_header_text%& expands to an empty string.
30406 .vitem &*void&~header_remove(int&~occurrence,&~uschar&~*name)*&
30407 This function removes header lines. If &%occurrence%& is zero or negative, all
30408 occurrences of the header are removed. If occurrence is greater than zero, that
30409 particular instance of the header is removed. If no header(s) can be found that
30410 match the specification, the function does nothing.
30413 .vitem "&*BOOL&~header_testname(header_line&~*hdr,&~uschar&~*name,&~&&&
30414 int&~length,&~BOOL&~notdel)*&"
30415 This function tests whether the given header has the given name. It is not just
30416 a string comparison, because white space is permitted between the name and the
30417 colon. If the &%notdel%& argument is true, a false return is forced for all
30418 &"deleted"& headers; otherwise they are not treated specially. For example:
30420 if (header_testname(h, US"X-Spam", 6, TRUE)) ...
30422 .vitem &*uschar&~*lss_b64encode(uschar&~*cleartext,&~int&~length)*&
30423 .cindex "base64 encoding" "functions for &[local_scan()]& use"
30424 This function base64-encodes a string, which is passed by address and length.
30425 The text may contain bytes of any value, including zero. The result is passed
30426 back in dynamic memory that is obtained by calling &'store_get()'&. It is
30429 .vitem &*int&~lss_b64decode(uschar&~*codetext,&~uschar&~**cleartext)*&
30430 This function decodes a base64-encoded string. Its arguments are a
30431 zero-terminated base64-encoded string and the address of a variable that is set
30432 to point to the result, which is in dynamic memory. The length of the decoded
30433 string is the yield of the function. If the input is invalid base64 data, the
30434 yield is -1. A zero byte is added to the end of the output string to make it
30435 easy to interpret as a C string (assuming it contains no zeros of its own). The
30436 added zero byte is not included in the returned count.
30438 .vitem &*int&~lss_match_domain(uschar&~*domain,&~uschar&~*list)*&
30439 This function checks for a match in a domain list. Domains are always
30440 matched caselessly. The return value is one of the following:
30442 &`OK `& match succeeded
30443 &`FAIL `& match failed
30444 &`DEFER `& match deferred
30446 DEFER is usually caused by some kind of lookup defer, such as the
30447 inability to contact a database.
30449 .vitem "&*int&~lss_match_local_part(uschar&~*localpart,&~uschar&~*list,&~&&&
30451 This function checks for a match in a local part list. The third argument
30452 controls case-sensitivity. The return values are as for
30453 &'lss_match_domain()'&.
30455 .vitem "&*int&~lss_match_address(uschar&~*address,&~uschar&~*list,&~&&&
30457 This function checks for a match in an address list. The third argument
30458 controls the case-sensitivity of the local part match. The domain is always
30459 matched caselessly. The return values are as for &'lss_match_domain()'&.
30461 .vitem "&*int&~lss_match_host(uschar&~*host_name,&~uschar&~*host_address,&~&&&
30463 This function checks for a match in a host list. The most common usage is
30466 lss_match_host(sender_host_name, sender_host_address, ...)
30468 .vindex "&$sender_host_address$&"
30469 An empty address field matches an empty item in the host list. If the host name
30470 is NULL, the name corresponding to &$sender_host_address$& is automatically
30471 looked up if a host name is required to match an item in the list. The return
30472 values are as for &'lss_match_domain()'&, but in addition, &'lss_match_host()'&
30473 returns ERROR in the case when it had to look up a host name, but the lookup
30476 .vitem "&*void&~log_write(unsigned&~int&~selector,&~int&~which,&~char&~&&&
30478 This function writes to Exim's log files. The first argument should be zero (it
30479 is concerned with &%log_selector%&). The second argument can be &`LOG_MAIN`& or
30480 &`LOG_REJECT`& or &`LOG_PANIC`& or the inclusive &"or"& of any combination of
30481 them. It specifies to which log or logs the message is written. The remaining
30482 arguments are a format and relevant insertion arguments. The string should not
30483 contain any newlines, not even at the end.
30486 .vitem &*void&~receive_add_recipient(uschar&~*address,&~int&~pno)*&
30487 This function adds an additional recipient to the message. The first argument
30488 is the recipient address. If it is unqualified (has no domain), it is qualified
30489 with the &%qualify_recipient%& domain. The second argument must always be -1.
30491 This function does not allow you to specify a private &%errors_to%& address (as
30492 described with the structure of &%recipient_item%& above), because it pre-dates
30493 the addition of that field to the structure. However, it is easy to add such a
30494 value afterwards. For example:
30496 receive_add_recipient(US"monitor@mydom.example", -1);
30497 recipients_list[recipients_count-1].errors_to =
30498 US"postmaster@mydom.example";
30501 .vitem &*BOOL&~receive_remove_recipient(uschar&~*recipient)*&
30502 This is a convenience function to remove a named recipient from the list of
30503 recipients. It returns true if a recipient was removed, and false if no
30504 matching recipient could be found. The argument must be a complete email
30511 .vitem "&*uschar&~rfc2047_decode(uschar&~*string,&~BOOL&~lencheck,&&&
30512 &~uschar&~*target,&~int&~zeroval,&~int&~*lenptr, &~&~uschar&~**error)*&"
30513 This function decodes strings that are encoded according to RFC 2047. Typically
30514 these are the contents of header lines. First, each &"encoded word"& is decoded
30515 from the Q or B encoding into a byte-string. Then, if provided with the name of
30516 a charset encoding, and if the &[iconv()]& function is available, an attempt is
30517 made to translate the result to the named character set. If this fails, the
30518 binary string is returned with an error message.
30520 The first argument is the string to be decoded. If &%lencheck%& is TRUE, the
30521 maximum MIME word length is enforced. The third argument is the target
30522 encoding, or NULL if no translation is wanted.
30524 .cindex "binary zero" "in RFC 2047 decoding"
30525 .cindex "RFC 2047" "binary zero in"
30526 If a binary zero is encountered in the decoded string, it is replaced by the
30527 contents of the &%zeroval%& argument. For use with Exim headers, the value must
30528 not be 0 because header lines are handled as zero-terminated strings.
30530 The function returns the result of processing the string, zero-terminated; if
30531 &%lenptr%& is not NULL, the length of the result is set in the variable to
30532 which it points. When &%zeroval%& is 0, &%lenptr%& should not be NULL.
30534 If an error is encountered, the function returns NULL and uses the &%error%&
30535 argument to return an error message. The variable pointed to by &%error%& is
30536 set to NULL if there is no error; it may be set non-NULL even when the function
30537 returns a non-NULL value if decoding was successful, but there was a problem
30541 .vitem &*int&~smtp_fflush(void)*&
30542 This function is used in conjunction with &'smtp_printf()'&, as described
30545 .vitem &*void&~smtp_printf(char&~*,&~...)*&
30546 The arguments of this function are like &[printf()]&; it writes to the SMTP
30547 output stream. You should use this function only when there is an SMTP output
30548 stream, that is, when the incoming message is being received via interactive
30549 SMTP. This is the case when &%smtp_input%& is TRUE and &%smtp_batched_input%&
30550 is FALSE. If you want to test for an incoming message from another host (as
30551 opposed to a local process that used the &%-bs%& command line option), you can
30552 test the value of &%sender_host_address%&, which is non-NULL when a remote host
30555 If an SMTP TLS connection is established, &'smtp_printf()'& uses the TLS
30556 output function, so it can be used for all forms of SMTP connection.
30558 Strings that are written by &'smtp_printf()'& from within &[local_scan()]&
30559 must start with an appropriate response code: 550 if you are going to return
30560 LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT, 451 if you are going to return
30561 LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT, and 250 otherwise. Because you are writing the
30562 initial lines of a multi-line response, the code must be followed by a hyphen
30563 to indicate that the line is not the final response line. You must also ensure
30564 that the lines you write terminate with CRLF. For example:
30566 smtp_printf("550-this is some extra info\r\n");
30567 return LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT;
30569 Note that you can also create multi-line responses by including newlines in
30570 the data returned via the &%return_text%& argument. The added value of using
30571 &'smtp_printf()'& is that, for instance, you could introduce delays between
30572 multiple output lines.
30574 The &'smtp_printf()'& function does not return any error indication, because it
30575 does not automatically flush pending output, and therefore does not test
30576 the state of the stream. (In the main code of Exim, flushing and error
30577 detection is done when Exim is ready for the next SMTP input command.) If
30578 you want to flush the output and check for an error (for example, the
30579 dropping of a TCP/IP connection), you can call &'smtp_fflush()'&, which has no
30580 arguments. It flushes the output stream, and returns a non-zero value if there
30583 .vitem &*void&~*store_get(int)*&
30584 This function accesses Exim's internal store (memory) manager. It gets a new
30585 chunk of memory whose size is given by the argument. Exim bombs out if it ever
30586 runs out of memory. See the next section for a discussion of memory handling.
30588 .vitem &*void&~*store_get_perm(int)*&
30589 This function is like &'store_get()'&, but it always gets memory from the
30590 permanent pool. See the next section for a discussion of memory handling.
30592 .vitem &*uschar&~*string_copy(uschar&~*string)*&
30595 .vitem &*uschar&~*string_copyn(uschar&~*string,&~int&~length)*&
30598 .vitem &*uschar&~*string_sprintf(char&~*format,&~...)*&
30599 These three functions create strings using Exim's dynamic memory facilities.
30600 The first makes a copy of an entire string. The second copies up to a maximum
30601 number of characters, indicated by the second argument. The third uses a format
30602 and insertion arguments to create a new string. In each case, the result is a
30603 pointer to a new string in the current memory pool. See the next section for
30609 .section "More about Exim's memory handling" "SECTmemhanloc"
30610 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "memory handling"
30611 No function is provided for freeing memory, because that is never needed.
30612 The dynamic memory that Exim uses when receiving a message is automatically
30613 recycled if another message is received by the same process (this applies only
30614 to incoming SMTP connections &-- other input methods can supply only one
30615 message at a time). After receiving the last message, a reception process
30618 Because it is recycled, the normal dynamic memory cannot be used for holding
30619 data that must be preserved over a number of incoming messages on the same SMTP
30620 connection. However, Exim in fact uses two pools of dynamic memory; the second
30621 one is not recycled, and can be used for this purpose.
30623 If you want to allocate memory that remains available for subsequent messages
30624 in the same SMTP connection, you should set
30626 store_pool = POOL_PERM
30628 before calling the function that does the allocation. There is no need to
30629 restore the value if you do not need to; however, if you do want to revert to
30630 the normal pool, you can either restore the previous value of &%store_pool%& or
30631 set it explicitly to POOL_MAIN.
30633 The pool setting applies to all functions that get dynamic memory, including
30634 &'expand_string()'&, &'store_get()'&, and the &'string_xxx()'& functions.
30635 There is also a convenience function called &'store_get_perm()'& that gets a
30636 block of memory from the permanent pool while preserving the value of
30643 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
30644 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
30646 .chapter "System-wide message filtering" "CHAPsystemfilter"
30647 .scindex IIDsysfil1 "filter" "system filter"
30648 .scindex IIDsysfil2 "filtering all mail"
30649 .scindex IIDsysfil3 "system filter"
30650 The previous chapters (on ACLs and the local scan function) describe checks
30651 that can be applied to messages before they are accepted by a host. There is
30652 also a mechanism for checking messages once they have been received, but before
30653 they are delivered. This is called the &'system filter'&.
30655 The system filter operates in a similar manner to users' filter files, but it
30656 is run just once per message (however many recipients the message has).
30657 It should not normally be used as a substitute for routing, because &%deliver%&
30658 commands in a system router provide new envelope recipient addresses.
30659 The system filter must be an Exim filter. It cannot be a Sieve filter.
30661 The system filter is run at the start of a delivery attempt, before any routing
30662 is done. If a message fails to be completely delivered at the first attempt,
30663 the system filter is run again at the start of every retry.
30664 If you want your filter to do something only once per message, you can make use
30665 of the &%first_delivery%& condition in an &%if%& command in the filter to
30666 prevent it happening on retries.
30668 .vindex "&$domain$&"
30669 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
30670 &*Warning*&: Because the system filter runs just once, variables that are
30671 specific to individual recipient addresses, such as &$local_part$& and
30672 &$domain$&, are not set, and the &"personal"& condition is not meaningful. If
30673 you want to run a centrally-specified filter for each recipient address
30674 independently, you can do so by setting up a suitable &(redirect)& router, as
30675 described in section &<<SECTperaddfil>>& below.
30678 .section "Specifying a system filter" "SECID212"
30679 .cindex "uid (user id)" "system filter"
30680 .cindex "gid (group id)" "system filter"
30681 The name of the file that contains the system filter must be specified by
30682 setting &%system_filter%&. If you want the filter to run under a uid and gid
30683 other than root, you must also set &%system_filter_user%& and
30684 &%system_filter_group%& as appropriate. For example:
30686 system_filter = /etc/mail/exim.filter
30687 system_filter_user = exim
30689 If a system filter generates any deliveries directly to files or pipes (via the
30690 &%save%& or &%pipe%& commands), transports to handle these deliveries must be
30691 specified by setting &%system_filter_file_transport%& and
30692 &%system_filter_pipe_transport%&, respectively. Similarly,
30693 &%system_filter_reply_transport%& must be set to handle any messages generated
30694 by the &%reply%& command.
30697 .section "Testing a system filter" "SECID213"
30698 You can run simple tests of a system filter in the same way as for a user
30699 filter, but you should use &%-bF%& rather than &%-bf%&, so that features that
30700 are permitted only in system filters are recognized.
30702 If you want to test the combined effect of a system filter and a user filter,
30703 you can use both &%-bF%& and &%-bf%& on the same command line.
30707 .section "Contents of a system filter" "SECID214"
30708 The language used to specify system filters is the same as for users' filter
30709 files. It is described in the separate end-user document &'Exim's interface to
30710 mail filtering'&. However, there are some additional features that are
30711 available only in system filters; these are described in subsequent sections.
30712 If they are encountered in a user's filter file or when testing with &%-bf%&,
30715 .cindex "frozen messages" "manual thaw; testing in filter"
30716 There are two special conditions which, though available in users' filter
30717 files, are designed for use in system filters. The condition &%first_delivery%&
30718 is true only for the first attempt at delivering a message, and
30719 &%manually_thawed%& is true only if the message has been frozen, and
30720 subsequently thawed by an admin user. An explicit forced delivery counts as a
30721 manual thaw, but thawing as a result of the &%auto_thaw%& setting does not.
30723 &*Warning*&: If a system filter uses the &%first_delivery%& condition to
30724 specify an &"unseen"& (non-significant) delivery, and that delivery does not
30725 succeed, it will not be tried again.
30726 If you want Exim to retry an unseen delivery until it succeeds, you should
30727 arrange to set it up every time the filter runs.
30729 When a system filter finishes running, the values of the variables &$n0$& &--
30730 &$n9$& are copied into &$sn0$& &-- &$sn9$& and are thereby made available to
30731 users' filter files. Thus a system filter can, for example, set up &"scores"&
30732 to which users' filter files can refer.
30736 .section "Additional variable for system filters" "SECID215"
30737 .vindex "&$recipients$&"
30738 The expansion variable &$recipients$&, containing a list of all the recipients
30739 of the message (separated by commas and white space), is available in system
30740 filters. It is not available in users' filters for privacy reasons.
30744 .section "Defer, freeze, and fail commands for system filters" "SECID216"
30745 .cindex "freezing messages"
30746 .cindex "message" "freezing"
30747 .cindex "message" "forced failure"
30748 .cindex "&%fail%&" "in system filter"
30749 .cindex "&%freeze%& in system filter"
30750 .cindex "&%defer%& in system filter"
30751 There are three extra commands (&%defer%&, &%freeze%& and &%fail%&) which are
30752 always available in system filters, but are not normally enabled in users'
30753 filters. (See the &%allow_defer%&, &%allow_freeze%& and &%allow_fail%& options
30754 for the &(redirect)& router.) These commands can optionally be followed by the
30755 word &%text%& and a string containing an error message, for example:
30757 fail text "this message looks like spam to me"
30759 The keyword &%text%& is optional if the next character is a double quote.
30761 The &%defer%& command defers delivery of the original recipients of the
30762 message. The &%fail%& command causes all the original recipients to be failed,
30763 and a bounce message to be created. The &%freeze%& command suspends all
30764 delivery attempts for the original recipients. In all cases, any new deliveries
30765 that are specified by the filter are attempted as normal after the filter has
30768 The &%freeze%& command is ignored if the message has been manually unfrozen and
30769 not manually frozen since. This means that automatic freezing by a system
30770 filter can be used as a way of checking out suspicious messages. If a message
30771 is found to be all right, manually unfreezing it allows it to be delivered.
30773 .cindex "log" "&%fail%& command log line"
30774 .cindex "&%fail%&" "log line; reducing"
30775 The text given with a fail command is used as part of the bounce message as
30776 well as being written to the log. If the message is quite long, this can fill
30777 up a lot of log space when such failures are common. To reduce the size of the
30778 log message, Exim interprets the text in a special way if it starts with the
30779 two characters &`<<`& and contains &`>>`& later. The text between these two
30780 strings is written to the log, and the rest of the text is used in the bounce
30781 message. For example:
30783 fail "<<filter test 1>>Your message is rejected \
30784 because it contains attachments that we are \
30785 not prepared to receive."
30788 .cindex "loop" "caused by &%fail%&"
30789 Take great care with the &%fail%& command when basing the decision to fail on
30790 the contents of the message, because the bounce message will of course include
30791 the contents of the original message and will therefore trigger the &%fail%&
30792 command again (causing a mail loop) unless steps are taken to prevent this.
30793 Testing the &%error_message%& condition is one way to prevent this. You could
30796 if $message_body contains "this is spam" and not error_message
30797 then fail text "spam is not wanted here" endif
30799 though of course that might let through unwanted bounce messages. The
30800 alternative is clever checking of the body and/or headers to detect bounces
30801 generated by the filter.
30803 The interpretation of a system filter file ceases after a
30805 &%freeze%&, or &%fail%& command is obeyed. However, any deliveries that were
30806 set up earlier in the filter file are honoured, so you can use a sequence such
30812 to send a specified message when the system filter is freezing (or deferring or
30813 failing) a message. The normal deliveries for the message do not, of course,
30818 .section "Adding and removing headers in a system filter" "SECTaddremheasys"
30819 .cindex "header lines" "adding; in system filter"
30820 .cindex "header lines" "removing; in system filter"
30821 .cindex "filter" "header lines; adding/removing"
30822 Two filter commands that are available only in system filters are:
30824 headers add <string>
30825 headers remove <string>
30827 The argument for the &%headers add%& is a string that is expanded and then
30828 added to the end of the message's headers. It is the responsibility of the
30829 filter maintainer to make sure it conforms to RFC 2822 syntax. Leading white
30830 space is ignored, and if the string is otherwise empty, or if the expansion is
30831 forced to fail, the command has no effect.
30833 You can use &"\n"& within the string, followed by white space, to specify
30834 continued header lines. More than one header may be added in one command by
30835 including &"\n"& within the string without any following white space. For
30838 headers add "X-header-1: ....\n \
30839 continuation of X-header-1 ...\n\
30842 Note that the header line continuation white space after the first newline must
30843 be placed before the backslash that continues the input string, because white
30844 space after input continuations is ignored.
30846 The argument for &%headers remove%& is a colon-separated list of header names.
30847 This command applies only to those headers that are stored with the message;
30848 those that are added at delivery time (such as &'Envelope-To:'& and
30849 &'Return-Path:'&) cannot be removed by this means. If there is more than one
30850 header with the same name, they are all removed.
30852 The &%headers%& command in a system filter makes an immediate change to the set
30853 of header lines that was received with the message (with possible additions
30854 from ACL processing). Subsequent commands in the system filter operate on the
30855 modified set, which also forms the basis for subsequent message delivery.
30856 Unless further modified during routing or transporting, this set of headers is
30857 used for all recipients of the message.
30859 During routing and transporting, the variables that refer to the contents of
30860 header lines refer only to those lines that are in this set. Thus, header lines
30861 that are added by a system filter are visible to users' filter files and to all
30862 routers and transports. This contrasts with the manipulation of header lines by
30863 routers and transports, which is not immediate, but which instead is saved up
30864 until the message is actually being written (see section
30865 &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&).
30867 If the message is not delivered at the first attempt, header lines that were
30868 added by the system filter are stored with the message, and so are still
30869 present at the next delivery attempt. Header lines that were removed are still
30870 present, but marked &"deleted"& so that they are not transported with the
30871 message. For this reason, it is usual to make the &%headers%& command
30872 conditional on &%first_delivery%& so that the set of header lines is not
30873 modified more than once.
30875 Because header modification in a system filter acts immediately, you have to
30876 use an indirect approach if you want to modify the contents of a header line.
30879 headers add "Old-Subject: $h_subject:"
30880 headers remove "Subject"
30881 headers add "Subject: new subject (was: $h_old-subject:)"
30882 headers remove "Old-Subject"
30887 .section "Setting an errors address in a system filter" "SECID217"
30888 .cindex "envelope sender"
30889 In a system filter, if a &%deliver%& command is followed by
30891 errors_to <some address>
30893 in order to change the envelope sender (and hence the error reporting) for that
30894 delivery, any address may be specified. (In a user filter, only the current
30895 user's address can be set.) For example, if some mail is being monitored, you
30898 unseen deliver monitor@spying.example errors_to root@local.example
30900 to take a copy which would not be sent back to the normal error reporting
30901 address if its delivery failed.
30905 .section "Per-address filtering" "SECTperaddfil"
30906 .vindex "&$domain$&"
30907 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
30908 In contrast to the system filter, which is run just once per message for each
30909 delivery attempt, it is also possible to set up a system-wide filtering
30910 operation that runs once for each recipient address. In this case, variables
30911 such as &$local_part$& and &$domain$& can be used, and indeed, the choice of
30912 filter file could be made dependent on them. This is an example of a router
30913 which implements such a filter:
30918 domains = +local_domains
30919 file = /central/filters/$local_part
30924 The filter is run in a separate process under its own uid. Therefore, either
30925 &%check_local_user%& must be set (as above), in which case the filter is run as
30926 the local user, or the &%user%& option must be used to specify which user to
30927 use. If both are set, &%user%& overrides.
30929 Care should be taken to ensure that none of the commands in the filter file
30930 specify a significant delivery if the message is to go on to be delivered to
30931 its intended recipient. The router will not then claim to have dealt with the
30932 address, so it will be passed on to subsequent routers to be delivered in the
30934 .ecindex IIDsysfil1
30935 .ecindex IIDsysfil2
30936 .ecindex IIDsysfil3
30943 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
30944 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
30946 .chapter "Message processing" "CHAPmsgproc"
30947 .scindex IIDmesproc "message" "general processing"
30948 Exim performs various transformations on the sender and recipient addresses of
30949 all messages that it handles, and also on the messages' header lines. Some of
30950 these are optional and configurable, while others always take place. All of
30951 this processing, except rewriting as a result of routing, and the addition or
30952 removal of header lines while delivering, happens when a message is received,
30953 before it is placed on Exim's queue.
30955 Some of the automatic processing takes place by default only for
30956 &"locally-originated"& messages. This adjective is used to describe messages
30957 that are not received over TCP/IP, but instead are passed to an Exim process on
30958 its standard input. This includes the interactive &"local SMTP"& case that is
30959 set up by the &%-bs%& command line option.
30961 &*Note*&: Messages received over TCP/IP on the loopback interface (127.0.0.1
30962 or ::1) are not considered to be locally-originated. Exim does not treat the
30963 loopback interface specially in any way.
30965 If you want the loopback interface to be treated specially, you must ensure
30966 that there are appropriate entries in your ACLs.
30971 .section "Submission mode for non-local messages" "SECTsubmodnon"
30972 .cindex "message" "submission"
30973 .cindex "submission mode"
30974 Processing that happens automatically for locally-originated messages (unless
30975 &%suppress_local_fixups%& is set) can also be requested for messages that are
30976 received over TCP/IP. The term &"submission mode"& is used to describe this
30977 state. Submission mode is set by the modifier
30979 control = submission
30981 in a MAIL, RCPT, or pre-data ACL for an incoming message (see sections
30982 &<<SECTACLmodi>>& and &<<SECTcontrols>>&). This makes Exim treat the message as
30983 a local submission, and is normally used when the source of the message is
30984 known to be an MUA running on a client host (as opposed to an MTA). For
30985 example, to set submission mode for messages originating on the IPv4 loopback
30986 interface, you could include the following in the MAIL ACL:
30988 warn hosts = 127.0.0.1
30989 control = submission
30991 .cindex "&%sender_retain%& submission option"
30992 There are some options that can be used when setting submission mode. A slash
30993 is used to separate options. For example:
30995 control = submission/sender_retain
30997 Specifying &%sender_retain%& has the effect of setting &%local_sender_retain%&
30998 true and &%local_from_check%& false for the current incoming message. The first
30999 of these allows an existing &'Sender:'& header in the message to remain, and
31000 the second suppresses the check to ensure that &'From:'& matches the
31001 authenticated sender. With this setting, Exim still fixes up messages by adding
31002 &'Date:'& and &'Message-ID:'& header lines if they are missing, but makes no
31003 attempt to check sender authenticity in header lines.
31005 When &%sender_retain%& is not set, a submission mode setting may specify a
31006 domain to be used when generating a &'From:'& or &'Sender:'& header line. For
31009 control = submission/domain=some.domain
31011 The domain may be empty. How this value is used is described in sections
31012 &<<SECTthefrohea>>& and &<<SECTthesenhea>>&. There is also a &%name%& option
31013 that allows you to specify the user's full name for inclusion in a created
31014 &'Sender:'& or &'From:'& header line. For example:
31016 accept authenticated = *
31017 control = submission/domain=wonderland.example/\
31018 name=${lookup {$authenticated_id} \
31019 lsearch {/etc/exim/namelist}}
31021 Because the name may contain any characters, including slashes, the &%name%&
31022 option must be given last. The remainder of the string is used as the name. For
31023 the example above, if &_/etc/exim/namelist_& contains:
31025 bigegg: Humpty Dumpty
31027 then when the sender has authenticated as &'bigegg'&, the generated &'Sender:'&
31030 Sender: Humpty Dumpty <bigegg@wonderland.example>
31032 .cindex "return path" "in submission mode"
31033 By default, submission mode forces the return path to the same address as is
31034 used to create the &'Sender:'& header. However, if &%sender_retain%& is
31035 specified, the return path is also left unchanged.
31037 &*Note*&: The changes caused by submission mode take effect after the predata
31038 ACL. This means that any sender checks performed before the fix-ups use the
31039 untrusted sender address specified by the user, not the trusted sender address
31040 specified by submission mode. Although this might be slightly unexpected, it
31041 does mean that you can configure ACL checks to spot that a user is trying to
31042 spoof another's address.
31044 .section "Line endings" "SECTlineendings"
31045 .cindex "line endings"
31046 .cindex "carriage return"
31048 RFC 2821 specifies that CRLF (two characters: carriage-return, followed by
31049 linefeed) is the line ending for messages transmitted over the Internet using
31050 SMTP over TCP/IP. However, within individual operating systems, different
31051 conventions are used. For example, Unix-like systems use just LF, but others
31052 use CRLF or just CR.
31054 Exim was designed for Unix-like systems, and internally, it stores messages
31055 using the system's convention of a single LF as a line terminator. When
31056 receiving a message, all line endings are translated to this standard format.
31057 Originally, it was thought that programs that passed messages directly to an
31058 MTA within an operating system would use that system's convention. Experience
31059 has shown that this is not the case; for example, there are Unix applications
31060 that use CRLF in this circumstance. For this reason, and for compatibility with
31061 other MTAs, the way Exim handles line endings for all messages is now as
31065 LF not preceded by CR is treated as a line ending.
31067 CR is treated as a line ending; if it is immediately followed by LF, the LF
31070 The sequence &"CR, dot, CR"& does not terminate an incoming SMTP message,
31071 nor a local message in the state where a line containing only a dot is a
31074 If a bare CR is encountered within a header line, an extra space is added after
31075 the line terminator so as not to end the header line. The reasoning behind this
31076 is that bare CRs in header lines are most likely either to be mistakes, or
31077 people trying to play silly games.
31079 If the first header line received in a message ends with CRLF, a subsequent
31080 bare LF in a header line is treated in the same way as a bare CR in a header
31088 .section "Unqualified addresses" "SECID218"
31089 .cindex "unqualified addresses"
31090 .cindex "address" "qualification"
31091 By default, Exim expects every envelope address it receives from an external
31092 host to be fully qualified. Unqualified addresses cause negative responses to
31093 SMTP commands. However, because SMTP is used as a means of transporting
31094 messages from MUAs running on personal workstations, there is sometimes a
31095 requirement to accept unqualified addresses from specific hosts or IP networks.
31097 Exim has two options that separately control which hosts may send unqualified
31098 sender or recipient addresses in SMTP commands, namely
31099 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& and &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&. In both
31100 cases, if an unqualified address is accepted, it is qualified by adding the
31101 value of &%qualify_domain%& or &%qualify_recipient%&, as appropriate.
31103 .oindex "&%qualify_domain%&"
31104 .oindex "&%qualify_recipient%&"
31105 Unqualified addresses in header lines are automatically qualified for messages
31106 that are locally originated, unless the &%-bnq%& option is given on the command
31107 line. For messages received over SMTP, unqualified addresses in header lines
31108 are qualified only if unqualified addresses are permitted in SMTP commands. In
31109 other words, such qualification is also controlled by
31110 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& and &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&,
31115 .section "The UUCP From line" "SECID219"
31116 .cindex "&""From""& line"
31117 .cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
31118 .cindex "sender" "address"
31119 .oindex "&%uucp_from_pattern%&"
31120 .oindex "&%uucp_from_sender%&"
31121 .cindex "envelope sender"
31122 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&""From""& line"
31123 Messages that have come from UUCP (and some other applications) often begin
31124 with a line containing the envelope sender and a timestamp, following the word
31125 &"From"&. Examples of two common formats are:
31127 From a.oakley@berlin.mus Fri Jan 5 12:35 GMT 1996
31128 From f.butler@berlin.mus Fri, 7 Jan 97 14:00:00 GMT
31130 This line precedes the RFC 2822 header lines. For compatibility with Sendmail,
31131 Exim recognizes such lines at the start of messages that are submitted to it
31132 via the command line (that is, on the standard input). It does not recognize
31133 such lines in incoming SMTP messages, unless the sending host matches
31134 &%ignore_fromline_hosts%& or the &%-bs%& option was used for a local message
31135 and &%ignore_fromline_local%& is set. The recognition is controlled by a
31136 regular expression that is defined by the &%uucp_from_pattern%& option, whose
31137 default value matches the two common cases shown above and puts the address
31138 that follows &"From"& into &$1$&.
31140 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &""From ""& line handling"
31141 When the caller of Exim for a non-SMTP message that contains a &"From"& line is
31142 a trusted user, the message's sender address is constructed by expanding the
31143 contents of &%uucp_sender_address%&, whose default value is &"$1"&. This is
31144 then parsed as an RFC 2822 address. If there is no domain, the local part is
31145 qualified with &%qualify_domain%& unless it is the empty string. However, if
31146 the command line &%-f%& option is used, it overrides the &"From"& line.
31148 If the caller of Exim is not trusted, the &"From"& line is recognized, but the
31149 sender address is not changed. This is also the case for incoming SMTP messages
31150 that are permitted to contain &"From"& lines.
31152 Only one &"From"& line is recognized. If there is more than one, the second is
31153 treated as a data line that starts the body of the message, as it is not valid
31154 as a header line. This also happens if a &"From"& line is present in an
31155 incoming SMTP message from a source that is not permitted to send them.
31159 .section "Resent- header lines" "SECID220"
31160 .cindex "&%Resent-%& header lines"
31161 RFC 2822 makes provision for sets of header lines starting with the string
31162 &`Resent-`& to be added to a message when it is resent by the original
31163 recipient to somebody else. These headers are &'Resent-Date:'&,
31164 &'Resent-From:'&, &'Resent-Sender:'&, &'Resent-To:'&, &'Resent-Cc:'&,
31165 &'Resent-Bcc:'& and &'Resent-Message-ID:'&. The RFC says:
31168 &'Resent fields are strictly informational. They MUST NOT be used in the normal
31169 processing of replies or other such automatic actions on messages.'&
31172 This leaves things a bit vague as far as other processing actions such as
31173 address rewriting are concerned. Exim treats &%Resent-%& header lines as
31177 A &'Resent-From:'& line that just contains the login id of the submitting user
31178 is automatically rewritten in the same way as &'From:'& (see below).
31180 If there's a rewriting rule for a particular header line, it is also applied to
31181 &%Resent-%& header lines of the same type. For example, a rule that rewrites
31182 &'From:'& also rewrites &'Resent-From:'&.
31184 For local messages, if &'Sender:'& is removed on input, &'Resent-Sender:'& is
31187 For a locally-submitted message,
31188 if there are any &%Resent-%& header lines but no &'Resent-Date:'&,
31189 &'Resent-From:'&, or &'Resent-Message-Id:'&, they are added as necessary. It is
31190 the contents of &'Resent-Message-Id:'& (rather than &'Message-Id:'&) which are
31191 included in log lines in this case.
31193 The logic for adding &'Sender:'& is duplicated for &'Resent-Sender:'& when any
31194 &%Resent-%& header lines are present.
31200 .section "The Auto-Submitted: header line" "SECID221"
31201 Whenever Exim generates an autoreply, a bounce, or a delay warning message, it
31202 includes the header line:
31204 Auto-Submitted: auto-replied
31207 .section "The Bcc: header line" "SECID222"
31208 .cindex "&'Bcc:'& header line"
31209 If Exim is called with the &%-t%& option, to take recipient addresses from a
31210 message's header, it removes any &'Bcc:'& header line that may exist (after
31211 extracting its addresses). If &%-t%& is not present on the command line, any
31212 existing &'Bcc:'& is not removed.
31215 .section "The Date: header line" "SECID223"
31216 .cindex "&'Date:'& header line"
31217 If a locally-generated or submission-mode message has no &'Date:'& header line,
31218 Exim adds one, using the current date and time, unless the
31219 &%suppress_local_fixups%& control has been specified.
31221 .section "The Delivery-date: header line" "SECID224"
31222 .cindex "&'Delivery-date:'& header line"
31223 .oindex "&%delivery_date_remove%&"
31224 &'Delivery-date:'& header lines are not part of the standard RFC 2822 header
31225 set. Exim can be configured to add them to the final delivery of messages. (See
31226 the generic &%delivery_date_add%& transport option.) They should not be present
31227 in messages in transit. If the &%delivery_date_remove%& configuration option is
31228 set (the default), Exim removes &'Delivery-date:'& header lines from incoming
31232 .section "The Envelope-to: header line" "SECID225"
31233 .cindex "&'Envelope-to:'& header line"
31234 .oindex "&%envelope_to_remove%&"
31235 &'Envelope-to:'& header lines are not part of the standard RFC 2822 header set.
31236 Exim can be configured to add them to the final delivery of messages. (See the
31237 generic &%envelope_to_add%& transport option.) They should not be present in
31238 messages in transit. If the &%envelope_to_remove%& configuration option is set
31239 (the default), Exim removes &'Envelope-to:'& header lines from incoming
31243 .section "The From: header line" "SECTthefrohea"
31244 .cindex "&'From:'& header line"
31245 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&""From""& line"
31246 .cindex "message" "submission"
31247 .cindex "submission mode"
31248 If a submission-mode message does not contain a &'From:'& header line, Exim
31249 adds one if either of the following conditions is true:
31252 The envelope sender address is not empty (that is, this is not a bounce
31253 message). The added header line copies the envelope sender address.
31255 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
31256 The SMTP session is authenticated and &$authenticated_id$& is not empty.
31258 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
31259 If no domain is specified by the submission control, the local part is
31260 &$authenticated_id$& and the domain is &$qualify_domain$&.
31262 If a non-empty domain is specified by the submission control, the local
31263 part is &$authenticated_id$&, and the domain is the specified domain.
31265 If an empty domain is specified by the submission control,
31266 &$authenticated_id$& is assumed to be the complete address.
31270 A non-empty envelope sender takes precedence.
31272 If a locally-generated incoming message does not contain a &'From:'& header
31273 line, and the &%suppress_local_fixups%& control is not set, Exim adds one
31274 containing the sender's address. The calling user's login name and full name
31275 are used to construct the address, as described in section &<<SECTconstr>>&.
31276 They are obtained from the password data by calling &[getpwuid()]& (but see the
31277 &%unknown_login%& configuration option). The address is qualified with
31278 &%qualify_domain%&.
31280 For compatibility with Sendmail, if an incoming, non-SMTP message has a
31281 &'From:'& header line containing just the unqualified login name of the calling
31282 user, this is replaced by an address containing the user's login name and full
31283 name as described in section &<<SECTconstr>>&.
31286 .section "The Message-ID: header line" "SECID226"
31287 .cindex "&'Message-ID:'& header line"
31288 .cindex "message" "submission"
31289 .oindex "&%message_id_header_text%&"
31290 If a locally-generated or submission-mode incoming message does not contain a
31291 &'Message-ID:'& or &'Resent-Message-ID:'& header line, and the
31292 &%suppress_local_fixups%& control is not set, Exim adds a suitable header line
31293 to the message. If there are any &'Resent-:'& headers in the message, it
31294 creates &'Resent-Message-ID:'&. The id is constructed from Exim's internal
31295 message id, preceded by the letter E to ensure it starts with a letter, and
31296 followed by @ and the primary host name. Additional information can be included
31297 in this header line by setting the &%message_id_header_text%& and/or
31298 &%message_id_header_domain%& options.
31301 .section "The Received: header line" "SECID227"
31302 .cindex "&'Received:'& header line"
31303 A &'Received:'& header line is added at the start of every message. The
31304 contents are defined by the &%received_header_text%& configuration option, and
31305 Exim automatically adds a semicolon and a timestamp to the configured string.
31307 The &'Received:'& header is generated as soon as the message's header lines
31308 have been received. At this stage, the timestamp in the &'Received:'& header
31309 line is the time that the message started to be received. This is the value
31310 that is seen by the DATA ACL and by the &[local_scan()]& function.
31312 Once a message is accepted, the timestamp in the &'Received:'& header line is
31313 changed to the time of acceptance, which is (apart from a small delay while the
31314 -H spool file is written) the earliest time at which delivery could start.
31317 .section "The References: header line" "SECID228"
31318 .cindex "&'References:'& header line"
31319 Messages created by the &(autoreply)& transport include a &'References:'&
31320 header line. This is constructed according to the rules that are described in
31321 section 3.64 of RFC 2822 (which states that replies should contain such a
31322 header line), and section 3.14 of RFC 3834 (which states that automatic
31323 responses are not different in this respect). However, because some mail
31324 processing software does not cope well with very long header lines, no more
31325 than 12 message IDs are copied from the &'References:'& header line in the
31326 incoming message. If there are more than 12, the first one and then the final
31327 11 are copied, before adding the message ID of the incoming message.
31331 .section "The Return-path: header line" "SECID229"
31332 .cindex "&'Return-path:'& header line"
31333 .oindex "&%return_path_remove%&"
31334 &'Return-path:'& header lines are defined as something an MTA may insert when
31335 it does the final delivery of messages. (See the generic &%return_path_add%&
31336 transport option.) Therefore, they should not be present in messages in
31337 transit. If the &%return_path_remove%& configuration option is set (the
31338 default), Exim removes &'Return-path:'& header lines from incoming messages.
31342 .section "The Sender: header line" "SECTthesenhea"
31343 .cindex "&'Sender:'& header line"
31344 .cindex "message" "submission"
31345 For a locally-originated message from an untrusted user, Exim may remove an
31346 existing &'Sender:'& header line, and it may add a new one. You can modify
31347 these actions by setting the &%local_sender_retain%& option true, the
31348 &%local_from_check%& option false, or by using the &%suppress_local_fixups%&
31351 When a local message is received from an untrusted user and
31352 &%local_from_check%& is true (the default), and the &%suppress_local_fixups%&
31353 control has not been set, a check is made to see if the address given in the
31354 &'From:'& header line is the correct (local) sender of the message. The address
31355 that is expected has the login name as the local part and the value of
31356 &%qualify_domain%& as the domain. Prefixes and suffixes for the local part can
31357 be permitted by setting &%local_from_prefix%& and &%local_from_suffix%&
31358 appropriately. If &'From:'& does not contain the correct sender, a &'Sender:'&
31359 line is added to the message.
31361 If you set &%local_from_check%& false, this checking does not occur. However,
31362 the removal of an existing &'Sender:'& line still happens, unless you also set
31363 &%local_sender_retain%& to be true. It is not possible to set both of these
31364 options true at the same time.
31366 .cindex "submission mode"
31367 By default, no processing of &'Sender:'& header lines is done for messages
31368 received over TCP/IP or for messages submitted by trusted users. However, when
31369 a message is received over TCP/IP in submission mode, and &%sender_retain%& is
31370 not specified on the submission control, the following processing takes place:
31372 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
31373 First, any existing &'Sender:'& lines are removed. Then, if the SMTP session is
31374 authenticated, and &$authenticated_id$& is not empty, a sender address is
31375 created as follows:
31378 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
31379 If no domain is specified by the submission control, the local part is
31380 &$authenticated_id$& and the domain is &$qualify_domain$&.
31382 If a non-empty domain is specified by the submission control, the local part
31383 is &$authenticated_id$&, and the domain is the specified domain.
31385 If an empty domain is specified by the submission control,
31386 &$authenticated_id$& is assumed to be the complete address.
31389 This address is compared with the address in the &'From:'& header line. If they
31390 are different, a &'Sender:'& header line containing the created address is
31391 added. Prefixes and suffixes for the local part in &'From:'& can be permitted
31392 by setting &%local_from_prefix%& and &%local_from_suffix%& appropriately.
31394 .cindex "return path" "created from &'Sender:'&"
31395 &*Note*&: Whenever a &'Sender:'& header line is created, the return path for
31396 the message (the envelope sender address) is changed to be the same address,
31397 except in the case of submission mode when &%sender_retain%& is specified.
31401 .section "Adding and removing header lines in routers and transports" &&&
31402 "SECTheadersaddrem"
31403 .cindex "header lines" "adding; in router or transport"
31404 .cindex "header lines" "removing; in router or transport"
31405 When a message is delivered, the addition and removal of header lines can be
31406 specified in a system filter, or on any of the routers and transports that
31407 process the message. Section &<<SECTaddremheasys>>& contains details about
31408 modifying headers in a system filter. Header lines can also be added in an ACL
31409 as a message is received (see section &<<SECTaddheadacl>>&).
31411 In contrast to what happens in a system filter, header modifications that are
31412 specified on routers and transports apply only to the particular recipient
31413 addresses that are being processed by those routers and transports. These
31414 changes do not actually take place until a copy of the message is being
31415 transported. Therefore, they do not affect the basic set of header lines, and
31416 they do not affect the values of the variables that refer to header lines.
31418 &*Note*&: In particular, this means that any expansions in the configuration of
31419 the transport cannot refer to the modified header lines, because such
31420 expansions all occur before the message is actually transported.
31422 For both routers and transports, the result of expanding a &%headers_add%&
31423 option must be in the form of one or more RFC 2822 header lines, separated by
31424 newlines (coded as &"\n"&). For example:
31426 headers_add = X-added-header: added by $primary_hostname\n\
31427 X-added-second: another added header line
31429 Exim does not check the syntax of these added header lines.
31431 The result of expanding &%headers_remove%& must consist of a colon-separated
31432 list of header names. This is confusing, because header names themselves are
31433 often terminated by colons. In this case, the colons are the list separators,
31434 not part of the names. For example:
31436 headers_remove = return-receipt-to:acknowledge-to
31438 When &%headers_add%& or &%headers_remove%& is specified on a router, its value
31439 is expanded at routing time, and then associated with all addresses that are
31440 accepted by that router, and also with any new addresses that it generates. If
31441 an address passes through several routers as a result of aliasing or
31442 forwarding, the changes are cumulative.
31444 .oindex "&%unseen%&"
31445 However, this does not apply to multiple routers that result from the use of
31446 the &%unseen%& option. Any header modifications that were specified by the
31447 &"unseen"& router or its predecessors apply only to the &"unseen"& delivery.
31449 Addresses that end up with different &%headers_add%& or &%headers_remove%&
31450 settings cannot be delivered together in a batch, so a transport is always
31451 dealing with a set of addresses that have the same header-processing
31454 The transport starts by writing the original set of header lines that arrived
31455 with the message, possibly modified by the system filter. As it writes out
31456 these lines, it consults the list of header names that were attached to the
31457 recipient address(es) by &%headers_remove%& options in routers, and it also
31458 consults the transport's own &%headers_remove%& option. Header lines whose
31459 names are on either of these lists are not written out. If there are multiple
31460 instances of any listed header, they are all skipped.
31462 After the remaining original header lines have been written, new header
31463 lines that were specified by routers' &%headers_add%& options are written, in
31464 the order in which they were attached to the address. These are followed by any
31465 header lines specified by the transport's &%headers_add%& option.
31467 This way of handling header line modifications in routers and transports has
31468 the following consequences:
31471 The original set of header lines, possibly modified by the system filter,
31472 remains &"visible"&, in the sense that the &$header_$&&'xxx'& variables refer
31473 to it, at all times.
31475 Header lines that are added by a router's
31476 &%headers_add%& option are not accessible by means of the &$header_$&&'xxx'&
31477 expansion syntax in subsequent routers or the transport.
31479 Conversely, header lines that are specified for removal by &%headers_remove%&
31480 in a router remain visible to subsequent routers and the transport.
31482 Headers added to an address by &%headers_add%& in a router cannot be removed by
31483 a later router or by a transport.
31485 An added header can refer to the contents of an original header that is to be
31486 removed, even it has the same name as the added header. For example:
31488 headers_remove = subject
31489 headers_add = Subject: new subject (was: $h_subject:)
31493 &*Warning*&: The &%headers_add%& and &%headers_remove%& options cannot be used
31494 for a &(redirect)& router that has the &%one_time%& option set.
31500 .section "Constructed addresses" "SECTconstr"
31501 .cindex "address" "constructed"
31502 .cindex "constructed address"
31503 When Exim constructs a sender address for a locally-generated message, it uses
31506 <&'user name'&>&~&~<&'login'&&`@`&&'qualify_domain'&>
31510 Zaphod Beeblebrox <zaphod@end.univ.example>
31512 The user name is obtained from the &%-F%& command line option if set, or
31513 otherwise by looking up the calling user by &[getpwuid()]& and extracting the
31514 &"gecos"& field from the password entry. If the &"gecos"& field contains an
31515 ampersand character, this is replaced by the login name with the first letter
31516 upper cased, as is conventional in a number of operating systems. See the
31517 &%gecos_name%& option for a way to tailor the handling of the &"gecos"& field.
31518 The &%unknown_username%& option can be used to specify user names in cases when
31519 there is no password file entry.
31522 In all cases, the user name is made to conform to RFC 2822 by quoting all or
31523 parts of it if necessary. In addition, if it contains any non-printing
31524 characters, it is encoded as described in RFC 2047, which defines a way of
31525 including non-ASCII characters in header lines. The value of the
31526 &%headers_charset%& option specifies the name of the encoding that is used (the
31527 characters are assumed to be in this encoding). The setting of
31528 &%print_topbitchars%& controls whether characters with the top bit set (that
31529 is, with codes greater than 127) count as printing characters or not.
31533 .section "Case of local parts" "SECID230"
31534 .cindex "case of local parts"
31535 .cindex "local part" "case of"
31536 RFC 2822 states that the case of letters in the local parts of addresses cannot
31537 be assumed to be non-significant. Exim preserves the case of local parts of
31538 addresses, but by default it uses a lower-cased form when it is routing,
31539 because on most Unix systems, usernames are in lower case and case-insensitive
31540 routing is required. However, any particular router can be made to use the
31541 original case for local parts by setting the &%caseful_local_part%& generic
31544 .cindex "mixed-case login names"
31545 If you must have mixed-case user names on your system, the best way to proceed,
31546 assuming you want case-independent handling of incoming email, is to set up
31547 your first router to convert incoming local parts in your domains to the
31548 correct case by means of a file lookup. For example:
31552 domains = +local_domains
31553 data = ${lookup{$local_part}cdb\
31554 {/etc/usercased.cdb}{$value}fail}\
31557 For this router, the local part is forced to lower case by the default action
31558 (&%caseful_local_part%& is not set). The lower-cased local part is used to look
31559 up a new local part in the correct case. If you then set &%caseful_local_part%&
31560 on any subsequent routers which process your domains, they will operate on
31561 local parts with the correct case in a case-sensitive manner.
31565 .section "Dots in local parts" "SECID231"
31566 .cindex "dot" "in local part"
31567 .cindex "local part" "dots in"
31568 RFC 2822 forbids empty components in local parts. That is, an unquoted local
31569 part may not begin or end with a dot, nor have two consecutive dots in the
31570 middle. However, it seems that many MTAs do not enforce this, so Exim permits
31571 empty components for compatibility.
31575 .section "Rewriting addresses" "SECID232"
31576 .cindex "rewriting" "addresses"
31577 Rewriting of sender and recipient addresses, and addresses in headers, can
31578 happen automatically, or as the result of configuration options, as described
31579 in chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&. The headers that may be affected by this are
31580 &'Bcc:'&, &'Cc:'&, &'From:'&, &'Reply-To:'&, &'Sender:'&, and &'To:'&.
31582 Automatic rewriting includes qualification, as mentioned above. The other case
31583 in which it can happen is when an incomplete non-local domain is given. The
31584 routing process may cause this to be expanded into the full domain name. For
31585 example, a header such as
31589 might get rewritten as
31591 To: hare@teaparty.wonderland.fict.example
31593 Rewriting as a result of routing is the one kind of message processing that
31594 does not happen at input time, as it cannot be done until the address has
31597 Strictly, one should not do &'any'& deliveries of a message until all its
31598 addresses have been routed, in case any of the headers get changed as a
31599 result of routing. However, doing this in practice would hold up many
31600 deliveries for unreasonable amounts of time, just because one address could not
31601 immediately be routed. Exim therefore does not delay other deliveries when
31602 routing of one or more addresses is deferred.
31603 .ecindex IIDmesproc
31607 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
31608 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
31610 .chapter "SMTP processing" "CHAPSMTP"
31611 .scindex IIDsmtpproc1 "SMTP" "processing details"
31612 .scindex IIDsmtpproc2 "LMTP" "processing details"
31613 Exim supports a number of different ways of using the SMTP protocol, and its
31614 LMTP variant, which is an interactive protocol for transferring messages into a
31615 closed mail store application. This chapter contains details of how SMTP is
31616 processed. For incoming mail, the following are available:
31619 SMTP over TCP/IP (Exim daemon or &'inetd'&);
31621 SMTP over the standard input and output (the &%-bs%& option);
31623 Batched SMTP on the standard input (the &%-bS%& option).
31626 For mail delivery, the following are available:
31629 SMTP over TCP/IP (the &(smtp)& transport);
31631 LMTP over TCP/IP (the &(smtp)& transport with the &%protocol%& option set to
31634 LMTP over a pipe to a process running in the local host (the &(lmtp)&
31637 Batched SMTP to a file or pipe (the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports with
31638 the &%use_bsmtp%& option set).
31641 &'Batched SMTP'& is the name for a process in which batches of messages are
31642 stored in or read from files (or pipes), in a format in which SMTP commands are
31643 used to contain the envelope information.
31647 .section "Outgoing SMTP and LMTP over TCP/IP" "SECToutSMTPTCP"
31648 .cindex "SMTP" "outgoing over TCP/IP"
31649 .cindex "outgoing SMTP over TCP/IP"
31650 .cindex "LMTP" "over TCP/IP"
31651 .cindex "outgoing LMTP over TCP/IP"
31654 .cindex "SIZE option on MAIL command"
31655 Outgoing SMTP and LMTP over TCP/IP is implemented by the &(smtp)& transport.
31656 The &%protocol%& option selects which protocol is to be used, but the actual
31657 processing is the same in both cases.
31659 If, in response to its EHLO command, Exim is told that the SIZE
31660 parameter is supported, it adds SIZE=<&'n'&> to each subsequent MAIL
31661 command. The value of <&'n'&> is the message size plus the value of the
31662 &%size_addition%& option (default 1024) to allow for additions to the message
31663 such as per-transport header lines, or changes made in a
31664 .cindex "transport" "filter"
31665 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
31666 transport filter. If &%size_addition%& is set negative, the use of SIZE is
31669 If the remote server advertises support for PIPELINING, Exim uses the
31670 pipelining extension to SMTP (RFC 2197) to reduce the number of TCP/IP packets
31671 required for the transaction.
31673 If the remote server advertises support for the STARTTLS command, and Exim
31674 was built to support TLS encryption, it tries to start a TLS session unless the
31675 server matches &%hosts_avoid_tls%&. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for more details.
31676 Either a match in that or &%hosts_verify_avoid_tls%& apply when the transport
31677 is called for verification.
31679 If the remote server advertises support for the AUTH command, Exim scans
31680 the authenticators configuration for any suitable client settings, as described
31681 in chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&.
31683 .cindex "carriage return"
31685 Responses from the remote host are supposed to be terminated by CR followed by
31686 LF. However, there are known to be hosts that do not send CR characters, so in
31687 order to be able to interwork with such hosts, Exim treats LF on its own as a
31690 If a message contains a number of different addresses, all those with the same
31691 characteristics (for example, the same envelope sender) that resolve to the
31692 same set of hosts, in the same order, are sent in a single SMTP transaction,
31693 even if they are for different domains, unless there are more than the setting
31694 of the &%max_rcpt%&s option in the &(smtp)& transport allows, in which case
31695 they are split into groups containing no more than &%max_rcpt%&s addresses
31696 each. If &%remote_max_parallel%& is greater than one, such groups may be sent
31697 in parallel sessions. The order of hosts with identical MX values is not
31698 significant when checking whether addresses can be batched in this way.
31700 When the &(smtp)& transport suffers a temporary failure that is not
31701 message-related, Exim updates its transport-specific database, which contains
31702 records indexed by host name that remember which messages are waiting for each
31703 particular host. It also updates the retry database with new retry times.
31705 .cindex "hints database" "retry keys"
31706 Exim's retry hints are based on host name plus IP address, so if one address of
31707 a multi-homed host is broken, it will soon be skipped most of the time.
31708 See the next section for more detail about error handling.
31710 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
31711 .cindex "SMTP" "batching over TCP/IP"
31712 When a message is successfully delivered over a TCP/IP SMTP connection, Exim
31713 looks in the hints database for the transport to see if there are any queued
31714 messages waiting for the host to which it is connected. If it finds one, it
31715 creates a new Exim process using the &%-MC%& option (which can only be used by
31716 a process running as root or the Exim user) and passes the TCP/IP socket to it
31717 so that it can deliver another message using the same socket. The new process
31718 does only those deliveries that are routed to the connected host, and may in
31719 turn pass the socket on to a third process, and so on.
31721 The &%connection_max_messages%& option of the &(smtp)& transport can be used to
31722 limit the number of messages sent down a single TCP/IP connection.
31724 .cindex "asterisk" "after IP address"
31725 The second and subsequent messages delivered down an existing connection are
31726 identified in the main log by the addition of an asterisk after the closing
31727 square bracket of the IP address.
31732 .section "Errors in outgoing SMTP" "SECToutSMTPerr"
31733 .cindex "error" "in outgoing SMTP"
31734 .cindex "SMTP" "errors in outgoing"
31735 .cindex "host" "error"
31736 Three different kinds of error are recognized for outgoing SMTP: host errors,
31737 message errors, and recipient errors.
31740 .vitem "&*Host errors*&"
31741 A host error is not associated with a particular message or with a
31742 particular recipient of a message. The host errors are:
31745 Connection refused or timed out,
31747 Any error response code on connection,
31749 Any error response code to EHLO or HELO,
31751 Loss of connection at any time, except after &"."&,
31753 I/O errors at any time,
31755 Timeouts during the session, other than in response to MAIL, RCPT or
31756 the &"."& at the end of the data.
31759 For a host error, a permanent error response on connection, or in response to
31760 EHLO, causes all addresses routed to the host to be failed. Any other host
31761 error causes all addresses to be deferred, and retry data to be created for the
31762 host. It is not tried again, for any message, until its retry time arrives. If
31763 the current set of addresses are not all delivered in this run (to some
31764 alternative host), the message is added to the list of those waiting for this
31765 host, so if it is still undelivered when a subsequent successful delivery is
31766 made to the host, it will be sent down the same SMTP connection.
31768 .vitem "&*Message errors*&"
31769 .cindex "message" "error"
31770 A message error is associated with a particular message when sent to a
31771 particular host, but not with a particular recipient of the message. The
31772 message errors are:
31775 Any error response code to MAIL, DATA, or the &"."& that terminates
31778 Timeout after MAIL,
31780 Timeout or loss of connection after the &"."& that terminates the data. A
31781 timeout after the DATA command itself is treated as a host error, as is loss of
31782 connection at any other time.
31785 For a message error, a permanent error response (5&'xx'&) causes all addresses
31786 to be failed, and a delivery error report to be returned to the sender. A
31787 temporary error response (4&'xx'&), or one of the timeouts, causes all
31788 addresses to be deferred. Retry data is not created for the host, but instead,
31789 a retry record for the combination of host plus message id is created. The
31790 message is not added to the list of those waiting for this host. This ensures
31791 that the failing message will not be sent to this host again until the retry
31792 time arrives. However, other messages that are routed to the host are not
31793 affected, so if it is some property of the message that is causing the error,
31794 it will not stop the delivery of other mail.
31796 If the remote host specified support for the SIZE parameter in its response
31797 to EHLO, Exim adds SIZE=&'nnn'& to the MAIL command, so an
31798 over-large message will cause a message error because the error arrives as a
31801 .vitem "&*Recipient errors*&"
31802 .cindex "recipient" "error"
31803 A recipient error is associated with a particular recipient of a message. The
31804 recipient errors are:
31807 Any error response to RCPT,
31809 Timeout after RCPT.
31812 For a recipient error, a permanent error response (5&'xx'&) causes the
31813 recipient address to be failed, and a bounce message to be returned to the
31814 sender. A temporary error response (4&'xx'&) or a timeout causes the failing
31815 address to be deferred, and routing retry data to be created for it. This is
31816 used to delay processing of the address in subsequent queue runs, until its
31817 routing retry time arrives. This applies to all messages, but because it
31818 operates only in queue runs, one attempt will be made to deliver a new message
31819 to the failing address before the delay starts to operate. This ensures that,
31820 if the failure is really related to the message rather than the recipient
31821 (&"message too big for this recipient"& is a possible example), other messages
31822 have a chance of getting delivered. If a delivery to the address does succeed,
31823 the retry information gets cleared, so all stuck messages get tried again, and
31824 the retry clock is reset.
31826 The message is not added to the list of those waiting for this host. Use of the
31827 host for other messages is unaffected, and except in the case of a timeout,
31828 other recipients are processed independently, and may be successfully delivered
31829 in the current SMTP session. After a timeout it is of course impossible to
31830 proceed with the session, so all addresses get deferred. However, those other
31831 than the one that failed do not suffer any subsequent retry delays. Therefore,
31832 if one recipient is causing trouble, the others have a chance of getting
31833 through when a subsequent delivery attempt occurs before the failing
31834 recipient's retry time.
31837 In all cases, if there are other hosts (or IP addresses) available for the
31838 current set of addresses (for example, from multiple MX records), they are
31839 tried in this run for any undelivered addresses, subject of course to their
31840 own retry data. In other words, recipient error retry data does not take effect
31841 until the next delivery attempt.
31843 Some hosts have been observed to give temporary error responses to every
31844 MAIL command at certain times (&"insufficient space"& has been seen). It
31845 would be nice if such circumstances could be recognized, and defer data for the
31846 host itself created, but this is not possible within the current Exim design.
31847 What actually happens is that retry data for every (host, message) combination
31850 The reason that timeouts after MAIL and RCPT are treated specially is that
31851 these can sometimes arise as a result of the remote host's verification
31852 procedures. Exim makes this assumption, and treats them as if a temporary error
31853 response had been received. A timeout after &"."& is treated specially because
31854 it is known that some broken implementations fail to recognize the end of the
31855 message if the last character of the last line is a binary zero. Thus, it is
31856 helpful to treat this case as a message error.
31858 Timeouts at other times are treated as host errors, assuming a problem with the
31859 host, or the connection to it. If a timeout after MAIL, RCPT,
31860 or &"."& is really a connection problem, the assumption is that at the next try
31861 the timeout is likely to occur at some other point in the dialogue, causing it
31862 then to be treated as a host error.
31864 There is experimental evidence that some MTAs drop the connection after the
31865 terminating &"."& if they do not like the contents of the message for some
31866 reason, in contravention of the RFC, which indicates that a 5&'xx'& response
31867 should be given. That is why Exim treats this case as a message rather than a
31868 host error, in order not to delay other messages to the same host.
31873 .section "Incoming SMTP messages over TCP/IP" "SECID233"
31874 .cindex "SMTP" "incoming over TCP/IP"
31875 .cindex "incoming SMTP over TCP/IP"
31878 Incoming SMTP messages can be accepted in one of two ways: by running a
31879 listening daemon, or by using &'inetd'&. In the latter case, the entry in
31880 &_/etc/inetd.conf_& should be like this:
31882 smtp stream tcp nowait exim /opt/exim/bin/exim in.exim -bs
31884 Exim distinguishes between this case and the case of a locally running user
31885 agent using the &%-bs%& option by checking whether or not the standard input is
31886 a socket. When it is, either the port must be privileged (less than 1024), or
31887 the caller must be root or the Exim user. If any other user passes a socket
31888 with an unprivileged port number, Exim prints a message on the standard error
31889 stream and exits with an error code.
31891 By default, Exim does not make a log entry when a remote host connects or
31892 disconnects (either via the daemon or &'inetd'&), unless the disconnection is
31893 unexpected. It can be made to write such log entries by setting the
31894 &%smtp_connection%& log selector.
31896 .cindex "carriage return"
31898 Commands from the remote host are supposed to be terminated by CR followed by
31899 LF. However, there are known to be hosts that do not send CR characters. In
31900 order to be able to interwork with such hosts, Exim treats LF on its own as a
31902 Furthermore, because common code is used for receiving messages from all
31903 sources, a CR on its own is also interpreted as a line terminator. However, the
31904 sequence &"CR, dot, CR"& does not terminate incoming SMTP data.
31906 .cindex "EHLO" "invalid data"
31907 .cindex "HELO" "invalid data"
31908 One area that sometimes gives rise to problems concerns the EHLO or
31909 HELO commands. Some clients send syntactically invalid versions of these
31910 commands, which Exim rejects by default. (This is nothing to do with verifying
31911 the data that is sent, so &%helo_verify_hosts%& is not relevant.) You can tell
31912 Exim not to apply a syntax check by setting &%helo_accept_junk_hosts%& to
31913 match the broken hosts that send invalid commands.
31915 .cindex "SIZE option on MAIL command"
31916 .cindex "MAIL" "SIZE option"
31917 The amount of disk space available is checked whenever SIZE is received on
31918 a MAIL command, independently of whether &%message_size_limit%& or
31919 &%check_spool_space%& is configured, unless &%smtp_check_spool_space%& is set
31920 false. A temporary error is given if there is not enough space. If
31921 &%check_spool_space%& is set, the check is for that amount of space plus the
31922 value given with SIZE, that is, it checks that the addition of the incoming
31923 message will not reduce the space below the threshold.
31925 When a message is successfully received, Exim includes the local message id in
31926 its response to the final &"."& that terminates the data. If the remote host
31927 logs this text it can help with tracing what has happened to a message.
31929 The Exim daemon can limit the number of simultaneous incoming connections it is
31930 prepared to handle (see the &%smtp_accept_max%& option). It can also limit the
31931 number of simultaneous incoming connections from a single remote host (see the
31932 &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& option). Additional connection attempts are
31933 rejected using the SMTP temporary error code 421.
31935 The Exim daemon does not rely on the SIGCHLD signal to detect when a
31936 subprocess has finished, as this can get lost at busy times. Instead, it looks
31937 for completed subprocesses every time it wakes up. Provided there are other
31938 things happening (new incoming calls, starts of queue runs), completed
31939 processes will be noticed and tidied away. On very quiet systems you may
31940 sometimes see a &"defunct"& Exim process hanging about. This is not a problem;
31941 it will be noticed when the daemon next wakes up.
31943 When running as a daemon, Exim can reserve some SMTP slots for specific hosts,
31944 and can also be set up to reject SMTP calls from non-reserved hosts at times of
31945 high system load &-- for details see the &%smtp_accept_reserve%&,
31946 &%smtp_load_reserve%&, and &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& options. The load check
31947 applies in both the daemon and &'inetd'& cases.
31949 Exim normally starts a delivery process for each message received, though this
31950 can be varied by means of the &%-odq%& command line option and the
31951 &%queue_only%&, &%queue_only_file%&, and &%queue_only_load%& options. The
31952 number of simultaneously running delivery processes started in this way from
31953 SMTP input can be limited by the &%smtp_accept_queue%& and
31954 &%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& options. When either limit is reached,
31955 subsequently received messages are just put on the input queue without starting
31956 a delivery process.
31958 The controls that involve counts of incoming SMTP calls (&%smtp_accept_max%&,
31959 &%smtp_accept_queue%&, &%smtp_accept_reserve%&) are not available when Exim is
31960 started up from the &'inetd'& daemon, because in that case each connection is
31961 handled by an entirely independent Exim process. Control by load average is,
31962 however, available with &'inetd'&.
31964 Exim can be configured to verify addresses in incoming SMTP commands as they
31965 are received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for details. It can also be configured
31966 to rewrite addresses at this time &-- before any syntax checking is done. See
31967 section &<<SECTrewriteS>>&.
31969 Exim can also be configured to limit the rate at which a client host submits
31970 MAIL and RCPT commands in a single SMTP session. See the
31971 &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%& option.
31975 .section "Unrecognized SMTP commands" "SECID234"
31976 .cindex "SMTP" "unrecognized commands"
31977 If Exim receives more than &%smtp_max_unknown_commands%& unrecognized SMTP
31978 commands during a single SMTP connection, it drops the connection after sending
31979 the error response to the last command. The default value for
31980 &%smtp_max_unknown_commands%& is 3. This is a defence against some kinds of
31981 abuse that subvert web servers into making connections to SMTP ports; in these
31982 circumstances, a number of non-SMTP lines are sent first.
31985 .section "Syntax and protocol errors in SMTP commands" "SECID235"
31986 .cindex "SMTP" "syntax errors"
31987 .cindex "SMTP" "protocol errors"
31988 A syntax error is detected if an SMTP command is recognized, but there is
31989 something syntactically wrong with its data, for example, a malformed email
31990 address in a RCPT command. Protocol errors include invalid command
31991 sequencing such as RCPT before MAIL. If Exim receives more than
31992 &%smtp_max_synprot_errors%& such commands during a single SMTP connection, it
31993 drops the connection after sending the error response to the last command. The
31994 default value for &%smtp_max_synprot_errors%& is 3. This is a defence against
31995 broken clients that loop sending bad commands (yes, it has been seen).
31999 .section "Use of non-mail SMTP commands" "SECID236"
32000 .cindex "SMTP" "non-mail commands"
32001 The &"non-mail"& SMTP commands are those other than MAIL, RCPT, and
32002 DATA. Exim counts such commands, and drops the connection if there are too
32003 many of them in a single SMTP session. This action catches some
32004 denial-of-service attempts and things like repeated failing AUTHs, or a mad
32005 client looping sending EHLO. The global option &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%&
32006 defines what &"too many"& means. Its default value is 10.
32008 When a new message is expected, one occurrence of RSET is not counted. This
32009 allows a client to send one RSET between messages (this is not necessary,
32010 but some clients do it). Exim also allows one uncounted occurrence of HELO
32011 or EHLO, and one occurrence of STARTTLS between messages. After
32012 starting up a TLS session, another EHLO is expected, and so it too is not
32015 The first occurrence of AUTH in a connection, or immediately following
32016 STARTTLS is also not counted. Otherwise, all commands other than MAIL,
32017 RCPT, DATA, and QUIT are counted.
32019 You can control which hosts are subject to the limit set by
32020 &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%& by setting
32021 &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%&. The default value is &`*`&, which makes
32022 the limit apply to all hosts. This option means that you can exclude any
32023 specific badly-behaved hosts that you have to live with.
32028 .section "The VRFY and EXPN commands" "SECID237"
32029 When Exim receives a VRFY or EXPN command on a TCP/IP connection, it
32030 runs the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_vrfy%& or &%acl_smtp_expn%& (as
32031 appropriate) in order to decide whether the command should be accepted or not.
32032 If no ACL is defined, the command is rejected.
32034 .cindex "VRFY" "processing"
32035 When VRFY is accepted, it runs exactly the same code as when Exim is
32036 called with the &%-bv%& option.
32038 .cindex "EXPN" "processing"
32039 When EXPN is accepted, a single-level expansion of the address is done.
32040 EXPN is treated as an &"address test"& (similar to the &%-bt%& option) rather
32041 than a verification (the &%-bv%& option). If an unqualified local part is given
32042 as the argument to EXPN, it is qualified with &%qualify_domain%&. Rejections
32043 of VRFY and EXPN commands are logged on the main and reject logs, and
32044 VRFY verification failures are logged on the main log for consistency with
32049 .section "The ETRN command" "SECTETRN"
32050 .cindex "ETRN" "processing"
32051 RFC 1985 describes an SMTP command called ETRN that is designed to
32052 overcome the security problems of the TURN command (which has fallen into
32053 disuse). When Exim receives an ETRN command on a TCP/IP connection, it runs
32054 the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_etrn%& in order to decide whether the command
32055 should be accepted or not. If no ACL is defined, the command is rejected.
32057 The ETRN command is concerned with &"releasing"& messages that are awaiting
32058 delivery to certain hosts. As Exim does not organize its message queue by host,
32059 the only form of ETRN that is supported by default is the one where the
32060 text starts with the &"#"& prefix, in which case the remainder of the text is
32061 specific to the SMTP server. A valid ETRN command causes a run of Exim with
32062 the &%-R%& option to happen, with the remainder of the ETRN text as its
32063 argument. For example,
32071 which causes a delivery attempt on all messages with undelivered addresses
32072 containing the text &"brigadoon"&. When &%smtp_etrn_serialize%& is set (the
32073 default), Exim prevents the simultaneous execution of more than one queue run
32074 for the same argument string as a result of an ETRN command. This stops
32075 a misbehaving client from starting more than one queue runner at once.
32077 .cindex "hints database" "ETRN serialization"
32078 Exim implements the serialization by means of a hints database in which a
32079 record is written whenever a process is started by ETRN, and deleted when
32080 the process completes. However, Exim does not keep the SMTP session waiting for
32081 the ETRN process to complete. Once ETRN is accepted, the client is sent
32082 a &"success"& return code. Obviously there is scope for hints records to get
32083 left lying around if there is a system or program crash. To guard against this,
32084 Exim ignores any records that are more than six hours old.
32086 .oindex "&%smtp_etrn_command%&"
32087 For more control over what ETRN does, the &%smtp_etrn_command%& option can
32088 used. This specifies a command that is run whenever ETRN is received,
32089 whatever the form of its argument. For
32092 smtp_etrn_command = /etc/etrn_command $domain \
32093 $sender_host_address
32095 .vindex "&$domain$&"
32096 The string is split up into arguments which are independently expanded. The
32097 expansion variable &$domain$& is set to the argument of the ETRN command,
32098 and no syntax checking is done on the contents of this argument. Exim does not
32099 wait for the command to complete, so its status code is not checked. Exim runs
32100 under its own uid and gid when receiving incoming SMTP, so it is not possible
32101 for it to change them before running the command.
32105 .section "Incoming local SMTP" "SECID238"
32106 .cindex "SMTP" "local incoming"
32107 Some user agents use SMTP to pass messages to their local MTA using the
32108 standard input and output, as opposed to passing the envelope on the command
32109 line and writing the message to the standard input. This is supported by the
32110 &%-bs%& option. This form of SMTP is handled in the same way as incoming
32111 messages over TCP/IP (including the use of ACLs), except that the envelope
32112 sender given in a MAIL command is ignored unless the caller is trusted. In
32113 an ACL you can detect this form of SMTP input by testing for an empty host
32114 identification. It is common to have this as the first line in the ACL that
32115 runs for RCPT commands:
32119 This accepts SMTP messages from local processes without doing any other tests.
32123 .section "Outgoing batched SMTP" "SECTbatchSMTP"
32124 .cindex "SMTP" "batched outgoing"
32125 .cindex "batched SMTP output"
32126 Both the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports can be used for handling
32127 batched SMTP. Each has an option called &%use_bsmtp%& which causes messages to
32128 be output in BSMTP format. No SMTP responses are possible for this form of
32129 delivery. All it is doing is using SMTP commands as a way of transmitting the
32130 envelope along with the message.
32132 The message is written to the file or pipe preceded by the SMTP commands
32133 MAIL and RCPT, and followed by a line containing a single dot. Lines in
32134 the message that start with a dot have an extra dot added. The SMTP command
32135 HELO is not normally used. If it is required, the &%message_prefix%& option
32136 can be used to specify it.
32138 Because &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& are both local transports, they accept only
32139 one recipient address at a time by default. However, you can arrange for them
32140 to handle several addresses at once by setting the &%batch_max%& option. When
32141 this is done for BSMTP, messages may contain multiple RCPT commands. See
32142 chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>& for more details.
32145 When one or more addresses are routed to a BSMTP transport by a router that
32146 sets up a host list, the name of the first host on the list is available to the
32147 transport in the variable &$host$&. Here is an example of such a transport and
32152 driver = manualroute
32153 transport = smtp_appendfile
32154 route_list = domain.example batch.host.example
32158 driver = appendfile
32159 directory = /var/bsmtp/$host
32164 This causes messages addressed to &'domain.example'& to be written in BSMTP
32165 format to &_/var/bsmtp/batch.host.example_&, with only a single copy of each
32166 message (unless there are more than 1000 recipients).
32170 .section "Incoming batched SMTP" "SECTincomingbatchedSMTP"
32171 .cindex "SMTP" "batched incoming"
32172 .cindex "batched SMTP input"
32173 The &%-bS%& command line option causes Exim to accept one or more messages by
32174 reading SMTP on the standard input, but to generate no responses. If the caller
32175 is trusted, the senders in the MAIL commands are believed; otherwise the
32176 sender is always the caller of Exim. Unqualified senders and receivers are not
32177 rejected (there seems little point) but instead just get qualified. HELO
32178 and EHLO act as RSET; VRFY, EXPN, ETRN and HELP, act
32179 as NOOP; QUIT quits.
32181 Minimal policy checking is done for BSMTP input. Only the non-SMTP
32182 ACL is run in the same way as for non-SMTP local input.
32184 If an error is detected while reading a message, including a missing &"."& at
32185 the end, Exim gives up immediately. It writes details of the error to the
32186 standard output in a stylized way that the calling program should be able to
32187 make some use of automatically, for example:
32189 554 Unexpected end of file
32190 Transaction started in line 10
32191 Error detected in line 14
32193 It writes a more verbose version, for human consumption, to the standard error
32196 An error was detected while processing a file of BSMTP input.
32197 The error message was:
32199 501 '>' missing at end of address
32201 The SMTP transaction started in line 10.
32202 The error was detected in line 12.
32203 The SMTP command at fault was:
32205 rcpt to:<malformed@in.com.plete
32207 1 previous message was successfully processed.
32208 The rest of the batch was abandoned.
32210 The return code from Exim is zero only if there were no errors. It is 1 if some
32211 messages were accepted before an error was detected, and 2 if no messages were
32213 .ecindex IIDsmtpproc1
32214 .ecindex IIDsmtpproc2
32218 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
32219 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
32221 .chapter "Customizing bounce and warning messages" "CHAPemsgcust" &&&
32222 "Customizing messages"
32223 When a message fails to be delivered, or remains on the queue for more than a
32224 configured amount of time, Exim sends a message to the original sender, or
32225 to an alternative configured address. The text of these messages is built into
32226 the code of Exim, but it is possible to change it, either by adding a single
32227 string, or by replacing each of the paragraphs by text supplied in a file.
32229 The &'From:'& and &'To:'& header lines are automatically generated; you can
32230 cause a &'Reply-To:'& line to be added by setting the &%errors_reply_to%&
32231 option. Exim also adds the line
32233 Auto-Submitted: auto-generated
32235 to all warning and bounce messages,
32238 .section "Customizing bounce messages" "SECID239"
32239 .cindex "customizing" "bounce message"
32240 .cindex "bounce message" "customizing"
32241 If &%bounce_message_text%& is set, its contents are included in the default
32242 message immediately after &"This message was created automatically by mail
32243 delivery software."& The string is not expanded. It is not used if
32244 &%bounce_message_file%& is set.
32246 When &%bounce_message_file%& is set, it must point to a template file for
32247 constructing error messages. The file consists of a series of text items,
32248 separated by lines consisting of exactly four asterisks. If the file cannot be
32249 opened, default text is used and a message is written to the main and panic
32250 logs. If any text item in the file is empty, default text is used for that
32253 .vindex "&$bounce_recipient$&"
32254 .vindex "&$bounce_return_size_limit$&"
32255 Each item of text that is read from the file is expanded, and there are two
32256 expansion variables which can be of use here: &$bounce_recipient$& is set to
32257 the recipient of an error message while it is being created, and
32258 &$bounce_return_size_limit$& contains the value of the &%return_size_limit%&
32259 option, rounded to a whole number.
32261 The items must appear in the file in the following order:
32264 The first item is included in the headers, and should include at least a
32265 &'Subject:'& header. Exim does not check the syntax of these headers.
32267 The second item forms the start of the error message. After it, Exim lists the
32268 failing addresses with their error messages.
32270 The third item is used to introduce any text from pipe transports that is to be
32271 returned to the sender. It is omitted if there is no such text.
32273 The fourth item is used to introduce the copy of the message that is returned
32274 as part of the error report.
32276 The fifth item is added after the fourth one if the returned message is
32277 truncated because it is bigger than &%return_size_limit%&.
32279 The sixth item is added after the copy of the original message.
32282 The default state (&%bounce_message_file%& unset) is equivalent to the
32283 following file, in which the sixth item is empty. The &'Subject:'& and some
32284 other lines have been split in order to fit them on the page:
32286 Subject: Mail delivery failed
32287 ${if eq{$sender_address}{$bounce_recipient}
32288 {: returning message to sender}}
32290 This message was created automatically by mail delivery software.
32292 A message ${if eq{$sender_address}{$bounce_recipient}
32293 {that you sent }{sent by
32297 }}could not be delivered to all of its recipients.
32298 This is a permanent error. The following address(es) failed:
32300 The following text was generated during the delivery attempt(s):
32302 ------ This is a copy of the message, including all the headers.
32305 ------ The body of the message is $message_size characters long;
32307 ------ $bounce_return_size_limit or so are included here.
32310 .section "Customizing warning messages" "SECTcustwarn"
32311 .cindex "customizing" "warning message"
32312 .cindex "warning of delay" "customizing the message"
32313 The option &%warn_message_file%& can be pointed at a template file for use when
32314 warnings about message delays are created. In this case there are only three
32318 The first item is included in the headers, and should include at least a
32319 &'Subject:'& header. Exim does not check the syntax of these headers.
32321 The second item forms the start of the warning message. After it, Exim lists
32322 the delayed addresses.
32324 The third item then ends the message.
32327 The default state is equivalent to the following file, except that some lines
32328 have been split here, in order to fit them on the page:
32330 Subject: Warning: message $message_exim_id delayed
32331 $warn_message_delay
32333 This message was created automatically by mail delivery software.
32335 A message ${if eq{$sender_address}{$warn_message_recipients}
32336 {that you sent }{sent by
32340 }}has not been delivered to all of its recipients after
32341 more than $warn_message_delay on the queue on $primary_hostname.
32343 The message identifier is: $message_exim_id
32344 The subject of the message is: $h_subject
32345 The date of the message is: $h_date
32347 The following address(es) have not yet been delivered:
32349 No action is required on your part. Delivery attempts will
32350 continue for some time, and this warning may be repeated at
32351 intervals if the message remains undelivered. Eventually the
32352 mail delivery software will give up, and when that happens,
32353 the message will be returned to you.
32355 .vindex "&$warn_message_delay$&"
32356 .vindex "&$warn_message_recipients$&"
32357 However, in the default state the subject and date lines are omitted if no
32358 appropriate headers exist. During the expansion of this file,
32359 &$warn_message_delay$& is set to the delay time in one of the forms &"<&'n'&>
32360 minutes"& or &"<&'n'&> hours"&, and &$warn_message_recipients$& contains a list
32361 of recipients for the warning message. There may be more than one if there are
32362 multiple addresses with different &%errors_to%& settings on the routers that
32368 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
32369 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
32371 .chapter "Some common configuration settings" "CHAPcomconreq"
32372 This chapter discusses some configuration settings that seem to be fairly
32373 common. More examples and discussion can be found in the Exim book.
32377 .section "Sending mail to a smart host" "SECID240"
32378 .cindex "smart host" "example router"
32379 If you want to send all mail for non-local domains to a &"smart host"&, you
32380 should replace the default &(dnslookup)& router with a router which does the
32381 routing explicitly:
32383 send_to_smart_host:
32384 driver = manualroute
32385 route_list = !+local_domains smart.host.name
32386 transport = remote_smtp
32388 You can use the smart host's IP address instead of the name if you wish.
32389 If you are using Exim only to submit messages to a smart host, and not for
32390 receiving incoming messages, you can arrange for it to do the submission
32391 synchronously by setting the &%mua_wrapper%& option (see chapter
32392 &<<CHAPnonqueueing>>&).
32397 .section "Using Exim to handle mailing lists" "SECTmailinglists"
32398 .cindex "mailing lists"
32399 Exim can be used to run simple mailing lists, but for large and/or complicated
32400 requirements, the use of additional specialized mailing list software such as
32401 Majordomo or Mailman is recommended.
32403 The &(redirect)& router can be used to handle mailing lists where each list
32404 is maintained in a separate file, which can therefore be managed by an
32405 independent manager. The &%domains%& router option can be used to run these
32406 lists in a separate domain from normal mail. For example:
32410 domains = lists.example
32411 file = /usr/lists/$local_part
32414 errors_to = $local_part-request@lists.example
32417 This router is skipped for domains other than &'lists.example'&. For addresses
32418 in that domain, it looks for a file that matches the local part. If there is no
32419 such file, the router declines, but because &%no_more%& is set, no subsequent
32420 routers are tried, and so the whole delivery fails.
32422 The &%forbid_pipe%& and &%forbid_file%& options prevent a local part from being
32423 expanded into a file name or a pipe delivery, which is usually inappropriate in
32426 .oindex "&%errors_to%&"
32427 The &%errors_to%& option specifies that any delivery errors caused by addresses
32428 taken from a mailing list are to be sent to the given address rather than the
32429 original sender of the message. However, before acting on this, Exim verifies
32430 the error address, and ignores it if verification fails.
32432 For example, using the configuration above, mail sent to
32433 &'dicts@lists.example'& is passed on to those addresses contained in
32434 &_/usr/lists/dicts_&, with error reports directed to
32435 &'dicts-request@lists.example'&, provided that this address can be verified.
32436 There could be a file called &_/usr/lists/dicts-request_& containing
32437 the address(es) of this particular list's manager(s), but other approaches,
32438 such as setting up an earlier router (possibly using the &%local_part_prefix%&
32439 or &%local_part_suffix%& options) to handle addresses of the form
32440 &%owner-%&&'xxx'& or &%xxx-%&&'request'&, are also possible.
32444 .section "Syntax errors in mailing lists" "SECID241"
32445 .cindex "mailing lists" "syntax errors in"
32446 If an entry in redirection data contains a syntax error, Exim normally defers
32447 delivery of the original address. That means that a syntax error in a mailing
32448 list holds up all deliveries to the list. This may not be appropriate when a
32449 list is being maintained automatically from data supplied by users, and the
32450 addresses are not rigorously checked.
32452 If the &%skip_syntax_errors%& option is set, the &(redirect)& router just skips
32453 entries that fail to parse, noting the incident in the log. If in addition
32454 &%syntax_errors_to%& is set to a verifiable address, a message is sent to it
32455 whenever a broken address is skipped. It is usually appropriate to set
32456 &%syntax_errors_to%& to the same address as &%errors_to%&.
32460 .section "Re-expansion of mailing lists" "SECID242"
32461 .cindex "mailing lists" "re-expansion of"
32462 Exim remembers every individual address to which a message has been delivered,
32463 in order to avoid duplication, but it normally stores only the original
32464 recipient addresses with a message. If all the deliveries to a mailing list
32465 cannot be done at the first attempt, the mailing list is re-expanded when the
32466 delivery is next tried. This means that alterations to the list are taken into
32467 account at each delivery attempt, so addresses that have been added to
32468 the list since the message arrived will therefore receive a copy of the
32469 message, even though it pre-dates their subscription.
32471 If this behaviour is felt to be undesirable, the &%one_time%& option can be set
32472 on the &(redirect)& router. If this is done, any addresses generated by the
32473 router that fail to deliver at the first attempt are added to the message as
32474 &"top level"& addresses, and the parent address that generated them is marked
32475 &"delivered"&. Thus, expansion of the mailing list does not happen again at the
32476 subsequent delivery attempts. The disadvantage of this is that if any of the
32477 failing addresses are incorrect, correcting them in the file has no effect on
32478 pre-existing messages.
32480 The original top-level address is remembered with each of the generated
32481 addresses, and is output in any log messages. However, any intermediate parent
32482 addresses are not recorded. This makes a difference to the log only if the
32483 &%all_parents%& selector is set, but for mailing lists there is normally only
32484 one level of expansion anyway.
32488 .section "Closed mailing lists" "SECID243"
32489 .cindex "mailing lists" "closed"
32490 The examples so far have assumed open mailing lists, to which anybody may
32491 send mail. It is also possible to set up closed lists, where mail is accepted
32492 from specified senders only. This is done by making use of the generic
32493 &%senders%& option to restrict the router that handles the list.
32495 The following example uses the same file as a list of recipients and as a list
32496 of permitted senders. It requires three routers:
32500 domains = lists.example
32501 local_part_suffix = -request
32502 file = /usr/lists/$local_part$local_part_suffix
32507 domains = lists.example
32508 senders = ${if exists {/usr/lists/$local_part}\
32509 {lsearch;/usr/lists/$local_part}{*}}
32510 file = /usr/lists/$local_part
32513 errors_to = $local_part-request@lists.example
32518 domains = lists.example
32520 data = :fail: $local_part@lists.example is a closed mailing list
32522 All three routers have the same &%domains%& setting, so for any other domains,
32523 they are all skipped. The first router runs only if the local part ends in
32524 &%-request%&. It handles messages to the list manager(s) by means of an open
32527 The second router runs only if the &%senders%& precondition is satisfied. It
32528 checks for the existence of a list that corresponds to the local part, and then
32529 checks that the sender is on the list by means of a linear search. It is
32530 necessary to check for the existence of the file before trying to search it,
32531 because otherwise Exim thinks there is a configuration error. If the file does
32532 not exist, the expansion of &%senders%& is *, which matches all senders. This
32533 means that the router runs, but because there is no list, declines, and
32534 &%no_more%& ensures that no further routers are run. The address fails with an
32535 &"unrouteable address"& error.
32537 The third router runs only if the second router is skipped, which happens when
32538 a mailing list exists, but the sender is not on it. This router forcibly fails
32539 the address, giving a suitable error message.
32544 .section "Variable Envelope Return Paths (VERP)" "SECTverp"
32546 .cindex "Variable Envelope Return Paths"
32547 .cindex "envelope sender"
32548 Variable Envelope Return Paths &-- see &url(http://cr.yp.to/proto/verp.txt) &--
32549 are a way of helping mailing list administrators discover which subscription
32550 address is the cause of a particular delivery failure. The idea is to encode
32551 the original recipient address in the outgoing envelope sender address, so that
32552 if the message is forwarded by another host and then subsequently bounces, the
32553 original recipient can be extracted from the recipient address of the bounce.
32555 .oindex &%errors_to%&
32556 .oindex &%return_path%&
32557 Envelope sender addresses can be modified by Exim using two different
32558 facilities: the &%errors_to%& option on a router (as shown in previous mailing
32559 list examples), or the &%return_path%& option on a transport. The second of
32560 these is effective only if the message is successfully delivered to another
32561 host; it is not used for errors detected on the local host (see the description
32562 of &%return_path%& in chapter &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&). Here is an example
32563 of the use of &%return_path%& to implement VERP on an &(smtp)& transport:
32569 ${if match {$return_path}{^(.+?)-request@your.dom.example\$}\
32570 {$1-request+$local_part=$domain@your.dom.example}fail}
32572 This has the effect of rewriting the return path (envelope sender) on outgoing
32573 SMTP messages, if the local part of the original return path ends in
32574 &"-request"&, and the domain is &'your.dom.example'&. The rewriting inserts the
32575 local part and domain of the recipient into the return path. Suppose, for
32576 example, that a message whose return path has been set to
32577 &'somelist-request@your.dom.example'& is sent to
32578 &'subscriber@other.dom.example'&. In the transport, the return path is
32581 somelist-request+subscriber=other.dom.example@your.dom.example
32583 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
32584 For this to work, you must tell Exim to send multiple copies of messages that
32585 have more than one recipient, so that each copy has just one recipient. This is
32586 achieved by setting &%max_rcpt%& to 1. Without this, a single copy of a message
32587 might be sent to several different recipients in the same domain, in which case
32588 &$local_part$& is not available in the transport, because it is not unique.
32590 Unless your host is doing nothing but mailing list deliveries, you should
32591 probably use a separate transport for the VERP deliveries, so as not to use
32592 extra resources in making one-per-recipient copies for other deliveries. This
32593 can easily be done by expanding the &%transport%& option in the router:
32597 domains = ! +local_domains
32599 ${if match {$return_path}{^(.+?)-request@your.dom.example\$}\
32600 {verp_smtp}{remote_smtp}}
32603 If you want to change the return path using &%errors_to%& in a router instead
32604 of using &%return_path%& in the transport, you need to set &%errors_to%& on all
32605 routers that handle mailing list addresses. This will ensure that all delivery
32606 errors, including those detected on the local host, are sent to the VERP
32609 On a host that does no local deliveries and has no manual routing, only the
32610 &(dnslookup)& router needs to be changed. A special transport is not needed for
32611 SMTP deliveries. Every mailing list recipient has its own return path value,
32612 and so Exim must hand them to the transport one at a time. Here is an example
32613 of a &(dnslookup)& router that implements VERP:
32617 domains = ! +local_domains
32618 transport = remote_smtp
32620 ${if match {$return_path}{^(.+?)-request@your.dom.example\$}}
32621 {$1-request+$local_part=$domain@your.dom.example}fail}
32624 Before you start sending out messages with VERPed return paths, you must also
32625 configure Exim to accept the bounce messages that come back to those paths.
32626 Typically this is done by setting a &%local_part_suffix%& option for a
32627 router, and using this to route the messages to wherever you want to handle
32630 The overhead incurred in using VERP depends very much on the size of the
32631 message, the number of recipient addresses that resolve to the same remote
32632 host, and the speed of the connection over which the message is being sent. If
32633 a lot of addresses resolve to the same host and the connection is slow, sending
32634 a separate copy of the message for each address may take substantially longer
32635 than sending a single copy with many recipients (for which VERP cannot be
32643 .section "Virtual domains" "SECTvirtualdomains"
32644 .cindex "virtual domains"
32645 .cindex "domain" "virtual"
32646 The phrase &'virtual domain'& is unfortunately used with two rather different
32650 A domain for which there are no real mailboxes; all valid local parts are
32651 aliases for other email addresses. Common examples are organizational
32652 top-level domains and &"vanity"& domains.
32654 One of a number of independent domains that are all handled by the same host,
32655 with mailboxes on that host, but where the mailbox owners do not necessarily
32656 have login accounts on that host.
32659 The first usage is probably more common, and does seem more &"virtual"& than
32660 the second. This kind of domain can be handled in Exim with a straightforward
32661 aliasing router. One approach is to create a separate alias file for each
32662 virtual domain. Exim can test for the existence of the alias file to determine
32663 whether the domain exists. The &(dsearch)& lookup type is useful here, leading
32664 to a router of this form:
32668 domains = dsearch;/etc/mail/virtual
32669 data = ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/etc/mail/virtual/$domain}}
32672 The &%domains%& option specifies that the router is to be skipped, unless there
32673 is a file in the &_/etc/mail/virtual_& directory whose name is the same as the
32674 domain that is being processed. When the router runs, it looks up the local
32675 part in the file to find a new address (or list of addresses). The &%no_more%&
32676 setting ensures that if the lookup fails (leading to &%data%& being an empty
32677 string), Exim gives up on the address without trying any subsequent routers.
32679 This one router can handle all the virtual domains because the alias file names
32680 follow a fixed pattern. Permissions can be arranged so that appropriate people
32681 can edit the different alias files. A successful aliasing operation results in
32682 a new envelope recipient address, which is then routed from scratch.
32684 The other kind of &"virtual"& domain can also be handled in a straightforward
32685 way. One approach is to create a file for each domain containing a list of
32686 valid local parts, and use it in a router like this:
32690 domains = dsearch;/etc/mail/domains
32691 local_parts = lsearch;/etc/mail/domains/$domain
32692 transport = my_mailboxes
32694 The address is accepted if there is a file for the domain, and the local part
32695 can be found in the file. The &%domains%& option is used to check for the
32696 file's existence because &%domains%& is tested before the &%local_parts%&
32697 option (see section &<<SECTrouprecon>>&). You cannot use &%require_files%&,
32698 because that option is tested after &%local_parts%&. The transport is as
32702 driver = appendfile
32703 file = /var/mail/$domain/$local_part
32706 This uses a directory of mailboxes for each domain. The &%user%& setting is
32707 required, to specify which uid is to be used for writing to the mailboxes.
32709 The configuration shown here is just one example of how you might support this
32710 requirement. There are many other ways this kind of configuration can be set
32711 up, for example, by using a database instead of separate files to hold all the
32712 information about the domains.
32716 .section "Multiple user mailboxes" "SECTmulbox"
32717 .cindex "multiple mailboxes"
32718 .cindex "mailbox" "multiple"
32719 .cindex "local part" "prefix"
32720 .cindex "local part" "suffix"
32721 Heavy email users often want to operate with multiple mailboxes, into which
32722 incoming mail is automatically sorted. A popular way of handling this is to
32723 allow users to use multiple sender addresses, so that replies can easily be
32724 identified. Users are permitted to add prefixes or suffixes to their local
32725 parts for this purpose. The wildcard facility of the generic router options
32726 &%local_part_prefix%& and &%local_part_suffix%& can be used for this. For
32727 example, consider this router:
32732 file = $home/.forward
32733 local_part_suffix = -*
32734 local_part_suffix_optional
32737 .vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
32738 It runs a user's &_.forward_& file for all local parts of the form
32739 &'username-*'&. Within the filter file the user can distinguish different
32740 cases by testing the variable &$local_part_suffix$&. For example:
32742 if $local_part_suffix contains -special then
32743 save /home/$local_part/Mail/special
32746 If the filter file does not exist, or does not deal with such addresses, they
32747 fall through to subsequent routers, and, assuming no subsequent use of the
32748 &%local_part_suffix%& option is made, they presumably fail. Thus, users have
32749 control over which suffixes are valid.
32751 Alternatively, a suffix can be used to trigger the use of a different
32752 &_.forward_& file &-- which is the way a similar facility is implemented in
32758 file = $home/.forward$local_part_suffix
32759 local_part_suffix = -*
32760 local_part_suffix_optional
32763 If there is no suffix, &_.forward_& is used; if the suffix is &'-special'&, for
32764 example, &_.forward-special_& is used. Once again, if the appropriate file
32765 does not exist, or does not deal with the address, it is passed on to
32766 subsequent routers, which could, if required, look for an unqualified
32767 &_.forward_& file to use as a default.
32771 .section "Simplified vacation processing" "SECID244"
32772 .cindex "vacation processing"
32773 The traditional way of running the &'vacation'& program is for a user to set up
32774 a pipe command in a &_.forward_& file
32775 (see section &<<SECTspecitredli>>& for syntax details).
32776 This is prone to error by inexperienced users. There are two features of Exim
32777 that can be used to make this process simpler for users:
32780 A local part prefix such as &"vacation-"& can be specified on a router which
32781 can cause the message to be delivered directly to the &'vacation'& program, or
32782 alternatively can use Exim's &(autoreply)& transport. The contents of a user's
32783 &_.forward_& file are then much simpler. For example:
32785 spqr, vacation-spqr
32788 The &%require_files%& generic router option can be used to trigger a
32789 vacation delivery by checking for the existence of a certain file in the
32790 user's home directory. The &%unseen%& generic option should also be used, to
32791 ensure that the original delivery also proceeds. In this case, all the user has
32792 to do is to create a file called, say, &_.vacation_&, containing a vacation
32796 Another advantage of both these methods is that they both work even when the
32797 use of arbitrary pipes by users is locked out.
32801 .section "Taking copies of mail" "SECID245"
32802 .cindex "message" "copying every"
32803 Some installations have policies that require archive copies of all messages to
32804 be made. A single copy of each message can easily be taken by an appropriate
32805 command in a system filter, which could, for example, use a different file for
32806 each day's messages.
32808 There is also a shadow transport mechanism that can be used to take copies of
32809 messages that are successfully delivered by local transports, one copy per
32810 delivery. This could be used, &'inter alia'&, to implement automatic
32811 notification of delivery by sites that insist on doing such things.
32815 .section "Intermittently connected hosts" "SECID246"
32816 .cindex "intermittently connected hosts"
32817 It has become quite common (because it is cheaper) for hosts to connect to the
32818 Internet periodically rather than remain connected all the time. The normal
32819 arrangement is that mail for such hosts accumulates on a system that is
32820 permanently connected.
32822 Exim was designed for use on permanently connected hosts, and so it is not
32823 particularly well-suited to use in an intermittently connected environment.
32824 Nevertheless there are some features that can be used.
32827 .section "Exim on the upstream server host" "SECID247"
32828 It is tempting to arrange for incoming mail for the intermittently connected
32829 host to remain on Exim's queue until the client connects. However, this
32830 approach does not scale very well. Two different kinds of waiting message are
32831 being mixed up in the same queue &-- those that cannot be delivered because of
32832 some temporary problem, and those that are waiting for their destination host
32833 to connect. This makes it hard to manage the queue, as well as wasting
32834 resources, because each queue runner scans the entire queue.
32836 A better approach is to separate off those messages that are waiting for an
32837 intermittently connected host. This can be done by delivering these messages
32838 into local files in batch SMTP, &"mailstore"&, or other envelope-preserving
32839 format, from where they are transmitted by other software when their
32840 destination connects. This makes it easy to collect all the mail for one host
32841 in a single directory, and to apply local timeout rules on a per-message basis
32844 On a very small scale, leaving the mail on Exim's queue can be made to work. If
32845 you are doing this, you should configure Exim with a long retry period for the
32846 intermittent host. For example:
32848 cheshire.wonderland.fict.example * F,5d,24h
32850 This stops a lot of failed delivery attempts from occurring, but Exim remembers
32851 which messages it has queued up for that host. Once the intermittent host comes
32852 online, forcing delivery of one message (either by using the &%-M%& or &%-R%&
32853 options, or by using the ETRN SMTP command (see section &<<SECTETRN>>&)
32854 causes all the queued up messages to be delivered, often down a single SMTP
32855 connection. While the host remains connected, any new messages get delivered
32858 If the connecting hosts do not have fixed IP addresses, that is, if a host is
32859 issued with a different IP address each time it connects, Exim's retry
32860 mechanisms on the holding host get confused, because the IP address is normally
32861 used as part of the key string for holding retry information. This can be
32862 avoided by unsetting &%retry_include_ip_address%& on the &(smtp)& transport.
32863 Since this has disadvantages for permanently connected hosts, it is best to
32864 arrange a separate transport for the intermittently connected ones.
32868 .section "Exim on the intermittently connected client host" "SECID248"
32869 The value of &%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& should probably be
32870 increased, or even set to zero (that is, disabled) on the intermittently
32871 connected host, so that all incoming messages down a single connection get
32872 delivered immediately.
32874 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
32875 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
32876 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
32877 Mail waiting to be sent from an intermittently connected host will probably
32878 not have been routed, because without a connection DNS lookups are not
32879 possible. This means that if a normal queue run is done at connection time,
32880 each message is likely to be sent in a separate SMTP session. This can be
32881 avoided by starting the queue run with a command line option beginning with
32882 &%-qq%& instead of &%-q%&. In this case, the queue is scanned twice. In the
32883 first pass, routing is done but no deliveries take place. The second pass is a
32884 normal queue run; since all the messages have been previously routed, those
32885 destined for the same host are likely to get sent as multiple deliveries in a
32886 single SMTP connection.
32890 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
32891 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
32893 .chapter "Using Exim as a non-queueing client" "CHAPnonqueueing" &&&
32894 "Exim as a non-queueing client"
32895 .cindex "client, non-queueing"
32896 .cindex "smart host" "suppressing queueing"
32897 On a personal computer, it is a common requirement for all
32898 email to be sent to a &"smart host"&. There are plenty of MUAs that can be
32899 configured to operate that way, for all the popular operating systems.
32900 However, there are some MUAs for Unix-like systems that cannot be so
32901 configured: they submit messages using the command line interface of
32902 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&. Furthermore, utility programs such as &'cron'& submit
32905 If the personal computer runs continuously, there is no problem, because it can
32906 run a conventional MTA that handles delivery to the smart host, and deal with
32907 any delays via its queueing mechanism. However, if the computer does not run
32908 continuously or runs different operating systems at different times, queueing
32909 email is not desirable.
32911 There is therefore a requirement for something that can provide the
32912 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& interface but deliver messages to a smart host without
32913 any queueing or retrying facilities. Furthermore, the delivery to the smart
32914 host should be synchronous, so that if it fails, the sending MUA is immediately
32915 informed. In other words, we want something that extends an MUA that submits
32916 to a local MTA via the command line so that it behaves like one that submits
32917 to a remote smart host using TCP/SMTP.
32919 There are a number of applications (for example, there is one called &'ssmtp'&)
32920 that do this job. However, people have found them to be lacking in various
32921 ways. For instance, you might want to allow aliasing and forwarding to be done
32922 before sending a message to the smart host.
32924 Exim already had the necessary infrastructure for doing this job. Just a few
32925 tweaks were needed to make it behave as required, though it is somewhat of an
32926 overkill to use a fully-featured MTA for this purpose.
32928 .oindex "&%mua_wrapper%&"
32929 There is a Boolean global option called &%mua_wrapper%&, defaulting false.
32930 Setting &%mua_wrapper%& true causes Exim to run in a special mode where it
32931 assumes that it is being used to &"wrap"& a command-line MUA in the manner
32932 just described. As well as setting &%mua_wrapper%&, you also need to provide a
32933 compatible router and transport configuration. Typically there will be just one
32934 router and one transport, sending everything to a smart host.
32936 When run in MUA wrapping mode, the behaviour of Exim changes in the
32940 A daemon cannot be run, nor will Exim accept incoming messages from &'inetd'&.
32941 In other words, the only way to submit messages is via the command line.
32943 Each message is synchronously delivered as soon as it is received (&%-odi%& is
32944 assumed). All queueing options (&%queue_only%&, &%queue_smtp_domains%&,
32945 &%control%& in an ACL, etc.) are quietly ignored. The Exim reception process
32946 does not finish until the delivery attempt is complete. If the delivery is
32947 successful, a zero return code is given.
32949 Address redirection is permitted, but the final routing for all addresses must
32950 be to the same remote transport, and to the same list of hosts. Furthermore,
32951 the return address (envelope sender) must be the same for all recipients, as
32952 must any added or deleted header lines. In other words, it must be possible to
32953 deliver the message in a single SMTP transaction, however many recipients there
32956 If these conditions are not met, or if routing any address results in a
32957 failure or defer status, or if Exim is unable to deliver all the recipients
32958 successfully to one of the smart hosts, delivery of the entire message fails.
32960 Because no queueing is allowed, all failures are treated as permanent; there
32961 is no distinction between 4&'xx'& and 5&'xx'& SMTP response codes from the
32962 smart host. Furthermore, because only a single yes/no response can be given to
32963 the caller, it is not possible to deliver to some recipients and not others. If
32964 there is an error (temporary or permanent) for any recipient, all are failed.
32966 If more than one smart host is listed, Exim will try another host after a
32967 connection failure or a timeout, in the normal way. However, if this kind of
32968 failure happens for all the hosts, the delivery fails.
32970 When delivery fails, an error message is written to the standard error stream
32971 (as well as to Exim's log), and Exim exits to the caller with a return code
32972 value 1. The message is expunged from Exim's spool files. No bounce messages
32973 are ever generated.
32975 No retry data is maintained, and any retry rules are ignored.
32977 A number of Exim options are overridden: &%deliver_drop_privilege%& is forced
32978 true, &%max_rcpt%& in the &(smtp)& transport is forced to &"unlimited"&,
32979 &%remote_max_parallel%& is forced to one, and fallback hosts are ignored.
32982 The overall effect is that Exim makes a single synchronous attempt to deliver
32983 the message, failing if there is any kind of problem. Because no local
32984 deliveries are done and no daemon can be run, Exim does not need root
32985 privilege. It should be possible to run it setuid to &'exim'& instead of setuid
32986 to &'root'&. See section &<<SECTrunexiwitpri>>& for a general discussion about
32987 the advantages and disadvantages of running without root privilege.
32992 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
32993 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
32995 .chapter "Log files" "CHAPlog"
32996 .scindex IIDloggen "log" "general description"
32997 .cindex "log" "types of"
32998 Exim writes three different logs, referred to as the main log, the reject log,
33003 The main log records the arrival of each message and each delivery in a single
33004 line in each case. The format is as compact as possible, in an attempt to keep
33005 down the size of log files. Two-character flag sequences make it easy to pick
33006 out these lines. A number of other events are recorded in the main log. Some of
33007 them are optional, in which case the &%log_selector%& option controls whether
33008 they are included or not. A Perl script called &'eximstats'&, which does simple
33009 analysis of main log files, is provided in the Exim distribution (see section
33010 &<<SECTmailstat>>&).
33012 .cindex "reject log"
33013 The reject log records information from messages that are rejected as a result
33014 of a configuration option (that is, for policy reasons).
33015 The first line of each rejection is a copy of the line that is also written to
33016 the main log. Then, if the message's header has been read at the time the log
33017 is written, its contents are written to this log. Only the original header
33018 lines are available; header lines added by ACLs are not logged. You can use the
33019 reject log to check that your policy controls are working correctly; on a busy
33020 host this may be easier than scanning the main log for rejection messages. You
33021 can suppress the writing of the reject log by setting &%write_rejectlog%&
33024 .cindex "panic log"
33025 .cindex "system log"
33026 When certain serious errors occur, Exim writes entries to its panic log. If the
33027 error is sufficiently disastrous, Exim bombs out afterwards. Panic log entries
33028 are usually written to the main log as well, but can get lost amid the mass of
33029 other entries. The panic log should be empty under normal circumstances. It is
33030 therefore a good idea to check it (or to have a &'cron'& script check it)
33031 regularly, in order to become aware of any problems. When Exim cannot open its
33032 panic log, it tries as a last resort to write to the system log (syslog). This
33033 is opened with LOG_PID+LOG_CONS and the facility code of LOG_MAIL. The
33034 message itself is written at priority LOG_CRIT.
33037 Every log line starts with a timestamp, in the format shown in the following
33038 example. Note that many of the examples shown in this chapter are line-wrapped.
33039 In the log file, this would be all on one line:
33041 2001-09-16 16:09:47 SMTP connection from [127.0.0.1] closed
33044 By default, the timestamps are in the local timezone. There are two
33045 ways of changing this:
33048 You can set the &%timezone%& option to a different time zone; in particular, if
33053 the timestamps will be in UTC (aka GMT).
33055 If you set &%log_timezone%& true, the time zone is added to the timestamp, for
33058 2003-04-25 11:17:07 +0100 Start queue run: pid=12762
33062 .cindex "log" "process ids in"
33063 .cindex "pid (process id)" "in log lines"
33064 Exim does not include its process id in log lines by default, but you can
33065 request that it does so by specifying the &`pid`& log selector (see section
33066 &<<SECTlogselector>>&). When this is set, the process id is output, in square
33067 brackets, immediately after the time and date.
33072 .section "Where the logs are written" "SECTwhelogwri"
33073 .cindex "log" "destination"
33074 .cindex "log" "to file"
33075 .cindex "log" "to syslog"
33077 The logs may be written to local files, or to syslog, or both. However, it
33078 should be noted that many syslog implementations use UDP as a transport, and
33079 are therefore unreliable in the sense that messages are not guaranteed to
33080 arrive at the loghost, nor is the ordering of messages necessarily maintained.
33081 It has also been reported that on large log files (tens of megabytes) you may
33082 need to tweak syslog to prevent it syncing the file with each write &-- on
33083 Linux this has been seen to make syslog take 90% plus of CPU time.
33085 The destination for Exim's logs is configured by setting LOG_FILE_PATH in
33086 &_Local/Makefile_& or by setting &%log_file_path%& in the run time
33087 configuration. This latter string is expanded, so it can contain, for example,
33088 references to the host name:
33090 log_file_path = /var/log/$primary_hostname/exim_%slog
33092 It is generally advisable, however, to set the string in &_Local/Makefile_&
33093 rather than at run time, because then the setting is available right from the
33094 start of Exim's execution. Otherwise, if there's something it wants to log
33095 before it has read the configuration file (for example, an error in the
33096 configuration file) it will not use the path you want, and may not be able to
33099 The value of LOG_FILE_PATH or &%log_file_path%& is a colon-separated
33100 list, currently limited to at most two items. This is one option where the
33101 facility for changing a list separator may not be used. The list must always be
33102 colon-separated. If an item in the list is &"syslog"& then syslog is used;
33103 otherwise the item must either be an absolute path, containing &`%s`& at the
33104 point where &"main"&, &"reject"&, or &"panic"& is to be inserted, or be empty,
33105 implying the use of a default path.
33107 When Exim encounters an empty item in the list, it searches the list defined by
33108 LOG_FILE_PATH, and uses the first item it finds that is neither empty nor
33109 &"syslog"&. This means that an empty item in &%log_file_path%& can be used to
33110 mean &"use the path specified at build time"&. It no such item exists, log
33111 files are written in the &_log_& subdirectory of the spool directory. This is
33112 equivalent to the setting:
33114 log_file_path = $spool_directory/log/%slog
33116 If you do not specify anything at build time or run time, that is where the
33119 A log file path may also contain &`%D`& or &`%M`& if datestamped log file names
33120 are in use &-- see section &<<SECTdatlogfil>>& below.
33122 Here are some examples of possible settings:
33124 &`LOG_FILE_PATH=syslog `& syslog only
33125 &`LOG_FILE_PATH=:syslog `& syslog and default path
33126 &`LOG_FILE_PATH=syslog : /usr/log/exim_%s `& syslog and specified path
33127 &`LOG_FILE_PATH=/usr/log/exim_%s `& specified path only
33129 If there are more than two paths in the list, the first is used and a panic
33134 .section "Logging to local files that are periodically &""cycled""&" "SECID285"
33135 .cindex "log" "cycling local files"
33136 .cindex "cycling logs"
33137 .cindex "&'exicyclog'&"
33138 .cindex "log" "local files; writing to"
33139 Some operating systems provide centralized and standardized methods for cycling
33140 log files. For those that do not, a utility script called &'exicyclog'& is
33141 provided (see section &<<SECTcyclogfil>>&). This renames and compresses the
33142 main and reject logs each time it is called. The maximum number of old logs to
33143 keep can be set. It is suggested this script is run as a daily &'cron'& job.
33145 An Exim delivery process opens the main log when it first needs to write to it,
33146 and it keeps the file open in case subsequent entries are required &-- for
33147 example, if a number of different deliveries are being done for the same
33148 message. However, remote SMTP deliveries can take a long time, and this means
33149 that the file may be kept open long after it is renamed if &'exicyclog'& or
33150 something similar is being used to rename log files on a regular basis. To
33151 ensure that a switch of log files is noticed as soon as possible, Exim calls
33152 &[stat()]& on the main log's name before reusing an open file, and if the file
33153 does not exist, or its inode has changed, the old file is closed and Exim
33154 tries to open the main log from scratch. Thus, an old log file may remain open
33155 for quite some time, but no Exim processes should write to it once it has been
33160 .section "Datestamped log files" "SECTdatlogfil"
33161 .cindex "log" "datestamped files"
33162 Instead of cycling the main and reject log files by renaming them
33163 periodically, some sites like to use files whose names contain a datestamp,
33164 for example, &_mainlog-20031225_&. The datestamp is in the form &_yyyymmdd_& or
33165 &_yyyymm_&. Exim has support for this way of working. It is enabled by setting
33166 the &%log_file_path%& option to a path that includes &`%D`& or &`%M`& at the
33167 point where the datestamp is required. For example:
33169 log_file_path = /var/spool/exim/log/%slog-%D
33170 log_file_path = /var/log/exim-%s-%D.log
33171 log_file_path = /var/spool/exim/log/%D-%slog
33172 log_file_path = /var/log/exim/%s.%M
33174 As before, &`%s`& is replaced by &"main"& or &"reject"&; the following are
33175 examples of names generated by the above examples:
33177 /var/spool/exim/log/mainlog-20021225
33178 /var/log/exim-reject-20021225.log
33179 /var/spool/exim/log/20021225-mainlog
33180 /var/log/exim/main.200212
33182 When this form of log file is specified, Exim automatically switches to new
33183 files at midnight. It does not make any attempt to compress old logs; you
33184 will need to write your own script if you require this. You should not
33185 run &'exicyclog'& with this form of logging.
33187 The location of the panic log is also determined by &%log_file_path%&, but it
33188 is not datestamped, because rotation of the panic log does not make sense.
33189 When generating the name of the panic log, &`%D`& or &`%M`& are removed from
33190 the string. In addition, if it immediately follows a slash, a following
33191 non-alphanumeric character is removed; otherwise a preceding non-alphanumeric
33192 character is removed. Thus, the four examples above would give these panic
33195 /var/spool/exim/log/paniclog
33196 /var/log/exim-panic.log
33197 /var/spool/exim/log/paniclog
33198 /var/log/exim/panic
33202 .section "Logging to syslog" "SECID249"
33203 .cindex "log" "syslog; writing to"
33204 The use of syslog does not change what Exim logs or the format of its messages,
33205 except in one respect. If &%syslog_timestamp%& is set false, the timestamps on
33206 Exim's log lines are omitted when these lines are sent to syslog. Apart from
33207 that, the same strings are written to syslog as to log files. The syslog
33208 &"facility"& is set to LOG_MAIL, and the program name to &"exim"&
33209 by default, but you can change these by setting the &%syslog_facility%& and
33210 &%syslog_processname%& options, respectively. If Exim was compiled with
33211 SYSLOG_LOG_PID set in &_Local/Makefile_& (this is the default in
33212 &_src/EDITME_&), then, on systems that permit it (all except ULTRIX), the
33213 LOG_PID flag is set so that the &[syslog()]& call adds the pid as well as
33214 the time and host name to each line.
33215 The three log streams are mapped onto syslog priorities as follows:
33218 &'mainlog'& is mapped to LOG_INFO
33220 &'rejectlog'& is mapped to LOG_NOTICE
33222 &'paniclog'& is mapped to LOG_ALERT
33225 Many log lines are written to both &'mainlog'& and &'rejectlog'&, and some are
33226 written to both &'mainlog'& and &'paniclog'&, so there will be duplicates if
33227 these are routed by syslog to the same place. You can suppress this duplication
33228 by setting &%syslog_duplication%& false.
33230 Exim's log lines can sometimes be very long, and some of its &'rejectlog'&
33231 entries contain multiple lines when headers are included. To cope with both
33232 these cases, entries written to syslog are split into separate &[syslog()]&
33233 calls at each internal newline, and also after a maximum of
33234 870 data characters. (This allows for a total syslog line length of 1024, when
33235 additions such as timestamps are added.) If you are running a syslog
33236 replacement that can handle lines longer than the 1024 characters allowed by
33237 RFC 3164, you should set
33239 SYSLOG_LONG_LINES=yes
33241 in &_Local/Makefile_& before building Exim. That stops Exim from splitting long
33242 lines, but it still splits at internal newlines in &'reject'& log entries.
33244 To make it easy to re-assemble split lines later, each component of a split
33245 entry starts with a string of the form [<&'n'&>/<&'m'&>] or [<&'n'&>\<&'m'&>]
33246 where <&'n'&> is the component number and <&'m'&> is the total number of
33247 components in the entry. The / delimiter is used when the line was split
33248 because it was too long; if it was split because of an internal newline, the \
33249 delimiter is used. For example, supposing the length limit to be 50 instead of
33250 870, the following would be the result of a typical rejection message to
33251 &'mainlog'& (LOG_INFO), each line in addition being preceded by the time, host
33252 name, and pid as added by syslog:
33254 [1/5] 2002-09-16 16:09:43 16RdAL-0006pc-00 rejected from
33255 [2/5] [127.0.0.1] (ph10): syntax error in 'From' header
33256 [3/5] when scanning for sender: missing or malformed lo
33257 [4/5] cal part in "<>" (envelope sender is <ph10@cam.exa
33260 The same error might cause the following lines to be written to &"rejectlog"&
33263 [1/18] 2002-09-16 16:09:43 16RdAL-0006pc-00 rejected fro
33264 [2/18] m [127.0.0.1] (ph10): syntax error in 'From' head
33265 [3/18] er when scanning for sender: missing or malformed
33266 [4/18] local part in "<>" (envelope sender is <ph10@cam
33268 [6\18] Recipients: ph10@some.domain.cam.example
33269 [7\18] P Received: from [127.0.0.1] (ident=ph10)
33270 [8\18] by xxxxx.cam.example with smtp (Exim 4.00)
33271 [9\18] id 16RdAL-0006pc-00
33272 [10/18] for ph10@cam.example; Mon, 16 Sep 2002 16:
33273 [11\18] 09:43 +0100
33275 [13\18] Subject: this is a test header
33276 [18\18] X-something: this is another header
33277 [15/18] I Message-Id: <E16RdAL-0006pc-00@xxxxx.cam.examp
33280 [18/18] Date: Mon, 16 Sep 2002 16:09:43 +0100
33282 Log lines that are neither too long nor contain newlines are written to syslog
33283 without modification.
33285 If only syslog is being used, the Exim monitor is unable to provide a log tail
33286 display, unless syslog is routing &'mainlog'& to a file on the local host and
33287 the environment variable EXIMON_LOG_FILE_PATH is set to tell the monitor
33292 .section "Log line flags" "SECID250"
33293 One line is written to the main log for each message received, and for each
33294 successful, unsuccessful, and delayed delivery. These lines can readily be
33295 picked out by the distinctive two-character flags that immediately follow the
33296 timestamp. The flags are:
33298 &`<=`& message arrival
33299 &`=>`& normal message delivery
33300 &`->`& additional address in same delivery
33301 &`*>`& delivery suppressed by &%-N%&
33302 &`**`& delivery failed; address bounced
33303 &`==`& delivery deferred; temporary problem
33307 .section "Logging message reception" "SECID251"
33308 .cindex "log" "reception line"
33309 The format of the single-line entry in the main log that is written for every
33310 message received is shown in the basic example below, which is split over
33311 several lines in order to fit it on the page:
33313 2002-10-31 08:57:53 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 <= kryten@dwarf.fict.example
33314 H=mailer.fict.example [192.168.123.123] U=exim
33315 P=smtp S=5678 id=<incoming message id>
33317 The address immediately following &"<="& is the envelope sender address. A
33318 bounce message is shown with the sender address &"<>"&, and if it is locally
33319 generated, this is followed by an item of the form
33323 which is a reference to the message that caused the bounce to be sent.
33327 For messages from other hosts, the H and U fields identify the remote host and
33328 record the RFC 1413 identity of the user that sent the message, if one was
33329 received. The number given in square brackets is the IP address of the sending
33330 host. If there is a single, unparenthesized host name in the H field, as
33331 above, it has been verified to correspond to the IP address (see the
33332 &%host_lookup%& option). If the name is in parentheses, it was the name quoted
33333 by the remote host in the SMTP HELO or EHLO command, and has not been
33334 verified. If verification yields a different name to that given for HELO or
33335 EHLO, the verified name appears first, followed by the HELO or EHLO
33336 name in parentheses.
33338 Misconfigured hosts (and mail forgers) sometimes put an IP address, with or
33339 without brackets, in the HELO or EHLO command, leading to entries in
33340 the log containing text like these examples:
33342 H=(10.21.32.43) [192.168.8.34]
33343 H=([10.21.32.43]) [192.168.8.34]
33345 This can be confusing. Only the final address in square brackets can be relied
33348 For locally generated messages (that is, messages not received over TCP/IP),
33349 the H field is omitted, and the U field contains the login name of the caller
33352 .cindex "authentication" "logging"
33353 .cindex "AUTH" "logging"
33354 For all messages, the P field specifies the protocol used to receive the
33355 message. This is the value that is stored in &$received_protocol$&. In the case
33356 of incoming SMTP messages, the value indicates whether or not any SMTP
33357 extensions (ESMTP), encryption, or authentication were used. If the SMTP
33358 session was encrypted, there is an additional X field that records the cipher
33359 suite that was used.
33361 The protocol is set to &"esmtpsa"& or &"esmtpa"& for messages received from
33362 hosts that have authenticated themselves using the SMTP AUTH command. The first
33363 value is used when the SMTP connection was encrypted (&"secure"&). In this case
33364 there is an additional item A= followed by the name of the authenticator that
33365 was used. If an authenticated identification was set up by the authenticator's
33366 &%server_set_id%& option, this is logged too, separated by a colon from the
33367 authenticator name.
33369 .cindex "size" "of message"
33370 The id field records the existing message id, if present. The size of the
33371 received message is given by the S field. When the message is delivered,
33372 headers may be removed or added, so that the size of delivered copies of the
33373 message may not correspond with this value (and indeed may be different to each
33376 The &%log_selector%& option can be used to request the logging of additional
33377 data when a message is received. See section &<<SECTlogselector>>& below.
33381 .section "Logging deliveries" "SECID252"
33382 .cindex "log" "delivery line"
33383 The format of the single-line entry in the main log that is written for every
33384 delivery is shown in one of the examples below, for local and remote
33385 deliveries, respectively. Each example has been split into two lines in order
33386 to fit it on the page:
33388 2002-10-31 08:59:13 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 => marv
33389 <marv@hitch.fict.example> R=localuser T=local_delivery
33390 2002-10-31 09:00:10 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 =>
33391 monk@holistic.fict.example R=dnslookup T=remote_smtp
33392 H=holistic.fict.example [192.168.234.234]
33394 For ordinary local deliveries, the original address is given in angle brackets
33395 after the final delivery address, which might be a pipe or a file. If
33396 intermediate address(es) exist between the original and the final address, the
33397 last of these is given in parentheses after the final address. The R and T
33398 fields record the router and transport that were used to process the address.
33400 If a shadow transport was run after a successful local delivery, the log line
33401 for the successful delivery has an item added on the end, of the form
33403 &`ST=<`&&'shadow transport name'&&`>`&
33405 If the shadow transport did not succeed, the error message is put in
33406 parentheses afterwards.
33408 .cindex "asterisk" "after IP address"
33409 When more than one address is included in a single delivery (for example, two
33410 SMTP RCPT commands in one transaction) the second and subsequent addresses are
33411 flagged with &`->`& instead of &`=>`&. When two or more messages are delivered
33412 down a single SMTP connection, an asterisk follows the IP address in the log
33413 lines for the second and subsequent messages.
33415 The generation of a reply message by a filter file gets logged as a
33416 &"delivery"& to the addressee, preceded by &">"&.
33418 The &%log_selector%& option can be used to request the logging of additional
33419 data when a message is delivered. See section &<<SECTlogselector>>& below.
33422 .section "Discarded deliveries" "SECID253"
33423 .cindex "discarded messages"
33424 .cindex "message" "discarded"
33425 .cindex "delivery" "discarded; logging"
33426 When a message is discarded as a result of the command &"seen finish"& being
33427 obeyed in a filter file which generates no deliveries, a log entry of the form
33429 2002-12-10 00:50:49 16auJc-0001UB-00 => discarded
33430 <low.club@bridge.example> R=userforward
33432 is written, to record why no deliveries are logged. When a message is discarded
33433 because it is aliased to &":blackhole:"& the log line is like this:
33435 1999-03-02 09:44:33 10HmaX-0005vi-00 => :blackhole:
33436 <hole@nowhere.example> R=blackhole_router
33440 .section "Deferred deliveries" "SECID254"
33441 When a delivery is deferred, a line of the following form is logged:
33443 2002-12-19 16:20:23 16aiQz-0002Q5-00 == marvin@endrest.example
33444 R=dnslookup T=smtp defer (146): Connection refused
33446 In the case of remote deliveries, the error is the one that was given for the
33447 last IP address that was tried. Details of individual SMTP failures are also
33448 written to the log, so the above line would be preceded by something like
33450 2002-12-19 16:20:23 16aiQz-0002Q5-00 Failed to connect to
33451 mail1.endrest.example [192.168.239.239]: Connection refused
33453 When a deferred address is skipped because its retry time has not been reached,
33454 a message is written to the log, but this can be suppressed by setting an
33455 appropriate value in &%log_selector%&.
33459 .section "Delivery failures" "SECID255"
33460 .cindex "delivery" "failure; logging"
33461 If a delivery fails because an address cannot be routed, a line of the
33462 following form is logged:
33464 1995-12-19 16:20:23 0tRiQz-0002Q5-00 ** jim@trek99.example
33465 <jim@trek99.example>: unknown mail domain
33467 If a delivery fails at transport time, the router and transport are shown, and
33468 the response from the remote host is included, as in this example:
33470 2002-07-11 07:14:17 17SXDU-000189-00 ** ace400@pb.example
33471 R=dnslookup T=remote_smtp: SMTP error from remote mailer
33472 after pipelined RCPT TO:<ace400@pb.example>: host
33473 pbmail3.py.example [192.168.63.111]: 553 5.3.0
33474 <ace400@pb.example>...Addressee unknown
33476 The word &"pipelined"& indicates that the SMTP PIPELINING extension was being
33477 used. See &%hosts_avoid_esmtp%& in the &(smtp)& transport for a way of
33478 disabling PIPELINING. The log lines for all forms of delivery failure are
33479 flagged with &`**`&.
33483 .section "Fake deliveries" "SECID256"
33484 .cindex "delivery" "fake; logging"
33485 If a delivery does not actually take place because the &%-N%& option has been
33486 used to suppress it, a normal delivery line is written to the log, except that
33487 &"=>"& is replaced by &"*>"&.
33491 .section "Completion" "SECID257"
33494 2002-10-31 09:00:11 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 Completed
33496 is written to the main log when a message is about to be removed from the spool
33497 at the end of its processing.
33502 .section "Summary of Fields in Log Lines" "SECID258"
33503 .cindex "log" "summary of fields"
33504 A summary of the field identifiers that are used in log lines is shown in
33505 the following table:
33507 &`A `& authenticator name (and optional id)
33508 &`C `& SMTP confirmation on delivery
33509 &` `& command list for &"no mail in SMTP session"&
33510 &`CV `& certificate verification status
33511 &`D `& duration of &"no mail in SMTP session"&
33512 &`DN `& distinguished name from peer certificate
33513 &`DT `& on &`=>`& lines: time taken for a delivery
33514 &`F `& sender address (on delivery lines)
33515 &`H `& host name and IP address
33516 &`I `& local interface used
33517 &`id `& message id for incoming message
33518 &`P `& on &`<=`& lines: protocol used
33519 &` `& on &`=>`& and &`**`& lines: return path
33520 &`QT `& on &`=>`& lines: time spent on queue so far
33521 &` `& on &"Completed"& lines: time spent on queue
33522 &`R `& on &`<=`& lines: reference for local bounce
33523 &` `& on &`=>`& &`**`& and &`==`& lines: router name
33524 &`S `& size of message
33525 &`ST `& shadow transport name
33526 &`T `& on &`<=`& lines: message subject (topic)
33527 &` `& on &`=>`& &`**`& and &`==`& lines: transport name
33528 &`U `& local user or RFC 1413 identity
33529 &`X `& TLS cipher suite
33533 .section "Other log entries" "SECID259"
33534 Various other types of log entry are written from time to time. Most should be
33535 self-explanatory. Among the more common are:
33538 .cindex "retry" "time not reached"
33539 &'retry time not reached'&&~&~An address previously suffered a temporary error
33540 during routing or local delivery, and the time to retry has not yet arrived.
33541 This message is not written to an individual message log file unless it happens
33542 during the first delivery attempt.
33544 &'retry time not reached for any host'&&~&~An address previously suffered
33545 temporary errors during remote delivery, and the retry time has not yet arrived
33546 for any of the hosts to which it is routed.
33548 .cindex "spool directory" "file locked"
33549 &'spool file locked'&&~&~An attempt to deliver a message cannot proceed because
33550 some other Exim process is already working on the message. This can be quite
33551 common if queue running processes are started at frequent intervals. The
33552 &'exiwhat'& utility script can be used to find out what Exim processes are
33555 .cindex "error" "ignored"
33556 &'error ignored'&&~&~There are several circumstances that give rise to this
33559 Exim failed to deliver a bounce message whose age was greater than
33560 &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&. The bounce was discarded.
33562 A filter file set up a delivery using the &"noerror"& option, and the delivery
33563 failed. The delivery was discarded.
33565 A delivery set up by a router configured with
33566 . ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
33567 . ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left.
33571 failed. The delivery was discarded.
33579 .section "Reducing or increasing what is logged" "SECTlogselector"
33580 .cindex "log" "selectors"
33581 By setting the &%log_selector%& global option, you can disable some of Exim's
33582 default logging, or you can request additional logging. The value of
33583 &%log_selector%& is made up of names preceded by plus or minus characters. For
33586 log_selector = +arguments -retry_defer
33588 The list of optional log items is in the following table, with the default
33589 selection marked by asterisks:
33591 &`*acl_warn_skipped `& skipped &%warn%& statement in ACL
33592 &` address_rewrite `& address rewriting
33593 &` all_parents `& all parents in => lines
33594 &` arguments `& command line arguments
33595 &`*connection_reject `& connection rejections
33596 &`*delay_delivery `& immediate delivery delayed
33597 &` deliver_time `& time taken to perform delivery
33598 &` delivery_size `& add &`S=`&&'nnn'& to => lines
33599 &`*dnslist_defer `& defers of DNS list (aka RBL) lookups
33600 &`*etrn `& ETRN commands
33601 &`*host_lookup_failed `& as it says
33602 &` ident_timeout `& timeout for ident connection
33603 &` incoming_interface `& incoming interface on <= lines
33604 &` incoming_port `& incoming port on <= lines
33605 &`*lost_incoming_connection `& as it says (includes timeouts)
33606 &` outgoing_port `& add remote port to => lines
33607 &`*queue_run `& start and end queue runs
33608 &` queue_time `& time on queue for one recipient
33609 &` queue_time_overall `& time on queue for whole message
33610 &` pid `& Exim process id
33611 &` received_recipients `& recipients on <= lines
33612 &` received_sender `& sender on <= lines
33613 &`*rejected_header `& header contents on reject log
33614 &`*retry_defer `& &"retry time not reached"&
33615 &` return_path_on_delivery `& put return path on => and ** lines
33616 &` sender_on_delivery `& add sender to => lines
33617 &`*sender_verify_fail `& sender verification failures
33618 &`*size_reject `& rejection because too big
33619 &`*skip_delivery `& delivery skipped in a queue run
33620 &` smtp_confirmation `& SMTP confirmation on => lines
33621 &` smtp_connection `& SMTP connections
33622 &` smtp_incomplete_transaction`& incomplete SMTP transactions
33623 &` smtp_no_mail `& session with no MAIL commands
33624 &` smtp_protocol_error `& SMTP protocol errors
33625 &` smtp_syntax_error `& SMTP syntax errors
33626 &` subject `& contents of &'Subject:'& on <= lines
33627 &` tls_certificate_verified `& certificate verification status
33628 &`*tls_cipher `& TLS cipher suite on <= and => lines
33629 &` tls_peerdn `& TLS peer DN on <= and => lines
33630 &` tls_sni `& TLS SNI on <= lines
33631 &` unknown_in_list `& DNS lookup failed in list match
33633 &` all `& all of the above
33635 More details on each of these items follows:
33638 .cindex "&%warn%& ACL verb" "log when skipping"
33639 &%acl_warn_skipped%&: When an ACL &%warn%& statement is skipped because one of
33640 its conditions cannot be evaluated, a log line to this effect is written if
33641 this log selector is set.
33643 .cindex "log" "rewriting"
33644 .cindex "rewriting" "logging"
33645 &%address_rewrite%&: This applies both to global rewrites and per-transport
33646 rewrites, but not to rewrites in filters run as an unprivileged user (because
33647 such users cannot access the log).
33649 .cindex "log" "full parentage"
33650 &%all_parents%&: Normally only the original and final addresses are logged on
33651 delivery lines; with this selector, intermediate parents are given in
33652 parentheses between them.
33654 .cindex "log" "Exim arguments"
33655 .cindex "Exim arguments, logging"
33656 &%arguments%&: This causes Exim to write the arguments with which it was called
33657 to the main log, preceded by the current working directory. This is a debugging
33658 feature, added to make it easier to find out how certain MUAs call
33659 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&. The logging does not happen if Exim has given up root
33660 privilege because it was called with the &%-C%& or &%-D%& options. Arguments
33661 that are empty or that contain white space are quoted. Non-printing characters
33662 are shown as escape sequences. This facility cannot log unrecognized arguments,
33663 because the arguments are checked before the configuration file is read. The
33664 only way to log such cases is to interpose a script such as &_util/logargs.sh_&
33665 between the caller and Exim.
33667 .cindex "log" "connection rejections"
33668 &%connection_reject%&: A log entry is written whenever an incoming SMTP
33669 connection is rejected, for whatever reason.
33671 .cindex "log" "delayed delivery"
33672 .cindex "delayed delivery, logging"
33673 &%delay_delivery%&: A log entry is written whenever a delivery process is not
33674 started for an incoming message because the load is too high or too many
33675 messages were received on one connection. Logging does not occur if no delivery
33676 process is started because &%queue_only%& is set or &%-odq%& was used.
33678 .cindex "log" "delivery duration"
33679 &%deliver_time%&: For each delivery, the amount of real time it has taken to
33680 perform the actual delivery is logged as DT=<&'time'&>, for example, &`DT=1s`&.
33682 .cindex "log" "message size on delivery"
33683 .cindex "size" "of message"
33684 &%delivery_size%&: For each delivery, the size of message delivered is added to
33685 the &"=>"& line, tagged with S=.
33687 .cindex "log" "dnslist defer"
33688 .cindex "DNS list" "logging defer"
33689 .cindex "black list (DNS)"
33690 &%dnslist_defer%&: A log entry is written if an attempt to look up a host in a
33691 DNS black list suffers a temporary error.
33693 .cindex "log" "ETRN commands"
33694 .cindex "ETRN" "logging"
33695 &%etrn%&: Every valid ETRN command that is received is logged, before the ACL
33696 is run to determine whether or not it is actually accepted. An invalid ETRN
33697 command, or one received within a message transaction is not logged by this
33698 selector (see &%smtp_syntax_error%& and &%smtp_protocol_error%&).
33700 .cindex "log" "host lookup failure"
33701 &%host_lookup_failed%&: When a lookup of a host's IP addresses fails to find
33702 any addresses, or when a lookup of an IP address fails to find a host name, a
33703 log line is written. This logging does not apply to direct DNS lookups when
33704 routing email addresses, but it does apply to &"byname"& lookups.
33706 .cindex "log" "ident timeout"
33707 .cindex "RFC 1413" "logging timeout"
33708 &%ident_timeout%&: A log line is written whenever an attempt to connect to a
33709 client's ident port times out.
33711 .cindex "log" "incoming interface"
33712 .cindex "interface" "logging"
33713 &%incoming_interface%&: The interface on which a message was received is added
33714 to the &"<="& line as an IP address in square brackets, tagged by I= and
33715 followed by a colon and the port number. The local interface and port are also
33716 added to other SMTP log lines, for example &"SMTP connection from"&, and to
33719 .cindex "log" "incoming remote port"
33720 .cindex "port" "logging remote"
33721 .cindex "TCP/IP" "logging incoming remote port"
33722 .vindex "&$sender_fullhost$&"
33723 .vindex "&$sender_rcvhost$&"
33724 &%incoming_port%&: The remote port number from which a message was received is
33725 added to log entries and &'Received:'& header lines, following the IP address
33726 in square brackets, and separated from it by a colon. This is implemented by
33727 changing the value that is put in the &$sender_fullhost$& and
33728 &$sender_rcvhost$& variables. Recording the remote port number has become more
33729 important with the widening use of NAT (see RFC 2505).
33731 .cindex "log" "dropped connection"
33732 &%lost_incoming_connection%&: A log line is written when an incoming SMTP
33733 connection is unexpectedly dropped.
33735 .cindex "log" "outgoing remote port"
33736 .cindex "port" "logging outgoint remote"
33737 .cindex "TCP/IP" "logging ougtoing remote port"
33738 &%outgoing_port%&: The remote port number is added to delivery log lines (those
33739 containing => tags) following the IP address. This option is not included in
33740 the default setting, because for most ordinary configurations, the remote port
33741 number is always 25 (the SMTP port).
33743 .cindex "log" "process ids in"
33744 .cindex "pid (process id)" "in log lines"
33745 &%pid%&: The current process id is added to every log line, in square brackets,
33746 immediately after the time and date.
33748 .cindex "log" "queue run"
33749 .cindex "queue runner" "logging"
33750 &%queue_run%&: The start and end of every queue run are logged.
33752 .cindex "log" "queue time"
33753 &%queue_time%&: The amount of time the message has been in the queue on the
33754 local host is logged as QT=<&'time'&> on delivery (&`=>`&) lines, for example,
33755 &`QT=3m45s`&. The clock starts when Exim starts to receive the message, so it
33756 includes reception time as well as the delivery time for the current address.
33757 This means that it may be longer than the difference between the arrival and
33758 delivery log line times, because the arrival log line is not written until the
33759 message has been successfully received.
33761 &%queue_time_overall%&: The amount of time the message has been in the queue on
33762 the local host is logged as QT=<&'time'&> on &"Completed"& lines, for
33763 example, &`QT=3m45s`&. The clock starts when Exim starts to receive the
33764 message, so it includes reception time as well as the total delivery time.
33766 .cindex "log" "recipients"
33767 &%received_recipients%&: The recipients of a message are listed in the main log
33768 as soon as the message is received. The list appears at the end of the log line
33769 that is written when a message is received, preceded by the word &"for"&. The
33770 addresses are listed after they have been qualified, but before any rewriting
33772 Recipients that were discarded by an ACL for MAIL or RCPT do not appear
33775 .cindex "log" "sender reception"
33776 &%received_sender%&: The unrewritten original sender of a message is added to
33777 the end of the log line that records the message's arrival, after the word
33778 &"from"& (before the recipients if &%received_recipients%& is also set).
33780 .cindex "log" "header lines for rejection"
33781 &%rejected_header%&: If a message's header has been received at the time a
33782 rejection is written to the reject log, the complete header is added to the
33783 log. Header logging can be turned off individually for messages that are
33784 rejected by the &[local_scan()]& function (see section &<<SECTapiforloc>>&).
33786 .cindex "log" "retry defer"
33787 &%retry_defer%&: A log line is written if a delivery is deferred because a
33788 retry time has not yet been reached. However, this &"retry time not reached"&
33789 message is always omitted from individual message logs after the first delivery
33792 .cindex "log" "return path"
33793 &%return_path_on_delivery%&: The return path that is being transmitted with
33794 the message is included in delivery and bounce lines, using the tag P=.
33795 This is omitted if no delivery actually happens, for example, if routing fails,
33796 or if delivery is to &_/dev/null_& or to &`:blackhole:`&.
33798 .cindex "log" "sender on delivery"
33799 &%sender_on_delivery%&: The message's sender address is added to every delivery
33800 and bounce line, tagged by F= (for &"from"&).
33801 This is the original sender that was received with the message; it is not
33802 necessarily the same as the outgoing return path.
33804 .cindex "log" "sender verify failure"
33805 &%sender_verify_fail%&: If this selector is unset, the separate log line that
33806 gives details of a sender verification failure is not written. Log lines for
33807 the rejection of SMTP commands contain just &"sender verify failed"&, so some
33810 .cindex "log" "size rejection"
33811 &%size_reject%&: A log line is written whenever a message is rejected because
33814 .cindex "log" "frozen messages; skipped"
33815 .cindex "frozen messages" "logging skipping"
33816 &%skip_delivery%&: A log line is written whenever a message is skipped during a
33817 queue run because it is frozen or because another process is already delivering
33819 .cindex "&""spool file is locked""&"
33820 The message that is written is &"spool file is locked"&.
33822 .cindex "log" "smtp confirmation"
33823 .cindex "SMTP" "logging confirmation"
33824 &%smtp_confirmation%&: The response to the final &"."& in the SMTP dialogue for
33825 outgoing messages is added to delivery log lines in the form &`C=`&<&'text'&>.
33826 A number of MTAs (including Exim) return an identifying string in this
33829 .cindex "log" "SMTP connections"
33830 .cindex "SMTP" "logging connections"
33831 &%smtp_connection%&: A log line is written whenever an SMTP connection is
33832 established or closed, unless the connection is from a host that matches
33833 &%hosts_connection_nolog%&. (In contrast, &%lost_incoming_connection%& applies
33834 only when the closure is unexpected.) This applies to connections from local
33835 processes that use &%-bs%& as well as to TCP/IP connections. If a connection is
33836 dropped in the middle of a message, a log line is always written, whether or
33837 not this selector is set, but otherwise nothing is written at the start and end
33838 of connections unless this selector is enabled.
33840 For TCP/IP connections to an Exim daemon, the current number of connections is
33841 included in the log message for each new connection, but note that the count is
33842 reset if the daemon is restarted.
33843 Also, because connections are closed (and the closure is logged) in
33844 subprocesses, the count may not include connections that have been closed but
33845 whose termination the daemon has not yet noticed. Thus, while it is possible to
33846 match up the opening and closing of connections in the log, the value of the
33847 logged counts may not be entirely accurate.
33849 .cindex "log" "SMTP transaction; incomplete"
33850 .cindex "SMTP" "logging incomplete transactions"
33851 &%smtp_incomplete_transaction%&: When a mail transaction is aborted by
33852 RSET, QUIT, loss of connection, or otherwise, the incident is logged,
33853 and the message sender plus any accepted recipients are included in the log
33854 line. This can provide evidence of dictionary attacks.
33856 .cindex "log" "non-MAIL SMTP sessions"
33857 .cindex "MAIL" "logging session without"
33858 &%smtp_no_mail%&: A line is written to the main log whenever an accepted SMTP
33859 connection terminates without having issued a MAIL command. This includes both
33860 the case when the connection is dropped, and the case when QUIT is used. It
33861 does not include cases where the connection is rejected right at the start (by
33862 an ACL, or because there are too many connections, or whatever). These cases
33863 already have their own log lines.
33865 The log line that is written contains the identity of the client in the usual
33866 way, followed by D= and a time, which records the duration of the connection.
33867 If the connection was authenticated, this fact is logged exactly as it is for
33868 an incoming message, with an A= item. If the connection was encrypted, CV=,
33869 DN=, and X= items may appear as they do for an incoming message, controlled by
33870 the same logging options.
33872 Finally, if any SMTP commands were issued during the connection, a C= item
33873 is added to the line, listing the commands that were used. For example,
33877 shows that the client issued QUIT straight after EHLO. If there were fewer
33878 than 20 commands, they are all listed. If there were more than 20 commands,
33879 the last 20 are listed, preceded by &"..."&. However, with the default
33880 setting of 10 for &%smtp_accep_max_nonmail%&, the connection will in any case
33881 have been aborted before 20 non-mail commands are processed.
33883 .cindex "log" "SMTP protocol error"
33884 .cindex "SMTP" "logging protocol error"
33885 &%smtp_protocol_error%&: A log line is written for every SMTP protocol error
33886 encountered. Exim does not have perfect detection of all protocol errors
33887 because of transmission delays and the use of pipelining. If PIPELINING has
33888 been advertised to a client, an Exim server assumes that the client will use
33889 it, and therefore it does not count &"expected"& errors (for example, RCPT
33890 received after rejecting MAIL) as protocol errors.
33892 .cindex "SMTP" "logging syntax errors"
33893 .cindex "SMTP" "syntax errors; logging"
33894 .cindex "SMTP" "unknown command; logging"
33895 .cindex "log" "unknown SMTP command"
33896 .cindex "log" "SMTP syntax error"
33897 &%smtp_syntax_error%&: A log line is written for every SMTP syntax error
33898 encountered. An unrecognized command is treated as a syntax error. For an
33899 external connection, the host identity is given; for an internal connection
33900 using &%-bs%& the sender identification (normally the calling user) is given.
33902 .cindex "log" "subject"
33903 .cindex "subject, logging"
33904 &%subject%&: The subject of the message is added to the arrival log line,
33905 preceded by &"T="& (T for &"topic"&, since S is already used for &"size"&).
33906 Any MIME &"words"& in the subject are decoded. The &%print_topbitchars%& option
33907 specifies whether characters with values greater than 127 should be logged
33908 unchanged, or whether they should be rendered as escape sequences.
33910 .cindex "log" "certificate verification"
33911 &%tls_certificate_verified%&: An extra item is added to <= and => log lines
33912 when TLS is in use. The item is &`CV=yes`& if the peer's certificate was
33913 verified, and &`CV=no`& if not.
33915 .cindex "log" "TLS cipher"
33916 .cindex "TLS" "logging cipher"
33917 &%tls_cipher%&: When a message is sent or received over an encrypted
33918 connection, the cipher suite used is added to the log line, preceded by X=.
33920 .cindex "log" "TLS peer DN"
33921 .cindex "TLS" "logging peer DN"
33922 &%tls_peerdn%&: When a message is sent or received over an encrypted
33923 connection, and a certificate is supplied by the remote host, the peer DN is
33924 added to the log line, preceded by DN=.
33926 .cindex "log" "TLS SNI"
33927 .cindex "TLS" "logging SNI"
33928 &%tls_sni%&: When a message is received over an encrypted connection, and
33929 the remote host provided the Server Name Indication extension, the SNI is
33930 added to the log line, preceded by SNI=.
33932 .cindex "log" "DNS failure in list"
33933 &%unknown_in_list%&: This setting causes a log entry to be written when the
33934 result of a list match is failure because a DNS lookup failed.
33938 .section "Message log" "SECID260"
33939 .cindex "message" "log file for"
33940 .cindex "log" "message log; description of"
33941 .cindex "&_msglog_& directory"
33942 .oindex "&%preserve_message_logs%&"
33943 In addition to the general log files, Exim writes a log file for each message
33944 that it handles. The names of these per-message logs are the message ids, and
33945 they are kept in the &_msglog_& sub-directory of the spool directory. Each
33946 message log contains copies of the log lines that apply to the message. This
33947 makes it easier to inspect the status of an individual message without having
33948 to search the main log. A message log is deleted when processing of the message
33949 is complete, unless &%preserve_message_logs%& is set, but this should be used
33950 only with great care because they can fill up your disk very quickly.
33952 On a heavily loaded system, it may be desirable to disable the use of
33953 per-message logs, in order to reduce disk I/O. This can be done by setting the
33954 &%message_logs%& option false.
33960 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
33961 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
33963 .chapter "Exim utilities" "CHAPutils"
33964 .scindex IIDutils "utilities"
33965 A number of utility scripts and programs are supplied with Exim and are
33966 described in this chapter. There is also the Exim Monitor, which is covered in
33967 the next chapter. The utilities described here are:
33969 .itable none 0 0 3 7* left 15* left 40* left
33970 .irow &<<SECTfinoutwha>>& &'exiwhat'& &&&
33971 "list what Exim processes are doing"
33972 .irow &<<SECTgreptheque>>& &'exiqgrep'& "grep the queue"
33973 .irow &<<SECTsumtheque>>& &'exiqsumm'& "summarize the queue"
33974 .irow &<<SECTextspeinf>>& &'exigrep'& "search the main log"
33975 .irow &<<SECTexipick>>& &'exipick'& "select messages on &&&
33977 .irow &<<SECTcyclogfil>>& &'exicyclog'& "cycle (rotate) log files"
33978 .irow &<<SECTmailstat>>& &'eximstats'& &&&
33979 "extract statistics from the log"
33980 .irow &<<SECTcheckaccess>>& &'exim_checkaccess'& &&&
33981 "check address acceptance from given IP"
33982 .irow &<<SECTdbmbuild>>& &'exim_dbmbuild'& "build a DBM file"
33983 .irow &<<SECTfinindret>>& &'exinext'& "extract retry information"
33984 .irow &<<SECThindatmai>>& &'exim_dumpdb'& "dump a hints database"
33985 .irow &<<SECThindatmai>>& &'exim_tidydb'& "clean up a hints database"
33986 .irow &<<SECThindatmai>>& &'exim_fixdb'& "patch a hints database"
33987 .irow &<<SECTmailboxmaint>>& &'exim_lock'& "lock a mailbox file"
33990 Another utility that might be of use to sites with many MTAs is Tom Kistner's
33991 &'exilog'&. It provides log visualizations across multiple Exim servers. See
33992 &url(http://duncanthrax.net/exilog/) for details.
33997 .section "Finding out what Exim processes are doing (exiwhat)" "SECTfinoutwha"
33998 .cindex "&'exiwhat'&"
33999 .cindex "process, querying"
34001 On operating systems that can restart a system call after receiving a signal
34002 (most modern OS), an Exim process responds to the SIGUSR1 signal by writing
34003 a line describing what it is doing to the file &_exim-process.info_& in the
34004 Exim spool directory. The &'exiwhat'& script sends the signal to all Exim
34005 processes it can find, having first emptied the file. It then waits for one
34006 second to allow the Exim processes to react before displaying the results. In
34007 order to run &'exiwhat'& successfully you have to have sufficient privilege to
34008 send the signal to the Exim processes, so it is normally run as root.
34010 &*Warning*&: This is not an efficient process. It is intended for occasional
34011 use by system administrators. It is not sensible, for example, to set up a
34012 script that sends SIGUSR1 signals to Exim processes at short intervals.
34015 Unfortunately, the &'ps'& command that &'exiwhat'& uses to find Exim processes
34016 varies in different operating systems. Not only are different options used,
34017 but the format of the output is different. For this reason, there are some
34018 system configuration options that configure exactly how &'exiwhat'& works. If
34019 it doesn't seem to be working for you, check the following compile-time
34022 &`EXIWHAT_PS_CMD `& the command for running &'ps'&
34023 &`EXIWHAT_PS_ARG `& the argument for &'ps'&
34024 &`EXIWHAT_EGREP_ARG `& the argument for &'egrep'& to select from &'ps'& output
34025 &`EXIWHAT_KILL_ARG `& the argument for the &'kill'& command
34027 An example of typical output from &'exiwhat'& is
34029 164 daemon: -q1h, listening on port 25
34030 10483 running queue: waiting for 0tAycK-0002ij-00 (10492)
34031 10492 delivering 0tAycK-0002ij-00 to mail.ref.example
34032 [10.19.42.42] (editor@ref.example)
34033 10592 handling incoming call from [192.168.243.242]
34034 10628 accepting a local non-SMTP message
34036 The first number in the output line is the process number. The third line has
34037 been split here, in order to fit it on the page.
34041 .section "Selective queue listing (exiqgrep)" "SECTgreptheque"
34042 .cindex "&'exiqgrep'&"
34043 .cindex "queue" "grepping"
34044 This utility is a Perl script contributed by Matt Hubbard. It runs
34048 to obtain a queue listing with undelivered recipients only, and then greps the
34049 output to select messages that match given criteria. The following selection
34050 options are available:
34053 .vitem &*-f*&&~<&'regex'&>
34054 Match the sender address. The field that is tested is enclosed in angle
34055 brackets, so you can test for bounce messages with
34059 .vitem &*-r*&&~<&'regex'&>
34060 Match a recipient address. The field that is tested is not enclosed in angle
34063 .vitem &*-s*&&~<&'regex'&>
34064 Match against the size field.
34066 .vitem &*-y*&&~<&'seconds'&>
34067 Match messages that are younger than the given time.
34069 .vitem &*-o*&&~<&'seconds'&>
34070 Match messages that are older than the given time.
34073 Match only frozen messages.
34076 Match only non-frozen messages.
34079 The following options control the format of the output:
34083 Display only the count of matching messages.
34086 Long format &-- display the full message information as output by Exim. This is
34090 Display message ids only.
34093 Brief format &-- one line per message.
34096 Display messages in reverse order.
34099 There is one more option, &%-h%&, which outputs a list of options.
34103 .section "Summarizing the queue (exiqsumm)" "SECTsumtheque"
34104 .cindex "&'exiqsumm'&"
34105 .cindex "queue" "summary"
34106 The &'exiqsumm'& utility is a Perl script which reads the output of &`exim
34107 -bp`& and produces a summary of the messages on the queue. Thus, you use it by
34108 running a command such as
34110 exim -bp | exiqsumm
34112 The output consists of one line for each domain that has messages waiting for
34113 it, as in the following example:
34115 3 2322 74m 66m msn.com.example
34117 Each line lists the number of pending deliveries for a domain, their total
34118 volume, and the length of time that the oldest and the newest messages have
34119 been waiting. Note that the number of pending deliveries is greater than the
34120 number of messages when messages have more than one recipient.
34122 A summary line is output at the end. By default the output is sorted on the
34123 domain name, but &'exiqsumm'& has the options &%-a%& and &%-c%&, which cause
34124 the output to be sorted by oldest message and by count of messages,
34125 respectively. There are also three options that split the messages for each
34126 domain into two or more subcounts: &%-b%& separates bounce messages, &%-f%&
34127 separates frozen messages, and &%-s%& separates messages according to their
34130 The output of &'exim -bp'& contains the original addresses in the message, so
34131 this also applies to the output from &'exiqsumm'&. No domains from addresses
34132 generated by aliasing or forwarding are included (unless the &%one_time%&
34133 option of the &(redirect)& router has been used to convert them into &"top
34134 level"& addresses).
34139 .section "Extracting specific information from the log (exigrep)" &&&
34141 .cindex "&'exigrep'&"
34142 .cindex "log" "extracts; grepping for"
34143 The &'exigrep'& utility is a Perl script that searches one or more main log
34144 files for entries that match a given pattern. When it finds a match, it
34145 extracts all the log entries for the relevant message, not just those that
34146 match the pattern. Thus, &'exigrep'& can extract complete log entries for a
34147 given message, or all mail for a given user, or for a given host, for example.
34148 The input files can be in Exim log format or syslog format.
34149 If a matching log line is not associated with a specific message, it is
34150 included in &'exigrep'&'s output without any additional lines. The usage is:
34152 &`exigrep [-t<`&&'n'&&`>] [-I] [-l] [-v] <`&&'pattern'&&`> [<`&&'log file'&&`>] ...`&
34154 If no log file names are given on the command line, the standard input is read.
34156 The &%-t%& argument specifies a number of seconds. It adds an additional
34157 condition for message selection. Messages that are complete are shown only if
34158 they spent more than <&'n'&> seconds on the queue.
34160 By default, &'exigrep'& does case-insensitive matching. The &%-I%& option
34161 makes it case-sensitive. This may give a performance improvement when searching
34162 large log files. Without &%-I%&, the Perl pattern matches use Perl's &`/i`&
34163 option; with &%-I%& they do not. In both cases it is possible to change the
34164 case sensitivity within the pattern by using &`(?i)`& or &`(?-i)`&.
34166 The &%-l%& option means &"literal"&, that is, treat all characters in the
34167 pattern as standing for themselves. Otherwise the pattern must be a Perl
34168 regular expression.
34170 The &%-v%& option inverts the matching condition. That is, a line is selected
34171 if it does &'not'& match the pattern.
34173 If the location of a &'zcat'& command is known from the definition of
34174 ZCAT_COMMAND in &_Local/Makefile_&, &'exigrep'& automatically passes any file
34175 whose name ends in COMPRESS_SUFFIX through &'zcat'& as it searches it.
34178 .section "Selecting messages by various criteria (exipick)" "SECTexipick"
34179 .cindex "&'exipick'&"
34180 John Jetmore's &'exipick'& utility is included in the Exim distribution. It
34181 lists messages from the queue according to a variety of criteria. For details
34182 of &'exipick'&'s facilities, visit the web page at
34183 &url(http://www.exim.org/eximwiki/ToolExipickManPage) or run &'exipick'& with
34184 the &%--help%& option.
34187 .section "Cycling log files (exicyclog)" "SECTcyclogfil"
34188 .cindex "log" "cycling local files"
34189 .cindex "cycling logs"
34190 .cindex "&'exicyclog'&"
34191 The &'exicyclog'& script can be used to cycle (rotate) &'mainlog'& and
34192 &'rejectlog'& files. This is not necessary if only syslog is being used, or if
34193 you are using log files with datestamps in their names (see section
34194 &<<SECTdatlogfil>>&). Some operating systems have their own standard mechanisms
34195 for log cycling, and these can be used instead of &'exicyclog'& if preferred.
34196 There are two command line options for &'exicyclog'&:
34198 &%-k%& <&'count'&> specifies the number of log files to keep, overriding the
34199 default that is set when Exim is built. The default default is 10.
34201 &%-l%& <&'path'&> specifies the log file path, in the same format as Exim's
34202 &%log_file_path%& option (for example, &`/var/log/exim_%slog`&), again
34203 overriding the script's default, which is to find the setting from Exim's
34207 Each time &'exicyclog'& is run the file names get &"shuffled down"& by one. If
34208 the main log file name is &_mainlog_& (the default) then when &'exicyclog'& is
34209 run &_mainlog_& becomes &_mainlog.01_&, the previous &_mainlog.01_& becomes
34210 &_mainlog.02_& and so on, up to the limit that is set in the script or by the
34211 &%-k%& option. Log files whose numbers exceed the limit are discarded. Reject
34212 logs are handled similarly.
34214 If the limit is greater than 99, the script uses 3-digit numbers such as
34215 &_mainlog.001_&, &_mainlog.002_&, etc. If you change from a number less than 99
34216 to one that is greater, or &'vice versa'&, you will have to fix the names of
34217 any existing log files.
34219 If no &_mainlog_& file exists, the script does nothing. Files that &"drop off"&
34220 the end are deleted. All files with numbers greater than 01 are compressed,
34221 using a compression command which is configured by the COMPRESS_COMMAND
34222 setting in &_Local/Makefile_&. It is usual to run &'exicyclog'& daily from a
34223 root &%crontab%& entry of the form
34225 1 0 * * * su exim -c /usr/exim/bin/exicyclog
34227 assuming you have used the name &"exim"& for the Exim user. You can run
34228 &'exicyclog'& as root if you wish, but there is no need.
34232 .section "Mail statistics (eximstats)" "SECTmailstat"
34233 .cindex "statistics"
34234 .cindex "&'eximstats'&"
34235 A Perl script called &'eximstats'& is provided for extracting statistical
34236 information from log files. The output is either plain text, or HTML.
34237 Exim log files are also supported by the &'Lire'& system produced by the
34238 LogReport Foundation &url(http://www.logreport.org).
34240 The &'eximstats'& script has been hacked about quite a bit over time. The
34241 latest version is the result of some extensive revision by Steve Campbell. A
34242 lot of information is given by default, but there are options for suppressing
34243 various parts of it. Following any options, the arguments to the script are a
34244 list of files, which should be main log files. For example:
34246 eximstats -nr /var/spool/exim/log/mainlog.01
34248 By default, &'eximstats'& extracts information about the number and volume of
34249 messages received from or delivered to various hosts. The information is sorted
34250 both by message count and by volume, and the top fifty hosts in each category
34251 are listed on the standard output. Similar information, based on email
34252 addresses or domains instead of hosts can be requested by means of various
34253 options. For messages delivered and received locally, similar statistics are
34254 also produced per user.
34256 The output also includes total counts and statistics about delivery errors, and
34257 histograms showing the number of messages received and deliveries made in each
34258 hour of the day. A delivery with more than one address in its envelope (for
34259 example, an SMTP transaction with more than one RCPT command) is counted
34260 as a single delivery by &'eximstats'&.
34262 Though normally more deliveries than receipts are reported (as messages may
34263 have multiple recipients), it is possible for &'eximstats'& to report more
34264 messages received than delivered, even though the queue is empty at the start
34265 and end of the period in question. If an incoming message contains no valid
34266 recipients, no deliveries are recorded for it. A bounce message is handled as
34267 an entirely separate message.
34269 &'eximstats'& always outputs a grand total summary giving the volume and number
34270 of messages received and deliveries made, and the number of hosts involved in
34271 each case. It also outputs the number of messages that were delayed (that is,
34272 not completely delivered at the first attempt), and the number that had at
34273 least one address that failed.
34275 The remainder of the output is in sections that can be independently disabled
34276 or modified by various options. It consists of a summary of deliveries by
34277 transport, histograms of messages received and delivered per time interval
34278 (default per hour), information about the time messages spent on the queue,
34279 a list of relayed messages, lists of the top fifty sending hosts, local
34280 senders, destination hosts, and destination local users by count and by volume,
34281 and a list of delivery errors that occurred.
34283 The relay information lists messages that were actually relayed, that is, they
34284 came from a remote host and were directly delivered to some other remote host,
34285 without being processed (for example, for aliasing or forwarding) locally.
34287 There are quite a few options for &'eximstats'& to control exactly what it
34288 outputs. These are documented in the Perl script itself, and can be extracted
34289 by running the command &(perldoc)& on the script. For example:
34291 perldoc /usr/exim/bin/eximstats
34294 .section "Checking access policy (exim_checkaccess)" "SECTcheckaccess"
34295 .cindex "&'exim_checkaccess'&"
34296 .cindex "policy control" "checking access"
34297 .cindex "checking access"
34298 The &%-bh%& command line argument allows you to run a fake SMTP session with
34299 debugging output, in order to check what Exim is doing when it is applying
34300 policy controls to incoming SMTP mail. However, not everybody is sufficiently
34301 familiar with the SMTP protocol to be able to make full use of &%-bh%&, and
34302 sometimes you just want to answer the question &"Does this address have
34303 access?"& without bothering with any further details.
34305 The &'exim_checkaccess'& utility is a &"packaged"& version of &%-bh%&. It takes
34306 two arguments, an IP address and an email address:
34308 exim_checkaccess 10.9.8.7 A.User@a.domain.example
34310 The utility runs a call to Exim with the &%-bh%& option, to test whether the
34311 given email address would be accepted in a RCPT command in a TCP/IP
34312 connection from the host with the given IP address. The output of the utility
34313 is either the word &"accepted"&, or the SMTP error response, for example:
34316 550 Relay not permitted
34318 When running this test, the utility uses &`<>`& as the envelope sender address
34319 for the MAIL command, but you can change this by providing additional
34320 options. These are passed directly to the Exim command. For example, to specify
34321 that the test is to be run with the sender address &'himself@there.example'&
34324 exim_checkaccess 10.9.8.7 A.User@a.domain.example \
34325 -f himself@there.example
34327 Note that these additional Exim command line items must be given after the two
34328 mandatory arguments.
34330 Because the &%exim_checkaccess%& uses &%-bh%&, it does not perform callouts
34331 while running its checks. You can run checks that include callouts by using
34332 &%-bhc%&, but this is not yet available in a &"packaged"& form.
34336 .section "Making DBM files (exim_dbmbuild)" "SECTdbmbuild"
34337 .cindex "DBM" "building dbm files"
34338 .cindex "building DBM files"
34339 .cindex "&'exim_dbmbuild'&"
34340 .cindex "lower casing"
34341 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
34342 The &'exim_dbmbuild'& program reads an input file containing keys and data in
34343 the format used by the &(lsearch)& lookup (see section
34344 &<<SECTsinglekeylookups>>&). It writes a DBM file using the lower-cased alias
34345 names as keys and the remainder of the information as data. The lower-casing
34346 can be prevented by calling the program with the &%-nolc%& option.
34348 A terminating zero is included as part of the key string. This is expected by
34349 the &(dbm)& lookup type. However, if the option &%-nozero%& is given,
34350 &'exim_dbmbuild'& creates files without terminating zeroes in either the key
34351 strings or the data strings. The &(dbmnz)& lookup type can be used with such
34354 The program requires two arguments: the name of the input file (which can be a
34355 single hyphen to indicate the standard input), and the name of the output file.
34356 It creates the output under a temporary name, and then renames it if all went
34360 If the native DB interface is in use (USE_DB is set in a compile-time
34361 configuration file &-- this is common in free versions of Unix) the two file
34362 names must be different, because in this mode the Berkeley DB functions create
34363 a single output file using exactly the name given. For example,
34365 exim_dbmbuild /etc/aliases /etc/aliases.db
34367 reads the system alias file and creates a DBM version of it in
34368 &_/etc/aliases.db_&.
34370 In systems that use the &'ndbm'& routines (mostly proprietary versions of
34371 Unix), two files are used, with the suffixes &_.dir_& and &_.pag_&. In this
34372 environment, the suffixes are added to the second argument of
34373 &'exim_dbmbuild'&, so it can be the same as the first. This is also the case
34374 when the Berkeley functions are used in compatibility mode (though this is not
34375 recommended), because in that case it adds a &_.db_& suffix to the file name.
34377 If a duplicate key is encountered, the program outputs a warning, and when it
34378 finishes, its return code is 1 rather than zero, unless the &%-noduperr%&
34379 option is used. By default, only the first of a set of duplicates is used &--
34380 this makes it compatible with &(lsearch)& lookups. There is an option
34381 &%-lastdup%& which causes it to use the data for the last duplicate instead.
34382 There is also an option &%-nowarn%&, which stops it listing duplicate keys to
34383 &%stderr%&. For other errors, where it doesn't actually make a new file, the
34389 .section "Finding individual retry times (exinext)" "SECTfinindret"
34390 .cindex "retry" "times"
34391 .cindex "&'exinext'&"
34392 A utility called &'exinext'& (mostly a Perl script) provides the ability to
34393 fish specific information out of the retry database. Given a mail domain (or a
34394 complete address), it looks up the hosts for that domain, and outputs any retry
34395 information for the hosts or for the domain. At present, the retry information
34396 is obtained by running &'exim_dumpdb'& (see below) and post-processing the
34397 output. For example:
34399 $ exinext piglet@milne.fict.example
34400 kanga.milne.example:192.168.8.1 error 146: Connection refused
34401 first failed: 21-Feb-1996 14:57:34
34402 last tried: 21-Feb-1996 14:57:34
34403 next try at: 21-Feb-1996 15:02:34
34404 roo.milne.example:192.168.8.3 error 146: Connection refused
34405 first failed: 20-Jan-1996 13:12:08
34406 last tried: 21-Feb-1996 11:42:03
34407 next try at: 21-Feb-1996 19:42:03
34408 past final cutoff time
34410 You can also give &'exinext'& a local part, without a domain, and it
34411 will give any retry information for that local part in your default domain.
34412 A message id can be used to obtain retry information pertaining to a specific
34413 message. This exists only when an attempt to deliver a message to a remote host
34414 suffers a message-specific error (see section &<<SECToutSMTPerr>>&).
34415 &'exinext'& is not particularly efficient, but then it is not expected to be
34418 The &'exinext'& utility calls Exim to find out information such as the location
34419 of the spool directory. The utility has &%-C%& and &%-D%& options, which are
34420 passed on to the &'exim'& commands. The first specifies an alternate Exim
34421 configuration file, and the second sets macros for use within the configuration
34422 file. These features are mainly to help in testing, but might also be useful in
34423 environments where more than one configuration file is in use.
34427 .section "Hints database maintenance" "SECThindatmai"
34428 .cindex "hints database" "maintenance"
34429 .cindex "maintaining Exim's hints database"
34430 Three utility programs are provided for maintaining the DBM files that Exim
34431 uses to contain its delivery hint information. Each program requires two
34432 arguments. The first specifies the name of Exim's spool directory, and the
34433 second is the name of the database it is to operate on. These are as follows:
34436 &'retry'&: the database of retry information
34438 &'wait-'&<&'transport name'&>: databases of information about messages waiting
34441 &'callout'&: the callout cache
34443 &'ratelimit'&: the data for implementing the ratelimit ACL condition
34445 &'misc'&: other hints data
34448 The &'misc'& database is used for
34451 Serializing ETRN runs (when &%smtp_etrn_serialize%& is set)
34453 Serializing delivery to a specific host (when &%serialize_hosts%& is set in an
34454 &(smtp)& transport)
34459 .section "exim_dumpdb" "SECID261"
34460 .cindex "&'exim_dumpdb'&"
34461 The entire contents of a database are written to the standard output by the
34462 &'exim_dumpdb'& program, which has no options or arguments other than the
34463 spool and database names. For example, to dump the retry database:
34465 exim_dumpdb /var/spool/exim retry
34467 Two lines of output are produced for each entry:
34469 T:mail.ref.example:192.168.242.242 146 77 Connection refused
34470 31-Oct-1995 12:00:12 02-Nov-1995 12:21:39 02-Nov-1995 20:21:39 *
34472 The first item on the first line is the key of the record. It starts with one
34473 of the letters R, or T, depending on whether it refers to a routing or
34474 transport retry. For a local delivery, the next part is the local address; for
34475 a remote delivery it is the name of the remote host, followed by its failing IP
34476 address (unless &%retry_include_ip_address%& is set false on the &(smtp)&
34477 transport). If the remote port is not the standard one (port 25), it is added
34478 to the IP address. Then there follows an error code, an additional error code,
34479 and a textual description of the error.
34481 The three times on the second line are the time of first failure, the time of
34482 the last delivery attempt, and the computed time for the next attempt. The line
34483 ends with an asterisk if the cutoff time for the last retry rule has been
34486 Each output line from &'exim_dumpdb'& for the &'wait-xxx'& databases
34487 consists of a host name followed by a list of ids for messages that are or were
34488 waiting to be delivered to that host. If there are a very large number for any
34489 one host, continuation records, with a sequence number added to the host name,
34490 may be seen. The data in these records is often out of date, because a message
34491 may be routed to several alternative hosts, and Exim makes no effort to keep
34496 .section "exim_tidydb" "SECID262"
34497 .cindex "&'exim_tidydb'&"
34498 The &'exim_tidydb'& utility program is used to tidy up the contents of a hints
34499 database. If run with no options, it removes all records that are more than 30
34500 days old. The age is calculated from the date and time that the record was last
34501 updated. Note that, in the case of the retry database, it is &'not'& the time
34502 since the first delivery failure. Information about a host that has been down
34503 for more than 30 days will remain in the database, provided that the record is
34504 updated sufficiently often.
34506 The cutoff date can be altered by means of the &%-t%& option, which must be
34507 followed by a time. For example, to remove all records older than a week from
34508 the retry database:
34510 exim_tidydb -t 7d /var/spool/exim retry
34512 Both the &'wait-xxx'& and &'retry'& databases contain items that involve
34513 message ids. In the former these appear as data in records keyed by host &--
34514 they were messages that were waiting for that host &-- and in the latter they
34515 are the keys for retry information for messages that have suffered certain
34516 types of error. When &'exim_tidydb'& is run, a check is made to ensure that
34517 message ids in database records are those of messages that are still on the
34518 queue. Message ids for messages that no longer exist are removed from
34519 &'wait-xxx'& records, and if this leaves any records empty, they are deleted.
34520 For the &'retry'& database, records whose keys are non-existent message ids are
34521 removed. The &'exim_tidydb'& utility outputs comments on the standard output
34522 whenever it removes information from the database.
34524 Certain records are automatically removed by Exim when they are no longer
34525 needed, but others are not. For example, if all the MX hosts for a domain are
34526 down, a retry record is created for each one. If the primary MX host comes back
34527 first, its record is removed when Exim successfully delivers to it, but the
34528 records for the others remain because Exim has not tried to use those hosts.
34530 It is important, therefore, to run &'exim_tidydb'& periodically on all the
34531 hints databases. You should do this at a quiet time of day, because it requires
34532 a database to be locked (and therefore inaccessible to Exim) while it does its
34533 work. Removing records from a DBM file does not normally make the file smaller,
34534 but all the common DBM libraries are able to re-use the space that is released.
34535 After an initial phase of increasing in size, the databases normally reach a
34536 point at which they no longer get any bigger, as long as they are regularly
34539 &*Warning*&: If you never run &'exim_tidydb'&, the space used by the hints
34540 databases is likely to keep on increasing.
34545 .section "exim_fixdb" "SECID263"
34546 .cindex "&'exim_fixdb'&"
34547 The &'exim_fixdb'& program is a utility for interactively modifying databases.
34548 Its main use is for testing Exim, but it might also be occasionally useful for
34549 getting round problems in a live system. It has no options, and its interface
34550 is somewhat crude. On entry, it prompts for input with a right angle-bracket. A
34551 key of a database record can then be entered, and the data for that record is
34554 If &"d"& is typed at the next prompt, the entire record is deleted. For all
34555 except the &'retry'& database, that is the only operation that can be carried
34556 out. For the &'retry'& database, each field is output preceded by a number, and
34557 data for individual fields can be changed by typing the field number followed
34558 by new data, for example:
34562 resets the time of the next delivery attempt. Time values are given as a
34563 sequence of digit pairs for year, month, day, hour, and minute. Colons can be
34564 used as optional separators.
34569 .section "Mailbox maintenance (exim_lock)" "SECTmailboxmaint"
34570 .cindex "mailbox" "maintenance"
34571 .cindex "&'exim_lock'&"
34572 .cindex "locking mailboxes"
34573 The &'exim_lock'& utility locks a mailbox file using the same algorithm as
34574 Exim. For a discussion of locking issues, see section &<<SECTopappend>>&.
34575 &'Exim_lock'& can be used to prevent any modification of a mailbox by Exim or
34576 a user agent while investigating a problem. The utility requires the name of
34577 the file as its first argument. If the locking is successful, the second
34578 argument is run as a command (using C's &[system()]& function); if there is no
34579 second argument, the value of the SHELL environment variable is used; if this
34580 is unset or empty, &_/bin/sh_& is run. When the command finishes, the mailbox
34581 is unlocked and the utility ends. The following options are available:
34585 Use &[fcntl()]& locking on the open mailbox.
34588 Use &[flock()]& locking on the open mailbox, provided the operating system
34591 .vitem &%-interval%&
34592 This must be followed by a number, which is a number of seconds; it sets the
34593 interval to sleep between retries (default 3).
34595 .vitem &%-lockfile%&
34596 Create a lock file before opening the mailbox.
34599 Lock the mailbox using MBX rules.
34602 Suppress verification output.
34604 .vitem &%-retries%&
34605 This must be followed by a number; it sets the number of times to try to get
34606 the lock (default 10).
34608 .vitem &%-restore_time%&
34609 This option causes &%exim_lock%& to restore the modified and read times to the
34610 locked file before exiting. This allows you to access a locked mailbox (for
34611 example, to take a backup copy) without disturbing the times that the user
34614 .vitem &%-timeout%&
34615 This must be followed by a number, which is a number of seconds; it sets a
34616 timeout to be used with a blocking &[fcntl()]& lock. If it is not set (the
34617 default), a non-blocking call is used.
34620 Generate verbose output.
34623 If none of &%-fcntl%&, &%-flock%&, &%-lockfile%& or &%-mbx%& are given, the
34624 default is to create a lock file and also to use &[fcntl()]& locking on the
34625 mailbox, which is the same as Exim's default. The use of &%-flock%& or
34626 &%-fcntl%& requires that the file be writeable; the use of &%-lockfile%&
34627 requires that the directory containing the file be writeable. Locking by lock
34628 file does not last for ever; Exim assumes that a lock file is expired if it is
34629 more than 30 minutes old.
34631 The &%-mbx%& option can be used with either or both of &%-fcntl%& or
34632 &%-flock%&. It assumes &%-fcntl%& by default. MBX locking causes a shared lock
34633 to be taken out on the open mailbox, and an exclusive lock on the file
34634 &_/tmp/.n.m_& where &'n'& and &'m'& are the device number and inode
34635 number of the mailbox file. When the locking is released, if an exclusive lock
34636 can be obtained for the mailbox, the file in &_/tmp_& is deleted.
34638 The default output contains verification of the locking that takes place. The
34639 &%-v%& option causes some additional information to be given. The &%-q%& option
34640 suppresses all output except error messages.
34644 exim_lock /var/spool/mail/spqr
34646 runs an interactive shell while the file is locked, whereas
34648 &`exim_lock -q /var/spool/mail/spqr <<End`&
34649 <&'some commands'&>
34652 runs a specific non-interactive sequence of commands while the file is locked,
34653 suppressing all verification output. A single command can be run by a command
34656 exim_lock -q /var/spool/mail/spqr \
34657 "cp /var/spool/mail/spqr /some/where"
34659 Note that if a command is supplied, it must be entirely contained within the
34660 second argument &-- hence the quotes.
34664 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34665 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34667 .chapter "The Exim monitor" "CHAPeximon"
34668 .scindex IIDeximon "Exim monitor" "description"
34669 .cindex "X-windows"
34670 .cindex "&'eximon'&"
34671 .cindex "Local/eximon.conf"
34672 .cindex "&_exim_monitor/EDITME_&"
34673 The Exim monitor is an application which displays in an X window information
34674 about the state of Exim's queue and what Exim is doing. An admin user can
34675 perform certain operations on messages from this GUI interface; however all
34676 such facilities are also available from the command line, and indeed, the
34677 monitor itself makes use of the command line to perform any actions requested.
34681 .section "Running the monitor" "SECID264"
34682 The monitor is started by running the script called &'eximon'&. This is a shell
34683 script that sets up a number of environment variables, and then runs the
34684 binary called &_eximon.bin_&. The default appearance of the monitor window can
34685 be changed by editing the &_Local/eximon.conf_& file created by editing
34686 &_exim_monitor/EDITME_&. Comments in that file describe what the various
34687 parameters are for.
34689 The parameters that get built into the &'eximon'& script can be overridden for
34690 a particular invocation by setting up environment variables of the same names,
34691 preceded by &`EXIMON_`&. For example, a shell command such as
34693 EXIMON_LOG_DEPTH=400 eximon
34695 (in a Bourne-compatible shell) runs &'eximon'& with an overriding setting of
34696 the LOG_DEPTH parameter. If EXIMON_LOG_FILE_PATH is set in the environment, it
34697 overrides the Exim log file configuration. This makes it possible to have
34698 &'eximon'& tailing log data that is written to syslog, provided that MAIL.INFO
34699 syslog messages are routed to a file on the local host.
34701 X resources can be used to change the appearance of the window in the normal
34702 way. For example, a resource setting of the form
34704 Eximon*background: gray94
34706 changes the colour of the background to light grey rather than white. The
34707 stripcharts are drawn with both the data lines and the reference lines in
34708 black. This means that the reference lines are not visible when on top of the
34709 data. However, their colour can be changed by setting a resource called
34710 &"highlight"& (an odd name, but that's what the Athena stripchart widget uses).
34711 For example, if your X server is running Unix, you could set up lighter
34712 reference lines in the stripcharts by obeying
34715 Eximon*highlight: gray
34718 .cindex "admin user"
34719 In order to see the contents of messages on the queue, and to operate on them,
34720 &'eximon'& must either be run as root or by an admin user.
34722 The command-line parameters of &'eximon'& are passed to &_eximon.bin_& and may
34723 contain X11 resource parameters interpreted by the X11 library. In addition,
34724 if the first parameter starts with the string "gdb" then it is removed and the
34725 binary is invoked under gdb (the parameter is used as the gdb command-name, so
34726 versioned variants of gdb can be invoked).
34728 The monitor's window is divided into three parts. The first contains one or
34729 more stripcharts and two action buttons, the second contains a &"tail"& of the
34730 main log file, and the third is a display of the queue of messages awaiting
34731 delivery, with two more action buttons. The following sections describe these
34732 different parts of the display.
34737 .section "The stripcharts" "SECID265"
34738 .cindex "stripchart"
34739 The first stripchart is always a count of messages on the queue. Its name can
34740 be configured by setting QUEUE_STRIPCHART_NAME in the
34741 &_Local/eximon.conf_& file. The remaining stripcharts are defined in the
34742 configuration script by regular expression matches on log file entries, making
34743 it possible to display, for example, counts of messages delivered to certain
34744 hosts or using certain transports. The supplied defaults display counts of
34745 received and delivered messages, and of local and SMTP deliveries. The default
34746 period between stripchart updates is one minute; this can be adjusted by a
34747 parameter in the &_Local/eximon.conf_& file.
34749 The stripchart displays rescale themselves automatically as the value they are
34750 displaying changes. There are always 10 horizontal lines in each chart; the
34751 title string indicates the value of each division when it is greater than one.
34752 For example, &"x2"& means that each division represents a value of 2.
34754 It is also possible to have a stripchart which shows the percentage fullness of
34755 a particular disk partition, which is useful when local deliveries are confined
34756 to a single partition.
34758 .cindex "&%statvfs%& function"
34759 This relies on the availability of the &[statvfs()]& function or equivalent in
34760 the operating system. Most, but not all versions of Unix that support Exim have
34761 this. For this particular stripchart, the top of the chart always represents
34762 100%, and the scale is given as &"x10%"&. This chart is configured by setting
34763 SIZE_STRIPCHART and (optionally) SIZE_STRIPCHART_NAME in the
34764 &_Local/eximon.conf_& file.
34769 .section "Main action buttons" "SECID266"
34770 .cindex "size" "of monitor window"
34771 .cindex "Exim monitor" "window size"
34772 .cindex "window size"
34773 Below the stripcharts there is an action button for quitting the monitor. Next
34774 to this is another button marked &"Size"&. They are placed here so that
34775 shrinking the window to its default minimum size leaves just the queue count
34776 stripchart and these two buttons visible. Pressing the &"Size"& button causes
34777 the window to expand to its maximum size, unless it is already at the maximum,
34778 in which case it is reduced to its minimum.
34780 When expanding to the maximum, if the window cannot be fully seen where it
34781 currently is, it is moved back to where it was the last time it was at full
34782 size. When it is expanding from its minimum size, the old position is
34783 remembered, and next time it is reduced to the minimum it is moved back there.
34785 The idea is that you can keep a reduced window just showing one or two
34786 stripcharts at a convenient place on your screen, easily expand it to show
34787 the full window when required, and just as easily put it back to what it was.
34788 The idea is copied from what the &'twm'& window manager does for its
34789 &'f.fullzoom'& action. The minimum size of the window can be changed by setting
34790 the MIN_HEIGHT and MIN_WIDTH values in &_Local/eximon.conf_&.
34792 Normally, the monitor starts up with the window at its full size, but it can be
34793 built so that it starts up with the window at its smallest size, by setting
34794 START_SMALL=yes in &_Local/eximon.conf_&.
34798 .section "The log display" "SECID267"
34799 .cindex "log" "tail of; in monitor"
34800 The second section of the window is an area in which a display of the tail of
34801 the main log is maintained.
34802 To save space on the screen, the timestamp on each log line is shortened by
34803 removing the date and, if &%log_timezone%& is set, the timezone.
34804 The log tail is not available when the only destination for logging data is
34805 syslog, unless the syslog lines are routed to a local file whose name is passed
34806 to &'eximon'& via the EXIMON_LOG_FILE_PATH environment variable.
34808 The log sub-window has a scroll bar at its lefthand side which can be used to
34809 move back to look at earlier text, and the up and down arrow keys also have a
34810 scrolling effect. The amount of log that is kept depends on the setting of
34811 LOG_BUFFER in &_Local/eximon.conf_&, which specifies the amount of memory
34812 to use. When this is full, the earlier 50% of data is discarded &-- this is
34813 much more efficient than throwing it away line by line. The sub-window also has
34814 a horizontal scroll bar for accessing the ends of long log lines. This is the
34815 only means of horizontal scrolling; the right and left arrow keys are not
34816 available. Text can be cut from this part of the window using the mouse in the
34817 normal way. The size of this subwindow is controlled by parameters in the
34818 configuration file &_Local/eximon.conf_&.
34820 Searches of the text in the log window can be carried out by means of the ^R
34821 and ^S keystrokes, which default to a reverse and a forward search,
34822 respectively. The search covers only the text that is displayed in the window.
34823 It cannot go further back up the log.
34825 The point from which the search starts is indicated by a caret marker. This is
34826 normally at the end of the text in the window, but can be positioned explicitly
34827 by pointing and clicking with the left mouse button, and is moved automatically
34828 by a successful search. If new text arrives in the window when it is scrolled
34829 back, the caret remains where it is, but if the window is not scrolled back,
34830 the caret is moved to the end of the new text.
34832 Pressing ^R or ^S pops up a window into which the search text can be typed.
34833 There are buttons for selecting forward or reverse searching, for carrying out
34834 the search, and for cancelling. If the &"Search"& button is pressed, the search
34835 happens and the window remains so that further searches can be done. If the
34836 &"Return"& key is pressed, a single search is done and the window is closed. If
34837 ^C is typed the search is cancelled.
34839 The searching facility is implemented using the facilities of the Athena text
34840 widget. By default this pops up a window containing both &"search"& and
34841 &"replace"& options. In order to suppress the unwanted &"replace"& portion for
34842 eximon, a modified version of the &%TextPop%& widget is distributed with Exim.
34843 However, the linkers in BSDI and HP-UX seem unable to handle an externally
34844 provided version of &%TextPop%& when the remaining parts of the text widget
34845 come from the standard libraries. The compile-time option EXIMON_TEXTPOP can be
34846 unset to cut out the modified &%TextPop%&, making it possible to build Eximon
34847 on these systems, at the expense of having unwanted items in the search popup
34852 .section "The queue display" "SECID268"
34853 .cindex "queue" "display in monitor"
34854 The bottom section of the monitor window contains a list of all messages that
34855 are on the queue, which includes those currently being received or delivered,
34856 as well as those awaiting delivery. The size of this subwindow is controlled by
34857 parameters in the configuration file &_Local/eximon.conf_&, and the frequency
34858 at which it is updated is controlled by another parameter in the same file &--
34859 the default is 5 minutes, since queue scans can be quite expensive. However,
34860 there is an &"Update"& action button just above the display which can be used
34861 to force an update of the queue display at any time.
34863 When a host is down for some time, a lot of pending mail can build up for it,
34864 and this can make it hard to deal with other messages on the queue. To help
34865 with this situation there is a button next to &"Update"& called &"Hide"&. If
34866 pressed, a dialogue box called &"Hide addresses ending with"& is put up. If you
34867 type anything in here and press &"Return"&, the text is added to a chain of
34868 such texts, and if every undelivered address in a message matches at least one
34869 of the texts, the message is not displayed.
34871 If there is an address that does not match any of the texts, all the addresses
34872 are displayed as normal. The matching happens on the ends of addresses so, for
34873 example, &'cam.ac.uk'& specifies all addresses in Cambridge, while
34874 &'xxx@foo.com.example'& specifies just one specific address. When any hiding
34875 has been set up, a button called &"Unhide"& is displayed. If pressed, it
34876 cancels all hiding. Also, to ensure that hidden messages do not get forgotten,
34877 a hide request is automatically cancelled after one hour.
34879 While the dialogue box is displayed, you can't press any buttons or do anything
34880 else to the monitor window. For this reason, if you want to cut text from the
34881 queue display to use in the dialogue box, you have to do the cutting before
34882 pressing the &"Hide"& button.
34884 The queue display contains, for each unhidden queued message, the length of
34885 time it has been on the queue, the size of the message, the message id, the
34886 message sender, and the first undelivered recipient, all on one line. If it is
34887 a bounce message, the sender is shown as &"<>"&. If there is more than one
34888 recipient to which the message has not yet been delivered, subsequent ones are
34889 listed on additional lines, up to a maximum configured number, following which
34890 an ellipsis is displayed. Recipients that have already received the message are
34893 .cindex "frozen messages" "display"
34894 If a message is frozen, an asterisk is displayed at the left-hand side.
34896 The queue display has a vertical scroll bar, and can also be scrolled by means
34897 of the arrow keys. Text can be cut from it using the mouse in the normal way.
34898 The text searching facilities, as described above for the log window, are also
34899 available, but the caret is always moved to the end of the text when the queue
34900 display is updated.
34904 .section "The queue menu" "SECID269"
34905 .cindex "queue" "menu in monitor"
34906 If the &%shift%& key is held down and the left button is clicked when the mouse
34907 pointer is over the text for any message, an action menu pops up, and the first
34908 line of the queue display for the message is highlighted. This does not affect
34911 If you want to use some other event for popping up the menu, you can set the
34912 MENU_EVENT parameter in &_Local/eximon.conf_& to change the default, or
34913 set EXIMON_MENU_EVENT in the environment before starting the monitor. The
34914 value set in this parameter is a standard X event description. For example, to
34915 run eximon using &%ctrl%& rather than &%shift%& you could use
34917 EXIMON_MENU_EVENT='Ctrl<Btn1Down>' eximon
34919 The title of the menu is the message id, and it contains entries which act as
34923 &'message log'&: The contents of the message log for the message are displayed
34924 in a new text window.
34926 &'headers'&: Information from the spool file that contains the envelope
34927 information and headers is displayed in a new text window. See chapter
34928 &<<CHAPspool>>& for a description of the format of spool files.
34930 &'body'&: The contents of the spool file containing the body of the message are
34931 displayed in a new text window. There is a default limit of 20,000 bytes to the
34932 amount of data displayed. This can be changed by setting the BODY_MAX
34933 option at compile time, or the EXIMON_BODY_MAX option at run time.
34935 &'deliver message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-M%& option to request
34936 delivery of the message. This causes an automatic thaw if the message is
34937 frozen. The &%-v%& option is also set, and the output from Exim is displayed in
34938 a new text window. The delivery is run in a separate process, to avoid holding
34939 up the monitor while the delivery proceeds.
34941 &'freeze message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mf%& option to request
34942 that the message be frozen.
34944 .cindex "thawing messages"
34945 .cindex "unfreezing messages"
34946 .cindex "frozen messages" "thawing"
34947 &'thaw message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mt%& option to request
34948 that the message be thawed.
34950 .cindex "delivery" "forcing failure"
34951 &'give up on msg'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mg%& option to request
34952 that Exim gives up trying to deliver the message. A bounce message is generated
34953 for any remaining undelivered addresses.
34955 &'remove message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mrm%& option to request
34956 that the message be deleted from the system without generating a bounce
34959 &'add recipient'&: A dialog box is displayed into which a recipient address can
34960 be typed. If the address is not qualified and the QUALIFY_DOMAIN parameter
34961 is set in &_Local/eximon.conf_&, the address is qualified with that domain.
34962 Otherwise it must be entered as a fully qualified address. Pressing RETURN
34963 causes a call to Exim to be made using the &%-Mar%& option to request that an
34964 additional recipient be added to the message, unless the entry box is empty, in
34965 which case no action is taken.
34967 &'mark delivered'&: A dialog box is displayed into which a recipient address
34968 can be typed. If the address is not qualified and the QUALIFY_DOMAIN parameter
34969 is set in &_Local/eximon.conf_&, the address is qualified with that domain.
34970 Otherwise it must be entered as a fully qualified address. Pressing RETURN
34971 causes a call to Exim to be made using the &%-Mmd%& option to mark the given
34972 recipient address as already delivered, unless the entry box is empty, in which
34973 case no action is taken.
34975 &'mark all delivered'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mmad%& option to
34976 mark all recipient addresses as already delivered.
34978 &'edit sender'&: A dialog box is displayed initialized with the current
34979 sender's address. Pressing RETURN causes a call to Exim to be made using the
34980 &%-Mes%& option to replace the sender address, unless the entry box is empty,
34981 in which case no action is taken. If you want to set an empty sender (as in
34982 bounce messages), you must specify it as &"<>"&. Otherwise, if the address is
34983 not qualified and the QUALIFY_DOMAIN parameter is set in &_Local/eximon.conf_&,
34984 the address is qualified with that domain.
34987 When a delivery is forced, a window showing the &%-v%& output is displayed. In
34988 other cases when a call to Exim is made, if there is any output from Exim (in
34989 particular, if the command fails) a window containing the command and the
34990 output is displayed. Otherwise, the results of the action are normally apparent
34991 from the log and queue displays. However, if you set ACTION_OUTPUT=yes in
34992 &_Local/eximon.conf_&, a window showing the Exim command is always opened, even
34993 if no output is generated.
34995 The queue display is automatically updated for actions such as freezing and
34996 thawing, unless ACTION_QUEUE_UPDATE=no has been set in
34997 &_Local/eximon.conf_&. In this case the &"Update"& button has to be used to
34998 force an update of the display after one of these actions.
35000 In any text window that is displayed as result of a menu action, the normal
35001 cut-and-paste facility is available, and searching can be carried out using ^R
35002 and ^S, as described above for the log tail window.
35009 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
35010 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
35012 .chapter "Security considerations" "CHAPsecurity"
35013 .scindex IIDsecurcon "security" "discussion of"
35014 This chapter discusses a number of issues concerned with security, some of
35015 which are also covered in other parts of this manual.
35017 For reasons that this author does not understand, some people have promoted
35018 Exim as a &"particularly secure"& mailer. Perhaps it is because of the
35019 existence of this chapter in the documentation. However, the intent of the
35020 chapter is simply to describe the way Exim works in relation to certain
35021 security concerns, not to make any specific claims about the effectiveness of
35022 its security as compared with other MTAs.
35024 What follows is a description of the way Exim is supposed to be. Best efforts
35025 have been made to try to ensure that the code agrees with the theory, but an
35026 absence of bugs can never be guaranteed. Any that are reported will get fixed
35027 as soon as possible.
35030 .section "Building a more &""hardened""& Exim" "SECID286"
35031 .cindex "security" "build-time features"
35032 There are a number of build-time options that can be set in &_Local/Makefile_&
35033 to create Exim binaries that are &"harder"& to attack, in particular by a rogue
35034 Exim administrator who does not have the root password, or by someone who has
35035 penetrated the Exim (but not the root) account. These options are as follows:
35038 ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX can be set to a string that is required to match the
35039 start of any file names used with the &%-C%& option. When it is set, these file
35040 names are also not allowed to contain the sequence &"/../"&. (However, if the
35041 value of the &%-C%& option is identical to the value of CONFIGURE_FILE in
35042 &_Local/Makefile_&, Exim ignores &%-C%& and proceeds as usual.) There is no
35043 default setting for &%ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX%&.
35045 If the permitted configuration files are confined to a directory to
35046 which only root has access, this guards against someone who has broken
35047 into the Exim account from running a privileged Exim with an arbitrary
35048 configuration file, and using it to break into other accounts.
35051 If a non-trusted configuration file (i.e. not the default configuration file
35052 or one which is trusted by virtue of being listed in the TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST
35053 file) is specified with &%-C%&, or if macros are given with &%-D%& (but see
35054 the next item), then root privilege is retained only if the caller of Exim is
35055 root. This locks out the possibility of testing a configuration using &%-C%&
35056 right through message reception and delivery, even if the caller is root. The
35057 reception works, but by that time, Exim is running as the Exim user, so when
35058 it re-execs to regain privilege for the delivery, the use of &%-C%& causes
35059 privilege to be lost. However, root can test reception and delivery using two
35063 The WHITELIST_D_MACROS build option declares some macros to be safe to override
35064 with &%-D%& if the real uid is one of root, the Exim run-time user or the
35065 CONFIGURE_OWNER, if defined. The potential impact of this option is limited by
35066 requiring the run-time value supplied to &%-D%& to match a regex that errs on
35067 the restrictive side. Requiring build-time selection of safe macros is onerous
35068 but this option is intended solely as a transition mechanism to permit
35069 previously-working configurations to continue to work after release 4.73.
35071 If DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined, the use of the &%-D%& command line option
35074 FIXED_NEVER_USERS can be set to a colon-separated list of users that are
35075 never to be used for any deliveries. This is like the &%never_users%& runtime
35076 option, but it cannot be overridden; the runtime option adds additional users
35077 to the list. The default setting is &"root"&; this prevents a non-root user who
35078 is permitted to modify the runtime file from using Exim as a way to get root.
35083 .section "Root privilege" "SECID270"
35085 .cindex "root privilege"
35086 The Exim binary is normally setuid to root, which means that it gains root
35087 privilege (runs as root) when it starts execution. In some special cases (for
35088 example, when the daemon is not in use and there are no local deliveries), it
35089 may be possible to run Exim setuid to some user other than root. This is
35090 discussed in the next section. However, in most installations, root privilege
35091 is required for two things:
35094 To set up a socket connected to the standard SMTP port (25) when initialising
35095 the listening daemon. If Exim is run from &'inetd'&, this privileged action is
35098 To be able to change uid and gid in order to read users' &_.forward_& files and
35099 perform local deliveries as the receiving user or as specified in the
35103 It is not necessary to be root to do any of the other things Exim does, such as
35104 receiving messages and delivering them externally over SMTP, and it is
35105 obviously more secure if Exim does not run as root except when necessary.
35106 For this reason, a user and group for Exim to use must be defined in
35107 &_Local/Makefile_&. These are known as &"the Exim user"& and &"the Exim
35108 group"&. Their values can be changed by the run time configuration, though this
35109 is not recommended. Often a user called &'exim'& is used, but some sites use
35110 &'mail'& or another user name altogether.
35112 Exim uses &[setuid()]& whenever it gives up root privilege. This is a permanent
35113 abdication; the process cannot regain root afterwards. Prior to release 4.00,
35114 &[seteuid()]& was used in some circumstances, but this is no longer the case.
35116 After a new Exim process has interpreted its command line options, it changes
35117 uid and gid in the following cases:
35122 If the &%-C%& option is used to specify an alternate configuration file, or if
35123 the &%-D%& option is used to define macro values for the configuration, and the
35124 calling process is not running as root, the uid and gid are changed to those of
35125 the calling process.
35126 However, if DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, the &%-D%&
35127 option may not be used at all.
35128 If WHITELIST_D_MACROS is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, then some macro values
35129 can be supplied if the calling process is running as root, the Exim run-time
35130 user or CONFIGURE_OWNER, if defined.
35135 If the expansion test option (&%-be%&) or one of the filter testing options
35136 (&%-bf%& or &%-bF%&) are used, the uid and gid are changed to those of the
35139 If the process is not a daemon process or a queue runner process or a delivery
35140 process or a process for testing address routing (started with &%-bt%&), the
35141 uid and gid are changed to the Exim user and group. This means that Exim always
35142 runs under its own uid and gid when receiving messages. This also applies when
35143 testing address verification
35146 (the &%-bv%& option) and testing incoming message policy controls (the &%-bh%&
35149 For a daemon, queue runner, delivery, or address testing process, the uid
35150 remains as root at this stage, but the gid is changed to the Exim group.
35153 The processes that initially retain root privilege behave as follows:
35156 A daemon process changes the gid to the Exim group and the uid to the Exim
35157 user after setting up one or more listening sockets. The &[initgroups()]&
35158 function is called, so that if the Exim user is in any additional groups, they
35159 will be used during message reception.
35161 A queue runner process retains root privilege throughout its execution. Its
35162 job is to fork a controlled sequence of delivery processes.
35164 A delivery process retains root privilege throughout most of its execution,
35165 but any actual deliveries (that is, the transports themselves) are run in
35166 subprocesses which always change to a non-root uid and gid. For local
35167 deliveries this is typically the uid and gid of the owner of the mailbox; for
35168 remote deliveries, the Exim uid and gid are used. Once all the delivery
35169 subprocesses have been run, a delivery process changes to the Exim uid and gid
35170 while doing post-delivery tidying up such as updating the retry database and
35171 generating bounce and warning messages.
35173 While the recipient addresses in a message are being routed, the delivery
35174 process runs as root. However, if a user's filter file has to be processed,
35175 this is done in a subprocess that runs under the individual user's uid and
35176 gid. A system filter is run as root unless &%system_filter_user%& is set.
35178 A process that is testing addresses (the &%-bt%& option) runs as root so that
35179 the routing is done in the same environment as a message delivery.
35185 .section "Running Exim without privilege" "SECTrunexiwitpri"
35186 .cindex "privilege, running without"
35187 .cindex "unprivileged running"
35188 .cindex "root privilege" "running without"
35189 Some installations like to run Exim in an unprivileged state for more of its
35190 operation, for added security. Support for this mode of operation is provided
35191 by the global option &%deliver_drop_privilege%&. When this is set, the uid and
35192 gid are changed to the Exim user and group at the start of a delivery process
35193 (and also queue runner and address testing processes). This means that address
35194 routing is no longer run as root, and the deliveries themselves cannot change
35198 .cindex "daemon" "restarting"
35199 Leaving the binary setuid to root, but setting &%deliver_drop_privilege%& means
35200 that the daemon can still be started in the usual way, and it can respond
35201 correctly to SIGHUP because the re-invocation regains root privilege.
35203 An alternative approach is to make Exim setuid to the Exim user and also setgid
35204 to the Exim group. If you do this, the daemon must be started from a root
35205 process. (Calling Exim from a root process makes it behave in the way it does
35206 when it is setuid root.) However, the daemon cannot restart itself after a
35207 SIGHUP signal because it cannot regain privilege.
35209 It is still useful to set &%deliver_drop_privilege%& in this case, because it
35210 stops Exim from trying to re-invoke itself to do a delivery after a message has
35211 been received. Such a re-invocation is a waste of resources because it has no
35214 If restarting the daemon is not an issue (for example, if &%mua_wrapper%& is
35215 set, or &'inetd'& is being used instead of a daemon), having the binary setuid
35216 to the Exim user seems a clean approach, but there is one complication:
35218 In this style of operation, Exim is running with the real uid and gid set to
35219 those of the calling process, and the effective uid/gid set to Exim's values.
35220 Ideally, any association with the calling process' uid/gid should be dropped,
35221 that is, the real uid/gid should be reset to the effective values so as to
35222 discard any privileges that the caller may have. While some operating systems
35223 have a function that permits this action for a non-root effective uid, quite a
35224 number of them do not. Because of this lack of standardization, Exim does not
35225 address this problem at this time.
35227 For this reason, the recommended approach for &"mostly unprivileged"& running
35228 is to keep the Exim binary setuid to root, and to set
35229 &%deliver_drop_privilege%&. This also has the advantage of allowing a daemon to
35230 be used in the most straightforward way.
35232 If you configure Exim not to run delivery processes as root, there are a
35233 number of restrictions on what you can do:
35236 You can deliver only as the Exim user/group. You should explicitly use the
35237 &%user%& and &%group%& options to override routers or local transports that
35238 normally deliver as the recipient. This makes sure that configurations that
35239 work in this mode function the same way in normal mode. Any implicit or
35240 explicit specification of another user causes an error.
35242 Use of &_.forward_& files is severely restricted, such that it is usually
35243 not worthwhile to include them in the configuration.
35245 Users who wish to use &_.forward_& would have to make their home directory and
35246 the file itself accessible to the Exim user. Pipe and append-to-file entries,
35247 and their equivalents in Exim filters, cannot be used. While they could be
35248 enabled in the Exim user's name, that would be insecure and not very useful.
35250 Unless the local user mailboxes are all owned by the Exim user (possible in
35251 some POP3 or IMAP-only environments):
35254 They must be owned by the Exim group and be writeable by that group. This
35255 implies you must set &%mode%& in the appendfile configuration, as well as the
35256 mode of the mailbox files themselves.
35258 You must set &%no_check_owner%&, since most or all of the files will not be
35259 owned by the Exim user.
35261 You must set &%file_must_exist%&, because Exim cannot set the owner correctly
35262 on a newly created mailbox when unprivileged. This also implies that new
35263 mailboxes need to be created manually.
35268 These restrictions severely restrict what can be done in local deliveries.
35269 However, there are no restrictions on remote deliveries. If you are running a
35270 gateway host that does no local deliveries, setting &%deliver_drop_privilege%&
35271 gives more security at essentially no cost.
35273 If you are using the &%mua_wrapper%& facility (see chapter
35274 &<<CHAPnonqueueing>>&), &%deliver_drop_privilege%& is forced to be true.
35279 .section "Delivering to local files" "SECID271"
35280 Full details of the checks applied by &(appendfile)& before it writes to a file
35281 are given in chapter &<<CHAPappendfile>>&.
35285 .section "IPv4 source routing" "SECID272"
35286 .cindex "source routing" "in IP packets"
35287 .cindex "IP source routing"
35288 Many operating systems suppress IP source-routed packets in the kernel, but
35289 some cannot be made to do this, so Exim does its own check. It logs incoming
35290 IPv4 source-routed TCP calls, and then drops them. Things are all different in
35291 IPv6. No special checking is currently done.
35295 .section "The VRFY, EXPN, and ETRN commands in SMTP" "SECID273"
35296 Support for these SMTP commands is disabled by default. If required, they can
35297 be enabled by defining suitable ACLs.
35302 .section "Privileged users" "SECID274"
35303 .cindex "trusted users"
35304 .cindex "admin user"
35305 .cindex "privileged user"
35306 .cindex "user" "trusted"
35307 .cindex "user" "admin"
35308 Exim recognizes two sets of users with special privileges. Trusted users are
35309 able to submit new messages to Exim locally, but supply their own sender
35310 addresses and information about a sending host. For other users submitting
35311 local messages, Exim sets up the sender address from the uid, and doesn't
35312 permit a remote host to be specified.
35315 However, an untrusted user is permitted to use the &%-f%& command line option
35316 in the special form &%-f <>%& to indicate that a delivery failure for the
35317 message should not cause an error report. This affects the message's envelope,
35318 but it does not affect the &'Sender:'& header. Untrusted users may also be
35319 permitted to use specific forms of address with the &%-f%& option by setting
35320 the &%untrusted_set_sender%& option.
35322 Trusted users are used to run processes that receive mail messages from some
35323 other mail domain and pass them on to Exim for delivery either locally, or over
35324 the Internet. Exim trusts a caller that is running as root, as the Exim user,
35325 as any user listed in the &%trusted_users%& configuration option, or under any
35326 group listed in the &%trusted_groups%& option.
35328 Admin users are permitted to do things to the messages on Exim's queue. They
35329 can freeze or thaw messages, cause them to be returned to their senders, remove
35330 them entirely, or modify them in various ways. In addition, admin users can run
35331 the Exim monitor and see all the information it is capable of providing, which
35332 includes the contents of files on the spool.
35336 By default, the use of the &%-M%& and &%-q%& options to cause Exim to attempt
35337 delivery of messages on its queue is restricted to admin users. This
35338 restriction can be relaxed by setting the &%no_prod_requires_admin%& option.
35339 Similarly, the use of &%-bp%& (and its variants) to list the contents of the
35340 queue is also restricted to admin users. This restriction can be relaxed by
35341 setting &%no_queue_list_requires_admin%&.
35343 Exim recognizes an admin user if the calling process is running as root or as
35344 the Exim user or if any of the groups associated with the calling process is
35345 the Exim group. It is not necessary actually to be running under the Exim
35346 group. However, if admin users who are not root or the Exim user are to access
35347 the contents of files on the spool via the Exim monitor (which runs
35348 unprivileged), Exim must be built to allow group read access to its spool
35353 .section "Spool files" "SECID275"
35354 .cindex "spool directory" "files"
35355 Exim's spool directory and everything it contains is owned by the Exim user and
35356 set to the Exim group. The mode for spool files is defined in the
35357 &_Local/Makefile_& configuration file, and defaults to 0640. This means that
35358 any user who is a member of the Exim group can access these files.
35362 .section "Use of argv[0]" "SECID276"
35363 Exim examines the last component of &%argv[0]%&, and if it matches one of a set
35364 of specific strings, Exim assumes certain options. For example, calling Exim
35365 with the last component of &%argv[0]%& set to &"rsmtp"& is exactly equivalent
35366 to calling it with the option &%-bS%&. There are no security implications in
35371 .section "Use of %f formatting" "SECID277"
35372 The only use made of &"%f"& by Exim is in formatting load average values. These
35373 are actually stored in integer variables as 1000 times the load average.
35374 Consequently, their range is limited and so therefore is the length of the
35379 .section "Embedded Exim path" "SECID278"
35380 Exim uses its own path name, which is embedded in the code, only when it needs
35381 to re-exec in order to regain root privilege. Therefore, it is not root when it
35382 does so. If some bug allowed the path to get overwritten, it would lead to an
35383 arbitrary program's being run as exim, not as root.
35387 .section "Dynamic module directory" "SECTdynmoddir"
35388 Any dynamically loadable modules must be installed into the directory
35389 defined in &`LOOKUP_MODULE_DIR`& in &_Local/Makefile_& for Exim to permit
35393 .section "Use of sprintf()" "SECID279"
35394 .cindex "&[sprintf()]&"
35395 A large number of occurrences of &"sprintf"& in the code are actually calls to
35396 &'string_sprintf()'&, a function that returns the result in malloc'd store.
35397 The intermediate formatting is done into a large fixed buffer by a function
35398 that runs through the format string itself, and checks the length of each
35399 conversion before performing it, thus preventing buffer overruns.
35401 The remaining uses of &[sprintf()]& happen in controlled circumstances where
35402 the output buffer is known to be sufficiently long to contain the converted
35407 .section "Use of debug_printf() and log_write()" "SECID280"
35408 Arbitrary strings are passed to both these functions, but they do their
35409 formatting by calling the function &'string_vformat()'&, which runs through
35410 the format string itself, and checks the length of each conversion.
35414 .section "Use of strcat() and strcpy()" "SECID281"
35415 These are used only in cases where the output buffer is known to be large
35416 enough to hold the result.
35417 .ecindex IIDsecurcon
35422 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
35423 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
35425 .chapter "Format of spool files" "CHAPspool"
35426 .scindex IIDforspo1 "format" "spool files"
35427 .scindex IIDforspo2 "spool directory" "format of files"
35428 .scindex IIDforspo3 "spool files" "format of"
35429 .cindex "spool files" "editing"
35430 A message on Exim's queue consists of two files, whose names are the message id
35431 followed by -D and -H, respectively. The data portion of the message is kept in
35432 the -D file on its own. The message's envelope, status, and headers are all
35433 kept in the -H file, whose format is described in this chapter. Each of these
35434 two files contains the final component of its own name as its first line. This
35435 is insurance against disk crashes where the directory is lost but the files
35436 themselves are recoverable.
35438 Some people are tempted into editing -D files in order to modify messages. You
35439 need to be extremely careful if you do this; it is not recommended and you are
35440 on your own if you do it. Here are some of the pitfalls:
35443 You must ensure that Exim does not try to deliver the message while you are
35444 fiddling with it. The safest way is to take out a write lock on the -D file,
35445 which is what Exim itself does, using &[fcntl()]&. If you update the file in
35446 place, the lock will be retained. If you write a new file and rename it, the
35447 lock will be lost at the instant of rename.
35449 .vindex "&$body_linecount$&"
35450 If you change the number of lines in the file, the value of
35451 &$body_linecount$&, which is stored in the -H file, will be incorrect. At
35452 present, this value is not used by Exim, but there is no guarantee that this
35453 will always be the case.
35455 If the message is in MIME format, you must take care not to break it.
35457 If the message is cryptographically signed, any change will invalidate the
35460 All in all, modifying -D files is fraught with danger.
35462 Files whose names end with -J may also be seen in the &_input_& directory (or
35463 its subdirectories when &%split_spool_directory%& is set). These are journal
35464 files, used to record addresses to which the message has been delivered during
35465 the course of a delivery attempt. If there are still undelivered recipients at
35466 the end, the -H file is updated, and the -J file is deleted. If, however, there
35467 is some kind of crash (for example, a power outage) before this happens, the -J
35468 file remains in existence. When Exim next processes the message, it notices the
35469 -J file and uses it to update the -H file before starting the next delivery
35472 .section "Format of the -H file" "SECID282"
35473 .cindex "uid (user id)" "in spool file"
35474 .cindex "gid (group id)" "in spool file"
35475 The second line of the -H file contains the login name for the uid of the
35476 process that called Exim to read the message, followed by the numerical uid and
35477 gid. For a locally generated message, this is normally the user who sent the
35478 message. For a message received over TCP/IP via the daemon, it is
35479 normally the Exim user.
35481 The third line of the file contains the address of the message's sender as
35482 transmitted in the envelope, contained in angle brackets. The sender address is
35483 empty for bounce messages. For incoming SMTP mail, the sender address is given
35484 in the MAIL command. For locally generated mail, the sender address is
35485 created by Exim from the login name of the current user and the configured
35486 &%qualify_domain%&. However, this can be overridden by the &%-f%& option or a
35487 leading &"From&~"& line if the caller is trusted, or if the supplied address is
35488 &"<>"& or an address that matches &%untrusted_set_senders%&.
35490 The fourth line contains two numbers. The first is the time that the message
35491 was received, in the conventional Unix form &-- the number of seconds since the
35492 start of the epoch. The second number is a count of the number of messages
35493 warning of delayed delivery that have been sent to the sender.
35495 There follow a number of lines starting with a hyphen. These can appear in any
35496 order, and are omitted when not relevant:
35499 .vitem "&%-acl%&&~<&'number'&>&~<&'length'&>"
35500 This item is obsolete, and is not generated from Exim release 4.61 onwards;
35501 &%-aclc%& and &%-aclm%& are used instead. However, &%-acl%& is still
35502 recognized, to provide backward compatibility. In the old format, a line of
35503 this form is present for every ACL variable that is not empty. The number
35504 identifies the variable; the &%acl_c%&&*x*& variables are numbered 0&--9 and
35505 the &%acl_m%&&*x*& variables are numbered 10&--19. The length is the length of
35506 the data string for the variable. The string itself starts at the beginning of
35507 the next line, and is followed by a newline character. It may contain internal
35510 .vitem "&%-aclc%&&~<&'rest-of-name'&>&~<&'length'&>"
35511 A line of this form is present for every ACL connection variable that is
35512 defined. Note that there is a space between &%-aclc%& and the rest of the name.
35513 The length is the length of the data string for the variable. The string itself
35514 starts at the beginning of the next line, and is followed by a newline
35515 character. It may contain internal newlines.
35517 .vitem "&%-aclm%&&~<&'rest-of-name'&>&~<&'length'&>"
35518 A line of this form is present for every ACL message variable that is defined.
35519 Note that there is a space between &%-aclm%& and the rest of the name. The
35520 length is the length of the data string for the variable. The string itself
35521 starts at the beginning of the next line, and is followed by a newline
35522 character. It may contain internal newlines.
35524 .vitem "&%-active_hostname%&&~<&'hostname'&>"
35525 This is present if, when the message was received over SMTP, the value of
35526 &$smtp_active_hostname$& was different to the value of &$primary_hostname$&.
35528 .vitem &%-allow_unqualified_recipient%&
35529 This is present if unqualified recipient addresses are permitted in header
35530 lines (to stop such addresses from being qualified if rewriting occurs at
35531 transport time). Local messages that were input using &%-bnq%& and remote
35532 messages from hosts that match &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%& set this flag.
35534 .vitem &%-allow_unqualified_sender%&
35535 This is present if unqualified sender addresses are permitted in header lines
35536 (to stop such addresses from being qualified if rewriting occurs at transport
35537 time). Local messages that were input using &%-bnq%& and remote messages from
35538 hosts that match &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& set this flag.
35540 .vitem "&%-auth_id%&&~<&'text'&>"
35541 The id information for a message received on an authenticated SMTP connection
35542 &-- the value of the &$authenticated_id$& variable.
35544 .vitem "&%-auth_sender%&&~<&'address'&>"
35545 The address of an authenticated sender &-- the value of the
35546 &$authenticated_sender$& variable.
35548 .vitem "&%-body_linecount%&&~<&'number'&>"
35549 This records the number of lines in the body of the message, and is always
35552 .vitem "&%-body_zerocount%&&~<&'number'&>"
35553 This records the number of binary zero bytes in the body of the message, and is
35554 present if the number is greater than zero.
35556 .vitem &%-deliver_firsttime%&
35557 This is written when a new message is first added to the spool. When the spool
35558 file is updated after a deferral, it is omitted.
35560 .vitem "&%-frozen%&&~<&'time'&>"
35561 .cindex "frozen messages" "spool data"
35562 The message is frozen, and the freezing happened at <&'time'&>.
35564 .vitem "&%-helo_name%&&~<&'text'&>"
35565 This records the host name as specified by a remote host in a HELO or EHLO
35568 .vitem "&%-host_address%&&~<&'address'&>.<&'port'&>"
35569 This records the IP address of the host from which the message was received and
35570 the remote port number that was used. It is omitted for locally generated
35573 .vitem "&%-host_auth%&&~<&'text'&>"
35574 If the message was received on an authenticated SMTP connection, this records
35575 the name of the authenticator &-- the value of the
35576 &$sender_host_authenticated$& variable.
35578 .vitem &%-host_lookup_failed%&
35579 This is present if an attempt to look up the sending host's name from its IP
35580 address failed. It corresponds to the &$host_lookup_failed$& variable.
35582 .vitem "&%-host_name%&&~<&'text'&>"
35583 .cindex "reverse DNS lookup"
35584 .cindex "DNS" "reverse lookup"
35585 This records the name of the remote host from which the message was received,
35586 if the host name was looked up from the IP address when the message was being
35587 received. It is not present if no reverse lookup was done.
35589 .vitem "&%-ident%&&~<&'text'&>"
35590 For locally submitted messages, this records the login of the originating user,
35591 unless it was a trusted user and the &%-oMt%& option was used to specify an
35592 ident value. For messages received over TCP/IP, this records the ident string
35593 supplied by the remote host, if any.
35595 .vitem "&%-interface_address%&&~<&'address'&>.<&'port'&>"
35596 This records the IP address of the local interface and the port number through
35597 which a message was received from a remote host. It is omitted for locally
35598 generated messages.
35601 The message is from a local sender.
35603 .vitem &%-localerror%&
35604 The message is a locally-generated bounce message.
35606 .vitem "&%-local_scan%&&~<&'string'&>"
35607 This records the data string that was returned by the &[local_scan()]& function
35608 when the message was received &-- the value of the &$local_scan_data$&
35609 variable. It is omitted if no data was returned.
35611 .vitem &%-manual_thaw%&
35612 The message was frozen but has been thawed manually, that is, by an explicit
35613 Exim command rather than via the auto-thaw process.
35616 A testing delivery process was started using the &%-N%& option to suppress any
35617 actual deliveries, but delivery was deferred. At any further delivery attempts,
35620 .vitem &%-received_protocol%&
35621 This records the value of the &$received_protocol$& variable, which contains
35622 the name of the protocol by which the message was received.
35624 .vitem &%-sender_set_untrusted%&
35625 The envelope sender of this message was set by an untrusted local caller (used
35626 to ensure that the caller is displayed in queue listings).
35628 .vitem "&%-spam_score_int%&&~<&'number'&>"
35629 If a message was scanned by SpamAssassin, this is present. It records the value
35630 of &$spam_score_int$&.
35632 .vitem &%-tls_certificate_verified%&
35633 A TLS certificate was received from the client that sent this message, and the
35634 certificate was verified by the server.
35636 .vitem "&%-tls_cipher%&&~<&'cipher name'&>"
35637 When the message was received over an encrypted connection, this records the
35638 name of the cipher suite that was used.
35640 .vitem "&%-tls_peerdn%&&~<&'peer DN'&>"
35641 When the message was received over an encrypted connection, and a certificate
35642 was received from the client, this records the Distinguished Name from that
35646 Following the options there is a list of those addresses to which the message
35647 is not to be delivered. This set of addresses is initialized from the command
35648 line when the &%-t%& option is used and &%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%&
35649 is set; otherwise it starts out empty. Whenever a successful delivery is made,
35650 the address is added to this set. The addresses are kept internally as a
35651 balanced binary tree, and it is a representation of that tree which is written
35652 to the spool file. If an address is expanded via an alias or forward file, the
35653 original address is added to the tree when deliveries to all its child
35654 addresses are complete.
35656 If the tree is empty, there is a single line in the spool file containing just
35657 the text &"XX"&. Otherwise, each line consists of two letters, which are either
35658 Y or N, followed by an address. The address is the value for the node of the
35659 tree, and the letters indicate whether the node has a left branch and/or a
35660 right branch attached to it, respectively. If branches exist, they immediately
35661 follow. Here is an example of a three-node tree:
35663 YY darcy@austen.fict.example
35664 NN alice@wonderland.fict.example
35665 NN editor@thesaurus.ref.example
35667 After the non-recipients tree, there is a list of the message's recipients.
35668 This is a simple list, preceded by a count. It includes all the original
35669 recipients of the message, including those to whom the message has already been
35670 delivered. In the simplest case, the list contains one address per line. For
35674 editor@thesaurus.ref.example
35675 darcy@austen.fict.example
35677 alice@wonderland.fict.example
35679 However, when a child address has been added to the top-level addresses as a
35680 result of the use of the &%one_time%& option on a &(redirect)& router, each
35681 line is of the following form:
35683 <&'top-level address'&> <&'errors_to address'&> &&&
35684 <&'length'&>,<&'parent number'&>#<&'flag bits'&>
35686 The 01 flag bit indicates the presence of the three other fields that follow
35687 the top-level address. Other bits may be used in future to support additional
35688 fields. The <&'parent number'&> is the offset in the recipients list of the
35689 original parent of the &"one time"& address. The first two fields are the
35690 envelope sender that is associated with this address and its length. If the
35691 length is zero, there is no special envelope sender (there are then two space
35692 characters in the line). A non-empty field can arise from a &(redirect)& router
35693 that has an &%errors_to%& setting.
35696 A blank line separates the envelope and status information from the headers
35697 which follow. A header may occupy several lines of the file, and to save effort
35698 when reading it in, each header is preceded by a number and an identifying
35699 character. The number is the number of characters in the header, including any
35700 embedded newlines and the terminating newline. The character is one of the
35704 .row <&'blank'&> "header in which Exim has no special interest"
35705 .row &`B`& "&'Bcc:'& header"
35706 .row &`C`& "&'Cc:'& header"
35707 .row &`F`& "&'From:'& header"
35708 .row &`I`& "&'Message-id:'& header"
35709 .row &`P`& "&'Received:'& header &-- P for &""postmark""&"
35710 .row &`R`& "&'Reply-To:'& header"
35711 .row &`S`& "&'Sender:'& header"
35712 .row &`T`& "&'To:'& header"
35713 .row &`*`& "replaced or deleted header"
35716 Deleted or replaced (rewritten) headers remain in the spool file for debugging
35717 purposes. They are not transmitted when the message is delivered. Here is a
35718 typical set of headers:
35720 111P Received: by hobbit.fict.example with local (Exim 4.00)
35721 id 14y9EI-00026G-00; Fri, 11 May 2001 10:28:59 +0100
35722 049 Message-Id: <E14y9EI-00026G-00@hobbit.fict.example>
35723 038* X-rewrote-sender: bb@hobbit.fict.example
35724 042* From: Bilbo Baggins <bb@hobbit.fict.example>
35725 049F From: Bilbo Baggins <B.Baggins@hobbit.fict.example>
35726 099* To: alice@wonderland.fict.example, rdo@foundation,
35727 darcy@austen.fict.example, editor@thesaurus.ref.example
35728 104T To: alice@wonderland.fict.example, rdo@foundation.example,
35729 darcy@austen.fict.example, editor@thesaurus.ref.example
35730 038 Date: Fri, 11 May 2001 10:28:59 +0100
35732 The asterisked headers indicate that the envelope sender, &'From:'& header, and
35733 &'To:'& header have been rewritten, the last one because routing expanded the
35734 unqualified domain &'foundation'&.
35735 .ecindex IIDforspo1
35736 .ecindex IIDforspo2
35737 .ecindex IIDforspo3
35739 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
35740 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
35742 .chapter "Support for DKIM (DomainKeys Identified Mail)" "CHID12" &&&
35746 DKIM is a mechanism by which messages sent by some entity can be provably
35747 linked to a domain which that entity controls. It permits reputation to
35748 be tracked on a per-domain basis, rather than merely upon source IP address.
35749 DKIM is documented in RFC 4871.
35751 Since version 4.70, DKIM support is compiled into Exim by default. It can be
35752 disabled by setting DISABLE_DKIM=yes in Local/Makefile.
35754 Exim's DKIM implementation allows to
35756 Sign outgoing messages: This function is implemented in the SMTP transport.
35757 It can co-exist with all other Exim features, including transport filters.
35759 Verify signatures in incoming messages: This is implemented by an additional
35760 ACL (acl_smtp_dkim), which can be called several times per message, with
35761 different signature contexts.
35764 In typical Exim style, the verification implementation does not include any
35765 default "policy". Instead it enables you to build your own policy using
35766 Exim's standard controls.
35768 Please note that verification of DKIM signatures in incoming mail is turned
35769 on by default for logging purposes. For each signature in incoming email,
35770 exim will log a line displaying the most important signature details, and the
35771 signature status. Here is an example (with line-breaks added for clarity):
35773 2009-09-09 10:22:28 1MlIRf-0003LU-U3 DKIM:
35774 d=facebookmail.com s=q1-2009b
35775 c=relaxed/relaxed a=rsa-sha1
35776 i=@facebookmail.com t=1252484542 [verification succeeded]
35778 You might want to turn off DKIM verification processing entirely for internal
35779 or relay mail sources. To do that, set the &%dkim_disable_verify%& ACL
35780 control modifier. This should typically be done in the RCPT ACL, at points
35781 where you accept mail from relay sources (internal hosts or authenticated
35785 .section "Signing outgoing messages" "SECID513"
35786 .cindex "DKIM" "signing"
35788 Signing is implemented by setting private options on the SMTP transport.
35789 These options take (expandable) strings as arguments.
35791 .option dkim_domain smtp string&!! unset
35793 The domain you want to sign with. The result of this expanded
35794 option is put into the &%$dkim_domain%& expansion variable.
35796 .option dkim_selector smtp string&!! unset
35798 This sets the key selector string. You can use the &%$dkim_domain%& expansion
35799 variable to look up a matching selector. The result is put in the expansion
35800 variable &%$dkim_selector%& which should be used in the &%dkim_private_key%&
35801 option along with &%$dkim_domain%&.
35803 .option dkim_private_key smtp string&!! unset
35805 This sets the private key to use. You can use the &%$dkim_domain%& and
35806 &%$dkim_selector%& expansion variables to determine the private key to use.
35807 The result can either
35809 be a valid RSA private key in ASCII armor, including line breaks.
35811 start with a slash, in which case it is treated as a file that contains
35814 be "0", "false" or the empty string, in which case the message will not
35815 be signed. This case will not result in an error, even if &%dkim_strict%&
35819 .option dkim_canon smtp string&!! unset
35821 This option sets the canonicalization method used when signing a message.
35822 The DKIM RFC currently supports two methods: "simple" and "relaxed".
35823 The option defaults to "relaxed" when unset. Note: the current implementation
35824 only supports using the same canonicalization method for both headers and body.
35826 .option dkim_strict smtp string&!! unset
35828 This option defines how Exim behaves when signing a message that
35829 should be signed fails for some reason. When the expansion evaluates to
35830 either "1" or "true", Exim will defer. Otherwise Exim will send the message
35831 unsigned. You can use the &%$dkim_domain%& and &%$dkim_selector%& expansion
35834 .option dkim_sign_headers smtp string&!! unset
35836 When set, this option must expand to (or be specified as) a colon-separated
35837 list of header names. Headers with these names will be included in the message
35838 signature. When unspecified, the header names recommended in RFC4871 will be
35842 .section "Verifying DKIM signatures in incoming mail" "SECID514"
35843 .cindex "DKIM" "verification"
35845 Verification of DKIM signatures in incoming email is implemented via the
35846 &%acl_smtp_dkim%& ACL. By default, this ACL is called once for each
35847 syntactically(!) correct signature in the incoming message.
35849 To evaluate the signature in the ACL a large number of expansion variables
35850 containing the signature status and its details are set up during the
35851 runtime of the ACL.
35853 Calling the ACL only for existing signatures is not sufficient to build
35854 more advanced policies. For that reason, the global option
35855 &%dkim_verify_signers%&, and a global expansion variable
35856 &%$dkim_signers%& exist.
35858 The global option &%dkim_verify_signers%& can be set to a colon-separated
35859 list of DKIM domains or identities for which the ACL &%acl_smtp_dkim%& is
35860 called. It is expanded when the message has been received. At this point,
35861 the expansion variable &%$dkim_signers%& already contains a colon-separated
35862 list of signer domains and identities for the message. When
35863 &%dkim_verify_signers%& is not specified in the main configuration,
35866 dkim_verify_signers = $dkim_signers
35868 This leads to the default behaviour of calling &%acl_smtp_dkim%& for each
35869 DKIM signature in the message. Current DKIM verifiers may want to explicitly
35870 call the ACL for known domains or identities. This would be achieved as follows:
35872 dkim_verify_signers = paypal.com:ebay.com:$dkim_signers
35874 This would result in &%acl_smtp_dkim%& always being called for "paypal.com"
35875 and "ebay.com", plus all domains and identities that have signatures in the message.
35876 You can also be more creative in constructing your policy. For example:
35878 dkim_verify_signers = $sender_address_domain:$dkim_signers
35881 If a domain or identity is listed several times in the (expanded) value of
35882 &%dkim_verify_signers%&, the ACL is only called once for that domain or identity.
35885 Inside the &%acl_smtp_dkim%&, the following expansion variables are
35886 available (from most to least important):
35890 .vitem &%$dkim_cur_signer%&
35891 The signer that is being evaluated in this ACL run. This can be a domain or
35892 an identity. This is one of the list items from the expanded main option
35893 &%dkim_verify_signers%& (see above).
35894 .vitem &%$dkim_verify_status%&
35895 A string describing the general status of the signature. One of
35897 &%none%&: There is no signature in the message for the current domain or
35898 identity (as reflected by &%$dkim_cur_signer%&).
35900 &%invalid%&: The signature could not be verified due to a processing error.
35901 More detail is available in &%$dkim_verify_reason%&.
35903 &%fail%&: Verification of the signature failed. More detail is
35904 available in &%$dkim_verify_reason%&.
35906 &%pass%&: The signature passed verification. It is valid.
35908 .vitem &%$dkim_verify_reason%&
35909 A string giving a litte bit more detail when &%$dkim_verify_status%& is either
35910 "fail" or "invalid". One of
35912 &%pubkey_unavailable%& (when &%$dkim_verify_status%&="invalid"): The public
35913 key for the domain could not be retrieved. This may be a temporary problem.
35915 &%pubkey_syntax%& (when &%$dkim_verify_status%&="invalid"): The public key
35916 record for the domain is syntactically invalid.
35918 &%bodyhash_mismatch%& (when &%$dkim_verify_status%&="fail"): The calculated
35919 body hash does not match the one specified in the signature header. This
35920 means that the message body was modified in transit.
35922 &%signature_incorrect%& (when &%$dkim_verify_status%&="fail"): The signature
35923 could not be verified. This may mean that headers were modified,
35924 re-written or otherwise changed in a way which is incompatible with
35925 DKIM verification. It may of course also mean that the signature is forged.
35927 .vitem &%$dkim_domain%&
35928 The signing domain. IMPORTANT: This variable is only populated if there is
35929 an actual signature in the message for the current domain or identity (as
35930 reflected by &%$dkim_cur_signer%&).
35931 .vitem &%$dkim_identity%&
35932 The signing identity, if present. IMPORTANT: This variable is only populated
35933 if there is an actual signature in the message for the current domain or
35934 identity (as reflected by &%$dkim_cur_signer%&).
35935 .vitem &%$dkim_selector%&
35936 The key record selector string.
35937 .vitem &%$dkim_algo%&
35938 The algorithm used. One of 'rsa-sha1' or 'rsa-sha256'.
35939 .vitem &%$dkim_canon_body%&
35940 The body canonicalization method. One of 'relaxed' or 'simple'.
35941 .vitem &%dkim_canon_headers%&
35942 The header canonicalization method. One of 'relaxed' or 'simple'.
35943 .vitem &%$dkim_copiedheaders%&
35944 A transcript of headers and their values which are included in the signature
35945 (copied from the 'z=' tag of the signature).
35946 .vitem &%$dkim_bodylength%&
35947 The number of signed body bytes. If zero ("0"), the body is unsigned. If no
35948 limit was set by the signer, "9999999999999" is returned. This makes sure
35949 that this variable always expands to an integer value.
35950 .vitem &%$dkim_created%&
35951 UNIX timestamp reflecting the date and time when the signature was created.
35952 When this was not specified by the signer, "0" is returned.
35953 .vitem &%$dkim_expires%&
35954 UNIX timestamp reflecting the date and time when the signer wants the
35955 signature to be treated as "expired". When this was not specified by the
35956 signer, "9999999999999" is returned. This makes it possible to do useful
35957 integer size comparisons against this value.
35958 .vitem &%$dkim_headernames%&
35959 A colon-separated list of names of headers included in the signature.
35960 .vitem &%$dkim_key_testing%&
35961 "1" if the key record has the "testing" flag set, "0" if not.
35962 .vitem &%$nosubdomains%&
35963 "1" if the key record forbids subdomaining, "0" otherwise.
35964 .vitem &%$dkim_key_srvtype%&
35965 Service type (tag s=) from the key record. Defaults to "*" if not specified
35967 .vitem &%$dkim_key_granularity%&
35968 Key granularity (tag g=) from the key record. Defaults to "*" if not specified
35970 .vitem &%$dkim_key_notes%&
35971 Notes from the key record (tag n=).
35974 In addition, two ACL conditions are provided:
35977 .vitem &%dkim_signers%&
35978 ACL condition that checks a colon-separated list of domains or identities
35979 for a match against the domain or identity that the ACL is currently verifying
35980 (reflected by &%$dkim_cur_signer%&). This is typically used to restrict an ACL
35981 verb to a group of domains or identities. For example:
35984 # Warn when Mail purportedly from GMail has no signature at all
35985 warn log_message = GMail sender without DKIM signature
35986 sender_domains = gmail.com
35987 dkim_signers = gmail.com
35991 .vitem &%dkim_status%&
35992 ACL condition that checks a colon-separated list of possible DKIM verification
35993 results agains the actual result of verification. This is typically used
35994 to restrict an ACL verb to a list of verification outcomes, for example:
35997 deny message = Mail from Paypal with invalid/missing signature
35998 sender_domains = paypal.com:paypal.de
35999 dkim_signers = paypal.com:paypal.de
36000 dkim_status = none:invalid:fail
36003 The possible status keywords are: 'none','invalid','fail' and 'pass'. Please
36004 see the documentation of the &%$dkim_verify_status%& expansion variable above
36005 for more information of what they mean.
36008 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
36009 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
36011 .chapter "Adding new drivers or lookup types" "CHID13" &&&
36012 "Adding drivers or lookups"
36013 .cindex "adding drivers"
36014 .cindex "new drivers, adding"
36015 .cindex "drivers" "adding new"
36016 The following actions have to be taken in order to add a new router, transport,
36017 authenticator, or lookup type to Exim:
36020 Choose a name for the driver or lookup type that does not conflict with any
36021 existing name; I will use &"newdriver"& in what follows.
36023 Add to &_src/EDITME_& the line:
36025 <&'type'&>&`_NEWDRIVER=yes`&
36027 where <&'type'&> is ROUTER, TRANSPORT, AUTH, or LOOKUP. If the
36028 code is not to be included in the binary by default, comment this line out. You
36029 should also add any relevant comments about the driver or lookup type.
36031 Add to &_src/config.h.defaults_& the line:
36033 #define <type>_NEWDRIVER
36036 Edit &_src/drtables.c_&, adding conditional code to pull in the private header
36037 and create a table entry as is done for all the other drivers and lookup types.
36039 Edit &_Makefile_& in the appropriate sub-directory (&_src/routers_&,
36040 &_src/transports_&, &_src/auths_&, or &_src/lookups_&); add a line for the new
36041 driver or lookup type and add it to the definition of OBJ.
36043 Create &_newdriver.h_& and &_newdriver.c_& in the appropriate sub-directory of
36046 Edit &_scripts/MakeLinks_& and add commands to link the &_.h_& and &_.c_& files
36047 as for other drivers and lookups.
36050 Then all you need to do is write the code! A good way to start is to make a
36051 proforma by copying an existing module of the same type, globally changing all
36052 occurrences of the name, and cutting out most of the code. Note that any
36053 options you create must be listed in alphabetical order, because the tables are
36054 searched using a binary chop procedure.
36056 There is a &_README_& file in each of the sub-directories of &_src_& describing
36057 the interface that is expected.
36062 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
36063 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
36065 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
36066 . These lines are processing instructions for the Simple DocBook Processor that
36067 . Philip Hazel has developed as a less cumbersome way of making PostScript and
36068 . PDFs than using xmlto and fop. They will be ignored by all other XML
36070 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
36075 foot_right_recto="&chaptertitle;"
36076 foot_right_verso="&chaptertitle;"
36080 .makeindex "Options index" "option"
36081 .makeindex "Variables index" "variable"
36082 .makeindex "Concept index" "concept"
36085 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
36086 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////